Skip to main content

AI assistant

Sign in to chat with this filing

The assistant answers questions, extracts KPIs, and summarises risk factors directly from the filing text.

Fulum Group Holdings Limited Proxy Solicitation & Information Statement 2011

Jul 27, 2011

49926_rns_2011-07-27_70ec9dc4-67ce-4eb2-82b0-dc6384384adf.pdf

Proxy Solicitation & Information Statement

Open in viewer

Opens in your device viewer

THIS CIRCULAR IS IMPORTANT AND REQUIRES YOUR IMMEDIATE ATTENTION

If you are in any doubt as to any aspect of this Circular, you should consult your stockbroker or other registered dealer in securities, bank manager, solicitor, professional accountants or other professional adviser.

If you have sold or transferred all your shares in Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited, you should at once hand this Circular together with the enclosed form of proxy to the transferee or to the bank, stockbroker or other agent through whom the sale was effected for transmission to the transferee.

Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited and The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited take no responsibility for the contents of this Circular, make no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaims any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon the whole or any part of the contents of this Circular.

This Circular is for information purposes only and does not constitute an invitation or offer to acquire, purchase or subscribe for securities.

(incorporated in Bermuda with limited liability)

(Stock Code: 621)

(1) VERY SUBSTANTIAL ACQUISITION OF UP TO 86.966% OF TAUNG GOLD LIMITED

(2) ISSUE OF WING HING SHARES UNDER SPECIFIC MANDATE (3) GRANT OF OPTIONS UNDER ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

(4) PROPOSED INCREASE IN AUTHORISED SHARE CAPITAL (5) NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING (6) PROPOSED CHANGE OF NAME

Unless the context otherwise requires, all capitalised terms used in this Circular have the meanings set out in the section headed ‘‘Definitions’’ of this Circular.

A letter from the Board is set out on pages 11 to 165 of this Circular.

A notice convening a special general meeting (SGM) of Wing Hing to be held at Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower, No. 8 Yeung Uk Road, Tsuen Wan, New Territories, Hong Kong on 19 August 2011, Friday, at 11: 00 a.m. is set out on pages N-1 to N-5 of this Circular.

Whether or not you are able to attend the SGM, you are requested to complete the accompanying form of proxy for use at the SGM in accordance with the instructions printed thereon and return the same to Wing Hing’s branch share registrar in Hong Kong, Tricor Tengis Limited, at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong, as soon as possible but in any event not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for the holding of the SGM or any adjournment thereof. Completion and return of the form of proxy will not preclude you from attending and voting in person at the SGM or any adjourned meeting thereof should you so wish.

28 July 2011

IMPORTANT

FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION

Certain information contained in this Circular constitutes forward-looking information. Investors are cautioned that forward-looking information is inherently uncertain and involves risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results, performance or achievements of Wing Hing to be materially different from any future results, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such forward-looking information.

Such forward-looking information includes comments regarding the completion and terms of the Transactions and the proposed business model and strategic plans of the Wing Hing Group, the Taung Group or the Enlarged Group. Factors that could cause actual results to differ materially include (without limitation) the ability to complete the Transactions, the failure to receive regulatory or shareholders’ approvals with respect to the Transactions and the Specific Mandate, and a change to the financial, political and regulatory positions in Hong Kong and South Africa and other relevant jurisdictions. In addition, specific reference is made to the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part B — Risk Factors — 1. Risks Associated with the Acquisition’’ in the letter from the Board. There can be no assurance that future developments affecting the Wing Hing Group or the Taung Group will be those anticipated by Wing Hing’s management.

While Wing Hing may elect to update the forward-looking information at any time, Wing Hing does not undertake to update it at any particular time or in response to any particular event. Investors and others should not assume that any forward-looking information in this Circular represents an estimation by Wing Hing’s management as at any date other than the Latest Practicable Date.

CURRENCY AND EXCHANGE RATES

For the purpose of illustration only, amounts denominated in US$ have been translated into HK$ at the rate of US$1.00 = HK$7.8 and amounts denominated in ZAR have been translated into US$ at the rate of US$1.00 = ZAR8.00, unless otherwise stated and such translations have been rounded to the nearest two (2) decimal points. Such translations should not be construed as a representation that the amounts quoted could have been or could be or will be converted at the stated rate or at any other rates at all.

– i –

CONTENTS

Page
IMPORTANT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . i
CONTENTS
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . ii
DEFINITIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
GLOSSARY
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . 10
LETTER FROM THE BOARD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
APPENDIX I — ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON WING HING
. . .
. . . . . . . I-1
APPENDIX II — FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF
THE TAUNG GROUP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . II-1
APPENDIX III — UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL
INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP . . . . . . III-1
APPENDIX IV — THE COMPETENT PERSONS REPORT
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . IV-1
APPENDIX V — THE VALUATION REPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V-1
APPENDIX VI — THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT,
ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT
AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . VI-1
APPENDIX VII — ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
ON THE TAUNG GROUP
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . VII-1
APPENDIX VIII — STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
ON WING HING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VIII-1
APPENDIX IX — DOCUMENTS AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION . . . . . . . IX-1
NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N-1

– ii –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Accountant’s Report’’ Taung Group’s accountant’s report for the three years ended 28 February 2011, which is set out in Appendix II of this Circular

  • ‘‘Acquisition’’ the acquisition of up to 86.966% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold subject to the terms set out in the Acquisition Agreement

  • ‘‘Acquisition the conditional sale and purchase agreement dated 28 January Agreement’’ 2011 entered into by Wing Hing, TG Sellers, Mandra and GoldCom for the acquisition of the TG Sale Shares, the Other TG Sale Shares and the Arctic Sale Shares, as amended by the Amendment Agreement and the Second Amendment Agreement

  • ‘‘Amendment the amendment agreement dated 22 March 2011 entered into by Agreement’’ Wing Hing, the TG Sellers (except for Easy Capital Holdings Limited, Manford Capital (HK) Limited, Amplewood Resources Limited, Hong Kong Sheen Smile International Investment Limited and Sino Reach Investments Limited), Supreme Best Limited, Mandra and GoldCom

  • ‘‘Announcement’’ the announcement issued by Wing Hing on 4 April 2011 in relation to the Acquisition

  • ‘‘Arctic’’ Arctic Sun Trading 56 (Pty) Ltd, which will be the indirect legal and beneficial owner of approximately 28.62% of Taung Gold as at the First Completion Date and not less than 26.0% of Taung Gold from Electrum Completion

  • ‘‘Arctic Consideration 1,638,677,252 new Wing Hing Shares valued at HK$0.41 each to Shares’’ be issued by Wing Hing to Mandra

  • ‘‘Arctic Holdco’’

  • Taung Gold BEE Limited, which will be the legal and beneficial owner of 49.90% of the issued capital of Arctic as at the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘Arctic Sale Shares’’ the entire issued share capital of Arctic Holdco, which in turn will hold 49.90% of the issued capital of Arctic as at the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘associate(s)’’

  • has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules

– 1 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Bankable Feasibility a comprehensive design and costing study of the selected option Study’’ or ‘‘feasibility for the development of a mineral project in which appropriate study’’ assessments have been made of realistically assumed geological, mining, metallurgical, economic, marketing, legal, environmental, social, governmental, engineering, operational and all other modifying factors, which are considered in sufficient detail to demonstrate at the time of reporting that extraction is reasonably justified (economically mineable) and the factors reasonably serve as the basis for a final decision by a proponent or financial institution to proceed with, or finance, the development of the project. The overall confidence of the study should be stated

  • ‘‘BEE’’ broad-based black economic empowerment

  • ‘‘BEE Shareholders’’ shareholders of SepGold who are historically disadvantaged South Africans

  • ‘‘Bless Luck’’ Bless Luck International Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Wing Hing

  • ‘‘Board’’

  • the board of Directors

  • ‘‘Business Day(s)’’ a day (excluding a Saturday, Sunday and public holiday) on which commercial banks are generally open for business in Hong Kong and South Africa and on which the Exchange is open for the business of dealing in securities

  • ‘‘Circular’’ this circular to be issued to the WH Shareholders

  • ‘‘Competent Evaluator’’ BMI Appraisals Limited, a competent evaluator as defined under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules

  • ‘‘Competent Person’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules

  • ‘‘Competent Persons the independent competent persons report on the South African Report’’ gold assets of the Taung Group prepared by Venmyn Rand Proprietary Limited, a third party independent of Wing Hing, in accordance with the JORC Code, the SAMREC Code and the Listing Rules, which is dated 11 February 2011

  • ‘‘Conditions’’ the conditions precedent to First Completion

  • ‘‘connected person(s)’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules

  • ‘‘Consideration’’

  • up to US$580,000,000, being the aggregate of the Loan Amount and the total consideration for the TG Sale Shares, the Other TG Sale Shares, the Arctic Sale Shares and the Electrum Option Shares

– 2 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Dayan Licence’’ the mining rights licence no. 5200000711044 granted by the PRC Ministry of Land and Resources in relation to the coal mine located in Zhijin County in the southwestern part of Guizhou Province

  • ‘‘Deed of Adherence’’ the form of a deed of adherence contained in the Acquisition Agreement which the Other TG Shareholders may enter into to adhere to the terms and conditions of the Acquisition Agreement

  • ‘‘Director(s)’’ the directors of Wing Hing

  • ‘‘DMR’’ Department of Mineral Resources of the Republic of South Africa

  • ‘‘Earn-in Agreement’’ a series of nine agreements between Taung Gold and EGM Limited dated 29 February 2008 under which EGM Limited is obliged to transfer the mining rights under the Evander Project to Taung Gold after certain works have been completed by Taung Gold, the details of which are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3.4 The Evander Project — (c) Sufficient influence in decisions over exploration of gold resources’’

  • ‘‘EGM Limited’’ Evander Gold Mines Limited, a subsidiary of Harmony

  • ‘‘Electrum’’ Electrum Strategic Exploration Limited

  • ‘‘Electrum Completion’’ completion of the sale and purchase of the Electrum Option Shares

  • ‘‘Electrum Completion the date of completion of the sale and purchase of the Electrum Date’’ Option Shares in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Acquisition Agreement and the Electrum Option Agreement

  • ‘‘Electrum Consideration Shares’’

  • up to 1,147,523,915 new Wing Hing Shares to be issued by Wing Hing to Electrum at the Issue Price

  • ‘‘Electrum Option an option agreement which may be entered into between Agreement’’ Electrum and Wing Hing on or prior to the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘Electrum Option up to 21,500,000 new TG Shares which Electrum is entitled to Shares’’ acquire if it elects to exercise the Electrum TG Warrants

  • ‘‘Electrum TG warrants in Taung Gold held by Electrum which if exercised, will Warrants’’ entitle Electrum to acquire the Electrum Option Shares, representing approximately 9.09% of the entire issued share capital of Taung Gold

– 3 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Enlarged Group’’

  • the Wing Hing Group immediately after First Completion

  • ‘‘Evander Project’’

  • the gold project located in the Six Shaft area and the Twistdraai area situated in the Mpumalanga Province of South Africa

  • ‘‘Evander Subsidiaries’’ the subsidiaries to be established by EGM Limited for the purpose of holding the rights to the Evander Project

  • ‘‘Exchange’’

The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited

  • ‘‘First Completion’’ completion of the sale and purchase of all TG Shares (other than those TG Shares to be acquired by Electrum upon its exercise of the Electrum TG Warrants) and Arctic Sale Shares

  • ‘‘First Completion Date’’

  • the date of First Completion, being the tenth Business Day after satisfaction or waiver of the Conditions (such date not being later than the Long Stop Date) unless Wing Hing, the majority of the TG Sellers (including any Other TG Shareholder who has entered into a Deed of Adherence to sell the TG Shares held by it to Wing Hing) and Mandra otherwise agree in writing to be another day

  • ‘‘Founders’’ Dr. David Twist and Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin ‘‘Future Material any agreement, arrangement or understanding outside the Transaction’’ ordinary course of business of Wing Hing and involving expenditure or liability of more than US$15,000,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$116,250,000)

  • ‘‘GoldCom’’ Gold Commercial Services Limited, a company incorporated under the laws of the British Virgin Islands with limited liability, whose principal business activities consist of investment holding and related activities

  • ‘‘GoldCom up to 1,134,348,686 new Wing Hing Shares to be issued by Wing Consideration Hing to GoldCom at the Issue Price on the First Completion Shares’’ Date

  • ‘‘Greenfield Projects’’ early stage exploration projects of the Taung Group

  • ‘‘Harmony’’ Harmony Gold Mining Company Limited

  • ‘‘HK$’’ Hong Kong dollars, the lawful currency of Hong Kong

  • ‘‘Hong Kong’’ the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region of the People’s Republic of China

  • ‘‘IFRS’’

  • International Financial Reporting Standards

  • ‘‘Investment a committee of the Board to be established on the First Committee’’ Completion Date comprising five members, namely three (3) directors from Taung Gold and two (2) existing Directors

– 4 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Issue Price’’

  • HK$0.41 per Wing Hing Share

  • ‘‘Jeanette Project’’

  • the mineral exploration and mining operation located in the Jeanette area within the Welkom goldfield in the Free State Province of South Africa

  • ‘‘JORC Code’’

has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules

  • ‘‘Last Trading Day’’

  • 28 January 2011, being the last full trading day for Wing Hing Shares prior to suspension of trading in the Wing Hing Shares pending the issue of the Announcement

  • ‘‘Latest Practicable 25 July 2011 Date’’

  • ‘‘Listing Committee’’ the Listing Committee of the Exchange

  • ‘‘Listing Rules’’

  • the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited

  • ‘‘Loan Amount’’

approximately HK$464,480,706.98

  • ‘‘Loan Note’’

  • the loan note having a principal amount of the Loan Amount to be issued by GoldCom to Wing Hing in consideration for the issue of new Wing Hing Shares

  • ‘‘Lock-up Shares’’ the Wing Hing Shares held by the TG Sellers, the Other TG Shareholders and Mandra directly or indirectly as at First Completion, including all Wing Hing Shares held by the TG Sellers, the Other TG Shareholders and Mandra through their affiliates

  • ‘‘Long Stop Date’’ 30 November 2011

  • ‘‘Mandra’’

  • Mandra Materials Limited, which will be the legal and beneficial owner of 100% of the issued capital of Arctic Holdco as at the First Completion Date and whose principal business activity is investment holding

  • ‘‘Mining Right No 107/2010’’

  • the new order mining right over an extensive mining area that permits the mining of gold and associated minerals in the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas

  • ‘‘Minxcon’’

  • Minxcon (Proprietary) Limited

  • ‘‘MMR’’

  • the Minister of the Department of Mineral Resources of South Africa

  • ‘‘MPRDA’’

  • the Mineral and Petroleum Resources Development Act of South Africa (28 of 2002)

– 5 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Other Consideration up to 743,079,165 new Wing Hing Shares to be issued to the Shares’’ Other TG Shareholders who have entered into Deeds of Adherence to sell their Other TG Sale Shares on or before the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘Other TG Sale Shares’’ shares in Taung Gold held by those Other TG Shareholders which may be purchased by Wing Hing on the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘Other TG those shareholders of Taung Gold in respect of whom Wing Hing Shareholders’’ offers to purchase the Other TG Sale Shares on or before the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘PRC Subsidiary’’ 貴州金億達礦業有限公司 (translated as Guizhou Jinyida Mining Company Limited), a wholly foreign owned enterprise established in the PRC and an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Union Sense

  • ‘‘PRC’’ the People’s Republic of China which, for the purposes of this Circular, excludes Hong Kong, the Macau Special Administrative Region of the PRC and Taiwan

  • ‘‘Pre-Feasibility Study’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules

  • ‘‘Proposed Change of the proposed change of the English name of Wing Hing from Name’’ ‘‘Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited’’ to ‘‘Taung Gold International Limited’’ and the change of the Chinese name ‘‘永 興國際(控股)有限公司’’ (which has been used for identification purposes only) to ‘‘壇金礦業有限公司’’ for identification purposes only

  • ‘‘Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital’’

  • the grant of approval by the WH Shareholders for the increase in the authorised share capital of Wing Hing from 15,000,000,000 Wing Hing Shares to 30,000,000,000 Wing Hing Shares by the creation of 15,000,000,000 additional new Wing Hing Shares

  • ‘‘Put Option Agreements’’

  • the agreements that may be entered into on or prior to the First Completion Date by each South African Shareholder, GoldCom and Wing Hing pursuant to which GoldCom conditionally agrees to grant a right to the relevant South African Shareholders to sell their TG Shares (the SA Put Option)

  • ‘‘Put Option Consideration Shares’’

  • such number of Wing Hing Shares as is calculated by multiplying the Share Exchange Ratio by the number of TG Shares to be sold by the relevant South African Shareholder

  • ‘‘Qualified BEE a company controlled by historically disadvantaged South Company’’ Africans

  • ‘‘RMB’’ Renminbi, the lawful currency of the People’s Republic of China

  • ‘‘RMB’’

– 6 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Rs’’ Rupees, the lawful currency of India ‘‘Sale Agreement’’ an agreement (including amendments to it) between EGM Limited and Pluriclox (Proprietary) Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Taung Gold, dated September 2010 pursuant to which, Pluriclox (Proprietary) Limited agreed to acquire the entire interest in the Evander Project, subject to the approval by the MMR for the transfer of a subdivided portion of EGM Limited’s new order mining right to Pluriclox (Proprietary) Limited

  • ‘‘SAMREC Code’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules ‘‘SAMVAL Code’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules ‘‘SARB’’ South African Reserve Bank ‘‘Scoping Study’’ has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules ‘‘Second Amendment the second amendment agreement dated 22 July 2011 entered Agreement’’ into by Wing Hing, the TG Sellers, Supreme Best Limited, Mandra and GoldCom

  • ‘‘SepGold’’ Sephaku Gold Holdings Limited ‘‘SFO’’ The Securities and Futures Ordinance (Chapter 571 of the Laws of Hong Kong)

  • ‘‘SGM’’ the special general meeting of Wing Hing to be convened to approve the matter(s) referred to herein

  • ‘‘Share Exchange means the ratio of 53.37320537 Wing Hing Shares for every 1 Ratio’’ (one) TG Share. There shall be no issuance of fractional Wing Hing Shares. This ratio applies to the TG Sale Shares, the Other TG Sale Shares, the Arctic Sale Shares, the Electrum Option Shares and the TG Shares held by the TG Optionholders following the exercise of their options in Taung Gold

  • ‘‘South Africa’’ the Republic of South Africa ‘‘South African those shareholders of Taung Gold who are residents of South Shareholders’’ Africa

  • ‘‘Specific Mandate’’ the authority to allot and issue such number of Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares pursuant to the resolutions of WH Shareholders to be proposed at the SGM

  • ‘‘State’’ the South African State ‘‘Takeovers Code’’ the Code on Takeovers and Mergers issued by the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong

– 7 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Taung Gold’’

  • Taung Gold Limited, a company incorporated under the laws of South Africa with limited liability

  • ‘‘Taung Group’’

Taung Gold and its subsidiaries

  • ‘‘TG Consideration Shares’’

  • 6,314,000,985 new Wing Hing Shares to be issued by Wing Hing to the TG Sellers at the Issue Price

  • ‘‘TG Optionholder(s)’’ holder(s) of options in Taung Gold which entitle the TG Optionholder to acquire TG Shares

  • ‘‘TG Optionholder Agreement(s)’’

  • optionholder agreement(s) that may be entered into between each of the TG Optionholders, GoldCom, Taung Gold and Wing Hing on or before the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘TG Optionholder Consideration Shares’’

  • up to 1,009,616,519 new Wing Hing Shares to be issued to the TG Optionholders who have entered into TG Optionholder Agreements and who exercise their right to sell up to 80% of the TG Shares held by them to Wing Hing following the First Completion Date

  • ‘‘TG Sale Shares’’

  • TG Shares held by TG Sellers on the First Completion Date, representing 50.02% of the issued and outstanding capital of Taung Gold

  • ‘‘TG Sellers’’

Electrum; David Twist; Helena Twist; Woo Foong Hong Limited; Yi Star Investment Limited; Lin, Hsin-Ho; Able Union Limited; ZNE Capital Limited; Fully Global Investments Limited; Grit Capital Limited; Angelfly Investments Limited; Mandra Esop Limited; Montane Development Limited; Hu, Xiang-Cheng; Mui, Bing-Wah Grace; Mandra; Easy Capital Holdings Limited; Manford Capital (HK) Limited: Amplewood Resources Limited; Hong Kong Sheen Smile International Investment Limited; and Sino Reach Investments Limited

  • ‘‘TG Shares’’

ordinary shares of ZAR0.001 each in the issued share capital of Taung Gold from time to time

– 8 –

DEFINITIONS

  • ‘‘Total Consideration the TG Consideration Shares, the Arctic Consideration Shares, Shares’’ the Other Consideration Shares, the GoldCom Consideration Shares and the Electrum Consideration Shares

  • ‘‘Transaction the Acquisition Agreement (including the Amendment Documents’’ Agreement and the Second Amendment Agreement), the Put Option Agreement, the Electrum Option Agreement, the TG Optionholder Agreement, the Deed of Adherence, the Lock-Up Agreements, the Lock-in Agreement and any other agreement, document or certificate entered into in connection with the transactions contemplated under these documents

  • ‘‘Transactions’’

  • the transactions contemplated under the Transaction Documents

  • ‘‘Union Sense’’

  • Union Sense Development Limited, a non-wholly owned subsidiary of the Wing Hing Group, of which 70% of the issued share capital is beneficially owned by Bless Luck

  • ‘‘United States’’

  • United States of America

  • ‘‘US$’’

  • United States dollars, the lawful currency of the United States

  • ‘‘Valuation Report’’ the valuation report prepared by the Competent Evaluator on the material assets of the Taung Group

  • ‘‘Venmyn’’

  • Venmyn Rand (Proprietary) Limited

  • ‘‘WH Shareholders’’

  • the holders of ordinary share(s) of HK$0.01 each in the existing issued share capital of Wing Hing

  • ‘‘WH Warrants’’ the 236,348,000 warrants of Wing Hing in issue as at the Latest Practicable Date, which if exercised in full, represent approximately 9.7% of Wing Hing as at the Latest Practicable Date (on a fully diluted basis)

  • ‘‘Wing Hing’’

  • Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited, a company incorporated in Bermuda with limited liability, the shares of which are listed on the Exchange

  • ‘‘Wing Hing Group’’ Wing Hing and its subsidiaries from time to time

  • ‘‘Wing Hing Shares’’ ordinary share(s) of HK$0.01 each in Wing Hing

  • ‘‘Xinghe Licence’’ the mining rights licence no. 5200000711403 granted by the PRC Ministry of Land and Resources in relation to the coal mine located proximate to the township of Baimang, and approximately 25 kilometres west of Duyun City

  • ‘‘ZAR’’ or ‘‘R’’ South African Rand, the lawful currency of the Republic of South Africa

  • ‘‘%’’

  • per cent.

– 9 –

GLOSSARY

‘‘g/t’’ gram per tonne ‘‘Indicated that part of a mineral resource for which tonnage, densities, shape, Resource’’ physical characteristics, quality, and mineral content can be estimated with a reasonable level of confidence. It is based on exploration, sampling, and testing information gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings, and drill holes. The locations are too widely or inappropriately spaced to confirm geological and/or quality continuity but are spaced closely enough for continuity to be assumed

‘‘Inferred that part of a mineral resource for which tonnage, quality and mineral Resource’’ content can be estimated with a low level of confidence. It is inferred from geological evidence and assumed but not verified geological and/ or quality continuity. It is based on information gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings and drill holes which may be limited or of uncertain quality and reliability ‘‘km’’ kilometre(s) ‘‘kt’’ kilotonne ‘‘MW’’ mega watt ‘‘m’’ metres ‘‘m[3] ’’ cubic metre ‘‘Measured that part of a mineral resource for which the nature, quality, amount Resource’’ and distribution of data are such as to leave no reasonable doubt, in the opinion of the Competent Person determining the mineral resource, that the tonnage and grade of the mineralisation can be estimated to within close limits, and that any variation from the estimate would be unlikely to significantly affect potential economic viability. This category requires a high level of confidence in, and understanding of, the geology and controls of the mineral deposit. Confidence in the estimate is sufficient to allow the application of technical and economic parameters and to enable an evaluation of economic viability that has a greater degree of certainty than an evaluation based on an Indicated Mineral Resource

‘‘Mt’’ million tonnes ‘‘Mtpa’’ million tonnes per annum ‘‘oz’’ ounce ‘‘sq. km’’ square kilometre(s) ‘‘t’’ tonnes ‘‘tph’’ tonnes per hour

– 10 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(incorporated in Bermuda with limited liability)

(Stock Code: 621)

Executive Directors:

Mr. Li Hok Yin Ms. Cheung Pak Sum Mr. Shen Junchen

Registered office: Canon’s Court 22 Victoria Street Hamilton, HM12 Bermuda

Independent Non-executive Directors:

Mr. Chui Man Lung, Everett Mr. Hui Wah Tat, Anthony Mr. Li Kam Chung

Principal office: Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower 8 Yeung Uk Road Tsuen Wan, New Territories Hong Kong

To the WH Shareholders:

Dear Sir or Madam,

  • (1) VERY SUBSTANTIAL ACQUISITION OF UP TO 86.966% OF TAUNG GOLD LIMITED

  • (2) ISSUE OF WING HING SHARES UNDER SPECIFIC MANDATE

(3) GRANT OPTIONS UNDER ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

(4) PROPOSED INCREASE IN AUTHORISED SHARE CAPITAL (5) NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING (6) PROPOSED CHANGE OF NAME

INTRODUCTION

Wing Hing announced that on 28 January 2011, it had entered into the Acquisition Agreement with the TG Sellers, Mandra and GoldCom relating to the sale and purchase of up to 86.966% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold subject to the terms of the Acquisition Agreement. The Acquisition Agreement has subsequently been amended by the Amendment Agreement and the Second Amendment Agreement. The Consideration for the Acquisition is up to US$580,000,000 (equivalent to HK$4,524,000,000) and will be satisfied by the issue of up to 10,977,630,003 new Wing Hing Shares at the issue price of HK$0.41 each. Under the Acquisition Agreement, completion of the Transactions will take place in two tranches.

– 11 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Taung Gold was incorporated under the laws of South Africa and was founded by Dr. David Twist and Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin. The Taung Group is engaged in the acquisition, exploration and development of mineral assets in respect of gold (and minerals associated with gold) located in South Africa. The primary assets of the Taung Group are the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. The Evander Project and Jeanette Project are advanced gold exploration projects for which Scoping Studies have been completed and for which Pre-Feasibility Studies and Bankable Feasibility Studies have been commissioned.

The Board believes the Acquisition will strengthen Wing Hing’s commitment to and will further develop its gold mining business. The Board believes that the Acquisition is in the interest of Wing Hing and the WH Shareholders as a whole and it hopes that WH Shareholders will support this exciting new phase in Wing Hing’s development by voting in favour of the Transactions.

Benefits to WH Shareholders

The Board believes that the Acquisition brings the following benefits to Wing Hing and for all WH Shareholders:

  • (a) the Acquisition represents a good opportunity to take advantage of the expected rising trend in the global price of gold;

  • (b) the Acquisition will deliver to Wing Hing a substantial portfolio of Measured and Indicated gold resources and Inferred gold resources exploration projects and future growth opportunities;

  • (c) the Taung Group will develop into one of the lower-cost producers in the South African gold mining industry when production of its projects commences;

  • (d) the Taung Group has a management team with extensive experience in gold mining, exploration and investment and it is expected that they will remain in the Enlarged Group following completion of the Transactions; and

  • (e) the Taung Group complies with the requirements for listing of a mineral company under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules.

Compliance with the requirements for listing under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules

Both (i) an independent competent persons report on the South African gold assets of the Taung Group addressed to Taung Gold and to Wing Hing (being the Competent Persons Report); and (ii) an independent valuation report addressed to Wing Hing on the material assets of the Taung Group, namely the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project (being the Valuation Report), are appended to this Circular.

Neither the Evander Project nor the Jeanette Project are in production stage but are in advanced exploration stage for which Scoping Studies have been completed and they have proceeded to at least the Pre-Feasibility Study stage, with a clear plan to proceed to

– 12 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

production. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project amount to an aggregate of approximately 11.725 million ounces.

The Listing Committee has also resolved that the Acquisition would not constitute a reverse takeover for the purpose of Rule 14.06(6) of the Listing Rules.

Purpose of this Circular

As one or more of the applicable percentage ratios (as defined under Rule 14.07 of the Listing Rules) in respect of the Transactions is or are greater than 100%, the Acquisition constitutes a very substantial acquisition for Wing Hing under Chapter 14 of the Listing Rules and will accordingly be subject to the shareholders’ approval requirements under Chapter 14 of the Listing Rules.

The purpose of this Circular is to provide you with, among other things:

  • (a) further information on the structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition, the satisfaction of the Consideration and the reasons for and benefits of the Transactions;

  • (b) further information on the risks associated with the Acquisition, the Taung Group’s business, the global gold mining industry, the South African gold mining industry and on investing in South Africa;

  • (c) further information on the quality and nature of the assets and business of the Taung Group;

  • (d) further information on the Loan Note, the Put Option Agreement, the Electrum Option Agreement and the TG Optionholder Agreement;

  • (e) further information on the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital;

  • (f) further information on the Total Consideration Shares, the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares and the Specific Mandate;

  • (g) the financial information of the Wing Hing Group, the Taung Group and its subsidiaries and the pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group;

  • (h) the Competent Persons Report;

  • (i) the Valuation Report;

  • (j) further information on the Proposed Change of Name;

– 13 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (k) the notice of the SGM at which ordinary resolutions will be proposed to consider and, if thought fit, approve, among other things:

  • (i) the Acquisition Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder (including the Loan Note, the issue of the Total Consideration Shares and the issue of the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares);

  • (ii) the Put Option Agreement, the Electrum Option Agreement and the TG Optionholder Agreements;

  • (iii) the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital; and

  • (iv) the Specific Mandate; and

  • (l) the notice of the SGM at which a special resolution will be proposed to consider, and if thought fit, approve the Proposed Change of Name.

Structure of this Circular

This letter from the Board is divided into eleven (11) parts and nine (9) appendices.

  • Part A : provides further information on the structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the satisfaction of the Consideration (including information on the Loan Note and the Put Option Agreements, the grant of the put options under the Electrum Option Agreement and the TG Optionholder Agreement) and the reasons for and benefits of the Transactions

  • Part B : sets out the risks associated with the Acquisition, the business of the Taung Group, the global gold mining industry, the South African gold mining industry and on investing in South Africa

  • Part C : sets out further information on the Taung Group and its primary projects (including an overview of the gold mining industry in South Africa)

  • Part D : provides the financial information and management discussion and analysis of the Taung Group

  • Part E : sets out further information on Mandra, Arctic and SepGold Part F : provides further information on the Wing Hing Group and the Enlarged Group

  • Part G : provides the financial information and management discussion and analysis of the Wing Hing Group

– 14 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • Part H : sets out the Listing Rules implications (including information on the Proposed Increase in Authorised Capital and the Specific Mandate)

  • Part I : sets out further information on the Proposed Change of Name Part J : sets out the additional information on the SGM

  • Part K : sets out the recommendations of the Board

  • Appendix I : provides the financial information of the Wing Hing Group for the three years ended 31 March 2011

  • Appendix II : provides the financial information of the Taung Group for the three years ended 28 February 2011

  • Appendix III : provides the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group

  • Appendix IV : sets out the Competent Persons Report

  • Appendix V : sets out the Valuation Report

  • Appendix VI : provides further information on the Loan Note, the Put Option Agreement, the Electrum Option Agreement and the TG Optionholder Agreement

  • Appendix VII : provides additional general information on the Taung Group

  • Appendix VIII : sets out the statutory and general information on Wing Hing

  • Appendix IX : sets out the documents to be made available for inspection by Wing Hing

This Circular also contains the notices convening the SGM.

– 15 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART A — STRUCTURE OF THE TRANSACTIONS, THE ACQUISITION AND THE CONSIDERATION

As at the Latest Practicable Date, public shareholders hold 100% of Wing Hing. Upon completion of the Acquisition, the shareholders of Taung Gold existing as at the First Completion Date, GoldCom and Electrum will together hold approximately 81.73% of the issued share capital of Wing Hing, and the shareholders of Wing Hing existing immediately prior to the First Completion Date will together hold approximately 18.27% of the issued share capital of Wing Hing. Wing Hing’s shareholding structures before and after completion of the Transactions are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part F — Information on the Wing Hing Group and the Enlarged Group — 3. Shareholding Structure of Wing Hing Before and After Completion of the Transactions’’.

1. THE ACQUISITION AGREEMENT

Date: 28 January 2011 (as amended by the Amendment Agreement dated 22 March 2011 and the Second Amendment Agreement dated 22 July 2011)

Parties: (a) Wing Hing (b) TG Sellers (c) Mandra (d) GoldCom

1.1 The parties to the Acquisition Agreement and the Transactions

As at the Latest Practicable Date, Taung Gold is beneficially owned as to 31.10% by Electrum, being its largest shareholder and a TG Seller, and its remaining shareholding is held by a diverse group of shareholders which includes SepGold, some of the TG Sellers (other than Electrum), all of the Other TG Shareholders and all of the South African Shareholders. Electrum is part of a group of private companies based in New York, the United States, whose business is to invest in and hold diversified portfolios of precious metals exploration projects around the world.

The TG Sellers other than Electrum are a group of investors who are independent of Electrum and of the other shareholders of Taung Gold and who invested in Taung Gold through various rounds of financing. Further details of the TG Sellers are set out in Appendix VII of this Circular. The Other TG Shareholders are shareholders of Taung Gold who may enter into Deeds of Adherence to sell their TG Shares to Wing Hing on the First Completion Date. The South African Shareholders are shareholders of Taung Gold who are residents of South Africa and who may enter into the Put Option Agreements with GoldCom and Wing Hing to sell their TG Shares to Wing Hing. GoldCom was introduced to the Acquisition to subscribe for Wing Hing Shares in consideration for the issuance of the Loan Note and to facilitate the arrangements under the Put Option Agreements between Wing Hing and the South African

– 16 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Shareholders. Further details of GoldCom are provided in this section of the Circular headed ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 1.13 GoldCom and the South African Shareholders’’.

Under South African laws and regulations, Taung Gold is a company primarily engaged in the exploration and/or mining of mineral resources in South Africa and it must have at least 26.0% of its shareholding beneficially owned either directly by historically disadvantaged South Africans or by a Qualified BEE Company. As at the Latest Practicable Date, SepGold holds approximately 16.00% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold and it is 100% owned by Arctic. Arctic is a Qualified BEE Company as at least 50.10% of its shares are controlled by historically disadvantaged South Africans. 49.90% of Arctic’s shares are being transferred to Mandra (through its 100% interest in Arctic Holdco). Upon First Completion, Mandra’s interest in Arctic will be acquired by Wing Hing. Further details regarding Mandra are provided in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part E — Information on Mandra, Arctic and SepGold’’.

1.2 Assets to be acquired under the Acquisition Agreement

The Acquisition Agreement provides for the acquisition of up to 86.966% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold. The primary assets of the Taung Group are the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project which are advanced gold exploration projects. The Acquisition involves the following acquisitions of TG Shares by Wing Hing:

  • (a) acquisition of the TG Sale Shares from the TG Sellers, representing approximately 50.02% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold;

  • (b) acquisition of 100% of Arctic Holdco from Mandra through which Mandra indirectly holds 12.982% of Taung Gold;

  • (c) acquisition of TG Shares held by the South African Shareholders, representing approximately 8.99% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold, through the Loan Note and the Put Option Agreements between Wing Hing, GoldCom and the South African Shareholders;

  • (d) acquisition of the Other TG Sale Shares from the Other TG Shareholders, representing approximately 5.89% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold; and

  • (e) acquisition of TG Shares to be subscribed by Electrum upon the exercise of the Electrum TG Warrants.

– 17 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

1.3 Interests in Taung Gold to be acquired

The various interests in Taung Gold to be acquired by Wing Hing under different scenarios are illustrated below:

On the First Completion Date

  • (a) Assuming no Other TG Shareholders enter into any Deeds of Adherence and no South African Shareholders sell any TG Shares, Wing Hing will own 63.00% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold, on the First Completion Date.

  • (b) Assuming all the Other TG Shareholders sell all the TG Shares they own pursuant to the Deeds of Adherence and no South African Shareholders sell any TG Shares, Wing Hing will own 68.89% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold on the First Completion Date.

  • (c) Assuming all the South African Shareholders sell all the TG Shares they own and no Other TG Shareholders enter into any Deeds of Adherence, Wing Hing will own 71.99% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold on the First Completion Date.

  • (d) Assuming all the Other TG Shareholders sell all the TG Shares they own pursuant to the Deeds of Adherence and all the South African Shareholders sell all the TG Shares they own to Wing Hing, Wing Hing will own 77.88% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold on the First Completion Date.

On the Electrum Completion Date

Assuming Electrum enters into the Electrum Option Agreement and sells the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing, Wing Hing will own up to 86.966% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold on the Electrum Completion Date.

– 18 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

After the Electrum Completion Date

Since Arctic’s indirect equity interest in Taung Gold held through SepGold must not fall below 26.0% as required by South African laws, Taung Gold will, for so long as such legal requirement remains in place, issue additional TG Shares to SepGold upon the exercise by the TG Optionholders of their options to acquire TG Shares, and the subscription price payable for such TG Shares will be recorded as a loan to SepGold (the top-up arrangements). Further details of the top-up arrangements are set out in the section in the Circular headed ‘‘Part E — Information on Mandra, Arctic and SepGold’’. On the basis of this top-up arrangement:

  • (a) assuming all the TG Optionholders exercise their options to acquire TG Shares but do not sell any to Wing Hing, Wing Hing will own 78.16% of the entire issued and outstanding capital of Taung Gold; and

  • (b) assuming all the TG Optionholders exercise their options to acquire TG Shares and also sell 80% of such shares to Wing Hing, Wing Hing will own 85.21% of the entire issued and outstanding share capital of Taung Gold.

The above shareholding percentages of Taung Gold are calculated based on the assumption that the Electrum TG Warrants are fully exercised.

In all of the scenarios illustrated above, Wing Hing will acquire a controlling stake in Taung Gold and Taung Gold will become a subsidiary of Wing Hing.

The TG Sale Shares, the Other TG Sale Shares, the Arctic Sale Shares and the Electrum Option Shares (if applicable) shall be transferred to Wing Hing or a wholly-owned subsidiary of Wing Hing, and the Loan Note shall be executed for the benefit of Wing Hing.

Wing Hing confirms that, to the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief, having made all reasonable enquiries, as at the date of this Circular, the TG Sellers, Mandra, the Other TG Shareholders, the South African Shareholders and GoldCom are third parties independent of Wing Hing and each of them is not a connected person (as defined under the Listing Rules) of Wing Hing or its subsidiaries or their respective associates. Where the TG Sellers, Mandra, the Other TG Shareholders, the South African Shareholders and GoldCom are not natural persons, the ultimate beneficial owners and substantial shareholders of such TG Sellers, Mandra, the Other TG Shareholders, the South African Shareholders and GoldCom are third parties independent of Wing Hing or its subsidiaries or their respective associates.

– 19 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

1.4 Conditions precedent

The obligations of Wing Hing, the TG Sellers, Mandra and GoldCom to complete the Acquisition are subject to the satisfaction or waiver of the following conditions precedent (save for conditions (a) and (b) which cannot be waived):

  • (a) the grant of approval by the WH Shareholders at the SGM of:

  • (i) the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital;

  • (ii) the Acquisition Agreement (including the Amendment Agreement and the Second Amendment Agreement) and the transactions contemplated thereunder, the Transaction Documents and the transactions contemplated thereunder (including but not limited to the allotment and issue of the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares pursuant to the Specific Mandate) in accordance with the requirements of the Listing Rules;

  • (b) the Exchange granting or agreeing to grant a listing of and permission to deal in the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares (subject to conditions to which neither the TG Sellers, Mandra, GoldCom nor Wing Hing may reasonably object);

  • (c) the obtaining of a written legal opinion issued by Mr. Hannes Gouws of Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc., Wing Hing’s appointed South African attorney;

  • (d) the obtaining by Wing Hing of the Valuation Report;

  • (e) the obtaining by Wing Hing of the Competent Persons Report; and

  • (f) the completion of the due diligence on (i) the recent agreement(s) entered into by Wing Hing and/or a subsidiary of Wing Hing to dispose of three coal mining licenses owned by it; (ii) the business pertaining to the two coal mining licenses owned by the PRC Subsidiary; and (iii) Wing Hing’s business of providing guarantees to entities and individuals for obtaining bank borrowings in the PRC, in each case to the reasonable satisfaction of (x) the majority of the TG Sellers (which majority must include Electrum) and (y) Mandra.

As of the date of this Circular, the Conditions (d) and (e) have been satisfied. It is anticipated that the other Conditions will be satisfied by First Completion.

Legal opinion from Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc.

In relation to 1.4(c) above, the legal opinion will cover usual matters relating to, among other things, the incorporation and valid existence of Taung Gold, that all necessary licenses, approvals and consents have been obtained for Taung Gold

– 20 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

and its subsidiaries to conduct its business, the legality of Taung Gold’s constitutive documents and the enforceability by Wing Hing of the obligations of Taung Gold and its subsidiaries, the TG Sellers, GoldCom, the South African Shareholders, Electrum and the TG Optionholders in terms of the Transaction Documents under the laws of South Africa.

1.5 Completion of the Transactions

Under the Acquisition Agreement, completion of the Acquisition will take place in two tranches, namely:

  • (a) First Completion. First Completion is conditional upon the satisfaction or waiver of all the Conditions which will involve the completion of the sale and purchase of potentially all TG Shares in issue (other than those TG Shares to be acquired by Electrum upon its exercise of the Electrum TG Warrants and those TG Shares held by SepGold) as well as the Arctic Sale Shares, and will result in Wing Hing holding approximately 77.88% of the issued capital of Taung Gold.

  • (b) Electrum Completion. Electrum Completion involves the completion of the sale and purchase by Wing Hing of the TG Shares to be subscribed by Electrum if and when it exercises the Electrum TG Warrants, that is, the Electrum Option Shares. Electrum Completion shall take place not later than one month after the First Completion Date.

After First Completion and Electrum Completion:

  • Arctic will become an associate of Wing Hing as defined under the Listing Rules; and

  • Wing Hing will acquire up to approximately 86.966% of the equity interest in Taung Gold and Taung Gold will become a non-wholly owned subsidiary of Wing Hing.

1.6 Termination

At any time before First Completion, Wing Hing on the one hand and the TG Sellers, the Other TG Shareholders and Mandra, on the other hand, may terminate the Acquisition Agreement by giving notice to each other if, among others:

  • (a) there is a material adverse change (as defined in the Acquisition Agreement) to Taung Gold or to Wing Hing (as the case may be); or

  • (b) any event, circumstance, effect, occurrence or state of affairs or any combination of them (whether existing or occurring on or before the date of the Acquisition Agreement or arising or occurring afterwards) occurs which would constitute a breach of any of the warranties given by any of the TG Sellers, Other TG Shareholders, and Mandra on the one hand and Wing

– 21 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Hing on the other hand (as the case may be) in the Acquisition Agreement, and in the case of termination by Wing Hing such breach of warranties being material, if they were repeated at any time on or before the First Completion Date by reference to the facts and circumstances then existing (on the basis that references in such warranties to the date of the Acquisition Agreement are references to the relevant date); or

  • (c) any material breach by any of the TG Sellers (including any Other TG Shareholder who has entered into a Deed of Adherence), Mandra or GoldCom of their obligations on the one hand or Wing Hing on the other hand (as the case may be) under the Acquisition Agreement; or

  • (d) any breach of the warranties given by Wing Hing on the one hand or the TG Sellers (including any Other TG Shareholder who has entered into a Deed of Adherence) or Mandra on the other hand in the Acquisition Agreement which will or is likely to cause a material adverse change to Wing Hing on the one hand and Taung Gold on the other.

1.7 Post-Completion Undertakings

After completion of the Acquisition, three existing executive Directors and all of the independent non-executive Directors will remain on the Board. It is expected that after completion of the Acquisition, Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick, Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin and Mr. Igor Levental will be appointed to the Board as executive Directors and that Electrum will put forward one additional person for appointment as an independent non-executive Director. As such, following completion of the Acquisition, the existing Directors will continue to constitute a majority of the Board.

Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick and Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin are South African Shareholders and also TG Optionholders, and Mr. Igor Levental is a TG Optionholder.

None of Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick, Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin or Mr. Igor Levental is a substantial shareholder of Taung Gold. Mr. Igor Levental is an employee of Electrum. Accordingly, the Transaction does not constitute a connected transaction for the purposes of Rule 14A.13(1)(b)(i) of the Listing Rules.

In addition, Wing Hing agrees and undertakes that it shall, following the Electrum Completion Date, subject to any requirements or conditions imposed by any applicable regulators and to the extent permissible under the Listing Rules and applicable laws from time to time:

  • (a) enter into an agreement to dispose of 100% of Wing Hing’s business of providing guarantees to entities and individuals for obtaining bank borrowings in the PRC, and the disposal of Guizhou Baoxin Investment and Guaranty Co. Ltd. and of any other subsidiary of Wing Hing that conducts such business within one (1) month after the Electrum Completion

– 22 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Date. Wing Hing further agrees and undertakes that it has ceased to enter into new business contracts in relation to the business of providing guarantees to entities and individuals for obtaining bank borrowings in the PRC from the date of the Acquisition Agreement; and

  • (b) enter into an agreement to, within one (1) month after the Electrum Completion Date, either (i) dispose of 70% of the issued share capital of Union Sense, a subsidiary of Wing Hing, and assign of all loans owing by Union Sense to Bless Luck, also a subsidiary of Wing Hing; or (ii) procure the disposal of the Dayan Licence and the Xinghe Licence held by the PRC Subsidiary.

Wing Hing is currently in discussions with a potential purchaser in respect of (a) and (b) above (the Potential Disposals). The Potential Disposals, when they materialise, will constitute notifiable transactions of Wing Hing.

Wing Hing will issue further announcements to inform WH Shareholders and potential investors of the above and comply with all applicable requirements under the Listing Rules as and when the Potential Disposals materialise.

1.8 Deed of Adherence

The purpose of entering into a Deed of Adherence is to enable an Other TG Shareholder to become a party to the Acquisition Agreement. A form of the Deed of Adherence is attached as a schedule to the Acquisition Agreement. Under a Deed of Adherence, an Other TG Shareholder:

  • agrees to sell his TG Shares to Wing Hing; and

  • undertakes that he will be bound by the Acquisition Agreement in all respects as if he were a party to the Acquisition Agreement and was named as a party on it.

In consideration, Wing Hing will, among other things, issue to such Other TG Shareholder Wing Hing Shares in accordance with the Share Exchange Ratio.

1.9 Consideration and Consideration Shares

The Consideration for the Acquisition is up to US$580,000,000 (equivalent to HK$4,524,000,000) which will be satisfied by the issue of up to 10,977,630,003 new Wing Hing Shares at the issue price of HK$0.41 each (being the Total Consideration Shares), respectively, in the following manner:

  • (a) Consideration for the TG Sale Shares (TG Consideration Shares). On the First Completion Date, Wing Hing shall allot and issue to each TG Seller, the TG Consideration Shares credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the TG Sale Shares.

– 23 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (b) Consideration for the Other TG Sale Shares (Other Consideration Shares). On the First Completion Date, Wing Hing shall issue to each of the Other TG Shareholders who has entered into a Deed of Adherence, the Other Consideration Shares credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Other TG Sale Shares held by such Other TG Shareholder.

  • (c) Consideration for the Loan Note and the delivery of the Put Option Agreements (GoldCom Consideration Shares). On the First Completion Date, Wing Hing shall issue to GoldCom the GoldCom Consideration Shares credited as fully paid at the Issue Price.

  • (d) Consideration for the Arctic Sale Shares (Arctic Consideration Shares). On the First Completion Date, Wing Hing shall issue to Mandra, the Arctic Consideration Shares credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Arctic Sale Shares.

  • (e) Consideration for the Electrum Option Shares (Electrum Consideration Shares). If Electrum exercises its right to sell the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing, Wing Hing shall issue the Electrum Consideration Shares on the Electrum Completion Date to Electrum as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Electrum Option Shares.

In addition to the Total Consideration Shares, Wing Hing may issue up to 1,009,616,519 new Wing Hing Shares to GoldCom or the TG Optionholders in consideration for the TG Shares to be subscribed for by GoldCom or the TG Optionholders, being the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares. For further details regarding the TG Optionholders and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares, please refer to the section of the Circular headed ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 1. The Acquisition Agreement — 1.12 Warrants and Options to be granted by Wing Hing pursuant to the Transactions — TG Optionholder Agreements’’’ and ‘‘Section 3 — TG Optionholder Agreements’’ of Appendix VI.

The Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares will be issued at the issue price of HK$0.41 per Wing Hing Share, credited as fully paid and when allotted and issued, they will rank pari passu in all respects with Wing Hing Shares then in issue and be entitled to all dividends, distributions and other rights carried by the Wing Hing Shares. The Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares will be issued pursuant to the Specific Mandate.

The maximum number of the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares that will be issued represent: — approximately 5.45 times the existing issued share capital of Wing Hing (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised);

– 24 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • approximately 4.92 times the existing issued share capital of Wing Hing (assuming the WH Warrants are exercised in full);

  • approximately 84.51% of the issued share capital of Wing Hing as enlarged by the allotment and issue of the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised); and

  • approximately 83.12% of the issued share capital of Wing Hing as enlarged by the allotment and issue of the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares (assuming the WH Warrants are exercised in full).

1.10 Basis of the Consideration, the Issue Price and the Share Exchange Ratio

The Consideration was arrived at after arm’s length negotiations between Wing Hing, the Founders, Mandra and Electrum taking into account various factors, including but not limited to, (i) the market price of gold; (ii) the future prospects of the gold mining industry; (iii) the existence and findings of the Competent Persons Report and Scoping Studies for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project; and (iv) the findings of the Valuation Report. The Consideration will be satisfied by the issue of up to 10,977,630,003 new Wing Hing Shares at the issue price of HK$0.41 each (being the Total Consideration Shares), credited as fully paid and will rank pari passu in all respects with the Wing Hing Shares then in issue and be entitled to all dividends, distributions and other rights carried by the Wing Hing Shares. Dealing with these factors in turn:

  • (a) The upward trend in the price of gold. The valuation of gold mines is largely related to the market price of gold and the prospects of the gold price. To the best knowledge of the Directors, as at the Latest Practicable Date, the spot price of gold as quoted by the London Bullion Market Association was approximately US$1,613.50 (equivalent to approximately HK$12,585.3) per ounce. As demonstrated in ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 1.4 Historical market price of gold and its fluctuation’’ the price of gold has followed an upward trend in the past year and demand for gold has also reached a 10-year high in 2011. After applying a significant discount to take into account the estimated Life of Mine production costs (as the Taung Group’s assets are not yet in production) (as further detailed in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3. Nature and Quality of Taung Group’s Assets and Businesses’’) and other costs, the parties have agreed on an arm’s length basis to the Consideration of US$580,000,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$4,524,000,000). Taking into account the upward trend in gold prices and in the demand for gold, and that since 86.966% of the net assets value of Taung Gold with the fair value adjustment made by reference to the valuation report of the Primary

– 25 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Projects, is higher than the Consideration of US$580,000,000, the Directors are of the view that the Consideration represents a fair and reasonable consideration.

  • (b) Prospects of the gold mining industry. According to the Competent Persons Report, the global demand for gold averaged approximately 4,041t per annum during the four years from 2006 to 2009. The gold price has been experiencing a steady increase since 2001. The average price of gold in 2001 was US$271 (equivalent to approximately HK$2,113.8) per ounce and it soared to US$918 (equivalent to approximately HK$7,160.4) per ounce in 2009. The devaluation of the US dollar, market concern over the effectiveness of financial stimulus packages and fears of inflation further drove the gold price to US$1,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$7,800) per ounce in September 2009. From 2009 to 2010, the average price of gold (London PM Fix: US dollars/troy ounce) increased from US$972/oz to US$1,225/oz. In light of the expected growing demand for gold, the Directors consider that the gold price will continue to rise and that the Consideration payable is fair and reasonable.

  • (c) Competent Persons Report. A copy of the Competent Persons Report, being an independent competent persons report on the South African gold assets of the Taung Group, is set out in Appendix IV of this Circular. The Competent Persons Report describes and documents all of Taung Group’s projects, including the assets of the Taung Group’s primary projects, namely the Evander Project in the Mpumalanga Province of South Africa and the Jeanette Project in the Free State Province of South Africa. In particular, the Competent Persons Report states that the total estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project amount to an aggregate of 11.725 million ounces. The estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of each project is set out below (determined in accordance with the JORC Code and SAMREC Code):

MINERAL RESOURCE MINING MINING
CATEGORY TONNES GRADE GOLD GOLD
(t) (g/t) (kg) (oz)
EVANDER*
Measured 140,078 10.63 1,489 47,873
Indicated 15,433,000 9.24 142,601 4,584,726
Total Measured and
Indicated 15,573,078 9.25 144,090 4,632,599
JEANETTE
Indicated 23,030,000 9.58 220,580 7,092,000
TOTAL (EVANDER
AND JEANETTE) 38,603,078 364,670 11,724,599
  • Subject to obtaining s11 consent in terms of the Sale Agreement

– 26 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Since the date of the Competent Persons Report, there has been no material change in the estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of each project.

  • (d) Scoping Studies for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. The Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are advanced exploration projects for which Scoping Studies have been completed and Pre-Feasibility Studies and Bankable Feasibility Studies have been commissioned. The Competent Persons Report is based upon the information contained in the Scoping Studies for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. Taung Gold completed a Scoping Study for the Evander Project on 9 April 2010 and it was recommended that Phase 1 of the Evander Project proceed to Bankable Feasibility Study and Phases 2 and 3 of the Evander Project proceed to PreFeasibility Study. Scoping Studies for the Jeanette Project were completed in June 2010 by Taung Gold and presented a sound business case for advancing the Jeanette Project to Pre-Feasibility Study stage. The individual Scoping Studies for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are available on Wing Hing’s website.

  • (e) Valuation Report. Based on the Valuation Report, the fair market value of a 100% interest of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project was approximately US$605,000,000 (which is equivalent to the value of approximately HK$4,726,800,000) as at 30 April 2011 (the Valuation). As advised by the Competent Evaluator, the discounted cash flow method in estimating the Valuation was used based on certain assumptions. The Valuation Report is set out in Appendix V of this Circular. Furthermore, as advised by the Competent Evaluator, the prospects for gold prices remain stable as well as positive and in its view, there is no material change to its outlook regarding gold prices for the near future. Having regard to the view of the Competent Evaluator, the Directors are of the view that there has been no material change in the estimated valuation of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project since the date of the Valuation Report. Moreover, regarding the possible fluctuation of the gold price and its effect on the valuation, a sensitivity analysis has been performed and included in the valuation report as set out in Appendix V of this circular.

The unaudited pro forma financial information takes into account an impairment of estimated goodwill arising from the Acquisition of approximately HK$1,097,459,000 immediately upon completion of the Acquisition which comprises a pro forma adjustment of HK$1,262,577,000 relating to a deferred tax liability that is required to be made in accordance with the applicable Hong Kong accounting principles. Further details of the goodwill impairment and deferred tax liability adjustments are set out in the section headed ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 6. Financial Effects of the Acquisition’’. Notwithstanding such goodwill impairment and deferred tax liability, the Directors are of the view that (a) since the deferred tax liability is a non-cash accounting item and does not affect the future cash flows of the Enlarged Group (which is the basis of the

– 27 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Competent Evaluator’s valuation in the Valuation Report) it should not be taken into account in determining the Consideration; and (b) taking into account all of the above factors regarding the gold price trend, the prospects of the gold mining industry and the quality of the Primary Projects, the Directors (including the Independent Nonexecutive Directors) are of the opinion that the Consideration, including its form of payment, is fair and reasonable.

In addition, the issue price of HK$0.41 per Wing Hing Share was determined after arm’s length negotiations between Wing Hing, Electrum, Mandra and the Founders taking into account similar factors. The Board concluded that Taung Gold is an appropriate investment in line with Wing Hing’s existing business and focus on the gold mining business with attractive future growth prospects and the Board considers that notwithstanding that the Issue Price represents a discount of over 30% to the market price of Wing Hing Shares immediately prior to the suspension of trading of Wing Hing Shares on 31 January 2011, the potential benefits the Transactions presented to Wing Hing justify such discount and the Issue Price is therefore fair and reasonable.

The Issue Price represents:

  • (a) a discount of approximately 31.67% to the closing price of HK$0.60 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange on the Last Trading Day;

  • (b) a discount of approximately 18.00% to the average closing price of approximately HK$0.50 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange for the ten consecutive trading days up to and including the Last Trading Day;

  • (c) a discount of approximately 14.58% to the average closing price of approximately HK$0.48 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange for the 30 consecutive trading days up to and including the Last Trading Day;

  • (d) a discount of approximately 24.07% to the average closing price of approximately HK$0.54 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange for the 60 consecutive trading days up to and including the Last Trading Day;

  • (e) a discount of approximately 22.64% to the average closing price of approximately HK$0.53 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange for the 90 consecutive trading days up to and including the Last Trading Day;

  • (f) a discount of approximately 36.92% to the closing price of approximately HK$0.65 per Wing Hing Share as quoted on the Exchange on the Latest Practicable Date; and

– 28 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (g) a premium of approximately 69.09% over the audited net assets attributable to equity holders of Wing Hing as at 31 March 2011 of approximately HK$0.242 per Wing Hing Share.

The number of new Wing Hing Shares to be issued in consideration for TG Shares is determined by applying the Share Exchange Ratio of 53.37320537 Wing Hing Shares for every one TG Share.

1.11 Outstanding Warrants and Options in Taung Gold

As at the date of this Circular, Taung Gold has the following options and warrants outstanding:

  • (a) Electrum TG Warrants. Taung Gold has issued 21,500,000 Electrum TG Warrants to Electrum (which if exercised, will entitle Electrum to subscribe for 21,500,000 TG Shares), exercisable at any time prior to June 2014 at an exercise price of ZAR5.00 per TG Share. When exercised, the TG Shares acquired by Electrum may be sold to Wing Hing pursuant to the Electrum Option Agreement.

  • (b) TG Optionholder options. Taung Gold has further issued a total of 23,645,210 options to the TG Optionholders, which are vested as of the date of this Circular and exercisable within five years of their respective dates of issue at the following exercise prices:

Round Exercise Price Vesting Date Number of options
(ZAR)
Round 1 4.95 26 May 2010 6,737,312
Round 2 4.95 26 July 2010 6,238,000
Round 3 7.425 1 September 2010 7,964,737
Round 4 9.90 1 November 2010 2,705,161

When exercised, 80% of the TG Shares acquired by the TG Optionholders may be sold to Wing Hing pursuant to the TG Optionholder Agreement.

  • (c) Other warrants. Taung Gold has granted 2,926,351 warrants to the original shareholders of African Precious Minerals Limited (including SepGold). It is expected that these warrants will be fully exercised prior to First Completion.

1.12 Warrants and Options to be granted by Wing Hing pursuant to the Transactions

  • (a) Electrum Option Agreement. On or prior to the First Completion Date, Wing Hing and Electrum may enter into the Electrum Option Agreement pursuant to which upon the exercise of the Electrum TG Warrants, Electrum may sell up to 21,500,000 TG Shares acquired by it to Wing Hing in consideration for the Electrum Consideration Shares. The Electrum Option Agreement is entered into in accordance with the requirements under

– 29 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Chapter 15 of the Listing Rules. All disclosure requirements under Chapter 15 are complied with and set out in ‘‘2. Electrum Option Agreement’’ of Appendix VI of this Circular. The terms of the Electrum Option Agreement are subject to the approval of the Exchange and the WH Shareholders at the SGM. The Electrum Option Agreement does not constitute a share option scheme of Wing Hing and accordingly, it does not fall within the requirements under Chapter 17 of the Listing Rules.

  • (b) TG Optionholder Agreements. Pursuant to the TG Optionholder Agreement, Wing Hing and GoldCom will grant to the TG Optionholders the right to sell a maximum number of 18,916,168 TG Shares to Wing Hing or to Wing Hing through GoldCom for a maximum of 1,009,616,519 new Wing Hing Shares or cash after the First Completion Date upon their exercise of the TG Optionholder options as disclosed in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 1.11 Outstanding Warrants and Options in Taung Gold’’. The TG Optionholder Agreement is entered into in accordance with the requirements under Chapter 15 of the Listing Rules. All disclosure requirements under Chapter 15 are complied with and set out in ‘‘3. TG Optionholder Agreement’’ of Appendix VI of this Circular. The terms of the TG Optionholder Agreement are subject to the approval of the Exchange and the WH Shareholders at the SGM. The TG Optionholder Agreement does not constitute a share option scheme of Wing Hing and accordingly, it does not fall within the requirements under Chapter 17 of the Listing Rules.

1.13 GoldCom and the South African Shareholders

The South African Shareholders are shareholders of Taung Gold who are residents of South Africa. As a result of foreign exchange control restrictions, the South African Shareholders would be restricted from on-selling, transferring or otherwise dealing in Wing Hing Shares. Accordingly, rather than receiving Wing Hing Shares as consideration, GoldCom, a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands, will subscribe for Wing Hing Shares (being the GoldCom Consideration Shares) in consideration for the Loan Note. GoldCom, Wing Hing and the South African Shareholders will enter into the Put Option Agreements pursuant to which the South African Shareholders may sell their TG Shares to Wing Hing through GoldCom in consideration for cash derived from the sale of the GoldCom Consideration Shares on-market. Such right to sell TG Shares to Wing Hing through GoldCom may be exercised by the South African Shareholders at any time within three years from (and including) the First Completion Date.

GoldCom is a third party whose principal business is to engage in investment holding and related activities and whose sole shareholder and sole director is Mr. Michael J. Yates, who is an Other TG Shareholder.

– 30 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The principal amount of the Loan Note is HK$464,480,706.98 (nil interest) and it will reduce accordingly upon the transfer of TG Shares to Wing Hing by the South African Shareholder (through GoldCom). Payment shall be made on written demand by Wing Hing (provided that Wing Hing may not demand repayment prior to the sale of any GoldCom Consideration Shares and GoldCom’s receipt of cash proceeds from such sale). The risk of any reduction in value of the GoldCom Consideration Shares shall be borne by Wing Hing. Please see the section headed ‘‘Part B — Risk Factors — 1. Risks Associated with the Acquisition — 1.6 The risk of any reduction in value of the GoldCom Consideration Shares is borne by Wing Hing.’’

Further details of the Loan Note and the Put Option Agreements are set out in ‘‘1. The Loan Note and The Put Option Agreements’’ of Appendix VI of this Circular.

1.14 Lock-up Agreement

Each TG Seller (and any Other TG Shareholder who has entered into a Deed of Adherence), GoldCom and Mandra will enter into a lock-up agreement with Wing Hing on or prior to the First Completion Date to undertake not to, without the prior consent of Wing Hing:

  • (a) during the period commencing from (and including) the First Completion Date and ending on the date which is ninety (90) days from the First Completion Date, directly sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any Wing Hing Shares held by them (or by their affiliates) as at the First Completion Date (the Lock-up Shares); and

  • (b) during the period commencing from the date which is ninety (90) days from the First Completion Date and ending on the date which is one hundred and eighty (180) days from the First Completion Date, effect a sale, transfer or disposition of an aggregate of more than 7.5% of the Lock-up Shares,

The above restrictions shall not apply to the sale, transfer or disposition of any Lock-up Shares by the relevant holder of Wing Hing Shares (or its affiliate) to any affiliate or any pledge of any Lock-up Shares by such holder of Wing Hing Shares (or its affiliate) to any banking institution(s) as collateral.

– 31 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  1. CORPORATE STRUCTURE OF TAUNG GOLD BEFORE AND AFTER FIRST COMPLETION

  2. 2.1 Corporate structure of Taung Gold immediately before First Completion

==> picture [429 x 191] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

MANDRA
100%
BEE
ARCTIC HOLDCO
SHAREHOLDERS
50.10% 49.90%
ARCTIC
TG SELLERS
SOUTH AFRICAN
ELECTRUM 100% (EXCLUDING ELECTRUM)
SHAREHOLDERS
AND OTHER TG SHAREHOLDERS
SEPGOLD
19.99% 9.90%
41.49%
28.62%
TAUNG GOLD
----- End of picture text -----

  • 2.2 Corporate structure of Taung Gold immediately after First Completion

==> picture [423 x 292] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

MANDRA TG SELLERS
(AS 100% OWNER (EXCL ELECTRUM) EXISTING PUBLIC
ELECTRUM GOLDCOM
OF ARCTIC AND OTHER TG SHAREHOLDERS
HOLDCO) SHAREHOLDERS
13.62% 19.08% 9.43% 39.60% 18.27%
WING HING
100%
BEE
ARCTIC HOLDCO
SHAREHOLDERS
50.10% 49.90%
ARCTIC
100%
SEPGOLD 71.38% [Note 1]
28.62%
TAUNG GOLD
----- End of picture text -----

Note 1: Assuming all the Other TG Shareholders and all South African Shareholders sell all their TG Shares to Wing Hing.

– 32 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3. APPLICATION FOR LISTING

Application will be made by Wing Hing to the Listing Committee for the listing of, and permission to deal in the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares.

4. REASONS FOR AND BENEFITS OF THE ACQUISITION

The Acquisition demonstrates Wing Hing’s commitment to continue operating in the gold mining business following the completion in July 2010 of its major transaction to acquire a gold mining licence, namely the Long Men Sou Mining Licence, located in Hebei province in the PRC. Since then, production at the Long Men Sou Mine has commenced and revenue from gold mining has been derived from the sale of gold concentrates produced from the Long Men Sou Mine to customers in the PRC. The mine produces a maximum of approximately 5 kilograms of gold concentrates per month. As a result of the Board’s general optimism about the global gold mining industry, the Board sought further opportunities to develop its gold mining business and expand into the gold mining business outside of China.

For the reasons set out below, the Board believes that the Acquisition will strengthen Wing Hing’s further development in the gold mining business and will benefit Wing Hing and all WH Shareholders:

4.1 The Acquisition represents a good opportunity to take advantage of the expected rising trend in the global gold price.

Gold is a precious metal and as disclosed in Wing Hing’s annual report for the year ended 31 March 2011, it is a risk-resistant investment tool and as a result of potential for the quantitative easing monetary policy of the United States which has potentially triggered worsening inflation on a global scale, there is expected to be increasing demand for commodities such as gold. Owners of gold, among others, will benefit from expected further increases in the value of gold. As such, the Directors seek to strategically focus on gold resources sectors which they believe will bring new prospects and opportunities to the future of the Wing Hing Group. Based on market analysis, the Directors believe that given the remaining uncertainties with respect to the Euro-zone debt situation, the general low interest rate environment and the tendency for central banks to be net buyers of gold in recent years, the upward trend in the gold price will continue for at least the next two years and the Directors therefore consider the Acquisition a good opportunity to take advantage of the expected rising trend in gold prices. As such, it is the intention and development strategy of Wing Hing to allocate its resources to the development of its gold mining related business where the Board considers that there are suitable opportunities.

– 33 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • 4.2 The Acquisition will deliver a meaningful portfolio of Measured and Indicated gold resources, exploration projects and future growth opportunities to Wing Hing.

The Board has taken into account the fact that it is rare to find a company that has a large amount of gold resources similar to the Taung Group. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project amount to an aggregate of approximately 11.725 million ounces. The Taung Group also has a portfolio of early exploration projects (that is, the Greenfield Projects) throughout South Africa and it is expected that these projects will provide attractive gold deposits for the Taung Group’s future production. Given the attractive resource profile of the Taung Group, the Board is of the view that the Acquisition is the appropriate channel for Wing Hing’s further development of its gold mining related business.

  • 4.3 The Taung Group will be one of the lower-cost producers in the South African gold mining industry when production of its projects commences.

According to the Competent Persons Report, the total capital cost of the Evander Project is estimated to be US$1,034.3 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,067.5 million) and the Evander Project is estimated to have a Life of Mine average operating cost of US$83.6/t milled. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total capital cost for developing the Jeanette Project, including plant construction, is US$1,067.8 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,328.8 million) and it is estimated that the Jeanette Project could achieve a Life of Mine average operating cost of US$72.06/t when producing at 145ktpm. Compared to other major producers in the South African gold mining industry, the Board is of the view that the Taung Group will be one of the lower-cost producers in that industry when production of these projects commences.

  • 4.4 The Taung Group has a management team with extensive experience in gold mining, exploration and investment and it is expected that they will remain in the Enlarged Group following completion of the Transactions.

Taung Gold’s directors and key management, taken together, have sufficient experience relevant to the exploration activities of Taung Gold and certain key senior management members of Taung Gold possess more than five years of relevant experience in gold mining exploration and/or extraction activities. It is expected that all of the directors and senior management of Taung Gold will remain in their positions after completion of the Transactions and the details of their relevant experience are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 5. Directors and Senior Management of Taung Gold’’.

Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick, Mr. Igor Levental and Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin will be put forward for appointment to the Board after the First Completion Date. In particular, Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick, the chief executive officer of Taung Gold has managed gold mines since the 1990s and Dr. David Twist, one of the Founders and a director of Taung Gold, has been involved in geological research with

– 34 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

respect to gold and has provided geological consulting advice to gold mining companies for over 20 years, with extensive experience in gold exploration projects in Africa.

Mr. Igor Levental has worked in investments and investor relations positions for gold mining companies since 1989 and is currently the president of the Electrum group of companies, managing Electrum’s portfolios of gold exploration and development projects and having been executive vice president from 2007 to February 2010.

Dr. Dawid Strydom, a director of Taung Gold, has worked in gold mining and exploration projects since the 1990s as exploration manager. He joined Taung Gold in 2007 and he has focused on the exploration and management of the Evander Project and Jeanette Project since then.

The Board believes that the Taung Group’s success depends to a significant extent on its pool of talented and experienced senior management and key employees. The extensive experience of the management of the Taung Group will significantly reduce the execution risks associated with the business.

4.5 The Taung Group complies with the requirements for listing of a mineral company under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules.

Although the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are not yet in production, they are advanced exploration projects for which Scoping Studies have been completed and for which Pre-Feasibility Studies and Bankable Feasibility Studies have been commissioned, with a clear plan to proceed to production.

Notwithstanding that the mining right covering the Evander Project is not held by Taung Gold as at the date of this Circular, Taung Gold has sufficient influence in decisions over the exploration of gold resources in the Evander Project through a joint venture arrangement with EGM Limited under which Taung Gold:

  • is entitled to up to 52% of the Evander mining right following the completion of a Pre-Feasibility Study and a Bankable Feasibility Study on the Evander Project; and

  • has the sole and absolute right to conduct exploration over the Evander Project area and to conduct the works necessary to complete the relevant Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study.

Consent to the transfer of the prospecting right to a subsidiary of Taung Gold was given by the DMR on 29 September 2010 and the prospecting right is valid for five years commencing from 29 June 2010. The prospecting right allows the exploration of gold, silver, uranium and associated minerals in the Jeanette area. All permits to conduct exploration over the mining area under the Jeanette Project have been obtained.

– 35 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

As stated in this section of the Circular, the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project have a meaningful portfolio of Measured and Indicated gold resources and Taung Gold’s directors and key management, taken together, have sufficient experience relevant to the exploration activities of the Taung Group.

Further details of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are provided in the section headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3. Nature and Quality of the Taung Group’s Assets and Businesses ’’ of this Circular.

5. DUE DILIGENCE MEASURES ON THE TAUNG GROUP

Prior to Wing Hing entering into the Acquisition Agreement, the Board reviewed the Competent Persons Report prepared by Venmyn and the Valuation Report in respect of the resources of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. Wing Hing also negotiated to include in the Acquisition Agreement conditions precedent to First Completion, including that Wing Hing would obtain (i) the Competent Persons Report; (ii) the Valuation Report; and (iii) a legal opinion to be issued by a practising South African attorney, Mr. Hannes Gouws of Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc., the details of which are set out in this part of the Circular under the section headed ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 1.4 Conditions precedent — (c) the obtaining of a written legal opinion issued by Mr. Hannes Gouws of Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc., Wing Hing’s appointed South African attorney.’’.

Following the signing of the Acquisition Agreement, the Board discussed with Taung Gold’s management the background information, financial information, projected production and future business plan of the Taung Group, and reviewed and studied certain research materials covering a general overview of the global and South African gold mining industry. The Board has since reviewed the Competent Persons Report, the Valuation Report and the Accountant’s Report set out in this Circular, as well as a draft of the legal opinion on Taung Gold prepared by Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc. Wing Hing is of the view that the above due diligence measures are adequate to protect the interests of Wing Hing and the WH Shareholders as a whole.

The Board is aware of the risks associated with the Transactions as set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part B — Risk Factors’’ and has balanced the risks associated with the Transactions and the prospects of the gold mining business of the Enlarged Group and has taken into account all the relevant factors. The Board, including the Independent Non-executive Directors, considers that the terms of the Acquisition Agreement and the Transactions are on normal commercial terms, fair and reasonable, and in the interests of Wing Hing and WH Shareholders as a whole.

– 36 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

6. FINANCIAL EFFECTS OF THE ACQUISITION

After First Completion and Electrum Completion, the Taung Group will become a non-wholly owned subsidiary of Wing Hing and the financial information of the Taung Group will be consolidated into the consolidated financial statements of Wing Hing. As referred to in the annual report of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011, the audited consolidated net assets of the Wing Hing Group (including non-controlling interests) as of 31 March 2011 were approximately HK$532.9 million comprising total assets of approximately HK$593.2 million and total liabilities of approximately HK$60.3 million, and the net loss of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 attributable to owners of Wing Hing was approximately HK$21.4 million.

According to the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group as set out in Appendix III to this Circular, upon First Completion and Electrum Completion, the unaudited pro forma net assets of the Enlarged Group would be approximately HK$4.27 billion, comprising unaudited pro forma total assets of approximately HK$5.61 billion and unaudited pro forma total liabilities of approximately HK$1.34 billion, and the unaudited pro forma net loss of the Enlarged Group would be approximately HK$1.22 billion. The professional fees and other expenses of the Acquisition would be approximately HK$24 million.

The unaudited pro forma financial information had also taken into account an impairment of estimated goodwill arising from the Acquisition of approximately HK$1,097,459,000 immediately upon completion of the Acquisition. The Directors have considered the requirements under the relevant accounting principles in determining the factors to be taken into account when performing the goodwill impairment test. An impairment test is performed in accordance with the requirements of Hong Kong Accounting Standards 36 ‘‘Impairment of Assets’’ issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants, resulting in a full impairment of goodwill arising from the Acquisition immediately upon completion of the Acquisition. Under Hong Kong Accounting Standard 36, the recoverable amount of an asset or a cash-generating unit is the higher of its fair value less costs to sell and its value in use. A cash-generating unit is the smallest identifiable group of assets that generates cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets. Fair value less costs to sell is the amount obtainable from the sale of an asset or cash-generating unit in an arm’s length transaction between knowledgeable, willing parties, less the costs of disposal. Value in use is the present value of the future cash flows expected to be derived from an asset or cashgenerating unit. If, and only if, the recoverable amount of an asset is less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset shall be reduced to its recoverable amount. That reduction is an impairment loss. For the purpose of impairment testing, goodwill arising from the Acquisition is allocated to the operations carried out by Taung Gold as a cashgenerating unit as this unit is expected to generate cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets of the Wing Hing Group. The recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit is determined based on a value in use calculation which involves discounting estimated future cash flows at a discount rate of 13.04% per annum, being the discount rate applied in the Valuation Report by the Competent Evaluator.

– 37 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The estimated goodwill is measured as the excess of the estimated fair value of the Consideration of approximately HK$4,030,343,000 over 77.88% of the adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold as if the Acquisition had been completed at the date it was reported on. The adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold of approximately HK$3,765,902,000 represents (i) the carrying amount of the net assets of Taung Gold of approximately HK$519,275,000 as at 28 February 2011 as adjusted for the fair value adjustment on intangible assets of Taung Gold of approximately HK$4,509,204,000 and (ii) the corresponding deferred tax effect calculated at the South African tax rate of 28% of approximately HK$1,262,577,000.

The deferred tax liability of approximately HK$1,262,577,000 is required to be made under paragraph 19 of the Hong Kong Accounting Standard 12 ‘‘Income Taxes’’, which Wing Hing complies with. Consequently, the pro forma adjustment on the deferred tax liability directly affected the amount of goodwill arising from the Acquisition in the unaudited pro forma financial information. The aforesaid deferred tax liability is a noncash accounting item and does not have any effect on the future cash flows of the Enlarged Group. In future periods subsequent to the Acquisition, the fair value of the intangible assets would be amortised to profit or loss as expenses whilst the corresponding deferred tax liability would be released to profit or loss as deferred tax income. In the event that no deferred tax liability was recognized on the fair value adjustment on intangible assets, the goodwill arising from the Acquisition of approximately HK$1,097,459,000 would decrease to approximately HK$114,164,000.

As stated in the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group as set out in Appendix III to this Circular, the Enlarged Group has unaudited consolidated pro forma cash and cash equivalents of approximately HK$0.43 billion. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of financial position of the Enlarged Group as at the First Completion and Electrum Completion is prepared based on (i) the audited consolidated statement of financial position of the Wing Hing Group as at 31 March 2011, as set out in Appendix I; and (ii) the audited statement of financial position of Taung Gold as at 28 February 2011 as set out in Appendix II, after incorporating the unaudited pro forma adjustments described in the accompanying notes, as if the Acquisition were completed on 31 March 2011.

– 38 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART B — RISK FACTORS

WH Shareholders should carefully consider all of the information set out in this Circular, including the risks and uncertainties associated with the Acquisition and the assets and business of the Taung Group and the industry in which it operates before making a decision on how to vote on the resolution relating to the Transactions at the SGM. The business, financial condition and results of operations of the Wing Hing Group, the Taung Group and the Enlarged Group could be materially and adversely affected by any of these risks.

To the best of the Directors’ knowledge, the Directors consider the following risks to be the most significant in respect of the assets and business of the Taung Group for the WH Shareholders and potential investors of Wing Hing. However, the risks listed below do not purport to comprise all those risks associated with the Transactions and are not set out in any particular order of priority. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to the Directors may also have an adverse effect on the Transactions, the Wing Hing Group and the Enlarged Group. If any of the following risks actually occurs, the Transactions, the Wing Hing Group’s and/or the Enlarged Group’s business, financial condition, capital resources, results and/or future operations could be materially and adversely affected.

1. RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE ACQUISITION

1.1 Risks relating to the significant expansion of the Wing Hing Group’s gold mining business and risks relating to investing in South Africa

The Acquisition constitutes a significant expansion of the Wing Hing Group’s gold mining business, a relatively new business of the Wing Hing Group and involves the exploration, development and ultimate production of gold in South Africa, a country which the Wing Hing Group has not previously had exposure to or experience in. Although the Wing Hing Group currently operates the Long Men Sou Mine in the Hebei province in the PRC, this mine is relatively small in scale and produces a maximum of approximately 5 kilograms of gold concentrates per month. While the Wing Hing Group is currently engaging in gold exploration and production, the Acquisition constitutes an investment in a significantly larger gold mine located in another country.

There are risks beyond the Wing Hing Group’s control associated with investing in mineral exploration, mine development and mining in foreign jurisdictions. These risks include, but are not limited to, health and safety issues; crime; business and regulatory environment and changes to that environment; political stability; government policy changes; expropriation of assets; ability to repatriate funds; corruption; quality and comprehensiveness of the legal regimes in relation to mining or generally the effectiveness of the judiciary; actions of non-government organisations; and adverse changes in attitude by host governments or host communities.

– 39 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The Taung Group has not yet commenced production at the Evander Project or the Jeanette Project and has not recorded any revenue during the three years ended 28 February 2011. Accordingly, its limited operating history makes the prediction of its future operating results, operating costs and prospects difficult. WH Shareholders and prospective investors should consider the Enlarged Group’s businesses and prospects in light of the potential risks, uncertainties, expenses and challenges that it may face as a developing company. In addition, the Enlarged Group may encounter risks and uncertainties frequently experienced by companies in the early stages of mine development, including those relating to its ability to:

  • manage large-scale mining operations to maintain effective control over construction and operating costs and expenses and to ramp up to design capacities and according to its production plans;

  • implement, monitor and enhance its internal control system, including systems and procedures to ensure compliance with the extensive regulatory requirements applicable to the mining industry in South Africa; and

  • manage the logistics, utility and supply needs of its expanded operations.

The Wing Hing Group has not previously invested in the African continent and this will be its first venture into Africa. Political, legal and economic uncertainties may exist in South Africa where the Taung Group’s exploration and planned mining projects are located and any change in the political and economic conditions in South Africa may also adversely affect the financial and operational results of the Taung Group. The Taung Group’s mineral exploration and mining activities may be adversely affected by political instability and changes to government regulations relating to the exploration and mining industry. There can be no assurance that changes in the laws of South Africa or changes in the regulatory environment for mining companies or for non-domiciled companies in South Africa will not be made that would adversely affect the Enlarged Group. There can be no assurance that possible future social unrest in South Africa will not adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s operations. Consequently, the Wing Hing Group is not in a position to assure the timing and amount of any return or benefits that may be received from the assets acquired. If the Taung Group’s business does not develop or progress as planned, the Enlarged Group may not recover the funds and resources it has spent, and this may adversely affect the profitability, prospects and financial conditions of the Enlarged Group.

1.2 Risks relating to completion of the Acquisition

Completion of the Acquisition is subject to satisfaction of the conditions precedent of the Acquisition Agreement, not all of which are within the control of the Wing Hing Group. For example, there is no assurance that the Acquisition Agreement and the transactions contemplated under it will be approved by the requisite majority of the relevant WH Shareholders at the SGM as required under the Listing Rules, and even if such approval were obtained, there is no assurance that such approval will not be or be proposed to be revoked. As such, there is a risk that the Acquisition may not be completed.

– 40 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • 1.3 After completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group will be substantially dependent on the gold mining business.

After completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group’s main business will be gold mining. The Enlarged Group will be subject to the operating risks associated with the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project, and if there is any disruption for a sustained period to the exploration or operation of these projects or their supporting infrastructure, or if there are adverse changes in the gold mining industry in South Africa or globally, the financial condition and results of operations of the Enlarged Group would be materially and adversely affected.

  • 1.4 The resources, production rates and operating costs of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project contained in the Competent Persons Report are estimates and based on a number of assumptions. Taung Group’s actual mining results may differ materially from such estimates.

The information presented in the Competent Persons Report on the resources, production rates and operating costs of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project has been assessed and classified in accordance with the JORC Code, the SAMREC Code and Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules. Resource estimates involve expressions of judgment based on various factors such as knowledge, experience and industry practice, and the accuracy of these estimates may be affected by many factors, including quality of the results of exploration drilling and analysis of gold samples, as well as the procedures adopted by and the experience of the person making the estimates.

As the Taung Group has not commenced production, the estimates on the resources, production rates and operating costs of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project may differ materially from the Taung Group’s actual mining results. There are various factors, assumptions and variables beyond the Taung Group’s control that could result in inherent uncertainties in estimating the resources and reserves and operating costs. If any of these factors, assumptions and variables proves to be incorrect, the actual amounts of the resources and reserves may be adjusted accordingly and the actual operating costs may materially deviate from the estimates. Such adjustment and deviation could materially and adversely affect the operational results of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project and the Enlarged Group’s financial condition.

Estimates of resources at the Taung Group’s projects may also change when new information becomes available or new factors arise, and interpretations and deductions on which resources estimates are based may potentially be inaccurate. Should the Taung Group encounter mineralisation different from that predicted by past drilling, sampling and similar examination, resource estimates may have to be adjusted. Any adjustment could materially affect the Taung Group’s development and mining plans, which could materially and adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s business and results of operations.

– 41 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The resource estimates are estimates only and should not be regarded as a full representation that all these amounts can be economically exploited. In particular, the grade of the resources ultimately mined may differ from that indicated by drilling results. There can be no assurance that gold recovered from exploration assay tests will be duplicated under on-site conditions or in production-scale operations. Material changes in resources resulting from unexpected changes to the gold price, grades, production costs, and recovery rates may affect their economic viability. Nothing contained in this Circular (including, without limitation, the estimated Life of Mine of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project) should be interpreted as assurance of the economic lives of the Taung Group’s gold resources or the profitability of the Enlarged Group’s future operations.

1.5 The accuracy of facts and other statistics with respect to certain information obtained from official government publications contained in this Circular cannot be guaranteed.

Certain facts and statistics in this Circular are derived from various official government publications. While the Directors have taken reasonable care to ensure that the facts and statistics presented are accurately reproduced from such sources, such information has not been independently verified by the Wing Hing Group or the Taung Group and may be inconsistent, inaccurate, incomplete or out of date. None of the Wing Hing Group, the Taung Group, their respective directors and advisers or any other parties involved in the Acquisition make any representation as to the accuracy or completeness of such facts and statistics and, accordingly, such facts and statistics should not be unduly relied upon. Furthermore, the statistics may not be comparable to statistics available for other nations’ economies, and there can be no assurance that the statistics are stated or compiled on the same basis or with the same degree of accuracy as may be the case elsewhere.

1.6 The risk of any reduction in value of the GoldCom Consideration Shares is borne by Wing Hing.

Upon First Completion, GoldCom will subscribe for and Wing Hing will issue 1,134,348,686 new Wing Hing Shares to GoldCom in consideration of the Loan Note. When a South African Shareholder exercises his SA Put Option, and transfers TG Shares to GoldCom, GoldCom will on-transfer such TG Shares to Wing Hing and the transfer will constitute partial repayment of the Loan Note to the extent of the value of the TG Shares as at the date of the Acquisition Agreement. If any South African Shareholder has not exercised his SA Put Option in full within the three year exercise period, GoldCom shall sell or procure the sale of its remaining Wing Hing Shares and the cash proceeds from such sale shall be paid to Wing Hing in partial repayment of the Loan Note. If the trading price of the Wing Hing Shares at the time GoldCom sells such Wing Hing Shares is below the Issue Price, the cash proceeds from the sale of such Wing Hing Shares, combined with the previous repayments may not be sufficient to repay the Loan Note in full. As GoldCom is unlikely to have any further assets, Wing Hing will incur a loss by writing down the unsettled Loan Amount. The Board has approved the Loan Note and it is satisfied that on First Completion when the

– 42 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

GoldCom Consideration Shares are issued and the Loan Note is granted to Wing Hing, there is no reason to believe that Wing Hing is or would be unable to pay its liabilities as they become due. For further details of the South African Shareholders, the Loan Note and the Put Option Agreement, please refer to Appendix VI.

2. RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE BUSINESS OF THE TAUNG GROUP

  • 2.1 Taung Gold’s business requires substantial capital investment and is subject to construction risks.

The gold mining business is capital intensive and the development and exploitation of gold resources, the conversion of resources into reserves, the acquisition of machinery and equipment, the expansion of production capacity and rehabilitation of the environment require substantial capital expenditure. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total capital cost of the Evander Project is estimated to be US$1,034.3 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,067.5 million) and the total capital cost for developing the Jeanette Project, including plant construction, is US$1,067.8 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,328.8 million). After completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group intends to invest significant capital to maintain or increase the Taung Group’s resources.

Some of Taung Group’s expansion plans and exploration prospects may require greater investment than currently planned, and it may not be able to access the necessary debt or equity funding for capital expenditure when needed, on acceptable terms or at all, which could prevent Taung Group from undertaking such expansion or exploration. In the event that Taung Group is unable to obtain adequate financing on acceptable terms, or at all, to satisfy its development, operating and expansion plans, the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project may not be completed in the time planned, may exceed the original budgets and may not achieve the intended economic results or commercial viability, all of which could have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition and the price of Wing Hing Shares.

  • 2.2 The Enlarged Group will be dependent on future cash flows generated from its business and its ability to obtain additional debt or equity financing to support its business operations and expansion plans to continue as a going concern.

If the Enlarged Group is unable to generate sufficient revenue and cash from its operations following Completion or secure additional financing to meet its obligations, it may be forced to reduce expenditures or not be able to continue as a going concern. Reduction of expenditures could have a negative impact on the business and would make it more difficult for the Enlarged Group to execute its strategy, including its expansion plans in accordance with its expectations.

– 43 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The Enlarged Group’s ability to obtain additional financial resources on acceptable terms is subject to uncertainties with respect to, among others:

  • conditions in the capital and financial markets in which the Enlarged Group may seek to raise funds;

  • the Enlarged Group’s future results of operations, financial condition and cash flows;

  • exchange control regulations that may be imposed by the South African Reserve Board; and

  • economic, political and other conditions in South Africa, China and the rest of the world.

In addition, if the Enlarged Group raise additional funding by issuing additional Wing Hing Shares, such financing may substantially dilute the interests of WH Shareholders.

  • 2.3 Taung Group’s planned mining activities are subject to exploration, development and operating risks that may adversely affect the cash flows and overall profitability of the Enlarged Group following completion of the Transactions. In particular, the Basal Reef at the Jeanette Project is overlain by a succession of quartzite and shale which has historically been a limiting factor in the mining of the reefs in the region.

Companies engaged in mining activities are subject to all of the hazards and risks inherent in exploring for and developing natural resource projects. Mining activities may encounter unusual or unexpected geological structures and formations or other geological or grade problems, unusual or unexpected ground conditions, cave-ins and rock bursts. The Khaki Shale which overlies the Basal Reef at the Jeanette Project may contribute to such hazards or risks. The thickness of the Khaki Shale in this area can be up to 2.8 metres. The proximity of the Khaki Shale to the Basal Reef varies across the property and may result in unfavourable geotechnical conditions. There are challenges at the Jeanette Project with mining under the Khaki Shale, which may alter the overall risk profile of the project and it is considered by the Competent Person to be the single most important technical risk to be managed. Notwithstanding such risks, neighbouring mines do mine under similar conditions and the Competent Person is of the view that the technical issues of mining below the Khaki Shale have been independently assessed as surmountable and have been successfully managed at adjacent properties.

Other hazards and risks may include unanticipated metallurgical characteristics, less than expected mineral recovery, unusual or unexpected water conditions, flooding, environmental hazards, industrial accidents, labour disputes, social unrest and periodic interruptions due to inclement or hazardous weather conditions and other acts of God or unfavourable operating conditions and losses.

– 44 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The Evander Project and the Jeanette Project have not commenced production and the future production phase may involve additional capital expenditures or significant risks and hazards, including environmental hazards, industrial incidents, labour disputes, discharge of toxic chemicals, fire, drought, flooding and other occurrences outside the Enlarged Group’s control. The occurrence of any of these risks and hazards can delay or interrupt exploration and production, increase exploration and production costs and result in liability to the Enlarged Group.

These risks and hazards could delay the production, increase the cost of mining, result in liability to the Enlarged Group and adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s financial condition and results of operations.

2.4 Economic returns and development costs could differ materially from Taung Group’s expectations.

Taung Group’s results of operations depend, in part, on the actual economic returns and the actual costs of developing mines, which may differ from its current estimates. The development of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project may be subject to unexpected problems and delays. Generally, a mining company’s decision to develop a mineral property is typically based on the results of a feasibility study. Feasibility studies derive estimates of expected or anticipated project economic returns. These estimates are based on assumptions about: future gold prices; anticipated tonnage, grades and metallurgical characteristics of ore to be mined and processed; anticipated recovery rates of gold from the ore; anticipated capital expenditure and cash operating costs; and the anticipated return on investment. Both the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are proceeding to the Pre-Feasibility Study stage.

Actual cash operating costs, production and economic returns may differ from those anticipated by such studies and estimates. There are a number of uncertainties inherent in the development and construction of any new mine. These uncertainties include, in addition to those discussed immediately above: the timing and cost of the construction of mining and processing facilities; the availability and cost of skilled labour, power, water, consumables, such as cyanide, lubricants and fuel, and transportation facilities; unexpected labour shortages or strikes; natural phenomena, such as inclement weather conditions including heavy rain, water availability, floods, and earthquakes; harsh climatic conditions; equipment breakdowns and the need to upgrade outdated machinery periodically; the availability and cost of appropriate refining arrangements; the need to obtain necessary environmental and other governmental permits, and the timing of those permits; and the availability of funds to finance construction and development activities.

Any one of the above factors can result in unexpected problems and delays to Taung Group’s mining operations during development, construction, mine start-up and commencement of mineral production, any of which could have a material adverse impact on the Enlarged Group’s revenue and profitability and on the price of Wing Hing Shares.

– 45 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

2.5 Taung Group may be unable to obtain or renew the prospecting rights and mining rights required for its operations.

As at the Latest Practicable Date, Taung Group has had sufficient influence in decisions over the exploration for gold resources in the Evander Project through a series of joint venture arrangements, details of which are further set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3. Nature and Quality of the Taung Group’s Assets and Businesses — 3.4 The Evander Project — (c) Sufficient influence in decisions over exploration of gold resources’’. Following the completion of the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study, Taung Gold is entitled to earn-in up to a 52% ownership interest in the Evander Project. The registration of Taung Gold’s interest in the Evander Project will be subject to the consent of the MMR to be given pursuant to Section 11 of the MPRDA. Although Taung Gold has received a legal opinion from its legal counsel on South African law stating that the rights of MMR to refuse an application under the MPRDA are extremely limited and provided that the applicant complies with the requirements set out in the MPRDA, the MMR is obliged to give her consent, if Taung Gold is unable to either (i) complete the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study on the Evander Project within the time prescribed under the joint venture arrangements; or (ii) the MMR fails to give her consent under Section 11 of the MPRDA, the value, profitability and future prospects of the Enlarged Group may be negatively affected.

Taung Gold entered into an agreement with Harmony to acquire the single prospecting right for the Jeanette area in 2008. Consent to the transfer of the prospecting right to a subsidiary of Taung Gold was given by the DMR on 29 September 2010 and the prospecting right is valid for five years commencing from 29 June 2010. This prospecting right can be renewed for a further period of three years by submitting a renewal application not later than 60 working days prior to the date of expiry of the right. The Jeanette Project prospecting right may or may not be successfully renewed upon its expiry. If this right cannot be renewed successfully, the value, profitability and future prospects of the Enlarged Group may be negatively affected.

Further, the mining right over the Evander Project and the prospecting right over the Jeanette Project are granted subject to conditions and can be suspended or cancelled if Taung Gold breaches its obligations under any of the conditions and fails to rectify such breach upon notice. The most commonly cited reasons for the MMR refusing to renew a prospecting or mining right are the holder’s failure to carry out the agreed exploration work programme or for failing to comply with environmental regulations. Any suspension or cancellation of prospecting or mining rights may limit Taung Group’s ability to operate the Evander Project or the Jeanette Project and will have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s business, operations or financial condition following completion of the Transactions.

– 46 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

2.6 Taung Group’s insurance coverage could prove inadequate to satisfy potential claims.

While the Directors believe that the Taung Group has taken out insurance within ranges of coverage consistent with industry practice in South Africa, in the course of exploration, development and production of mineral properties, a variety of risks (and in particular, unexpected or unusual geological or operating conditions) may occur. It is not possible to fully insure against many of the risks, and the Taung Group may decide not to take out insurance against such risks as a result of high premiums or other reasons. Should such liabilities arise, they could reduce or eliminate any future profitability and result in an increase in costs and a decline in the value of our securities.

In particular, the Taung Group may be subject to liability for pollution (excluding sudden and accidental pollution) or other hazards against which it has not insured or cannot insure, including those in respect of past mining activities. Further, insurance policies contain exclusions and limitations on coverage.

As a result, in the future, Taung Group’s insurance coverage may not cover the extent of claims against the Enlarged Group for environmental or industrial accidents or pollution. In the event that Taung Group suffers a significant liability for which it is not insured or insurance coverage is inadequate to cover the entire liability, the Enlarged Group’s business and results of operation could be materially and adversely affected.

2.7 If the Enlarged Group is unable to retain its key personnel, the Enlarged Group’s business and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.

The Directors believe the Taung Group’s success depends to a significant extent on its pool of talented and experienced senior management and key employees, the details of which are set out in the section headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 5. Directors and Senior Management of Taung Gold’’. Although it is expected that all such senior management and key employees will remain in Taung Gold following completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group cannot prevent such senior management and key employees from terminating their services with Taung Gold in accordance with the relevant agreed conditions. In addition, it is critical that the Taung Group is able to recruit, develop and retain skilled employees who are historically disadvantaged South Africans in order to meet the broad-base black economic initiatives stipulated under the MPRDA and the Mining Charter, further details of which are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 2. Laws and Regulations relating to the Mining Industry in South Africa — 2.3 Broad-based SocioEconomic Charter (the Mining Charter)’’.

The Taung Group’s success further depends on the ability of its key personnel to operate effectively, both individually and as a group. All of the Taung Group’s key management and technical personnel are important to its success; however none of the key personnel are irreplaceable. If the Enlarged Group is not successful in retaining or

– 47 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

attracting such personnel after completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group’s business may be harmed. The global shortage of key mining industry human resource skills, including geologists, mining engineers, metallurgists and skilled artisans has been exacerbated in the current environment of increased mining activity across the globe. There can be no assurance that the Taung Group will be able to attract and retain skilled and experienced employees and, should the Taung Group loses any of its key personnel, the Enlarged Group’s business may be harmed and its results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

2.8 Disputes between Taung Gold and its joint venture partner, EGM Limited could adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s future financial condition.

As discussed in the section headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3. Nature and Quality of the Taung Group’s Assets and Businesses — 3.4 The Evander Project — (c) Sufficient influence in decisions over exploration of gold resources’’ below, Taung Gold gained sufficient influence over the exploration rights of the Evander Project with a joint venture arrangement with EGM Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Harmony.

Harmony is a large gold producer in South Africa. Conflicts of interest may arise, and there is no guarantee that Harmony will continue to agree with Taung Gold on its access or management rights over the Evander Project or other matters. Any such disagreement could result in a potential dispute which could affect the viability of the Evander Project and would divert management’s attention or financial resources away from the Taung Group’s other projects. If any such disputes occur following completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.

2.9 The Taung Group competes with companies with greater financial resources.

The Taung Group operates in an industry with other more well-established companies which have greater financial resources or access to financing. Accordingly, the Taung Group faces strong competition from other mining companies in connection with exploration and the acquisition of properties producing, or capable of producing, base and precious metals as well as for access to financial resources. Many of these companies have greater financial resources, operational experience and technical capabilities than the Taung Group. As a result of this competition, the Taung Group may be unable to maintain or acquire attractive mining properties on terms it considers acceptable or at all. Consequently, its revenues, operations and financial condition could be materially adversely affected.

– 48 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3. RISKS RELATING TO THE GLOBAL GOLD MINING INDUSTRY

The Enlarged Group’s results of operations will be affected by changes in the market price for gold.

Substantially all of the revenues and cash flows of the Enlarged Group will be derived from the sale of gold produced from the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. As such, the commercial viability and profitability of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are sensitive to the market price for gold, which can fluctuate widely. These fluctuations are caused by numerous factors beyond the Enlarged Group’s control, including: financial market expectations regarding the rate of inflation; the strength of the US dollar (the currency in which the gold price trades internationally) relative to other currencies; speculative positions taken by investors or traders in gold; changes in the demand for gold use in jewellery, for industrial uses and for investment; changes in the supply of gold from production, disinvestment, scrap and hedging; changes in interest rates; actual or expected gold sales by central banks; gold sales by gold producers in forward transactions; global or regional political or economic events; and costs of gold production.

The price of gold is often subject to sharp, short-term changes resulting from speculative activities. While the overall supply of and demand for gold can affect its market price, because of the considerable size of aboveground stocks of the metal, in comparison to other commodities, these factors typically do not affect the price in the same manner or degree as the supply of and demand for other commodities tend to affect their market price.

There is no assurance that the global demand for gold and associated mineral products will continue to grow or that the internal demand for such products will not experience excess supply. According to the London Bullion Market Association and based on the London pm fix price, the gold price reached a record high of US$1,421.00 per troy ounce in 2010. The gold price ranged from US$712.50 to US$1,011.25 per troy ounce in 2008, from US$810.00 to US$1,212.50 per troy ounce in 2009 and from US$1,058.00 to US$1,421.00 per troy ounce in 2010. The market price of gold on the Latest Practicable Date was US$1,613.50 per troy ounce, compared with the 2010 average price for gold of US$1,224.52 per troy ounce. These prices are significantly above the historic average price of gold and may decline significantly in the future. Future prolonged reductions or declines in world gold prices could have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s revenue and profitability and on the price of Wing Hing Shares.

In the case of a significant and prolonged reduction in the price of gold, the Enlarged Group may determine that it is not economically feasible to continue commercial production at some or all of its operations or the development of some or all of its current prospects, as applicable. In such a circumstance, the Enlarged Group may curtail or suspend some or all of its exploration and production activities and/or

– 49 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

be required to draw down (without replacement) and/or restate downwards its resources, which could have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s revenue and profitability and on the price of Wing Hing Shares.

4. RISKS RELATING TO THE SOUTH AFRICAN GOLD MINING INDUSTRY

  • 4.1 The supply of electricity and increases in the cost of power may adversely affect the Taung Group’s results of operations and the Enlarged Group’s financial condition.

The Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are dependent on electrical power generated by the South African State utility Eskom, which holds a monopoly on the generation and distribution of electricity in the South African market. As a result of an increase in demand exceeding available generating capacity, South Africa has been subject to disruptions in electrical power supply.

Electricity supply to the Evander Project would be established through new temporary and permanent agreements with Eskom. Electricity supply to the Jeanette Project would be supplied in the same manner. Generators would supplement the temporary supplies at the initial mining phases and upon full production phase, Eskom will supply power to the Evander and Jeanette Projects. Applications have been submitted to Eskom for temporary and permanent power allocations to the Evander Project. Any shortfalls in electricity will be supplied by diesel generation. The application for a similar arrangement with Eskom regarding the Jeanette Project will commence during the first quarter of 2012. The Competent Persons Report has provided for the capital expenditure estimate required to provide 7.5MW of self generated power but if Eskom is unable to allocate sufficient electricity to the Evander Project and/or the Jeanette Project during the early construction stages, this will increase the Taung Group’s capital costs due to the use of diesel generated power.

The National Energy Regulator South Africa (NERSA) has approved imposing an average 25% per annum tariff increase for the three year multi-year price determination period as a result of Eskom’s planned capital expansion program to deal with the current power constraints. The first increase became effective on 1 April 2010. As a result of the increasing constraints on power in South Africa and Eskom’s monopoly status, the Wing Hing Group is not in a position to predict whether there will be any further tariff increases after completion of the Transactions. If the electricity tariff continues to increase, the profitability and results of operations of the Enlarged Group may be adversely affected which may in turn have a material and adverse impact on the price of Wing Hing Shares.

  • 4.2 The Taung Group’s planned mining projects will rely on significant amounts of water, the bulk of which will be supplied by local water authorities who may increase costs or impose restrictive requirements on their conditions of supply.

The Evander Project is expected to consume approximately 3,000m[3] /day of water at full production, the majority of which will be supplied by the fissure water which is being made inside the mine. Any supplemental water required will be supplied from the Vaal River Water Scheme. Water supply to the Evander Project is unlikely to be a

– 50 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

future limiting factor since most of the current mining operations in the Evander Project were planned for greater production profiles than are currently maintained, with a 160Mm[3] per annum water pipeline, delivering water from the Vaal River, having recently been completed. The Jeanette Project is estimated to consume approximately 3t/t (tons of water per ton total rock broken). Water will be supplied to the Jeanette Project by the Rand Water Board and potable water will be sent underground and used as drinking water, service water and makeup water for the refrigeration plants. All water will be supplied to the mining blocks by means of a network of underground piping. Water costs for these projects were approximately US$0.56/m[3] in 2010 and are expected to increase to US$0.75/m[3] in 2013. As the balance of the water requirements will be provided by the local authorities (with the remainder being underground sources from adjacent mines), any increases in costs by the local water boards or if the local water boards impose restrictive requirements on their conditions of supply, this may have an increased cost impact on the Enlarged Group’s profitability and results of operations which may in turn have an impact on the price of Wing Hing Shares.

4.3 The Taung Group’s operations are subject to environmental laws and regulations.

As a gold mining company, the Taung Group is subject to environmental legislation and regulation in South Africa, specifically the MPRDA and the National Environmental Management Act, 1998 (NEMA). This legislation and regulation could impose unexpected costs and burdens on the Taung Group, the full extent of which cannot always be predicted. Details of these regulations are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 2. Laws and Regulations relating to the Mining Industry in South Africa — 2.7 Environmental Legislation’’.

In particular, the NEMA requires, among other things, that every person who causes, has caused or may cause significant pollution or degradation of the environment must take reasonable steps to prevent such pollution or degradation from occurring, continuing or recurring. The reach of the NEMA remains subject to interpretation by South African courts. In addition, the MPRDA requires companies that undertake mining activities to make financial provision for rehabilitation liabilities to the satisfaction of the DMR. Directors of mining companies may be held jointly and severally liable for any unacceptable negative impact on the environment, including damages caused by the company which they represent. Under the National Water Act, 1998, owners, controllers and occupiers of land on which any activity or process is or was performed or undertaken or on which any situation exists that causes, has caused or is likely to cause the pollution of a water resource, must take all reasonable measures to prevent such pollution from occurring, continuing or recurring.

Violation of these laws and regulations may result in the Taung Group having to pay penalties and incur other liabilities. In extreme cases the authorities may have the right to suspend or cancel licenses where the holder is found to be in breach of health and safety and environmental laws and regulations and fails to rectify the same despite written notification to do so.

– 51 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The MPRDA, certain other environmental legislation and the administrative policies of the South African government regulate the impact of the Taung Group’s prospecting and mining operations on the environment. The Taung Group has yet to obtain approval of the DMR with respect to the compliance with environmental control measures in respect of certain of its projects, including the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project. Before commencing work on a project site, a detailed environmental update study will be required, for which site visits have to be conducted and various documents have to be submitted. There can be no assurance that the Taung Group will be able to obtain all the necessary approvals. If the Taung Group is unable to obtain any of such approvals, the development and operations of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project may be adversely affected.

Mining operations have inherent risks and liabilities associated with safety and damage to the environment and the disposal of waste products occurring as a result of mineral exploration and production. The occurrence of any such safety or environmental incident could delay production and/or increase production costs and may impact on the Taung Group’s ongoing compliance with environmental legislation, regulations and the conditions of the prospecting rights or mining rights granted. Liabilities could be imposed on the Taung Group for damages, clean up costs or penalties in the event of certain discharges into the environment, environmental damage caused by previous operations or non-compliance with environmental laws or regulations. Current legislation requires the establishment of an Environmental Trust Fund by all mining companies in South Africa, which makes provision during Life of Mine for rehabilitation at mine closure. Changes to legislation may cause a shortfall of funding at mine closure.

In the future, the Taung Group may incur unexpected costs associated with complying with the requirements being imposed under new legislation and regulations. This may include the need to increase and accelerate expenditure on environmental rehabilitation and to alter provisions for this expenditure, which could have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s results and financial condition. The Taung Group may also face increased pumping costs should other mines in the vicinity of its mines fail to meet their obligations with regard to the pumping or treatment of water.

  • 4.4 The Taung Group’s planned mining activities may employ processes and chemicals that may be harmful to the environment and may be subject to compliance, clean-up and other costs.

Mining activities are generally subject to environmental and safety hazards as a result of the processes and chemicals used in the extraction and production methods. In addition, environmental hazards may exist on the Taung Group’s properties, or may be encountered while its products are in transit, which are currently unknown to it or may arise irrespective of such compliance.

The Taung Group may be liable for losses associated with environmental hazards and rehabilitation, have its licences and permits withdrawn or suspended, face negative reputational consequences or be forced to undertake extensive remedial clean-up

– 52 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

action or to pay for government-ordered remedial clean-up actions, even in cases where such hazards have been caused by any previous or subsequent owners or operators of the property, by any past or present owners of adjacent properties or by acts of vandalism by trespassers. Any such losses, withdrawals, suspensions, reputational consequences, actions or payments may have a material adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition and the price of Wing Hing Shares.

  • 4.5 The Taung Group is subject to a significant number of laws and governmental regulations, and the costs of compliance or changes to applicable laws and regulations may negatively affect the Enlarged Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition to environmental laws and regulations, the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are subject to extensive laws, governmental regulations, policies, controls, standards and requirements in South Africa. There can be no assurance that the relevant government authorities will not change such laws and regulations, revoke the approvals granted or impose additional or more stringent conditions, laws or regulations or that the Taung Group would be able to comply with any such new laws or regulations applicable to the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project economically or at all. Failure to continue to obtain approvals or to comply with the relevant conditions, laws and regulations applicable to mine development and natural resources production projects may adversely affect the Taung Group’s capacity to operate and negatively affect the Enlarged Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

4.6 Fluctuations in currencies may adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition.

The Evander Project and the Jeanette Project will generate revenue in South African Rand (ZAR) from the sale of gold and construction and operating costs will be incurred in South African Rand (ZAR) and other foreign currencies. As the reporting currency of the Enlarged Group will be HK$, movements in the currency exchange rates may adversely affect the Enlarged Group’s results or operations and cash flows. Neither the Wing Hing Group nor the Taung Group currently undertakes any hedging activities in relation to currency fluctuation risk and accordingly, is fully exposed to any adverse fluctuations in the relevant exchange rates.

5. RISKS RELATING TO INVESTING IN SOUTH AFRICA

Following completion of the Transactions, the Enlarged Group’s primary assets and businesses will be in South Africa and accordingly, WH Shareholders and potential investors in Wing Hing Shares should consider the following risks relating to operating a mining business in South Africa.

– 53 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • 5.1 Changes or instability to the socio-economic framework in South Africa or its neighbouring countries may have an adverse effect on the Enlarged Group’s operations and profits.

Countries neighbouring South Africa such as Zimbabwe have recently been subject to major instability and socio-economic changes. Changes or instability to the economic or political environment in any of South Africa or its neighbouring countries could affect the attractiveness of South Africa as a country to invest in or do business with which may adversely affect Taung Group’s operations and profits and the attractiveness of Wing Hing Shares. It is difficult to predict the future political, social and economic direction in these countries, or any other country in which the Taung Group operates, and the impact government decisions may have on the Taung Group’s business.

  • 5.2 HIV and AIDS pose risks to South African mining companies in terms of productivity and costs.

HIV/AIDS is prevalent in South Africa. Some of Taung Group’s employees may have or could contract this potentially deadly virus. The prevalence of HIV/AIDS in South Africa poses risks to mining companies in South Africa, including the Taung Group, in terms of potentially reduced productivity, and increased medical and other costs. These risks may limit or disrupt the Taung Group’s exploration activities or development of future mining operations, restrict the movement of funds, or result in expropriation without fair compensation. If a significant increase in the incidence of HIV and AIDS infection and HIV and AIDS-related diseases among the workforce over the next several years occurs, this may have an adverse impact on the Enlarged Group’s operations, projects and financial condition.

5.3 The Enlarged Group’s financial flexibility could be materially constrained by exchange control regulations as imposed by the South African Reserve Board.

South African law provides for exchange control regulations which restrict the export of capital by residents from the common monetary area, which includes South Africa. These regulations apply to transactions involving South African residents, including both natural persons and legal entities. In particular, Taung Gold is generally not permitted (i) to export capital from South Africa if the export is not in line with current exchange control rulings; (ii) to hold foreign currency for a period of longer than six months offshore; or (iii) to incur indebtedness denominated in foreign currencies without the approval of the South African exchange control authorities, which may affect Taung Gold’s ability to borrow funds from members of the Enlarged Group for use in South Africa and to repay these borrowings from South Africa.

If Taung Gold were to have an offshore subsidiary or offshore operations, it could raise capital and retain dividends offshore and use the capital for any purpose on condition that (i) there is no recourse to South Africa; (ii) the dividends may not be reinvested in the Common Monetary Area; and (iii) it is annually reported to SARB. Taung Gold is permitted to acquire an interest in a foreign venture with the approval of SARB.

– 54 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Since 1995, certain exchange controls in South Africa have been relaxed. Although the government has expressed an intention to gradually relax exchange control regulations with a view to ultimately eliminating exchange controls, there is no certainty that exchange control regulations will be reduced or eliminated.

5.4 The cost of occupational healthcare services may increase in the future.

The Taung Group’s operations in South Africa are subject to health and safety regulations which could impose significant costs and burdens. South African legislation has granted the relevant authorities broad powers to among other things, close unsafe mines and order corrective action relating to health and safety matters.

The legislation also sets out prescriptive provisions to govern the payment of compensation and medical costs related to certain illnesses contracted by persons employed in mines or at sites where activities ancillary to mining are conducted. Occupational healthcare services are available to the Taung Group’s employees from existing healthcare facilities in South Africa. The costs associated with providing such services and implementing the various programs could potentially increase in the future as a result of (a) changes in the nature of underlying legislation and (b) the profile of our employees. Given the uncertain nature of this risk, it is not possible for the Taung Group to accurately assess such potential costs. South African legislation also mandatorily requires the Taung Group to apply medical surveillance on all employees to monitor their medical condition throughout their work history. The latter serves to make employers liable for that part of medical deterioration for which a company is responsible during an employee’s work tenure.

5.5 Laws governing mineral rights affect the Taung Group’s business.

Although all of the old order prospecting rights in respect of both the Evander Project and Jeanette Project have been converted into new order prospecting rights, such new order prospecting rights may be suspended or cancelled if the DMR, having followed the requisite procedures under the MPRDA, determines that the holder is in breach of the provisions of the MPRDA or the terms under which such new order prospecting rights were granted. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Taung Group has not committed any material breach of the MPRDA or of the terms under which its new order prospecting rights for the Jeanette Project have been granted. The same holds true for EGM Limited in respect of itself and for the Evander Project.

Part of the procedure for converting each old order mining or prospecting right into a new order mining or prospecting right in respect of the Jeanette Project and Evander Project was the approval by the MMR of an environmental management programme, for which the former holder had to, amongst other things, investigate, assess and evaluate the impact of its proposed prospecting operations on the environment and on the socio-economic conditions of any person who might be directly affected by those operations. In subsequently taking transfer or exercising control over these licenses, the Taung Group is continually assessing and evaluating the impact which its operations exert. Furthermore, in applying for each new order prospecting right under the MPRDA for the Greenfield Projects, the Taung Group was

– 55 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

also required to consult with the landowner or lawful occupier and any other affected party with respect to the land over which it sought to be granted new order prospecting rights. The Taung Group therefore has experience in dealing with the concerns of parties that may be affected by its operations, for example local communities and local municipalities.

Under the MPRDA, tenure over established mining operations is secured for up to 30 years (and renewable for periods not exceeding 30 years each thereafter), provided that mining companies applied for new order mining rights over existing operations within five years of 1 May 2004 or before the existing right expired, whichever was the earlier date, and fulfil the requirements specified in the MPRDA and the Broad-Based Socio-Economic Empowerment Charter for the South African mining industry as amended in 2010 (the Mining Charter). Details of the MPRDA and the Mining Charter are set out in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 2. Laws and Regulations relating to the Mining Industry in South Africa — 2.3 Broad-based Socio-Economic Charter (the Mining Charter)’’.

The Mining Charter was designed to facilitate the participation of historically disadvantaged South Africans in South African’s mining industry. Non-compliance with the provisions of the Mining Charter could lead to loss of mining and related rights. The Mining Charter has a number of objectives which include, among other things:

  • the expansion of opportunities for persons disadvantaged by unfair discrimination under the previous political dispensation;

  • the expansion of the skills base of such persons;

  • the promotion of employment and advancement of the social and economic welfare of mining communities; and

  • the promotion of beneficiation within South Africa.

The Mining Charter contains principles relating to the transfer, over a 10-year period, of 26% of South Africa’s mining assets (as equity or attributable units of production) to historically disadvantaged South Africans.

  • 5.6 WH Shareholders and potential investors in Wing Hing may have difficulty bringing actions, and enforcing judgments, against the Taung Group, its directors and executive officers

Taung Gold is incorporated in South Africa and forms the primary asset of the Enlarged Group. All of the Taung Group’s assets are located in South Africa. The directors and senior management of the Taung Group reside outside of Hong Kong. Substantially all of the assets of these persons and substantially all of the Enlarged Group’s assets will be located outside of Hong Kong following completion of the Transactions. As a result, it may not be possible for investors to enforce a judgment

– 56 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

against these persons or Taung Gold obtained in a court of Hong Kong. A foreign judgment is not directly enforceable in South Africa, but constitutes a cause of action which will be enforced by South African courts provided that:

  • the court that pronounced the judgment had jurisdiction to entertain the case according to the principles recognized by South African law with reference to the jurisdiction of foreign courts;

  • the judgment is final and conclusive;

  • the judgment has not lapsed;

  • the recognition and enforcement of the judgment by South African courts would not be contrary to public policy, including observance of the rules of natural justice which require that the documents initiating the Hong Kong proceeding were properly served on the defendant and that the defendant was given the right to be heard and represented by counsel in a free and fair trial before an impartial tribunal;

    • the judgment does not involve the enforcement of a penal or revenue law; and
  • the enforcement of the judgment is not otherwise precluded by the provisions of the Protection of Business Act 99 of 1978, as amended, of South Africa.

  • 5.7 Taung Gold may not pay dividends or make similar payments to Wing Hing in the future

Payment of any future dividends is at the discretion of Taung Gold’s board of directors after taking into account many factors including Taung Gold’s operating results, financial condition and Taung Gold’s anticipated cash needs. Under South African law, Taung Gold is only entitled to pay a dividend or similar payment to shareholders if it meets the solvency and liquidity tests set out in the Companies Act of South Africa and Taung Gold’s articles of association. Cash dividends or other similar payments may not be paid in the future.

In February 2007, the South African government announced a proposal to replace Secondary Tax on Companies with a 10% withholding tax on dividends and other distributions payable to shareholders. The amendments will be implemented in phases and are expected to become effective in the near future. Although this may reduce the tax payable on Taung Gold’s South African operations, thereby increasing distributable earnings, the withholding tax will generally reduce the amount of dividends or other distributions received by shareholders.

– 57 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART C — INFORMATION ON THE TAUNG GROUP AND ITS PRIMARY PROJECTS

1. INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

1.1 General background and gold industry characteristics

Gold is a commodity for which there are multiple uses, including selected industrial applications, jewellery manufacture and financial investment. Gold remains a strong hedge against inflation and can act as a ‘store of financial value’. Primary gold supply consists of mine production. Secondary gold supply consists of scrap metal recycle and sales by Government Central Banks of reserve stocks.

In the recent past, gold demand has consistently exceeded gold supply and the price of gold has appreciated in dollar terms every year since 2001. The price of gold is inherently volatile and driven by many factors that could include investment demand for currency hedged assets, availability of primary and secondary supply, interest rates and bond yields, global economic cycles and equity and bond market performance and volatility. Historically, the most significant driver of gold demand has been the jewellery sector. However, financial investment is now increasingly significant to gold demand.

Central Bank activity has a significant impact on the gold market. The European Central Bank and fourteen other central banks continue to abide by the terms of the Central Bank Gold Agreement (CBGA). This current agreement is the third such agreement, with the first agreement being initiated in September 1999. CBGAs were introduced to place a ceiling on the level of gold sold over a certain period of time. Under the current agreement, all participating central banks have agreed to a maximum level of sales of 400 tonnes per annum, amongst all participants, with an overall total of no more than 2,000 tonnes sold over a five year period. Central banks have recently become net purchasers of gold for the first time in over two decades, with large purchases coming from China, India and Russia.

According to the United States Geological Survey (U.S. Geological Survey), South Africa (6,000 tonnes), Australia (5,800 tonnes) and Russia (5,000 tonnes) hold the largest gold reserves in the world. However, China is by far the largest producer. U.S. Geological Survey estimates that China produced 11.09 million troy ounces in 2010, an increase of 8% year-on-year.

– 58 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

World Gold Reserves by Country

==> picture [363 x 204] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

Other 20% Australia 14%
Canada 2%
South Africa 12%
Papua New Guinea 2%
Mexico 3%
Ghana 3%
Russia 10%
Uzbekistan 3%
China 4%
Chile 6%
Peru 4%
Brazil 5% Indonesia 6% United States 6%
----- End of picture text -----

Source: Data courtesy of the U.S. Geological Survey

The global gold mining industry is characterised by a smaller group of major producers and a larger, fragmented group of junior exploration and production companies. In 2010, according to company reports, the world’s top ten largest producers accounted for approximately 40% of global gold production. Barrick Gold Corporation was the world’s single largest producer, supplying a total of 7.77 million ounces of gold.

– 59 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Top 10 World’s Largest Gold Producers

==> picture [368 x 219] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
2010 Mine Production (Moz.)
Barrick Newmont AngloGold GoldFields Goldcorp Kinross Freeport Newcrest Polyus Buenaventura
----- End of picture text -----

Source: 2010 Company Annual Reports

The traditional gold regions of North America, South Africa and Australia remain an important source of global primary supply. Increasingly significant are new gold mining regions including recent exploration and mine development activities in South America, West Africa and Papua New Guinea. The main contributors to mine production growth in 2010 were increased Chinese production, Newmont’s Boddington mine in Australia, and Barrick Gold’s Veladero and Cortez Hills mines in Argentina and the United States respectively.

Gold sector companies continue to be significant participants in global mergers and acquisitions activity in the metals and mining industry. In August 2010, Australia’s Newcrest Mining acquired Lihir Gold Limited for a total consideration of AUD9.5 billion. At the time, these two companies controlled the world’s 9th and 10th largest gold resources respectively. In September 2010, Kinross Gold, the world’s 6th largest producer, acquired Red Back Mining for US$7.1 billion. Red Back’s principal gold assets are located in the greenstone belts of Ghana and Mauritania in West Africa.

1.2 Historical and current gold demand

In 2010, the total demand for gold reached a 10-year high of 4,312 tonnes. This represents an increase of 1% year-on-year after an increase of 8% in 2009. From 2009 to 2010, the average price of gold (London PM Fix: US dollars/troy ounce) increased from US$972/oz to US$1,225/oz. This represents an increase of 26% year-on-year. In value terms, a 26% rise in the US dollar price of gold combined with a 1% rise in volume demand resulted in pushing up the value demand in 2010 to US$170 billion against US$134 billion in 2009, an increase of 27%.

– 60 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Global Gold Supply and Demand

*Q4 component of 2010 numbers provisional at time of print

Supply
Mine Production
Official sector sales
Old gold scrap
Implied net
disinvestment
Total Supply
Demand
Fabrication
Jewellery
Other
Total Fabrication
Bar Hoarding
Net producer de-hedging
Implied net investment
Official sector purchases
Total Demand
2000
2,620
479
620
299
4,018
3,205
557
3,762
242
15
4,018
2001
2,646
520
749
3,915
3,009
474
3,483
261
151
20
3,915
2002
2,618
547
874
4,038
2,662
481
3,143
264
412
220
4,038
2003
2,623
620
986
4,228
2,484
515
2,999
180
289
760
4,228
2004
2,494
479
881
12
3,866
2,616
555
3,172
257
438
3,866
2005
2,549
663
902
4,115
2,718
581
3,299
264
92
459
4,115
2006
2,483
365
1,133
3,981
2,298
650
2,948
235
434
365
3,981
2007
2,473
484
982
3,939
2,417
672
3,089
236
444
169
3,939
2008
2,409
232
1,316
3,957
2,193
696
2,889
386
352
330
3,957
2009
2,572
41
1,674
4,287
1,759
658
2,417
187
254
1,429
4,287
2010
2,659
1,653
4,312
2,060
420
2,479
713
116
916
87
4,312

Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd

  • The totals may not add up due to independent rounding.

Demand for gold in the jewellery sector exhibited strong recovery in 2010, with annual demand increasing by 17% year-on-year to a total of 2,059.6 tonnes. Indian and Chinese jewellery demand increased by 69% and 13% year-on-year in tonnes, respectively. Total bar and coin demand increased by 34% year-on-year in tonnes after declining by 14% in 2009. Demand for Exchange Traded Funds (ETFs) and similar investment products decreased by 45% year-on-year in tonnes after increasing by 92% in 2009. In 2010, industrial demand for gold increased by 13% year-on-year in tonnes.

Gold Demand by Category in Tonnes

*Q4 component of 2010 numbers provisional at time of print

==> picture [324 x 195] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
0
2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
Industrial Demand Investment Demand Jewellery Demand
Tonnes
----- End of picture text -----

Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd

– 61 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Significant demand drivers of the gold price include:

  • Investment demand;

  • Jewellery demand; and

  • Industrial demand.

  • (a) Investment Demand

Total investment demand, including bar and coin demand, ETFs and similar products, and over-the-counter (OTC) investment and stock flows, remained stable in 2010 and accounted for 1,629 tonnes of gold demand, compared to 1,616 tonnes in 2009. Total bar and coin investment increased to a record 995 tonnes in 2010, a 34% year-on-year increase. This is after a 14% decline from 2008 to 2009. Growth in this sector in 2010 was dominated by China, where investors continued to purchase more physical gold resulting in an increase of 70% from 105.5 tonnes in 2009 to 179.9 tonnes in 2010.

This makes China the second largest gold bar and coin investment market surpassing the United States and Germany, and falling just behind India. The main driving factors for this demand were continued concerns over domestic inflation and poor performance of alternative asset classes, combined with expectations of further gold price gains. In local currency terms, a 25% rise in the Renminbi price of gold combined with a 70% rise in volume demand resulted in a rise in the value demand in 2010 to RMB48 billion against RMB23 billion in 2009. This represents an annual increase of more than 100%.

India continued to be the largest gold bar and coin investment market in 2010, with annual demand of 217.4 tonnes, compared to 136.1 tonnes in 2009, an increase of 60%. In local currency terms, a 20% rise in the rupee price of gold combined with a 60% rise in volume demand resulted in a rise in the value demand in 2010 to Rs391 billion against Rs206 billion in 2009, an annual increase of close to 100%. Across other Asian markets, bar and coin investment demand grew almost universally.

Thailand was a notable market in 2010, reversing a net negative investment in 2009 of 9.9 tonnes to a positive annual investment of 51.2 tonnes. There was also an increase for gold bars and coins in Europe’s two largest gold investment markets; Germany and Switzerland. This was mainly as a result of fresh concerns over sovereign debt issues in the region and reflected investors’ conviction that gold offers security in uncertain times. Investors in the remainder of the Western markets were generally unable to sustain levels of investment in gold bars and coins seen in 2009.

– 62 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Total Bar and Coin Investment Demand (Tonnes)

  • *Q4 component of 2010 numbers provisional at time of print

==> picture [457 x 181] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

2009 2010
Turkey, 31.8 Middle East, 19.6 Turkey, 40.5 Middle East, 26.3
Thailand, 51.2 India, 217.4
Thailand, 9.9
India, 136.1
Vietnam, 58.2
Vietnam, 67
Switzerland,
97.3
Switzerland,
91.7
China, 105.5
China, 179.9
US, 104.7
US, 114.3
Germany, 133.9
Germany, 126.9
----- End of picture text -----

Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd

ETFs and similar products experienced a significant drop off in 2010 to total holdings of 338 tonnes, a year-on-year decline of 45% in tonnes. This comes after a surge in demand for ETFs and similar products in 2009 to a level of 617 tonnes, compared to 321 tonnes in 2008, a year-on-year increase of 92%. In value terms, a 26% rise in the US dollar price of gold combined with a 45% decline in volume demand resulted in a fall in the value demand in 2010 to US$13 billion against US$19 billion in 2009, an annual decline of 31%.

OTC investment and stock flows were estimated at 296 tonnes for 2010, compared to 540.6 tonnes in 2009, a decline of 45% year-on-year. This data is largely reflective of the opaque OTC market with additional occasional effects from short term changes to fabrication inventories.

(b) Jewellery Demand

Jewellery demand for gold peaked in 1997 and remained stable for a period of approximately 4 years. Since 2001, jewellery demand for gold has generally been falling, with the exception of 2010 where jewellery demand increased 17% to 2,059.6 tonnes.

Key geographies in the gold jewellery sector are India, China and the United States. Over the past three years, these three geographies collectively accounted for 46%, 54% and 62% respectively of the total annual jewellery demand for gold. India was the main contributor to the growth in jewellery demand for growth in 2010 with a year-on-year increase of 69% from 442.4 tonnes in 2009 to 745.7 tonnes in 2010. This represented a record year for Indian jewellery demand, 13% above the previous peak in 1998. In local currency terms, Indian jewellery demand

– 63 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

more than doubled between 2009 and 2010. A 20% rise in the rupee price of gold combined with a 69% rise in volume demand resulted in a rise in the value demand in 2010 to Rs1,342 billion against Rs669 billion in 2009.

Chinese jewellery demand expanded to 399.7 tonnes in 2010, an increase of 13% year-on-year. Between 2000 and 2004, Chinese jewellery demand remained steady around 200 tonnes per annum. From 2004, demand has grown at an annual compound growth rate of 10%. This has predominantly been driven by the rising level of wealth within China’s middle class. In local currency terms, a 25% rise in the Renminbi price of gold combined with a 13% rise in volume demand resulted in a rise in the value demand in 2010 to RMB106 billion against RMB75 billion in 2009, an increase of 41%.

Proportion of Total Jewellery Demand Represented by India, China & United States *Q4 component of 2010 numbers provisional at time of print

==> picture [373 x 261] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

70%
60%
50%
40%
30%
20%
10%
0%
2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
United States China India
Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd
----- End of picture text -----

Hong Kong’s jewellery demand for gold increased by 26% in 2010 to 20.6 tonnes. This is near the previous peaks in demand experienced in 2000 and 2001. In the United States, the demand for gold jewellery has continued its recent decline after reaching peaks of approximately 390 tonnes in the early 2000s. Gold jewellery demand dropped to a level of 128.6 tonnes in 2010, a decrease of 14% year-on-year. Generally, demand for gold jewellery in Europe remained steady between 2009 and 2010 after a sharp decline between 2008 and 2009.

– 64 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Historic Indian and Chinese Demand for Gold Jewellery *Q4 component of 2010 numbers provisional at time of print

==> picture [374 x 234] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

India (tonnes) China (tonnes)
800 800
700 700
600 600
500 500
400 400
300 300
200 200
100 100
0 0
Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd
2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
----- End of picture text -----

  • (c) Industrial Demand

In 2010, the annual industrial demand for gold increased by 12% to 419.6 tonnes. In value terms, the annual industrial demand increased by 41% to a record US$17 billion. The majority of this increase in demand came from the electronics sector. The annual electronics sector demand for gold increased by 16% year-onyear in 2010 to 287.0 tonnes. Electronics demand has experienced double-digit growth in the previous four consecutive quarters as the sector recovered from the challenging economic environment of early 2009.

1.3 Historical and current gold supply

Primary gold supply consists of mine production. Secondary supply consists of scrap metal recycle and sales by Government Central Banks of reserve stocks. Official reserve stock sales, once a large component of gold supply, have been largely reduced as a secondary supply source since early 2009. However, rising mine production and gold scrap supply have increased. Global gold mine production increased by approximately 7% and 3% in 2008–2009 and 2009–2010 respectively.

– 65 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Historical Global Supply of Gold by Source

==> picture [397 x 216] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

4,500
4,000
3,500
3,000
2,500
2,000
1,500
1,000
500
-
2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 2010
Mine Production Official sector sales Old gold scrap Implied net disinvestment
----- End of picture text -----

Source: WGC and GFMS Ltd

(a) Mine Production

Since 2000, the global supply of gold from mine production has remained steady around 2,500 tonnes per annum. Generally, declines in mine production from large, mature gold mines in South Africa, Canada and Australia have been offset by increased production from China, Russia and South America. Exploration expenditure dropped between 1997 and 2004, but has risen in recent years. Despite higher exploration expenditure, there have been relatively few large, high quality gold discoveries reported.

China became the world’s leading gold producer in 2007, due to a combination of rising domestic gold production and declining supply from the United States and South Africa. Additionally, West African countries such as Ghana, Cote d’Ivoire and Burkina Faso have become increasingly important regions for gold production and exploration.

– 66 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

World Mine Production by Country

==> picture [450 x 239] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

Chile
Papua New Guinea
Mexico
Brazil
Canada
Uzbekistan
Ghana
Indonesia
Peru
Russia
South Africa
United States
Australia
China
- 2 4 6 8 10 12
2009 Mine Production (Moz.) 2010e Mine Production (Moz.)
----- End of picture text -----

Source: Data courtesy of the U.S. Geological Survey

(b) Gold Scrap

Gold scrap supply is generally sourced from old jewellery stocks. Historically, jewellery scrap sales account for approximately double the proportion of total supply as central bank sales. Gold scrap sales are generally considered to be a highly variable source of supply, thought to be correlated to the prevailing gold spot price. Because gold jewellery typically retails for a lower premium in emerging economies, scrap supply is far more mobile in these markets than in developed economies. Rising gold prices encouraged an increase of approximately 27% in gold scrap supply between 2008 and 2009. Despite falling 1% between 2009 and 2010, scrap supply remained at historically high levels. (c) Official Sector Sales Central banks in developed markets hold large gold stocks, perhaps as a legacy of the gold standard and Bretton Woods agreement. Over the past twenty years, official sector sales of these gold stocks have comprised an important portion of global supply. This historical supply position was reversed in early 2009, as the official sector became a net buyer of gold, and continued through 2010. Net central bank purchases totalled approximately 87 tonnes in 2010. The Russian central bank, alone, accounted for net purchases of 140 tonnes of gold. Other important official sector buyers include Thailand, Bangladesh and Venezuela. Sales by signatories to the third Central Bank Gold Agreement (CBGA3) were minimal, totalling less than 7 tonnes in 2010.

– 67 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The International Monetary Fund (the IMF) recently completed the sale of one-eighth of its gold portfolio, totalling 403.3 tonnes. The first stage of these gold sales was executed in off-market deals with central banks, thus leaving the total official sector gold holdings unchanged. The IMF sold a total of 222 tonnes of gold to four central banks during this stage. In February 2010, the second phase of the programme commenced with on-market sales of approximately 18 tonnes per month, eventually concluding in December 2010.

1.4 Historical market price of gold and its fluctuation

10 Year Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 208] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 10 year period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated by 446% and exhibited a volatility of 51% (measured as a standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

– 68 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

5 Year Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 207] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 5 year period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated 129% and exhibited a volatility of 27% (measured as standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

1 Year Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 207] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 1 year period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated 32% and exhibited a volatility of 7% (measured as standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

– 69 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • 6 Month Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 207] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 6 month period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated 15% and exhibited a volatility of 3% (measured as standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

60 Day Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 207] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 60 day period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated by 7% and exhibited a volatility of 3% (measured as a standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

– 70 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

30 Day Gold Price Chart

==> picture [338 x 207] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

US dollar per ounce
----- End of picture text -----

Source: www.kitco.com

Over the last 30 day period, the price of gold in US dollar currency has appreciated by 8% and exhibited a volatility of 2% (measured as a standard deviation from the mean and based on London PM fix).

Wing Hing notes that over the last 10-year period the price of gold in US dollar currency has exhibited significant appreciation, combined with periods of depreciation, demonstrating significant volatility. Based on historical price performance, Wing Hing anticipates that the price of gold in US dollar currency will continue to exhibit volatility in the future. However, Wing Hing notes that past performance may not be an accurate predictor of future performance and therefore the future price of gold in US dollar currency remains fundamentally uncertain.

– 71 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

1.5 Major market participants, extent of competition, entry/exit barriers, future opportunities and challenges

The ten largest gold producing companies (ranked by gold production) as at 31 December 2010 were:

Rank: Name: 2010 Production (Moz.):
1 Barrick 7.77
2 Newmont 5.39
3 AngloGold 4.52
4 Gold Fields 3.50
5 Goldcorp 2.52
6 Kinross 2.33
7 Freeport 1.89
8 Newcrest 1.76
9 Polyus 1.39
10 Buenaventura 1.10

Source: 2010 Company Annual Reports

Barrick Gold Corporation is a Canadian company with a primary listing on the Toronto Stock Exchange (TSX) and operations in North America, South America, Africa and Asia-Pacific regions.

Newmont Mining Corporation is an American company with a primary listing on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) and operations in the United States, Indonesia, Australia, New Zealand, Ghana and Peru.

AngloGold Ashanti Limited is a South African company with a primary listing on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE) and operations in the United States, Brazil, Argentina, Namibia, South Africa, Guinea, Mali, Ghana, Tanzania and Australia.

Gold Fields Limited is a South African company with a primary listing on the JSE and operations in South Africa, Ghana, Peru and Australia.

Goldcorp Incorporated is a Canadian company with a primary listing on the TSX and operations in Canada, the United States, Mexico, Guatemala, Argentina, the Dominican Republic and Chile.

Kinross Gold Corporation is a Canadian company with a primary listing on the TSX and operations in Canada, the United States, Brazil, Chile, Ecuador, Russia, Ghana and Mauritania.

Freeport-McMoRan Copper & Gold Incorporated is an American registered company with a primary listing on the NYSE and operations in the United States, Chile, Peru, Spain, the Democratic Republic of Congo and Indonesia.

– 72 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Newcrest Mining Limited is an Australian company with a primary listing on the Australian Stock Exchange (ASX) and operations in Australia, Indonesia, Papua New Guinea and Cote d’Ivoire.

Polyus Gold is a Russian company with a primary listing on the Russian Trading System (RTS) and operations in Russia.

Compania de Minas Buenaventura is a Peruvian company with a primary listing on the Lima Stock Exchange (BVL) and operations in Peru.

As at 31 December 2010, global market share between the top ten gold producing companies was as follows:

Global Top Ten Producer Market Share

==> picture [336 x 189] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

10%
Barrick
7%
Newmont
AngloGold
6%
GoldFields
Goldcorp
4%
Kinross
3% Freeport
60% Newcrest
3%
2% Polyus
2% Buenaventura
2%
Others
1%
----- End of picture text -----

Source: 2010 Company Annual Reports, Data courtesy of the U.S. Geological Survey

As at 31 December 2010, the extent of market competition is illustrated by the top ten gold producing companies accounting for 40% of total global mine production, with the remaining market participants accounting for 60% of total global mine production.

Barriers to entry may include access to resources of sufficient economic size and grades, technical mining expertise, technical processing expertise, capital and marketing and distribution capabilities.

Future opportunities may include advances in exploration, mining and processing technologies, the identification of previously undiscovered gold deposits, previously uneconomic deposits rendered economic in a higher gold price environment and industry consolidation.

– 73 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Future challenges may include a decrease in the gold price, increasing costs of labour, materials and other inputs, a decline in the demand of gold, an increase in the supply of gold (from either primary or secondary supply sources) and the lack of available technical mining expertise or technical processing expertise and the lack of available capital.

1.6 Specific market environment for gold mining exploration and exploitation in South Africa

Historically, the South African gold mining industry is thought to have produced an estimated 40% of the world’s total gold supply. A significant component of this production has been sourced from the gold reefs of the Witswatersrand Basin. Discovered over a century ago, these resources were a major factor in the initial colonisation and economic development of South Africa. Over 100 years of production from this region has resulted in ore reserve depletion, deepening mine shafts and declining ore grades. AngloGold Ashanti’s TauTona and Savuka gold mines in South Africa are currently the deepest mining operations in the world, reaching nearly 4 kilometres in depth below the surface. Over the past decade, South Africa’s share of the world gold market has declined. However, the gold mining industry remains an important component of the South African economy.

South Africa’s largest gold companies are AngloGold Ashanti, Gold Fields and Harmony. Of these three companies, Harmony has the greatest proportion of its producing assets located in South Africa. Other large South African gold mining companies include DRD Gold, Great Basin Gold and Pan-African Resources.

2. LAWS AND REGULATIONS RELATING TO THE MINING INDUSTRY IN SOUTH AFRICA

2.1 Overview

The mining industry in South Africa is subject to extensive laws and regulations. These laws and regulations cover a range of areas including, but not limited to, prospecting rights, mining rights, production rights, health and safety issues and environmental matters.

The key regulator overseeing the mining industry in South Africa is the South African Department of Mineral Resources (the DMR) and the key laws and regulations which the Taung Group’s assets and businesses are subject to are set out below.

2.2 Mineral and Petroleum Resources Development Act 28 of 2002

In terms of the current regulatory regime which became effective on 1 May 2004 with the implementation of the MPRDA, the State became the custodian of all the mineral and petroleum resources in South Africa for the benefit of all South Africans.

– 74 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The objectives of the MPRDA are inter alia to recognise the internationally accepted right of the State to exercise sovereignty over the mineral and petroleum resources within the Republic of South Africa, to give effect to the principle of the State’s custodianship over mineral and petroleum resources, to promote economic growth and the development of mineral and petroleum resources, to expand opportunities for historically disadvantaged persons, to promote employment, to advance the social and economic development of all South Africans, to ensure that the holders of mining and production rights contribute towards the socio-economic development of the areas in which they operate and to provide for the security of tenure in respect of prospecting, exploration, mining and production operations.

The State regulates the mineral industry through the MMR and the MMR has the right to inter alia grant, issue, administer and manage prospecting and mining rights.

A prospecting or mining right granted in terms of the MPRDA is a limited real right in respect of the mineral and the land to which such right relates.

In order to protect the rights of existing holders of inter alia prospecting permits or mining authorizations issued in terms of the Minerals Act, 1991 (Old Order Rights), certain transitional provisions were included in the MPRDA which allowed for the conversion of such Old Order Rights into the new order rights introduced by the MPRDA. The MPRDA established a ‘‘use-it or lose-it’’ principle, and the holders of the Old Order Rights had to apply for the conversion of these Old Order Rights into new order rights within certain timeframes, failing which these rights have lapsed.

Once the DMR has granted the conversion of an Old Order Right or has granted a new order right to an applicant who submitted an application after the implementation of the MPRDA, a notarial agreement is entered into between the MMR and the holder of the new order right. This notarial agreement is registered with the Mineral and Petroleum Registrations Office and inter alia sets out the terms and conditions under which the right was granted, its duration and renewal.

If any material term of the right has been breached the MMR has the right to suspend or cancel the right after, inter alia, notice to this effect has been given to the holder of the right in which the reasons for the MMR’s intention to cancel or suspend the right were provided. The MMR must also give directions to the holder to remedy the breach and the MMR may only cancel or suspend the right if the holder did not take the measures directed by the MMR to remedy the breach and after the holder’s representations have been considered.

The holders of prospecting and mining rights also have to comply with the approved environmental management plans and programmes submitted and approved during the application processes of the said rights.

– 75 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The different types of new order rights and permits applicable to the mining industry in South Africa, as provided for in the MPRDA, are listed below.

LICENCE TYPE PURPOSE DURATION REQUIREMENTS CONDITIONS
Reconnaissance Exploration at the 2 years (non Financial ability; Holder does not have
Permission reconnaissance renewable) technical ability; the exclusive right to
stage and apply for a
reconnaissance Prospecting Right or
work programme Mining Right.
Reconnaissance
Permission may not
be transferred, ceded,
let, sublet, alienated,
disposed of or
encumbered by
mortgage.
Prospecting Right Exploration at Up to 5 years Financial ability; Payment of Prospecting
target-definition initially. technical ability; fees. Holder has the
stage Renewable once expenditure is exclusive right to
for 3 years compatible with apply for a Mining
work programme; Right. A prospecting
prospecting work right may be ceded,
programme; transferred, let,
environmental sublet, assigned,
plan alienated and
otherwise disposed of
with the approval of
the MMR.
Retention Permit Hold on to legal 3 years initially. Prospecting stage May not result in
rights between Renewable once complete; exclusion of
prospecting and for 2 years feasibility study competition, unfair
mining stages complete; project competition or result
not currently in concentration of
feasible due to minerals in hands of
market applicant. Holder has
conditions. exclusive right to be
granted a mining
right. Retention
Permit may not be
transferred, ceded,
let, sublet, alienated,
disposed of or
mortgaged or
encumbered in any
way.

– 76 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

LICENCE TYPE PURPOSE DURATION REQUIREMENTS CONDITIONS Mining Right Development and 30 years initially. Financial ability; Payment of royalties production stage Renewable for technical ability; (from 2010). further periods of prospecting Compliance with 30 years, complete; inter alia EMP, effectively for the financing is Mining Charter and length of the compatible with Codes of Good mine. intended Practice on broadoperations, based BEE (BBBEE.). mining work A mining right may programme; social be ceded, transferred, plan; labour plan; let, sublet, assigned, and completed alienated and EMP otherwise disposed of with the approval of the MMR Mining Permit Small-scale mining 2 years initially. Life of project must Payment of royalties Renewable for 3 be 52 years; (from 2010). further periods of areas must be May not be 1 year each. 51.5Ha; and transferred, ceded, completed EMP let, sublet, alienated or disposed of but may be mortgaged.

The Evander Project is the subject of a mining right whilst the Jeanette Project is the subject of a prospecting right.

2.3 Broad-based Socio-Economic Charter (the Mining Charter)

Sections 2(d) and 2(f) of the MPRDA, are commonly known as the ‘‘empowerment objectives’’ of the MPRDA and they specifically provide:

‘‘2(d) [an objective of the MPRDA is to] substantially and meaningfully expand opportunities for historically disadvantaged persons, including women, to enter the mineral and petroleum industries and to benefit from the exploitation of the nation’s mineral and petroleum resources;’’ and

‘‘2(f) [an objective of the MPRDA is to] promote employment and advance the social and economic welfare of all South Africans’’.

The significance of the empowerment objectives is that an old order mining right holder (right holder) had to submit as part of its application for the conversion of its old order mining right an undertaking that, and the manner in which, the right holder would give effect to the objects referred to in section 2(d) and 2(f) of the MPRDA, being the empowerment objectives.

– 77 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Section 100(2)(a) of the MPRDA, provides that:

‘‘To ensure the attainment of Government’s objectives of redressing historical, social and economic inequalities as stated in the Constitution, the Minister must within six months from the date on which this Act (the MPRDA) takes effect, develop a broad-based socio-economic empowerment Charter that will set the framework-targets and timetable for effecting the entry of historically disadvantaged South African into the mining industry, and allow such South Africans to benefit from the exploitation of mining and mineral resources.’’

Such Mining Charter has been gazetted. The Mining Charter amplifies the empowerment objectives by indicating the specific steps which applicants for conversion of Old Order Rights must take to convert those rights, alternatively which steps new applicants for prospecting and mining rights must take to ensure the granting of those rights.

The Mining Charter suggests broadly that certain criteria would be holistically considered by the DMR when considering an application for a prospecting right and a mining right, namely:

  • Ownership: 26% ownership by historically disadvantaged South African’s (HDSAs) must be facilitated within ten years of 1 May 2004;

  • Procurement: procurement has been broken down to three levels namely capital goods, services and consumables and stakeholders undertook to give HDSAs a preferred supplier status in all three levels of procurement. It is also noted that the Preferential Procurement Framework Act No. 5 of 2000 would assist socio-economic empowerment.

  • Employment: companies will be expected to comply with obligations under the Employment Equity Act No. 55 of 1998 which promotes affirmative action in South Africa. The objective was to achieve a base line of 40% HDSA participation in management within five years of 1 May 2004 and a base line of 10% of women participation in the mining industry within five years;

  • Upliftment: applicants of rights undertook to inter alia ensure that employees are functionally literate.

To provide the mining industry with an indication as to how the criteria referred to in the Charter for conversions will be evaluated, the DMR circulated a ‘‘scorecard for the broad based socio-economic empowerment Charter for the South African mining industry’’.

– 78 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

In addition, a clarification document was issued by the DMR on 14 July 2004 seeking to clarify misconceptions that may have arisen as a result of the interpretation and application of the MPRDA and the Charter with regard to unused rights and pending applications.

An amendment of the Mining Charter was published by the DMR in September 2010. The amended Mining Charter effectively retained the 26% HDSA ownership targets set for 2014 and also introduced a target of 26% ‘‘meaningful economic participation’’ as defined by 2014. The value of beneficiation as provided for in the MPRDA can be offset to a maximum of 11% of the ownership target. With regard to employment equity a minimum of 40% HDSA representation is required at all management levels by 2014 and the mining industry must invest a certain percentage of payroll in essential skills development activities.

2.4 Promotion of Beneficiation Bill

This is still in the process of being finalised, and is expected to provide incentives for upstream companies that facilitate downstream investments, in order to reduce the exporting of unprocessed mineral products and to promote local value addition.

2.5 Mineral and Petroleum Resources Royalty Act, 28 of 2008 (the MPRRA)

The MPRRA incorporates the government’s intention to impose royalties on revenues derived from mineral production in South Africa. The main purpose of the MPRRA was to provide legislation for the collection of royalties from mines, developed and operated in terms of the new order mining and other right granted in terms of the MPRDA.

The MPRRA came into operation on 1 May 2010 and provides for the payment of royalties on the transfer of mineral resources to the South African government. A transfer of a mineral resource is defined as inter alia the disposal or export of mineral resources recovered.

The royalties payable are formulae based and take into account the profitability of the mining company.

There are a number of challenges with the administration of the MPRRA, in that it needs to be linked to existing tax legislation, which clearly defines mining and industrial tax rates based on a profitability formula. The intention is not to facilitate double taxation.

The MPRRA distinguishes between refined and unrefined mineral resources, where refined minerals have been refined beyond a condition specified by the MPRRA, and unrefined minerals have undergone limited beneficiation as specified by the MPRRA.

– 79 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The royalty is determined by multiplying the gross sales value of the extractor, in respect of that mineral resource, in a specified year, by the percentage determined by the royalty formula.

Both direct operating expenditure (Opex) and capital expenditure (Capex) incurred is deductable for the determination of earnings before interest and tax (EBIT). The quantum of the revenue royalty on all minerals is dependent on the profitability of the company based on the following formula. For Refined Mineral Resources the formula is:

==> picture [312 x 25] intentionally omitted <==

The maximum percentage for Refined Mineral Resources is 5%.

For Unrefined Mineral Resources the formula is:

==> picture [312 x 24] intentionally omitted <==

The maximum percentage for Unrefined Mineral Resources is 7%.

The EBIT in the above formula shall be zero before the cumulative cashflow of the projects becomes positive. Capex incurred is deductable for the determination of EBIT, as stated above.

2.6 Taxation

Gold mining companies are taxed according to a formula, as shown in the table below, and such companies may elect whether to pay Secondary Tax on Companies (STC) separately. For companies that elect to pay STC separately, STC is only payable if dividends are declared. If no dividends are declared, no STC is payable.

COMPANIES ELECTING TO PAY STC SEPARATELY

COMPANIES ELECTING TO NOT PAY STC SEPARATELY

Y = 34–(170/X)

Y = 43–(215/X)

  • Y = % tax rate

  • X = ratio expressed as a percentage which the taxable income from gold mining bears to the total turnover from gold mining

– 80 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

2.7 Environmental Legislation

The key environmental legislation applicable in South Africa is as follows:

  • National Environmental Management Act (107 of 1998) as regulated by the Department of Environmental Affairs and relevant Provincial Departments of Environmental Affairs;

  • MPRDA and its Regulations as regulated by the DMR; and

  • Mine Health and Safety Act (Act 29 of 1996) as regulated by the DMR. This deals with the protection of the health and safety of persons in the mining industry but also has implications for environmental issues related to environmental health monitoring within mines.

Additional relevant legislation includes the following:

  • National Water Act (36 of 1998);

  • Atmospheric Pollution Prevention Act (45 of 1965);

  • Environment Conservation Act (73 of 1989);

  • National Heritage Resources Act (25 of 1999);

  • Hazardous Substances Act (15 of 1973);

  • National Forest Acts (84 of 1998).

2.8 Exchange controls

The export of capital from South Africa is restricted. In particular, Taung Gold is generally not permitted (i) to export capital from South Africa if the export is not in line with current exchange control rulings; (ii) to hold foreign currency for a period of longer than six months offshore; or (iii) incur indebtedness denominated in foreign currencies without the approval of the South African exchange control authorities.

If Taung Gold were to have an offshore subsidiary or offshore operations, it could raise capital and retain dividends offshore and use the capital for any purpose on condition that (i) there is no recourse to South Africa; (ii) the dividends may not be reinvested in the Common Monetary Area; and (iii) it is annually reported to SARB. Taung Gold is permitted to acquire an interest in a foreign venture with the approval of SARB.

– 81 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3. NATURE AND QUALITY OF THE TAUNG GROUP’S ASSETS AND BUSINESSES

3.1 Overview

The Taung Group is engaged in the acquisition, exploration and development of mineral assets in respect of gold (and minerals associated with gold) located in South Africa. On the First Completion Date, Arctic will hold no less than 26.0% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold. Taung Gold holds via its wholly-owned subsidiaries various rights with respect to, among others, the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project, which are the primary projects of the Taung Group.

(a) Competent Persons Report

The Competent Persons Report is set out in Appendix IV of this Circular and is prepared by Venmyn. Venmyn is an independent advisory company whose consultants have extensive experience in preparing competent persons reports, technical advisors reports and valuation reports for mining and exploration companies. Venmyn has experience in preparing competent persons reports and technical reports for companies listed on the Toronto Stock Exchange, the Australian Stock Exchange, the London Stock Exchange and the Alternative Investment Market of the London Stock Exchange, as well as the Johannesburg Stock Exchange.

The signatories to the Competent Persons Report are qualified to express their professional opinions on the technical and economic aspects of the mineral assets described and their relevant competent persons’ certificates are appended to the Competent Persons Report.

The techno-economic review of the gold assets in the Evander Project and Jeanette Project was compiled in accordance with Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules and also in accordance with:

— the JORC Code; and

— the SAMREC Code.

The Competent Persons Report describes and documents the Evander Project, Jeanette Project and the Greenfield Projects of the Taung Group. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total estimated Measured and Indicated gold resources of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project amount to an aggregate of approximately 11.725 million ounces.

The effective date of the Competent Persons Report is 11 February 2011. There have not occurred any material changes since the effective date of the Competent Persons Report.

– 82 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(b) Valuation Report

The Valuation Report is set out in Appendix V of this Circular and is prepared by BMI. The Valuation Report is an independent valuation report on the material assets of the Taung Group. The valuation to be included in the Valuation Report is prepared in accordance with the VALMIN Code, which complies with the requirements under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules. The methodology adopted is the discounted cash flow methodology and Inferred Resources of the Taung Group’s projects will be excluded from the valuation. The date of valuation of the Valuation Report is 30 April 2011. The Valuation Report only takes into account the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project and value has been attached only to the reserves for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project.

3.2 The locations of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project

The Evander Project comprises the Six Shaft area and the Twistdraai area in the eastern Highveld and on the north-eastern limb of the Witwatersrand Basin of the Mpumalanga Province of South Africa, covering an area of approximately 5,129 hectares. The Jeanette Project, in the Jeanette area within the southwest margin of the Witwatersrand Basin, northeast of Welkom, in the Free State Province of South Africa, covers an area of approximately 3,886 hectares. The following map shows the location of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project.

– 83 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

==> picture [427 x 643] intentionally omitted <==

– 84 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3.3 The Taung Group’s portfolio of Measured and Indicated gold resources

The primary projects of the Taung Group, the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project, together have a meaningful portfolio of Measured and Indicated gold resources. Below is a summary of the combined mineral resources for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project prepared in accordance with the JORC Code and stated in the Competent Persons Report:

(a) Evander Project

MINING MINING MINING MINING CHANNEL CHANNEL
MINERAL RESOURCE CATEGORY TONNES GRADE GRADE WIDTH WIDTH GRADE GOLD GOLD
(t) (g/t) (cmg/t) (cm) (cm) (g/t) (kg) (oz)
Measured 140,078 10.63 1,254 118 87 13.92 1,489 47,873
Indicated 15,433,000 9.24 969 104 74 13.28 142,601 4,584,726
Inferred 13,984,700 7.63 786 103 68 12.46 106,703 3,430,589
Total Measured and Indicated 15,537,078 9.25 971 105 74 13.28 144,090 4,632,598
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCE* 29,577,000 8.48 883 104 71 12.89 250,793 8,063,188

Source: Turnberry 2010 as stated in the Competent Persons Report Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Stoping width of 100cm, Specific Gravity 2.7 100% attributable to Taung Gold (subject to s11 consent being obtained in terms of the Sale Agreement)

  • Computational discrepancies due to rounding down

(b) Jeanette Project

MINING MINING MINING MINING CHANNEL CHANNEL
MINERAL RESOURCE CATEGORY TONNES GRADE GRADE WIDTH WIDTH GRADE GOLD GOLD
(t) ** (g/t) (cmg/t) (cm) (cm) (g/t) (kg) (oz)
Indicated (Black Chert Facies) 23,030,000 9.58 958 100 24 39.92 220,580 7,092,000
Inferred (Overlap Facies) 11,540,000 9.58 958 100 24 39.92 110,530 3,553,000
Inferred (A-Reef) 28,340,000 4.95 559 113 113 4.95 140,260 4,510,000
Total Indicated 23,030,000 9.58 958 100 24 39.92 220,580 7,092,000
Total Inferred 39,880,000 6.29 250,790 8,063,000
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCE* 62,910,000 7.49 471,370 15,155,000

Source: Venmyn, August 2009 Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves * Computational discrepancies due to rounding down ** Cut-off at 3g/t Source: Venmyn 2009 Geological Losses 25% Area 39,107,291m[2] Density value used 2.75t/m[3] Average Dip 258 100% attributable to Taung Gold

As shown above, the Evander Project has approximately 57.5% of its mineral resources classified as Measured and Indicated Resources whilst the Jeanette Project has approximately 46.8% of its mineral resources classified as Indicated Resources. In total, the Taung Group has over 11.7 million ounces of Measured and Indicated gold resources. The Wing Hing Group has considered the Measured

– 85 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

and Indicated Resource position of a number of publicly listed companies whose business is in the exploration and development of gold globally with a market capitalisation of over US$200 million and the Taung Group’s portfolio of Measured and Indicated Resources is substantial when compared to the average of those considered companies. This data was collected from a variety of market sources including market data, company disclosures, and analyst research. The resources referred to are all compliant with the JORC, NI 43-101 or SAMREC industry standards and assessed as such by the relevant Competent Persons.

3.4 The Evander Project

(a) Infrastructure and planned infrastructure of the Evander Project

The Evander Project is situated in well developed industrial and mining areas of South Africa with other operating mines in the immediate vicinity. Gold and coal mining has been conducted in the Evander Project area for 50 years and consequently, access and mining related infrastructure is well developed. Access to Six Shaft is by well-maintained paved roads and the area has well established rail links and an air field. The map below shows the railway, power lines and road route of the area near the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas.

– 86 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

==> picture [427 x 643] intentionally omitted <==

– 87 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Six Shaft is a surface shaft system which began reef production in 1986 but was decommissioned in 1998. It is a vertical shaft complex, comprising an 8.5 metre diameter man, material and rock hoisting shaft and a 6.0 metre diameter ventilation shaft. The main shaft is 1,377 metres deep below surface and services mining operations is from above 17 level which is 1,300 metres below surface. The ventilation shaft (780 metres deep) is equipped with a brattice wall, buntons and guides for an emergency cage. The mine was in production for a period of 13 years from 1986 to 1998 processing a total of 2.3 million tonnes of reef at an estimated mill feed grade of 6.0g/t gold. At mine closure, the shaft had not reached its planned depth and was unable to exploit the deeper steep reserves or any of the flat dipping reserves. The Six Shaft shaft winders, headgear, pumps and ancillary equipment were sold to a third party. The original design capacity of the shaft was 200,000tpm, although mining and ventilation constraints resulted in historically lower production rates. The shaft complex is equipped with three main surface ventilation fans, rated to circulate 450kg/s of air. There is limited cooling plant installation which includes a 450kg/s bulk air cooler.

No access exists either from surface or neighbouring shafts into the Twistdraai area.

Electrical and water supply infrastructure is very well established in this portion of the Mpumalanga Province. Electrical supply is provided through an agreement with Eskom (the electrical service parastatal in South Africa). Water is supplied by a parastatal organisation from the Vaal River, and water supply to the Evander Project area is unlikely to be a future limiting factor since most of the current mining operations were planned with greater production profiles than are currently operable. A 160Mm[3] per annum water pipeline, delivering water from the Vaal River has recently been completed.

– 88 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(b) Prospecting rights and approvals

The mining right which covers the Evander Project is currently held by EGM Limited, a subsidiary of Harmony. EGM Limited was granted the Mining Right No 107/2010 on 29 April 2008 over an extensive mining area which includes the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas. The Mining Right No 107/2010 permits the mining of gold and associated minerals in the Six Shaft and Twistdraai area. The details of the Mining Right No 107/2010 are set out below:

Six Shaft

COMMENCEMENT EXPIRY
PROJECT FARM SIZE MINING RIGHT DATE DATE MINERAL HELD BY
(HA)
Six Shaft Driefontein 137IS 2,453 MP30/5/1/2/2/1 29 April 2008 30 Years Gold and New order
Holfontein 138 IS 26MR Mining associated Mining Right
Linana 493 IS Right 107/2010 minerals held by EGM
Czanik 534 IS Limited
TOTAL 2,453
Twistdraai
COMMENCEMENT EXPIRY
PROJECT FARM SIZE MINING RIGHT DATE DATE MINERAL HELD BY
(HA)
Twistdraai Goedehoop 290IS 2,677 MP30/5/1/2/2/1 29 April 2008 30 Years Gold and New order
Twisdraai 285IS 26MR Mining associated Mining Right
Ferdi 486IS Right 107/2010 minerals held by EGM
Sasolkraai 289IS Limited
Goedehoop 533IS
TOTAL 2,677

All governmental requirements to conduct exploration over the mining area under the Evander Project have been met. Prior to the granting of the Mining Right No 107/2010, EGM Limited has to obtain three approvals: (1) approval of the mine works programme; (2) approval of the environmental management programme; and (3) approval of the social and labour plan. These approvals have all been obtained by EGM Limited. There are no legal proceedings or claims that would affect the Taung Group’s ability to proceed with further investigation and exploration activities at the Evander Project or that may have an influence on the Taung Group’s right to explore or mine the Evander Project.

The Mining Right No 107/2010 is a converted mining right granted on 29 April 2008, registered on 15 October 2010 in respect of a mining area measuring 36,898 hectares, of which the Evander Project area (Six Shaft and Twistdraai), measuring 5,129 hectares, forms part. It is valid for thirty years ending on 28 April 2038, and can be renewed for a further thirty years by submitting a renewal application not later than 60 working days prior to the date of expiry of the right. The Mining Right No 107/2010 was granted on condition that the holder honours or carries out any agreement, arrangement or undertaking made in terms of the

– 89 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

approved mining work programme, environmental management programme and social and labour plan. The right does not require production capacity to be met by the holder of the right as this is not a requirement of the MPRDA.

The Mining Right No 107/2010 covers both exploration and exploitation in the Evander Project areas. From the perspective of the MPRDA, so long as a party is granted a mining right, this right will also give the holder a right to conduct exploration on the area covered by that licence.

(c) Sufficient influence in decisions over exploration of gold resources

Although the mining right covering the Evander Project is not held by Taung Gold as at the Latest Practicable Date, Taung Gold has sufficient influence in decisions over the exploration of gold resources in the Evander Project through a joint venture arrangement with EGM Limited whereby Taung Gold contributed the financial resources and the technical expertise to actively explore the Evander Project and EGM Limited contributed the Mining Right No 107/2010.

Taung Gold entered into a series of nine agreements with EGM Limited on 29 February 2008 (being the Earn-in Agreement) under which EGM Limited is obliged to transfer the mining rights to Taung Gold after certain works have been completed by Taung Gold. Through the Earn-in Agreement, Taung Gold gains sufficient influence in decisions over the gold exploration activities in the Evander Project and can still exercise (and is exercising) its rights to conduct exploration over the mining area under the Evander Project.

The Earn-in ‘‘points’’

Under the Earn-in Agreement, in order for Taung Gold to ‘‘earn-in’’ an interest in the Evander Project, Taung Gold is obliged to complete a Scoping Study, a Pre-Feasibility Study and a Bankable Feasibility Study. As at the Latest Practicable Date, Taung Gold has already completed the Scoping Study for the Evander Project. The ‘‘earn-in’’ points in the Earn-in Agreement are as follows:

  • First ‘‘earn-in’’ point — Completion of the Pre-Feasibility Study. When Taung Gold completes the Pre-Feasibility Study, it will earn a 25% interest in Six Shaft and Twistdraai. Following completion of the Pre-Feasibility Study, Taung Gold will assign its right to the Pre-Feasibility Study to EGM Limited in return for an allotment and issuance to Taung Gold of shares representing a total of 25% interest in the rights to the Six Shaft and the Twistdraai areas and certain assets under the Evander Project (the Sale Assets).

  • Second ‘‘earn-in’’ point — Completion of the Bankable Feasibility Study. When Taung Gold completes the Bankable Feasibility Study, it will earn an aggregate of 52% interest in Six Shaft and

– 90 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Twistdraai. Upon successful completion of the Bankable Feasibility Study and assignment of all rights in the Bankable Feasibility Study to EGM Limited, EGM Limited will allot and issue further shares representing a total of 52% interest in the rights to the Six Shaft and the Twistdraai areas and certain assets under the Evander Project.

Nature of Earn-In Agreements

Earn-in agreements are common in South Africa and in the exploration industry. They are used globally and not just in South Africa. They are mainly used when one party (the exploration licence holder or mining licence holder) has a project which it believes is geologically prospective and another party (the third party) wishes to secure an interest in this project. Rather than acquiring a portion of the project, the third party agrees to fund (and normally manage) exploration over the project. Generally, the greater the portion of the capital expenditure committed by the third party, the greater the interest such party can ‘‘earn-in’’ on the licence. An earn-in agreement is effectively a joint venture agreement. In any mining joint venture there are essentially three elements that need to be combined: a licence (prospecting or mining), technical expertise and the money for the exploration. In many cases a party may have the technical expertise and the licence but lack the money to actively explore. In such cases, a third party may provide the funds in order to ‘‘earn-in’’ on the project. Taung Gold has both the financial resources and the technical expertise to actively explore the Evander Project. EGM Limited’s ‘‘contribution’’ to this joint venture is the licence and Taung Gold is contributing the funds and the expertise.

Taung Gold’s sole and exclusive right to conduct exploration

In order for Taung Gold to ‘‘earn-in’’ an interest in the Evander Project, it must complete certain works. All required licenses, permits and approvals have been obtained for Taung Gold to legally operate its exploration activities in the Evander Project area and it is not required to separately apply for an exploration licence for its operations to complete the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study. Further, Taung Gold has the sole and exclusive right to conduct the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study:

  • entirely at Taung Gold’s own cost and expense; and

  • in accordance with industry best practice and in compliance with all applicable laws, including environmental laws.

– 91 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

In achieving this goal, the contractual provisions in the Earn-in Agreement have given Taung Gold:

  • Scoping Study: the sole and absolute right to conduct exploration over the Evander Project area and to conduct the works necessary to complete the Scoping Study, upon completion of which the Technical Committee shall determine whether the Scoping Study should proceed to the Pre-Feasibility Study stage;

  • Pre-Feasibility Study: the sole and absolute right to conduct exploration over the Evander Project area and complete the works necessary to complete the Pre-Feasibility Study; and

  • Bankable Feasibility Study: the sole and absolute right to conduct exploration over the Evander Project area and complete the works necessary to complete the Bankable Feasibility Study.

Under the Earn-in Agreement, only Taung Gold has the right to conduct exploration over the Evander Project and to complete the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study. EGM Limited has no unilateral right to terminate the Earn-in Agreement except in the event that Taung Gold fails to complete the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study by their due dates. The due date for completion of the Scoping Study was 9 April 2010. The other due dates have been extended in terms of an addendum to the Sale Agreement from April 2012 (Pre-Feasibility Study) and from April 2013 (Bankable Feasibility Study) to the following new due dates:

Pre-Feasibility Study 9 July 2012 Bankable Feasibility Study 9 July 2013

There is also a standard provision for termination of the Earn-in Agreement by either party in case either party commits any breach of the Earn-in Agreement and fails to remedy such breach within ten business days of written notice requiring the breach to be remedied. Neither party shall be entitled to terminate the Earn-in Agreement under this provision unless the breach is a material breach.

There are no other termination events to the Earn-in Agreement and accordingly, unless there is a material breach of the Earn-in Agreement on the part of Taung Gold, and provided Taung Gold delivers the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study in accordance with the above timeframe, EGM Limited is obliged to, upon submission of the Pre-Feasibility Study, grant to Taung Gold a 25% interest in the Evander Project and, upon submission of the Bankable Feasibility Study, grant to Taung Gold a 52% interest in the Evander Project in the manner as specified above.

– 92 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

In the event that Taung Gold chooses not to commission the Bankable Feasibility Study or does not complete the Bankable Feasibility Study by the requisite time, Taung Gold shall be deemed to have assigned all of its rights in the incomplete Bankable Feasibility Study to EGM Limited for no additional cost.

Taung Gold’s management of the Evander Project

The Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study must yield certain standards in order to be considered completed. As demonstrated below, Taung Gold has significant influence over the management and execution of the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study. In determining whether the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study yield positive results, Taung Gold and EGM Limited has established two committees — the Technical Committee and the Gatekeeper Committee. Taung Gold and EGM Limited each have two members on the Technical Committee and Taung Gold appointees constitute a majority on the Gatekeeper Committee. Taung Gold has also been appointed project manager of the Evander Project.

  • The Technical Committee. The Technical Committee has input into the day-to-day running of the exploration of the Evander Project and the Gatekeeper Committee has a supervisory/auditor role to ensure that the Scoping Study, Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study produced are robust enough to demonstrate that the project will be economically viable. Other than the Technical Committee and the Gatekeeper Committee, there are no other committees that can be established pursuant to the Earn-in Agreement.

The Technical Committee comprises four members — two appointed by Taung Gold and two appointed by EGM Limited.

Roles and Responsibilities of the Technical Committee

The Technical Committee is responsible for, among other things:

  • . appointing a project manager in respect of the Evander Project who is responsible for executing the Scoping Study and managing and executing the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study. Under the Earn-in Agreement, Taung Gold was appointed as the project manager;

  • . providing written reports on the progress of the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study to EGM Limited, Taung Gold and the Gatekeeper Committee on a quarterly basis;

– 93 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • . providing a copy of the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study to each of EGM Limited, Taung Gold and the Gatekeeper Committee upon completion of the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study; and

  • . giving Taung Gold and EGM Limited its recommendation on whether the project should proceed to the next stage.

Decision-making process of the Technical Committee

Decisions of the Technical Committee are made by way of a simple majority. Unanimous approval is not required for a resolution to be passed at the Technical Committee. In the event of a deadlock, the issue will be decided by an independent consulting firm who shall act as an expert and not as an arbitrator. In the agreement an independent consulting firm means a firm agreed to between EGM Limited and Taung Gold and, failing such agreement within ten days of written request by a party for such agreement, any of the following, in descending order of preference (depending on availability and willingness to determine the relevant issue on an expeditious basis):

  • . SRK Consulting (Proprietary) Limited

  • . Mineral Corporation Consultancy (Proprietary) Limited

  • . Turgis Consulting (Proprietary) Limited

  • . Snowdens (Proprietary) Limited

EGM Limited does not have any veto rights in respect of any decisions to be made by the Technical Committee.

Gatekeeper Committee

Taung Gold has four members on the Gatekeeper Committee while EGM Limited only has two. Decisions of the Gatekeeper Committee shall be way of simple majority. Unanimous approval is not required for a resolution to be passed at the Gatekeeper Committee.

The purpose of the Gatekeeper Committee is to assess the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study from a technical perspective so as to ensure that the requisite technical standards are met.

The Gatekeeper Committee has the right to reject the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study on technical grounds. It does not have the right to reject the Scoping Study, the Pre-

– 94 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study merely because the study has not complied with the mining modus operandi preferred by EGM Limited. In the event of any deadlock arising in respect of any matter to be determined by the Gatekeeper Committee, such deadlock may at the request of either party be referred for determination by an independent consulting firm, acting as an expert and not as an arbitrator.

EGM Limited does not have any veto rights in respect of any decisions to be made by the Gatekeeper Committee.

Role of the Project Manager

Taung Gold has been appointed as project manager of the Evander Project.

The project manager is responsible for executing the Scoping Study and managing and executing the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study subject to the direction, policies, rules and procedures from time to time determined by the Technical Committee.

The project manager submits to the Technical Committee a proposed programme for the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study together with a budget showing in detail the estimated expenditure in respect thereof.

The project manager also has the right to appoint skilled and qualified contractors and consultants of its choice to assist Taung Gold in carrying out the Scoping Study, the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study.

(d) The Sale Assets

The following sets out the Sale Assets to be transferred by EGM Limited to the Evander Subsidiaries upon completion of the Phase 1 Bankable Feasibility Study and the obtaining of the consent from the MMR for (1) the transfer of the Sale Assets from EGM Limited to the Evander Subsidiaries; and (2) for Taung Gold to ‘‘earn-in’’ on its interest in the Evander Subsidiaries.

Six Shaft Area. In relation to the Six Shaft area:

  • the Evander Six Shaft;

  • the infrastructure and equipment owned by EGM Limited and situated on the area comprising the Six Shaft mining area;

  • all geological data in respect of Evander Six Shaft and the mining area including all available reports and drill cores;

  • the Evander Six Shaft mining right; and

– 95 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • the Surface Right Permit,

excluding the headgear and winder building at Evander Six Shaft, which have been disposed of to, and are accordingly owned by, a third party. However, Taung Gold has subsequently purchased this headgear and winder building from the relevant third party.

Twistdraai Area. In relation to the Twistdraai area:

  • all geological data in respect of Twistdraai and the mining area including all available reports and drill cores; and

  • the Twistdraai mining right.

There is no infrastructure on the Twistdraai area.

(e) Development costs

The development costs incurred in the Evander Project before Taung Gold acquires an interest in the Evander Subsidiaries will be capitalised as intangible assets in Taung Gold’s financial accounts. Once shares in the Evander Subsidiaries are issued and allotted to Taung Gold, the capitalised costs will be transferred from intangible assets to investment cost in the accounts of Taung Gold and to intangible assets in the accounts of the Evander Subsidiary.

(f) Current Status of the Evander Project

The Scoping Study for the Evander Project was completed and delivered to EGM Limited in April 2010. The Scoping Study was, in the opinion of the Gatekeeper Committee, the Technical Committee and Taung Gold, positive and it therefore proceeded to conduct the Pre-Feasibility Study. Taung Gold is confident that the Pre-Feasibility Study will be delivered before 9 April 2012, being the original due date for delivery of same, notwithstanding the fact that this due date has now been extended to 9 July 2012 by an addendum to the Sale Agreement. Taung Gold expects to complete the Pre-Feasibility Study by the first quarter of 2012. The Scoping Study, Pre-Feasibility Study and Bankable Feasibility Study were carried out and are to be carried out in accordance with industry best practice and in compliance with all applicable laws.

(g) Consent from the MMR

Save for the consent of the MMR to be given pursuant to Section 11 of the MPRDA, there are no other regulatory requirements to be met as a condition for the allotment and issuance of shares in the Evander Subsidiaries to Taung Gold and the transfer of assets to the Evander Subsidiaries.

– 96 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Taung Gold has received a legal opinion from its legal counsel on South African law stating that the rights of MMR to refuse an application under the MPRDA are extremely limited and provided that the applicant complies with the requirements set out in the MPRDA, the MMR is obliged to give her consent.

(h) Following completion of the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study

Following completion of the Pre-Feasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study and if EGM Limited and Taung Gold agree to proceed with mining for minerals over the Evander Project areas, they will establish a joint venture to conduct such mining activities and will share their costs and profits on a pro rata basis.

(i) The Sale Agreement

Following the signing of the Earn-in Agreement, Taung Gold came to the conclusion that greater value could be achieved if it owned 100% of the Evander Project. Accordingly, negotiations were initiated with EGM Limited resulting in the signing of the sale agreement between EGM Limited and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Taung Gold in September 2010 to acquire the entire interest in the Evander Project (the Sale Agreement), subject to the approval by the MMR for the transfer of a subdivided portion of EGM Limited’s new order mining right to a wholly-owned subsidiary of Taung Gold. This subdivided portion covers the entire Evander Project. Completion of the Acquisition Agreement is not conditional to the completion of the Sale Agreement.

Consideration under the Sale Agreement

The consideration under the Sale Agreement is ZAR225 million (or approximately US$28.13 million). A ZAR20 million (or approximately US$2.5 million) deposit has been placed in an escrow account with EGM Limited’s attorneys, pending transfer of the Sale Assets. A prepayment of ZAR100 million towards the total consideration payable has also been made directly to Harmony pursuant to the terms of an addendum to the Sale Agreement.

An addendum to the Sale Agreement was entered into on 19 July 2011 which extended the date for fulfilment of the outstanding conditions precedent including the date by which the MMR must give her consent for the transfer of the Sale Assets from EGM Limited to Pluriclox in accordance with Section 11 of the MPRDA from 31 December 2011 to 31 January 2012. Under Section 11 of the MPRDA, a prospecting right or mining right or an interest in any such right, or a controlling interest in Wing Hing or closed corporation, may not be ceded, transferred, let, sublet, assigned, alienated or otherwise disposed of without the written consent of the MMR. Accordingly, in order for Taung Gold to obtain proprietary interest in the Mining Right No 107/2010 (be it the 52% interest under the Earn-in Agreement or the

– 97 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

100% interest in the Sale Agreement), it is a pre-requisite that such consent under Section 11 of the MPRDA is obtained. The rights of the South African Minister of Minerals and Energy to refuse such an application are limited and provided the applicant complies with the MPRDA, the MMR is obliged to give such consent.

Relationship between the Earn-in Agreement and the Sale Agreement

When the Sale Agreement becomes unconditional, the Earn-in Agreement will terminate. Upon completion of the Sale Agreement, Taung Gold will have a 100% interest in the Evander Project, regardless whether the Pre-Feasibility Study or the Bankable Feasibility Study has been completed. Notwithstanding the signing of the Sale Agreement, Taung Gold is still proceeding towards completing the Bankable Feasibility Study so as to ‘‘earn-in’’ the 52% interest under the Earn-in Agreement. Accordingly, in the unlikely event that the MMR does not grant her approval, Taung Gold will still have the right to ‘‘earn-in’’ on 52% of the Evander Project. Further, even when the Sale Agreement is completed and Taung Gold holds 100% of the interest in the Evander Project, Taung Gold will continue with the Bankable Feasibility Study (that is, the further exploration and drilling of the areas underlying the Evander Projects) with a view to increase the value of the Evander Project of which it owns 100%.

If the Sale Agreement becomes unconditional prior to completion of the Bankable Feasibility Study, Taung Gold will own 100% of the Evander Project upon project implementation.

Acquisition of the Sale Assets

Upon completion of the Sale Agreement, whether or not Taung Gold has completed the Bankable Feasibility Study, Taung Gold will acquire all of the Sale Assets.

– 98 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(j) The Surface Right Permits

There are two Surface Right Permits to the area covered by the Evander Project, the details of which are as follows:

  1. Permit No. 5/1997 Re-Registration No. 626/2005 Diagram RMB No. O 10/96 Purposes mine road, mine railway line, electric power lines, underground electric cables and water pipe lines with fencing Total surface area 18.5483 hectares 2. Permit No. 135/1993 Re-Registration No. 627/2005 Diagram RMB No. O 133/93 Purposes shaft equipment and purposes incidental to fencing Total surface area 41.5208 hectares

These Surface Right Permits allow the holder to construct and maintain infrastructure on the sites covered by them.

These Surface Right Permits are currently in the name of Winkelhaak Mines Limited. Winkelhaak Mines Limited has subsequently changed its name and is now EGM Limited. Taung Gold does not currently have these Surface Right Permits but they will be transferred to Taung Gold upon Taung Gold taking cession of the Evander Project.

(k) Path to Commercial Production of the Evander Project

The Evander Project has a clear path to commercial production. A due diligence review of historic data has been completed and a sedimentological interpretation of the evolution and depositional trends has been developed. The study recognised certain depositional and channel trends and suggested identification of high grade ore zones in both the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas.

As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Evander Project is at the exploration stage and the Pre-Feasibility Study is currently being conducted. Taung Gold is currently carrying out a US$5.7 million drilling programme in order to complete the Pre-Feasibility Study. Taung Gold is confident that the Pre-Feasibility Study will be delivered before 9 April 2012. Taung Gold expects to complete the Phase 2 Pre-Feasibility Study by the first quarter of 2012 and the Phase 3 Bankable Feasibility Study by the first quarter of 2013.

– 99 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Key works and capital costs to commercial production

  • Study stage. The study stage of the Evander Project has been divided into three phases due to the different stages of completion of the project and due to the different timetables for each stage.

Phase 1 — Bankable Feasibility Study of the main shaft at the Six Shaft area. Taung Gold has started work on the Bankable Feasibility Study for this main shaft in January 2011. The lead consultant appointed is Turnberry Projects and the estimated costs of completing this Bankable Feasibility Study is ZAR19.0 million (approximately US$2.38 million).

Phases 2 & 3 — Pre-Feasibility Study of the sub-vertical shaft of the Six Shaft area and Twistdraai. Surface exploration drilling commenced on 17 February 2011 to convert Inferred resources into Indicated resources. The cost of drilling is estimated to be ZAR49.5 million (approximately US$6.19 million). The consultancy costs for the required studies for Phases 2 and 3 are estimated at ZAR61.0 million (approximately US$7.63 million).

  • Mine rehabilitation stage — Six Shaft. Six Shaft is a vertical shaft complex, currently non-functional and the main shaft is 1,576 metres deep. It is estimated to be flooded to 645 metres below surface and as a result, a key work to be completed before production phase is to rehabilitate the Six Shaft mine, dewater the mine and re-equip the existing shaft system. The mine rehabilitation stage will also involve installation of surface winding plant, deepening of the surface ventilation shaft with an aim to achieve production from above 17 level, which is at 1,300 metres below surface at Six Shaft. The cost of this rehabilitation phase and commencement of production above 17 level is estimated to be US$132 million.

  • Sinking and establishment stage — Six Shaft. In order to achieve full production, the Six Shaft will involve the sinking and equipping of a sub-vertical shaft and further developing and equipping this shaft to ramp up to full production. The cost of this stage is estimated to be US$449 million.

  • Twistdraai — Twistdraai is a sub-incline (decline) shaft complex. A cost of US$195 million is estimated to be required to develop the Twistdraai sub-incline shaft locations, sinking of the Twistdraai sub-incline shafts and develop the Twistdraai complex to full production.

The expected costs for each stage of the plans to proceed to commercial production

According to the Competent Persons Report, the total capital cost of the Evander Project is estimated to be US$1,034.3 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,067.5 million). The peak funding requirement is approximately US$315 million (equivalent to approximately HK$2,457 million) in year five after commencement in gold production.

– 100 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

supported by the Competent Persons Report: Est Cost* (US$’mil) 0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
0.31
2.37
0.75
0.69
2.69
3.50
6.19
124.80
893.00
1,034.30 *
Exchange rate used = 8.00
PROJECT CONSTRUCTION PHASE is the capital spent to the time of first production
PRODUCTION (Ramp-Up Phase) is the capital spent from the time of first production to the time of full production
Est Cost (ZAR’mil) 2.5
19.0
6.0
5.5
21.5
28.0
49.5
998.5
7,144.0
8,274.5
2019
2018
2017
2016
2015 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2014 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2013 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2012 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2011 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2010 2nd
Half
1st
Half
EVANDER
A
SCOPING STUDY (Completed)
B
Phase 1:
BANK FEASIBILITY STUDY
C
Phase 2:
PRE-FEASIBILITY STUDY
BANK FEASIBILITY STUDY
D
Phase 3:
PRE-FEASIBILITY STUDY
BANK FEASIBILITY STUDY
E
EXPLORATION PROGRAM
F
PROJECT CONSTRUCTION PHASE
G
PRODUCTION (Ramp-Up Phase)
TOTAL:

– 101 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Timetable to commercial production

According to the Competent Persons Report and Turnberry Projects, the independent consultant that managed the advanced Scoping Study for the Evander Project, there exists an opportunity to fast track the production start date if the dewatering and re-equipping of the main shaft at Six Shaft are accelerated.

There are two possible timetable options for the Evander Project

  • Scenario 1 — dewatering of the main shaft at Six Shaft to commence immediately upon successful completion of the PreFeasibility Study. This will accelerate production start date of the Evander Project to 2014

  • Scenario 2 — dewatering of the main shaft at Six Shaft to commence immediately (before successful completion of the PreFeasibility Study). This scenario will accelerate production start date to 2012

Currently, Taung Gold expects actual production to commence in the third quarter of 2014 or early 2015. Whether the Evander Project can be accelerated will depend on whether it can obtain the necessary financing. Construction of the processing plant will take place concurrently with the sinking of the Twistdraai sub-shaft and is not on the critical path.

Evander Project scheduling

Based on the Competent Persons Report, it is envisaged that the development plan of the Evander Project will be staged over 32 years, as follows:

  • the first two years for sinking, refurbishment and establishing construction;

  • seven years for mine ramp up to full production;

  • 21 years for full tonnage profile production; and

  • the remaining two years for mine closing down.

– 102 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (l) Economic viability of the mineral resources of the Evander Project, as assessed by the Scoping Study and reported by the Competent Persons Report

Parameter Indicator Peak Annual Production 267,000 oz (20 years) Average Recovered Grade 6.55 g/t Average Cash Cost US$397/oz (equivalent to approximately HK$3,096.6 per ounce), calculated based on an average operating cost of US$83.6/t milled (equivalent to approximately HK$652.1/t milled) Anticipated Construction July 2013 Start Date Life Of Mine 30 Years

3.5 The Jeanette Project

(a) Infrastructure and planned infrastructure

The Jeanette Project is a historic mine with two unequipped shafts that were sunk during the 1950s which are available for early mine access. Similar to the Evander Project, the Jeanette Project is situated in well developed industrial and mining areas of South Africa with other operating mines in the immediate vicinity. There is access to the Jeanette Project by the tarred national road R30 linking Welkom and Bothaville, which lie immediately south and north of the property, respectively. The western portions of the Jeanette Project are accessed through 2 kilometres of tarred road from the town of Allanridge. Well-maintained secondary roads traverse the central and southern portions of the Jeanette Project area and in the future, access to drill sites is expected to be through farm tracks. The most proximal populated centre to the project area is the town of Odendaalsrus, located about 2 kilometres to the south of the Jeanette Project. A local airport is maintained at Welkom with tarred runways and hangars. The Taung Group is planning to construct a short, tar access road of 4 kilometres at a cost of approximately ZAR1 million per km. This road will be ready to serve the commencement of onsite construction. The map shows the railway, power lines and road route of the area near the Jeanette Project.

– 103 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

==> picture [427 x 644] intentionally omitted <==

– 104 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

In terms of power, the Jeanette Project has access to the national Eskom power lines which are situated on the western side of the prospecting area. The Jeanette Project will be using diesel generation during the de-watering process as a supplement to line power and the diesel generation capacity will be retained as permanent backup power.

(b) Prospecting rights and approvals

Taung Gold entered into an agreement with a subsidiary of Harmony to acquire the single prospecting right for the Jeanette area in 2008. Consent to the transfer of the prospecting right of the Jeanette Project to Taung Gold was given by the DMR on 29 September 2010 and the prospecting right is valid for five years commencing from 29 June 2010. The prospecting right permits the exploration of gold, silver, uranium and associated minerals in the Jeanette area. All permits to conduct exploration over the mining area under the Jeanette Project have been granted and there are no legal obstacles to commence exploration. The prospecting right can be renewed for a further period of three years by submitting a renewal application not later than 60 working days prior to the date of expiry of the right.

The prospecting right was granted on condition that the new holder honours or carries out any agreement, arrangement, or undertaking made in terms of the approved prospecting work programme and environmental management programme.

The details of the Jeanette prospecting right are set out below:

PROSPECTING COMMENCEMENT EFFECTIVE
FARM SIZE RIGHT DATE EXPIRY DATE MINERAL INTEREST
(HA)
Philadelphia 273 3,886 FS30/5/1/1/2/ 29 June 2010 5 Years from Gold, silver, On 29 Sept 2010
My Betty 351 895PR commencement uranium and Section 11 consent
Wesselsrust 58 date associated to the transfer of
Vriendskap 234 minerals the prospecting right
Roodepoort 235 to Taung Gold
Rustoord 33 Freestate (Pty) Ltd
Heldenmoet 117 from ARMgold/
Zoeten Inval 268 Harmony was
Paardevley 251 granted by the
Martina 226 DMR under FS30/5/
Aanleg 50 1/1/2/895PR
Goud Rand 272
Jeanette 371
De Erf 140
Allanridge 425
Uitkyk 258
  • (c) Control over a majority of the assets of the Jeanette Project and adequate rights over the exploration for gold resources

Notarial execution of the transfer of the right to a subsidiary of Taung Gold took place on 21 February 2011 and cession of this right has been executed. An application for the registration of the right has been filed with the Mining Titles

– 105 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Registration Office. Taung Gold has been informed that there is a reasonable possibility of the right being registered before the SGM. The registration process is merely an administrative procedure and does not affect Taung Gold’s right to prospect over the Jeanette Project area. Taung Gold has obtained a legal opinion from its South African legal counsel confirming that there is no legal impediment in completing the registration of the rights for the Jeanette Project.

As a holder of the prospecting right (whether or not such right is registered), Taung Gold enjoys all the rights which are granted to the holder of a prospecting right. These are set out in Section 5 and 19 of the MPRDA, and include, amongst others, the right to:

  • enter the land to which such right relates together with its employees, and to bring onto that land any plant, machinery or equipment and build, construct or lay down any surface, underground or under sea infrastructure which may be required for the purpose of prospecting;

  • prospect for its account on or under that land for minerals for which such prospecting right has been granted;

  • remove and dispose of any such mineral during the course of prospecting;

  • use water from any natural spring, lake, river or stream situated on or flowing through such land or from any excavation previously made and used for prospecting, mining, exploration or production purposes or sink a well or borehole required for use relating to prospecting, mining, exploration or production on such land;

  • carry out any other activity incidental to prospecting operations;

  • apply for and be granted a renewal of the prospecting right; and

  • apply for and be granted a mining right.

The same applies to the prospecting rights held by Taung Gold.

The Taung Group conducted ground geophysical surveys over the right in 2010. The Taung Group intends to conduct further intrusive exploration over the right, including a geophysical survey and drilling programme in 2011. The Taung Group is currently in the process of drilling in the project area.

Further, Taung Gold has established a Technical Committee, which includes independent industry specialists, to further review the mining strategy for identified areas of the Basal Reef to mitigate any risk associated with the mining thereof. The Basal Reef at the Jeanette Project is the horizon of main economic interest and is a narrow tabular orebody, ranging in thickness from 0.05 to 0.77 metres, which is overlain by a succession of quartzite and shale. The layer

– 106 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

of shale is prevalent in the Northern Free State goldfield and is known locally as the ‘‘Khaki Shale’’. It is of variable thickness, is geotechnically weak and is separated from the Basal Reef by a layer of quartzite which is also of varying thickness but which is geotechnically competent. The thickness of the Khaki Shale in this area can be up to 2.8 metres. The proximity of the Khaki Shale to the Basal Reef varies across the property and may result in unfavourable geotechnical conditions. Notwithstanding this, neighbouring mines are successfully extracting the Basal Reef under similar conditions.

(d) Path to Commercial Production for the Jeanette Project

The Jeanette Project is still at the exploration stage. A Scoping Study for the Jeanette Project was completed in June 2010 and the results were positive. Since then, the Jeanette Project has proceeded to the ‘‘resource upgrade stage’’ through drilling. This refers to the process whereby the Taung Group is improving the certainty that it has in respect of the gold resources in the area under the Jeanette Project through further exploration, mainly drilling.

The Jeanette gold mine prospect area has been evaluated at various stages over the past 60 years. During this time a substantial database of geological information has been acquired through drilling, underground sampling, and extrapolation of geological information from adjacent mining operations. The Taung Group has been investigating and evaluating the Jeanette Project for the past two years. The Scoping Study on the Jeanette Project has been compiled in an iterative manner — that is the results of one phase of the study determines the direction of the study and may necessitate revision of the inputs so that an increasingly accurate study is presented. The Jeanette Scoping Study has advanced through several phases, as the economic implications of certain input options are investigated. The final version of the Jeanette Scoping Study was completed by Minxcon in June 2010, who presented a positive business case for a mining operation. Minxcon recommended that the project progress through to Pre-Feasibility Study stage. After completion of the Scoping Study in June 2010, further information over the Jeanette Project became available to Taung Gold. As such, the board of directors of Taung Gold considers it to be appropriate to commission an advanced study to improve confidence in the Scoping Study. It is expected that the advanced study will complete by the third quarter of 2011 and the total cost (including costs of the Scoping Study) is estimated to be ZAR14.10 million (or approximately US$1.76 million).

– 107 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Key works (and timetable for completion) and capital costs to commercial production
The information contained in the table below is derived from the Jeanette Scoping Study prepared by Minxcon, a
registered Competent Person in South Africa. The information contained in the table below is supported by the
Competent Persons Report:
Est Cost* (US$’mil) 1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1.76
1.53
6.96
19.03
332.72
705.85
1,067.85 *
Exchange Rate used=8.00
Est Cost (ZAR’mil) 14.1
12.2
55.7
152.3
2,661.7
5,646.0
8,542.0
2019
2018
2017
2016
2015 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2014 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2013 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2012 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2011 2nd
Half
1st
Half
2010 2nd
Half
1st
Half
JEANETTE
A
SCOPING STUDY (Completed)
B
PRE-FEASIBILITY STUDY
C
BANK FEASIBILITY STUDY
D
EXPLORATION PROGRAM
E
PROJECT CONSTRUCTION PHASE
F
PRODUCTION (Ramp-Up Phase)
TOTAL:

– 108 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The Jeanette Project has significant Indicated Resources. The path to commercial production includes:

  • Exploration. Further drilling to upgrade the confidence in the independently generated mineral resource estimates. The Taung Group commenced further drilling at the Jeanette Project in February 2011. ZAR21.1 million (or approximately US$2.64 million) has been allocated for this work. The drilling is scheduled for completion by early 2012. New data on gold grades will be included in an updated geological database, and presented to independent consultants for mineral resource estimate revision. The Taung Group plans to drill not less than four (and as many as eight) boreholes over the coming two to three years for the purposes of upgrading confidence in the geology of the mineral resource.

  • 3D Seismic Study. A 3D structural model will be constructed with additional drilling. The 3D structural model of the Jeanette Project will be assisted by information gained from a 3D seismic survey over the mineral resource area, which is scheduled to commence in August 2011. This 3D Seismic Study will cost approximately ZAR72 million (or approximately US$9.01 million) and will be completed by December 2011. The 3D seismic survey will be interpreted at the Pre-Feasibility Study and Bankable Feasibility Study stages. The interpretation of the geologic structure is a key process during the Pre-Feasibility Study and Bankable Feasibility Study stages and such interpretation must be based on a sound exploration programme. A 3D Seismic Study will provide reliable positions of major faults, and relevant depths to target mineralised horizons, and positions of sills and other structures which provide more accurate data for the Pre-Feasibility Study and Bankable Feasibility Study.

  • Pre-Feasibility Study. When the Pre-Feasibility Study is at an advanced stage, an application to convert the existing prospecting right into a mining right will be made. The estimated cost for the Pre-Feasibility Study is ZAR12.2 million (or approximately US$1.53 million).

  • Bankable Feasibility Study. Upon completion of the Bankable Feasibility Study and the grant of a mining right, shaft sinking of the main shaft will commence. The estimated cost of the Bankable Feasibility Study is ZAR55.7 million (or approximately US$6.96 million).

  • Sink main shaft and Refurbish existing Vent Shaft. The existing 5.5 metre vent shaft at the Jeanette Project will be refurbished and deepened to provide the required ventilation and a second outlet

– 109 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

infrastructure for the mining operation. This will be refurbished at the same time as the sinking of the new Main shaft. The estimated cost for completing this part of the project is ZAR2.7 billion (or approximately US$0.33 billion).

  • Access development to Reef. Access development to reef will require tunnelling of various sizes and at various inclinations on different levels. The estimated costs or this access development is ZAR304.6 million (approximately US$38.1 million).

  • Production. Gold production at the Jeanette Project is expected to take place in 2016.

After First Completion, Taung Gold plans to conduct the PreFeasibility Study and the Bankable Feasibility Study in collaboration with independent consultants. Physical implementation of the mining plan and commencement of construction will be contingent on the granting of mining rights for the area. It is estimated that preparation for sinking construction will begin in March 2013.

The expected costs for each stage of the plans to proceed to commercial production

The Jeanette Project does not currently have a dedicated processing plant. According to the Competent Persons Report, the total capital cost for developing the Jeanette Project, including plant construction, is US$1,067.8 million (equivalent to approximately HK$8,328.8 million). The peak funding requirement for the Jeanette Project is estimated to be US$603 million (equivalent to approximately HK$4,703.4 million), expected to be required in year one after commencement of gold production.

Jeanette Project scheduling

It is envisaged that the development of the Jeanette Project will be staged over 37 years, as follows:

  • the first five years for feasibility studies, establishment, shaft sinking and construction;

  • three years for mine ramp up to full production;

  • 15 years for full tonnage profile production at a rate of 145ktpm;

  • four years for mine ramp down; and

  • the remaining ten years for mining remnant blocks and pillars.

– 110 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Est
Cost*
(US$'mil)
1.76 1.53 6.96 351.75 705.85 1,067.85
Est Cost
(ZAR'mil)
14.1 12.2 55.7 2,814.0 5,646.0 8,542.0
2019
2018
2017
2016
2015
1st
Half
2nd
Half
2014
1st
Half
2nd
Half
2013
1st
Half
2nd
Half
2012
1st
Half
2nd
Half
2011
1st
Half
2nd
Half
2010
1st
Half
2nd
Half
JEANETTE SCOPING STUDY (Completed) PRE-FEASIBILITY STUDY
BANK FEASIBILITY STUDY
PROJECT CONSTRUCTION PHASE ** PRODUCTION (Ramp-Up Phase) *** TOTAL:
A B
C
D E

– 111 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (e) Economic viability of the mineral resources of the Jeanette Project, as assessed by the Scoping Study

Parameter Indicator Peak Annual Production 380,000 oz Average Recovered Grade 6.96 g/t Average Cash Cost US$322/oz (equivalent to approximately HK$2,511.6 per ounce) (calculated based on an average operating cost of US$72.1/t milled (equivalent to approximately HK$562.4/t milled) Anticipated Construction 2013 Start Date Life Of Mine 30 Years

4. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

To the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief, the Taung Group is not and has not been involved in any legal claims or proceedings, including any legal claims that may have an influence on its exploration rights over the Evander Project and Jeanette Project.

5. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT OF TAUNG GOLD

As at the Latest Practicable Date, Taung Gold has ten directors and two alternate directors. Taung Gold also has seven senior management members and together with the directors, they form Taung Gold’s core management team. Taung Gold’s core management team, taken together, have sufficient experience relevant to the exploration activities of Taung Gold and certain key senior management members of Taung Gold possess more than five years of relevant experience in the gold mining exploration and/or mining activities. It is expected that all of the directors and senior management of Taung Gold will remain in their positions after completion of the Transactions.

The details of Taung Gold’s directors, senior management and key employees are set out below.

5.1 Directors

Dr. Lelau Mohuba, aged 54, is a director and chairman of Taung Gold. He is the co-founder and chairman of Sephaku Holdings Ltd. His commercial experience includes holding the positions of chairman and chief executive officer of Shikisha Tyre and Rubber (Proprietary) Limited, a joint venture with Goodyear Holdings Limited, as well as co-founding Kiba Investment Holdings (Proprietary) Limited, a mining

– 112 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

beneficiation company. Prior to joining Sephaku Holdings, he was an executive director of Boynton Platinum and a founder and the chairman of Lekgotla Investments (Proprietary) Limited. Dr. Lelau Mohuba received a Bachelor of Medicine degree and Bachelor of Surgery degree at the University of Natal (later renamed Nelson Mandela School of Medicine) in 1980.

Mr. Neil Andrew Herrick, aged 47, is a director and chief executive officer of Taung Gold. Mr. Herrick has over 20 years of experience in the gold mining industry, having joined the Gold Division of Anglo American in 1988 and became section manager at Anglogold Limited from 1994 to 1997 responsible for an underground section of a mine and a shaft system. He became production manager at Anglogold Limited from 1997 to 1999 and was responsible for an entire shaft complex. From 1999 to 2002 he was the general manager of the North West Operations of Durban Roodepoort Deep Limited. In 2002, he joined Gold Fields Limited as senior manager and was responsible for the completion of two pre-feasibility studies for the exploitation of below infrastructure resources at Kloof mine and later as Senior Manager in charge of Kloof mine’s underground operations. From 2006 to 2007, he was a mine manager at Anglo Platinum Limited, after which he joined Norilsk Nickel Africa (Pty) Limited as a mining executive. He is registered as a professional engineer with the Engineering Council of South Africa, and is a past president and council member of the Association of Mine Managers of South Africa. He is a former Chairman of the Mines Professional Associations Committee of Management. He graduated from the University of Newcastle upon Tyne with a Bachelor of Engineering degree (Honours) in Mining Engineering in 1987.

Mr. Stefanus David Steyn, aged 46, is a director and chief financial officer of Taung Gold. Mr Steyn joined the South African Revenue Services for two years in 1990 before being appointed as a practising assistant in an auditing practice. From 1995 to 1998 he was financial manager for two different companies and re-joined private practice in 1998. He was appointed as director in 2000 and acted as auditor of a number of listed companies between 2000 and 2007. He has been employed by Taung Gold since 2007. He graduated from the University of Pretoria in 1988 with a Bachelor of Commerce (Accounting) degree, and received a Bachelor of Commerce degree (Honours) from the University of South Africa in 1990. Mr Steyn qualified as a Chartered Accountant in South Africa in 1991.

Dr. Dawid Strydom, aged 57, is a director of Taung Gold. Currently Dr Strydom is a consulting exploration geologist for Taung Gold. Between 1990 and 1996, Dr. Strydom worked at the gold division of Anglo American on gold mining and gold exploration projects, specialising in examining the geological structure and continuity of gold reefs in exploration projects and on existing gold mines. Dr. Strydom was also responsible for delineating additional gold resources on the existing mines and was involved in the projects designed to ascertain the origin of the gold within the Witwatersrand basin and assisted in providing structural interpretations to seismic surveys conducted over various gold projects. Between 1997 and 1998, Dr. Strydom was seconded to the Anglo American Corporation Limited Head Office Division of the Geo-Physical Survey Department where Dr. Strydom worked on gold projects in West

– 113 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Africa, such as the Sadiola Gold Mine. In addition to his work in Africa during this period, Dr. Strydom also conducted structural evaluations over gold projects in two provinces in Brazil for Anglo American Corporation Limited. Between 1999 and 2002, Dr. Strydom was country manager for Anglo American in Ghana and in Togo. He was responsible for the exploration programme which focused on gold exploration initially then shifted to base metal exploration in these countries. Prior to joining Taung Gold, Dr. Strydom was an exploration manager for Platmin Limited. Dr. Strydom received his Master of Science degree (Cum Laude) in 1978 and PhD in 1985. He was a lecturer, researcher and senior lecturer at the University of Free State and Natal between 1978 and 1990.

Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin, aged 58, a director of Taung Gold, is the co-founder of Taung Gold, Platmin Ltd and Sephaku Holdings Ltd. Mr. de Bruin received a Bachelor of Commerce degree (Cum Laude) from the University of the Free State in 1975 and a Bachelor of Law degree (Cum Laude) from the Rand Afrikaans University in 1977 and practiced as an advocate at the Pretoria Bar from 1979 to 1989, specialising in commercial law and mineral law cases. Mr. de Bruin left the Bar in 1989 and focused on finding, acquiring and developing mineral exploration and mining projects in various African countries. Mr. de Bruin was involved in aspects of law relating to minerals, companies, stock exchange and international finance. He also acted as a consultant to a number of South African companies, becoming involved in their management, including the management of their systems, human resources, customers and financing activities. Between 1999 and 2005, he was a co-founder member of the Platmin Group of companies, which developed the Pilanesberg Platinum Mine and is currently listed on the Toronto Stock Exchange, the Johannesburg Stock Exchange and the Alternative Investment Market of the London Stock Exchange. His role was to engineer the acquisition of mineral projects including supervising the execution of over 300 mineral rights agreements and the conversion of the Platmin Group’s old order rights into new order rights and the acquisition of new mining rights. Mr. de Bruin was also involved with the applications for new mining rights and the management of the operational aspects, including logistics, human resources and administration during his time with the Platmin Group.

Dr. David Twist, aged 57, a director of Taung Gold, is the co-founder of Taung Gold, Platmin Ltd and Sephaku Holdings Ltd. He is a registered member of the South African Council of Natural Scientists, a member of the Geological Society of London and a member of the Society of Economic Geologists. Dr. Twist was a geologist at the Impala Platinum Mines, Rustenburg from 1980 to 1981. From 1981 to 1990, Dr. Twist worked as a post-doctoral research geologist at the University of Pretoria in South Africa researching on various geological issues relating to gold and was also involved in numerous consulting assignments on gold. In particular, he was contracted by Anglo American to assist in its regional exploration programme for gold in the Bushveld Complex of South Africa, and by Gold Fields of South Africa in its exploration of the granophyres of the Rooiberg fragment. He was also commissioned by the Atomic Energy Corporation of South Africa to report on the causes of copper-gold-uranium mineralisation at the Olympic Dam discovery in Australia. In the 1990s, Dr. Twist began focusing on mineral exploration opportunities, including gold exploration

– 114 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

opportunities, in Africa. In mid to late 1990s, Dr. Twist acted as an executive director and exploration manager of Coronation International Mining Corporation, where he focused on gold exploration projects in West Africa and undertook investigations of gold prospects in Nigeria, Benin, Togo, Niger and Burkina Faso. In Benin, Niger and Burkina Faso, Dr. Twist helped identify gold targets and planned, implemented and supervised regional gold exploration programs. During the 2000s, Dr. Twist continued to be involved in precious metal exploration. He was a founding member and executive director of African Precious Minerals Limited, which engaged in gold exploration of targeted Archaean greenstone belts primarily in Tanzania and Mozambique. Dr. Twist is a founding member and an executive director of Taung Gold and has been involved in the target generation and exploration planning of Taung Gold’s South African Witwatersrand gold projects for the past six years. Dr. Twist received a Bachelor of Science degree (Honours) in Geology from the University of Reading in 1975 and a Doctoral degree in geology from the University of Newcastle-upon-Tyne in 1980.

Mr. Igor Levental, aged 55, is a director of Taung Gold. He is also the director of Gabriel Resources Ltd., Sunward Resources Ltd and NovaGold Resources Inc. He worked at International Corona Corporation, a gold producer, from 1986 to 1992, as director of investor relations from 1986 to 1989 and vice president of investments and investor relations from 1989 to 1992. He joined Homestake Mining Corporation, a gold mining company with interest in the United States, Canada, Australia and South America, after its acquisition of International Corona Corporation, serving in various positions including senior consultant, manager of the corporate department and vice president of the investor relations, from 1992 to 2002. In 2007, he joined Electrum (USA) Limited as executive vice president and in March 2010 became the president of the Electrum group of companies, which holds a portfolio of gold exploration and development projects globally. He is a registered professional engineer in Canada and a member of the National Investor Relations Institute. He graduated from the University of Alberta with a Bachelor of Science degree in Chemical Engineering in 1978 and received his MBA degree from the University of Alberta in 1982.

Mr. Marcel F. DeGuire, aged 62, is a director of Taung Gold. He held positions as president of Resurrection Mining Company, chairman and president of Dawn Mining Company and president of Idarado Mining Company. He was a vice president of Newmont Mining Corporation between 1989 and 1996 and was responsible for environmental affairs, metallurgical research, project development and country manager for the CIS. He was also a vice president and a senior vice president at Apex Silver Mines Corporation and was a senior vice president responsible for project development and marketing from 2004 to 2007. Since 2007, Mr. DeGuire has acted as the chief executive officer of Electrum USA Ltd, a global gold exploration company. He is a member of Canadian Institute of Mining, Metallurgy and Petroleum, a member of Mining and Metallurgical Society of America and a member of Prospectors and Development Association of Canada. He graduated from the Michigan Technological University with a Bachelor of Science degree in 1971 and received a Master of Science degree from University of Nevada in 1974.

– 115 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Mr. Neil Robus Crafford-Lazarus, aged 52, is a director of Taung Gold. He started his career in mining finance when he joined Anglo American Corporation as a tax advisor in 1988. In 1990, he joined Gencor Ltd. and held senior management positions in taxation, business development and corporate finance and worked on various gold mining projects. In 1998, he joined Xstrata SA (Proprietary) Limited as financial director. In October 2005, he joined Platmin Limited, a Canadian platinum exploration company, as the chief financial officer. He is a chartered accountant in South Africa and is a member of South Africa Institute of Chartered Accountants. He graduated from the University of South Africa with a Bachelor of Computing degree (Honours).

Mr. Derek Kyle, aged 73, is a director of Taung Gold. He worked as a mine geologist and field exploration geologist and co-founded a consulting firm in mining, mineral exploration, engineering geology, remote sensing and mining feasibility studies during the period from 1959 to 1975. From 1975 to 1995, he worked for Anglovaal Limited, first serving as a chief consulting geologist and later as a general manager, responsible for group mining geology, mineral exploration and new business. He was a director of Avmin Limited from 1995 to 1997 and was responsible for mineral exploration and new business matters. In 1997, he founded the Mineral Corporation as advisers to the minerals industry for mineral acquisition, geological exploration, engineering geology and was the managing director and chairman. He has been an independent mineral advisor since 2005 advising on all aspects of exploration, ore resources evaluation, mining feasibility studies and project technical risk analysis. He is a fellow of the Geological Society of South Africa, a member of the Society of Economic Geologists, and a member of the American Society of Engineering Geologists. Mr. Kyle graduated from Kearsney College with a Bachelor of Science in 1957 and received his Master of Science degree from Rhodes University in 1972.

5.2 Alternate Directors

Mr. Kweku Andoh Awotwi, aged 50, is an alternate director of Taung Gold. He has been a principal of Gold Coast Ventures since 2004 and is currently a director of African Precious Minerals Limited, a company holding mineral properties in Africa. He acted as the Chairman of African Precious Minerals Limited from 2007 to 2010. He was a director at Ashanti Goldfields focusing on strategic planning from 1998 to 2004. Mr. Awotwi held various board memberships including Takoradi Power Company Ltd, Ghana Chamber of Mines, West African Gas Pipeline Company and the UN Global Compact Advisory Board. He graduated from Yale University with a Bachelor of Science degree in 1984 and received his MBA degree from Stanford Graduate School of Business in 1990.

Ms. Sonja Hester Rosser, aged 41, is an alternate director of Taung Gold. In 2001, she was employed as executive assistant to a senior director at Couzyn Herzon & Horak Attorneys. Since 2004, she has been working at Taung Gold Limited responsible for client relations and managing the preparation and lodgement of all documents pertaining to applications for prospecting rights at the Department of Mineral

– 116 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Resources of South Africa. She completed an executive secretarial course from Technicon Pretoria in 1989. In 1992, she joined the collections department at Koos Grey Attorneys and two years later she joined Whiteside’s Attorneys.

5.3 Senior management

Mr. Jacques Du Plessis, aged 54, is a senior mining engineer of Taung Gold. He was mine manager in various mining companies, such as Samancor Manganese MinesHotazel, St. Helena Gold Mines and Oryx Mine. In 2001, he was employed by Murray & Roberts RUC Mining Contractors as a managing director of the mining division. In 2003, he worked as a mining consultant to closed and ailing mines in the Barberton Mountain Land to improve their operations. He was a member of Engineering Council of South Africa, a member of Association of Mine Managers of South Africa and a member of the Commission of Examiners for Mine Manager’s Certificate. Mr. Du Plessis graduated from the University of Pretoria with a Bachelor of Science (Engineering) degree in 1981 and received an MBA degree from Potchefstroom University in 1995.

Mr. Gert Adriaan Du Plessis, aged 51, is the Chief Operating Officer (Technical) of Taung Gold. He started his career as a mine geologist at Anglo American Corporation in 1981. He spent 16 years with Anglo American Corporation until he joined African Rainbow Minerals in 1998 as the company chief geologist and a member of the Business Engineering Unit conducting feasibility studies on potential business. From 2002 to August 2003, Mr. Du Plessis worked at Modikwa Platinum Mine and was responsible for geology, evaluation and ground water management, after which he became a managing director of ITEC Project Impact (Pty) Limited and consultant in providing services with respect to geotechnical engineering and project management until 2006. In August 2006, he joined Platinum Group Metals (Pty) Limited, a mine exploration company, as a project manager until October 2007. He graduated from the Potchefstroom University with a Bachelor of Science degree in 1982 and obtained a Graduate Diploma in Engineering at the Witwatersrand University in 2002.

Mr. Chris Hendrik Mulder, aged 53, is the company secretary of Taung Gold. He started his legal career as a public prosecutor in the regional court for the Department of Justice. In 1987, he joined Eskom, an electricity supply company, as a property lawyer. From 1994 to 1996, he was employed as a mining rights lawyer at Gencor Limited, a mining holding company. He was appointed as a corporate legal adviser of Kelgran Group of Companies, a company engaged in granite mining listed on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange, in 1996 responsible for compliance with the rules and regulations of the Johannesburg Stock Exchange. He graduated from the University of Pretoria with a Bachelor of Law degree in 1982 and was admitted as attorney of the high court of South Africa in 1985.

Mr. Arthur Hanbury Godfrey Griffin, aged 51, is the project manager and senior geologist of Taung Gold. He had been a mine geologist in a number of mining companies since his graduation and has worked on gold, platinum and chrome mines.

– 117 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

In 1992, he joined Consolidated Modderfontein Mines as a senior mine geologist. From 1994 to 2007, he was employed by Pretoria Portland Cement Company as an exploration geologist. He was an exploration manager of Caledonia Mining Corporation before joining Taung Gold. He graduated from the University of Natal with a Bachelor of Science degree in 1981 and received a Bachelor of Science degree (Honours) at the University of Natal in 1982.

Mr. Herbert Robertson, aged 46, is the Safety, Health, Environment and Quality manager of Taung Gold. From 2005 to 2007, he was a field manager at Boynton Platinum. Since 2007, he has been a senior safety coordinator of Sephaku Management and Taung Gold responsible for management review, communication and awareness, auditing and logistics. He holds a Postgraduate Degree in Safety from the University of Southern Queensland.

Mr. Peter Warring, aged 50, is the Chief Operating Officer (Legal) of Taung Gold. In 1990 he joined British American Tobacco as head of their legal department and as assistant public affairs manager, before joining a division of Anglovaal Industries as head of their legal department in 1995. From 2001 Mr. Warring was Commercial Manager for Anglo American’s Base Metal Division (Africa), charged with negotiating joint venture and other agreements whilst travelling extensively across the continent. He joined Taung Gold as Chief Operating Officer (Legal) in May 2007. He holds a Bachelor of Arts degree in Economic History & Legal Theory (BA) and Bachelor of Law degree (LLB) from Rhodes University and a higher diploma in labour from Rand Afrikaans University.

Mr. James Donald Edwin Wilson, aged 48, is a project manager and senior geologist of Taung Gold since June 2008. He is responsible for steering the Jeanette project through scoping study towards feasibility study evaluation. He worked at a number of mining companies as a geologist from 1985 to 2004, including Anglovaal Limited. From 2004 to 2008, he was employed by Boynton Platinum Limited, part of the Platmin Group, as a senior project geologist and a project manager responsible for managing the exploration work and conducting a pre-feasibility study programme on a platinum project. He is a registered member with the South African Council for Natural Scientists, a member of the Geological Society of South Africa and a fellow of the Geological Society of London. He graduated from Trinity College Dublin with a Bachelor of Arts in Natural Sciences in 1985 and received his MBA degree from Durham University Business School in 1992.

– 118 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART D — FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND MANAGEMENT DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF THE TAUNG GROUP

1. OVERVIEW

Set out below is the management’s discussion and analysis of the Taung Group for the three years ended 28 February 2011. This section should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the related notes of the Taung Group included in Appendix II to this Circular. All the companies in the Taung Group are registered in South Africa. The assets of the Taung Group are held through its subsidiaries.

1.1 Significant factors affecting the results and operations of the Taung Group

Since the incorporation of Taung Gold and each of its subsidiaries, the Taung Group has been engaged in the acquisition, exploration and development of gold and associated minerals located in South Africa. The mineral assets have been consolidated into a focused entity with the strategy of developing two flagship projects — the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project, whilst conducting further exploration on greenfields exploration assets. Scoping studies have been completed on both of the flagship projects which returned positive results. At present a Pre-Feasibility Study is being conducted over the Evander Project, and the Jeanette Project has advanced to the ‘‘resource upgrade stage’’ through drilling. Consequently the Taung Group has not generated any revenue during the three years ended 28 February 2011 save for interest received on excess funds. The historical operating results are therefore not indicative of its future operating results after it commences commercial production and sale of gold and related minerals.

The financial position of the Taung Group and its operating results reflect the costs associated with the acquisition of prospecting and mining rights, various studies, staff costs and other cost normally incurred by exploration companies. All qualifying expenditure, including administration and other overhead costs directly associated with the specific project, are capitalised. Once technical and commercial feasibility of the project has been established, the relevant exploration assets will be transferred to development costs. To the extent that the Taung Group continues to engage in exploration and development activities, results of its operations will continue to be affected by these and other costs associated with exploration and pre-production stages of development. It is estimated that the Taung Group will spend a further ZAR342.2 million for the period May 2011 up to February 2012 (including the settlement of the purchase price of the Evander Project) and ZAR131.9 million in the ensuing financial year on the further development of both flagship projects, when it is anticipated that the Bankable Feasibility Studies on both projects will be completed. Immediately after Electrum Completion it is anticipated that the Taung Group will have cash resources of ZAR687.8 million which will be sufficient to fund the operations of the Taung Group until February 2013.

– 119 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

1.2 Critical accounting policies

In preparing the Taung Group financial statements, management is required to select appropriate accounting policies and to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts represented in the Taung Group financial statements and related disclosures. Critical accounting policies are those considered by management to require significant judgement and estimates and/or these where a diverse range of accounting treatment is permitted by IFRS. The critical accounting policies and estimates adopted by the Taung Group are described below. For more information regarding the Taung Group’s critical accounting estimates and judgements, see ‘‘Appendix II — Financial Information of the Taung Group — note 1.2’’ of this Circular.

Impairment testing

The Taung Group reviews and tests the carrying value of assets when events or changes in circumstances suggest that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which identifiable cash flows are largely independent of cash flows of other assets and liabilities. If there are indications that impairment may have occurred, estimates are prepared of expected future cash flows for each group of assets. Expected future cash flows used to determine the value in use of goodwill and tangible assets are inherently uncertain and could materially change over time.

Taxation

Judgement is required in determining the provision for income taxes due to the complexity of legislation. There are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Taung Group recognises liabilities for anticipated tax audit issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made.

The Taung Group recognises the net future tax benefit related to deferred income tax assets to the extent that it is probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future. Assessing the recoverability of deferred income tax assets requires the Taung Group to make significant estimates related to expectations of future taxable income. Estimates of future taxable income are based on forecast cash flows from operations and the application of existing tax laws in each jurisdiction. To the extent that future cash flows and taxable income differ significantly from estimates, the ability of the Taung Group to realise the net deferred tax assets recorded at the end of the reporting period could be impacted. Due to the nature of the potential cash generating units, there is not enough evidence to prove that it will be probable that taxable profits will be generated against which the deductible temporary differences

– 120 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

can be utilised. Due to the fact that it is not probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future, no provision for a deferred tax asset was made by any of the Companies within the Group.

Exploration expenses capitalised

Exploration and evaluation expenses are those expenses incurred in connection with acquisition of rights to explore, investigate, examine and evaluate an area of mineralization including related overhead costs. The directors of Taung Gold exercise judgment to determine if the costs associated with a specific project must be capitalised against the specific project or written off.

Exploration assets are reviewed at reporting date and where the directors of Taung Gold consider there to be indicators of impairment, impairment tests will be performed on the capitalised costs and any impairments will be recognised through the income statement.

Intangible assets

Intangible assets are initially recognised at cost and are subsequently carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and any impairment losses. All costs, including administration and other general overhead costs directly associated with the specific project are capitalised. The directors of Taung Gold evaluate each project at each period end to determine if the carrying value should be impaired. To determine whether expenditure meet the criteria to be capitalised, the directors of Taung Gold use information from several sources, depending on the level of exploration. Purchased exploration and evaluation assets are recognised at cost of acquisition or at the fair value if purchased as part of a business combination. Exploration assets are not amortised as they will only be available for use once transferred to the development cost of the project. This will occur once technical and commercial feasibility of the project has been established. No further exploration cost will be capitalised. The cost transferred to development cost will be amortised over the life of the project based on the expected flow of economic resources associated with the project.

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash on hand and demand deposits, and other short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to a known amount of cash and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value. These are initially and subsequently recorded at fair value.

Share based payments

Goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment transaction are recognised when the goods are received or as the services are rendered. A corresponding increase in equity is recognised if the goods or services were received in an equity-settled share-based payment transaction or a liability if the goods or services were acquired in a cash-settled share-based payment transaction.

– 121 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

When the goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment transaction do not qualify for recognition as assets, they are recognised as expenses.

For equity-settled share-based payment transactions the goods or services received and the corresponding increase in equity are measured, directly, at the fair value of the goods or services received provided that the fair value can be estimated reliably.

If the fair value of the goods or services received cannot be estimated reliably, their value and the corresponding increase in equity, indirectly, are measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments granted.

For cash-settled share-based payment transactions, the goods or services acquired and the liability incurred are measured at the fair value of the liability. Until the liability is settled, the fair value of the liability is re-measured at each reporting date and at the date of settlement, with any changes in fair value recognised in profit or loss for the period.

If the share-based payments granted do not vest until the counterparty completes a specified period of service, the Taung Group accounts for those services as they are rendered by the counterparty during the vesting period, (or on a straight line basis over the vesting period).

If the share-based payments vest immediately the services received are recognised in full.

For share-based payment transactions in which the terms of the arrangement provide either the entity or the counterparty with the choice of whether the entity settles the transaction in cash (or other assets) or by issuing equity instruments, the components of that transaction are recorded, as a cash-settled share-based payment transaction if, and to the extent that, a liability to settle in cash or other assets has been incurred, or as an equity-settled share-based payment transaction if, and to the extent that, no such liability has been incurred.

2. DESCRIPTION OF SELECTED LINE ITEMS FROM THE TAUNG GROUP’S CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME.

Other income

Other income mainly consists of profits realised on foreign currency received from investors subscribing for ordinary shares.

Interest received

Surplus funds are invested in various term investments with banks and interest is earned from this.

– 122 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Employees, remuneration and share incentive scheme

Taung Gold presently has 38 employees. For the two financial years ended 28 February 2010, Taung Gold had 16 and 22 employees respectively. A remuneration committee, comprising two directors of Taung Gold, ensures that employees and executive directors are fairly rewarded for their individual contributions and Taung Gold’s overall performance. Remuneration packages are structured to be competitive against remuneration paid in the market so as to attract and retain the services of suitably qualified employees and to keep the employees motivated and incentivised. Taung Gold is not contractually bound to pay any bonuses and the granting of bonuses is entirely at the discretion of the remuneration committee.

Taung Gold operates a share incentive scheme. The policy allocates 10% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold to employees. Employees have been awarded options to subscribe for shares in Taung Gold within a period of up to 5 years at the market value of the shares at the date the options are awarded less between 1% and 5%. The remuneration committee allocates the options to employees based on their individual contributions. Details of all outstanding options in Taung Gold are set in ‘‘Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 1.11 Outstanding Warrants and Options in Taung Gold’’. This share incentive scheme will lapse when all the outstanding options issued to the TG Optionsholders are exercised.

Training needs are identified by management and training is done as and when deemed necessary. Employees are also encouraged to assess their own needs for training and Taung Gold will accommodate any such needs as necessary.

Employee costs and employee costs capitalised and recouped

All costs relating to staff remuneration is allocated on a time basis to either overheads or, where the cost relates directly to a specific project, to that project. Where time is allocated to other entities, these costs are reallocated to these entities on a cost basis.

Pre-granting costs written off

Costs are only capitalised to projects once legal rights to explore has been acquired. Costs incurred before legal rights have been secured which relate to exploration assets, are expensed through the statement of comprehensive income.

Share based payments — Options to staff

The fair value of options granted to employees is determined by using the Cox Cross Rubinstein bi-nominal tree model. Costs are allocated to either projects or overheads based on the time allocated to the various cost centres over the preceding twelve month period.

– 123 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Administration and other costs

Administration and other costs consist mainly of consulting fees not directly attributable to projects, depreciation and other various administration costs.

Taxation

No provision has been made for taxation as a result of the losses incurred to date. Due to the exploration and future developed activities of the Taung Group, it is not probable that the Taung Group will be in a profitable position in the foreseeable future. Therefore, the deferred asset recognised is limited to the amount of the deferred liability recognised.

Results of operations

The table below sets forth data from the consolidated statement of comprehensive income:

Revenue
Other income
Net interest received
Employee costs
Pre-granting costs and impairment of
exploration assets
Share-based payments — options to staff
Administration and other costs
Loss before taxation
Taxation
Loss after tax
Year ended 28 February
2011
2010
2009
ZAR’000
ZAR’000
ZAR’000



1,172
89
57
5,571
1,843
136
(9,480)
(4,099)
(1,952)
(5,569)
(1,485)
(1,146)
(64,146)


(8,924)
(4,417)
(4,381)
(81,376)
(8,069)
(7,286)



(81,376)
(8,069)
(7,286)

Years ended 28 February 2009, 2010 and 2011

Other income

The profit on the conversion of foreign exchange increased substantially in 2011. This is due to the fact that the profit was realised on the receipt of foreign currency on the subscription for shares in Taung Gold.

Net interest received

The increased interest received in 2010 and 2011 relates mainly to the increase in cash balances during these years.

– 124 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Employee costs

The gross cost of salaries before any of these costs were capitalised to exploration assets amounted to ZAR18.57 million, ZAR10.35 million and ZAR6.51 million in for 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively. The costs capitalised to exploration assets or recouped from other companies over the corresponding period amounted to ZAR9.09 million, ZAR6.25 million and ZAR4.56 million respectively. This is mainly due to the increased activities in Taung Gold and the concomitant increase in the number of employees.

Pre-granting costs and impairment of exploration assets

The increase in the pre-granting costs to ZAR5.57 million in 2011 from ZAR1.49 million and ZAR1.15 million in 2010 and 2009 respectively reflects the increased activities and applications for exploration rights.

Share-based payments

Options were only granted to staff during the 2011 financial year. All options vest immediately and are accounted for in full at granting. The total value of the options as determined using the Cox Cross Rubinstein bi-nominal tree model amounts to ZAR93.23 million. An amount of ZAR29.08 million was capitalised to the various projects based on the time allocated directly to these projects over the preceding twelve month period. In determining the fair value of the options the expected volatility was estimated to be between 74.77% and 77.82%. It was assumed that no dividends will be paid over the life of the options and the share price was between ZAR5.00 and ZAR10.00 on date of granting of the options. It was further assumed that nonmanagerial staff would exercise their options within one year from granting and that managerial staff would exercise their options over a three year period.

Administration and other costs

The increase in the administration fee was due to the following major items:

  • (a) Consulting fees amounted to ZAR0.02 million in 2009. In 2010 the consulting charges amounted to ZAR0.78 million and in 2011 this increased to ZAR3.18 million; and

  • (b) Travel and accommodation costs increased from ZAR0.06 million in 2009 to ZAR0.52 million in 2010 and ZAR1.63 million in 2011.

  • (c) In 2009 the costs associated with the initial capital raising amounted to ZAR2.04 million.

– 125 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3. DESCRIPTION OF SELECTED ITEMS FROM THE TAUNG GROUP’S CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

Intangible assets

The carrying amount of the intangible assets, which mainly consists of the exploration assets, increased from ZAR36.95 million on 28 February 2009 to ZAR193.46 million at 28 February 2011. This reflects the acquisition price paid for the Jeanette project of ZAR75.00 million as well as the continuing exploration activities undertaken during the period.

Liquidity and capital resources

Historically the Taung Group has financed its capital expenditure and working capital requirements through capital contributions from shareholders. As at 28 February 2011 the net current assets increased to ZAR260.68 million from a net current liability position of ZAR17.01 million in 2009. The Taung Group has not loaned any funds from any banking or similar institutions.

The Taung Group intends to finance its future capital expenditure and meet its working capital requirements through its cash at bank as well as from the proceeds of the exercise of warrants before First Completion and Electrum Completion which is expected to increase the cash at bank by ZAR415.50 million. In addition, it is anticipated that a further ZAR28.08 million will be received on the exercise of existing warrants which will be exercised before First Completion but for which payment will only be received 9 months after First Completion.

The following table sets forth the current assets and current liabilities of the Taung Group at the dates as indicated:

Current assets
Trade and other receivables
Short-term deposits
Cash and cash equivalents
Total current assets
Current liabilities
Loans from shareholders
Trade and other payables
Total current liabilities
Net current assets/(liabilities)
As
2011
ZAR’000
2,024
2,469
270,228
274,721
5,315
8,730
14,045
260,676
at 28 February
2010
2009
ZAR’000
ZAR’000
4,807
2,029
26,819

1,744
2,381
33,370
4,410
5,270
8,655
10,119
12,766
15,389
21,421
17,981
(17,011)

– 126 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Cashflows

Selected cash flow statement data
Net cash used in operating activities
Net cash used in investing activities
Net cash flows from financing
activities
Net cash movement for the year
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of
the year
As
2011
ZAR’000
(18,685)
(82,026)
369,195
268,484
270,228
at 28 February
2010
2009
ZAR’000
ZAR’000
(7,397)
(4,003)
(39,339)
(27,699)
46,099
29,572
(637)
(2,130)
1,744
2,381

Operating Costs

Net cash used in operating activities for the year ended 28 February 2011 was ZAR18.69 million and cash outflow before working capital changes was ZAR22.03 million. The net decrease of ZAR2.25 million in working capital reflects a decrease in trade and other payables of ZAR1.38 million and an increase in other receivables of ZAR0.87 million.

Net cash used in operating activities for the year ended 28 February 2010 was ZAR7.40 million and cash outflow before working capital changes was ZAR8.35 million. The net decrease of ZAR0.82 million reflects a decrease of ZAR1.96 million in trade and other payables and an increase of ZAR2.77 million in other receivables.

Net cash used in operating activities for the year ended 28 February 2009 was ZAR4.00 million and cash outflow before working capital changes was ZAR6.27 million. Working capital was increased by the reduction of other receivables of ZAR0.65 million and the increase in trade and other payables of ZAR1.71 million.

Investing activities

Cash utilised in investing activities amounted to ZAR82.03 million in 2011, ZAR39.34 million in 2010 and ZAR27.70 million in 2009. The outflow of funds related mainly to:

  • (a) acquisition of fixed assets of ZAR1.98 million in 2011 and ZAR0.69 million in 2010; and

  • (b) cost capitalised to mainly exploration assets of: ZAR84.39 million in 2011, ZAR11.84 million in 2010 and ZAR22.70 million in 2009; and

  • (c) deposits paid for the acquisition of the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project in 2011 of ZAR20.00 million and ZAR5.00 million in 2009; and

– 127 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (d) the short-term deposits were reduced by ZAR24.35 million in 2011 and increased by ZAR26.82 million in 2010.

Financing activities

The funds generated from financing activities are mainly made up of the following:

  • (a) proceeds from share issued ZAR369.15 million in 2011, ZAR54.09 million in 2010 and ZAR22.82 million in 2009; and

  • (b) proceeds/(repayments) of shareholder loans and advances of ZAR0.05 million in 2011, ZAR(7.99 million) in 2010 and ZAR6.75 million in 2009.

Taung Gold has not raised any debt financing from third party lenders and accordingly, it does not have a gearing ratio.

Contingencies and guarantees

As of 28 February 2011 the Taung Group had no bank overdrafts or other forms of financing from any financial institutions. Guarantees totalling ZAR1.26 million were provided to the DMR, for the provision of possible rehabilitation or management of negative environment impacts, and a further amount of ZAR1.34 million was deposited in cash for the same purpose. As far as the Taung Group is aware, no possible liabilities exist in relation to any exploration undertaken.

Pursuant to the Sale Agreement, subject to the approval of the MMR, Taung Gold is obliged to pay a total acquisition price of ZAR225 million (or equivalent to HK$219.38 million). A deposit of ZAR20 million (or equivalent to HK$19.5 million) was paid to EGM Limited prior to 28 February 2011. So far as the Directors are aware, other than as mentioned, Taung Gold has no other contingent liabilities. There were no further contingent liabilities for the three financial years ended 28 February 2011.

Charge on assets

For the previous three years, and at present, all fixed assets have been the exclusive property of the Taung Group and there have not been, nor are there at present any encumbrances, liens or other charges against the property.

– 128 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Capital expenditure

As at 28 February 2011, capital expenditure of the Taung Group totalled ZAR195.83 million. Set out below is a breakdown of the aggregate capital expenditure for the Taung Group:

At carrying value
Tangible assets

Computer equipment

Computer software

Field equipment

Furniture and fixtures

Motor vehicles

Office equipment

Plant and machinery
Intangible assets

Computer software

Exploration assets
Total assets
Market risks
28 February 2011
ZAR’000
2,374
292
12
25
119
533
19
1,374
193,456
398
193,058
195,830

Taung Gold is exposed to various types of market risks, including capital risk management, liquidity risk and interest rate risk in the normal course of business.

Capital risk management

The objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Taung Group’s ability to continue as a going concern in order to provide returns for shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders. The further exploration and development of the exploration assets will require additional capital. The continuing development of the mineral resources and reserves will depend on the ability of directors to raise additional funds. The Taung Group also strives to achieve an optional weighted average cost of capital while continuing to safeguard the Taung Group’s ability to meet its liquidity requirements. There are no externally imposed capital requirements.

Liquidity risk

The Taung Group’s risk to liquidity is a result of the funds available to cover future commitments. The Taung Group manages liquidity risk through an ongoing review of future commitments and credit facilities.

Cash flow forecast are prepared and adequate utilised borrowing facilities are monitored.

– 129 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Interest rate risk

The Taung Group has limited exposure to interest rate risk as the Taung Group has no interest bearing liabilities. Cash funds are deposited with reputable financial institutions until such time as the funds are required. No other assets or liabilities are exposed to any interest rate risks.

The company is sensitive to movement in the South African interest rates which are the primary interest rate to which the company is exposed. The funds deposited with financial institutions are the only asset or liability exposed to the interest rate risk and the interest earned is linked to the prime rate of lending.

Subsequent events after 28 February 2011

No material events have occurred between 28 February 2011 and the date of this Circular.

– 130 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART E — INFORMATION ON MANDRA, ARCTIC AND SEPGOLD

1. BACKGROUND

Under the Broad-Based Socio-Economic Empowerment Charter for the South African Mining Industry pursuant to the provisions of Section 100(2) of the MPRDA, Taung Gold is a company primarily engaged in the exploration and/or mining activities of mineral resources in South Africa and it must by 2014 have at least 26.0% of its shareholding beneficially owned either directly by historically disadvantaged South Africans or by a Qualified BEE Company. As at the Latest Practicable Date, SepGold holds approximately 16% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold and it is 100% owned by Arctic. Arctic is a Qualified BEE Company with more than 50% of its shares being controlled by historically disadvantaged South Africans. 49.90% of Arctic’s shares are being transferred to Mandra (through its 100% interest in Arctic Holdco). Upon First Completion, Mandra’s interest in Arctic will be acquired by Wing Hing. The shareholding structure of Mandra, Arctic and SepGold immediately before First Completion and immediately after First Completion is set out below.

  • 1.1 Shareholding Structure of Mandra, Arctic and SepGold immediately before First Completion

==> picture [281 x 275] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

BEE SHAREHOLDERS MANDRA
50.10% 100%
49.90%
ARCTIC ARCTIC HOLDCO
100%
SEPGOLD
28.62%
TAUNG GOLD
----- End of picture text -----

– 131 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • 1.2 Shareholding Structure of Mandra, Arctic and SepGold immediately after First Completion

==> picture [281 x 366] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

MANDRA
(as 100% owner of
ARCTIC HOLDCO)
13.62%
BEE SHAREHOLDERS WING HING
50.10% 100%
49.90%
ARCTIC ARCTIC HOLDCO
100%
SEPGOLD
28.62%
TAUNG GOLD
----- End of picture text -----

2. INVESTMENT IN ARCTIC BY MANDRA

Mandra is principally an investment holding company ultimately beneficially owned as to 50% by Mr. Zhang Songyi and as to 50% by Ms. Mui Bing How, the wife of Mr. Zhang Songyi. Mandra holds 100% of Arctic Holdco’s equity interest which will be the legal and beneficial owner of 49.90% of the issued share capital of Arctic immediately prior to First Completion.

In December 2009 (and later as amended in February 2010), Mandra Capital, an affiliate of Mandra and Mr. MS Wu, a historically disadvantaged South African, entered into an agreement with SepGold’s then owner, Sephaku Holdings Limited, to acquire the entire issued share capital of SepGold using Arctic as the acquiring vehicle. As at the Latest Practicable Date, Arctic is 100% owned by Mr. MS Wu. Before First Completion, Arctic will be held by Mandra as to 49.90% and by BEE Shareholders as to 50.10%. Mr. MS Wu is

– 132 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

in the process of transferring shares in Arctic to other BEE Shareholders, and on or before First Completion, the BEE Shareholders in Arctic will consist of Mr. MS Wu as to 40.1%, Mr. Vika Khumlo as to 5% and Mr. Lelau Mohuba as to 5%.

As at the Latest Practicable Date, Arctic has an aggregate interest of approximately 16% in the issued and outstanding capital of Taung Gold held through SepGold. As a result of the vendor financing arrangements to ensure SepGold holds no less than 26.0% of the issued shares in Taung Gold (further details are set out in the following section below headed ‘‘3. Vendor Financing and Top-Up Arrangements’’), Arctic (through SepGold) will be interested in approximately 28.62% of Taung Gold immediately before and after First Completion. Immediately after the Electrum Completion, Arctic’s indirect interest in the issued and outstanding capital of Taung Gold will reduce to 26.02% held through SepGold.

3. VENDOR FINANCING AND TOP-UP ARRANGEMENTS

As mentioned above, SepGold must hold no less than 26.0% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold at all times for so long as this is required by South African laws (the BEE Requirement). On 22 July 2011, Taung Gold and SepGold entered into a vendor financing agreement for the purpose of complying with the BEE Requirement pursuant to which Taung Gold will, subject to conditions, grant a loan to SepGold to enable SepGold to (i) exercise its warrants held in Taung Gold and thereby subscribe for the corresponding number of TG Shares; and (ii) to subscribe for such number of additional TG Shares (TopUp Shares) as are necessary to bring SepGold’s shareholding in Taung Gold to at least 26.0% by First Completion (the Loan). The Loan will be interest free and will be repayable on or before 31 December 2014. However, if the Loan is not repaid in full by this date, it shall accrue interest at the prime rate quoted by ABSA Bank from time to time plus 4% compounded annually in arrears. 50% of any dividends declared by Taung Gold in any financial year shall be applied in repayment of the Loan. The TG Shares acquired by SepGold pursuant to the Loan shall be pledged to Taung Gold as security for repayment of the Loan.

For so long as the BEE Requirement is in place, and upon the exercise by the TG Optionholders of their options to acquire TG Shares, Taung Gold will make further loans to SepGold on substantially the same terms as the Loan, to enable SepGold to subscribe for the necessary number of TG Shares so as to prevent dilution of SepGold’s shareholding in Taung Gold and thereby maintain such shareholding at a minimum of 26.0%.

4. ASSETS OF ARCTIC

Other than its indirect interest in Taung Gold through SepGold, Arctic does not have any other assets or liabilities. Since Arctic is an investment holding company and was only incorporated on 19 March 2009, no financial information is available on Arctic.

– 133 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART F — INFORMATION ON THE WING HING GROUP AND THE ENLARGED GROUP

1. INFORMATION ON THE WING HING GROUP

The Wing Hing Group is an investment holding company and its subsidiaries are principally engaged in operating coal and gold mines in the PRC and the sale of minerals. Wing Hing is a company incorporated in Bermuda and the Wing Hing Shares are listed on the Main Board of the Exchange.

2. BUSINESS MODEL AND STRATEGIC PLANS OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

2.1 The Enlarged Group’s PRC operations

Wing Hing currently engages in the gold mining business through its operations in the Long Men Sou Mine, located in Hebei province in the PRC. Production at the Long Men Sou Mine has commenced and this mine produces a maximum of approximately 5 kilograms of gold concentrates per month. Revenue from Wing Hing’s gold mine for the year ended 31 March 2011 amounted to HK$4.9 million and was derived from the sale of gold products to customers in the PRC. For the reasons stated in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part A: Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration — 4. Reasons for and Benefits of the Acquisition’’, the Board remains optimistic about Wing Hing’s gold mining business. Following completion of the Acquisition, the Enlarged Group will continue its operations of the Long Men Sou Mine at their existing levels. Although there are currently no concrete plans to further expand the operations at the Long Men Sou Mine, the Board believes that the geographical area in which the Long Men Sou Mine is located has good geological potential. As such, following completion of the Acquisition, the Enlarged Group will consider further strategies to explore the areas around the Long Men Sou Mine.

Wing Hing also engages in the coal mining business through its operations in the Xinghe Coal Mine and the Dayan Coal Mine. The Board has been aware of the limitations in Wing Hing’s coal mining business for some time. In particular, due to the occurrence in succession of several coal mine accidents in the PRC, the Department of Energy of China has pointed out that it will initiate the formulation of coal regulations and policies, including some directions, among others, strengthening the management of coal resources, the improvement of coal planning and the protection of rights and interests of the miners and accordingly, the Board came to the view that the costs in the construction of coal mines and the production of coal will increase in order to comply with these new regulations and policies. As such, the Wing Hing Group is cautious about its coal mining business, particularly since its coal mining business has not generated satisfactory income, and has undertaken in the Acquisition Agreement to dispose of the Dayan Licence and the Xinghe Licence after completion of the Acquisition.

– 134 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

2.2 The Enlarged Group’s South African operations

As a result of Wing Hing’s optimism on global gold prices, the Board searched for more opportunities in the gold mining business and also sought to expand its gold mining business outside of the PRC through its acquisition of Taung Gold. The Evander Project has proceeded to Pre-Feasibility stage and the Jeanette Project is at ‘‘resource upgrading stage’’ and upon their completion, will progress to Bankable Feasibility Studies. It is anticipated that the Bankable Feasibility Studies for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project will be completed before the end of February 2013, in preparation for investment decisions during the second quarter of 2013. The path to production for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project (including indicative costs and expected date to commence commercial production) are clearly stated in the section of this Circular headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 3. Nature and Quality of the Taung Group’s assets and businesses — 3.4 The Evander Project/3.5 The Jeanette Project’’.

2.3 Capital expenditures, funding requirements and future financing plans

Anticipated exploration expenditure of US$0.5 million will be incurred in the PRC over the next two years and will be covered by existing cash resources, income from operations and receivables. Save as disclosed, the Wing Hing Group does not expect any need for substantial capital expenditures for the next 12 months in respect of the Long Men Sou Mine given that there is no significant expansion planned for this mine.

For the Enlarged Group’s South African operations, it is expected that the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project will require approximately US$71.8 million to the end of February 2013. The Taung Group’s Greenfield Projects will also be progressed in the next two years in accordance with their respective prospecting and mining permits. Capital expenditure of US$6.1 million is expected for the Greenfield Projects of the Taung Group for the period ended 28 February 2013. The total expected expenditure for Taung Group for the period ended 28 February 2013 is expected to be about US$84.0 million. Taung Gold will, by Electrum Completion, have up to US$86.0 million in cash which will cover the expected capital expenditure of the Taung Group for the next two years.

Accordingly, the Board believes that the Enlarged Group will not have immediate pressure to raise funds to support the operation of the Enlarged Group in the short term after completion of the Transactions. In the long run, the Directors will from time to time assess the financial position of Wing Hing and, if appropriate, consider the feasibility of fund raising methods, including but not limited to debt financing and equity financing, to support future capital expenditures and operating costs of the Enlarged Group.

The peak funding requirement for the Evander Project and the Jeanette Project is approximately US$315 million (equivalent to approximately HK$2,457.01 million) and approximately US$603 million (equivalent to approximately HK$4,703.40 million)

– 135 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

respectively in 2018 and 2016. It is currently expected that actual gold production will begin at the Evander Project in the third quarter of 2014 or early 2015 and in 2016 for the Jeanette Project.

As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Wing Hing Group has no concrete plans to further raise capital (whether by equity or by debt). However, in anticipation of the additional funding requirement after commencement of gold production, following completion of the Acquisition, the Enlarged Group will consider its future funding needs and possible capital raising option to meet the funding requirements of the two projects.

3. SHAREHOLDING STRUCTURE OF WING HING BEFORE AND AFTER COMPLETION OF THE TRANSACTIONS

  • A. Before and After First Completion. The following table sets out the shareholding structure of Wing Hing

  • (i) as at the date of this Circular and before First Completion;

  • (ii) immediately after First Completion and the allotment and issue of the TG Consideration Shares, Other Consideration Shares, Arctic Consideration Shares and the GoldCom Consideration Shares (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised); and

– 136 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  • (iii) immediately after First Completion and the allotment and issue of the TG Consideration Shares, Other Consideration Shares, Arctic Consideration Shares and GoldCom Consideration Shares (assuming the WH Warrants are exercised in full):
WH Shareholders
(A)
TG Sellers (excluding members under
item (B))
Electrum
Mandra, Mandra Esop Limited and
Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace (Note 2)
Woo Foong Hong Limited (Note 3)
Yi Star Investment Limited (Note 3)
Mr. Lin Hsin Ho (Note 3)
Montane Development Limited (Note 3)
Mr. Hu Xiang Cheng (Note 3)
Able Union Limited (Note 3)
ZNE Capital Limited (Note 3)
Fully Global Investments Limited (Note 3)
Grit Capital Limited (Note 3)
Angelfly Investments Limited (Note 3)
Easy Capital Holdings Limited
Manford Capital (HK) Limited
Amplewood Resources Limited
Hong Kong Sheen Smile International
Investment Limited
Sino Reach Investments Limited
Sub-Total
As at the date of this Circular
and before First Completion
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s
issued
share
capital
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
0
0
Immediately after First
Completion and the allotment
and issue of the TG
Consideration Shares, Other
Consideration Shares, Arctic
Consideration Shares and
GoldCom Consideration
Shares (assuming no WH
Warrants are exercised)
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s
issued
share
capital
2,295,047,831
19.08%
2,041,422,493
16.97%
526,530,727
4.38%
227,095,837
1.89%
197,480,860
1.64%
188,000,017
1.56%
97,675,634
0.81%
747,224,875
6.21%
275,138,874
2.29%
584,436,599
4.86%
37,361,244
0.31%
37,361,244
0.31%
37,361,244
0.31%
22,416,746
0.19%
117,421,052
0.98%
138,770,334
1.16%
40,029,904
0.33%
7,610,775,515
63.28%
Immediately after First
Completion and the allotment
and issue of
the TG Consideration Shares,
Other Consideration Shares,
Arctic Consideration Shares
and GoldCom Consideration
Shares (assuming the WH
Warrants are exercised
in full)
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s
issued
share
capital
2,295,047,831
18.71%
2,041,422,493
16.65%
526,530,727
4.29%
227,095,837
1.85%
197,480,860
1.61%
188,000,017
1.53%
97,675,634
0.80%
747,224,875
6.09%
275,138,874
2.24%
584,436,599
4.77%
37,361,244
0.30%
37,361,244
0.30%
37,361,244
0.30%
22,416,746
0.18%
117,421,052
0.96%
138,770,334
1.13%
40,029,904
0.33%
7,610,775,515
62.04%
Immediately after First
Completion and the allotment
and issue of
the TG Consideration Shares,
Other Consideration Shares,
Arctic Consideration Shares
and GoldCom Consideration
Shares (assuming the WH
Warrants are exercised
in full)
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s
issued
share
capital
2,295,047,831
18.71%
2,041,422,493
16.65%
526,530,727
4.29%
227,095,837
1.85%
197,480,860
1.61%
188,000,017
1.53%
97,675,634
0.80%
747,224,875
6.09%
275,138,874
2.24%
584,436,599
4.77%
37,361,244
0.30%
37,361,244
0.30%
37,361,244
0.30%
22,416,746
0.18%
117,421,052
0.96%
138,770,334
1.13%
40,029,904
0.33%
7,610,775,515
62.04%
62.04%

– 137 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Immediately after First
Immediately after First Completion and the allotment
Completion and the allotment and issue of
and issue of the TG the TG Consideration Shares,
Consideration Shares, Other Other Consideration Shares,
Consideration Shares, Arctic Arctic Consideration Shares
Consideration Shares and and GoldCom Consideration
GoldCom Consideration Shares (assuming the WH
As at the date of this Circular Shares (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised
WH Shareholders and before First Completion Warrants are exercised) in full)
% of Wing % of Wing % of Wing
Hing’s Hing’s Hing’s
issued issued issued
No. of Wing share No. of Wing
share
No. of Wing
share
Hing Shares capital Hing Shares
capital
Hing Shares
capital

(B) TG Sellers and Other TG Shareholders who are parties acting in concert

African Precious Minerals Limited, Dr.
David Twist and Mrs. Helena Twist, Mr.
Kweku A. Awotwi, Mr. Michael J. Yates
and family and GoldCom (Note 1)
Mr. Claude de Bruin and Mr. Marcel de
Bruin (Note 3)
Geologic Resource Funds Limited and its LP
and Geologic Resource Opportunities
Fund Limited and its LP (Note 3)
Mr. James F. M. Johnson and Ms. Marina
L. Johnson (Note 3)
Mr. Qian Hai Ming and Mr. Qian Wei Qi
(Note 3)
Sub-Total
(C)
Other TG Shareholders (excluding
members under item (B))
(D)
Existing public WH Shareholders
(E)
TG Optionholders
TOTAL PUBLIC SHAREHOLDERS
(Note 4)
TOTAL NUMBER OF WING HING
SHARES
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
0
N/A
2,197,909,600
N/A
2,197,909,600
2,197,909,600
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
0
N/A
100.00%
N/A
100.00%
100.00%
1,521,798,821
39,856,975
130,354,607
1,067,517
69,385,167
1,762,463,087
456,867,486
2,197,909,600
N/A
7,426,826,275
12,028,015,688
12.65%
0.33%
1.08%
0.01%
0.58%
14.65%
3.80%
18.27%
N/A
61.75%
100.00%
1,521,798,821
39,856,975
130,354,607
1,067,517
69,385,167
1,762,463,087
456,867,486
2,434,257,600
N/A
7,663,174,275
12,264,363,688
12.41%
0.33%
1.06%
0.01%
0.57%
14.38%
3.73%
19.85%
N/A
62.48%
100.00%

Notes:

  1. Michael J. Yates, his family and GoldCom are not connected persons of Wing Hing and accordingly forms part of Wing Hing’s public float.

  2. Mandra will become a substantial shareholder of Wing Hing following the First Completion Date. Accordingly, Mandra, along with its associates, Mandra Esop Limited and Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace are connected persons of Wing Hing following the First Completion Date.

  3. As these shareholders are not connected persons of Wing Hing, they will be counted towards the public float.

– 138 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

  1. Excludes shareholding in Wing Hing by connected persons of Wing Hing (e.g. Directors, substantial shareholders (as defined in the Listing Rules) of Wing Hing and their associates (as defined by the Listing Rules)).

  2. B. Before and After Electrum Completion. The following table sets out the shareholding structure of Wing Hing:

  3. (i) immediately after Electrum Completion and the allotment and issue of the Electrum Consideration Shares (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised and no TG Optionholder exercises their options/warrants);

  4. (ii) immediately after Electrum Completion and the allotment and issue of the Electrum Consideration Shares (assuming the WH Warrants are exercised in full and no TG Optionholder exercises their options/warrants);

  5. (iii) immediately after the allotment and issue of the Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares (assuming no WH Warrants are exercised); and

  6. (iv) immediately after the allotment and issue of the Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares (assuming the WH Warrants are exercised in full):

Shareholders
(A)
TG Sellers (excluding members
under item (B))
Electrum
Mandra, Mandra Esop Limited and Ms.
Mui Bing Wah Grace
(Note 2)
Woo Foong Hong Limited (Note 3)
Yi Star Investment Limited (Note 3)
Mr. Lin Hsin Ho (Note 3)
Montane Development Limited (Note 3)
Mr. Hu Xiang Cheng (Note 3)
Able Union Limited (Note 3)
ZNE Capital Limited (Note 3)
Fully Global Investments Limited (Note 3)
Grit Capital Limited (Note 3)
Angelfly Investments Limited (Note 3)
Easy Capital Holdings Limited
Manford Capital (HK) Limited
Amplewood Resources Limited
Hong Kong Sheen Smile International
Investment Limited
Sino Reach Investments Limited
Sub-Total
Immediately af
Completion and th
issue of the
Consideration Shar
WH Warrants a
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
3,442,571,746
2,041,422,493
526,530,727
227,095,837
197,480,860
188,000,017
97,675,634
747,224,875
275,138,874
584,436,599
37,361,244
37,361,244
37,361,244
22,416,746
117,421,052
138,770,334
40,029,904
8,758,299,430
ter Electrum
e allotment and
Electrum
es (assuming no
re exercised)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
26.13%
15.49%
4.00%
1.72%
1.50%
1.43%
0.74%
5.67%
2.09%
4.44%
0.28%
0.28%
0.28%
0.17%
0.89%
1.06%
0.30%
66.47%
Immediately af
Completion and th
issue of the
Consideratio
(assuming the WH
exercised
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
3,442,571,746
2,041,422,493
526,530,727
227,095,837
197,480,860
188,000,017
97,675,634
747,224,875
275,138,874
584,436,599
37,361,244
37,361,244
37,361,244
22,416,746
117,421,052
138,770,334
40,029,904
8,758,299,430
ter Electrum
e allotment and
Electrum
n Shares
Warrants are
in full)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
25.67%
15.22%
3.93%
1.69%
1.47%
1.40%
0.73%
5.57%
2.05%
4.36%
0.28%
0.28%
0.28%
0.17%
0.87%
1.03%
0.30%
65.30%
Immediately after the allotment
and issue of the Total
Consideration Shares and TG
Optionholder Consideration Shares
(assuming no WH Warrants are
exercised)
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
3,442,571,746
24.27%
2,041,422,493
14.39%
526,530,727
3.71%
227,095,837
1.60%
197,480,860
1.39%
188,000,017
1.33%
97,675,634
0.69%
747,224,875
5.27%
275,138,874
1.94%
584,436,599
4.12%
37,361,244
0.26%
37,361,244
0.26%
37,361,244
0.26%
22,416,746
0.16%
117,421,052
0.83%
138,770,334
0.98%
40,029,904
0.28%
8,758,299,430
61.74%
Immediately afte
and issue of
Consideration S
Optionholder Cons
(assuming the WH
exercised
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
3,442,571,746
2,041,422,493
526,530,727
227,095,837
197,480,860
188,000,017
97,675,634
747,224,875
275,138,874
584,436,599
37,361,244
37,361,244
37,361,244
22,416,746
117,421,052
138,770,334
40,029,904
8,758,299,430
r the allotment
the Total
hares and TG
ideration Shares
Warrants are
in full)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
23.87%
14.16%
3.65%
1.58%
1.37%
1.30%
0.68%
5.18%
1.91%
4.05%
0.26%
0.26%
0.26%
0.15%
0.81%
0.96%
0.28%
60.73%

– 139 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Shareholders
(B)
TG Sellers and Other TG
Shareholders who are parties
acting in concert
African Precious Minerals Limited, Dr.
David Twist and Mrs. Helena Twist,
Mr. Kweku A. Awotwi, Mr. Michael J.
Yates and family and GoldCom
(Note 1)
Mr. Claude de Bruin and Mr. Marcel de
Bruin (Note 3)
Geologic Resource Funds Limited and its
LP and Geologic Resource
Opportunities Fund Limited and its LP
(Note 3)
Mr. James F. M. Johnson and Ms. Marina
L. Johnson (Note 3)
Mr. Qian Hai Ming and Mr. Qian Wei Qi
(Note 3)
Sub-Total
(C)
Other TG Shareholders (excluding
members under item (B))
(D)
Existing Public Shareholders
(E)
TG Optionholders
TOTAL PUBLIC SHAREHOLDERS
(Note 4)
Total number of Wing Hing Shares
Immediately af
Completion and t
issue of the
Consideration Sha
WH Warrants
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
1,521,798,821
39,856,975
130,354,607
1,067,517
69,385,167
1,762,463,087
456,867,486
2,197,909,600
N/A
7,426,826,275
13,175,539,603
ter Electrum
he allotment and
Electrum
res (assuming no
are exercised)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
11.55%
0.30%
0.99%
0.01%
0.53%
13.38%
3.47%
16.68%
N/A
56.37%
100.00%
Immediately af
Completion and th
issue of the
Considerati
(assuming the W
exercised
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
1,521,798,821
39,856,975
130,354,607
1,067,517
69,385,167
1,762,463,087
456,867,486
2,434,257,600
N/A
7,663,174,275
13,411,887,603
ter Electrum
e allotment and
Electrum
on Shares
H Warrants are
in full)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
11.35%
0.30%
0.97%
0.01%
0.52%
13.15%
3.40%
18.15%
N/A
57.14%
100.00%
Immediately after the allotment
and issue of the Total
Consideration Shares and TG
Optionholder Consideration Shares
(assuming no WH Warrants are
exercised)
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
1,521,798,821
10.73%
39,856,975
0.28%
130,354,607
0.92%
1,067,517
0.01%
69,385,167
0.49%
1,762,463,087
12.43%
456,867,486
3.22%
2,197,909,600
15.49%
1,009,616,519
7.12%
8,436,442,794
59.47%
14,185,156,122
100.00%
Immediately afte
and issue of
Consideration S
Optionholder Cons
(assuming the W
exercised
No. of Wing
Hing Shares
1,521,798,821
39,856,975
130,354,607
1,067,517
69,385,167
1,762,463,087
456,867,486
2,434,257,600
1,009,616,519
8,672,790,794
14,421,504,122
r the allotment
the Total
hares and TG
ideration Shares
H Warrants are
in full)
% of Wing
Hing’s issued
share capital
10.55%
0.28%
0.90%
0.01%
0.48%
12.22%
3.17%
16.88%
7.00%
60.14%
100.00%

Notes:

  1. Michael J. Yates, his family and GoldCom are not connected persons of Wing Hing and accordingly form part of Wing Hing’s public float.

  2. Mandra will become a substantial shareholder of Wing Hing following the First Completion Date. Accordingly, Mandra, along with its associates, Mandra Esop Limited and Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace are connected persons of Wing Hing following the First Completion Date.

  3. As these shareholders are not connected persons of Wing Hing, they will be counted towards the public float.

  4. Excludes shareholding in Wing Hing by connected persons of Wing Hing (e.g. Directors, substantial shareholders (as defined in the Listing Rules) of Wing Hing and their associates (as defined by the Listing Rules)).

– 140 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

4. DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT OF WING HING

The biographical details of each of the Directors are set out as follows:

Mr. Li Hok Yin, aged 33, is the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and an Executive Director of the Company. He was previously the Investment Manager of Cheever Capital Management (Asia) Ltd., a substantial shareholder (as defined in the Listing Rules) of the Company, from September 2007 to December 2009. He was the Territory Manager of Ecolab Ltd, a company listed on the New York Stock Exchange, from March 2004 to July 2007. He also obtained a Bachelor of Engineering degree from The Chinese University of Hong Kong. Mr. Li was appointed as an Executive Director of the Company on 8 January 2010 and becomes the chairman on 1 September 2010.

Mr. Shen Junchen, aged 40, is an Executive Director. Mr. Shen holds a master of business administration degree from Asia International Open University (Macau). He has over 16 years of experience in coal mining industry. Mr. Shen was appointed as an Executive Director of the Company on 1 April 2009.

Ms. Cheung Pak Sum, aged 34, was appointed as an Executive Director of the Company on 20 April 2010. She is the Head of Human Resources and Administration of the Company and the legal representative of two subsidiaries of the Company. She is well experienced in the areas of Human Resources and Administration. She was the senior administration officer of Pineview Industries Limited, a listed company on the Stock Exchange, from May 2006 to May 2008.

Mr. Hui Wah Tat, Anthony, aged 49, is an Independent Non-Executive Director of the Company. He is a member of The Hong Kong Institute of Directors. He is a President of Lions Club of Hong Kong (Mainland), vice-chairman of Hong Kong Hunan Youth Exchange Promotion Association Limited and a consultant of City Junior Chamber. Mr. Hui is also an executive committee member of Hunan Province Youth Federation (湖南省青年聯合會), Chinese People’s Political Consultative Conference Guangxi Fang Cheng Gang City Committee (廣西壯族自治區防城港市政 協) and Vice President of Guangxi Fang Cheng Gang City Overseas Friendship Association (廣西省防城港市海外聯誼會副會長). Mr. Hui was appointed as an Independent Non-Executive Director of the Company on 7 March 2008. Mr. Li Kam Chung, aged 59, is an Independent Non-Executive Director. Mr. Li has over 10 years experience in trading businesses between Mainland, China and Hong Kong. Mr. Li is currently the vice chairman of Tai Po Shuen Wan Joint Villages Office Association and a member of Tai Po District Council Environment, Housing and Works Committee. Mr. Li was appointed as an Independent Non-Executive Director of the Company on 1 April 2009.

Mr. Chui Man Lung, Everett, aged 47, was appointed as an independent nonexecutive Director of Wing Hing in April 2010. Mr. Chui is a fellow member of both the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the Association of Chartered Certified Accountants. He is a member of the Institute of Chartered

– 141 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Accountants in England and Wales. He is currently the director and shareholder of Cen-1 Partners Limited, an independent consultancy company specializing in financial engineering and corporate structuring. He was the financial controller and company secretary of Yau Lee Holdings Ltd., a company listed on the Exchange, from February 1995 to May 2008. He is well experienced in the areas of finance, audit and accounting. Mr. Chui graduated from the University of Southampton in the United Kingdom with a bachelor degree in social sciences in business, economics and accounting. Mr. Chui was appointed as an Independent Non-executive Director of Duoyuan Printing, Inc., a listed company in the New York Stock Exchange, on 26 November 2010.

The biographical details of the senior management of Wing Hing are set out as follows:

Mr. Chen Yifei, aged 72, is the general manager and senior geological engineer of the Long Men Sou Mine. He was the general manager of China Langfang Dashan Geology and Mining Corporation Limited and the former director of both Research Center of Mining Tail Materials Disposal and Utilization and Chinese Academy of Geological Sciences. Mr. Chen was also the former director and general engineer of the Regional Geological Survey Team of the Hebei Geology & Resources Bureau.

Mr. Liu Guodong, aged 75, is the senior consultant of the Long Men Sou Mine. He was the senior consultant of China Langfang Dashan Geology and Mining Corporation Limited and a research fellow of the Institute of Geology of Chinese Academy of Sciences. He is a geophysicist and the former director of the Northeast Institute of Geology and the former deputy director of Institute of Geology of National Seismic Bureau. He has published 105 scientific papers and three publications and gained one national basic sciences award and three achievement department awards for his scientific achievements.

5. MANAGEMENT OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Following completion of the Transactions, the board of the Enlarged Group is expected to comprise the existing Directors of Wing Hing, three current directors of Taung Gold and a new Independent Non-Executive Director to be recommended by Electrum. The senior management team of the Enlarged Group will comprise the existing senior management team of Wing Hing, including Mr. Chen Yifei and Mr. Liu Guodong, and the senior management team of Taung Gold.

The Board believes that the combination of the existing Wing Hing management team and the Taung Gold management team will bring synergistic values to the Enlarged Group given the diverse but complimentary skill sets of its members. In particular, the Taung Gold team has strong technical expertise in gold mining whilst the existing Wing Hing team has extensive knowledge in mining and investments in China as well as experience in managing a listed company in Hong Kong. The Board is of the view that the combination of these skills will be beneficial to the Enlarged Group as a whole.

– 142 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

To ensure that there is appropriate allocation of management resources after completion of the Transactions, the following arrangements have been proposed by Taung Gold and Wing Hing:

  • Financial management: The Enlarged Group’s board expects to establish an executive committee (the Proposed Executive Committee) comprising the chief executive officer and chief financial officer of the Enlarged Group and other members equally represented by the existing Board and the Taung Gold management team. This executive committee will report to the Board on budgetary and financial planning and operational matters for the Enlarged Group.

  • Long Men Sou Mine: Long Men Sou Mine will be managed by a business development/operations executive in the Proposed Executive Committee who will report directly to the chief executive officer of the Enlarged Group. The strategy for managing the Long Men Sou Mine with a view to integrate the operation of the mine in the PRC with the South African operations of the Enlarged Group in the most effective and efficient manner will be devised as a matter of priority after First Completion. It is expected the Long Men Sou Mine will continue to be managed under the guidance and management of Mr. Chen Yifei and Mr. Liu Guodong, with technical input from the Taung Gold management team, Mr. Shen Junchen, Mr. Chen Yifei and Mr. Liu Guodong. Mr. Shen Junchen has over 15 years of experience in coal mining. Both Mr. Chen and Mr. Liu are involved in the management of the Long Men Sou Mine and they are professionally qualified as geologist and geophysicist.

  • South African operations: The mining and projects executive and the mineral resources executive in the Proposed Executive Committee will be responsible for managing the Enlarged Group’s South African operations and both of which will be reporting directly to the chief executive officer of the Enlarged Group. It is expected that such executive roles will be filled by Taung Gold’s current senior management who will continue to manage Taung Gold’s South African operations.

  • Business development and investments: Business development initiatives and investment plans are expected to be managed by an investment committee to be established comprising members from the existing Board and the Taung Gold management team. The investment committee will report to the Board directly.

  • Regulatory matters and investor relations: Given the experience of the Wing Hing management team in managing a Hong Kong-listed company, the Enlarged Group’s regulatory compliance and investor relations matter are expected to be managed by Wing Hing’s existing management team.

For details on the biographies of the directors and senior management of Taung Gold, please refer to the section headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 5. Directors and Senior Management of Taung Gold’’ of this Circular. For details on the biographies of the directors and senior management of Wing Hing, please refer to the section headed ‘‘Part F — Information on the Wing Hing Group and the Enlarged Group — 4. Directors and Senior Management of Wing Hing’’.

– 143 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART G — FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND MANAGEMENT DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF THE WING HING GROUP

1. OVERVIEW

Wing Hing is an investment holding company and its subsidiaries are principally engaged in operating coal and gold mines in the PRC and the sale of minerals. The Wing Hing Group’s revenue represents income from the sale of minerals, leasing of mining licenses and gold mining operations. In July 2010, the Wing Hing Group completed the acquisition of Long Men Sou Mine in the PRC and the Board is optimistic about gold mining due to the expected growing demand for gold. Please refer to the section headed ‘‘Part C — Information on the Taung Group and its Primary Projects — 1. Industry Overview’’ of this Circular for discussion of the market outlook of gold. Other than the Long Men Sou Mine, Wing Hing’s other lines of business for the three financial years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, include operation of coal mines, sale of minerals and provision of guarantee services. Wing Hing had previously engaged in various discontinued lines of business and the relevant figures for the financial years ended 31 March 2009 has been restated to reflect the continuing operations of Wing Hing.

Unless otherwise indicated, all references to ‘‘FY’’ in this section refer to a financial year ended 31 March. ‘‘FY2009’’, ‘‘FY2010’’ and ‘‘FY2011’’ refer to the financial years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.

2. SIGNIFICANT FACTORS AFFECTING THE WING HING GROUP’S RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following factors have had a significant effect on the Wing Hing Group’s results of operations:

  • Demand for gold — Demand for gold will affect the selling price of gold concentrates produced by Long Men Sou Mine in the same manner.

  • Weather conditions — Poor weather conditions will adversely affect the operation of the loading port and discharging port, in turn increasing the operating cost incurred in the trading of minerals.

  • Seasonality — Cold climate will slow down or suspend the normal operation of mine, in turn increasing the operating cost of incurred in the trading of minerals.

  • Events beyond control — The operation of the mine could be interrupted by mechanical and electrical equipment failure.

– 144 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3. CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The Wing Hing Group’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with the Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards which requires the use of certain critical accounting estimates. In the application of the Wing Hing Group’s accounting policies, which are described in note 3 of the Wing Hing Group’s audited financial information, the Directors are required to make judgments, estimates and assumptions about the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and other factors that are considered to be relevant. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The selection of critical accounting policies, as well as the judgements and other uncertainties affecting the application of those critical accounting policies are factors to be considered when reviewing the Wing Hing Group’s financial information. The following are the key assumptions concerning the future and involving the most significant judgement and estimates used in the preparation of its financial statements:

3.1 Impairment of mining rights

The Wing Hing Group assesses whether there are any indicators of impairment for mining rights at each reporting date. Mining rights are tested for impairment when there are indicators that the carrying amounts may not be recoverable. When value in use calculations are undertaken, management must estimate the expected future cash flows from the asset or cash-generating unit and choose a suitable discount rate in order to calculate the present values of those cash flows.

3.2 Impairment loss of trade and other receivables

The Wing Hing Group’s policy for doubtful receivables is based on the on-going evaluation of the collectability and aging analysis of the trade and other receivables and on management’s judgements. Considerable judgement is required in assessing the ultimate realization of these receivables, including the current creditworthiness and the past collection history of each debtor, and the present values of the estimated future cash flows discounted at the effective interest rates. If the financial conditions of the Wing Hing Group’s debtors were to deteriorate, resulting in an impairment of their ability to make payments, additional impairment loss of trade and other receivables may be required.

3.3 Expected useful lives of mining rights and mineral reserves

The Wing Hing Group’s management has determined the estimated useful lives of its mining rights based on the proven and probable mineral reserves. The Directors are of the opinion that the Wing Hing Group will be able to continuously renew the mining rights and the business licenses of respective mining subsidiaries at minimal charges. Accordingly, the Wing Hing Group has used the proven and probable mineral reserves as a basis for estimation of the useful lives of its mining rights.

– 145 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

Amortization rate is determined based on estimated proven and probable mineral reserve quantities with reference to the independent technical assessment report. The capitalized costs of the mining rights are amortized using the unit-of-production method. Any change to the estimated proven and probable mineral reserves will affect the amortization charge of the mining rights.

Proven and probable mineral reserve estimates are updated at regular basis taking into account production and technical information about the mines. In addition, as prices and cost levels change from year to year, the estimate of proven and probable mineral reserves also changes. This change is considered a change in estimate for accounting purposes and is reflected on a prospective basis in relation to amortization rate.

3.4 Description of selected line items from the Wing Hing Group’s consolidated income statements

(a) Revenue

The Wing Hing Group’s revenue represents mainly income from sale of minerals, leasing of mining licenses and gold mining operation. The table below sets forth a breakdown of the Wing Hing Group’s revenue for the continuing operations for the years indicated.

Sale of minerals
Leasing of mining licenses
Gold mining operation
Loan guarantee service operations
Total
FY2011
HK$’000
34,410
4,340
4,925
230
43,905
FY2010
HK$’000
18,398
7,872


26,270
FY2009
HK$’000
(restated)

2,624

2,624

– 146 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(b) Cost of sales

The Wing Hing Group’s cost of sales primarily consists of costs of trading and amortisation of mining rights. The table below sets forth the Wing Hing Group’s cost of sales for the continuing operations for years indicated.

Sale of minerals
Leasing of mining licenses
Gold mining operation
Loan guarantee service operations
Total
FY2011
HK$’000
28,979
2,761
3,653
33
35,426
FY2010
HK$’000
17,774
1,375


19,149
FY2009
HK$’000
(restated)

1,407

1,407
  • (c) Other income and other gains and losses

Other income consists of, among other things, management fee income, interest income on bank deposits, effective interest income on promissory note receivable, loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment, gain on disposal of subsidiaries and impairment losses recognised in respect of mining rights.

(d) Administrative and operating expenses

Administrative and operating expenses primarily consist of legal, professional, consultancy and secretarial fees, salaries, allowances and provident fund contributions and directors’ remunerations.

  • (e) Share of profits of associates and jointly-controlled entities

Share of profits of associates and jointly-controlled entities consist of profits generated by associates and jointly-controlled entities of Club Ace Holdings Limited. The Wing Hing Group disposed the entire issued share capital of Club Ace Holdings Limited in October 2009.

  • (f) Finance costs

Finance costs primarily consist of interest expenses on promissory note payable.

  • (g) Income tax expense

Income tax expenses consists of PRC Enterprise Income Tax expenses and deferred tax.

– 147 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(h) Loss for the year from discontinued operations

Loss for the year from discontinued operations was incurred in the financial years ended 31 March 2009 and 2010 due to the disposal of the entire issued share capital of Club Ace Holdings Limited and the shareholder’s loan to Mr. Ng Tat Leung, George (a former executive director of Wing Hing) in October 2009. Club Ace Holdings Limited and its subsidiaries, associates and jointly-controlled entities previously carried on all of the Wing Hing Group’s construction operations.

(i) Results of operations

The table below sets forth the Wing Hing Group’s consolidated income statement for the continuing operations and discontinued operations for years indicated.

Continuing operations
Revenue
Cost of sales
Gross profit
Other income
Other gains and losses
Administrative and operating expenses
Share of profits of associates
Share of profits of jointly-controlled
entities
Finance costs
Loss before tax
Income tax expense
Loss for the year from continuing
operations
Discontinued operations
Loss for the year from discontinued
operations
Loss for the year
FY2011
HK$’000
43,905
(35,426)
8,479
224

(32,266)


(408)
(23,971)
(162)
(24,133)

(24,133)
FY2010
HK$’000
26,270
(19,149)
7,121
1
(76)
(16,743)


(568)
(10,265)
(1,901)
(12,166)
(22)
(12,188)
FY2009
HK$’000
(restated)
2,624
(1,407)
1,217
2,208
8,917
(18,051)
156
427
(21,991)
(27,117)
(591)
(27,708)
(45,961)
(73,669)

– 148 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

3.5 Years ended 31 March 2011 and 2010

(a) Revenue

Revenue increased by 67%, or HK$17.6 million, from HK$26.3 million for FY2010 to HK$43.9 million for FY2011. This increase was primarily due to the increase in sale of minerals in FY2011.

(b) Cost of sales

Cost of sales increased by 85%, or HK$16.3 million, from HK$19.1 million for FY2010 to HK$35.4 million for FY2011. This increase was mainly due to the increase in sale of minerals in FY2011.

(c) Gross profit

Gross profit increased by 19%, or HK$1.4 million, from HK$7.1 million for FY2010 to HK$8.5 million for FY2011. The increase was mainly due to the increase in sale of minerals, which was offset in part by a decrease in gross profit of leasing of mining licenses as a result of the expiration of leasing agreements during the year ended 31 March 2011.

(d) Other income

Other income increased by more than 100% from HK$1,000 for FY2010 to HK$0.2 million for FY2011. The increase was primarily due to the interest income on interest bearing receivable in FY2011.

(e) Other gains and losses

Other gains and losses increased by 100% from a loss of HK$76,000 for FY2010 to HK$nil for FY2011. The increase was mainly due to the absence of loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment in FY2011.

  • (f) Administrative and operating expenses

Administrative and operating expenses increased by 93%, or HK$15.5 million, from HK$16.7 million for FY2010 to HK$32.2 million for FY2011. The increase was mainly due to the increase in legal and professional fee incurred for very substantial acquisition and impairment for deposits paid for purchase of goods in FY2011.

(g) Finance costs

Finance costs decreased by 28%, or HK$0.2 million, from HK$0.6 million for FY2010 to HK$0.4 million for FY2011. The decrease was mainly due to the early settlement of a promissory note issued in FY2011.

– 149 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(h) Income tax expense

Income tax expense decreased by 91%, or HK$1.7 million, from HK$1.9 million for FY2010 to HK$0.2 million for FY2011. The decrease was mainly due to the decrease in PRC Enterprise Income Tax generated by the decrease in profit from the leasing of mining licences in FY2011.

(i) Loss for the year from continuing operations

The Wing Hing Group’s loss from continuing operations was HK$24.1 million for FY2011, compared to a loss from continuing operations of HK$12.2 million for FY2010. This change was due to the reasons noted above.

(j) Loss for the year from discontinued operations

The Wing Hing Group has not discontinued operations in FY2011 compared to a loss from discontinued operations of HK$22,000 for FY2010. The change was due to the disposal of Club Ace Holdings Limited by the Wing Hing Group in October 2009.

(k) Loss for the year

For the reasons noted above, the Wing Hing Group’s loss increased by 98%, or HK$11.9 million, from HK$12.2 million for FY2010 to HK$24.1 million for FY2011.

3.6 Years ended 31 March 2010 and 2009

  • (a) Revenue

Revenue increased by 901%, or HK$23.6 million, from HK$2.6 million for FY 2009 to HK$26.3 million for FY2010. This increase was primarily due to the sale of minerals in FY2010 but not in FY2009.

(b) Cost of sales

Cost of sales increased by 1,261%, or HK$17.7 million, from HK$1.4 million for FY2009 to HK$19.1 million for FY2010. This increase was mainly due to the sale of minerals in FY2010 but not in FY2009.

(c) Gross profit

Gross profit increased by 485%, or HK$5.9 million, from HK$1.2 million for FY2009 to HK$7.1 million for FY2010. The increase was mainly due to full year’s leasing of mining rights in FY2010 while 4-month only in FY2009.

– 150 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(d) Other income

Other income decreased by almost 100% from HK$2.2 million for FY2009 to HK$1,000 for FY2010. The decrease was primarily due to the absence of service fee income and the absence of interest income on a promissory note receivable.

  • (e) Other gains and losses

Other gains and losses decreased by more than 100% from a gain of HK$8.9 million for FY2009 to a loss of HK$76,000 for FY2010. The decrease was mainly due to the absence of gain on disposal of subsidiary in FY2010.

(f) Administrative and operating expenses

Administrative and operating expenses decreased by 7%, or HK$1.3 million, from HK$18 million for FY2009 to HK$16.7 million for FY2010. The increase was mainly due to the decrease in amortisation of prepaid lease payment.

  • (g) Share of profits of associated and jointly-controlled entities

The Wing Hing Group disposed of Club Ace Holdings Limited in October 2009 and as such, no profit was recorded from associates and jointly-controlled entities for FY2010.

(h) Finance costs

Finance costs decreased by 97%, or HK$21.4 million, from HK$22 million for FY2009 to HK$0.6 million for FY2010. The decrease was mainly due to settlement of a promissory note issued by Wing Hing in FY2010.

(i) Income tax expense

Income tax expense increased by 222%, or HK$1.3 million, from HK$0.6 million for FY2009 to HK$1.9 million for FY2010. The increase was mainly due to the increase in PRC Enterprise Income Tax generated by the increase in revenue generated by the leasing of mining licences.

(j) Loss for the year from continuing operations

The Wing Hing Group’s loss from continuing operations was HK$27.7 million for FY2009, compared to a loss from continuing operations of HK$12.1 million for FY2010. This change was due to the reasons noted above.

(k) Loss for the year from discontinued operations

The Wing Hing Group recorded a loss from discontinued operations of HK$45.9 million for FY2009 compared to a loss from discontinued operations of HK$22,000 for FY2010. The change was due to the disposal of Club Ace Holdings Limited by the Wing Hing Group in October 2009.

– 151 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(l) Loss for the year

For the reasons noted above, the Wing Hing Group’s loss decreased by 83%, or HK$61.5 million, from HK$73.7 million for FY2009 to HK$12.2 million for FY2010.

4. LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

For FY2009, FY2010 and FY2011, the Wing Hing Group has met its working capital and cash requirements primarily through cash generated from financing activities such as the issuance of new shares.

On 7 August 2009, Wing Hing entered into subscription agreements with Galaxy Asset Management (HK) Limited and VMS Investment Group Limited in respect of the subscription of 10,350,000 and 3,450,000 new shares of HK$1.00 each in the capital of the Company, respectively, at the subscription price of HK$1.46 per share. The new shares were issued and allotted on 1 September 2009. The net proceeds amounted to HK$20.0 million and had been utilised in full as general working capital and funding for investments.

On 25 September 2009, Wing Hing entered into a subscription agreement with Cheever Capital Management (Asia) Limited relating to the issuance and allotment of 12,000,000 new shares of HK$1.00 each in the capital of the Company to Cheever Capital Management (Asia) Limited at the subscription price of HK$1.78 per share. The new shares were issued and allotted on 13 October 2009. The net proceeds amounted to HK$21.2 million and had been utilised in full as general working capital and funding for investments.

On 13 November 2009, Wing Hing entered into an underwriting agreement with China Everbright Securities (HK) Limited relating to the issuance and allotment of 46,264,000 offer shares of HK$0.10 each in the capital of the Company at a subscription price of HK$1.80 per offer share by way of an open offer. The proceeds amounted to HK$83.3 million and had been utilised in full as general working capital and funding for investments.

In April 2010, Wing Hing entered into a placing agreement over the possible placing of shares of up to 80,000,000 Wing Hing Shares at the issue price of HK$0.50 per Wing Hing Share. The placing was completed in May 2010 and 80,000,000 Wing Hing shares were allotted and issued. The proceeds from the placing amounted to HK$39.5 million and had been utilised fully as general working capital and funding for investments.

– 152 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

During FY2009, FY2010 and FY2011, the Wing Hing Group did not have any bank borrowings. As of 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, the Wing Hing Group had net current (liabilities)/assets of HK$(5.2) million, HK$98.2 million and HK$264.1 million respectively.

Current assets:
Inventories
Loan receivable
Trade and other receivables
Pledged bank deposits
Cash and bank balances
Assets classified as held for sale
Current liabilities:
Trade and other payables
Current tax liabilities
Net current assets/(liabilities)
4.1
Cash flows
Selected Statement of Cash Flows Data
Net cash used in operating activities
Net cash used in investing activities
Net cash generated by financing activities
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash
equivalents
Effects of change in foreign exchange rates
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the
financial year
FY2011
HK$’000
15

48,412
5,921
156,069
87,360
297,777
30,757
2,944
33,701
264,076
FY2011
HK$’000
(18,107)
(41,521)
168,070
108,442
1,720
156,069
FY2010
HK$’000


56,814

45,907

102,721
2,021
2,492
4,513
98,208
FY2010
HK$’000
(20,284)
(59,782)
103,891
23,825

45,907
FY2009
HK$’000

1,000
113,489
24,362
22,082

160,933
165,575
591
166,166
(5,233)
FY2009
HK$’000
(33,258)
(18,421)
15,142
(36,537)

22,082

– 153 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

(a) Operating activities

In FY2011, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in operating activities amounted to HK$18.1 million and operating cash flows before movements in working capital was HK$(11.4) million. The net decrease of HK$6.7 million in working capital primarily reflected an increase in trade receivables of HK$31.9 million and prepayments, deposits and other receivables of HK$1.9 million, offset by the HK$27.5 million increase in trade payables and accruals.

In FY2010, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in operating activities amounted to HK$20.3 million and operating cash flows before movements in working capital was HK$2.7 million. The net decrease of HK$23.0 million in working capital primarily reflected the following working capital changes: (i) an HK$19.2 million decrease in trade and loan receivables; (ii) an HK$19.2 million increase in prepayments, deposits and other receivables; (iii) an HK$19.9 million decrease in trade payables; and (iv) an HK$1.9 million increase in net amount due from jointly-controlled entities, associates and related companies.

In FY2009, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in operating activities amounted to HK$33.3 million and operating cash flows before movements in working capital was HK$(28.3) million. The net decrease of HK$5.0 million in working capital primarily reflected the following working capital changes: (i) an HK$7.0 million increase in trade receivables; (ii) an HK$39.5 million increase in prepayments, deposits and other receivables; (iii) an HK$7.0 million increase in net amount due from jointly-controlled entities, associates and related companies; and (iv) an HK$47.8 million increase in trade and other payables and accruals.

(b) Investing activities

In FY2011, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in investing activities amounted to HK$41.5 million, which primarily reflected the payments of HK$12.0 million for the purchase of property, plant and equipment, the increase in pledged bank deposits of HK$5.9 million and payment of HK$31.7 million for acquisition of subsidiaries, offset by the deposit refunded of HK$8.0 million for acquisition of subsidiaries.

In FY2010, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in investing activities amounted to HK$59.8 million, which primarily reflected the decrease in pledged bank deposits of HK$24.4 million, offset by payments of HK$2.7 million for the purchases of property, plant and equipment, HK$33 million of deposits paid for acquisition of subsidiaries and HK$48.5 million relating to the disposal of subsidiary.

In FY2009, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash used in investing activities amounted to HK$18.4 million, which primarily reflected payments of HK$175.6 million for the acquisition of subsidiaries and acquisition of assets through acquisition of subsidiary, HK$23.7 million of amounts advanced to a jointly-

– 154 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

controlled entity, partially offset by HK$45.3 million of proceeds for disposal of subsidiary and HK$121 million of proceeds from repayment of promissory note receivable.

(c) Financing activities

In FY2011, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash generated from financing activities was HK$168.1 million, which consisted of the net proceeds from shares issued upon placing of shares, the exercise of warrants by a warrants holder and the exercise of share options by employees of the Wing Hing Group, offset by the repayment of a promissory note of HK$30 million.

In FY2010, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash generated from financing activities was HK$103.9 million, primarily consisted of the net proceeds from shares issued upon placing and open offer of shares, the exercise of share options by employees of the Wing Hing Group and partially offset by HK$20.3 million in repayment of promissory note.

In FY2009, the Wing Hing Group’s net cash generated from financing activities was HK$15.1 million, primarily consisted of the net proceeds from the issuance of shares.

4.3 Liquidity and financial resources

For the year ended 31 March 2011

As at 31 March 2011, the Wing Hing Group did not have any outstanding borrowings and any charge over the assets of the Wing Hing Group.

The Wing Hing Group’s gearing ratio as at 31 March 2011 was zero, calculated based on the Wing Hing Group’s total zero borrowings over the Wing Hing Group’s total assets of approximately HK$593,231,000.

The Wing Hing Group continues to adopt a policy of dealing principally with clients with whom the Wing Hing Group has enjoyed a long working relationship so as to minimise risks in its business.

For the year ended 31 March 2010

As at 31 March 2010, the Wing Hing Group did not have any outstanding borrowings and any charge over the assets of the Wing Hing Group.

The Wing Hing Group’s gearing ratio as at 31 March 2010 was nil, calculated based on the Wing Hing Group’s total borrowings of approximately zero over the Wing Hing Group’s total assets of approximately HK$346,796,000.

The Wing Hing Group continues to adopt a policy of dealing principally with clients with whom the Wing Hing Group has enjoyed a long working relationship so as to minimise risks in its business.

– 155 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

For the year ended 31 March 2009

As at 31 March 2009, apart from a promissory note payable of approximately HK$20,267,000, the Wing Hing Group did not have any outstanding borrowings. As at 31 March 2009, the Wing Hing Group’s banking facilities were supported by (i) pledged deposits of approximately HK$24,362,000 of the Wing Hing Group; (ii) corporate guarantees to the extent of approximately HK$44,600,000 in aggregate executed by the Company in respect of the banking facilities granted to certain subsidiaries of the Company; and (iii) cross guarantees amongst certain subsidiaries of the Company. As at 31 March 2009, the Wing Hing Group did not have any charge over the assets of the Wing Hing Group.

The Wing Hing Group’s gearing ratio as at 31 March 2009 was 0.049, calculated based on the Wing Hing Group’s total borrowings of approximately HK$20,267,000 over the Wing Hing Group’s total assets of approximately HK$412,001,000.

The Wing Hing Group continues to adopt a policy of dealing principally with clients with whom the Wing Hing Group has enjoyed a long working relationship so as to minimise risks in its business.

4.4 Employees

The Wing Hing Group employed approximately 10, 20 and 60 staff, excluding workers under exclusive subcontracting arrangements, for the years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011 respectively. Total staff costs for the year ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, excluding Directors’ remuneration, amounted to approximately HK$4,135,000, HK$1,605,000 and HK$2,848,000. The remuneration packages of the Wing Hing Group’s employees are mainly based on their performance and experience, taking into account current industry practices. The remuneration policy and packages of the Wing Hing Group’s employees are reviewed regularly.

The Wing Hing Group operates a defined contribution Mandatory Provident Fund retirement benefits scheme (the MPF Scheme) under the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance, for all its employees who are eligible to participate in the MPF Scheme. Contributions are made based on a percentage of the employees’ basic salaries. The assets of the MPF Scheme are held separately from those of the Wing Hing Group in an independently administered fund. The Wing Hing Group’s employer contributions vest fully with the employees when contributed into the MPF Scheme in accordance with the rules of the MPF Scheme.

In addition to the provision of the MPF Scheme, a share option scheme (the 2002 Share Option Scheme) is also available to employees based on their performance. The Company operates the Scheme for the purpose of providing incentives or rewards to eligible participants for their contribution to the Wing Hing Group and/or to enable the Wing Hing Group to recruit and retain high-calibre employees and attract human resources that are valuable to the Wing Hing Group and any entity in which the Wing Hing Group holds an equity interest (the Invested Entity). Eligible participants of the

– 156 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

2002 Share Option Scheme include the Directors and employees of the Company, its subsidiaries or any Invested Entity, suppliers and customers of the Wing Hing Group or any Invested Entity, any technical, financial and legal professional advisers engaged by the Wing Hing Group or any Invested Entity, and any shareholder of any member of the Wing Hing Group or any Invested Entity or any holder of any securities issued by any member of the Wing Hing Group or any Invested Entity. The 2002 Share Option Scheme became effective on 29 August 2002 and was terminated by the shareholders of the Company on 4 January 2010 and a new share option scheme (the New Share Option Scheme) was adopted. The New Share Option Scheme became effective on 4 January 2010 and, unless otherwise cancelled or amend, will remain in force for 10 years from that date.

Share options do not confer rights on the holders to dividends or to vote at shareholders’ meetings. No share options were granted under the 2002 Share Option Scheme as at 31 March 2009 and 2010.

During the year ended 31 March 2010, the 97,154,400 of shares in respect of which options had been granted under the New Share Option Scheme. During the year ended 31 March 2011, no additional shares in respect of which options had been granted under the New Share Option Scheme.

4.5 Exposure to fluctuations in exchange rates

Since the functional currencies of the Wing Hing Group’s operations are mainly Hong Kong dollars, United States dollars and Renminbi, the Directors consider that the potential foreign exchange exposure of the Wing Hing Group during each of the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011 is limited.

4.6 Material acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries and associated companies

Save as disclosed below, there were no material acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries, jointly-controlled entities and associated companies during each of the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

The Wing Hing Group has acquired the 70% equity interest in Union Sense Development Limited, a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands, and a subsidiary of which is principally engaged in the operation of coal mines and leasing of mining licenses in the People’s Republic of China during the year ended 31 March 2009.

The Wing Hing Group has disposed its equity interests in Wing Hing Group (BVI) Limited and its subsidiaries to a connected person during the year ended 31 March 2009.

The Wing Hing Group has disposed its equity interests in Farrell Global Limited and its subsidiaries to an Independent Third Party during the year ended 31 March 2009.

– 157 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

During the year ended 31 March 2010, the Wing Hing Group disposed of the entire issued share capital of Club Ace Holdings Limited, a company and its subsidiaries involved in the construction business, to Ng Tat Leung, George, a connected person of the Wing Hing Group.

During the year ended 31 March 2011, the Wing Hing Group acquired the entire equity interests in Bestkin International Limited (Bestkin), a BVI company, through its subsidiary to be involved in the holding of gold mining rights to conduct mining activities at a gold mine situated in Long Men Sou, District of the Chicheng County, Hebei Province, the PRC.

4.7 Significant investments or capital assets

Save as those disclosed under the paragraph headed ‘‘4.6 Material acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries and associated companies’’, there were no significant investment or capital assets for each of the years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

4.8 Future plans for material investments or capital assets

The Wing Hing Group generally finances its material investments or capital assets with internally generated cash flows.

Save for the Acquisition as disclosed in this Circular or as otherwise disclosed herein, there were no future plans for material investments or capital assets for the three (3) years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

4.9 Contingent liabilities

At 31 March 2009 and 2010, the Wing Hing Group had executed guarantees in respect of performance bonds in favour of contract customers of approximately HK$28,583,000 and HK$nil respectively. At 31 March 2011, the Wing Hing Group had contingent liabilities of approximately HK$22,760,000 in relation to the provision of loan guarantee services in the PRC.

At 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, the Company had executed guarantees for approximately HK$36,000,000, HK$nil and HK$nil respectively, in respect of the general banking facilities granted to CHEC-CWF Limited (a jointly-controlled entity in which the Wing Hing Group has 30% equity interests).

At 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, the Company had executed guarantees for approximately HK$44,620,000, HK$nil and HK$nil respectively, in respect of the general banking facilities granted to W. Hing Construction Company Limited and CWF Piling & Civil Engineering Company Limited (wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company).

– 158 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

The Wing Hing Group has a contingent liability in respect of possible future long service payments to employees under the Hong Kong Employment Ordinance, with a maximum possible amount of approximately HK$2.8 million, HK$nil and HK$nil as at 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011 respectively. The contingent liability has arisen because, at the balance sheet date, a number of current employees have achieved the required number of years of service to the Wing Hing Group in order to be eligible for long service payments under the Employment Ordinance if their employment is terminated under certain circumstances. A provision has not be recognised in the financial statements of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2009 in respect of such possible payments, as it is not considered probable that the situation will result in a material future outflow of resources from the Wing Hing Group.

4.10 Indebtedness

Save as disclosed under the section headed ‘‘8. Indebtedness’’ as set out in Appendix VIII ‘‘Statutory and General Information on Wing Hing’’ or as otherwise disclosed herein, and apart from intra-group liabilities and normal trade payables, the Wing Hing Group did not have any outstanding borrowings, bank overdrafts, loans or other similar indebtedness under acceptances (other than normal trade bill) or acceptance credits, debentures or other loan capital, mortgages, charges, hire purchase or finance lease commitments, guarantees, capital commitments or other contingent liabilities at the close of business on 31 May 2011.

The Directors have confirmed that there has not been any material change in the indebtedness and contingent liabilities of the Wing Hing Group since 31 May 2011.

4.11 Market risks

The Wing Hing Group is exposed to various types of market risks, including foreign currency risk, cash flow and fair value interest rate risk in the normal course of business.

Foreign currency risk

Certain of the assets of Wing Hing Group are principally denominated in US dollars and Renminbi. The Wing Hing Group does not have a foreign currency hedging policy currently as the Directors consider that the currency risk is not significant.

Cash flow and fair value interest rate risk

Except for cash and cash equivalents, the Wing Hing Group has no other significant interest-bearing assets. Wing Hing Group’s income and operating cash flows are substantially independent of changes in market interest rates. The Wing Hing Group does not anticipate significant impact on interest-bearing assets resulting from changes in interest rates because the interest rates of its bank deposits are not expected to change significantly.

– 159 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

5. FUND RAISING ACTIVITIES WITHIN THE LAST 12 MONTHS

On 18 January 2011, Wing Hing announced the proposed placing of up to 346,000,000 shares at the issue price of HK$0.40 per Wing Hing Share. The Placing was completed on 27 January 2011 and 346,000,000 Shares were allotted and issued. The net proceeds in the amount of approximately HK$135.5 million were intended to be used as general working capital of the Wing Hing Group and to fund potential investments. As at the date of this Circular, approximately of HK$56 million of net proceeds has been utilised as the general working capital of the Wing Hing Group of which HK$30 million was used to repay a promissory note.

Save as disclosed in this Circular, Wing Hing has not conducted any fund raising activities in the past twelve months prior to the date of this Circular.

– 160 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART H — LISTING RULES IMPLICATIONS

1. VERY SUBSTANTIAL ACQUISITION

As the applicable percentage ratios calculated pursuant to Rule 14.07 of the Listing Rules in respect of the Acquisition exceed 100%, the Acquisition constitutes a very substantial acquisition of Wing Hing under Rule 14.06(5) of the Listing Rules.

Pursuant to Rule 14.49 of the Listing Rules, the Transactions are therefore subject to the approval of the WH Shareholders at the SGM.

2. PROPOSED INCREASE IN AUTHORISED SHARE CAPITAL

The Board proposes to increase Wing Hing’s authorized share capital from 15,000,000,000 Wing Hing Shares to 30,000,000,000 Wing Hing Shares by the creation of 15,000,000,000 additional new Wing Hing Shares. The Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital is determined by taking into account the maximum number of the Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares which may be allotted and issued and Wing Hing’s need for flexibility to issue new Wing Hing Shares for future investments and developments respectively. An ordinary resolution will be put forward at the SGM for the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital. Wing Hing has no present intention of issuing any part of the increased authorised share capital in the near term, other than under the Transactions.

The Board is of the view that the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital is necessary for proceeding with the Transactions as (i) First Completion is conditional upon the success of the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital; and (ii) payment of the Consideration involves the issue of the Total Consideration Shares. It will also provide flexibility to Wing Hing in fund raising through the issue of new equity securities for implementation of its future business plan as adopted from time to time, and is therefore in the interests of the WH Shareholders. No WH Shareholder is required to abstain from voting on the resolution to be proposed at the SGM regarding the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital.

3. SPECIFIC MANDATE

The Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares will be issued under the Specific Mandate subject to WH Shareholders’ approval at the SGM. The issue of the Total Consideration Shares and TG Optionholder Consideration Shares will result in the issue of 10,977,630,003 and 1,009,616,519 new Wing Hing Shares respectively, which will cause a significant dilution of the existing WH Shareholders.

4. SUFFICIENCY OF PUBLIC FLOAT

Wing Hing will maintain the listing status of the Wing Hing Shares on the Exchange and the 25% minimum public float requirement upon the issue of the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares.

– 161 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

For the purpose of determining the public float of Wing Hing, the Exchange will not regard any connected person of Wing Hing as a member of ‘‘the public’’ or shares held by a connected person as being ‘‘in public hands’’. In addition the Exchange will not recognize as a member of ‘‘the public’’:

  • (a) any person whose acquisition of securities has been financed directly or indirectly by a connected person;

  • (b) any person who is accustomed to take instructions from a connected person in relation to the acquisition, disposal, voting or other disposition of securities of the issuer registered in his name or otherwise held by him.

Wing Hing will be able to maintain the 25% public float requirement at all times immediately before and after First Completion and immediately before and after the Electrum Completion.

5. NO CHANGE IN CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDER

Based on the fact that there have been no controlling shareholders of Wing Hing during the 24 months prior to and immediately before entering into the Acquisition Agreement, currently there is not and nor will there be any controlling shareholder (as defined in the Listing Rules) of Wing Hing as a result of the Transactions. Following the completion of the Transactions, the existing Directors, including the Independent Nonexecutive Directors, will continue to constitute a majority of the Board.

– 162 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART I — PROPOSED CHANGE OF NAME

1. PROPOSED CHANGE OF NAME

The Board proposes to change the English name of Wing Hing from ‘‘Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited’’ to ‘‘Taung Gold International Limited’’. Subject to the new English name of Wing Hing becoming effective, Wing Hing will adopt ‘‘壇金礦業有限公 司’’ as its new Chinese name for identification purposes only. The Proposed Change of Name is subject to, among other things, the approval of the WH Shareholders at the SGM, the completion of the Acquisition and the approval by the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda of the use of the new English name by Wing Hing. Wing Hing will issue a further announcement regarding the effective date of the change of name and the trading arrangement of the change of Wing Hing’s stock short name.

The Board believes that the Proposed Change of Name will provide Wing Hing with a new corporate identity that reflects the new development focus of the Wing Hing Group of the gold mining business in South Africa, which is in the interests of Wing Hing and the WH Shareholders as a whole.

2. CONDITIONS

The Proposed Change of Name is subject to the following conditions being fulfilled:

  • (a) the passing of the necessary resolution by the WH Shareholders at the SGM;

  • (b) the completion of the Acquisition; and

  • (c) the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda approving the use of the new English name by Wing Hing.

The Proposed Change of Name will take effect from the date on which the new English name is entered onto the register by the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda in place of the existing name. Upon the Proposed Change of Name becoming effective, all existing share certificates bearing the current name of ‘‘Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited’’ will continue to be evidence of title to shares of Wing Hing and will continue to be valid for trading, settlement and registration purposes and the rights of the WH Shareholders will not be affected as a result of the Proposed Change of Name. There will not be any free exchange of the existing share certificates of Wing Hing for new share certificates under the new name of Wing Hing. If the Proposed Change of Name becomes effective, any issue of share certificates thereafter will be in the new name of Wing Hing and the securities of Wing Hing will be traded on the Exchange in the new name of Wing Hing.

– 163 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART J — SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

A notice convening the SGM is set out on pages N-1 to N-5 of this Circular. The SGM will be held at Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower, No. 8 Yeung Uk Road, Tsuen Wan, New Territories, Hong Kong on Friday, 19 August 2011 at 11: 00 a.m. (or any adjournment thereof) to consider, and, if thought fit, approve, among other things, the necessary resolutions relating to (1) the transactions contemplated under the Acquisition Agreement; (2) the Put Option Agreement and the Loan Note; (3) the Electrum Option Agreement; (4) the TG Optionholder Agreement; (5) the issue of Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares under the Specific Mandate.

In addition, application will be made by Wing Hing to the Listing Committee for the listing of, and permission to deal in the Total Consideration Shares and the TG Optionholder Consideration Shares.

To the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief and having made all reasonable enquiries, no WH Shareholder has a material interest in the Acquisition Agreement, the Electrum Option Agreement, the Put Option Agreements, the Loan Note, the TG Optionholder Agreements, the Proposed Increase in Authorised Share Capital or the Specific Mandate which is materially different from the other WH Shareholders. Accordingly, no WH Shareholders are required under the Listing Rules to abstain from voting at the SGM.

A form of proxy for use at the SGM is sent to the WH Shareholders together with this Circular. Whether or not the WH Shareholders are able to attend the SGM, the WH Shareholders are requested to complete and return the enclosed form of proxy in accordance with the instructions printed thereon as soon as possible and in any event not less than 48 hours before the time for holding of the SGM or adjournment thereof. Completion and return of the form of proxy will not preclude the WH Shareholders from attending and voting at the SGM or any adjourned meeting thereof should the WH Shareholders so wish.

– 164 –

LETTER FROM THE BOARD

PART K — RECOMMENDATION

For the reasons set out in the sections headed ‘‘1.10 Basis of the Consideration, the Issue Price and the Share Exchange Ratio’’ and ‘‘4. Reasons for and benefits of the Acquisition’’ of Part A — Structure of the Transactions, the Acquisition and the Consideration of this letter from the Board, the Board, including the Independent Nonexecutive Directors, considers that the terms of the Acquisition Agreement and the Transactions are on normal commercial terms, fair and reasonable, and in the interests of Wing Hing and WH Shareholders as a whole. Accordingly, the Board recommends the WH Shareholders to vote in favour of all the resolutions to be proposed at the SGM.

– 165 –

ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON WING HING

APPENDIX I

1. FINANCIAL SUMMARY AND AUDITORS’ REPORTS

A summary of the published results, assets and liabilities of the Wing Hing Group for the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011 as extracted from the respective annual reports of the Company is set out below. No qualified opinion has been expressed by the auditors of the Company on the audited financial statements of the Wing Hing Group for each of the years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

Continuing operations
Revenue
Cost of sales
Gross profit
Other income
Other gains and losses
Administrative and operating expenses
Share of profits of associates
Share of profits of jointly-controlled
entities
Finance costs
Loss before tax
Income tax expense
Loss for the year from continuing
operations
Discontinued operations
Loss for the year from discontinued
operations
For the year ended 31 March
2011
2010
2009
(Audited)
(Audited)
(Audited)
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
(restated)
43,905
26,270
2,624
(35,426)
(19,149)
(1,407)
8,479
7,121
1,217
224
1
2,208

(76)
8,917
(32,266)
(16,743)
(18,051)


156


427
(408)
(568)
(21,991)
(23,971)
(10,265)
(27,117)
(162)
(1,901)
(591)
(24,133)
(12,166)
(27,708)

(22)
(45,961)

– I-1 –

ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON WING HING

APPENDIX I

Loss for the year
Other comprehensive income, net of income
tax
Exchange differences on translating foreign
operations
Gain arising on revaluation of property,
plant and equipment
Total comprehensive expense for the year
(Loss)/Profit attributable to:
Owners of the Company
Non-controlling interests
Total comprehensive (expense)/income
attributable to:
Owners of the Company
Non-controlling interests
Loss per share
From continuing and discontinued
operations
— Basic and diluted
(HK cents per share)
From continuing operations
— Basic and diluted
(HK cents per share)
For the year ended 31 March
2011
2010
2009
(Audited)
(Audited)
(Audited)
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
(restated)
(24,133)
(12,188)
(73,669)
16,725

12,651


2,796
(7,408)
(12,188)
(58,222)
(21,359)
(14,404)
(69,184)
(2,774)
2,216
(4,485)
(24,133)
(12,188)
(73,669)
(8,234)
(14,404)
(59,087)
826
2,216
865
(7,408)
(12,188)
(58,222)
(1.17)
(1.17)
(8.14)
(1.17)
(1.17)
(2.73)

– I-2 –

ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON WING HING

APPENDIX I

There were no extraordinary or exceptional items for the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

Information regarding rates of dividend paid or proposed on each class of shares and amounts absorbed thereby has not been disclosed as no dividends were paid or proposed in respect of the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011.

Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
Mining rights
Interests in associates
Interests in jointly-controlled entities
Contract retention receivables
Prepayments
Current assets
Inventories
Loan receivable
Trade and other receivables
Pledged bank deposits
Cash and bank balances
Assets classified as held for sale
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
Current tax liabilities
Net current assets/(liabilities)
Total assets less current liabilities
As at 31 March
2011
2010
(Audited)
(Audited)
HK$’000
HK$’000
12,924
2,545
281,120
241,530






1,410

295,454
244,075
15



48,412
56,814
5,921

156,069
45,907
210,417
102,721
87,360

297,777
102,721
30,757
2,021
2,944
2,492
33,701
4,513
264,076
98,208
559,530
342,283
2009
(Audited)
HK$’000
6,481
242,906
2,804
(12,540)
11,417

251,068

1,000
113,489
24,362
22,082
160,933

160,933
165,575
591
166,166
(5,233)
245,835

– I-3 –

ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON WING HING

APPENDIX I

Capital and reserves
Share capital
Reserves
Equity attributable to owners of the
Company
Non-controlling interests
Total equity
Non-current liabilities
Deferred tax liabilities
Provision for restoration cost
Promissory notes
As at 31 March
2011
2010
(Audited)
(Audited)
HK$’000
HK$’000
21,979
16,354
435,422
251,240
457,401
267,594
75,544
74,689
532,945
342,283
26,265

320



26,585

559,530
342,283
2009
(Audited)
HK$’000
89,860
62,238
152,098
72,473
224,571
997

20,267
21,264
245,835

2. AUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE WING HING GROUP

The audited consolidated financial statements of the Wing Hing Group (i) for the year ended 31 March 2009 is set out on pages 27 to 116 of the annual report of the Company for the year ended 31 March 2009 published on 30 July 2009; (ii) for the year ended 31 March 2010 is set out on pages 24 to 96 of the annual report of the Company for the year ended 31 March 2010 published on 30 July 2010; and (iii) for the year ended 31 March 2011 is set out on pages 25 to 92 of the annual report of the Company for the year ended 31 March 2011 published on 21 July 2011. All of the above annual reports have been published on the website of the Stock Exchange (www.hkex.com.hk).

– I-4 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS WING HING INTERNATIONAL (HOLDINGS) LIMITED

Dear Sirs,

We set out below our report on the Financial Information (‘‘Financial Information’’) relating to Taung Gold Limited (the ‘‘Company’’) and its subsidiaries (hereafter collectively referred to as the ‘‘Group’’) prepared on the basis set out in note 1 of section 2 below, for each of the three years ended 28 February 2009, 2010 and 2011 (‘‘Relevant Periods’’), for inclusion in the shareholders’ circular issued by Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (hereafter referred to as ‘‘Wing Hing’’) dated 28 July 2011 (the ‘‘Circular’’) in connection with the proposed acquisition of 86.966% of the issued shares of Taung (the ‘‘Acquisition’’) by Wing Hing.

The Company is a public company and was incorporated in South Africa on 25 August 2004 in terms of the Companies Act of South Africa. As at the date of this report, the Company owned a 100% equity interest in Taung Gold Exploration Limited (‘‘TGE’’), a 100% equity interest in Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty) Ltd (‘‘TGEW’’), a 100% equity interest in Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd (‘‘TGNW’’), a 100% equity interest in Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Ltd (‘‘TGFS’’), a 100% equity interest in Ulinet (Pty) Ltd (‘‘ULI’’), a 100% equity interest in Pluriclox (Pty) Ltd (‘‘PLU’’), and a 100% equity interest in Sephaku Gold Exploration (Pty) Ltd (‘‘SGE’’). The interests in SGE and PLU were acquired during the 2011 financial year. Particulars of the subsidiaries of the Company are set out in note 5 of Section 2 below. The Group is currently in its development and exploration stage and will principally be engaged in the business of gold mining.

We have acted as the auditor of the Company and its subsidiaries for the Relevant Period or since the date that they became subsidiaries to 28 February 2011 where there is a shorter period. Our audit was performed in accordance with International Standards on auditing.

The Company and the Group have adopted 28 February as their financial year end date and no further audited financial statements have been prepared in respect of any period subsequent to 28 February 2011.

The directors of the Company have prepared the statutory consolidated financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board for the Relevant Periods (the ‘‘Underlying Financial Statements’’).

We have examined the Underlying Financial Statements for the Relevant Periods in accordance with the Auditing Guideline 3.340 ‘‘Prospectus and the Reporting Accountant’’ as recommended by the HKICPA.

The Financial Information of the Company and the Group for the Relevant Periods set out in this report has been prepared based on the Underlying Financial Statements, after making such adjustments as we consider necessary to adjust the Underlying Financial Statements in preparing our report for inclusion in the Circular.

– II-1 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

The Underlying Financial Statements are the responsibility of the directors of the Company who approve their issue. The directors of Wing Hing are responsible for the contents of the Circular in which this report is included. It is our responsibility to compile the Financial Information set out in this report from the Underlying Financial Statements, to form an independent opinion on the Financial Information and to report our opinion to you.

In our opinion, the Financial Information is prepared on the basis of preparation set out in note 1 of Section 2 below gives, for the purpose of this report, a true and fair view of the results and cash flows of the Company and the Group for each of the Relevant Periods and of the state of affairs of the Company and the Group as at 28 February 2009, 2010 and 2011.

– II-2 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

1. FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Presented in South African Rands (R) Statement of Financial Position

As at 28 February 2011

Notes
Assets
Non-Current Assets
Property, plant and equipment
3
Intangible assets
4
Investments in subsidiaries
5
Deposits
6
Loans to group companies
7
Current Assets
Other receivables
8
Short-term deposits
9
Cash and cash equivalents
10
Current Liabilities
Loans from shareholders
11
Trade and other payables
12
Net Current assets/(liabilities)
Total Assets less Current
Liabilities
Equity and Liabilities
Equity
Share capital
13
Reserves
14
Retained income/
(accumulated loss)
Total shareholders’ interest
2011
R
2,373,725
193,456,581

21,340,350
Group
2010
R
612,042
47,291,539

5,962,550
2009
R

36,947,882

5,886,550
2011
R
999,360
118,369,490
38,985,412
20,000,000
76,835,423
Company
2010
R
612,042
12,917,646
8,290,742
5,000,000
67,363,277
2009
R

7,277,487
2,670,954
5,000,000
36,389,178
217,170,656 53,866,131 42,834,432 255,189,685 94,183,707 51,337,619
2,023,409
2,469,118
270,228,046
4,806,517
26,818,892
1,744,678
2,028,953

2,381,479
2,848,971
517,156
270,158,109
4,994,851
160,000
1,675,251
1,141,459

1,821,249
274,720,573
5,314,683
8,730,011
33,370,087
5,269,653
10,119,450
4,410,432
8,655,023
12,765,929
273,524,236
5,314,683
6,757,060
6,830,102
5,269,653
6,963,200
2,962,708
8,655,023
12,320,019
14,044,694 15,389,103 21,420,952 12,071,743 12,232,853 20,975,042
260,675,879 17,980,984 (17,010,520) 261,452,493 (5,402,751) (18,012,334)
477,846,535 71,847,115 25,823,912 516,642,178 88,780,956 33,325,285
483,809,185
93,225,735
(99,188,385)
89,659,185


(17,812,070)
35,567,040


(9,743,128)
483,809,185
93,225,735

(60,392,742)
89,659,185


(878,229)
35,567,040


(2,241,755)
477,846,535 71,847,115 25,823,912 516,642,178 88,780,956 33,325,285

– II-3 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Statement of Comprehensive Income

For the three years ended 28 February 2011

Notes
Other income
Operating expenses
Operating loss
15
Interest received
16
Finance costs
Profit/(loss) before taxation
Taxation
17
Profit (loss) for the year
Other comprehensive income
Total comprehensive
income/(loss)
Total comprehensive (loss)/
income attributable to:
Owners of the parent
Non-controlling interest
2011
R
1,171,716
(88,118,810)
Group
2010
R
88,855

(10,000,605)
2009
R
57,077

(7,479,114)
2011
R
1,171,716

(71,079,478)
Company
2010
R
88,855

(2,280,629)
2009
R
57,077

(2,397,628)
(2,209,238)
(2,209,238)
(81,376,315) (8,068,942) (7,286,381) (59,514,513) 1,363,526 (2,209,238)
(2,209,238)
(81,376,315) (8,068,942) (7,286,381) (59,514,513) 1,363,526 (2,209,238)

– II-4 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Statement of Changes in Equity

As at 28 February 2011

Group
Balance at 01 March 2008
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive loss for the year
Issue of shares
Commission paid on shares
Total changes
Balance at 01 March 2009
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive loss for the year
Issue of shares
Total changes
Balance at 01 March 2010
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive loss for the year
Issue of shares
Employees share option scheme
Total changes
Balance at 28 February 2011
Notes
Share
Capital
R
110

68,570

68,570
68,680

10,822
10,822
79,502

58,040

58,040
137,542
13
Share
premium
R


35,908,440
(410,080)
35,498,360
35,498,360

54,081,323
54,081,323
89,579,683

394,091,960

394,091,960
483,671,643
13
Total share
capital
R
110

35,977,010
(410,080)
35,566,930
35,567,040

54,092,145
54,092,145
89,659,185

394,150,000

394,150,000
483,809,185
13
Other NDR
— Share
based
payments
R












93,225,735
93,225,735
93,225,735
14
Accumulated
loss
R
(2,456,747)
(7,286,381)


(7,286,381)
(9,743,128)
(8,068,942)

(8,068,942)
(17,812,070)
(81,376,315)


(81,376,315)
(99,188,385)
Total equity
R
(2,456,637)
(7,286,381)
35,977,010
(410,080)
28,280,549
25,823,912
(8,068,942)
54,092,145
46,023,203
71,847,115
(81,376,315)
394,150,000
93,225,735
405,999,420
477,846,535

– II-5 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Company
Balance at 01 March 2008
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive loss for the year
Issue of shares
Commission paid on shares
Total changes
Balance at 01 March 2009
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive income for the
year
Issue of shares
Total changes
Balance at 01 March 2010
Changes in equity
Total comprehensive loss for the year
Issue of shares
Employees share option scheme
Total changes
Balance at 28 February 2011
Notes
Share
Capital
R
110

68,570

68,570
68,680

10,822
10,822
79,502

58,040

58,040
137,542
13
Share
premium
R


35,908,440
(410,080)
35,498,360
35,498,360

54,081,323
54,081,323
89,579,683

394,091,960

394,091,960
483,671,643
13
Total share
capital
R
110

35,977,010
(410,080)
35,566,930
35,567,040

54,092,145
54,092,145
89,659,185

394,150,000

394,150,000
483,809,185
13
Other NDR
— Share
based
payments
R












93,225,735
93,225,735
93,225,735
14
Accumulated
loss
R
(32,517)
(2,209,238)


(2,209,238)
(2,241,755)
1,363,526

1,363,526
(878,229)
(59,514,513)


(59,514,513)
(60,392,742)
Total equity
R
(32,407)
(2,209,238)
35,977,010
(410,080)
33,357,692
33,325,285
1,363,526
54,092,145
55,455,671
88,780,956
(59,514,513)
394,150,000
93,225,735
427,861,222
516,642,178

– II-6 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Statement of Cash Flows

For the three years ended 28 February 2011

Notes
Cash flows from operating activities
Cash used in operations
18
Interest income
16
Finance costs
Deposits
VAT movement
Net cash from operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities
Purchase of property, plant and
equipment
3
Cost capitalised in intangible assets
4
Subsidiary acquired
19
Loans advanced to group
companies
Deposit on acquisition of projects
Movement in short-term deposits
Net cash from investing activities
Cash flows from financing activities
Proceeds on share issue
13
Proceeds from/(repayment of)
shareholders loan
Repayment of advances — African
Precious Minerals Limited
Net cash from financing activities
Total cash movement for the period
Cash at the beginning of the period
Total cash at end of the period
10
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
Group
Company
2011
2010
2009
2011
2010
2009
R
R
R
R
R
R
(24,281,385)
(9,163,556)
(3,901,983)
(7,297,360)
(6,720,043)
(1,673,549)
5,571,207
1,843,053
135,711
4,773,982
900,439
131,313
(428)
(245)
(55)
(421)
(143)


(76,000)
(237,100)



25,482


54,742


(18,685,124)
(7,396,748)
(4,003,427)
(2,469,057)
(5,819,747)
(1,542,236)
(1,982,806)
(685,120)

(608,441)
(685,120)

(84,393,913)
(11,835,052)
(22,698,860)
(71,351,666)
(5,641,259)
(6,604,306)
407


(100)
(100)




(5,925,752)
(33,938,783)
(20,491,670)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
(20,000,000)

(5,000,000)
24,349,774
(26,818,892)

(357,156)
(160,000)

(82,026,538)
(39,339,064)
(27,698,860)
(98,243,115)
(40,425,262)
(32,095,976)
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
369,150,000
54,092,145
22,821,699
45,030
(3,385,370)
13,324,453
45,030
(3,385,370)
19,211,420

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)

(4,607,764)
(6,573,658)
369,195,030
46,099,011
29,572,494
369,195,030
46,099,011
35,459,461
268,483,368
(636,801)
(2,129,793) 268,482,858
(145,998)
1,821,249
1,744,678
2,381,479
4,511,272
1,675,251
1,821,249

270,228,046
1,744,678
2,381,479
270,158,109
1,675,251
1,821,249
(82,026,538) (39,339,064) (27,698,860) (98,243,115) (40,425,262) (32,095,976)
369,150,000
45,030
369,150,000
45,030

369,195,030 46,099,011 29,572,494 369,195,030 46,099,011 35,459,461
268,483,368
1,744,678
270,228,046 1,744,678 2,381,479 270,158,109 1,675,251 1,821,249

– II-7 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

2. NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL INFORMATION

For the three years ending 28 February 2011

The Company is a public company incorporated in South Africa and its shares are not listed on any stock exchange. The Company does not have a holding company.

The Company and the Group is engaged in exploration, development and mining of gold and associated minerals.

The Company’s registered address and principal place of business is:

Block C, Ground Floor Little Fourways Office Park 1 Leslie Avenue East Fourways South Africa 2055

1. PRESENTATION OF GROUP FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The Group financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards. The Group financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except for the measurement of certain financial instruments and share based payments at fair value, and incorporate the principal accounting policies set out below.

These accounting policies have been consistently applied.

They are presented in South African Rands, which is also the functional currency of the Company and the Group.

1.1 Consolidation

Basis of consolidation

The consolidated Group financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the Company and all entities, including special purpose entities, which are controlled by the Company.

Control exists when the Company has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities.

The results of subsidiaries are included in the consolidated Group financial statements from the effective date of acquisition to the effective date of disposal.

Adjustments are made when necessary to the financial statements of the subsidiaries to bring their accounting policies in line with those of the Group. All intra-group transactions, balances, income and expenses are eliminated in full on consolidation.

– II-8 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Non-controlling interests in the net assets of consolidated subsidiaries are identified and recognised separately from the Group’s interest therein, and are recognised within equity. Losses of subsidiaries attributable to non-controlling interests are allocated to the non-controlling interest even if this results in a debit balance being recognised for non-controlling interest.

The difference between the fair value of consideration paid or received and the movement in noncontrolling interest for such transactions is recognised in equity attributable to the owners of the parent.

Where a subsidiary is disposed of and a non-controlling shareholding is retained, the remaining investment is measured to fair value with the adjustment to fair value recognised in profit or loss as part of the gain or loss on disposal of the controlling interest.

1.2 Critical accounting estimates and judgements

In preparing the Group financial statements, management is required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts represented in the Group financial statements and related disclosures. Use of available information and the application of judgement is inherent in the formation of estimates. Actual results in the future could differ from these estimates which may be material to the Group financial statements. Significant judgements include:

Critical accounting estimates and assumptions

Impairment testing

The Group reviews and tests the carrying value of assets when events or changes in circumstances suggest that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which identifiable cash flows are largely independent of cash flows of other assets and liabilities. If there are indications that impairment may have occurred, estimates are prepared of expected future cash flows for each group of assets. Expected future cash flows used to determine the value in use of goodwill and tangible assets are inherently uncertain and could materially change over time.

Taxation

Judgement is required in determining the provision for income taxes due to the complexity of legislation. There are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Group recognises liabilities for anticipated tax audit issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made.

The Group recognises the net future tax benefit related to deferred income tax assets to the extent that it is probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future. Assessing the recoverability of deferred income tax assets requires the Group to make significant estimates related to expectations of future taxable income. Estimates of future taxable income are based on forecast cash flows from operations and the application of existing tax laws in each jurisdiction. To the extent that future cash flows and taxable income differ significantly from estimates, the ability of the Group to realise the net deferred tax assets recorded at the end of the reporting period could be impacted. Due to the nature of the potential cash generating units, there is not enough evidence to prove that it will be probable that taxable profits will be generated against which the deductible temporary differences can be utilised.

– II-9 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Critical judgements in applying the entities accounting policies

Exploration expenses capitalised

Exploration and evaluation expenses are those expenses incurred in connection with acquisition of rights to explore, investigate, examine and evaluate an area of mineralization including related overhead costs. The directors exercise judgment to determine if the costs associated with a specific project must be capitalised against the specific project or written off.

Exploration assets are reviewed at reporting date and where the directors consider there to be indicators of impairment, impairment tests will be performed on the capitalised costs and any impairments will be recognised through the income statement.

1.3 Property, plant and equipment

The cost of an item of property, plant and equipment is recognised as an asset when:

  • . it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Company; and

  • . the cost of the item can be measured reliably.

Property, plant and equipment is initially measured at cost.

Costs include costs incurred initially to acquire or construct an item of property, plant and equipment and costs incurred subsequently to add to, replace part of, or service it. If a replacement cost is recognised in the carrying amount of an item of property, plant and equipment, the carrying amount of the replaced part is derecognised.

Property, plant and equipment are depreciated on the straight line basis over their expected useful lives to their estimated residual value.

Property, plant and equipment is carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses.

Item Average useful life
Computer equipment 3 years
Computer software 3 years
Field equipment 6 years
Furniture and fixtures 6 years
Motor vehicles 5 years
Office equipment 6 years
Plant & Machinery 10 years

The residual value, useful life and depreciation method of each asset are reviewed at the end of each reporting period. If the expectations differ from previous estimates, the change is accounted for as a change in accounting estimate.

– II-10 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

The depreciation charge for each period is recognised in profit or loss unless it is included in the carrying amount of another asset.

The gain or loss arising from the derecognition of an item of property, plant and equipment is included in profit or loss when the item is derecognised. The gain or loss arising from the derecognition of an item of property, plant and equipment is determined as the difference between the net disposal proceeds, if any, and the carrying amount of the item.

1.4 Site restoration

Provision for future site restoration costs are based on the estimates made of the expenditure needed to settle the present obligation arising.

1.5 Intangible assets

Intangible assets are initially recognised at cost.

Intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and any impairment losses.

Exploration assets are carried at cost less any impairment losses. All costs, including administration and other general overhead costs directly associated with the specific project are capitalised. The directors evaluate each project at each period end to determine if the carrying value should be written off. In determining whether expenditure meet the criteria to be capitalised, the directors use information from several sources, depending on the level of exploration. Purchased exploration and evaluation assets are recognised at the cost of acquisition or at the fair value if purchased as part of a business combination. Exploration assets are not amortised as they will only be available for use once transferred to the development cost of the project.

An intangible asset is regarded as having an indefinite useful life when, based on all relevant factors, there is no foreseeable limit to the period over which the asset is expected to generate net cash inflows. Amortisation is not provided for these intangible assets, but they are tested for impairment annually and whenever there is an indication that the assets may be impaired. For all other intangible assets amortisation is provided on a straight line basis over their useful life.

When the technical and commercial feasibility of a project has been established, the relevant exploration assets are transferred to development costs. No further exploration costs for the project will be capitalised. The costs transferred to development costs will be amortised over the life of the project based on the expected flow of economic resources associated with the project.

The amortisation period and the amortisation method for intangible assets are reviewed every period-end.

Amortisation is provided to write down the intangible assets, on a straight line basis, to their residual values as follows:

Item Useful life Computer software 3 years Exploration assets Not amortised

– II-11 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

1.6 Investments in subsidiaries

Company financial statements

In the Company’s separate annual financial statements, investments in subsidiaries are carried at cost less any accumulated impairment.

The cost of an investment in a subsidiary is the aggregate of:

  • . the fair value, at the date of exchange, of assets given, liabilities incurred or assumed, and equity instruments issued by the Company; plus

  • . any costs directly attributable to the purchase of the subsidiary.

Where the consideration the Company transfers in a business combination includes assets or liabilities resulting from a contingent consideration arrangement, the contingent consideration is measured at its acquisition-date fair value and considered as part of the consideration transferred in a business combination. Changes in the fair value of the contingent consideration that qualify as measurement period adjustments are adjusted retrospectively. Measurement period adjustments are adjustments that arise from additional information obtained during the measurement period about facts and circumstances that existed as of the acquisition date. A measurement period does not exceed one year from the acquisition date.

1.7 Financial instruments

Classification

The Group classifies financial assets and financial liabilities into the following categories:

  • . Loans and receivables and other financial liabilities

Classification depends on the purpose for which the financial instruments were obtained/incurred and takes place at initial recognition.

Initial recognition and measurement

Financial instruments are recognised initially when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instruments.

The Group classifies financial instruments, or their component parts, on initial recognition as a financial liability or an equity instrument in accordance with the substance of the contractual arrangement.

Subsequent measurement

Loans and receivables are subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest method, less accumulated impairment losses.

– II-12 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Impairment of financial assets

At each reporting date the Group assesses all financial assets, other than those at fair value through profit or loss, to determine whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or group of financial assets has been impaired.

Impairment losses are recognised in profit or loss.

Loans to (from) Group companies

These include loans to and from subsidiaries and are recognised initially at fair value plus direct transaction costs.

Loans from Group companies are classified as financial liabilities measured at amortised cost.

Loans to (from) shareholders

These financial assets are classified as loans and receivables.

Other receivables

Other receivables are measured at initial recognition at fair value, and are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. Appropriate allowances for estimated irrecoverable amounts are recognised in profit or loss when there is objective evidence that the asset is impaired. Significant financial difficulties of the debtor, probability that the debtor will enter bankruptcy or financial reorganisation, and default or delinquency in payments (more than 180 days overdue) are considered indicators that the receivable is impaired. The allowance recognised is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate computed at initial recognition.

The carrying amount of the asset is reduced through the use of an allowance account, and the amount of the loss is recognised in profit or loss within operating expenses. When a receivable is uncollectible, it is written off against the allowance account for receivables. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are credited against operating expenses in profit or loss.

Other receivables are classified as loans and receivables.

Trade and other payables

Trade payables are initially measured at fair value, and are subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest rate method.

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash on hand and demand deposits, and other short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to a known amount of cash and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value. These are initially and subsequently recorded at fair value.

– II-13 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Share capital and equity

An equity instrument is any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity after deducting all of its liabilities.

If the Group reacquires its own equity instruments, the consideration paid, including any directly attributable incremental costs (net of income taxes) on those instruments is deducted from equity until the shares are cancelled or reissued. No gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of the Group’s own equity instruments. Consideration paid or received shall be recognised directly in equity. Incremental costs directly attributable to the issue of new shares or options are shown in equity as a deduction, net of tax, from the proceeds.

1.8 Tax

Deferred tax assets and liabilities

A deferred tax liability is recognised for all taxable temporary differences, except to the extent that the deferred tax liability arises from the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction which at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit.

A deferred tax asset is recognised for all deductible temporary differences to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary difference can be utilised. A deferred tax asset is not recognised when it arises from the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit.

A deferred tax asset is recognised for the carry forward of unused tax losses and unused STC credits to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses and unused STC credits can be utilised.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is realised or the liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period.

1.9 Impairment of assets

The Group assesses at each end of the reporting period whether there is any indication that an asset may be impaired. If any such indication exists, the Group estimates the recoverable amount of the asset.

Irrespective of whether there is any indication of impairment, the Group also:

  • . tests intangible assets with an indefinite useful life or intangible assets not yet available for use for impairment annually by comparing their carrying amounts with their recoverable amounts. This impairment test is performed during the annual period and at the same time every period.

– II-14 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

If there is any indication that an asset may be impaired, the recoverable amount is estimated for the individual asset. If it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of the individual asset, the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs is determined.

The recoverable amount of an asset or a cash-generating unit is the higher of its fair value less costs to sell and its value in use.

If the recoverable amount of an asset is less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset is reduced to its recoverable amount. That reduction is an impairment loss.

An impairment loss of assets carried at cost less any accumulated depreciation or amortisation is recognised immediately in profit or loss.

An impairment loss is recognised for cash-generating units if the recoverable amount of the unit is less than the carrying amount of the units. The impairment loss is allocated to reduce the carrying amount of the assets of the unit in the following order:

  • . first, to reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill allocated to the cash-generating unit and

  • . then, to the other assets of the unit, pro rata on the basis of the carrying amount of each asset in the unit.

An entity assesses at each reporting date whether there is any indication that an impairment loss recognised in prior periods for assets other than goodwill may no longer exist or may have decreased. If any such indication exists, the recoverable amounts of those assets are estimated.

The increased carrying amount of an asset other than goodwill attributable to a reversal of an impairment loss does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset in prior periods.

A reversal of an impairment loss of assets carried at cost less accumulated depreciation or amortisation other than goodwill is recognised immediately in profit or loss.

1.10 Share-based payments

Goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment transaction are recognised when the goods are received or as the services are rendered. A corresponding increase in equity is recognised if the goods or services were received in an equity-settled share-based payment transaction or a liability if the goods or services were acquired in a cash-settled share-based payment transaction.

When the goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment transaction do not qualify for recognition as assets, they are recognised as expenses.

– II-15 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

For equity-settled share-based payment transactions, the goods or services received and the corresponding increase in equity are measured, directly, at the fair value of the goods or services received provided that the fair value can be estimated reliably. If the fair value of the goods or services received cannot be estimated reliably, their value and the corresponding increase in equity, indirectly, are measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments granted.

For cash-settled share-based payment transactions, the goods or services acquired and the liability incurred are measured at the fair value of the liability. Until the liability is settled, the fair value of the liability is re-measured at each reporting date and at the date of settlement, with any changes in fair value recognised in profit or loss for the period.

If the share-based payments granted do not vest until the counterparty completes a specified period of service, the Group accounts for those services as they are rendered by the counterparty during the vesting period, (or on a straight line basis over the vesting period).

If the share-based payments vest immediately, the services received are recognised in full.

For share-based payment transactions in which the terms of the arrangement provide either the entity or the counterparty with the choice of whether the entity settles the transaction in cash (or other assets) or by issuing equity instruments, the components of that transaction are recorded, as a cash-settled share-based payment transaction if, and to the extent that, a liability to settle in cash or other assets has been incurred, or as an equity-settled share-based payment transaction if, and to the extent that, no such liability has been incurred.

1.11 Employee benefits

Short-term employee benefits

The cost of short-term employee benefits, (those payable within 12 months after the service is rendered, such as paid vacation leave and sick leave, bonuses, and non-monetary benefits such as medical care), are recognised in the period in which the service is rendered and are not discounted.

The expected cost of compensated absences is recognised as an expense as the employees render services that increase their entitlement or, in the case of non-accumulating absences, when the absence occurs.

The expected cost of profit sharing and bonus payments is recognised as an expense when there is a legal or constructive obligation to make such payments as a result of past performance.

– II-16 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

1.12 Provisions and contingencies

Provisions are recognised when:

  • . the Group has a present obligation as a result of a past event;

  • . it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation; and

  • . a reliable estimate can be made of the obligation.

The amount of a provision is the present value of the expenditure expected to be required to settle the obligation using a pre-tax rate reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risk specific to the obligation.

Where some or all of the expenditure required to settle a provision is expected to be reimbursed by another party, the reimbursement shall be recognised when, and only when, it is virtually certain that reimbursement will be received if the entity settles the obligation. The reimbursement shall be treated as a separate asset. The amount recognised for the reimbursement shall not exceed the amount of the provision.

Provisions are not recognised for future operating losses.

If an entity has a contract that is onerous, the present obligation under the contract shall be recognised and measured as a provision.

A constructive obligation to restructure arises only when an entity:

  • . has a detailed formal plan for the restructuring, identifying at least:

  • the business or part of a business concerned;

  • the principal locations affected;

  • the location, function, and approximate number of employees who will be compensated for terminating their services;

  • the expenditures that will be undertaken; and

  • when the plan will be implemented; and

  • . has raised a valid expectation in those affected that it will carry out the restructuring by starting to implement that plan or announcing its main features to those affected by it.

– II-17 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

After their initial recognition, contingent liabilities recognised in business combinations that are recognised separately are subsequently measured at the higher of:

  • . the amount that would be recognised as a provision; and

  • . the amount initially recognised less cumulative amortisation.

1.13 Revenue

Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and represents the amounts receivable for goods and services provided in the normal course of business, net of trade discounts and volume rebates, and value added tax.

Interest is recognised, in profit or loss, using the effective interest rate method.

1.14 Translation of foreign currencies

Foreign currency transactions

A foreign currency transaction is recorded, on initial recognition in Rand, by applying to the foreign currency amount the spot exchange rate between the functional currency and the foreign currency at the date of the transaction.

At the end of the reporting period:

  • . foreign currency monetary items are translated using the closing rate;

  • . non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rate at the date of the transaction; and

  • . non-monetary items that are measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the date when the fair value was determined.

Exchange differences arising on the settlement of monetary items or on translating monetary items at rates different from those at which they were translated on initial recognition during the period or in previous Group financial statements are recognised in profit or loss in the period in which they arise.

When a gain or loss on a non-monetary item is recognised to other comprehensive income and accumulated in equity, any exchange component of that gain or loss is recognised to other comprehensive income and accumulated in equity. When a gain or loss on a non-monetary item is recognised in profit or loss, any exchange component of that gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss.

Cash flows arising from transactions in a foreign currency are recorded in Rand by applying to the foreign currency amount the exchange rate between the Rand and the foreign currency at the date of the cash flow.

– II-18 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

2. NEW STANDARDS AND INTERPRETATIONS

2.1 Standards and interpretations not yet effective

The Group and the Company have adopted all of the new and revised standards and interpretations issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (‘‘IASB’’) and the International Financial Reporting Committee of the IASB that are effective for the preparation of its Financial Information throughout the Relevant Periods.

In addition, the Group and the Company has not early applied the new and revised standards and interpretation that have been issued but are not yet effective throughout the Relevant Periods. The directors of the Company anticipate that the application of these new and revised standards and interpretation will have no material impact on the results and the financial position of the Group on the Company.

3. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

Group

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Plant & Machinery
Total
Cost/
Valuation
378,582
16,698
29,504
145,665
690,315
32,797
1,374,365
2,667,926
2011
Accumulated
depreciation
(86,159)
(5,210)
(4,640)
(26,791)
(157,281)
(14,120)

(294,201)
Carrying
value
292,423
11,488
24,864
118,874
533,034
18,677
1,374,365
2,373,725
Cost/
Valuation
99,259
4,307

58,442
490,315
32,797

685,120
2010
Accumulated
depreciation
(10,656)
(893)

(5,934)
(49,218)
(6,377)

(73,078)
Carrying
value
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420
612,042

Company

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Total
Cost/
Valuation
378,582
16,698
29,504
145,665
690,315
32,797
1,293,561
2011
Accumulated
depreciation
(86,159)
(5,210)
(4,640)
(26,791)
(157,281)
(14,120)
(294,201)
Carrying
value
292,423
11,488
24,864
118,874
533,034
18,677
999,360
Cost/
Valuation
99,259
4,307

58,442
490,315
32,797
685,120
2010
Accumulated
depreciation
(10,656)
(893)

(5,934)
(49,218)
(6,377)
(73,078)
Carrying
value
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420
612,042

– II-19 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Reconciliation of property, plant and equipment — Group 2011

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Plant & Machinery
Opening
balance
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420

612,042
Additions
279,323
12,391
29,504
87,223
200,000

1,374,365
1,982,806
Depreciation
(75,503)
(4,317)
(4,640)
(20,857)
(108,063)
(7,743)

(221,123)
Total
292,423
11,488
24,864
118,874
533,034
18,677
1,374,365
2,373,725

Reconciliation of property, plant and equipment — Group 2010

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Total
Opening
balance






Additions
99,259
4,307

58,442
490,315
32,797
685,120
Depreciation
(10,656)
(893)

(5,934)
(49,218)
(6,377)
(73,078)
Total
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420
612,042

Reconciliation of property, plant and equipment — Company 2011

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Opening
balance
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420
612,042
Additions
279,323
12,391
29,504
87,223
200,000

608,441
Depreciation
(75,503)
(4,317)
(4,640)
(20,857)
(108,063)
(7,743)
(221,123)
Total
292,423
11,488
24,864
118,874
533,034
18,677
999,360

– II-20 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Reconciliation of property, plant and equipment — Company 2010

Computer equipment
Computer software
Field equipment
Furniture and fixtures
Motor vehicles
Office equipment
Total
4.
INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Group
Opening
balance






Additions
99,259
4,307

58,442
490,315
32,797
685,120
Depreciation
(10,656)
(893)

(5,934)
(49,218)
(6,377)
(73,078)
Total
88,603
3,414

52,508
441,097
26,420
612,042
Computer software
Exploration assets
Total
Computer software
Exploration assets
Total
Computer software
Exploration assets
Total
Cost/
Valuation
486,806
193,058,564
193,545,370
Cost/
Valuation
20,158
47,282,141
47,302,299
Cost/
Valuation
14,500
36,938,212
36,952,712
2011
Accumulated
depreciation
(88,789)

(88,789)
2010
Accumulated
depreciation
(10,760)

(10,760)
2009
Accumulated
depreciation
(4,830)

(4,830)
Carrying value
398,017
193,058,564
193,456,581
Carrying value
9,398
47,282,141
47,291,539
Carrying value
9,670
36,938,212
36,947,882

– II-21 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Company

2011
Cost/
Valuation
Accumulated
depreciation
Carrying value
Computer software
486,806
(88,789)
398,017
Exploration assets
117,971,473

117,971,473
Total
118,458,279
(88,789)
118,369,490
2010
Cost/
Valuation
Accumulated
depreciation
Carrying value
Computer software
20,158
(10,760)
9,398
Exploration assets
12,908,248

12,908,248
Total
12,928,406
(10,760)
12,917,646
2009
Cost/
Valuation
Accumulated
depreciation
Carrying value
Exploration assets
7,277,487

7,277,487
Total
7,277,487

7,277,487
Reconciliation of intangible assets — Group 2011
Opening
balance
Additions
Amortisation
Impairment
loss
Total
Computer software
9,398
466,648
(78,029)

398,017
Exploration assets
47,282,141
146,347,046

(570,623)
193,058,564
47,291,539
146,813,694
(78,029)
(570,623)
193,456,581
Reconciliation of intangible assets — Group 2010
Opening
balance
Additions
Amortisation
Impairment
loss
Total
Computer software
9,670
5,658
(5,930)

9,398
Exploration assets
36,938,212
10,343,929


47,282,141
36,947,882
10,349,587
(5,930)

47,291,539
Carrying value
398,017
117,971,473
Carrying value
398,017
117,971,473
118,369,490
Carrying value
9,398
12,908,248
12,917,646
Carrying value
7,277,487
7,277,487
Total
398,017
193,058,564
193,456,581
Total
9,398
47,282,141
47,291,539

– II-22 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

Reconciliation of intangible assets — Group 2009

Computer software
Exploration assets
Opening
balance
14,500
15,385,402
15,399,902
Additions

22,698,860
22,698,860
Amortisation
(4,830)

(4,830)
Impairment
loss

(1,146,050)
(1,146,050)
Total
9,670
36,938,212
36,947,882

Reconciliation of intangible assets — Company 2011

Computer software
Exploration assets
Opening
balance
9,398
12,908,248
12,917,646
Additions
466,648
105,063,225
105,529,873
Amortisation
(78,029)

(78,029)
Impairment
loss


Total
398,017
117,971,473
118,369,490

Reconciliation of intangible assets — Company 2010

Computer software
Exploration assets
Opening
balance

7,277,487
7,277,487
Additions
20,158
5,630,761
5,650,919
Other
changes
movements
(9,660)

(9,660)
Impairment
loss
(1,100)

(1,100)
Total
9,398
12,908,248
12,917,646

Reconciliation of intangible assets — Company 2009

Exploration assets Opening
balance
673,181
Additions
6,604,306
Amortisation
Impairment
loss
Total
7,277,487

– II-23 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

5. INVESTMENTS IN SUBSIDIARIES

Name of company
Place &
date of
incorporation
% holding
2011
% holding
2010
% holding
2009
Taung Gold Exploration
(West) (Pty) Ltd
South Africa
23/09/2004
100.00%
100.00%
100.00%
Taung Gold Exploration
Limited
South Africa
28/04/1993
100.00%
100.00%
100.00%
Taung Gold (North
West) (Pty) Ltd
South Africa
31/01/2005
100.00%
100.00%
100.00%
Taung Gold (Free State)
(Pty) Ltd
South Africa
04/02/2005
100.00%
100.00%
100.00%
Ulinet (Pty) Ltd
South Africa
27/03/2009
100.00%
100.00%

Pluriclox (Pty) Ltd
South Africa
12/07/2010
100.00%


Sephaku Gold
Exploration (Pty) Ltd
South Africa
25/10/2004
100.00%


Capitalized as a result of
imputed interest
Carrying
amount
2011
7,875
7,875
100
100
100
100
25,000,000
25,016,150
13,969,262
38,985,412
Carrying
amount
2010
7,875
7,875
100
100
100


16,050
8,274,692
8,290,742
Carrying
amount
2009
7,875
7,875
100
100


15,950
2,655,004
2,670,954

All the subsidiaries are registered and operate within South Africa and principal activities of all the subsidiaries are the exploration, development and mining of gold and associated minerals. Refer to note 7 for information regarding loans to subsidiaries.

6. DEPOSITS FOR REHABILITATION

Deposits amounting to R20,000,000 (2010: R5,000,000; 2009: R5,000,000) were held in escrow or as guarantees until the fulfilment of certain suspensive conditions in terms of agreements to acquire certain rights and projects.

In terms of section 41 of the Minerals and Petroleum Development Act an applicant for a prospecting right, mining right or mining permit must make the prescribed financial provision for the rehabilitation or management of negative environmental impacts. The Group made deposits to the amount of R1,340,350 (2010: R962,550; 2009: R886,550), with the Department of Mineral Resources in compliance therewith.

In addition the Group also provided guarantees to the value of R1,256,522 (2010: R1,107,317; 2009: RNil) to the Department of Mineral Resources. The funds are held for security in a short-term deposit account as per note 9.

– II-24 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

7. LOANS TO GROUP COMPANIES

Subsidiaries
Taung Gold (West) (Pty) Ltd
Taung Gold Exploration Limited
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Ltd
Ulinet (Pty) Ltd
Sephaku Gold Exploration (Pty) Ltd
Pluriclox (Pty) Ltd
Imputed interest
2011
R









Group
2010
R









2009
R









2011
R
2,767,162
63,163,380
4,232,082
5,531,621
1,425,752
3,843,190
1,566,806
82,529,993
(5,694,570)
76,835,423
Company
2010
R
1,494,259
66,440,783
2,036,092
2,763,831
248,000

2009
R
721,488
34,803,799
1,121,952
2,396,943



39,044,182
(2,655,004)
36,389,178
72,982,965
(5,619,688)
67,363,277

These unsecured loans are interest free and have no fixed terms of repayment. In the opinion of the directors, the loans are not repayable within twelve months since the end of the reporting period.

8. OTHER RECEIVABLES

Deposits
VAT
Other receivables
2011
R
349,895
640,577
1,032,937
2,023,409
Group
2010
R

663,959
4,142,558
4,806,517
2009
R

881,419
1,147,534
2,028,953
2011
R
349,895
296,383
2,202,693
2,848,971
Company
2010
R

351,119
4,643,732
4,994,851
2009
R

270,546
870,913
1,141,459

9. SHORT-TERM DEPOSITS

Short-term deposits 2011
R
2,469,118
Group
2010
R
26,818,892
2009
R
2011
R
517,156
Company
2010
R
160,000
2009
R

The short-term deposits are held for guarantees provided to the Department of Mineral Resources. In the 2010 financial year a further guarantee of R25,000,000 was held for Harmony Gold Mines Company Limited as deposit for the acquisition of the Jeanette Project.

– II-25 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

10. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

Cash and cash equivalents
consist of:
Cash on hand
Bank balances
Call account
2011
R
97,554
245,140,044
24,990,448
270,228,046
Group
2010
R
34,332
132,012
1,578,334
1,744,678
2009
R
41,906
2,339,573

2,381,479
2011
R
53,200
245,114,461
24,990,448
270,158,109
Company
2010
R
5,110
91,807
1,578,334
1,675,251
2009
R
2,110
1,819,139
1,821,249

Credit quality of cash at bank and short term deposits, excluding cash on hand

The credit quality of cash at bank and short term deposits, excluding cash on hand that are neither past due nor impaired have been assessed by reference to external credit ratings of The Fitch Ratings of January 2011:

Credit rating
F1+ (zaf)
2011
R
272,599,610
Group
2010
R
28,529,238
2009
R
2,339,573
2011
R
270,622,065
Company
2010
R
1,830,141
2009
R
1,819,139

11. LOANS FROM SHAREHOLDERS

D Twist
CRD de Bruin
JG Barkhuizen
Sephaku Gold Holdings (Pty) Ltd
2011
R
45,030


5,269,653
5,314,683
Group
2010
R



5,269,653
5,269,653
2009
R
423,179
220,400
185,060
7,826,384
8,655,023
2011
R
45,030


5,269,653
5,314,683
Company
2010
R



5,269,653
5,269,653
2009
R
423,179
220,400
185,060
7,826,384
8,655,023

The loans are unsecured, bear no interest and are repayable on demand.

12. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES

Trade payables
Advances — African Precious
Minerals Limited
Accrued leave pay
2011
R
2,352,253
5,404,810
972,948
8,730,011
Group
2010
R
3,953,506
5,803,656
362,288
10,119,450
2009
R
2,145,648
10,411,420
208,861
12,765,929
2011
R
1,351,890
5,405,170

6,757,060
Company
2010
R
1,159,544
5,803,656

6,963,200
2009
R
1,908,599
10,411,420
12,320,019

– II-26 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

The amount due to African Precious Minerals Limited is unsecured, bears no interest and has no fixed terms of repayment.

The average credit period on purchases is 30 days. The Company and the Group have financial risk management policies in place to ensure that all payables are paid within the pre-agreed credit terms.

The following is an aged analysis of trade payable presented based on the invoice date at the end of the period.

0–60 days 2,352,253 3,953,506 2,145,648 1,351,890 1,159,544 1,908,599

13. SHARE CAPITAL

Authorised
500,000,000 ordinary shares of
R0.001 each
Reconciliation of number of shares
issued:
Reported as at beginning of
the period
Issue of shares — ordinary shares
2011
R
500,000
79,501,582
58,040,000
137,541,582
Group
2010
R
500,000
68,680,153
10,821,429
79,501,582
2009
R
500,000
110,000
68,570,153
68,680,153
2011
R
500,000
79,501,582
58,040,000
137,541,582
Company
2010
R
500,000
68,680,153
10,821,429
79,501,582
2009
R
500,000
110,000
68,570,153
68,680,153

The unissued ordinary shares are under the control of the directors until the next annual general meeting of the Company.

Issued
Ordinary
Share premium
2011
R
137,542
483,671,643
483,809,185
Group
2010
R
79,502
89,579,683
89,659,185
2009
R
68,680
35,498,360
35,567,040
2011
R
137,542
483,671,643
483,809,185
Company
2010
R
79,502
89,579,683
89,659,185
2009
R
68,680
35,498,360
35,567,040

During the 2010 financial year, 10,821,429 shares were issued at R5-00. Commission amounting to R15,000 was paid on the capital raised. During the period under review, 32,250,000 shares were issued (see below) at R5-00. 5,000,000 shares were issued at R5-00 for the acquisition of Sephaku Gold Exploration (Pty) Ltd. A further 20,790,000 shares were issued at R10-00 each (2010: 10,821,429 shares at R5-00; 2009: 62,627,297 shares at R0-10 and 5,942,856 shares at R5-00). During the period under review no commission was paid on the capital raised (2010: R15,000; 2009: R410,080). Subsequent to year end a further 710,000 shares were issued at R10-00 each. Commission will become payable once the transaction whereby Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (‘‘Wing Hing’’) acquires up to 86.966% of the issued shares of the Company is approved by the shareholders of Wing Hing. The commission will be settled by the issue of 4,500,000 shares. The Company is in the process of finalising the issue of 30,800,000 warrants which will enable the holders of the warrants to subscribe for 30,800,000 shares of the Company at R10-00 each on or before the date on which Wing Hing acquires the controlling interest in the Company. The capital was raised to provide working capital for the Group.

– II-27 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

During the 2011 financial year, a total of 23,645,210 options were granted to staff with exercise prices ranging from R4-95 to R9-90 and exercisable for a period of five years from the date of granting.

The Company entered into a subscription agreement with Electrum Strategic Exploration Limited (‘Electrum’) in May 2009 in terms of which Electrum undertook to subscribe for 21.5 million units (‘Units’). Each Unit comprises one ordinary share in the share capital of the Company and two warrants, each of which entitles the holder to subscribe for one ordinary share in the share capital of the Company at a price of R5.00 each. The 43 million warrants referred to above are divided into 21.5 million ‘‘P’’ Warrants and 21.5 million ‘‘Harmony’’ Warrants. Electrum subscribed for half of the Units in June 2009, purchasing 10.75 million shares for R53.75 million. All conditions precedent were met during June 2010 and Electrum subscribed for the remaining 10.75 million shares and exercised the Harmony options at R5-00 per share. The 21.5 million P Warrants are to be exercised at a future date but no later than 5 years after the closing date set out in the May 2009 agreement between Taung and Electrum. As the warrants confer a right to a fixed number of shares for a fixed amount of cash, the warrants are classified as equity and will only be accounted for once the warrants are exercised.

14. RESERVES — SHARE BASED PAYMENTS

The Company has a share option scheme for management and staff. In accordance with the terms of the plan, all management and staff may be granted options to purchase ordinary shares at an exercise price that is between 1% and 5% less than the market value of the shares at the date options are awarded.

Each employee’s share option converts to one ordinary share of the Company on exercise. No amounts are paid or are payable by the recipient on receipt of the option. The option carry neither rights to dividends nor voting rights. All options vested on the date of grant and options may be exercised within 5 years from the date of grant.

Share Option — Group and Company
Granted May 2010 and July 2010 to staff
Granted May 2010 and July 2010 to management
Granted September 2010 to staff
Granted September 2010 to management
Granted November 2010 to staff
Granted November 2010 to management
Number
Weighted Fair
value
3,036,000
2.19
9,939,312
3.38
1,908,000
3.27
6,056,737
5.00
679,000
4.36
2,026,161
6.64
23,645,210
Total value
6,657,032
33,592,498
6,248,275
30,313,001
2,960,053
13,454,876
93,225,735

Weighted average share price at vesting date of options was R 5-00 to R10-00.

Outstanding options
Options with exercise price of R4-95
Options with exercise price of R7-425
Options with exercise price of R9-90
Exercise date
within one year
12,975,312
7,964,737
2,705,161
23,645,210
Exercise date
from two to
five years



Exercise date
after five years


All options were granted during the 2011 financial year and no options have been exercised or have lapsed to date.

– II-28 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Information on options granted during the year

Fair value was determined by using the Cox Cross Rubinstein bi-nominal tree model. The following inputs were used:

  • . Weighted average share price, R5-00 to R10-00

  • . Exercise price, R4-95 to R9-90

  • . Expected volatility, 74.77% to 77.82%

  • . Option life, 5 years

  • . Expected dividends, Nil

  • . For early exercise it was assumed that non-managerial staff would exercise their options within one year and managerial staff would exercise their options over three years.

Total expenses of R93,225,735 (2010: RNil; 2009: RNil) related to equity-settled share based payments transactions were recognised in 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively. Of this R29,079,741 (2010: RNil; 2009: RNil) was capitalised against intangible assets and R64,145,994 (2010: RNil; 2009: RNil) was expensed through the statement of comprehensive income, based on the actual time allocated of each employee over the past 12 months to either intangible assets or expenses.

15. OPERATING LOSS

Operating loss for the three years ended 28 February 2011 is stated after accounting for the following:

Administration expenses
Amortisation on intangible assets
Auditor’s remuneration
Consulting fees
Travel & accommodation
Depreciation on property, plant
and equipment
Employee costs
Employee cost capitalised and
recouped
Pre-granting costs written off
Impairment exploration assets
Share-based payments — Options
to staff
Overheads charged by African
Nickel
Overheads charged by Sephaku
Management
Profit on foreign exchange
difference
2011
R
1,463,640
78,029
554,144
3,183,808
1,633,265
122,657
18,571,902
(9,091,695)
4,998,565
570,623
64,145,994
687,736
1,200,142
(1,171,716)
Group
2010
R
689,333
5,930
140,986
778,511
521,597
73,078
10,348,486
(6,249,902)
1,485,467


524,271
1,682,848
(88,855)
2009
R
2,498,452
4,830
60,000
21,943


6,511,900
(4,559,980)

1,146,050


1,795,919
(57,077)
2011
R
1,255,217
78,029
425,144
3,183,168
1,581,919
122,657




64,145,994
39,818
247,532
(1,171,716)
Company
2010
R
515,562
1,100
81,656
724,573
490,247
73,078
8,255




179,558
206,600
(88,855)
2009
R
2,256,451

20,000
10,270


4,500





106,407
(57,077)

– II-29 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

The overheads charged by Sephaku Management and African Nickel include a charge for the leasing of the offices by the Company. The amount was not separately determined and therefore cannot be disclosed as a separate line item.

16. INTEREST RECEIVED

Banks and financial institutions
Imputed interest
2011
R
5,571,207

5,571,207
Group
2010
R
1,843,053

1,843,053
2009
R
135,711

135,711
2011
R
4,773,982
5,619,688
10,393,670
Company
2010
R
900,439
2,655,004
3,555,443
2009
R
131,313
131,313

17. TAXATION

No provision has been made for 2011 tax as the Group has no taxable income. The estimated tax loss available for set off against future taxable income is R32,891,259 (2010: R17,384,039; 2009: R9,855,363). In addition an estimated capital allowance of R90,584,944 (2010: R47,169,908; 2009: R36,825,979) will be available to the Group for set-off against future mining income. The cumulative loss of the Company available for the Company to set-off against future income amounts to R658,195 (2010: R3,153,818; 2009: R2,241,755). The estimated capital allowance of the Company which will be available for deduction against future mining income amounts to R42,971,473 (2010: R12,908,248; 2009: R7,277,487). Due to the exploration activities of the Group, it is not probable that the Group will be in a profitable position in the foreseeable future. Therefore, the deferred asset recognised is limited to the amount of the deferred tax liability recognised. Excluded from the estimated capital allowance is an amount of R75,000,000 which was paid for the acquisition of the Jeanette project. In terms of current legislation, a portion of this amount will be allowed as a capital allowance. As at reporting date, the amount allowed as a deduction has not yet been determined.

The income tax expense can be reconciled as follows:

Profit/(Loss) before taxation
Income tax expense at 28%
Tax effect of loss not recognised
Taxation
2011
R
(81,376,315)
(22,785,368)
22,785,368
Group
2010
R
(8,068,942)
(2,259,303)
2,259,303
2009
R
(7,286,381)
(2,040,186)
2,040,186
2011
R
(59,514,513)
(16,664,064)
16,664,064
Company
2010
R
1,363,526
381,787
(381,787)
2009
R
(2,209,238)
(618,587)
618,587

– II-30 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

18. CASH USED IN OPERATIONS

Profit/(Loss) before taxation
Adjustments for:
Depreciation and amortisation
Interest received
Finance costs
Impairment of exploration assets
Share-based payments — Options
to staff
Changes in working capital:
Trade and other receivables
Trade and other payables
2011
R
(81,376,315)
200,686
(5,571,207)
428
570,623
64,145,994
(874,645)
(1,376,949)
(24,281,385)
Group
2010
R
(8,068,942)
79,008
(1,843,053)
245
1,485,467

(2,773,005)
1,956,724
(9,163,556)
2009
R
(7,286,381)
4,830
(135,711)
55
1,146,050

658,817
1,710,357
(3,901,983)
2011
R
(59,514,513)
200,686
(10,393,670)
421

64,145,994
(1,534,697)
(201,581)
(7,297,360)
Company
2010
R
1,363,526
74,178
(3,555,443)
143


(4,102,105)
(500,342)
(6,720,043)
2009
R
(2,209,238)

(131,313)



(1,084,196)
1,751,198
(1,673,549)

19. ACQUISITION OF ASSETS THROUGH PURCHASE OF SUBSIDIARIES

Net assets acquired
Intangible assets
Cash
Satisfied by
Cash
Equity — 5,000,000 ordinary
shares
Net cash outflow on acquisition
Cash consideration paid
Cash acquired
2011
R
24,999,593
507
25,000,100
(100)
(25,000,000)
(25,000,100)
(100)
507
407
Group
2010
R

100
100
(100)

(100)
(100)
100
2009
R








2011
R






(100)

(100)
Company
2010
R






(100)

(100)
2009
R



– II-31 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

20. RELATED PARTIES

Relationships

Subsidiaries Refer to note 5 Shareholder with significant influence Sephaku Gold Holdings (Pty) Ltd (owns a 18.5% holding in Taung Gold Limited (Feb 2010: 25.9%)) Members of key management Directors of the Company

Related party balances

Loan accounts/Debtors/Creditors
— Owing (to) by related parties
Sephaku Gold Holdings (Pty) Ltd
CRD de Bruin — Director of the
Company
D Twist — Director of the
Company
Loans to subsidiaries by holding
Company
Taung Gold Exploration (West)
(Pty) Ltd
Taung Gold Exploration Limited
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Ltd
Ulinet (Pty) Ltd
Pluriclox (Pty) Ltd
Sephaku Gold Exploration (Pty) Ltd
Related party transactions
Consultation fees
D Twist — Director of the
Company
2011
R
(5,269,653)

(45,030)







513,216
Group
2010
R
(5,269,653)









475,000
2009
R
(7,826,384)
220,400
(423,179)







2011
R
(5,269,653)

(45,030)
2,767,162
63,163,380
4,232,082
5,531,621
1,425,752
1,566,806
3,843,190
513,216
Company
2010
R
(5,269,653)


1,494,259
66,440,783
2,036,092
2,763,831
248,000


475,000
2009
R
(7,826,384)
220,400
(423,179)
721,488
34,803,799
1,121,952
2,396,943


– II-32 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

21. DIRECTORS’ EMOLUMENTS

The amounts below comprise of the gross remuneration paid to directors of the Company. Remuneration directly attributable to exploration expenses have been capitalised against the relevant projects. Remuneration paid to non-executive directors comprises amounts charged to the Company relating to the allocation of the directors remuneration on a time basis, paid by other entities. Costs allocated to non-group entities comprise costs allocated on a time basis to entities not part of the Group.

Executive

2011
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
SH Rosser
SD Steyn
D Twist
D Strydom
CRD de Bruin
NA Herrick
2010
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
SH Rosser
SD Steyn
D Twist
D Strydom
CRD de Bruin
Remuneration
5,513,136
Salary
537,417
1,154,386

1,130,217
1,042,126
1,294,332
5,158,478
Remuneration
2,195,070
Salary
258,105
989,577

1,015,200
324,453
2,587,335
Allocated to
non-group
entities
1,016,540
Bonus
44,660
96,074
42,768
104,060
287,822
97,222
672,606
Allocated to
non-group
entities

435,203
Bonus
21,384
87,340
39,333
39,334

187,391
Charged by
non-group
entities
118,616
Options
20,850
58,086
75,550
107,300
109,337
126,500
497,623
Charged by
non-group
entities

324,453
Options





Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances



120,000
163,754
35,831
319,585
Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances

60,000

120,000

180,000
Total
6,648,292
Total
602,927
1,308,546
118,318
1,461,577
1,603,039
1,553,885
6,648,292
Total
2,954,726
Total
279,489
1,136,917
39,333
1,174,534
324,453
2,954,726

– II-33 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

2009
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
SH Rosser
JH de Bruin
SD Steyn
D Strydom
CRD de Bruin
Remuneration
403,593
Salary
234,657
132,721
80,254
260,834
297,993
1,006,459
Allocated to
non-group
entities*
91,779
Bonus
20,572




20,572
Charged by
non-group
entities**
558,827
Options





Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances
19,432
2,736
5,000


27,168
Total
1,054,199
Total
274,661
135,457
85,254
260,834
297,993
1,054,199

Non-executive

2011
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
L Mohuba
DL Kyle
MF DeGuire
I Levental
Remuneration
161,998
Salary
292,443



292,443
Allocated to
non-group
entities*

Bonus
30,323



30,323
Charged by
non-group
entities**
292,443
Options
24,925
10,500
48,125
48,125
131,675
Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances




Total
454,441
Total
347,691
10,500
48,125
48,125
454,441

– II-34 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

2010
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
L Mohuba
2009
In connection with the affairs
of the Company or its
subsidiaries
L Mohuba
NR Crafford-Lazarus
Remuneration

Salary
264,250
Remuneration
13,667
Salary
175,826
104,778
280,604
Allocated to
non-group
entities

Bonus

Allocated to
non-group
entities


Bonus
13,667

13,667
Charged by
non-group
entities
264,250
Options

Charged by
non-group
entities

280,604
Options


Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances

Gain on
exercise of
options

Expenses and
allowances


Total
264,250
Total
264,250
Total
294,271
Total
189,493
104,778
294,271
  • Represents amounts allocated to other companies outside the Taung group on a time basis.

** Represents costs paid by Sephaku Management and allocated to Taung on a time basis.

22. EMPLOYEE’S EMOLUMENTS

Of the five individuals with the highest emoluments in the Group, three (2010: two; 2009: none) are directors of the Company whose emoluments are included in the above disclosures. The amount for the remaining individuals are disclosed below.

Salaries and other benefits
Bonuses
Options
2011
3,754,654
326,073
293,849
4,374,576
2010
3,027,404
254,076

3,281,480
2009
3,899,728
373,560
4,273,288

– II-35 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Their emoluments are within the following bands:

RNil to R1,000,000
R1,000,000 to R1,500,000
Number of employees
2011
2010

1
2
2
2009
4
1

23. RISK MANAGEMENT

Capital risk management

The Group’s and Company’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group’s and Company’s ability to continue as a going concern in order to provide returns for shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders. The further exploration and development of the exploration assets will require additional capital. The continuing development of the Group’s and the Company’s mineral resources and reserves will depend on the ability of directors to raise additional funds.

The capital structure of the Company and the Group consists of cash and cash equivalents disclosed in note 10, and equity as disclosed in the statement of financial position.

The Company’s and the Group’s capital management objective is to achieve an optimal weighted average cost of capital while continuing to safeguard the Company’s ability to meet its liquidity requirements (including its commitments in respect of capital expenditure).

There are no externally imposed capital requirements.

Liquidity risk

The Group’s and the Company’s risk to liquidity is a result of the funds available to cover future commitments. The Company and the Group manage liquidity risk through an ongoing review of future commitments and credit facilities.

Cash flow forecasts are prepared and adequate utilised borrowing facilities are monitored.

– II-36 –

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

APPENDIX II

The table below analyses the financial liabilities of the Group and the Company based on the remaining period at the statement of financial position to the contractual maturity date. The amounts disclosed in the table are the contractual undiscounted cash flows. Balances due within 12 months equal their carrying balances as the impact of discounting is not significant.

At 2011
Trade and other payables
Loans from shareholders
At 2010
Trade and other payables
Loans from shareholders
At 2009
Trade and other payables
Loans from shareholders
THE
GROUP
Less than
1 year
8,730,011
5,314,683
Less than
1 year
10,119,450
5,269,653
Less than
1 year
12,765,929
8,655,023
THE
COMPANY
Less than
1 year
6,757,060
5,314,683
Less than
1 year
6,963,200
5,269,653
Less than
1 year
12,320,019
8,655,023

Interest rate risk

The Group and the Company have limited exposure to interest rate risk as the Group has no interest bearing liabilities. Cash funds are deposited with reputable financial institutions until such time as the funds are required. No other assets or liabilities are exposed to any interest rate risks.

The Group and the Company are sensitive to movement in South African interest rate which is the primary interest rate to which the Group and Company are exposed. The funds deposited with financial institutions is the only asset or liability exposed to the interest rate risk and the interest earned is linked to the prime rate of lending. Should the interest rate have been 1% higher or lower, the estimated increase or decrease in the interest received would have been R678,879 (2010: R270,147; 2009: R10,702) for the Company and R679,055 (2010: R281,403; 2009: R14,081) for the Group.

Credit risk

The major credit granted relates to loans granted to wholly owned subsidiaries. It is estimated that the realisable values of the project in each subsidiary exceeds the value of the loan and as such the directors are of the opinion that the loans will be recoverable.

– II-37 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

24. FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES BY CATEGORY

The accounting policies for financial instruments have been applied to the line items below:

Financial assets

2011
Trade and other receivables
Short-term deposits
Cash and cash equivalents
2010
Trade and other receivables
Short-term deposits
Cash and cash equivalents
2009
Trade and other receivables
Cash and cash equivalents
Financial liabilities
2011
Loans from shareholders
Trade and other payables
2010
Loans from shareholders
Trade and other payables
2009
Loans from shareholders
Trade and other payables
Group
Loans and
receivables
2,023,409
2,469,118
270,228,046
274,720,573
4,806,517
26,818,892
1,744,678
33,370,087
2,028,953
2,381,479
4,410,432
Group
Loans and
payables
5,314,683
8,730,011
14,044,694
5,269,653
10,119,450
15,389,103
8,655,023
12,765,929
21,420,952
Company
Loans and
receivables
2,848,971
517,156
270,158,109
273,524,236
4,994,851
160,000
1,675,251
6,830,102
1,141,459
1,821,249
2,962,708
Company
Loans and
payables
5,314,683
6,757,060
12,071,743
5,269,653
6,963,200
12,232,853
8,655,023
12,320,019
20,975,042

– II-38 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

25. EARNINGS/(LOSS) PER SHARE

No earnings/(loss) per share information is presented as its inclusion, for the purpose of this report, is not considered meaningful.

26. CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS

In preparing the Group financial statements, management is required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts represented in the Group financial statements and related disclosures. Use of available information and the application of judgement is inherent in the formation of estimates. Actual results in the future could differ from these estimates which may be material to the Group financial statements. Significant judgements include:

Critical accounting estimates and assumptions

Impairment testing

The Group reviews and tests the carrying value of assets when events or changes in circumstances suggest that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which identifiable cash flows are largely independent of cash flows of other assets and liabilities. If there are indications that impairment may have occurred, estimates are prepared of expected future cash flows for each group of assets. Expected future cash flows used to determine the value in use of intangible assets are inherently uncertain and could materially change over time.

Taxation

Judgement is required in determining the provision for income taxes due to the complexity of legislation. There are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Group recognises liabilities for anticipated tax audit issues based on estimates of whether additional taxes will be due. Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made.

The Group recognises the net future tax benefit related to deferred income tax assets to the extent that it is probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future. Assessing the recoverability of deferred income tax assets requires the Group to make significant estimates related to expectations of future taxable income. Estimates of future taxable income are based on forecasted cash flows from operations and the application of existing tax laws in each jurisdiction. To the extent that future cash flows and taxable income differ significantly from estimates, the ability of the Group to realise the net deferred tax assets recorded at the end of the reporting period could be impacted. Due to the nature of the potential cash generating units, there is not enough evidence to prove that it will be probable that taxable profits will be generated against which the deductible temporary differences can be utilised. Due to the fact that it is not probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future, no provision for a deferred tax asset was made by any of the Companies within the Group.

Critical judgements in applying the entities accounting policies

Exploration expenses capitalised

Exploration and evaluation expenses are those expenses incurred in connection with acquisition of rights to explore, investigate, examine and evaluate an area of mineralization including related overhead costs. The directors exercise judgment to determine if the costs associated with a specific project must be capitalised against the specific project or written off.

– II-39 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

Exploration assets are reviewed at reporting date and where the directors consider there to be indicators of impairment, impairment tests will be performed on the capitalised costs and any impairments will be recognised through the statement of comprehensive income.

27. CONTINGENCIES AND CAPITAL COMMITMENTS

On 10 September 2010, Pluriclox (Pty) Ltd, a subsidiary of Taung Gold Limited, entered into a sale agreement with Evander Gold Mines Limited for the acquisition of the Evander Project, subject to the approval of the transfer of the license by the Department of Mineral Resources. The total acquisition price is R225 million and a deposit of R20 million was paid during the current financial year.

During the 2010 financial year the Company purchased the prospecting right over the property known as Jeanette Prospecting area for an amount of R75 million. A R5 million deposit was paid and the balance of R70 million was payable upon the earlier of either the registration of the Deed of Cession or the date upon which transfer is affected by other agreed legal mechanism set out in the agreement.

There was no other capital expenditure contracted for but not provided for in the Group or Company financial statements.

There was no other capital expenditure authorised but not contracted for.

28. RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLANS

The Group and the Company had no retirement benefit plans.

29. SEGMENT INFORMATION

The only operating and reportable segment of the Group is gold mining. The Group’s operations and noncurrent assets are all located in South Africa

30. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

Subsequent to 28 February 2011, the Company issued 710,000 shares at a value of R10-00 each.

Once the transaction with Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited is finalised, commission will become payable to a third party which will be settled by the issue of 4,500,000 shares in the Company.

The Company is in the process of finalising the issue of 30,800,000 warrants which will enable the holders of the warrants to subscribe for 30,800,000 shares of the Company at R10-00 each on or before the date that Wing Hing acquires the controlling interest in the Company. The issue of warrants will not have a significant financial impact on the Group.

– II-40 –

APPENDIX II

FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE TAUNG GROUP

3. SUBSEQUENT FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

No audited financial statements have been prepared by the Company and the Group subsequent to 28 February 2011.

==> picture [145 x 49] intentionally omitted <==

Deloitte & Touche

Registered Auditors Per BG Joubert Johannesburg South Africa

28 July 2011

– II-41 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

  • A. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position

The unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of financial position of the Enlarged Group (the ‘‘Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position’’) has been prepared in accordance with Rule 4.29 of the Listing Rules for the purpose of illustrating the effects of the Acquisition as if the Acquisition had been completed at the date reported on (i.e. 31 March 2011).

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position is based on the consolidated statement of financial position of the Wing Hing Group at 31 March 2011 (as extracted from Wing Hing’s annual report for the year ended 31 March 2011) and the audited consolidated statement of financial position of Taung Gold at 28 February 2011 (as extracted from the financial information of Taung Gold as shown in Appendix II), after making pro forma adjustments relating to the Acquisition that are (i) directly attributable to the transaction concerned and not relating to future events or decisions; and (ii) factually supportable.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position should be read in conjunction with the historical financial information of the Wing Hing Group and other financial information included elsewhere in this circular. The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position does not take account of any trading or other transactions subsequent to the date of the financial statements included in the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position has been prepared by the Directors for illustrative purposes only and because of its hypothetical nature, it may not give a true picture of the financial position of the Wing Hing Group at 31 March 2011 or any future date.

– III-1 –

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

APPENDIX III

Wing Hing
Group
Taung Gold
Taung Gold
Aggregated
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
First
Completion
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
Electrum
Completion
As at
31-Mar-11
As at
28-Feb-11
As at
28-Feb-11
HK$’000
ZAR
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 1
Note 2
Note 3
Note 4
Note 5(i)
Note 5(ii)
Note 5(iii)
Note 5(iv)
Note 6
Note 7
Note 8
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
12,924
2,373,725
2,579
15,503
15,503
15,503
Goodwill




2,588,740
304,662
465,083
671,858
(2,932,884)
(1,097,459)


Intangible assets
281,120


281,120
281,120
281,120
Intangible assets — Computer
software

398,017
433
433
433
433
Intangible assets —
Exploration assets

193,058,564
209,796
209,796
4,509,204
4,719,000
4,719,000
Deposits

21,340,350
23,191
23,191
23,191
23,191
Prepayments
1,410


1,410
1,410
1,410
295,454
217,170,656
235,999
531,453
5,040,657
5,040,657
Current assets
Inventories
15


15
15
15
Trade and other receivables
48,412
2,023,409
2,199
50,611
50,611
50,611
Pledged bank deposits
5,921


5,921
5,921
5,921
Short-term deposits

2,469,118
2,683
2,683
2,683
2,683
Cash and bank balances
156,069
270,228,046
293,657
449,726
(24,000)
425,726
425,726
210,417
274,720,573
298,539
508,956
484,956
484,956
Assets classified as held for sale
87,360


87,360
87,360
87,360
297,777
274,720,573
298,539
596,316
572,316
572,316
Current liabilities
Loans from shareholders

5,314,683
5,776
5,776
5,776
5,776
Trade and other payables
30,757
8,730,011
9,487
40,244
40,244
40,244
Current tax liabilities
2,944


2,944
2,944
2,944
33,701
14,044,694
15,263
48,964
48,964
48,964
Non-current liabilities
Deferred tax liabilities
26,265


26,265
1,262,577
1,288,842
1,288,842
Provision for restoration cost
320


320
320
320
26,585


26,585
1,289,162
1,289,162
Net assets
532,945
477,846,535
519,275
1,052,220
4,274,847
4,274,847
Capital and reserves
Share capital
21,979
137,542
149
22,128
63,140
7,431
11,343
16,387
(149)
120,280
11,475
131,755
Share premium
274,183
483,671,643
525,606
799,789
2,525,600
297,231
453,740
655,471
(525,606)
4,206,225
459,010
4,665,235
Other reserves
162,250
93,225,735
101,308
263,558
(101,308)
162,250
(128,164)
34,086
Accumulated losses
(1,011) (99,188,385)
(107,788)
(108,799)
(24,000)
107,788
(1,097,459)
(1,122,470)
(1,122,470)
Equity attributable to owners of
Wing Hing
457,401
477,846,535
519,275
976,676
3,366,285
3,708,606
Non-controlling interests —
Wing Hing Group
75,544


75,544
75,544
75,544
Non-controlling interests —
Taung Gold




833,018
833,018
(342,321)
490,697
Total equity
532,945
477,846,535
519,275
1,052,220
4,274,847
4,274,847
5,040,657 15
50,611
5,921
2,683
425,726
484,956
87,360
572,316 5,776
40,244
2,944
48,964 1,288,842
320
1,289,162 4,274,847 131,755
4,665,235
34,086
(1,122,470)
3,708,606
75,544
490,697
4,274,847

– III-2 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position:

  1. The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of financial position of the Wing Hing Group at 31 March 2011 as disclosed in the published annual report of Wing Hing for the year ended 31 March 2011.

  2. The adjustments represent the inclusion of the assets, liabilities and equity of Taung Gold, as if the Acquisition had taken place at the date reported on (i.e. 31 March 2011). The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of financial position of Taung Gold at 28 February 2011 as disclosed in Appendix II to this circular. The Directors considered that no adjustment is necessary to the financial information of Taung Gold (which has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards) to align with the accounting policies of Wing Hing which comply with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards (‘‘HKFRSs’’) issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (‘‘HKICPA’’). For the purpose of the pro forma financial information, the financial information of Taung Gold has been translated into HK$ at the exchange rate of ZAR1 to HK$1.0867.

  3. The adjustments represent payment for estimated acquisition-related costs (including fees to legal advisers, financial adviser, reporting accountants, valuer, printer and other expenses) of approximately HK$24,000,000 in cash, which would be expensed in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income upon completion of the Acquisition in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standard 3 (Revised) ‘‘Business Combinations’’ (‘‘HKFRS 3 (Revised)’’) issued by the HKICPA.

  4. The adjustments represent fair value adjustment on intangible assets of Taung Gold of approximately HK$4,509,204,000 and the recognition of deferred tax on fair value adjustment at the South African tax rate of 28%. The estimated fair value of the intangible assets of Taung Gold is based on a professional valuation conducted by BMI Appraisals Limited which stated that a fair market value of the 100% interest in the Gold Mines as at 30 April 2011 was US$605,000,000 (equivalent to HK$4,719,000,000).

  5. The adjustments represent the settlement of the Consideration for the Acquisition on the First Completion Date which shall be satisfied by the issue of up to 9,830,106,088 new Wing Hing Shares at the Issue Price of HK$0.41 each and resulted in the Wing Hing Group holding 77.88% of the issued capital of Taung Gold, in the following manner:

  6. (i) Wing Hing shall allot and issue to the TG Sellers, the TG Consideration Shares (6,314,000,985 new Wing Hing Shares) credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the TG Sale Shares.

  7. (ii) Wing Hing shall issue to each of the Other TG Shareholders who has entered into a Deed of Adherence, the Other Consideration Shares (up to 743,079,165 new Wing Hing Shares) credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Other TG Sale Shares held by such Other TG Shareholders.

  8. (iii) Wing Hing shall issue to GoldCom the GoldCom Consideration Shares (up to 1,134,348,686 new Wing Hing Shares) credited as fully paid at the Issue Price for the Loan Note and delivery of the Put Option Agreements.

  9. (iv) Wing Hing shall issue to Mandra, the Arctic Consideration Shares (1,638,677,252 new Wing Hing Shares) credited as fully paid at the Issue Price, as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Arctic Sale Shares.

– III-3 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

For the purpose of the preparation of the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position, it has been assumed that the Issue Price of new Wing Hing Share approximated its fair value at the date of exchange.

  1. The adjustments reflect:

  2. (i) the estimated goodwill arising from the Acquisition of approximately HK$1,097,459,000;

  3. (ii) elimination of the share capital and pre-acquisition reserves of Taung Gold, as if the Acquisition had been completed at the date reported on; and

  4. (iii) recognition of 22.12% non-controlling interest of Taung Gold.

For the purpose of the preparation of the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position, it has been assumed that:

  • (i) the fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities (except intangible assets and deferred tax) of Taung Gold as at 28 February 2011 is assumed to be the same as their carrying amounts.

  • (ii) the estimated goodwill is measured as the excess of the estimated fair value of the consideration of approximately HK$4,030,343,000 over 77.88% of the adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold, as if the Acquisition had been completed at the date reported on. The adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold of approximately HK$3,765,902,000 represents the carrying amount of the net assets of Taung Gold of approximately HK$519,275,000 as at 28 February 2011 as adjusted for the fair value adjustment on intangible assets of Taung Gold of approximately HK$4,509,204,000 and the corresponding deferred tax effect of approximately HK$1,262,577,000. The estimated fair value of the consideration is based on 9,830,106,088 new Wing Hing Shares at the Issue Price of HK$0.41 each.

  • (iii) the amount of the 22.12% non-controlling interests of Taung Gold of approximately HK$833,018,000 has been calculated at 22.12% of the adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold.

Upon First Completion, 77.88% equity interests in Taung Gold would have been exchanged for Wing Hing’s Shares and become legally held by Wing Hing whilst 22.12% equity interests in Taung Gold would not be exchanged for Wing Hing’s Shares and would be held by the non-controlling shareholders.

Since the actual fair value of the consideration shares and the actual fair values of the assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities of Taung Gold on the date of completion of the Acquisition would be different from their estimated fair values used in the preparation of the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Financial Position presented above, the actual financial position and amount of goodwill arising from the Acquisition might be materially different from the estimated amounts shown in this Appendix.

  1. The adjustments represent the impairment of goodwill arising from the Acquisition which would be charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income upon completion of the Acquisition.

For the purpose of the preparation of the Pro Forma Financial Information, the Directors performed an impairment test of goodwill in accordance with the requirements of Hong Kong Accounting Standard 36 ‘‘Impairment of Assets’’ (‘‘HKAS 36’’) issued by the HKICPA, resulting in

– III-4 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

a full impairment of goodwill arising from the Acquisition immediately upon completion of the Acquisition. After completion of the Acquisition, in preparation of the consolidated financial statements of the Group for the next financial year, the Group will perform impairment testing on the cash-generating unit to which the goodwill has been allocated in accordance with the requirements of HKAS 36 and adopt the consistent accounting policies and principal assumptions for the above impairment test of the goodwill arising from the Acquisition. The reporting accountants (who are also the Company’s auditors for the time being) concurred with the Directors’ assessment of impairment of goodwill in the Pro Forma Financial Information and adoption of consistent accounting policies and principal assumptions in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements of the Enlarged Group after completion of the Acquisition.

  1. The adjustments reflect the acquisition of an additional of 9.09% equity interests in Taung Gold by the Wing Hing Group on the Electrum Completion Date, representing:

  2. (i) Electrum exercises its right to sell the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing, Wing Hing shall issue the Electrum Consideration Shares (up to 1,147,523,915 new Wing Hing Shares) on the Electrum Completion Date to Electrum as a complete discharge of Wing Hing’s obligation to pay for the Electrum Option Shares;

  3. (ii) the adjustment to non-controlling interests amounting to approximately HK$342,321,000; and

  4. (iii) the recognition of other reserves amounting to approximately HK$128,164,000 being the difference between the estimated fair value of the Electrum Consideration Shares amounting to approximately HK$470,485,000 and adjustment to non-controlling interests amounting to approximately HK$342,321,000.

Upon Electrum Completion, 86.97% equity interests in Taung Gold would have been exchanged for Wing Hing’s Shares and become legally held by Wing Hing whilst 13.03% equity interests in Taung Gold would not be exchanged for Wing Hing’s Shares and would be held by the non-controlling shareholders. Therefore, the non-controlling interest upon Electrum Completion would be 13.03%. Accordingly, a pro forma adjustment of approximately HK$342,321,000 is made to adjust the noncontrolling interest from 22.12% to 13.03% of the adjusted net amount of identifiable assets and liabilities of Taung Gold (i.e. HK$490,697,000 or 13.03% of HK$3,765,902,000).

– III-5 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

The unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of comprehensive income of the Enlarged Group (the ‘‘Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income’’) has been prepared in accordance with Rule 4.29 of the Listing Rules for the purpose of illustrating the effects of the Acquisition as if the Acquisition had been completed at the commencement of the period being reported on (i.e. 1 April 2010).

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income is based on the audited consolidated statement of comprehensive income of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 (as extracted from Wing Hing’s annual report for the year ended 31 March 2011) and the audited consolidated statement of comprehensive income of Taung Gold for the year ended 28 February 2011 (as extracted from the financial information of Taung Gold as shown in Appendix II), after making pro forma adjustments relating to the Acquisition that are (i) directly attributable to the transaction concerned and not relating to future events or decisions; and (ii) factually supportable.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income should be read in conjunction with the historical financial information of the Wing Hing Group and other financial information included elsewhere in this circular. The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income does not take account of any trading or other transactions subsequent to the date of the financial statements included in the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income.

– III-6 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income has been prepared by the Directors for illustrative purposes only and because of its hypothetical nature, it may not give a true picture of the results of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 or for any future period.

Revenue
Cost of sales
Gross profit
Other income
Administrative and operating expenses
Payment for acquisition-related costs
Impairment of goodwill arising from the
Acquisition
Finance costs
Loss before tax
Income tax expense
Loss for the year
Other comprehensive income, net of
income tax
Exchange differences on translating
foreign operation
Total comprehensive expense for the
year
Wing Hing
Group
Year ended
31-Mar-11
HK$’000
Note 9
43,905
(35,426)
8,479
224
(32,266)


(408)
(23,971)
(162)
(24,133)
16,725
(7,408)
Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
ZAR



6,742,923
(88,118,810)


(428)
(81,376,315)

(81,376,315)

(81,376,315)
Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
HK$’000
Note 10



7,328
(95,759)



(88,431)

(88,431)

(88,431)
Aggregated
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 11
Note 12
43,905
(35,426)
8,479
7,552
(128,025)

(24,000)

(1,097,459)
(408)
(112,402)
(162)
(112,564)
16,725
(95,839)
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
First
Completion
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 13
43,905
(35,426)
8,479
7,552
(128,025)
(24,000)
(1,097,459)
(408)
(1,233,861)
(162)
(1,234,023)
16,725
(1,217,298)
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
Electrum
Completion
HK$’000
43,905
(35,426)
8,479
7,552
(128,025)
(24,000)
(1,097,459)
(408)
(1,233,861)
(162)
(1,234,023)
16,725
(1,217,298)

Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income:

  1. The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of comprehensive income of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 as disclosed in the published annual report of Wing Hing for the year ended 31 March 2011.

  2. The adjustments represent the inclusion of items of comprehensive income of Taung Gold, as if the Acquisition had taken place at the commencement of the period being reported on (i.e. 1 April 2010). The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of comprehensive income of Taung Gold for the year ended 28 February 2011 as disclosed in Appendix II to this circular. The Directors considered that no adjustment is necessary to the financial information of Taung Gold (which has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards) to align with the accounting policies of Wing Hing which comply with HKFRSs. For the purpose of the pro forma financial information, the financial information of Taung Gold has been translated into HK$ at the exchange rate of ZAR1 to HK$1.0867.

  3. The adjustments represent payment for estimated acquisition-related costs of approximately HK$24,000,000 in cash, which would be expensed in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income upon completion of the Acquisition in accordance with HKFRS 3 (Revised). This adjustment is not expected to have a continuing effect on the Enlarged Group.

– III-7 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

  1. The adjustments represent the impairment of goodwill arising from the Acquisition which would be charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income upon completion of the Acquisition, further details of which are set out in Note 7 above. The basis of calculation of the goodwill is set out in Note 6 above. This adjustment is not expected to have a continuing effect on the Enlarged Group.

  2. As explained in Notes 6 and 8 above, the non-controlling interest upon First Completion would be 22.12%. Upon Electrum Completion, the non-controlling interest would be reduced from 22.12% to 13.03%. The aforesaid reduction in non-controlling interest is not expected to have any effect on the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income and accordingly, no pro forma adjustment has been made.

Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

The unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of cash flows of the Enlarged Group (the ‘‘Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows’’) has been prepared in accordance with Rule 4.29 of the Listing Rules for the purpose of illustrating the effects of the Acquisition as if the Acquisition had been completed at the commencement of the period being reported on (i.e. 1 April 2010).

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows is based on the audited consolidated statement of cash flows of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 (as extracted from Wing Hing’s annual report for the year ended 31 March 2011) and the audited consolidated statement of cash flows of Taung Gold for the year ended 28 February 2011 (as extracted from the financial information of Taung Gold as shown in Appendix II), after making pro forma adjustments relating to the Acquisition that are (i) directly attributable to the transaction concerned and not relating to future events or decisions; and (ii) factually supportable.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows should be read in conjunction with the historical financial information of the Wing Hing Group and other financial information included elsewhere in this circular. The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows does not take account of any trading or other transactions subsequent to the date of the financial statements included in the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows has been prepared by the Directors for illustrative purposes only and because of its hypothetical nature, it may not give a true picture of the cash flows of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 or for any future period.

– III-8 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Cash flows from operating activities
Loss for the year
Adjustments for:
Payment for acquisition-related
costs
Impairment of goodwill arising from
the Acquisition
Income tax expense recognized in
profit or loss
Finance costs recognized in profit or
loss
Interest income
Gain on early redemption of
promissory note
Amortization of intangible assets
Expense recognized in respect of
equity-settled share-based
payments
Depreciation for property, plant and
equipment
Provision for restoration cost
Impairment of exploration assets
Impairment losses recognized on
other receivables
Operating cash flows before
movements in working capital
Inventories
Trade receivables
Prepayments, deposits and other
receivables
Trade payables
Other payables and accruals
Cash used in operations
Interest received
Interest paid
Income taxes paid
VAT movement
Net cash used in operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities
Interest received
Purchase of property, plant and
equipment
Cost capitalized in intangible assets
Payment for acquisition-related
costs
Acquisition of Taung Gold, net of
cash and cash equivalents
acquired
Subsidiary acquired
Refund/(Payment) of deposits for
acquisition of subsidiaries
Net cash outflow on acquisition of
subsidiaries
Increase in pledged bank deposits
Movement in short-term deposits
Net cash used in investing activities
Wing Hing
Group
Year ended
31-Mar-11
HK$’000
Note 14
(24,133)


162
408
(201)
(23)
2,181

1,802
320

8,105
Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
ZAR
(81,376,315)



428
(5,571,207)

78,029
64,145,994
122,657

570,623
Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
HK$’000
Note 15
(88,431)




(6,054)

85
69,707
133

620
Aggregated
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 16
Note 17
Note 18
(112,564)
(24,000)
(1,097,459)

24,000

1,097,459
162
408
(6,255)
(23)
2,266
69,707
1,935
320
620
8,105
(35,319)
39
(31,953)
(2,883)
(1,496)
27,548
(44,064)
6,054
(423)
(6)
28
(38,411)
201
(14,201)
(91,711)

(24,000)

1,896

(13,734)
(31,755)
(5,921)
26,461
(130,660)
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
First
Completion
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 19
(1,234,023)
24,000
1,097,459
162
408
(6,255)
(23)
2,266
69,707
1,935
320
620
8,105
(35,319)
39
(31,953)
(2,883)
(1,496)
27,548
(44,064)
6,054
(423)
(6)
28
(38,411)
201
(14,201)
(91,711)
(24,000)
1,896

(13,734)
(31,755)
(5,921)
26,461
(152,764)
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
Electrum
Completion
HK$’000
(1,234,023)
24,000
1,097,459
162
408
(6,255)
(23)
2,266
69,707
1,935
320
620
8,105
(11,379)
39
(31,953)
(1,933)

27,548
(22,029,791)


(874,645)
(1,376,949)
(23,940)


(950)
(1,496)
(35,319)
39
(31,953)
(2,883)
(1,496)
27,548
(17,678)

(423)
(6)
(24,281,385)
5,571,207
(428)

25,482
(26,386)
6,054


28
(44,064)
6,054
(423)
(6)
28
(18,107) (18,685,124) (20,304) (38,411)
201
(12,046)




8,000
(31,755)
(5,921)

(1,982,806)
(84,393,913)


407
(20,000,000)


24,349,774

(2,155)
(91,711)



(21,734)


26,461
201
(14,201)
(91,711)
(24,000)
1,896

(13,734)
(31,755)
(5,921)
26,461
(41,521) (82,026,538) (89,139) (152,764)

– III-9 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Cash flows from financing activities
Proceeds from issue of ordinary
shares
Share issue expenses
Proceeds from shareholders loan
Repayment of promissory note
Proceeds from exercise of options
Proceeds from exercise of warrants
Net cash generated by financing
activities
Net increase in cash and cash
equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at
beginning of the year
Effects of exchange rate changes on
the balance of cash held in
foreign currencies
Cash and cash equivalents at end of
the year
Wing Hing
Group
Year ended
31-Mar-11
HK$’000
Note 14
178,400
(3,371)

(30,000)
9,041
14,000
Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
ZAR
369,150,000

45,030


Taung Gold
Year ended
28-Feb-11
HK$’000
Note 15
401,155

49


Aggregated
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 16
Note 17
Note 18
579,555
(3,371)
49
(30,000)
9,041
14,000
569,274
400,203
47,803
(1,896)
1,720
449,726
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
First
Completion
Pro forma
adjustment
HK$’000
HK$’000
Note 19
579,555
(3,371)
49
(30,000)
9,041
14,000
569,274
378,099
45,907
1,720
425,726
Pro forma
Enlarged
Group upon
Electrum
Completion
HK$’000
579,555
(3,371)
49
(30,000)
9,041
14,000
168,070 369,195,030 401,204 569,274
108,442
45,907
1,720
268,483,368
1,744,678
291,761
1,896
378,099
45,907
1,720
156,069 270,228,046 293,657 425,726

Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows:

  1. The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of cash flows of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 as disclosed in the published annual report of Wing Hing for the year ended 31 March 2011.

  2. The adjustments represent the inclusion of items of cash flows of Taung Gold, as if the Acquisition had taken place at the commencement of the period being reported on (i.e. 1 April 2010). The balances have been extracted from the audited consolidated statement of cash flows of Taung Gold for the year ended 28 February 2011 as disclosed in Appendix II to this circular. The Directors considered that no adjustment is necessary to the financial information of Taung Gold (which has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards) to align with the accounting policies of Wing Hing which comply with HKFRSs. For the purpose of the pro forma financial information, the financial information of Taung Gold has been translated into HK$ at the exchange rate of ZAR1 to HK$1.0867.

  3. The adjustments represent a reclassification of payment for estimated acquisition-related costs of approximately HK$24,000,000 in cash under investing activities. This adjustment is not expected to have a continuing effect on the Enlarged Group.

– III-10 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

  1. The adjustments represent the impairment of goodwill arising from the Acquisition which would be charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income upon completion of the Acquisition, further details of which are set out in Note 7 above. The basis of calculation of the goodwill is set out in Note 6 above. The impairment charge has been added back as a non-cash item. This adjustment is not expected to have a continuing effect on the Enlarged Group.

  2. The adjustments represent a reclassification of the opening balances of cash and cash equivalents of Taung Gold under investing activities, as if the Acquisition had taken place at the commencement of the period being reported on (i.e. 1 April 2010).

  3. As explained in Notes 6 and 8 above, the non-controlling interest upon First Completion would be 22.12%. Upon Electrum Completion, the non-controlling interest would be reduced from 22.12% to 13.03%. The aforesaid reduction in non-controlling interest is not expected to have any effect on the Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows and accordingly, no pro forma adjustment has been made.

– III-11 –

APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

B. REPORT ON THE UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

The following is the text of a report, prepared for the sole purpose of inclusion in this circular, received from the auditors of the Company, HLB Hodgson Impey Cheng, Chartered Accountants, Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong.

==> picture [212 x 79] intentionally omitted <==

31/F, Gloucester Tower The Landmark 11 Pedder Street Central Hong Kong

28 July 2011

The Board of Directors Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited

Dear Sirs,

REPORT ON THE UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

Introduction

We report on the unaudited pro forma financial information of Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (‘‘Wing Hing’’) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter collectively referred to as the ‘‘Wing Hing Group’’) as set out in Section A entitled ‘‘Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information of the Enlarged Group’’ of Appendix III (the ‘‘Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information’’) to Wing Hing’s circular dated 28 July 2011 (the ‘‘Circular’’). The Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information has been prepared by the directors of Wing Hing for illustrative purposes only, to provide information about how the Acquisition (as defined in the Circular) might have affected the financial information presented. The basis of preparation of the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information is set out in Section A of Appendix III of the Circular.

Respective responsibilities of the directors of Wing Hing and the reporting accountants

It is the responsibility solely of the directors of Wing Hing to prepare the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information in accordance with Rule 4.29 of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the ‘‘Listing Rules’’) and with reference to Accounting Guideline 7 ‘‘Preparation of Pro Forma Financial Information for Inclusion in Investment Circulars’’ issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants.

– III-12 –

APPENDIX III

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

It is our responsibility to form an opinion, as required by Rule 4.29(7) of the Listing Rules, on the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information and to report our opinion to you. We do not accept any responsibility for any reports previously given by us on any financial information used in the compilation of the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information beyond that owed to those to whom those reports were addressed by us at the dates of their issue.

Basis of opinion

We conducted our engagement in accordance with Hong Kong Standard on Investment Circular Reporting Engagements (HKSIR) 300 ‘‘Accountants’ Reports on Pro Forma Financial Information in Investment Circulars’’ issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants. Our work consisted primarily of comparing the unadjusted financial information with source documents, considering the evidence supporting the adjustments and discussing the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information with the directors of Wing Hing. This engagement did not involve independent examination of any of the underlying financial information.

We planned and performed our work so as to obtain the information and explanations we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information has been properly compiled by the directors of Wing Hing on the basis stated, that such basis is consistent with the accounting policies of the Wing Hing Group and that the adjustments are appropriate for the purposes of the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information as disclosed pursuant to Rule 4.29(1) of the Listing Rules.

The Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information has been prepared for illustrative purposes only, based on the judgments and assumptions of the directors of Wing Hing, and, because of its hypothetical nature, does not provide any assurance or indication that any event will take place in the future and may not be indicative of:

  • . the financial position of the Wing Hing Group as at 31 March 2011 or any future date; or

  • . the results or cash flows of the Wing Hing Group for the year ended 31 March 2011 or for any future periods.

– III-13 –

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

APPENDIX III

Opinion

In our opinion:

  • a. the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information has been properly compiled by the directors of Wing Hing on the basis stated;

  • b. such basis is consistent with the accounting policies of the Wing Hing Group; and

  • c. the adjustments are appropriate for the purposes of the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information as disclosed pursuant to Rule 4.29(1) of the Listing Rules.

Yours faithfully, HLB Hodgson Impey Cheng Chartered Accountants Certified Public Accountants Hong Kong

– III-14 –

APPENDIX IV

THE COMPETENT PERSONS REPORT

The following is the text of the Competent Persons Report received from Venmyn Rand (Proprietary) Limited prepared for the purpose of incorporation in this Circular in respect of the South African gold assets of the Taung Group. A copy in full color of the Competent Persons Report is also available on the website of Wing Hing (www.whih.com.hk).

– IV-1 –

==> picture [460 x 75] intentionally omitted <==

First Floor, Block G Rochester Place 173 Rivonia Road Sandton 2146 PO Box 782761 Sandton 2146 Republic of South Africa

Tel: +27 11 783 9903 Fax: +27 11 783 9953 www.venmyn.com

INDEPENDENT COMPETENT PERSONS REPORT ON THE SOUTH AFRICAN GOLD ASSETS OF TAUNG GOLD LIMITED BY VENMYN RAND (PTY) LIMITED

Our Ref. D861R Effective Date 11[th] February 2011

Directors: A N Clay (British); S E Conquest, E de V Greyling; N McKenna; C A Telfer

Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd. trading as Venmyn Reg. No. 1988/004918/07

– IV-2 –

ii

Taung Gold Limited Ground Floor, Block C Little Fourways Office Park 1 Leslie Avenue East East Fourways 2101 South Africa

Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited Room 1901,19[th] Floor, Nina Tower 8 Yeung UK Road Tsuen Wan, Hong Kong

Dear Sirs

SYNOPSIS

PURPOSE AND PROJECT OUTLINE

Taung Gold Limited (‘Taung’) holds prospecting rights in respect of various gold exploration projects in Mpumalanga, Limpopo, Gauteng, North West and Free State Provinces of South Africa. The mineral assets have been consolidated into a focused entity whose intention is to develop its two highly prospective flagship projects, Jeanette and Evander, whilst conducting further exploration on its greenfields and brownfield exploration projects. Taung’s vision is to become a significant role player in the South African gold exploration, development and mining sector. Taung has implemented a sound business strategy ensuring steady value growth of its assets. Building on the technical strength and extensive industry experience of its management team, Taung has prepared detailed plans to grow the company and move it up the value curve.

Taung’s strategy is to generate shareholder value through securing competitive assets, conducting effective historical data investigation and exploration and thereafter, fast-tracking project proposal and development of the most attractive projects. The technical team, with the assistance of independent consultancy companies, has utilised historical and current exploration data and mining knowledge to add significant value to its flagship projects.

The technical documentation in support of a ‘Very Substantial Acquisition’ (‘VSA’) between Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (‘Wing Hing’) and Taung on the Hong Kong Exchange (HKeX), has been prepared for Taung and Wing Hing in the form of this Competent Persons Report (‘CPR’). The CPR describes and documents Taung’s flagship mineral assets, namely the Jeanette project in the Free State Province and the Evander project in the Mpumalanga Province. The Evander and Jeanette projects are advanced exploration projects for which Scoping Studies have been completed and for which Pre-Feasibility Studies (‘PFS’) are being commissioned. These flagship projects represent a sound and attractive base from which to accelerate through PFS to Bankable Feasibility Study (‘BFS’) and development phases.

The CPR also includes greenfields projects in several provinces, which are at various exploration stages and for which, in the most part, insufficient information is available to define Mineral Resources. The brownfields and greenfields projects form an attractive pipeline of prospective properties for future exploration.

The techno-economic review of the gold assets was compiled according to comprehensive checklists that ensure compliance with the following:-

  • Australasian Code for Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves (‘JORC Code’);

  • reporting in compliance with the South African Code for the Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves (‘SAMREC Code’);

  • the South African Code for the Reporting of Mineral Asset Valuation (‘SAMVAL Code); and

  • full compliance with the Hong Kong Exchange Listing Rules for Mineral and Exploration companies.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-3 –

iii

CORPORATE STRUCTURE FOR TAUNG

Taung was incorporated in 2004 for the purpose of holding the South African gold assets of African Precious Minerals Limited (‘APM’), an exploration company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands. Taung was originally incorporated under the name Midnight Masquerade Properties 151 (Pty) Limited.

The company changed its name to Taung Gold Holdings (Pty) Limited in 2005. Taung was converted from a private to a public company called Taung Gold Holdings Limited and the company name was then changed to Taung Gold Limited.

Taung’s Black Economic Empowerment (‘BEE’) partner is Sephaku Gold Holdings (Pty) Limited (‘Sephaku’). Sephaku has undertaken to maintain its shareholding in Taung at the 26% level required by law.

TAUNG ASSETS

Taung holds various prospecting rights clustered into a total of 13 project areas located in Mpumalanga, Limpopo, Gauteng, Northwest and Free State Provinces of South Africa. The majority of these projects are located within the world renowned Witwatersrand Basin and are summarised in Table A and illustrated overleaf:-

Table A : Summary of Taung Mineral Assets

PROVINCE PROJECT PROPERTY SIZE(ha) HELD BY TYPE OF RIGHT
Mpumalanga Evander Six Shaft 2,452 Evander Gold Mines
Limited
New Order MiningRight
Twistdraai 2,677 Evander Gold Mines
Limited
NewOrder MiningRight
Free State Jeanette Jeanette 3,886 Taung Gold Free State
(Pty)Limited
New Order ProspectingRight
Various Greenfields Various 96,401 Various New Order ProspectingRights

Source: Taung

THE EVANDER PROJECT

Location, Project Description, Legal Aspects and Tenure

The Evander project (‘Evander’) consists of two adjacent properties, namely the Six Shaft area (‘Six Shaft’) and the Twistdraai area (‘Twistdraai’), located in the eastern Highveld of the Mpumalanga Province, of South Africa. The project comprises a dormant gold mine, which was part of Harmony Gold Mining Company Limited (‘Harmony’) portfolio of mines in the Witwatersrand Basin, 120km east-southeast of Johannesburg. The Witwatersrand Basin is the largest gold province globally and contains numerous gold deposits, which are grouped geographically into goldfields, separated by gaps where no economic deposits have been found.

The Evander project is located within the eastern Evander Goldfield on the northeastern limb of the Witwatersrand Basin. Gold and coal mining have been conducted in the Evander Goldfield area for 50 years and, consequently, access and mining related infrastructure is well developed. The Evander project properties are held by Evander Gold Mines Limited (‘EGM’), a subsidiary of Harmony. EGM currently operates one mine in the Evander Goldfield, namely No 8 Shaft (Leslie Mine). EGM recently closed a further three shafts within their operational area, namely No 2 Shaft, No 5 Shaft (originally known as Winkelhaak Mine) and No 7 Shaft (Kinross Mine). The Six Shaft area is largely unmined except for a small area in the vicinity of No 6 Shaft where approximately 2Mt of Kimberley Reef was mined between September 1986 and June 1998 at a reported grade of 7.82g/t Au over a width of 147cm (88cm channel width).

No 6 Shaft was closed in 1998 primarily as a result of the poor prevailing gold price. The Twistdraai project area is situated directly south of Six Shaft, some 12km east of the town of Evander. The proximity to Six Shaft means that much of the geological and structural control discussed for Six Shaft is directly applicable to Twistdraai.

The legal tenure of mineral properties within South Africa is governed by the Mineral and Petroleum Resources Development Act, No 28 of 2002 (‘MPRDA’) and administered by the Department of Mineral Resources (‘DMR’). EGM holds a new order Mining Right granted on the 29[th] April 2008 and valid for 30 years, over an extensive mining area, which includes the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-4 –

==> picture [432 x 651] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-5 –

v

In 2007, EGM’s parent company, Harmony, adopted a strategy to extract optimal value from assets which, though prospective, did not form part of Harmony’s overall strategy. This would be achieved through Harmony entering into agreements to joint venture, sell or re-capitalize these assets. In line with this strategy, Harmony, entered into a series of agreements with Taung over the Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects in early 2008. The earn-in agreements unlocked value for Harmony and at the same time presented Taung with attractive assets to explore and, eventually mine.

Accordingly, on 29[th] February 2008, Taung entered into a series of agreements with EGM in terms of which Taung could “earn-in” on the Six Shaft and Twistdraai Projects by completing a Scoping Study, a Pre Feasibility Study (‘PFS’) and a Bankable Feasibility Study (‘BFS’). Provision was made in the agreements for the mining right to be transferred into subsidiaries of Harmony, with Taung enjoying the right to earn a majority interest by completing a BFS over the Six Shaft and Twistdraai Projects.

Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas are separate projects from a contractual perspective. However the areas were treated as a single entity for the purposes of the Scoping Study commissioned by Taung. The results of the consolidated Scoping Study both the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas are presented in this CPR.

Taung completed a Scoping Study on the project on 9[th] April 2010. Taung is required to complete the PFS by 9[th] April 2012 and the BFS by 9[th] April 2013. The Scoping Study recommended that the project proceed to the PFS stage. Upon completion of a PFS Taung will ‘earn-in’ 25% shareholding in the subsidiaries (and therefore the projects), and upon completion of a BFS, an aggregate of 52% in the subsidiaries.

Subsequent to the decision to proceed to a PFS, Taung independently of Harmony, commissioned a further Scoping Study by Turnberry, which was completed in August 2010 (the Turnberry 2010 Scoping Study) and which forms the basis of the Evander portion of this CPR.

On 10[th] September 2010, a subsidiary of Taung, Pluriclox (Proprietary) Limited (‘Pluriclox’) entered into a sale agreement with EGM whereby, subject to certain conditions precedent being met, Pluriclox will acquire a 100% interest in the Evander Project. The acquisition cost is USD28.125m.

The conclusion of the Sale Agreement does not entail cancellation of the existing earn-in agreements with EGM and the rights and obligations in terms of the 2008 earn-in agreements will continue. More specifically Taung will continue to be obliged to complete the PFS and BFS. Once the Sale Agreement becomes unconditional, the 2008 earn-in agreements will terminate.

Regional Geological Setting, Local Geology and Exploration Results - Evander

The Witwatersrand Basin is located on the Kaapvaal Craton in South Africa and is an oval shaped basin, with a 160km long axis through Welkom and Johannesburg and a short axis of approximately 80km. Only a small proportion of the late Archaean Witwatersrand Basin is exposed at surface and the vast majority of the basin is covered by younger sediments and volcanics. The Evander project is located within the eastern Evander Goldfield on the northeastern limb of the Witwatersrand Basin.

The Evander Goldfield hosts several operating and two defunct gold mines, all of which produce or produced gold from the Kimberley Reef (‘Kimberley Reef’), situated within sediments of the Central Rand Group of the Witwatersrand Supergroup. The Evander Goldfield is arcuate in shape and characterised by basin margin faulting. The northeastern margin of the basin is dominated by a northwest striking asymmetrical fold structure with strata overturned to the west and thrust faulted. The Kimberley Reef varies between a few centimetres to 300cm in width and dips 60º to 90º in the steep, western fold limb and 25º in the east of the project area. The Kimberley Reef sub-crops against the overlying Transvaal Supergroup at 200m in the east, progressively deepening to the west.

Historically, a total of 39 surface exploration boreholes with 124 associated reef deflections were drilled in the Six Shaft area, the last of which was drilled in 1988. In addition, in excess of 400 underground diamond drill holes were drilled from underground excavations for reef and structural intersections during the Six Shaft mining operations. The historical exploration efforts on Twistdraai included 19 boreholes with 89 reef sections. A full independent review of the data provided confidence in the reliability of the historic data and a statistical evaluation showed that the data density is sufficient for estimation of Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-6 –

vi

To date, Taung has not conducted drilling or geophysical surveys on Six Shaft. However, an extensive, independent due diligence review of historical data has been completed by Explormine Consultants (‘ExplorMine’) and an advanced Scoping Study was recently compiled by Turnberry Projects (‘Turnberry’) in August 2010. Turnberry evaluated two options for the Evander project, one initiating the project in 2014 and a fast track option with project initiation in 2013.

A comprehensive and significant sedimentological interpretation of the Evander Goldfield Basin evolution and depositional trends has been developed from existing boreholes and regional Evander Goldfields information. The significant result of the study was the recognition of an eastwest depositional and channel trend in the southern portions of the Evander Goldfield and a southeast to northwest depositional trend in the remainder of the Evander Goldfield.

The east to west depositional trends could represent a later ‘overprint’ of the dominant southeast to northwest depositional trend. This sedimentological model has been used as a basis for geostatistical modelling and 3Dmodelling of the Kimberley Reef on the Evander project. A further significant aspect of the Scoping Study was the identification of high grade ore zones (termed geo-zones) both for Six Shaft and Twistdraai, which have been identified as the focus for future exploration. The geo-zones are important components of the mining plan and conversion of Mineral Resources to Mineral Reserves. Venmyn and ExplorMine are confident that the reliability of the input data in the Scoping Study has been established.

Planned Exploration Expenditure - Evander

The short-term exploration forecast for the financial year ending February 2012, required to ensure the Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects are technically and cost-effectively explored is summarised in Table B:- .

Table B: Exploration Expenditure for Evander for the Financial Year ending February 2012

PROJECT EXPLORATION1 CONSULTANTS2 OVERHEADS3 TOTAL
(USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000)
Evander (5,740) (5,107) (869) (11,716)
1. Drilling of four boreholes and sampling
2 .Consultants, environmental management
3. On site and Head Office
4. Purchase price to EGM
Negative values in (red)

Funds are available for exploration programmes and Taung has the ability and flexibility to manage the budget to achieve significant uplift in the value of the company through selected exploration methodologies

Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves - Evander

The Evander project Mineral Resource for high grade geo-zones defined for Six Shaft and Twistdraai in the Turnberry Scoping Study (at a stoping width of 100cm and a cut-off grade of >500cmg/t Au) are summarised in the consolidated Mineral Resource estimate Table C:-

Table C : Consolidated Total Evander Mineral Resource for Defined Geo-zones at 100cm SW (>500cmg/t Cut-off Grade) May 2010

MINERAL RESOURCE
CATEGORY
Measured
Indicated
Inferred
Total Measured and Indicated
MINING
TONNES
(t)
140,078
15,433,000
13,984,700
15,573,078

MINING
GRADE
(g/t)
10.63
9.24
7.63
9.25
MINING
GRADE
(cmg/t)
1,213
969
786
971
MINING
WIDTH
(cm)
118
104
103
105
CHANNE
L WIDTH
(cm)
87
74
68
74
CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
13.92
13.28
12.46
13.28

GOLD
(kg)

1,488

142,870

106,730

144,358

GOLD
(oz)
47,873
4,584,726
3,430,589
4,632,598
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCE* 29,557,000 8.485 883 **104 ** 71 12.89 251,000 8,063,000

Source : Turnberry 2010

Excludes the Deep and Shallow geo-zones from Twistdraai, since they are outside the scope of the mine scheduling process Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Stoping width of 100cm, Specific Gravity 2.7 100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent *Computational discrepancies due to rounding down

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-7 –

vii

Only a specific portion of the total defined Mineral Resources for Evander was selected for conversion to Mineral Reserves. A suite of modifying factors was applied to the Mineral Resources from the selected Shaft geo-zone only, in order to convert the Mineral Resources to Mineral Reserves. The final Mineral Reserves for the Shaft geo-zone of the Evander project are presented in Table D below:-

Table D : Probable Mineral Reserves for the Shaft Geo-zone at Six Shaft

MINING
WIDTH
TONNES MINING GRADE GOLD GOLD
PARAMETER
(t) (g/t) (cm) (kg) (oz)
Total Resource 9,550,000 10.41 104 99,373 3,195,000
Resources outside design areas (1,135,000) 9.90 104 (11,233) (361,000)
MiningTonnes 8,415,000 10.47 104 88,141 2,834,000
Pillar loss(Bracketpillars) (290,000) 10.49 104 (3,048) (98,000)
Pillar loss(Stopepillars) (643,000) 10.46 104 (6,728) (216,000)
Mineable Tonnage 7,481,000 10.48 104 78,365 2,519,000
Miningloss (150,000) 10.48 - (1,568) (50,000)
Dilution(on-reef development) 691,000 - - - -
Dilution(minor structures) 618,000 - - - -
Diluted Mineable Tonnage Resource 8,640,000 8.89 104 76,797 2,469,000
Mine Call Factor(MCF) (864,000) - - (7,680) (247,000)
PROBABLE RESERVES* 8,640,000 8.00 104 69,000 2,222,000

Source: Turnberry 2010

100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent No Inferred Mineral Resources are included in the Mineral Reserve estimation All figures in (red) are negative

*Computational discrepancies due to rounding down

Inferred Mineral Resources – Evander

The Evander project is situated in an historical mining area where 50 years of mining the Kimberley Reef has led to confidence in the understanding of the geology of the ore horizon. Taung has classified the Kimberley Reef into high grade geo-zones, many of which are classified as Indicated Mineral Resources. The remaining geo-zones are classified as Inferred Mineral Resources, as a consequence of insufficient data points within the zone, leading to lack of confidence in the grade distribution. However, the confidence levels for the remaining resource classification parameters exceed those required for classification in the Inferred category. In the context of the high confidence levels applicable to grade distribution in the Kimberley Reef in the Evander Goldfields area, Taung is confident that, the Inferred Mineral Resources will be rapidly upgraded to the Indicated category through the proposed exploration programme. It is this confidence in the upgrade of the Inferred Mineral Resources that is the basis for Taung’s motivation to include the Inferred Resources in the Scoping Study.

The Turnberry (2010) Scoping Study applied modifying factors to the Inferred and Indicated Mineral Resources for Evander. The Indicated Mineral Resources were converted to Probable Mineral Reserves (Table D). Since no category exists for modified Inferred Resources in international reporting codes, these modified Mineral Resources have not been termed Mineral Reserves but are termed ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for the purposes of reporting the Scoping Study results .

In order to comply with international reporting standards, both the Mineral Reserves alone and the ‘Mineral Reserves plus Economic Inferred Resources’ are presented in Table E:-

Table E : Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ – Evander (Turnberry 2010)

REC
GRADE
(g/t)
6.80
8.00
MINING
WIDTH
GOLD
TONNES GOLD
REEF CATEGORY (t) (cm) (kg) (oz)
Kimberley Reef
KimberleyReef
Probable Reserves + Economic
Inferred Mineral Resources
Probable Reserve only
28,222,000
8,640,000
104
104
191,000
69,000
6,170,000
2,222,000

Source: Turnberry 2010 and Includes Inferred Mineral Resources

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-8 –

viii

Scoping Study – Evander Project

The Scoping Study proposed that conventional breast mining methodology be used, as is common throughout the Witwatersrand Basin. No 6 Shaft is a 160ktpm vertical shaft complex, comprising an 8.5m diameter, man, material and rock hoisting shaft and a 6.0m diameter ventilation shaft sunk to a depth of 1,576m. The shaft was closed in 1998, as a result of adverse economic conditions and the winders and ancillary equipment were sold.

Electrical and water supply infrastructure is established, with electrical supply provided through an existing agreement with Eskom (the para-statal electrical service) and water is supplied by a para-statal organisation from the Vaal River. Water supply to the Evander Goldfield is unlikely to be a future limiting factor since most of the current mining operations in the goldfield were planned for greater production profiles than are currently maintained.

No 6 Shaft did not originally feed to a dedicated processing plant and therefore the Scoping Study included provision for a new processing plant. The mining studies carried out to date have progressed from a conceptual Scoping Study, prepared in 2008 by Turnberry, to detailed mine design completed in 2010 by Turnberry Projects (Pty) Limited (‘Turnberry’) and Ukwazi Group (‘Ukwazi’), with the Shaft geo-zone mine design and scheduling parameters having been completed to PFS level.

The mine design and schedule showed that the Evander project has a 30 year production life with the following key phases:-.

  • 2 years – sinking and establishment;

  • 7 years – mine ramp up to full production;

  • 21 years – full tonnage profile production; and

  • 2 years – mine closing down cycle.

Approximately 94% of the first 10 years production is projected to be sourced from areas of the ore body, which are currently at the Indicated Mineral Resource level of confidence.

A Life of Mine (‘LoM’) production rate of 1.2Mtpa over 30 years has been proposed, resulting in the production of 266,922oz per annum over the LoM. The peak production is projected to be 102ktpm with a peak shaft head grade of 7.43g/t Au. A total of 5,94Moz Au will be produced over the LoM.

During the first 10 years of the mine’s life the following project activities will occur:-

  • the existing No 6 Shaft will be de-watered and re-equipped to 18 Level elevation;

  • the ventilation (‘vent’) shaft will be sunk to 18 Level elevation;

  • production will commence on the upper levels;

  • the 6 sub-vertical shaft and sub-vent shaft infrastructure will be sunk and developed, along with the haulages and return air ways (‘RAW’s’) from the upper levels towards the Twistdraai area; and

  • the Twistdraai mining complex design that comprises 3 twin incline shafts will be developed during the latter part of the first 10 years. (Mining at Twistdraai will occur during the second half of the mine’s life).

The projected production statistics for the Evander Project are shown in Table F below.

The project implementation is anticipated to commence during January 2013.

Mineral Processing – Evander

No 6 Shaft does not have a dedicated processing plant and the EGM plants in the region do not have sufficient capacity to accommodate No 6 Shafts’ ore.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-9 –

ix

A new, conventional Witwatersrand gold mine carbon-in-pulp/carbon-in-leach (‘CIP/CIL’) plant dedicated to No 6 Shaft is to be built. The plant design is such that it is to be completed in several modules with an initial plant of 25ktpm and two modules thereafter, each with capacities of 100ktpm. The plants are to be positioned in the vicinity of No 6 Shaft. The CIP/CIL adopted by Turnberry in the mining complex is a plant with known design parameters and proven recovery parameters at a cost of (USD38.75m (Turnberry 2010). The planned plant utilizes proven, effective technology with a known recovery factor of 95%. The Evander project ore body has the same metallurgical characteristics as Evander Gold mines where a similar plant is achieving such recoveries.

Table F : Scheduled Forecast Production Statistics – Evander

ITEM LoM SUMMARY* LoM SUMMARY**
CAPEX IncludingPlant and OngoingCAPEX(USDm) (1,023.00) (623)
OPEX LifeAverage Cost/tonnemilled (USD/t) (83.60) (80.88)
Cash Cost Total Cash Cost/oz Auproduced(USD/oz) (396.71) (325.85)
Production Annual Ore Production(tonnesper annum – tpa)) 1,229,000 1,150,000
Monthly OreProduction(tonnes per month-tpm) 102,417 95,833
Annual Gold Production(kg goldper annum) 8,302 4,649
Annual PeakGold Production(ouncesper annum) 291,094 286,185
AverageProductionGold ounces pa 266,922 149,480
Head Grade(g/t) 6.801 7.99
Yield(g/t) 6.55 7.72
TotalGold (kg) 184,853 66,699
Total Gold(ounces) 5,943,148 2,144,441
Total Waste Tonnes(LOM) 9,627,007 1,908,796
Reef: WasteRatio 2.93 4.53
SustainingWaste Tonnes(LOM) 5,120,663 969,150
Reef: Waste Ratio 5.51 8.91
Mine Call Factor 90% 90%

Source: Turnberry 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red)

There is no tailings dam at Six Shaft. An area of approximately 115ha will be required for a 30m high tailings dam and return water facility, estimated at a cost USD10.31m. Waste rock-dump areas are already established and no additional sites will be required.

No metallurgical test work has been conducted on the Evander Project ore. However more than 2Mt of reef has been treated through the EGM No 2 Shaft gold plant with recoveries at approximately 96.5%.

Estimates of Capital Expenditure (‘CAPEX’) – Evander

The total capital cost of the project was revised by Taung in February 2011 to USD1,034m, including sustaining capital expenditure of USD56.25m (see Table G).

The peak funding requirement is approximately USD315m in year five after commencement of gold production.

Table G : Evander Project – Revised Phased Capital Estimate

DESCRIPTION *COST(USD'000) ** COST(USD'000)**
Phase 0–Studies (10,310) (10,310)
Phase 1 – Dewater Mine and Upper Level SteepProduction (132,114) (132,114)
Phase 2 – Sub-vertical Shaft (442,402) (438,878)
Phase 3– Twistdraai Incline Shaft (194,862) 0
Possible savings on second hand equipment -31,250 -20,000
Exploration drilling programme (6,190) (6,190)
ProjectDevelopment Capital Estimate (223,421) (40,867)
SustainingCapital – Engineeringand Projects (56,250) (21,563)
Total Capital Expenditure (1,034,300) (629,922)
Source: Taung 2011
Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferr
Negative figures in (red)
*Indicated Mineral Resources only
ed Mineral Resources

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-10 –

x

Estimates of Operating Costs - Evander

The Evander project is estimated to have an operating cost of USD83.5/t milled (including the full recent electricity tariff price increase), as detailed in Table H:-

Table H : Evander Project – Estimated Operating Costs

TOTAL PROJECT(ZAR /t milled) COST*(USD/t) COST(USD/t)**
MiningCost (55.73) (52.71)
Processing Cost (Excluding services) (4.88) (4.88)
Analytical Cost(Excludingservices) (0.19) (0.19)
Smeltingand Treatment Charges (0.49) (0.58)
Services (11.73) (11.28)
Administration and Overhead Costs (10.58) (11.24)
TOTAL (83.60) (80.88)

Source: Turnberry 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red)

A 7 year production ramp up period has been estimated for the Evander project and the mine will operate at full production for 21 years with an annual production of 267,000oz Au. Total gold production is estimated to be 184.9t Au (5.9Moz Au). The estimated LoM average operating costs will be USD83.6/t milled. All costs are expressed in December 2009 money terms.

Project Risks and Potential - Evander

The areas of potential technical risk to the Evander operation at Scoping Study level have been reviewed, in particular those areas where the risk component could materially impact the proposed mine development and projected cashflows. The applicable mitigation implementations will be addressed during the PFS and BFS stage. The project risks are not materially different to those of any historical or current South African gold project with similar depth, geology and mineralogy. The up-side potential of the Evander project can be summarised as:-

  • additional drilling to upgrade Inferred Mineral Resources into the Indicated Mineral Resource category;

  • definition of Mineral Reserves from the newly defined Indicated Resources;

  • exploration to identify additional economic reef zones that are theoretically present;

  • stoping width reduction to within a maximum of 35cm over and above the channel width;

  • improved gold plant recovery as a result of higher head grade and process optimisation;

  • reviewing the optimal mining and plant throughput rate during PFS and BFS;

  • additional tonnage processed through the plant as a result of improved availability and control;

  • a geological and structural regime that is simpler in reality than that proposed by the current interpretation;

  • increased mechanisation in the stoping environment to reduce costs; and

  • a project start date earlier than January 2013.

Recommendations and Conclusions – Evander

Twistdraai is structurally complex, although no more complex than other Witwatersrand mines located along the basin margin. A suitable exploration programme should be designed to expand on the current geological and geostatistical information. The new exploration data will provide the basis for expanding upon, and upgrading, the current Inferred Mineral Resource estimate to the Indicated Mineral Resource category in order that a conversion to Mineral Reserves can be undertaken.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-11 –

xi

The level of confidence in the channel width data is sufficient, but additional intersections need to be analysed for grade and accumulation statistics. Seven surface boreholes are planned in the Inferred Mineral Resource areas before the end of BFS, (four holes with a total number of 32 reef intersections are planned before end of February 2011 and budgeted accordingly) with the intention of upgrading the Mineral Resource to the Indicated Mineral Resource category. Future surface drilling should be guided by the 3D estimated block model. A minimum of eight reef deflections (intersections) are required to ensure the Macro Kriging method can be effectively applied.

A PFS is to be commissioned by Taung for the Evander project, which will include the following:-

  • drilling to upgrade Inferred Mineral Resources to Indicated Mineral Resources in the Twistdraai area;

  • detailed mine planning as conducted for the Shaft geo-zone to be extended into the other mining areas;

  • environmental scoping study to be commissioned;

  • water study to be commissioned to consider the effect of the closure of EGM’s No 2 and No 5 shafts;

  • definitive study of the steep mining practices to be undertaken to establish the viability of the ‘shrink and scrape’ method proposed in the Scoping Study;

  • optimisation of the mining and plant throughput rates;

  • sub-shaft position is to be optimised, including assessment of a surface ventilation/men and material shaft in the Twistdraai area;

  • establishment of practical method to sink the incline shafts for mechanised mining;

  • definitive study on the method of operation of the decline shafts using ‘endless rope’ technologies;

  • a collaborative study between rock engineering and ventilation models aimed at cost benefit outcomes that contribute to the overall project viability; and

  • discussions between Harmony, EGM, Taung and Eskom with regard to the supply of grid power.

The Evander project will be a stand-alone operation and will not rely on any mining infrastructure from other sources. The gold produced from the processing plant will be refined at the Rand Refinery in Johannesburg.

The Evander project will produce at a rate of 1.2Mt/a for a period of 21 years at full production with a 7 year ramp up phase and a 2 year closure phase, i.e. a total of 30 years production. The mine will require a two year development and construction phase before production commences. The total reef tonnage milled will be approximately 28Mt.

The projected Evander project start date of January 2013 was established in the Scoping Study.

The Competent Persons recommend that Taung progress the Phase 1 of Six Shaft to a full BFS as the technical and economic risks, as well as the outlook for the gold price, support the potential development of the project. PFS will be undertaken to evaluate the Phase 2 and Phase 3 of the project.

THE JEANETTE PROJECT

Location, Project Description, Legal Aspects and Tenure

The Jeanette project comprises a historic mine, originally owned by Anglo American Corporation (‘AAC’) with two unequipped shafts sunk during the 1950s, and is located within the southwest margin of the Witwatersrand Basin, northeast of Welkom, in the Free State Province of South Africa. The Jeanette mine was closed as a result of unfavourable market conditions in the mid 1950s, the technical difficulties of mining below a shale horizon (the Khaki Shale) before new technologies were available, and better opportunities elsewhere for AAC in the Welkom Goldfield.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-12 –

xii

The Jeanette project is located within the Welkom Goldfield, which hosts eleven mines in the triangle between Allanridge, Welkom and Virginia, 270km southwest of Johannesburg. Historically, these mines have collectively produced 8.7Mkg (279.7Moz) gold. The Jeanette area includes numerous farms and farm portions over which a single New Order Prospecting Right is held.

Taung and APM entered into an agreement with a wholly-owned subsidiary of Harmony, ARMgold/Harmony Freegold Joint Venture Company (Proprietary) Limited (‘Freegold’), on 1[st] February 2008, in terms of which Taung acquired 100% of the Jeanette Project by way of the issue of shares in APM. The agreement was amended on 30[th] June 2008 to provide for the purchase of the right by way of a cash payment of a USD12.5m. The agreement was further updated on 11[th] March 2010 to amend the purchase price to USD9.375 million, which has been paid by Taung.

On 29[th] September 2010 the DMR granted consent for a Section 11 transfer of ownership of the prospecting right from Freegold to Taung Gold Free State (Pty) Ltd, a wholly owned subsidiary of Taung.

Environmental Management Plans (‘EMP’) for each Prospecting Right have been approved by the DMR. Private landowners are the surface rights holders over the Prospecting Right area and all relevant parties have been consulted by Taung. Access to project area is excellent and the infrastructure with respect to mining is well developed.

Regional Geological Setting, Local Geology and Exploration Results

The Jeanette project is situated northeast of Welkom on the southwest margin of the Witwatersrand Basin and in the Free State Province of South Africa. The project is located within the Welkom Goldfield, which hosts eleven mines in the triangle between Allanridge, Welkom and Virginia, 270km southwest of Johannesburg.

The target horizons in the Jeanette area occur within the Central Rand Group of the Witwatersrand Supergroup and include the Basal Reef, Big Pebble Conglomerate, A-Reef and the B-Reef. The Basal Reef is the main economic reef and is recognised as being distal in nature with several facies types, which are distinguished and separately reported in the Mineral Resource estimates. The Basal Reef is a 5cm to 77cm thick quartzite conglomerate, dipping in a westerly direction (9º to 27º) from 950m to 2,200m below surface.

To date, Taung has not conducted drilling on the Jeanette project areas. However, an extensive, independent due diligence review of historical data purchased from Harmony and AngloGold Ashanti has been completed. Three 2D seismic lines were completed over the Jeanette area, which will assist in positioning the future planned two boreholes.

The Jeanette historic data and Mineral Resource statements were audited and the original assay results verified in resampling exercises that have provided assurance that the historical data for both the Basal Reef and the A-Reef are reliable for Mineral Resource estimation purposes. The results of the study permit the estimation of Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources for Jeanette. The western and central areas of the adjacent greenfields Hilton project correlate with the low grade Basal Reef Loraine facies and are unlikely to be attractive targets.

An initial Scoping Study by Sound Mining Solutions Consultants (‘SMS’, 2009), included a preliminary mining layout, a trial mining option, mining schedule, CAPEX and OPEX cost estimates, as well as the examination of an option whereby the existing ventilation shaft would be utilised for a future mining operation with the subsequent sinking of a new shaft. The full production underground ore handling proposed for Jeanette is similar to that employed on other Free State gold mines i.e. trackless vehicles in the declines where dips are less than 12° and by means of track bound equipment in the declines where dips are over 12°. A design and layout based on this philosophy has been completed. The Scoping Study was later modified by Minxcon Engineering Consultants (‘Minxcon’) in 2010 to examine the possibility of fast tracking the project, updating the project inputs, updating modifying factors, without the need for trial mining. The study showed improved financial outputs and presented a sound business case for advancing the project to PFS stage.

Planned Exploration Expenditure - Jeanette

Taung expects exploration costs of USD15.584m to be incurred for the financial year ending February 2012 on the Jeanette project exploration activities (Table I). The focus for the exploration is to upgrade certain current Inferred Mineral Resources to the Indicated Mineral Resource category. Funding to undertake this exploration programme is available.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-13 –

xiii

Table I : Exploration Expenditure for Jeanette for the Financial Year ending February 2012

EXPLORATION 1 CONSULTANTS 2 OVERHEADS3 TOTAL
(USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000)
(13,084) (2,188) (312) (15,584)
1. Drilling of two boreholes, sampling and geophysical 3
2 .Consultants, environmental management
3. On site and Head Office
Negative values in (red)
D survey

Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves – Jeanette

A consolidated Mineral Resource statement for the Basal and A-Reefs at the Jeanette project area is presented in Table J:-

Table J : Consolidated Mineral Resource Statement for Jeanette (Venmyn, August 2009)

MINERAL RESOURCE
CATEGORY
Indicated (Black Chert Facies)
Inferred (Overlap Facies)
Inferred (A-Reef)
Total Indicated
Total Inferred
TOTAL MINERAL
RESOURCE*
MINING
TONNES
(t) **
23,030,000
11,540,000
28,340,000
23,030,000
39,880,000

MINING
GRADE
(g/t)
9.58
9.58
4.95
9.58
6.29
MINING
GRADE
(cmg/t)
958
958
559
958
MINING
WIDTH
(cm)
100
100
113
100
CHANNEL
WIDTH
(cm)
24
24
113
24
CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
39.92
39.92
4.95
39.92
GOLD
(kg)
220,580
110,530
140,260
220,580
250,790

GOLD
(oz)
7,092,000
3,553,000
4,510,000
7,092,000
8,063,000
62,910,000 7.49 471,370 15,155,000

Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Computational discrepancies due to rounding down *Tonnes at cut-off above 3.0g/t Au Source: Venmyn 2009 Geological Losses 25% Area 39,107,291m[2] Density value used 2.75t/m[3] Average Dip 25°

A Scoping Study by Minxcon (2010) applied modifying factors to the Inferred and Indicated Mineral Resources for Jeanette. The Indicated Mineral Resources were converted to Probable Mineral Reserves. Since no category exists for modified Inferred Resources in international reporting codes, these modified Mineral Resources have not been termed Mineral Reserves but are termed ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for the purposes of reporting the Scoping Study results .

In order to comply with international reporting standards, both the Mineral Reserves alone and the ‘Mineral Reserves plus Economic Inferred Resources’ are presented in Table K:-

Table K : ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ and Probable Reserves for Jeanette (Minxcon 2010)

VOLUME TONNES GRADE GOLD GOLD
REEF CATEGORY
**( ‘000 m3) **

(t)

(g/t)
7.26
7.26

(kg)

(oz)
Basal Reef
Basal Reef
Probable
Reserves
+
Economic Inferred Mineral
Resources
Probable Reserve only*
10,956
8,086
30,130,000
22,254,000
218,425
161,000
7,022,525
5,191,000

Source: Minxcon 2010 Mining width 88cm (excluding overbreaking) 100% attributable to Taung *Rounded down

The Basal Reef, as the primary economic horizon in the Jeanette area has been mined for 60 years, with the result that the level of geological understanding of this reef is high. Although an Inferred Mineral Resource classification has been applied to the Overlap facies, the confidence levels for most of the resource classification parameters exceed those required for classification in the Inferred category.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-14 –

xiv

In the context of the high confidence levels applicable to grade distribution in Basal Reef in the Welkom goldfields area, Taung is confident that the Overlap facies Inferred Mineral Resources will be rapidly upgraded to the Indicated category through the proposed exploration programme. It is this confidence in the upgrade of the Inferred Mineral Resources that is the basis for Taung’s motivation to include the Inferred Resources in the Scoping Study.

Scoping Study – Jeanette

Jeanette is a historic mine with two unequipped shafts that were sunk during the 1950s which can provide early access. The area has a well developed infrastructure with a rail link and a national road (R30) between Odendaalsrus and Bothaville. Eskom power lines (part of a major grid) are situated close to the western boundary of the prospect area.

The No 1 Shaft is a seven compartment vertical shaft, which was concrete lined to a depth of 240m, followed by 4m concrete strips to a depth of 382m. Below this elevation, the shaft walls had been improved sufficiently to allow for normal strip support in conjunction with steel buntons. The 5,5m diameter No 2B Ventilation Shaft is developed to a depth of 1,547m and reef development was conducted on 49 Level at No 2B Shaft. The total development tunnel infrastructure included 3,556m, of which 762m was on the Basal Reef. Taung has recovered the sampling data collected from this development.

The Scoping Study on the Basal Reef at Jeanette proposed a conventional/scattered breast mining methodology. The mine design and schedule revealed that Jeanette has a 37 year production life as summarised below:-

  • 5 years – sinking and establishment;

  • 3 years – mine ramp up to full production;

  • 15 years – full tonnage profile production;

  • 4 years – mine ramp down; and

  • 10 years – mining remnant blocks and pillars. Potential exists to optimise the operation and add additional Mineral Resources.

A production rate of 145ktpm is planned for a 15 year steady state production period. The schedule is based on LoM mining of 30.13Mt of ore at an average recovered grade of 6.96g/t Au, and development of 7Mt of waste to access the ore. The total anticipated production over the LoM will be 209t Au or 6.7Moz Au.

The new shaft design entails the sinking of a new vertical shaft to a depth of over 1,900m, complete with the necessary infrastructure, within close proximity to the existing ventilation shaft. The new shaft and existing ventilation shaft would be designed to service a production level of 145ktpm. The portions of the ore body originally planned to be accessed from the existing rectangular shaft will be accessed via twin declines and horizontal haulages from the new shaft. The aim is to maximise the mining for as long as possible in order to optimise infrastructural capital expenditure towards steady state of approximately 145ktpm.

The ranking of the various mining blocks generated by the 3D geological model was undertaken prior to designing the access from the shaft system so that the most prospective mining blocks could be targeted first in the production sequencing and scheduling studies. The ranking was based on the location and mineralisation available in each block. The mining blocks requiring the least access development were prioritised. An in-situ grade of 11.98g/t Au, over a channel width of 80cm was used for all of the blocks within the payable area (i.e. 64% of the total Mineral Resource area). The projected production statistics for the Jeanette project are shown in Table L:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-15 –

xv

Table L : Jeanette Forecast Production Statistics Schedule

LoM SUMMARY
(USD)*
LoM SUMMARY
(USD)**
ITEM
CAPEX IncludingPlant and OngoingCAPEX (1,057,000) (1,024,000)
OPEX Life Average cost/tonne milled (72.06) (74.48)
CashCost TotalCashCost/oz Au produced (322.03) (330.94)
Production Annual Ore Production(tonnesper annum – tpa)) 1,720,000 1,63,0000
MonthlyOre Production(tonnesper month- tpm) 145,000 135,000
AnnualGoldProduction(kg gold perannum) 11,000 9,600
Annual Peak Gold Production(ouncesper annum) 411,000 380,000
Average Production Gold ouncespa 380,000 290,000
StopingWidth(cm) 88 88
Head Grade(g/t) 7.25 7.26
Mine Call Factor 79.90 79.90
Metallurgical Yield (g/t) 6.96 7.00
Total Gold(kg) 209,518 154,845
Total Gold(ounces) 6,736,149 4,978,381
Total WasteTonnes (LoM) 7,965,000 6,994,000
Reef: Waste Ratio 3.86 3.18

Figures in (red) are negative Source: Minxcon 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only

Mineral Processing – Jeanette

The Jeanette project does not currently have a dedicated processing plant and a new, conventional CIP/CIL plant could be built at an estimated cost of USD92.0m (Minxcon 2010). The cost estimate includes provision for tailings and a rock-dump.

The Jeanette project is at a Scoping Study stage of evaluation and Taung has not conducted metallurgical or mineral processing studies. Metallurgical test work will be undertaken at the full BFS stage of the project evaluation.

The Basal Reef, A-Reef and B-Reef are mined on surrounding mines with good recoveries in similar facies type and it is anticipated that data from these operations would be appropriate for profiling the metallurgical response of these reefs. Historical and current plant recoveries of 95% to 96% are achieved on adjacent operating mines processing the Basal Reef, A-Reef and B-Reef ores.

The capital costs of a new plant have been included in the economic evaluation. However; capital sensitivity studies should be completed to determine if toll treatment or the purchase of an existing plant would be more viable options.

Jeanette Project Capital and Operating Expenditure

Capital and operational cost estimates were broadly defined in the Scoping Study from industry benchmarks and known costs of operating mines in the vicinity. These costs are included as examples only and will be defined more accurately during the PFS, when the actual mine design will be developed. The LoM capital for mining and surface facilities was estimated by Minxcon in the 2010 Scoping Study to within 30% accuracy as summarised in Table M.

Table M : Jeanette LoM Capital Estimate

**TOTALCAPITALOVER LoM ** USD* USD**
FeasibilityStudies (10,244,625) (10,244,625)
Exploration Drillingand 3D Seismic Survey (19,033,638) (19,033,638)
Mining Capex (651,724,320) (651,724,320)
Plant and Other Infrastructure (181,381,025) (181,381,118)
Contingency (73,391,362) (73,391,362)
Ongoing Capex (132,080,387) (98,303,408)
TOTAL (1,067,855,357) (1,034,078,471)

Source:Minxcon 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red)

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-16 –

xvi

The peak funding requirement for the Jeanette project is estimated to be USD603m in year 2 after commencement of gold prodcution. A LoM total cost of USD118/t could be achieved at a production rate of 145ktpm and includes a USD52.13/t direct operating cost at steady state. The operating cost for the overall LoM is summarised in Table N:-

Table N : Estimated Operating Costs for the overall LoM – Jeanette

Cost*(USD/t) Cost (USD/t)**
Mining Cost (54.12) (54.37)
ProcessingCosts (9.12) (11.31)
Analytical costs (0.08) (0.08)
Smelting/treatment charges (0.10 (0.10)
Administration/overheads and services (8.64) (8.62)
TOTAL (72.06) (74.48)
Source: Minxcon 2010
Total Ore body including both Indicated and In
Negative figures in (red)
*Indicated Mineral Resources only

Project Risks and Potential – Jeanette

At Scoping Study level the following primary risks have been identified and the appropriate mitigating processes will be addressed during the PFS and BFS stages:-

  • the Basal Reef at the Jeanette Project is overlain by a succession of quartzite and shale. The layer of shale is prevalent in the Northern Free State goldfield and is known locally as the “Khaki Shale”. The shale horizon is of variable thickness and is geotechnically weak. The Khaki Shale is separated from the Basal Reef by a layer of quartzite, also of varying thickness, but which is geotechnically competent;

  • reef cut assumptions require verification. Whilst the risk associated with conventional mining is low, the challenge at Jeanette is mining under the Khaki Shale, although neighbouring mines do mine under similar conditions. The undercutting of the Khaki Shale alters the overall risk profile so that it becomes the single most important technical risk to be ameliorated or managed;

  • mining is affected by mostly north-south trending faults with displacements of up to 300m. The final access strategy and timing of the development must be carefully planned to ensure the availability of the stope faces;

  • operating cost estimates are a risk and their accuracy will be reviewed during the PFS;

  • operating a conveyor system over a total distance of approximately 26km for all of the blocks combined, notwithstanding the provision of suitable storage systems, will require innovative design and management to maintain daily production rates of 700tpd (reef and waste). If the conveyor system has to be loaded from more than one location (i.e. different mining blocks, advancing waste development, etc.), the efficiency and productivity will be adversely affected unless suitable storage is always available;

  • developing and operating in decline systems are invariably less efficient and more costly than on horizontal systems. The system of declines will have to rely on trackless vehicles operating at an angle over long distances. A trade-off study between chairlift versus trackless systems will determine the best option; and

  • training and equipment management in mechanised mining have a major influence on costs.

Recommendations and Conclusions - Jeanette

A focused infill exploration-drilling programme should be designed to improve confidence in the area centred on the Jeanette shaft and underground development. Providing that the inter-borehole sample variance is unaffected by further drilling, an additional 2 boreholes could upgrade the Inferred Resource to an Indicated Resource.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-17 –

xvii

It is recommended that a 3D reflective seismic survey planned across a selected surface area of Jeanette and Hilton will provide invaluable structural information upon which the drilling strategy and mine planning can be designed. A fast-tracked PFS is to be commissioned by Taung for the Jeanette project, which will include the following:-

  • the Inferred Mineral Resources to be upgraded to Indicated Mineral Resources;

  • a test of the northern high grade ore body area for grade continuity;

  • an environmental Scoping Study is to be commissioned;

  • investigation into the use of the ‘rail-veyor system’ for transporting ore and waste;

  • shaft positions to be optimised;

  • reviewing the optimal mining and plant throughput rate during PFS and BFS;

  • working costs need to be defined within a 30% accuracy level;

  • additional geotechnical studies on under-cutting the Khaki Shale to be undertaken;

  • geological confidence needs to be improved to determine if reef cut assumptions are valid;

  • sensitivity studies with regard to the toll treating of ore should be considered; and

  • application for a mining right towards the end of the PFS.

Taung plans to investigate the economic potential of the other reefs present on the adjacent, Greenfields Hilton project, as well as further examine the Melkkraal facies of the Basal Reef which was excluded from the previous study.

Additional 3D modelling exercises will deepen the understanding of the structure and highlight the potential for hitherto unidentified shallow mineralised reef development. Grade distribution models will determine if potentially economic deposits occur on adjacent properties. The technical review of the Jeanette project area has highlighted the following:-

  • the Jeanette Gold Mine has been investigated on an ongoing basis for the past 60 years. The mine has been dormant since 1955 due to historic economic and geotechnical issues, which may now no longer be valid due to better in the gold price and mining technologies respectively;

  • the prevailing gold price and market drivers present an opportunity to improve project economics and this, together with advances in mining practices and support technologies, will result in amelioration of the two historical factors, which prevented progress in the past;

  • the substantial historic Jeanette Mine Basal Reef and Kimberley Formation reef information has been verified and permits the classification of an Indicated Mineral Resource for the Black Chert facies of the Basal Reef. The total Indicated Mineral Resource for the Black Chert facies is estimated to be 23.03Mt (above a 3g/t Au cut-off) at 9.58g/t Au for 7.092Moz contained gold, over a mining width of 100cm;

  • the consolidated JORC compliant Mineral Resource estimate for the Basal and A Reefs over the Jeanette project at a cutoff grade of 3g/t Au, is:-

  • Indicated Mineral Resources 23.03Mt for 7.09Moz contained gold (over a mining width of 100cm); and

  • Inferred Mineral Resources 39.88Mt for 8.06Moz contained gold (over a maximum width of 113cm).

  • upside potential exists for the definition of improved reef development in the northern portion of the lease area where the Basal Reef Loraine facies has been reclassified as the thicker Melkkraal facies;

  • a sophisticated 3D structural model will be constructed with additional drilling and 3D seismic survey interpretation at the PFS and BFS stages;

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-18 –

xviii

  • an independent high level Scoping Study on the Jeanette project has been completed which examined a conventional breast mining option, utilising the original ventilation shaft and sinking a new shaft to 1,925m below surface (Minxcon, 2009). The results of the Scoping Study demonstrated that at an in-situ grade of 9.58g/t Au over 100cm, the project proved economically viable at gold prices less than those prevalent at September 2010;

  • a PFS should now be commissioned to design a mine plan, convert the Mineral Resources to compliant Mineral Reserves and develop a financial model based on these reserves.

  • a technical assessment of the rock mechanic aspects of mining the Basal Reef below the Khaki shale has shown that mining is feasible (Keen 2009). Furthermore, the Basal Reef is successfully exploited in adjacent and neighbouring mines in the region. A Technical Committee including independent industry specialists has been established to further review the mining strategy for the Basal Reef at Jeanette and to mitigate the risk associated with the mining thereof. The PFS will include the application of recommendations from the Technical Committee; and

  • the funding for the planned next phase of exploration on the Jeanette project is available; and

  • the review of the adjacent Hilton project area indicated that no Mineral Resource estimate compliant with international reporting JORC standards could be compiled for the Basal Reef at Hilton.

TAUNG GREENFIELDS PROJECTS

Location, Project Description, Legal Aspects and Tenure - Greenfields

Venmyn has reviewed the techno-economic nature and parameters of the Greenfields projects within the Taung mineral asset portfolio. Since the majority of the projects are at an early stage of exploration, the information available with regards to these assets is limited. Some of the projects are at too early a stage for full JORC and SAMREC Code disclosure. These Greenfields projects are of significance in terms of Taung’s future exploration focus but are of lower order in terms of value when compared to the flagship projects. Taung’s Greenfields gold assets are geographically widely positioned throughout five provinces of South Africa. However, most projects are located within the Witwatersrand Basin, within renowned goldfields. Three projects are situated outside the Witwatersrand Basin.

Regional Geological Setting, Local Geology and Exploration Results - Greenfields

Taung has ranked the greenfields projects according to the prospectivity of the project, historic exploration expenditure and the stage of Mineral Resource definition achieved. Applying these criteria the greenfields projects have been ranked from highest to lowest as follows:-

  • Hilton Project;

  • South Rand project;

  • Harrisburg -Yzerspruit project;

  • Bothaville Gap; and

  • Palmietfontein, Malmani, Richelieu/Plecy, Evander West (Watervalshoek) and Jeanette (BanWel) projects at the lowest order (see Note 14).

Hilton Project

The Hilton project comprises numerous properties directly adjacent to Jeanette, over which seven New Order Prospecting Rights are held by Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Limited (‘Taung Free State’). Exploration for all minerals excepting coal and diamonds is permitted under five of the Prospecting Rights. Two rights were granted for exploration of gold, silver, and uranium.

Historical exploration results exist for the project but no compliant Mineral Resources or Mineral Reserves have been defined for the Hilton project area.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-19 –

xix

The historic exploration results permit the definition of an exploration target or “deposit” (as defined by the SAMREC Code) for both north and south blocks at 0g/t Au cut-off grade, of 36.4Mt at 2.31g/t Au, potentially yielding 2.71Moz of gold. No ranges have been provided as the statistics required to do this would be speculative and could lead to an unrealistic presentation of technical quantities.

The Hilton project represents considerable upside potential for Taung and Venmyn recommends that exploration programmes be designed to upgrade the exploration target or “deposit” to the Inferred and Indicated Mineral Resource categories. Taung’s planned exploration expenditure for the Hilton project for the financial year 2012 is USD0.40m.

South Rand Project

The South Rand project consists of numerous Prospecting Rights within the South Rand Basin, in the eastern part of the Witwatersrand Basin. The project area is located 80km southeast of Johannesburg in the Mpumalanga Province of South Africa.

The South Rand project has been divided into six prospect regions but sufficient information is available for full evaluation of only three of these regions, namely: Balfour, Witpoort and Roodepoort. The project is accessed via the N3, Johannesburg to Durban highway and the prospect regions are accessible via a network of gravel roads.

The Balfour region consists of five Prospecting Rights adjacent to Great Basin Gold Limited’s (‘GBG’) Burnstone project, which has reported Mineral Resources of 10.9Moz at a mean grade of 6.9g/t Au (7.7Moz of which are in the Measured category). The Burnstone project is forecast to produce 254,000oz Au per annum over a 19 year LoM.

The Witpoort region consists of five Prospecting Rights located to the southeast of the Balfour region. A drilling programme (11 surface boreholes) clarified the stratigraphy and identified regional marker horizons.

Kimberley Reef was identified in two facies types, as channel deposits and as thin grit deposits on palaeo basement highs.

The Kimberley Reef channel width varies from 13cm to 95cm and the assay values reported range from zero to 18.12g/t Au. No compliant Mineral Resource can be defined at this stage of the exploration programme.

Yzerspruit Project

The Yzerspruit project comprises two areas, namely the Yzerspruit and Harrisburg areas. The Yzerspruit portion of the project is located 20km southwest of the town of Orkney, and 40km southwest of Klerksdorp. The Yzerspruit portion is located in the North West Province of South Africa and is bounded by the Vaal River to the south.

The Harrisburg area is situated adjacent and to the south of the Yzerspruit area and is bounded by the Vaal River to the north. Taung has identified 29 boreholes drilled by previous exploration companies which are considered close to, or on, Taung’s project areas and Taung has commissioned geological consultants who have an intimate geological knowledge of the area, to develop geological models and assess the Mineral Resource potential.

The historical results show that significant gold mineralisation was intersected on the VCR and Elsburg Reef horizons in the project area and potential exists to define a Mineral Resource base over these project areas. Insufficient data exists at present to define a compliant Mineral Resource for Yzerspruit but historical data suggests that an exploration target or “deposit” (as defined by the SAMREC code) exists over portions of Harrisburg with grades of 6.28g/t Au for the VCR and 4.85g/t Au for the Elsburg reefs.

Bothaville Gap Project

The Bothaville Gap project is located between the Klerksdorp and Free State goldfields, near the town of Bothaville, in the Free State Province of South Africa.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-20 –

xx

The project comprises a Prospecting Right which covers an area from Bothaville for 17km southwards. Access to the area is via tar roads, in particular the R59 and R30 national roads from Johannesburg, a distance of 200km, as well as rural gravel roads. The main electrified Johannesburg to Kimberley railway line (with stations at Klerksdorp) links to the Orkney-Kroonstad rail line, which traverses the property. No gold production from the Bothaville Gap project has occurred historically and consequently no mining infrastructure is present. The geological setting is considered to be analogous to the basin edge synclinal structure on Harmony’s Target Gold Mine, located to the south of the Bothaville Gap project area.

Other Greenfields projects

Taung’s greenfields portfolio also includes numerous additional licences in lower order ranking which occur in the Witwatersrand Basin, as well as greenstone belt-hosted, hydrothermal vein type deposits. The projects are all prospective for gold mineralisation and provide an excellent opportunity for Taung to move them up the value curve through appropriate and effective exploration activities.

CONCLUDING REMARKS

The Taung flagship projects, Evander and Jeanette, are intermediate depth gold projects in the Witwatersrand Basin, with a combined Mineral Resource of 92.4Mt at a grade of 7.03g/t Au for 23.2Moz Au (Table O) and Probable Mineral Reserves of 30.89Mt at 7.47g/t Au for 7.413Moz Au (Table P) (see Tables O and P for mining widths).

Table O : Taung Combined Mineral Resources for the Flagship Projects

TONNES
(t)*

GRADE
(g/t)
MINING WIDTH
(cm)
GOLD
(oz)
PROJECT CATEGORY
Miner al Resources
Evander
Jeanette
Indicated + Measured 15,573,078 9.25 105 4,632,598
Inferred
Indicated
13,984,700
23,025,000
7.63
9.58
103
100
3,430,589
7,092,000
Inferred(Basal) 11,537,000 9.58 100 3,553,000
Inferred(A-Reef) 28,336,000 4.95 113 4,510,000
**TOTAL TAUNG *** Measured, Indicated, Inferred 92,455,000 23,218,000

Source : Taung 2010, Turnberry 2010, Minxcon 2010

*Green : “A Reef” not included in economic evaluation

Mineral Resources quoted inclusive of Mineral Reserves

*Computational discrepancies due to rounding down Tonnes = above 3g/t cut-off

100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent

Table P : Taung Combined Mineral Reserves for the Flagship Projects

TONNES
(t)*

GRADE
(g/t)
MINING WIDTH
(cm)
GOLD
(oz)
PROJECT CATEGORY
Mine ral Reserves
Evander
Jeanette
Probable 8,640,000 8.00 104 2,222,259
Probable
Reserves
+
Economic
Inferred Mineral Resources
Probable
28,222,000
22,254,000
6.80
**7.25
104
***103
6,170,036
5,191,000
Probable
Reserves
+
Economic
Inferred Mineral Resources
30,130,000 **7.26 ***103 7,022,525
TOTAL TAUNG* Probable Reserves 30,894,000 7.47 104 7,413,000

Computational discrepancies due to rounding down Source: Turnberry 2010, Minxcon 2010 Tonnes = above 3g/t cut-off Head grade **Tramming width

100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-21 –

xxi

Both flagship projects are historic mines that were closed when higher grade, adjacent Witwatersrand Basin projects were deemed more attractive at that time. In addition, mining methods and support technology in the 1950s constrained effective mining below the Khaki Shale horizon at Jeanette, further motivating the development of other projects. Since 2006, the South African underground gold mining industry has been experiencing rising unit costs as a result of large fixed costs, declining volumes, increasing depths and declining grades. The large fixed costs base of existing older mines are by virtue of outdated and/or inefficient operations, transportation of ore over lomg distances to the shaft and mining ore bodies that have been preferentially depleted of high grade Mineral Reserves. Taung’s two flagship projects, Evander and Jeanette, are however, not constrained by these factors, and therefore represent a new generation of South African gold projects.

Evander and Jeanette are, in the Witwatersrand Basin mines context, intermediate depth projects and are projected to produce gold at grades of 6.55g/t Au and 7.25g/t Au respectively. These grades are well above the current average of 5.7g/t Au for the three major Witwatersrand gold mining companies. Furthermore, Taung has a unique advantage over historic and current South African gold operations in that it is able to streamline and design its operations specifically to suit to its production profiles. The resultant average cash operating cost estimate of USD82.5/t reflects this ability in comparison to the current average operating cost of close to USD125.0/t for the three major South African mining companies.

The Taung Mineral Reserves will be readily accessible to new shaft systems without the necessity of transporting ore over long distances and Taung will not be mining an ore body preferentially depleted of high grade Mineral Reserves, as is the case in many existing South African gold mines. Scoping Studies on the projects have indicated that the projects are economically robust under current economic parameters utilising modern, cost effective mining methods. The sound data base for the Taung projects enables the fast tracking of the Evander project to the PFS level in a time frame shorter than the industry norm, largely because computerised modelling can effectively optimise this valuable set of underground data.

The technical issues of mining below the Khaki Shale at Jeanette have been independently assessed as surmountable, and are being successfully managed in adjacent properties.

Both flagship projects can proceed from a platform of existing infrastructure and have the comfort of adjacent operations successfully mining and processing similar reefs under similar geological and structural environments.

Taung has demonstrated through Scoping Studies that, with appropriate, modern infrastructure, the projects have the ability to produce a combined annual production of 700,000oz Au, which will commence ramp-up operations in 2013 to optimally benefit from the predicted increase in the gold price.

Venmyn is of the opinion that the Taung flagship projects are based on sound geological information and interpretation, in historically well understood geological domains. Both flagship projects display demonstrable potential for increasing their Mineral Resource and Mineral Reserve base, and under the stewardship of the experienced Taung management team, should rapidly progress up the value curve, through the PFS stage to the BFS and development stages. In addition, Taung has a portfolio of prospective greenfields exploration projects that serves as a pipeline for future exploration efforts.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-22 –

xxii

INDEPENDENT COMPETENT PERSONS REPORT ON THE SOUTH AFRICAN GOLD ASSETS OF TAUNG GOLD LIMITED BY VENMYN RAND (PTY) LIMITED

1 INTRODUCTION.......................................................................................................................................... 1
1.1 Competent Persons Declaration and Scope of the Opinion .................................................................... 1
1.2 Source of Information .............................................................................................................................. 2
1.3 Site Visits ................................................................................................................................................. 2
1.4 Reliance on Other Experts ...................................................................................................................... 2
2 TAUNG CORPORATE STRUCTURE ......................................................................................................... 3
3 LOCATION OF TAUNG’S GOLD ASSETS ................................................................................................. 3
4 EVANDER PROJECT .................................................................................................................................. 3
4.1 Property Description and Location .......................................................................................................... 3
4.2 Legal Aspects and Tenure ....................................................................................................................... 5
4.3 Material Agreements................................................................................................................................ 8
4.3.1
Subscription, Shareholder and Sale Agreements with EGM .......................................................... 8
4.3.2
Survey of Property Boundaries ....................................................................................................... 8
4.3.3
Surface Rights ................................................................................................................................ 8
4.3.4
Ore Concentrate and Treatment Agreements ................................................................................ 8
4.3.5
Permits to Conduct Work ................................................................................................................ 8
4.3.6
South African Mining Law ............................................................................................................... 8
4.3.7
Royalties and Taxes ....................................................................................................................... 8
4.4 Accessibility, Infrastructure, Climate and Physiography .......................................................................... 9
4.4.1
Property Access .............................................................................................................................. 9
4.4.2
Topography, Climate and Vegetation ............................................................................................. 9
4.4.3
Infrastructure with Respect to Mining ............................................................................................. 9
4.5 History ...................................................................................................................................................... 9
4.5.1
Historical Exploration ...................................................................................................................... 9
4.6 Regional Geology and Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin ....................................................... 10
4.6.1
Stratigraphy of the Witwatersrand Basin ...................................................................................... 10
4.6.2
Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin .................................................................................... 13
4.6.3
Structural Controls of the Witwatersrand Basin ............................................................................ 13
4.7 Geological Setting of the Evander Goldfield .......................................................................................... 13
4.8 Local Geology of the Evander Project ................................................................................................... 13
4.9 Deposit Type and Mineralisation ........................................................................................................... 16
4.10
Exploration ........................................................................................................................................ 16
4.11
Geological Data ................................................................................................................................. 18
4.11.1
Drilling ....................................................................................................................................... 18
4.11.2
Sampling Methodology ............................................................................................................. 18

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-23 –

xxiii

4.11.3 Data Management, Processing and Verification ...................................................................... 18
4.12
Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves ........................................................................................ 18
4.12.1 Geological Modelling ................................................................................................................ 18
4.12.2 Conversion of Mineral Resources to Mineral Reserves ........................................................... 25
4.12.3 Logic for Inclusion of Inferred Mineral Resources in the Scoping Study .................................. 27
4.12.4 Logic for Classification of Evander Inferred Mineral Resources .............................................. 27
4.13
Techno-Economic Study – Mining .................................................................................................... 27
4.13.1 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 27
4.13.2 Geological Model and Mining Methodology in the Mine Design .............................................. 28
4.13.3 Evander Project Scheduling ..................................................................................................... 28
4.13.4 Mine Planning and Development/Stoping Scheduling ............................................................. 30
4.13.5 Production Schedule – Tonnage Sources and Profiles ............................................................ 30
4.13.6 Geotechnical and Hydrological Aspects ................................................................................... 30
4.13.7 Mining Infrastructure ................................................................................................................. 33
4.13.8 Ventilation Requirements ......................................................................................................... 34
4.13.9 Manpower ................................................................................................................................. 34
4.13.10 Capital Requirements and Costs .............................................................................................. 35
4.13.11 Working Capital ........................................................................................................................ 37
4.13.12 Project Risk Profile ................................................................................................................... 38
4.13.13 Gold Market Assessment ......................................................................................................... 39
4.14
Techno-Economic Study – Mineral Processing ................................................................................ 39
4.14.1 General ..................................................................................................................................... 39
4.14.2 Plant Design ............................................................................................................................. 39
4.15
Techno-Economic Study - Project Implementation ........................................................................... 39
4.16
Environmental Considerations .......................................................................................................... 39
4.16.1 Tailings Storage Facility ........................................................................................................... 40
4.17
Social, Community and Land Use ..................................................................................................... 40
4.18
Conclusions ....................................................................................................................................... 40
5 JEANETTE PROJECT ............................................................................................................................... 42
5.1 Property Description and Location ........................................................................................................ 42
5.2 Legal Aspects and Tenure ..................................................................................................................... 42
5.3 Material Agreements.............................................................................................................................. 44
5.3.1 Survey of Property Boundaries ..................................................................................................... 44
5.3.2 Surface Rights .............................................................................................................................. 44
5.3.3 Ore Concentrate and Treatment Agreement ................................................................................ 44
5.3.4 Permits to Conduct Work .............................................................................................................. 44
5.3.5 South African Mining Law , Royalties and Taxes ......................................................................... 44
5.4 Accessibility, Infrastructure, Climate and Physiography ........................................................................ 44
5.4.1 Property Access ............................................................................................................................ 44
5.4.2 Topography, Climate and Vegetation ........................................................................................... 44
5.4.3 Infrastructure with Respect to Mining ........................................................................................... 45
5.5 Historical ................................................................................................................................................ 45
5.5.1 Early Historical Exploration and Mine Development ..................................................................... 45
5.6 Regional Geology and Mineralisation .................................................................................................... 46
5.6.1 Regional Geology and Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin ............................................... 46
5.6.2 Regional Geological Setting of the Welkom Goldfield .................................................................. 46
5.7 Local Geology of the Jeanette Project................................................................................................... 49
5.7.1 Structure of the Jeanette Region .................................................................................................. 49
5.7.2 Stratigraphy of the Jeanette Project ............................................................................................. 49
5.7.3 Mineralised Reefs of the Jeanette Project .................................................................................... 49
5.8 Deposit Type and Mineralisation ........................................................................................................... 52

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-24 –

xxiv

5.8.1 Widths of the Mineralised Zones and Basal Reef Hanging Wall .................................................. 52
5.8.2 Orientation of the Mineralised Zones ............................................................................................ 52
5.9 Recent Exploration ................................................................................................................................ 53
5.10
Geological Data ................................................................................................................................. 53
5.10.1 Drilling – Due Diligence of Historic Drilling and Re-sampling ................................................... 53
5.10.2 Sampling Methodology ............................................................................................................. 55
5.11
Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves ........................................................................................ 57
5.11.1 Geological Modelling ................................................................................................................ 57
5.11.2 Mineral Resource and Reserve Estimates ............................................................................... 57
5.11.3 Summary of Mineral Resource Classification Logic for Jeanette ............................................. 61
5.11.4 Inclusion of Inferred Mineral Resources in the Scoping Study ................................................. 61
5.11.5 Modifying Factors ..................................................................................................................... 62
5.11.6 Jeanette Planned Exploration Expenditure .............................................................................. 63
5.12
Mining ................................................................................................................................................ 63
5.12.1 Overview ................................................................................................................................... 63
5.12.2 Mine Design in the Scoping Study............................................................................................ 64
5.12.3 Mine Planning and Scheduling ................................................................................................. 64
5.12.4 Manpower ................................................................................................................................. 68
5.12.5 Capital Requirements ............................................................................................................... 68
5.12.6 Working Capital ........................................................................................................................ 70
5.12.7 Project Risk Profile ................................................................................................................... 71
5.13
Processing ......................................................................................................................................... 71
5.14
Project Implementation ...................................................................................................................... 71
5.14.1 Contracting Strategy ................................................................................................................. 71
5.14.2 Status of Implementation .......................................................................................................... 71
5.14.3 Project Schedule....................................................................................................................... 71
5.15
Environmental Considerations .......................................................................................................... 72
5.15.1 Environmental Standards ......................................................................................................... 72
5.16
Social, Community and Land Use ..................................................................................................... 72
5.17
Conclusions ....................................................................................................................................... 72
6 GREENFIELDS PROJECTS ..................................................................................................................... 74
6.1 Hilton Project ......................................................................................................................................... 74
6.1.1 Property Description and Location ................................................................................................ 74
6.1.2 Property Accessibility, Climate and Physiography........................................................................ 76
6.1.3 Geology, Historical Exploration and Potential ............................................................................... 76
6.2 South Rand Project................................................................................................................................ 79
6.2.1 Property Description and Location ................................................................................................ 79
6.2.2 Property Accessibility, Climate and Physiography........................................................................ 81
6.2.3 Historical Exploration and Potential .............................................................................................. 81
6.2.4 Geology of the South Rand Basin ................................................................................................ 81
6.3 Bothaville Gap Project ........................................................................................................................... 82
6.3.1 Property Description and Location ................................................................................................ 82
6.3.2 Historical Exploration and Potential .............................................................................................. 88
6.3.3 Geology and Mineralisation .......................................................................................................... 88
6.4 Yzerspruit Project .................................................................................................................................. 88
6.4.1 Property Description and Location ................................................................................................ 88
6.4.2 Historical Exploration and Potential .............................................................................................. 91
6.4.3 Geology and Mineralisation .......................................................................................................... 91
6.5 Other Greenfield Projects ...................................................................................................................... 91
7 REFERENCES........................................................................................................................................... 92

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-25 –

xxv

LIST OF TABLES

Table 1 : Summary of Site Visits - Evander ...................................................................................................... 2 Table 2 : Reliance on Other Experts for Evander and Jeanette ........................................................................ 2 Table 3 : Summary of Taung's Gold Assets ...................................................................................................... 3 Table 4 : The Evander Project, Location, Extent and Rights Status ................................................................. 5 Table 5 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Six Shaft .............................................................................................. 8 Table 6 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Twistdraai ............................................................................................ 8 Table 7 : Stratigraphy of the Witwatersrand Basin .......................................................................................... 10 Table 8 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Six Shaft at Various Cut-off Grades, 2009 ................................... 21 Table 9 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Six Shaft Geo-zones at a Cut-off Grade of >500cmg/t Au (August 2009) ........................................................................................................................................... 22 Table 10 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Twistdraai at Various Cut-off Grades (August 2009) .................. 24 Table 11 : Mineral Resource Statement for Twistdraai Geo-zones at a Cut-off Grade of >500cmg/t Au ....... 24 Table 12 : Total Evander Mineral Resource in the Geo-zones at 100cm SW (>500cmg/t Cut-off Grade) May 2010 ............................................................................................................................................ 25 Table 13 : Modifying Factors for ‘Flats’ (Turnberry 2010) ............................................................................... 26 Table 14 : Modifying Factors for 'Steeps' (Turnberry 2010) ............................................................................ 26 Table 15 : Mineral Reserves for the Shaft Geo-zone, Six Shaft May 2010 ..................................................... 26 Table 16 : Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for Evander (Turnberry 2010) ... 27 Table 17 : Ramp-up Production Schedule for Evander ................................................................................... 31 Table 18 : Evander Project Staffing Profile at Full Production ........................................................................ 35 Table 19 : Phased Capital Expenditure ........................................................................................................... 35 Table 20 : Revised LoM Capital Expenditure .................................................................................................. 36 Table 21 : Future Exploration Expenditure for the Evander Project for the Financial Year ending February 2012 .................................................................................................................................................... 36 Table 22 : Evander Operating Cost Estimate (Turnberry 2010) ...................................................................... 37 Table 23 : Production Parameters and Phases in Relation to Costs .............................................................. 38 Table 24 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Jeanette ........................................................................................... 42 Table 25 : Historical Ownership and Exploration on Jeanette......................................................................... 45 Table 26: Borehole Values and Facies Type for the Basal Reef– Jeanette .................................................... 58 Table 27 : Grade Tonnage Data for the A Reef .............................................................................................. 60 Table 28: Consolidated Mineral Resource Estimate – Jeanette (Venmyn, August 2009) .............................. 61 Table 29: Design Criteria and Modifying Factors – Jeanette (Minxcon, 2010) ............................................... 62 Table 30: Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for Jeanette (Minxcon 2010 ....... 63 Table 31 : Exploration Expenditure for Jeanette for the Financial Year 2012 ................................................. 63 Ta ble 32 : Ramp-up Mining Production for Jeanette Scoping Study including Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources (Minxcon, 2010) ........................................................................................................ 65 Table 33 : Ramp-up Mining Production Schedule for Jeanette Scoping Study for Indicated Mineral Resources Only (Minxcon 2010) ................................................................................................................... 65 Table 34 : Production Statistics for Jeanette ................................................................................................... 67 Table 35 : Mining Capex Estimates for Jeanette Mine .................................................................................... 69 Table 36 : Total LoM Capital for Jeanette ....................................................................................................... 69 Table 37 : EPCM Activity Costs ....................................................................................................................... 69 Table 38 : Process Plant and Infrastructure Capital ........................................................................................ 70 Table 39 : Operating Costs over LoM .............................................................................................................. 70 Table 40 : Summary of Taung's Greenfields Assets ....................................................................................... 74 Table 41 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Hilton ............................................................................................... 76 Table 42 : Mineral Deposit Estimate of a Portion of the Hilton Area ............................................................... 77 Table 43 : Indicated Tonnage Estimates for Structural Blocks at Hilton ........................................................ 77 Table 44 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Balfour Region ................................................................................. 79 Table 45 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Witpoort Region............................................................................... 79 Table 46 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Roodepoort Region ......................................................................... 79 Table 47 : Historical Exploration in the South Rand Region ........................................................................... 81 Table 48 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of the Bothaville Project....................................................................... 82 Table 49 : Mineral Resource Statements for Adjacent Properties .................................................................. 88 Table 50 : Legal Aspects and Tenure - Harrisburg Area of the project ........................................................... 89 Table 51 : Legal Aspects and Tenure - Yzerspruit Area of the project ........................................................... 89 Table 52 : Evander Project Schedule ............................................................................................................ 114

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-26 –

xxvi

LIST OF FIGURES

Figure 1 :Taung Corporate Structure ................................................................................................................. 4 Figure 2 : Location of Taung’s Principal Gold Assets ........................................................................................ 6 Figure 3 : Location and Infrastructure of Six Shaft ............................................................................................ 7 Figure 4 : Historical Boreholes and Reef Intersections - Six Shaft and Twistdraai ......................................... 11 Figure 5 : Interpreted Regional Geology of the Witwatersrand Basin (Pre-Ventersdorp Age) ........................ 12 Figure 6 : Local Geology, Structure and Stratigraphy of Evander Goldfield ................................................... 14 Figure 7 : Regional Structural Control of the Evander Goldfield ..................................................................... 15 Figure 8 : Schematic Representation of the Nature and Evolution of the Evander Goldfield ......................... 17 Figure 9 : 3D Geological Model and Geo-zones Defined by Gold Content and Structural Domain................ 20 Figure 10 : Geo-zones and Structural Blocks Defined for the Evander Ore Body .......................................... 23 Figure 11 : Geo-zone Mining Sequence .......................................................................................................... 29 Figure 12 : Six Shaft and Twistdraai Annual Production and Waste Schedule............................................... 32 Figure 13 : Locality and Infrastructure of Jeanette .......................................................................................... 43 Figure 14 : Historical Exploration on Jeanette ................................................................................................. 47 Figure 15: Regional Structural Controls of the Welkom Goldfield ................................................................... 48 Figure 16: Local Geology and Structural Controls – Jeanette ........................................................................ 50 Figure 17 : Mine Design Criteria and Preliminary 3D Model of the Basal Reef .............................................. 59 Figure 18 : Target Mining Blocks for Jeanette ................................................................................................. 66 Figure 19 : Locality, Infrastructure and Historical Exploration - Hilton ............................................................ 75 Figure 20 : Structural Features - Hilton ........................................................................................................... 78 Figure 21 : Locality and Exploration Regions of the South Rand Project ....................................................... 80 Figure 22 : Geology and Structure of the South Rand Basin .......................................................................... 83 Figure 23: Geology and Historical Exploration - Balfour Region ..................................................................... 84 Figure 24 : Geology and Exploration of the Witpoort Region .......................................................................... 85 Figure 25: Geology and Exploration of Roodepoort Region............................................................................ 86 Figure 26 : Locality of the Bothaville Project Relative to Other Exploration Projects ...................................... 87 Figure 27 : Locality and Infrastructure of the Yzerspruit Project ..................................................................... 90 Figure 28 : Spot Price Trends in Gold ........................................................................................................... 111

LIST OF’NOTES TO CPR’

Note 1 : Glossary and Abbreviation, Units of Measurement and Acronyms ................................................... 95 Note 2 : Legal Aspects and Tenure Evander ................................................................................................ 100 Note 3 : South African Mining and Environmental Law ................................................................................. 102 Note 4 : Global Gold Market .......................................................................................................................... 109 Note 5 : Sampling Protocols for Evander ...................................................................................................... 112 Note 6 : Production Schedule for Evander .................................................................................................... 113 Note 7: Risk Assessment Matrix - Evander ................................................................................................... 115 Note 8 : Surface Rights Owners of Jeanette and Hilton ................................................................................ 118 Note 9 : Historical Sampling Results for Jeanette ......................................................................................... 120 Note 10 : Sampling Protocols for Due Diligence of the Reefs at Jeanette .................................................... 122 Note 11 : Re-sampled Intervals and Re-sampling for Basal Reef at Jeanette .............................................. 124 Note 12 : Risk Assessment Matrix for Jeanette............................................................................................. 126 Note 13 : Jeanette Project Schedule ............................................................................................................. 129 Note 14 : Greenfields Project Locations, Status of Legal Tenure and Size of Rights ................................... 130 Note 15 : Competent Persons Certificates .................................................................................................... 132

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-27 –

xxvii

DISCLAIMER AND RISKS

This Independent Competent Persons Report has been prepared by Venmyn. In the preparation of the report, Venmyn has utilised information relating to operational methods and expectations provided to them by Taung. Where possible, Venmyn has verified this information from independent sources after making due enquiry of all material issues that are required in order to comply with the JORC Code. Venmyn and its directors accept no liability for any losses arising from reliance upon the information presented in this report.

OPERATIONAL RISKS

The business of mining and mineral exploration, development and production by their nature contain significant operational risks. The business depends upon, amongst other things, successful prospecting programmes and competent management. Profitability and asset values can be affected by unforeseen changes in operating circumstances and technical issues.

POLITICAL AND ECONOMIC RISK

Factors such as political and industrial disruption, currency fluctuation and interest rates could have an impact on Taung’s future operations, and potential revenue streams can also be affected by these factors. The majority of these factors are, and will be, beyond the control of Taung or any other operating entity.

COMPLIANCE AND “NOTES” TO THE CPR

The techno-economic review of the Taung Assets has been compiled as a CPR, according to comprehensive checklists that ensure compliance with:-

  • Australasian Code for Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves (JORC Code);

  • reporting in compliance with the South African Code for the Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves (SAMREC Code);

  • the South African Code for the Reporting of Mineral Asset Valuation (SAMVAL Code); and

  • full compliance with the Hong Kong Exchange Listing Rules for Mineral and Exploration companies (Chapter 18).

Portions of the CPR that are required for full compliance that either contain information strategic to Taung’s operation or are applicable to all the flagship projects, have been extracted from the main body of the CPR and are presented as Notes at the end of the technical sections.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-28 –

1

1 INTRODUCTION

Taung holds the Prospecting Rights in respect of various gold developmental and exploration projects in the Mpumalanga, Limpopo, North West, Gauteng and Free State provinces of South Africa. These gold assets are combined into a focused entity whose business will be to develop the highly prospective projects and to conduct further exploration on the greenfields and brownfield exploration projects within the portfolio. Taung’s vision is to become a significant role player in the South African gold exploration, development and mining sector. The Group has implemented a sound business strategy ensuring steady value growth of its assets. Building on the technical strength and extensive industry experience of its management team, Taung has prepared detailed plans to grow the company and move it up the value curve.

Taung’s strategy is to generate shareholder value through securing competitive assets, conducting effective historical data investigation and exploration and thereafter, fast-tracking project proposal and development on the most attractive projects. The technical team, with the assistance of independent consultancy companies, has utilised historical and current exploration data and mining knowledge to add significant value to its flagship projects.

Taung’s Black Economic Empowerment (‘BEE’) partner is Sephaku Gold Holdings (Pty) Ltd (‘Sephaku’). Sephaku has undertaken to maintain its shareholding in Taung at the levels required by law.

The technical documentation in support of a ‘Very Substantial Acquisition’ (‘VSA’) between Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (‘Wing Hing’) and Taung on the Hong Kong Exchange (‘HKeX’), has been prepared for Taung and Wing Hing in the form of this Competent Persons Report (‘CPR’). The CPR describes and documents Taung’s flagship mineral assets, namely the Jeanette project in the Free State Province and the Evander project in the Mpumalanga Province. The Evander and Jeanette projects are advanced exploration projects for which Scoping Studies have been completed and for which Pre-Feasibility Studies (‘PFS’) are being commissioned. These flagship projects represent a sound and attractive base from which to accelerate through PFS to Bankable Feasibility Study (‘BFS’) and development phases. The CPR also includes the remaining Greenfields projects in various provinces, which are at an exploration stage and in respect of which no Mineral Resources have been reported. The CPR has been compiled by Venmyn according to propriety comprehensive checklists that ensure the following:-

  • reporting in compliance with the South African Code for the Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves (‘SAMREC Code’);

  • the South African Code for the Reporting of Mineral Asset Valuation (‘SAMVAL Code’);

  • reporting in compliance with the ‘Australasian Code for Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral Resources and Ore Reserves’ (‘JORC Code’); and

  • full compliance with the Hong Kong Exchange Listing Rules for Mineral and Exploration companies.

Throughout the CPR all monetary values are quoted in US dollars (‘USD’). An exchange rate of ZAR8.0:USD1.0 has been assumed (‘ZAR’ South African Rand).

1.1 Competent Persons Declaration and Scope of the Opinion

Venmyn is an independent advisory company and its consultants have extensive experience in preparing competent persons’, technical advisors’ and valuation reports for mining and exploration companies. Venmyn’s advisors have, collectively, more than 100 years of experience in the assessment and evaluation of mining projects and are members in good standing of appropriate professional institutions. The signatories to this report are qualified to express their professional opinions on the values of the mineral assets described and, to this end; Competent Persons Certificates are presented in Note 15.

Neither Venmyn nor its staff have, or have had, any interest in this project capable of affecting their ability to give an unbiased opinion, and have not and will not receive any pecuniary or other benefits in connection with this assignment, other than normal consulting fees. In executing its mandate, Venmyn undertook a technical evaluation of the contributing gold assets and project components in order to identify all modifying factors of both a technical and economic nature.

Venmyn also considered the strategic merits of the proposed projects and has defined the valuation outcomes on an open and transparent basis.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-29 –

2

1.2 Source of Information

This CPR has been based upon historical and current technical information supplied by Taung and its subsidiary companies. Portions of the technical information were sourced from independent technical and due diligence exercises conducted by other consultants, whose information and expert opinions are partially used in this report with permission and referenced in the appropriate positions in the text. A summary of the extent of the reliance on these independent experts is presented in Section 1.4 and a list of the source documentation is presented in Section 7. Taung has warranted that it has openly provided all material information to Venmyn, which, to the best of its knowledge and understanding, is complete, accurate and true.

1.3 Site Visits

The Taung flagship projects have been visited by Venmyn in the course of 2008 and 2009. The site visits conducted by independent consultant, Mr. D. Kershaw of The Mineral Corporation (‘TMC’), were conducted on the 14[th] and 22[nd] April 2008. The site visits to Evander are summarised in Table 1.

Table 1 : Summary of Site Visits - Evander

**PROJECT ** DATE EXPERT COMPANY
Evander and Jeanette 2008,2009 Mr A.N.Clay Venmyn
Evander 6 Shaft March 2008, July 2008 Mr G. Mitchell
Mr A. Deiss
Mr K. Pienaar
ExplorMine Consultants

1.4 Reliance on Other Experts

Venmyn has relied upon the independent opinion of the following experts to the extent and in the context described in the summary below. The technical reports by independent consultants have been reviewed by Venmyn and, having made due enquiry, Venmyn is reasonably assured that they are based on accepted South African industry practice and fairly represent Taung’s assets.

Venmyn has reviewed the legal title documentation and, whilst this does not constitute a legal opinion, the authors have satisfied themselves that the information presented herein is materially correct.

Table 2 : Reliance on Other Experts for Evander and Jeanette

**PROJECT ** EXPERT COMPANY TYPEOF STUDY DATE **EXTENTOF RELIANCE **
Evander
Six Shaft Mitchell G. ExplorMine Competent Persons Report
('CPR') of the Resource
Estimate for the Six Shaft
Mpumalanga Province,SA
2008 Reliance on data verification and
mineral resource estimate
Mitchell, G.
et al
ExplorMine CPR of the Resource
Estimate for the Evander Six
Shaft Area, Mpumalanga
Province,SA
2009 Reliance on data verification and
mineral resource estimate
Lemmer C. Geological and
Geostatistical
Services
Evander Upgrade
Requirements: Additional
Questions Addressed
2008 Reliance on statistical evaluation
Spindler T Turnberry/Ukwazi Reserve and Preliminary
Conversion of Mineral Resources to
,
et al

Group
Assessment -Mine Design
Criteria
2009
Mineral Reserves, Mine design
Twistdraai Posley A. Stefan, Roberts
andKirsten
Harmony CPR 2007 Reliance on data verification
Mitchell, G.
et al
Spindler et
al
ExplorMine CPR of the Resource
Estimate for the Twistdraai
Area, Evander Gold Mines,
Mpumalanga Province,SA
2009/2010 Reliance on data verification and
Mineral Resource estimation
Jeanette
Jeanette - The Mineral
Corporation
Evaluation of the Basal Reef
and
Kimberley
Formation
reefs in terms of tonnage and
grade,
updated
Mineral
Resource
2008 &
2009
Reliance on Due Diligence of the re-
sampling programme and mineral
resource estimate
Jeanette Lemmer C. Geological and
Geostatistical
Services
Jeanette project Resource
Upgrade Requirements
2008 Reliance on statistical evaluation
Jeanette Campbell D. Sound Mining
Solutions(‘SMS’)
Jeanette Gold Mine project
ScopingStudy
2009 Reliance on conversion of mineral
resources to reserves,mineplan and

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-30 –

3

**PROJECT ** EXPERT COMPANY TYPEOF STUDY DATE **EXTENTOF RELIANCE **
scheduling
Jeanette Keen, J.E. Consulting Rock
Engineering
A Technical Assessment of
the Feasibility of proposed
Mining of the Basal reef
overlain byKhaki Shales
2008 Technical assessment of potential to
safely mine below the shale
Jeanette Odendal,J. Minxcon Technical Review 2010
Greenfields Project
South Rand Mitchell G. ExplorMine Report
on
Stratigraphic
Correlation of Boreholes
2007 Reliance on stratigraphic confirmation
Bothaville Gap Bargmann,
C.
Snowden Geological
Report
on
Sephaku’s Gold Explorations
Bothaville GapProject
2008 Due Diligence of Historical Data
Hilton - The Mineral
Corporation
Technical review of historical
data
2008 Reliance on due diligence of original
borehole data and potential
mineralisation estimate

Source: Taung

2 TAUNG CORPORATE STRUCTURE

Taung was incorporated in 2004 for the purpose of holding the South African gold assets of APM, a gold exploration company registered in the British Virgin Islands.

Originally incorporated under the name Midnight Masquerade Properties 151 (Pty) Limited, the company changed its name to Taung Gold Holdings (Pty) Limited in 2005. Taung was subsequently converted from a private to a public company called Taung Gold Holdings Limited and the company name changed to Taung Gold Limited. Taung ceased to be a subsidiary of APM in 2008.

Sephaku is Taung’s Black Economic Empowerment (‘BEE’) partner and holds a 26% equity interest in Taung (Figure 1).

Taung’s corporate structure is illustrated in the organizational structure in Figure 1.

3 LOCATION OF TAUNG’S GOLD ASSETS

Taung holds prospecting and mining rights in respect of various gold assets in the Mpumalanga, Limpopo, Gauteng, North West and Free State Provinces of South Africa as summarised in Table 3. The majority of the assets, including Taung’s flagship projects are situated within the world renowned Witwatersrand Basin and the location of these assets is illustrated in Figure 2.

Table 3 : Summary of Taung's Gold Assets

PROVINCE PROJECT PROPERTY SIZE (ha) HELD BY TYPE OF RIGHT
Mpumalanga
Free State
Various
Evander
Jeanette
Greenfields
SixShaft 2,452 EvanderGoldMinesLimited NewOrder MiningRight
Twistdraai
Jeanette
Various
2,677
3,886
96,401
Evander Gold Mines Limited
Taung Gold Free State (Pty)
Limited
Various
New Order Mining Right
New Order Prospecting Right
New Order ProspectingRights
Source: Taung 20 11

4 EVANDER PROJECT

4.1 Property Description and Location

The Evander project (‘Evander’) consists of two adjacent areas, namely Six Shaft area (‘Six Shaft’) and Twistdraai area (‘Twistdraai’), located in the eastern Highveld of the Mpumalanga Province of South Africa as summarised in Table 4 and illustrated in Figure 2 and Figure 3.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-31 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-32 –

5

Table 4 : The Evander Project, Location, Extent and Rights Status

PROVINCE PROJECT PROPERTY SIZE(ha) HELD BY TYPE OF RIGHT
Mpumalanga Evander Six Shaft 2,452 Evander Gold Mines Ltd New Order MiningRight
Twistdraai 2,677 Evander Gold Mines Ltd New Order Mining Right
TOTAL 5,129
Source: Taung

The Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects are located in the Govan Mbeki Local Municipality, of South Africa and form part of the Evander Goldfield on the northeastern limb of the Witwatersrand Basin (Figure 2 and Figure 6). Both projects are approximately 120km east-southeast of Johannesburg, with Six Shaft some 10km east of the town of Evander and Twistdraai 12km east of Evander. The project area occurs within the urbanised region of Secunda-Sasol and the town of Secunda is the main centre servicing the Evander Goldfield.

Harmony Gold Mining Company Limited (‘Harmony’) originally acquired a 100% interest in the assets in 1998 and consolidated the assets into an Old Order Mining Right. EGM currently operates No 8 Shaft in the region. EGM’s No 9 Shaft is on care and maintenance and No 3, 4, 6 and 10 Shafts are either closed or used as ventilation shafts. The neighbouring mines do not have direct access to the underground working at No 6 Shaft, although there is twin haulage from Evander No 5 Shaft on 22 Level, possibly to the shaft position of the future sub-vertical shaft at No 6 Shaft.

The Six Shaft project area is largely un-mined except for a small area in the vicinity of No 6 Shaft where approximately 2Mt of Kimberley Reef was mined between September 1986 and June 1998 at a reported grade of 7.82g/t over a width of 147cm (88cm channel width). Twistdraai is directly south of Six Shaft, as illustrated in Figure 3.

4.2 Legal Aspects and Tenure

The properties comprising the Six Shaft project are held by EGM, a subsidiary of Harmony. EGM was granted a new order Mining Right over an extensive mining area, which includes the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas, on 29[th] April 2008. The mining right is valid for a period of 30 years (as summarised in Table 5 and Table 6). The summary below does not constitute a legal opinion but the authors of this Techno-economic report have reviewed the legal title documentation.

Taung entered into an earn-in agreement with EGM on 29[th] February 2008 with respect to the Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects. Subsequent to that on, 10[th] September 2010, a Sale Agreement was concluded in terms of which a Taung subsidiary will purchase 100% of the projects from EGM for a purchase price of USD28.125m.

Ministerial permission for transfer of the projects into Taung’s name is required, but should the transfer not be approved for any reason, the existing earn-in agreement will continue to apply. The principal agreements constituting the earn-in agreement are summarised in Section 4.3 and Note 2.

All governmental requirements for the exploration of the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas have been obtained or approved. Although the Six Shaft and Twistdraai areas are from a contractual perspective, separate projects, the areas have for the purpose of the Scoping Study, been treated as a single entity. The rationale for this approach is that the projects are adjacent to each other and as single entities, they do not constitute economically viable projects. The Scoping Study constitutes consolidated Scoping Studies for both Six Shaft and Twistdraai.

The legal tenure of mineral properties within South Africa is governed by the Mineral and Petroleum Resources Development Act, No 28 of 2002 (‘MPRDA’). The MPRDA came into effect on 1[st] May 2004. (see Note 3). There are no legal proceedings that would affect Taung’s ability to proceed with further investigation and exploration activities.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-33 –

==> picture [432 x 651] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-34 –

==> picture [432 x 651] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-35 –

8

Table 5 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Six Shaft

PROJECT FARM SIZE MINING COMMENCE- EXPIRY
DATE
MINERAL
HELD BY
(ha)) RIGHT MENT DATE
Si Shft Driefontein
137IS
Holfontein 138
2453 MP30/5/1/2/2/126MR 29A08 30 Gold and
associated
minerals

New order Mining
Right
held
by
EGM. Section 11
Transfer pending.
x a IS
Linana 493 IS
, Mining Right 107/2010 -pr- years
Czanik534 IS
TOTAL 2,453

Source: Taung

Table 6 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Twistdraai

PROJECT FARM SIZE MINING COMMENCE- EXPIRY
DATE
MINERAL HELD BY
(ha) RIGHT MENT DATE
Goedehoop 290IS 2677 MP30/5/1/2/2/126MR 29A08 30 Gold and
associated
minerals


Titdi Twistdraai 285IS
Fdi 486IS
New
order
Mining
Right held by EGM
Section 11 Transfer
pending
wsraa er
Sasolkraal 289IS
, Mining Right 107/2010 -pr- years
Goedehoop 533IS
TOTAL 2,677
Source: Taung

Key provisions of the various agreements are summarised as follows:-

4.3 Material Agreements

4.3.1 Subscription, Shareholder and Sale Agreements with EGM

The historical agreements are summarised in Note 2.

4.3.2 Survey of Property Boundaries

The properties indicated in Table 5 and Table 6 are registered with the South African Deeds Office. Property boundaries and corner beacons have been interrogated as part of the Mining and Prospecting Right applications of previous and current right holders.

4.3.3 Surface Rights

Taung does not hold any surface rights in the Twistdraai area. The rights to the surface area at Six Shaft to be acquired from EGM in terms of the EGM Sale Agreement, is sufficient for the location of the proposed plant infrastructure and waste rock dumps.

4.3.4 Ore Concentrate and Treatment Agreements

Currently there are no agreements in place for the treating of ore, and such agreements will only be negotiated upon the favourable outcome of a complete PFS.

4.3.5 Permits to Conduct Work

All permits required to conduct exploration have been obtained and all governmental requirements have been met.

4.3.6 South African Mining Law

The mining law applicable to the South African minerals industry, including the Mining Charter and the Mineral and Petroleum Resources Royalty Act (MPRRA) are discussed in Note 3.

4.3.7 Royalties and Taxes

See Note 3 for the discussion and calculation of the royalties and taxes applicable under South African Mining Law. Taung will produce refined products and consequently will pay a 5% royalty.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-36 –

9

4.4 Accessibility, Infrastructure, Climate and Physiography

4.4.1 Property Access

Gold and coal mining has been conducted in the Evander Goldfield area for 50 years and, consequently, access and mining related infrastructure is well developed (Figure 3). Access to Six Shaft is by well-maintained paved roads and the area has well established rail links and an airfield.

4.4.2 Topography, Climate and Vegetation

The southwestern part of the Mpumalanga Province is a gently undulating plain, with the immediate area of Six Shaft, approximately 1,620m (‘above mean sea level’) amsl. The area is extensively cultivated, while gold mining, coal mining, petrochemicals and agriculture are the main economic activities in the area. The surface is traversed by a number of small seasonal drainage canals.

Mpumalanga has a varied subtropical climate with summer rainfall with hot and humid days. The winter months are mild but the temperatures in the Highveld are lower than the Lowveld areas. Summer temperatures range from 19°C to 33°C, while winter temperatures range from 6°C to 26°C.

The area has a summer (October to April) rainfall, averaging around 600mm to 800mm per annum. The winters are generally very dry. Due to the underground nature of the operation at Six Shaft, the climate is not a risk factor that will affect operations, and exploration and mining activities will be feasible throughout the year.

4.4.3 Infrastructure with Respect to Mining

Six Shaft is a vertical shaft complex, comprising an 8.5m diameter man, material and rock hoisting shaft and a 6.0m diameter ventilation shaft. The main shaft is 1,576m deep (18 Level) and services mining operations above 17 Level. The ventilation shaft (780m deep) is equipped with a brattice wall, buntons and guides for an emergency cage. The Six Shaft shaft winders, headgear, pumps and ancillary equipment were sold to a third party.

The original design capacity of the shaft was 200,000tpm, although mining and ventilation constraints resulted in historically lower production rates. The shaft complex is equipped with three main surface ventilation fans, rated to circulate 450kg/s of air. There is limited cooling plant installation which includes a 450kg/s bulk air cooler.

The Kimberley Reef can be accessed from 4 to 17 Levels. These levels and related mine infrastructure were developed from 1986 until the shaft was closed in 1998.

Electrical and water supply infrastructure is very well established in this portion of the Mpumalanga Province. Electrical supply is provided through an existing agreement with Eskom (the electrical service parastatal).

Water is supplied by a parastatal organisation from the Vaal River, and water supply to the Evander Goldfield is unlikely to be a future limiting factor since most of the current mining operations in the Goldfield were planned with greater production profiles than are currently operable. A 160Mm[3] per annum water pipeline, delivering water from the Vaal River to Secunda, has recently been completed.

4.5 History

4.5.1 Historical Exploration

Interest in gold-bearing reefs of the Central Rand Group in the Evander Goldfield started in 1902, but the first major advance in exploration occurred in August 1951, when boreholes, originally sited to intersect the Main Reef (at the base of the Central Rand Group), intersected gold-bearing conglomerates stratigraphically above the Main Reef. These conglomerates were assigned to the Kimberley and Elsburg Formations, and future exploration in that portion of the Witwatersrand Basin focused on the Kimberley Reef.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-37 –

10

Geophysical surveys significantly contributed to the understanding of the structure of the goldfield.

A total of 39 surface exploration boreholes with 124 associated reef deflections were drilled in the Six Shaft area, the last of which was drilled in 1988 (see Figure 4).

In addition, in excess of 400 underground diamond drill holes were drilled from underground excavations for reef and structural intersections during the duration of Six Shaft mining operations.

At Twistdraai the historical drilling programme included 19 boreholes with 89 reef sections. A full review of the data provided confidence in the reliability of the historic data and a statistical evaluation showed that the number of intersections of Kimberley Reef that occur on Twistdraai are sufficient for Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources to be estimated.

4.6 Regional Geology and Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin

The Evander project is located in the Evander Goldfield on the northeastern margin of the Achaean Witwatersrand Gold Basin, on the Kaapvaal Craton in South Africa (Figure 2).

The Late Archaean Witwatersrand Gold Basin is an oval shaped basin, 160km long and 80km wide, which hosts the largest gold ore province globally. The numerous gold deposits are grouped geographically into goldfields as illustrated in Figure 5, separated by “gaps”, in which economic deposits have yet to be discovered. Approximately 48,670t of gold was produced between 1886 and 2000, which amounts to 40% of all the gold mined during recorded history. Unexploited gold resources were estimated in 2008 at 36,000t of gold, representing an estimated 40.1% of world resources (Conradie, 2008).

Deposition in the Witwatersrand Basin took place along the interface between a fluvial system and a major inland sea. The source of the gold is problematic and is postulated as being a northerly Archaean Greenstone, which eroded and was subsequently re-deposited as sediments.

The basin is filled with approximately 14,000m of sedimentary and subordinate volcanic rocks, which have folded along a northeast to southwest axis into an asymmetrical syncline (Pretorius, 1974).

4.6.1 Stratigraphy of the Witwatersrand Basin

The Witwatersrand Basin is underlain by an Archaean (>3.1Ga) granite-greenstone basement and the 3.086Ga to 3.074Ga Dominion Group. The basin is unconformably overlain, by rocks of the Ventersdorp Supergroup (~2.7Ga), the Transvaal Supergroup (~2.6Ga) and the Karoo Supergroup (~280Ma). The stratigraphy of the Witwatersrand Basin is summarised in Table 7:-

Table 7 : Stratigraphy of the Witwatersrand Basin

ORIGINAL NOMENCL ATURE(MELLOR 1917) SACS TERMI NOLOGY 1980
Upper Witwatersrand
System
Kimberley/ ElsburgSeries Central Rand Group Turffontein Subgroup
Main-Bird series Johannesburg
Subgroup
Lower Witwatersrand
System
Jeppestown Series West Rand Group Jeppestown Subgroup
Government Reef Series Government Subgroup
Hospital Hill Series Hospital Hill Subgroup

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-38 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-39 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-40 –

13

4.6.2 Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin

The origin of the gold mineralisation in the Witwatersrand Basin has been the source of debate for over 100 years. The debate has been historically divided between the syngenetic or placer proponents and the epigenetic or hydrothermal model. At present, the most widely accepted model is the ‘modified placer model’ whereby, placer gold grains have been remobilised possibly during hydrothermal events.

The majority of the economic reefs within the Witwatersrand Basin are located stratigraphically in the Central Rand Group but it is significant that the principal reefs of the geographically separated goldfields of the basin, do not all occur at the same stratigraphic level. Economic gold concentrations commonly extend for 10km to 30km down depositional dip, and for up to 10km to 12km along depositional strike and are postulated to represent mineralised channels within the postulated braid-plains.

4.6.3 Structural Controls of the Witwatersrand Basin

The Witwatersrand has been affected by several superimposed structural events which are differentiated as syn-deposition and post-deposition deformations.

Syn-depositional deformation played a key role in the distribution of sediments, controlled the locality of auriferous conglomerates and the thickness of enclosing sedimentary sequences. Later faulting and folding of the sequence determined which parts of the basin remained buried, as well as the depths to mineable horizons, relative to the present-day surface.

Extensional tectonics during and post-Ventersdorp times resulted in the ubiquitous development of normal and wrench faulting present throughout the basin (Stanistreet et al., 1986) and after the Transvaal Sequence was deposited, a high-strain event resulted in the formation of folds, bedding parallel faults and regional low-angle cleavage (McCarthy et al., 1986).

4.7 Geological Setting of the Evander Goldfield

The Evander Goldfield is arcuate in shape, lying between the towns of Leandra in the northeast, Kinross in the north, Trichardt in the east, and Secunda in the southeast. The southern and western margins are well defined by geological data from mining and exploration; however the northern and eastern limits, being at greater depth, are less well understood.

The Evander Goldfield is characterised by basin margin faulting, thought to be syn-deposition (Witwatersrand) in age (Figure 7 and Figure 6). The northeastern margin of the basin is dominated by a northwest striking asymmetrical fold structure with strata overturned to the west and thrust faulted. The southern margin of the basin is fault-bounded by structure parallel to the Sugarbush Fault (Figure 4).

4.8 Local Geology of the Evander Project

The Evander project is located on the eastern margin of the Evander Basin, which is characterised by a northwest-striking asymmetrical fold structure, where strata are overturned to the west (Figure 6).

The main gold-bearing horizon is the Kimberley Reef of the Evander Quartzite Formation within the Turffontein Subgroup of the Witwatersrand Supergroup (Figure 5). The Kimberley Reef varies in thickness from a “pencil line” thickness (referred to locally as “waste on contact” or “WOC”) to in excess of 300cm. The Kimberley Reef is a polymictic conglomerate, composed primarily of quartz and banded cherts. Pebble diameters vary from 4mm to 60mm, and are mostly well rounded.

The Evander project is structurally complicated (Figure 4, Figure 6 and Figure 7). The dominant structure is an asymmetrical northwesterly plunging fold with a steep western dip between 60° and 90° and locally over turned. The eastern limb dips 25° to the east. The Kimberley Reef sub-crops against the Black Reef Formation and the Karoo Supergroup at approximately 200m below surface, whilst to the north, the reef sub-crops at progressively deeper levels against the Transvaal Supergroup.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-41 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-42 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-43 –

16

Westerly verging thrust faulting, which is syn-Witwatersrand in age, is associated with the steep western limb, whilst relatively steeply-dipping, south down-throw normal faults (mid-Ventersdorp age) striking essentially northeast-southwest, displace the faults and the strata (Figure 7). Large losses of ground are associated with the normal faulting. There has been only minor lateral displacement along the normal faults, and “pay” channels can normally be traced across them.

4.9 Deposit Type and Mineralisation

The model of the evolution of the Evander Goldfield mineralisation is schematically represented in Figure 8. The gold-bearing Kimberley Reef includes a composite sequence of fluvial and channel sediments and was deposited on a palaeo-surface striking northwest-southeast and dipping to the northeast. The Kimberley Reef in the Evander Basin represents proximal to distal facies of a fluvial placer formed by a braided stream system (Figure 8). The sedimentological model has been used as a basis for the geostatistical modelling which contributed to the Mineral Resource evaluation.

The theoretical palaeo-drainage pattern, indicated by the sedimentation suggests a broad depositional front striking northwest-southeast. In the Evander No 2, No 5 and No 6 Shaft areas specifically, it is evident from the facies distribution that the depositional front may be modified by material input from the eastern basin margin at approximately 70° to the depositional front (Figure 8).

In the Six Shaft area, a significant east west depositional and channel trend (Thick Reef facies) in the southern portions of the goldfield is identified, which may represent an overprint on the dominant southeast to northwest (Thin Reef facies) depositional trend present in the remainder of the basin (Figure 8). This sedimentological model is the basis for the geostatistical modelling.

In the Twistdraai area, Taung Gold geologists in consultation with EGM geologists have interpreted basin evolution and depositional trends as presented in Figure 8. The important feature in terms of the Twistdraai project area is the recognition of a southeast to northwest depositional and channel trend (‘Northern Thin Reef facies’) in the northern portions of the goldfield (No 5 Shaft areas and northwestwards).

Gold occurs in the Kimberley Reef as free particles in the conglomerate matrix or as inclusions within compact detrital pyrite. The gold distribution corresponds to sedimentological controls within the Kimberley Reef and associated channels within the Evander Basin. The channels are braided with the gold distribution showing both lateral and vertical variation in response to the sedimentary processes during deposition.

Nodular pyrite, chromite, rutile, zircon and leucoxene as well as minor quantities of gold, uraninite and osmiridium are present in the matrix of the Kimberley Reef.

4.10 Exploration

No exploration activities have been conducted by Taung on the Evander project. However, numerous Independent Due Diligence exercises on the historic exploration and mining data have been conducted by various independent consultants. The comprehensive audit by ExplorMine of the historical Six Shaft borehole data concluded that the data was reliable for Mineral Resource estimation. A complete sedimentological interpretation of the Evander Goldfield Basin evolution and depositional trends has been developed.

The significant result of the study is the recognition of an east west depositional and channel trend in the southern portions of the Evander Goldfield and a southeast to northwest depositional trend in the remainder of the Evander Goldfield. The east to west depositional trends could represent a later ‘overprint’ of the dominant southeast to northwest depositional trend. This sedimentological model has been used as a basis for geostatistical modelling and 3D modelling of the Kimberley Reef.

Future exploration efforts are intended to focus on the upgrading of the Inferred Mineral Resource to the Indicated Mineral Resource category and further delineate structural controls on the preservation of the Kimberley Reef in this area.

The significant result of the study is the recognition of an east west depositional and channel trend in the southern portions of the Evander Goldfield and a southeast to northwest depositional trend in the remniade rot fhe Evande rGdlodleif .

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-44 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-45 –

18

The east to west depositional trends could represent a later ‘overprint’ of the dominant southeast to northwest depositional trend. This sedimentological model has been used as a basis for geostatistical modelling and 3D modelling of the Kimberley Reef. Future exploration efforts are intended to focus on the upgrading of the Inferred Mineral Resource to the Indicated Mineral Resource category and further delineate structural controls on the preservation of the Kimberley Reef in this area.

4.11 Geological Data

4.11.1 Drilling

No drilling has been conducted by Taung to date on the Evander project.

The historical surface drilling programmes comprised 39 surface exploration boreholes with 124 associated reef deflections.

Underground borehole and stope face chip sampling data outweighs the surface borehole data by orders of magnitude. Underground diamond drilling was conducted using compressed air driven drill rigs, which typically drilled ‘A’ size (27mm diameter) core from short boreholes to depths rarely exceeding 300m in length, with 100% core recovery (ExplorMine 2009).

4.11.2 Sampling Methodology

The detailed historical sampling methodology, sample preparation and laboratory procedures for the sampling programme are described in detail in Note 5.

4.11.3 Data Management, Processing and Verification

Historical datasets have been independently reviewed by ExplorMine and electronically captured to form the basis for a geostatistical Mineral Resource estimation.

The following data capture protocols were maintained during the data capture:-

  • imperial versus metric units were rationalised;

  • all local co-ordinate systems were converted toLO29 System based on the World Geodetic System (WGS84);

  • collar co-ordinates were transformed to be compatible with Datamine™;

  • magnetic declination was applied to all surface down-hole surveys;

  • all elevation (Z) values were referenced to mean sea level;

  • all datasets were de-surveyed utilising the Datamine™ De-survey option; and

  • underground borehole reef intersections were captured as point data.

Eight of the surface boreholes proved inadequate for incorporation in the database and, in total, 31 surface boreholes and 111 underground boreholes were finally used.

4.12 Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves

The Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves presented in this CPR are fully compliant with the SAMREC and JORC Codes. The statements were prepared by independent specialist consultants from nationally and internationally renowned consulting groups, in conjunction with Taung’s technical specialists. The Evander Mineral Resource estimates represent the total tonnage of in-situ mineralisation delineated within the drilled areas and above a defined cut-off.

Taung Gold’s Evander Mineral Reserves represent those portions of the Mineral Resource which can be economically mined under defined parameters, and which are planned to be mined within a designed mine plan. The Mineral Resources are quoted as inclusive of Mineral Reserves.

4.12.1 Geological Modelling

A complete re-evaluation of the Six Shaft and Twistdraai historical Mineral Resources was undertaken by ExplorMine (2009). The 3D modelling of the ore body utilising Datamine™ software resulted in the geological model presented in Figure 9a.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-46 –

19

4.12.1.1 Six Shaft – Methodology and Estimation Procedures

An initial geological model was constructed utilising geological sections perpendicular to strike.

All the sections were interpreted in Datamine™ and the geological sections formed the basis of the geological wireframe model creation. In successive sections the same structural features were linked to create wireframe surfaces which were utilised as boundaries for the stratigraphic wireframe modelling.

The Six Shaft area was divided according to identifiable and known reef facies types, into northern and southern facies areas and further split according to reef characteristics. An axial line parallel to the fold axis was constructed and used to divide the block models into ‘inclined’ and ‘flat’ models. Block sizes used were as follows:-

Measured Resource 30mx30mx10m;

Indicated Resource 60mx60mx10m; and

Inferred Resource 120mx120mx120m.

The resultant 3D models of the structure, reef morphology and grade distribution for the Kimberley Reef at Six Shaft are illustrated in Figure 9 and Figure 10 and clearly indicate the folding, faulting and sedimentologically controlled grade distributions, which will affect mining strategy and economics going forward.

A Kriging process was applied to the 3D geological model, which produced a 2D spatial distribution of low and high grade regions in horizontal and incline planes, which permitted development of the single reef mining design.

4.12.1.2 Mineral Resource Classification – Six Shaft

Measured Mineral Resource was estimated utilising the search distance corresponding to the range at three quarters of the total variance on point variogram for each domain (Snowden, 1996) for the Au mg/t parameter and the channel width. A minimum number of five samples were accessed by the search volume.

The Indicated Mineral Resource was defined by the search radius greater than that defining the Measured Mineral Resource but less than the range of the 60m regularised semi-variogram. A minimum number of three samples were accessed by the search volume.

The Inferred Mineral Resource was defined by a search radius greater than that defining the Indicated Mineral Resource. Areas that were not estimated by the range of the 120m semi-variogram were then estimated by an unlimited search radius. The geostatistical methodology described above was applied to each domain individually.

The Mineral Resource estimations at various cut-off grades are presented in Table 8. The Mineral Resource tabulation suggests that the Indicated Mineral Resource is the most sensitive to increases in cut-off grade and that the higher grade portions of the Inferred Mineral Resource should be targeted for exploration efforts to upgrade them to an Indicated classification.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-47 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-48 –

21

Table 8 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Six Shaft at Various Cut-off Grades, 2009

MINING MINING MINING MINING CHANNEL CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
GOLD GOLD
MINERAL RESOURCE
CATEGORY
TONNES
(t)
GRADE
(g/t)
WIDTH
(cm)
GRADE
(cmg/t)
WIDTH
(cm)
(kg)
(oz)
S ix Shaft, Total Project Miner al Resource s at a 300cmg/t Cut-off Gr ade
Measured 147,400 10.30 117 1,173 86 13.71 1,518 48,812
Indicated 16,794,900 7.70 102 793 59 13.55 129,321 4,157,758
Inferred 4,623,000 5.36 100 536 34 15.59 24,779 796,672
Total Measured and Indicated 16,942,300 7.72 103 796 59 13.56 130,839 4,206,569
S ix Shaft, Total Project Miner al Resource s at a 400cmg/t Cut-off Gr ade
Measured 144,803 10.42 117 1,188 86 13.81 1,509 48,511
Indicated 13,029,300 8.90 103 919 66 13.92 115,961 3,728,225
Inferred 3,476,000 5.91 100 591 35 16.69 20,530 660,478
Total Measured and Indicated 13,174,103 8.91 103 922 66 13.92 117,470 3,776,736
S ix Shaft, Total Project Miner al Resource s at a 500cmg/t Cut-off Gr ade
Measured 140,078 10.63 118 1,213 87 13.92 1,489 47,873
Indicated 10,972,700 9.73 104 1,008 71 14.20 106,764 3,432,554
Inferred 2,354,000 6.58 100 658 36 18.03 15,480 497,993
Total Measured and Indicated 11,112,778 9.74 104 1,011 71 14.20 108,269 3,480,427
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCES* 13,466,000 9.19 103 949 65 14.57 123,749 3,978,000

Source: ExplorMine 2009

  • 100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent Mineral Resources inclusive of Mineral Reserves

  • *Computational inconsistencies due to rounding down

In order to make the exploration decisions to upgrade Mineral Resources, a closer study of the structural characteristics of the ore body in terms of grade, tonnage, depth below surface and dip was required, the conclusions of which are discussed below.

4.12.1.3 Structural Blocks and Geo-zone Demarcation – Six Shaft

Explormine identified five high grade geological domains within the Six Shaft ore body. The high-grade geological domains are defined as ‘geo-zones’ by Taung and were incorporated in the mine design and mine plan completed by Turnberry 2010 (Figure 9). In addition, the Six Shaft ore body has been split into structural blocks based on the following criteria (Figure 9b and Figure 10):-

  • geological structure: position relative the major northsouth fault that splits the ore body into the East Orebody and West Orebody (Figure 10b);

  • reef morphology and dip: the ore body comprises a steep fold limb in the west (70º dip to vertical) which turns at depth into a shallow dipping reef (average 20º) as illustrated in Figure 6 and Figure 9;

  • geo-zone; defined as a high grade target area with grades of >500cmg/t Au. Five geo-zones have been identified, as illustrated in Figure 9b;

  • depth below surface; the Six Shaft ore body is split into north and south, above and below 17 level on either side of the ore body fold axis (Figure 10b).

The geographic distribution of the various geo-zones and structural blocks show a clear demarcation into the East Orebody and West Orebody across the central fault. The East Orebody contains the high grade mineralisation and is a result of the development of Thick Reef facies. In the West Orebody the Thin Reef facies is developed and, at this stage, the extent to which these facies types impinge upon each other is unknown (Figure 10).

The Mineral Resources for each structural block (Figure 10b) were determined. Furthermore, a study of the distribution of gold content (>500cmg/t), grade and channel widths revealed that within the defined structural blocks, the following areas of note exist:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-49 –

22

  • a single zone of higher grade in the East Orebody, in the vicinity of the current shaft infrastructure (Figure 10b); and

  • two distinct higher grade zones in the West Orebody (Figure 9b), namely a western zone bounding the current No 5 and No 2 Evander Shafts; and an eastern zone termed the ‘2010 Payshoot’.

The Mineral Resource estimates for these Structural Blocks (Figure 10) are summarised in Table 9:-

Table 9 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Six Shaft Geo-zones at a Cut-off Grade of >500cmg/t Au (August 2009)

GEO-ZONE MINING
GRADE
GOLD
MINERAL
RESOURCE
MINING
TONNES
MINING
WIDTH
MINING
GRADE
CHANNEL
WIDTH
CHANNEL
GRADE
GOLD
CATEGORY (t) (g/t) (cm) (cmg/t) (cm) (g/t) (kg) (oz)
2010 North
Inferred
2010 Central
Inferred
2010 South
Indicated
Inferred
Mine Geo-
zone
Indicated
Shaft Geo-
zone
Measured
Indicated
Inferred
Total Measured and
Indicated Mineral
Resources
TOTAL MINERAL
RESOURCES*
Inferred
Inferred
Indicated
Inferred
Indicated
544,000
927,000
372,300
650,000
1,120,800
140,078
9,351,500
58,000
10,984,678
5.66
6.96
5.53
6.80
6.03
10.63
10.37
10.69
9.76
100
100
100
100
100
118
104
100
104
567
695
554
681
603
1,213
1,081
1,073
1,015
44
33
39
33
37
87
77
86
72
12.75
20.92
14.29
20.47
16.19
13.92
14.20
18.03
14.40
3,079
6,452
2,059
4,420
6,758
1,489
96,975
620
107,578
98,993
207,434
66,193
142,106
217,288
47,873
3,117,820
19,934
3,449,174
Measured
Indicated
13,163,000 9.25 103 958 66 15.11 122,000 3,917,000

Source: Turnberry 2010 100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves

*Computational discrepancies due to rounding down Stoping Width at 100cm Geological Losses 23%

4.12.1.4 Twistdraai

A complete re-evaluation of the historical database and Twistdraai Mineral Resources was performed by ExplorMine (2009). The intention of the reevaluation was to produce a spatial expression of gold value distribution in three dimensions.

In the Twistdraai area, the same principles and assumptions were applied as described for Six Shaft. A block modelling exercise was undertaken utilising Datamine™. Based upon the geological interpretation and geostatistical analysis of the chip sampling data from No 2 Shaft, No 5 Shaft and No 6 Shafts, the Twistdraai area was assumed to be a single reef facies.

The area was further split according to reef elevation. An axial line parallel to the fold axis was constructed and used to divide the block models into ‘inclined’ and ‘flat’ models. The optimal parent block size was determined by the smallest mining unit (‘SMU’) commonly used by Harmony. The parent block sizes used were as follows:

  • Measured 30m x 30m x 10m;

  • Indicated 60m x 60m x 10m; and

  • Inferred 120m x 120m x 120m.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-50 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-51 –

24

A wireframe model was created by individually filling each reef surface block according to the classification criteria described above. A final 3D block model was populated with the estimated grades utilising a ‘nearest neighbour’ estimate per parent block size and facies models.

A Kriging process was applied to the 3D geological model, which produced a 2D spatial distribution of low and high grade regions in horizontal and incline planes, which enabled the design of single reef mining. Ordinary point Kriging was applied to Measured Resources, while macro-Kriging was applied to the Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resource categories.

The cut-off for the Mineral Resource estimates is 2.5mg/t Au (or 3g/t at a minimum of 1m block width). A cut-off of between 2.5mg/t and 3mg/t Au is in accordance with accepted Witwatersrand Basin gold mines’ norms. The Mineral Resource categorisation and totals for various cut-off grades are shown in Table 10.

Table 10 : Mineral Resource Estimates for Twistdraai at Various Cut-off Grades (August 2009)

MINERAL RESOURCE MINING
TONNES
MINING
GRADE
MINING
WIDTH
MINING
GRADE
CHANNEL
WIDTH
CHANNEL
GRADE
GOLD
GOLD
CATEGORY (t) (g/t) (cm) (cmg/t) (cm) (g/t) (kg) (oz)
Mineral Resour ces-Twistdra ai at 250cmg/t cut-off (Aug 2009)
Measured na na na na na na na na
Indicated 11,686,400 5.58 103 583 63 9.29 65,220 2,096,872
Inferred 17,620,100 6.91 103 710 65 10.87 121,800 3,915,961
Total Measured and Indicated 11,686,400 5.58 103 583 63 9.29 65,220 2,096,872
Mineral Resour ces-Twistdra ai at 300cmg/t cut-off (Aug 2009)
Measured na na na na na na na na
Indicated 10,470,300 5.91 103 618 64 9.7 61,840 1,988,202
Inferred 17,165,900 7.02 103 722 66 11 120,580 3,876,737
Total Measured and Indicated 10,470,300 5.91 103 618 64 9.7 61,840 1,988,202
Mineral Resour ces-Twistdra ai at 500cmg/t cut-off (Aug 2009)
Measured na na na na na na na na
Indicated 5,525,900 7.61 106 813 72 11.32 42,050 1,351,939
Inferred 13,997,700 7.67 106 790 68 11.66 107,400 3,452,990
Total Measured and Indicated 5,525,900 7.61 106 813 72 11.32 42,050 1,352,939
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCES* 19,523,000 7.65 104 797 69 11.56 149,000 4,804,000

Source: ExplorMine 2009 100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Computational discrepancies due to rounding August 2009 Specific Gravity = 2.70

The Twistdraai orebody was further evaluated in the Scoping Study on the basis of structure and grade distribution. Four geo-zones for the Twistdraai orebody were defined as illustrated in Figure 9a.

Table 11 : Mineral Resource Statement for Twistdraai Geo-zones at a Cut-off Grade of >500cmg/t Au

MINING
TONNES
(t)
2,525,100
8,924,900
2,052,300
2,880,800
769,470
1,495,900
660,000

MINING
GRADE
(g/t)
6,47
7.89
9.96
7.54
5.47
7.27
6.32
MINING
WIDTH
(cm)
100
102
115
107
100
100
100
MINING
GRADE
(cmg/t)
649
807
1,132
809
547
727
631
CHANNEL
WIDTH
(cm)
64
68
101
83
26
41
54
CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
10.14
11.83
11.17
9.71
21.45
17.62
11.59
GOLD
(kg)
16,330
70,430
20,450
21,730
4,210
10,880
4,170
GOLD
(oz)
525,022
2,264,377
657,483
698,636
135,355
349,800
134,069
19,309,000 7.67 104 799 96 12.04 148,200 4,764,000

Source : Turnberry 2010

100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Stoping width of 100cm

*Computational discrepancies due to rounding

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-52 –

25

The total Evander project Mineral Resource for the geo-zones defined in Six Shaft and Twistdraai, at a stoping width of 100cm and a cut-off grade of >500cmg/t Au, are summarised in Table 12:-

Table 12 : Total Evander Mineral Resource in the Geo-zones at 100cm SW (>500cmg/t Cut-off Grade) May 2010

MINERAL RESOURCE
CATEGORY
MINING
TONNES
(t)

MINING
GRADE
(g/t)
MINING
GRADE
(cmg/t)
MINING
WIDTH
(cm)
CHANNE
L WIDTH
(cm)
CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
GOLD
k

GOLD
(g) (oz)
Measured 140,078 10.63 1,254 118 87 14 1,489 47,873
Indicated 15,433,000 9.24 961 104 74 13 142,601 4,584,726
Inferred 13,984,700 7.63 786 103 68 12 106,703 3,430,589
Total Measured andIndicated 15,573,078 9.25 971 105 74 13 144,090 4,632,599
TOTAL MINERAL RESOURCE* 29,557,000 8.48 883 104 71 13 250,793 8,063,000

Source : Turnberry 2010 100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent Excludes the Deep and Shallow geo-zones from Twistdraai Mineral Resources quoted are inclusive of Mineral Reserves Stoping width of 100cm, Specific gravity 2.7

  • *Computational discrepancies due to rounding down

4.12.2 Conversion of Mineral Resources to Mineral Reserves

In order to convert the Mineral Resource to Mineral Reserves the following parameters and criteria have been considered in the Scoping Study by Turnberry 2010. Portions of the ore body have been studied at a PFS level and the issues discussed below pertain to that portion of the study:-

  • the target ore body is the Kimberley Reef and no other reefs are considered to be economic for the purposes of the study;

  • Mineral Reserves have been estimated for the Shaft geo-zone only, which has been subjected to optimised mine design to PFS levels;

  • no Inferred Mineral Resources were included in the estimation of Mineral Reserves;

  • the mining width of the reef is approximately 100cm;

  • the ore body comprises a steep fold limb in the west (70º dip to vertical) which turns at depth into a shallow dipping reef (average 20º) as illustrated in Figure 9a. The steeply dipping sections of the ore body are termed ‘Steeps’ and the deeper portions of the ore body, where the dip flattens, are termed “Flats’;

  • separate mining methods are proposed for the ‘Steeps’ and the ‘Flats’;

  • the ‘Flats’ will be mined via conventional Witwatersrand gold mine scraper cleaned methods and the ‘Steeps’ will be mined via a modified shrinkage method with scraper cleaning and installation of support on retreat;

  • the Mineral Reserves were estimated on the basis of conventional and modified shrinkage mining of the ‘Flats’ and ‘Steeps’ respectively, at a production rate of 1Mtpa;

  • historically, the Specific Gravity (‘SG’) was determined on thousands of rock samples from Six Shaft and a historical figure of 2.70 was determined;

  • Mine2-4D™ and Surpac™ software was used to define the optimum mine design using inputs including geotechnical parameters, mining parameters, metal prices, metallurgical recoveries, mining and processing costs and royalties;

  • a two year historic average gold price of USD34,375/kg;

  • mining dilution was determined for the two types of mining methods and is shown in Table 13 and Table 14;

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-53 –

26

  • metallurgical recoveries were based on a conventional carbon–in-pulp (‘CIP’)/ carbon-in-leach (‘CIL’) plant with known recovery parameters and a gold recovery of 97%; and

  • mining and processing costs were estimated and appropriate allowances were made for royalties and other costs.

Considering the issues discussed above, the modifying factors used in the conversion of the Evander Mineral Resources for the Shaft geo-zone quoted in Table 12 to Mineral Reserves, are summarised in Table 13 and Table 14 and the final Mineral Reserves for the Shaft geozone of the Evander project are summarised in Table 15.

Turnberry applied financial models on this geo-zone with positive results as a standalone entity. Consequently, Turnberry have declared Probable Reserves for Six Shaft in the Shaft geo-zone.

Table 13 : Modifying Factors for ‘Flats’ (Turnberry 2010)

MODIFYING FACTORS VALUE
Hangingwall and footwall overbreak(cm) 10
Minimum stopingwidth(cm) 100
StopingDilution(trammingwidth) (%) 9
Unknown majorgeological losses(%) 15
In-stope dilution due to minor structures(%) 8
Raise development dilution(%) 2.7
Mininglosses(%) 2
Mine Call Factor(%) 90

A minimum stoping width of 100cm is assumed for the flat dipping areas. In areas where the channel width is less than 100cm, the only stope dilution that applies, is the dilution to get to the minimum stoping width of 100cm. The 10cm over break dilution only applies when the channel width exceeds 100cm.

Table 14 : Modifying Factors for 'Steeps' (Turnberry 2010)

MODIFYING FACTORS VALUE
Hangingwall and footwall overbreak(cm) 10
Minimum stopingwidth(cm) 100
Unknown majorgeological losses(%) 15
In-stope dilution due to minor structures(%) 8
On-reef development dilution(%) 11
Mininglosses(%) 2
Mine Call Factor(%) 90

Source: Turnberry 2010

Table 15 : Mineral Reserves for the Shaft Geo-zone, Six Shaft May 2010

MINING MINING
WIDTH
GOLD GOLD
PARAMETER TONNES GRADE
(t) (g/t) (cm) (kg) (oz)
Total Resource
Resources outside design areas
Mining Tonnes
Pillar loss (Bracket pillars)
Pillar loss (Stope pillars)
Mineable Tonnage
Mining loss
Dilution (on-reef development)
Dilution (minor structures)
Diluted Mineable Tonnage Resource
Mine Call Factor(MCF)
9,550,000
(1,135,000)
8,415,000
(290,000)
(643,000)
7,481,000
(150,000)
691,000
618,000
8,640,000
10.41
9.90
10.47
10.49
10.46
10.48
10.48
8.89
104
104
104
104
104
104
104
99,373
(11,233)
88,141
(3,048)
(6,728)
78,365
(1,568)
76,797
(7,680)
3,195,000
(361,000)
2,834,000
(98,000)
(216,000)
2,519 ,000
(50,000)
2,469,000
(247,000)
(864,000)
PROBABLE RESERVES* 8,640,000 8.00 104 69,000 2,222,000

Source: Turnberry 2010

100% attributable to Taung subject to Section 11 Ministerial consent No Inferred Mineral Resources are included in the Mineral Reserve estimation

  • *Computational inconsistencies due to rounding down

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-54 –

27

4.12.3 Logic for Inclusion of Inferred Mineral Resources in the Scoping Study

As part of the economic evaluation at Scoping Study level, Turnberry 2010 included both the Indicated and some of Inferred Mineral Resources in the mine plan and scheduling. In terms of international reporting codes no category exists for modified Inferred Mineral Resources and consequently the resultant tonnages are not compliant Mineral Reserves but are referred to as “Economic Inferred Mineral Resources” for the purposes of reporting the Scoping Study results . In Canada, this is referred to as a “Preliminary Assessment”, whereby Inferred Mineral Resources can be evaluated economically.

As discussed in Section 4.12.4, apart from grade continuity, there is a high level of detailed geological understanding of the Inferred Mineral Resources at Twistdraai, which would require only minimal exploration to be upgraded into the Indicated Mineral Resources category. Taung therefore, considered the inclusion of the Inferred Mineral Resources in the economic evaluation of Scoping Study to be reasonable and based on the sound expectation of upgrading the Inferred Mineral Resources to the Indicated category.

The Scoping Study indicated that the mine is economic based on the Indicated Mineral Resources alone and the economic contribution of the ‘Inferred’ Mineral Resource is therefore an additional advantage.

The Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for Evander are summarised in Table 16:-

Table 16 : Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for Evander (Turnberry 2010)

REC
GRADE
(g/t)
6.80
8.00
MINING
WIDTH
GOLD
TONNES GOLD
REEF CATEGORY (t) (cm) (kg) (oz)
Kimberley Reef
KimberleyReef
Probable Reserves + Economic
Inferred Mineral Resources
Probable Reserve only
28,222,000
8,640,000
104
104
191,000
69,000
6,170,000
2,222,000

Source: Turnberry 2010 Includes Inferred Mineral Resources from Twistdraai

4.12.4 Logic for Classification of Evander Inferred Mineral Resources

The Evander project is situated in an historical mining area where 50 years of mining the Kimberley Reef has led to confidence in the understanding of the ore horizon. Taung has classified the Kimberley Reef into high grade geo-zones, many of which are classified as Indicated Mineral Resources.

The remaining geo-zones are classified as Inferred Mineral Resources, as a consequence of insufficient data points within the zone, leading to lack of confidence in the grade distribution. However, the confidence levels for the remaining resource classification parameters exceed those required for classification in the Inferred category.

In the context of the very high confidence levels applicable to grade distribution in the Kimberley Reef in the Evander Goldfields area, Taung is confident that the Inferred Mineral Resources will be rapidly upgraded to the Indicated category through the proposed exploration programme. It is this confidence in the upgrade of the Inferred Mineral Resources that is the basis for Taung’s motivation in including the Inferred Resources in the Scoping Study.

4.13 Techno-Economic Study – Mining

4.13.1 Overview

Six Shaft is largely un-mined except for a small area in the vicinity of No 6 Shaft where approximately 2Mt of Kimberley Reef was mined between September 1986 and June 1998 at a reported grade of 7.82g/t Au over a width of 147cm (88cm channel width).

No 6 Shaft is currently a non-functional shaft and the shaft complex comprises two shaft headgears.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-55 –

28

The current mining studies have progressed from conceptual to detailed designs, in the 2010 Scoping Study by Turnberry/Ukwazi, with the Shaft geo-zone portion of the ore body designed to PFS level. The shaft designs propose that No 6 Shaft is likely to extend from a 1,000m below surface to a depth of 2,200m below surface.

4.13.2 Geological Model and Mining Methodology in the Mine Design

The existing tunnel infrastructure and the Kimberley Reef profile as used in the Scoping Study are illustrated in Figure 11. The basic geological and mining related parameters integral to the mine design were:-

  • the target ore body is the Kimberley Reef which has been mined extensively on neighbouring shafts in the Evander area and no other reefs are considered to be economic for the purposes of the study;

  • the mining width of the reef is approximately 100cm;

  • the ore body comprises a steep fold limb in the west (70º dip to vertical) which turns at depth into a shallow dipping reef (average 20º) as illustrated in Figure 9a. The steeply dipping sections of the ore body are termed ‘Steeps’ and the deeper portions of the ore body, where the dip flattens, are termed ‘Flats’;

  • the Six Shaft area is split into structural blocks namely the East Orebody and West Orebody, above and below 17 level (Figure 10b);

  • the ‘Twistdraai’ area is divided into four geo-zones ( East, West, Shallow and Deep, Figure 9b).The ore body in each of these areas is divided into flat and steep dipping sections, which are termed ‘Flats’ and ‘Steeps’ respectively, as in Six Shaft;

  • separate mining methods are proposed for the ‘Steeps’ and the ‘Flats’;

  • the ‘Flats’ will be mining via conventional Witwatersrand gold mine scraper cleaning methods;

  • the ‘Steeps’ will be mined via a modified shrinkage method with scraper cleaning and installation of support on retreat; and

  • historically, the Specific Gravity (‘SG’) was determined on thousands of rock samples from Six Shaft and a historical figure of 2.70 was determined.

In all the steep dipping areas, a shrinkage stope mining (‘shrinkage mining’) method is proposed, similar to that used at No 6 Shaft prior to mine closure in 1998. The original shrinkage mining methodology was to remove the ore material on a regular basis during the life of the stope.

This approach resulted in excessive ore dilution due to slabbing and losses due to abandonment. The material difference to the original method is the proposal to scrape the shrink material only at the end of the stope’s life (‘scrape shrinkage mining’).

Adopting this method could ensure that a Mine Call Factor (‘MCF’) of 90% is achieved. A MCF of 90% was applied in the Scoping Study and the additional labour and materials required for this method are catered for in the working and capital cost estimates. The flat dipping and intermediate areas are suitable for conventional ‘Witwatersrand gold mine’ stoping techniques, with associated footwall drives and crosscuts.

4.13.3 Evander Project Scheduling

The mine design and schedule indicates a 30 year production life for Evander as summarised below and presented in Note 6:-.

  • 2 years – sinking and establishment;

  • 7 years – mining ramp up to full production;

  • 21 years – full tonnage profile production; and

  • 2 years – mining closing down cycle.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-56 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-57 –

30

4.13.4 Mine Planning and Development/Stoping Scheduling

The preliminary three-dimensional development and stoping designs for the Shaft geo-zone were undertaken at a PFS level of detail and accuracy. The development and stoping designs were completed using General Mine Planning (‘GMP’) software to comply with the mine design criteria. The stoping design process included allowances for bracket pillars, stope pillars and reef development. The dilutions and ore body losses applied were derived from the 3D geological and geo-zone model. The reef development designs were applied to each stope block and then scheduled to deliver the diluted reef tonnes from each stope. Preliminary waste development design layouts were created considering ventilation requirements, ore handling systems and people, material and equipment access.

4.13.5 Production Schedule – Tonnage Sources and Profiles

Approximately 92% of the tonnage for the first 10 years of production is derived largely from the Indicated Resources which have been modified to Probable Mineral Reserves. Two production planning schedules were applied to the ore body above a cut off grade of 500cmg/t Au. The first production schedule forms part of a PFS level study focused on the Shaft geo-zone and the second schedule forms part of a preliminary economic assessment of geo-zones above 500cmg/t Au.

The combined Six Shaft and Twistdraai annual production and waste profiles for the rampup period are illustrated in Figure 12 and summarised in Table 17. The slight dip in production in 2017 and 2018 is a result of the insufficient stope face generation to maintain the same mining tonnages, as a consequence of the one-side mining approach to the primary access development.

The peak production is 102ktpm with a peak shaft head grade of 7.43g/t Au.

4.13.6 Geotechnical and Hydrological Aspects

Rock Engineering

The geotechnical environment and factors that impact the mining and rock mechanics strategies to be adopted at Six Shaft and Twistdraai project areas have been derived from mining experience at EGM’s No’s 2, 5 and 6 Shafts, and from information gathered from exploration boreholes drilled in the target areas.

A preliminary Shaft Pillar model exercise recommends a pillar 200m x 200m, with the shaft locality positioned at the dip midpoint of the un-mined block, and 50m and 100m from the dip faults defining the north and south strike limits of the block respectively.

Water Contained in the Mine and Dewatering

The No 6 Shaft is estimated to be flooded to 645m below surface, between No 8 and 9 Levels on the Main Shaft. The implication is that the Ventilation Shaft is not flooded. No sampling for water quality has been undertaken.

The volume of water in the old workings and shaft is estimated to be 800,000m[3] , based on the volume mined and the estimated volume of the haulages and other excavations. Based on historical pumping figures, No 6 Shaft historically generated some 4,000m[3] per day of water from fissure and other sources. The ongoing pumping capacity to control the fissure inflow is estimated to be 4,000m[3] per day.

Considering both these parameters, the pumping installation on 7 Level requires a capacity of 12,000m[3] per day. In the light of the power optimising strategy by Eskom (the local power provider) it is probably necessary to install a facility to manage 24,000m[3 ] per day. To dewater the mine, at a pumping rate of 4,000m[3] /day for fissure water and 4,000m[3] /day to lower the water level, it will take approximately 10 months to dewater the mine.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-58 –

==> picture [259 x 492] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

1.17 0.41 1.61 1.17 7.51 96.5 8,492 273 1.09 0.24 1.33 1.10 7.67 96.5 8,106 261
2022 2022
0.7 0.44 1.22 0.7 7.6 96.5 5,127 165 0.68 0.31 0.99 0.68 7.67 96.5 4,996 161
2021 2021
0.34 0.52 0.78 0.34 8.03 96.5 2,634 85 0.25 0.26 0.52 0.26 8.84 96.5 2,175 70
2020 2020
0.28 0.44 0.69 0.28 7.67 96.5 2,064 66 0.19 0.23 0.42 0.19 8.70 96.5 1,578 51
2019 2019
0.25 0.41 0.49 0.25 6.69 96.5 1,588 51 0.17 0.09 0.27 0.17 7.25 96.5 1,211 39
2018 2018
0.2 0.24 0.38 0.21 7.37 96.5 1,457 47 0.18 0.03 0.21 0.18 7.61 96.5 1,315 42
2017 2017
0.2 0.18 0.4 0.21 7.45 96.5 1,481 48 0.18 0.06 0.24 0.18 7.66 96.5 1,331 43
2016 2016
0.21 0.2 0.3 0.1 6.43 96.5 608 20 0.09 0.06 0.16 0.09 6.47 96.5 568 18
2015 2015
0.12 0.2 0.5 0 4.99 96.5 10 0 0.00 0.01 0.01 0.00 4.99 96.5 10 0
2014 2014
0 ~ ~ ~ 0 96.5 ~ ~ 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 96.5 0 0
2013 2013
TOTAL 28.22 9.63 37.85 28.22 6.8 96.3 184,853 5,943 TOTAL 8.64 1.91 10.55 8.64 8.00 96.50 66,700 2,144
Mt Mt Mt Mt % kg Mt Mt Mt Mt % kg
UNITS g/t Au ‘000oz UNITS g/t Au 000oz
ITEM ITEM
Reef Mined Waste Mined Total Mined Reef Milled Head Grade Gold Recovered Gold Production Gold Production Reef Mined Waste Mined Total Mined Reef Milled Head Grade Gold Recvered Gold Production Gold Production
Table 17 : Ramp-up Production Schedule for Evander Including Inferred Mineral Resources Source : Turnberry 2010 Total for LoM Excluding Inferred Mineral Resources Source : Turnberry 2010 Total for LoM
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-59 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-60 –

33

4.13.7 Mining Infrastructure

Access and drainage

The surface infrastructure at No 6 Shaft is non-functional and of limited value to Taung for further mine development. The shaft is accessed via 3.5km of good condition, secondary tarred road linking Evander and Secunda. The area immediately surrounding No 6 Shaft is flat and extensive earthworks have ensured that the site is prepared for construction.

Power Supply

Electric power is a critical resource in South Africa since the regional power provider, Eskom (Electric Power generating authority in South Africa), has been forced to restrict power supplies to the mining industry and commercial consumers. New mining ventures have to consider the installation of alternative power generation capacity at considerable capital expenditure, as well as associated operating cost.

No 6 Shaft was originally supplied by an 88kV Eskom supply but this entire infrastructure has been removed (including most of the foundations) and will need to be replaced entirely.

The mine and processing plant will have a power requirement of approximately 40MVA, which will not be supplied by the national grid in the near future and additional supplies will not be available prior to 2015. Alternative prime power sources will be required to cater for all consumption requirements until this time.

Eskom will be able to provide a portion of the construction power at perhaps 5MW, whilst the dewatering requirement will be approximately 10MW. The shortfall will be supplied by diesel generation (5MW) and possibly with heavy fuel oil (HFO) generation, subject to availability of the HFO. Provision has been made in the capital estimate for an initial 7.5MW of self generation, increasing to 10MW. Initial discussions and preliminary applications have been submitted to Eskom for the future Evander Project.

Water Supply and Water Disposal

Surface water is a scarce resource in the region but pipelines are available to deliver water to new mines. It is assumed that the water supply line is still intact and could be reinstated readily. The mine water discard pipeline has been partly removed and will need to be reinstated for de-watering of the mine.

Headgear

The headgears for both surface shafts are in position and in relatively good condition. The surface ventilation fans have been removed from site.

Gold Processing Plant

No dedicated processing plant exists to serve ore from No 6 shaft. Until recently, EGM had two operating gold processing plants, one at Evander No 2 Shaft (Winkelhaak Plant) and the other at Evander No 7 Shaft (Kinross Plant). These plants had a maximum milling capacity of approximately 220,000tpm and were milling approximately 100,000tpm at the time of closure of the Evander No 2 Shaft plant. The No 2 Shaft plant was milling reef and pumping the slurry to the Evander No 7 Shaft plant, whilst the No 7 Shaft plant mills and processes the combined slurry.

With the closure of the Evander No 2 Shaft plant, the Scoping Study has now incorporated a design and construction of a completely new metallurgical facility with an associated tailings dam.

Waste Dumps

A waste rock dump on the No 6 Shaft property is being reprocessed. Elsewhere waste rock dumps are already established and no additional sites would be required in future.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-61 –

34

Existing Underground Infrastructure

The main shaft is currently at a depth of 1,377m (18 Level) below surface and can only service mining operations on the levels above 17 Level. The shaft bottom is on 18 Level. The ventilation shaft is at a depth of 589m below surface (7 Level) with a raise bored pilot hole to 16 Level. The raise borehole has been surveyed and it is approximately 2m to 3m off vertical on 16 Level.

The vent shaft was equipped with three main ventilation fans on surface, rated to air circulation of 560kg/s. Limited components items of the cooling plant remain such as a 450kg/s surface bulk air cooler. The main fans have been removed and only the cowlings and ducts remained on surface.

Twin haulages from No 5 Shaft on 22 Level elevation were developed to a distance of 250m from the reef horizon proximal to No 6 Shaft when the mine stopped the development. It seems that this development may have intersected the future position of the sub-vertical shaft on 22 Level.

4.13.8 Ventilation Requirements

Using a basic ventilation design ratio of 4.0kg per second per 1,000t milled per month (kg/sec/ktpm), the shaft sizes were calculated for No 6 Sub-vertical shafts and Twistdraai Sub-incline (decline) shafts. The necessary surface refrigeration for the Sub-vertical shaft areas of 15MW was included.

Each mining level will be accessed by twin haulages, one for intake and the other for return air. The interconnecting haulages from the No 6 Surface Shaft to Twistdraai Sub-incline shafts will require a cross sectional area of 54.7m[2] at a flow of 6.0m/sec. Exhaust air from Twistdraai will require 21.9m[2] of haulage for airflow of 15m/sec. This requires a total combined cross sectional area for air flow of 76.6m[2] which can be made up of three 4m x 5m ends and one 4m x 4.15m.

As a result of the depth of the mining blocks, refrigeration will be required from early in the mine’s life, initially with surface bulk air cooler installations and eventually with possible underground refrigeration plants and chilled water reticulation.

4.13.9 Manpower

The workforce will be accommodated in the surrounding urbanised areas of Evander and Secunda, in dwellings which they own or rent. Taung does not intend to house the workforce on site in purpose built accommodation. The workforce will thus be integrated into the local community and the strategy will be outlined in the Social and Labour Plan during the BFS.

Due to the nature and orientation of the reef width, full scale mechanised mining would not be viable, thus the mine will be staffed in a similar manner to neighbouring mines in the Evander area.

The production workforce profile (stoping, developing, ledging, equipping and tramming) at peak production was calculated on production level basis for the different mining methods.

The support services workforce for underground and surface, (shafts, engineering, technical services, finance and administration) has been estimated, based on similar operations.

Contracted plant staff will be approximately 120 outsourced members, not included in the overall staffing numbers. The maximum number of employees will be approximately 3,005, including 392 persons for leave and sick relief, of which 2,513 will be underground employees. At any one time, the maximum number of people underground will be approximately 2,200.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-62 –

35

Table 18 : Evander Project Staffing Profile at Full Production

EVANDER PROJECT STAFF ING PROFILE – A t Full Production Capacity
Section
Stoping
CAT 1 to 8
2,037
140
48
100
Miners
50
28
Supervisors
50
4
16
20
Management
20
Total
2,157
172
64
120
Development
Tramming
Engineering
Shaft
Technical Services
Total Underground 2,325 78 90 20 2,513
Engineering
Stores/Admin
Gold Plant
Senior Staff
20
40
0
0 5
5
0
30 25
45
0
30
TotalSurface 60 0 10 30 100
Total Workforce
Absentee allowance at 15% of
workforce
2,613
392
**TOTAL Mine Labour ** 3,005

Source ; Turnberry 2010

The employment profile will be verified by a detailed manning study in the next phase of the project.

The mine is located in a region which has supplied labour to the mines for many decades. The available labour is expected to be sufficiently industrialised to provide trained manpower to the Evander project. This labour will be available to work with minimal additional training, without compromising safety. The region experiences a high level of unemployment.

The Evander project will pay a gate wage, adequate to cover all accommodation expenses and thus no accommodation factor has been included in the capital schedules, but is included in the operating cost estimate.

4.13.10 Capital Requirements and Costs

The overall project capital expenditure was initially estimated by Turnberry 2010 as follows and was split into three phases as discussed below and summarised in Table 19:-

Table 19 : Phased Capital Expenditure

DESCRIPTION *COST(USD'000) ** COST(USD'000)**
Phase 0–Studies (3,978) (3,978)
Phase 1 – Dewater Mine and Upper Level SteepProduction (132,114) (132,114)
Phase 2 – Sub-vertical Shaft (442,402) (438,878)
Phase 3– Twistdraai Incline Shaft (194,862) 0
Possible savings on second hand equipment -31,250 -20,000
Project Development Capital Estimate (225,676) (47,057)
Sustaining Capital – Engineering andProjects (56,250) (21,563)
Total Capital Expenditure (1,024,033) (623,590)
Source: Turnberry 2010
Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferr
Negative figures in (red)
*Indicated Mineral Resources only
ed Mineral Resources
  • Phase 0 : includes costs associated with the study phase of the overall project, as indicated in Table 19 was estimated to be USD3.978m. Subsequently Taung created a budget for the financial year ending February 2012 and the capital provision for the studies was increased as shown in Table 20;

  • Phase 1: estimated to be USD0.132bn and includes surface rehabilitation of the No 6 Shaft area, installation of the surface winding plant, dewatering and re-equipping of the existing shaft system, deepening of the surface ventilation shaft and commencement of production from above 17 Level;

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-63 –

36

  • Phase 2 : estimated to be USD0.449bn and includes sinking and equipping of Evander No 6 sub-vertical shaft, development and equipping of 14 levels and the build up to full production from the Sub-vertical Shaft; and

  • Phase 3: estimated to be USD0.195bn and includes development to the Twistdraai sub-incline shaft locations, sinking of the Twistdraai sub-incline shafts and development to full production.

Table 20 : Revised LoM Capital Expenditure

DESCRIPTION *COST(USD'000) ** COST(USD'000)**
Phase 0 – Studies (10,310) (10,310)
Phase1 – Dewater Mine and Upper LevelSteepProduction (132,114) (132,114)
Phase 2 – Sub-vertical Shaft (442,402) (438,878)
Phase 3 – Twistdraai Incline Shaft (194,862) 0
Possible savings onsecondhand equipment -31,250 -20,000
Exploration drilling programme*** (6,190) (6,190)
Project Development Capital Estimate (223,421) (40,867)
Sustaining Capital – Engineering andProjects (56,250) (21,563)
Total Capital Expenditure (1,034,300) (629,922)

The total LoM capital for the Evander project was estimated by Turnberry (2010) in the Scoping Study Report to be USD1,024bn including an ongoing replacement capital expenditure of USD56.250m.

4.13.10.1 Processing Plant Costs

The new gold plant with an 100ktpm processing capability to be built for No 6 Shaft reef processing, is expected to cost approximately USD44.75m in December 2009 money terms), including all associated infrastructure and Engineering, Procurement, Construction, Management (‘EPCM’) costs. In addition, the tailings dam is expected to cost USD12.05m.

4.13.10.2 On-going Capital Costs and Exploration Costs

The On-going or Sustaining Capital Cost Requirement details the costs associated with upgrading the infrastructure during the production life of the mine and includes mining equipment and infrastructure upgrade. This value on ongoing replacement (sustaining) capital expenditure is estimated to be USD56.25m.

The exploration forecast for the financial year ending February 2012 required to ensure the project is professionally and cost-effectively explored is summarised in Table 21. Funds are available for exploration undertakings. The aim of the drilling is to convert Inferred Resources into Indicated Resources. Venmyn considers the proposed exploration plan and budget for the financial year 2012, to be adequate for the next phase of the exploration programme:-

Table 21 : Future Exploration Expenditure for the Evander Project for the Financial Year ending February 2012

PROJECT EXPLORATION1 CONSULTANTS2 OVERHEADS3 TOTAL
(USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000)
Evander (5,740) (5,107) (869) (11,716)
1. Drilling (four holes) and sampling
2 .Consultants, environmental management
3. On site and Head Office
Negative figures in (red)

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-64 –

37

4.13.11 Working Capital

4.13.11.1 Operating Costs

The working cost estimate excludes all mining development costs for the LoM which are included in the capital expenditure estimate. A 7 year production ramp up period was estimated for the Evander project and the mine will operate at full production for 21 years with an annual production of 267,000oz of gold. Total gold production is estimated to be 184.9t (5.9mMoz).

The Evander project is estimated to have a LoM average operating cost of UDS83.6/t milled (including the recent Eskom price increase), as detailed in Table 22:-

Table 22 : Evander Operating Cost Estimate (Turnberry 2010)

COST
(USD/t)*
COST
(USD/t)**
TOTAL PROJECT (ZAR /t milled)
MiningCost (55.73) (52.71)
Processing Cost (Excluding services) (4.88) (4.88)
Analytical Cost(Excludingservices) (0.19) (0.19)
Smeltingand Treatment Charges (0.49) (0.58)
Services (11.73) (11.28)
Administration and Overhead Costs (10.58) (11.24)
TOTAL (83.60) (80.88)

Source: Turnberry 2010 *Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red)

4.13.11.2 Cost of Eskom Power

The March 2010 National Electricity Regulator of South Africa (‘NERSA’) review approved the national supplier’s (Eskom) proposed power cost increases from USD0.04per kWhr in 2010 to UDS0.08per kWhr in 2013, which amounts to a 25% increase in tariff. Increases beyond 2013 have not been announced and it is assumed that they will follow inflation. As the increases are inflation linked, there is no impact on the financial model, which is a constant money model.

The power requirement is based on 45kWh/t milled for the gold plant and 75kWh/t mined for the remainder for the other infrastructure.

4.13.11.3 Cost of Water

The estimated cost of water supplied to a mine is currently USD0.56/m[3] . As water supply is directly related to the cost of energy, the cost of water has been increased with the Eskom increases from USD0.56/m[3 ] in 2010 to USD0.75/m[3 ] in 2013, a 9% increase.

The mine is expected to consume approximately 1,000m[3/] /day of water which will be made up from fissure water plus about 250m[3] /day of potable water from the local authority.

It has been assumed that the water consumed by the mine will be 0.5m[3] /t milled for the gold plant and 0.4m[3] /t mined for the remainder of the mine. The, service requirements will need to be determined from a complete mine power and water balance study.

4.13.11.4 Salient Features of CAPEX, OPEX and Production

The salient features of the Evander Project with regard to production parameters are depicted in Table 23 below:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-65 –

38

Table 23 : Production Parameters and Phases in Relation to Costs

LoM SUMMARY
(USDm)*
LoM SUMMARY
(USDm)**
ITEM
CAPEX(Turnberry2010) IncludingPlant and Ongoing CAPEX (1,023.00) (623.00)
CAPEX (Revised by
TaungFeb 2011)
Including Plant and Ongoing CAPEX (1,034.30) (629.92)
OPEX Life Average Cost/tonne milled (83.60) (80.88)
CashCost TotalCashCost/oz Au produced (396.71) (325.85)
Production Annual Ore Production(tonnesper annum – tpa)) 1,229,000 1,150,000
MonthlyOre Production(tonnesper month- tpm) 102,417 95,833
AnnualGoldProduction(kg gold perannum) 8,302 4,649
Annual PeakGold Production(ouncesper annum) 291,094 286,185
Average Production Gold ouncespa 266,922 149,480
Head Grade (g/t) 6.801 7.99
Yield(g/t) 6.55 7.72
Total Gold(kg) 184,853 66,699
TotalGold (ounces) 5,943,148 2,144,441
Total Waste Tonnes(LOM) 9,627,007 1,908,796
Reef: Waste Ratio 2.93 4.53
SustainingWasteTonnes (LOM) 5,120,663 969,150
Reef: Waste Ratio 5.51 8.91
Mine Call Factor 90% 90%
Source: Turnberry 2010
*Total Ore body including bot
h Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources
  • **Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red)

4.13.12 Project Risk Profile

4.13.12.1 Risk background

In comparison to industrial and commercial operations, mining is relatively high risk. Each orebody is unique and morphology, grade, mining and processing characteristics are estimates. Inherent inaccuracies can be expected when calculating estimates based on natural material.

Mining project revenues are subject to variations in metal prices and exchange rates which are beyond the control of Taung. Estimations of project capital and operating costs are rarely more accurate than ±15%. The risks identified at Scoping Study level are presented in a matrix in Note 7. No formal risk analysis has been conducted for the Evander project; however there are a number of factors which combine to reduce some of the risks identified above. Principal amongst these are:-

  • all geological data is based on historical diamond drilling; core recoveries are historically reported to be good. The geology, though complex, has been soundly modelled and the mineralisation controls are well understood and this has greatly reduced the risk in the area where initial mining will be undertaken;

  • drilling to convert the Inferred Mineral Resources in Twistdraai to Indicated Mineral Resources will provide a valuable guide to mining in this area;

  • the production in the early years of the LoM is sourced from high grade geo-zones, providing an opportunity to optimise the ore feed in the initial years;

  • several independent CPRs have been compiled for the project;

  • the plant design is based on a known technologies which are currently operating throughout the Witwatersrand mining industry; and

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-66 –

39

  • local, regional and national regulatory agencies support the project’s development, in terms of gaining government approvals, access to land, and managing local employment and local community relations. There appear to be no irresolvable social or regulatory difficulties at this stage.

4.13.13 Gold Market Assessment

A review of the global gold market is presented in Note 4.

4.14 Techno-Economic Study – Mineral Processing

4.14.1 General

Currently there are no agreements in place for the treatment of the ore which will arise from the mining at Evander. Such agreements will only be negotiated upon the favourable outcome of a completed PFS.

Taung has initiated a study to investigate the establishment of a “fit for purpose” plant adjacent to the No 6 Shaft and the initial costing and financial model by Turnberry are positive.

No metallurgical test work has been conducted on the Kimberley Reef at the Evander project but more than 2Mt of reef has been processed through the EGM’s No 2 Shaft gold plant, without deleterious effect, at a reported recovery of approximately 96.5%. Based upon the consistency of the metallurgical performance of the neighbouring EGM mines, it is fair and reasonable to expect a similar high gold recovery at Evander.

4.14.2 Plant Design

The mineralogy of the Kimberley Reef from the Evander project is expected to be similar to that of neighbouring EGM mines, thus conventional gold processing using cyanide and CIP/CIL technology will be applicable.

A new conventional Witwatersrand CIP/CIL plant, dedicated to No 6 Shaft complex, is to be built and operated according to the following modules and phases:-

  • with an initial 25ktpm plant to operate from until 2013 to 2030 (18 years);

  • Module 1: 100ktpm plant to operate from 2018 to 2045 (28 years); and

  • Module 2: 100ktpm plant from 2023 to 2045 (23 years).

4.15 Techno-Economic Study - Project Implementation

A detailed discussion of the project implementation is presented in Note 6.

4.16 Environmental Considerations

The South African Environmental legislation is summarised in Note 3, together with a discussion of the details of the Evander project in relation to the legislation.

Evander project is located within the mining area of EGM. An integral part of the process of acquiring a mining title in South Africa is the requirement to compile a comprehensive EMPR for approval by the DMR. The EMPR incorporates environmental baseline studies, air quality and noise, surface hydrology, fauna and flora, freshwater ecosystems and many other topics. The Evander mining operations, sites and related infrastructure are the subject of an EMPR approved as part of the conversion to a ‘New Order’ Mining Right by all relevant interested and affected parties.

The initial EMPR entitled “Evander Gold Mines Limited, Ref: MP30/5/1/2/3/2/1/126EM” was approved as part EGM’s successful application for a New Order Mining Right.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-67 –

40

A revised EMPR was completed in February 2009 and is entitled; “Evander Gold Mines Limited, Ref: MP 30/5/1/2/3/2/1/126EM, Environmental Management Programme, Revised by: Shangoni Management Services (Pty) Limited”. Taung will undertake further environmental studies as part of the PFS and BFS process.

4.16.1 Tailings Storage Facility

Currently, the Evander project falls under the umbrella of the EGM’s EMPR and Taung is legally bound to abide by the conditions of this document. However, Taung will initiate comprehensive study by independent consultants to assess the tailings dam’s environmental requirements as part of the PFS and BFS processes.

A 30Mt tailings storage facility (‘TSF’) will be required at Six Shaft, the location of which has not been determined at the Scoping Study level. There is a possibility that co-deposition with Harmony’s LIBRA Project tailings is possible, but this has not been included in the Scoping Study.

4.17 Social, Community and Land Use

The closest major urban areas to the Evander project are Evander and Secunda, 6km northeast of and 4km southwest of Evander project respectively.

The population of the area is mainly a black ethnic group with a white minority. The estimated population of Secunda is 250,000 persons and of Evander, 30,000 persons.

The local government is well established, with First World structures and, consequently, both towns are significant trading centres. The local per-capita income is one of the highest averages in South Africa. Two major employers, namely; Sasol (Sasol Mining and Sasol Synfuels) and EGM, provide employment in the area. The workforce will sourced from the local community, since this is a historical mining district and has the necessary skills. Skills training will be provided by Taung. No resettlement of the local community is planned.

4.18 Conclusions

The Evander project including Six Shaft and Twistdraai will produce Run of Mine (‘RoM’) at a rate of 1.2Mtpa for a period of 21 years at full production with a 7 year ramp up phase and a 2 year closure phase, i.e. a total of 30 years in production. The mine will require 2 years to develop before production can commence. The total reef tonnage milled over the LoM will be approximately 28Mt. The mine will be a stand-alone operation and will not rely on any mining infrastructure from other sources.

The bullion produced from the processing plant will be refined at the Rand Refinery in Johannesburg. The estimated LoM Capital Cost for the Project is USD1,034.3m

The project start date for Phase 1 in this Scoping Study is January 2013 with the proposed date of completion of the BFS in Feb 2013, as per the agreement with EGM. This will allow a period of 9 months for the review of the BFS with the necessary project financing being activated for the partners.

It is not deemed essential for a PFS to be completed prior to a BFS as there are only limited access options to the ore body. Normally these options would be reviewed during the PFS phase of the project, but the BFS could commence immediately. A PFS and a BFS are based on at least Measured and Indicated Resource categories, whereas a Scoping Study can include Inferred Mineral Resource. It is recommended that additional drilling be completed on the geozones with Inferred Mineral Resources to upgrade these zones to an Indicated level for inclusion in a future study.

The project is robust and is likely to be economically viable under the current cost and revenue scenarios.

The unique skills associated with narrow, steep, shrinkage stoping has not been lost in the country, and should be revived with effective training and skills transferring programmes.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-68 –

41

However, by concentrating on the steep reefs as low production, high grade areas the yield can be significantly improved. This can be achieved by implementing the ‘shrink & scrape’ stoping method to control dilution and minimize gold loss.

Before other improvements can be planned, the method of mining, stoping and developing, will have to be reviewed. If substantial blocks of payable reef are concentrated in smaller areas, mechanisation of the development function could allow for greater capacity to build up production rates while still achieving reasonable utilisation from the costly machinery. Therefore, all production rate options only consider 20,000 reef tonnes per month from the upper section. This depletion rate also allows 6 years for the sinking and commissioning of the sub-vertical shaft without a drop in production. In order to achieve this production rate, the existing shaft system, re-equipped and deepened, where necessary, will be more than adequate and is easily able to service the sinking of the No 6 Sub-vertical shaft complex at the same time.

The basic requirements are a rock winder hoisting from 18 Level, and a man winder able to deliver men and material to seven stations. The downcast compartment of the ventilation shaft must be equipped with a service winder as a second outlet and also to assist the movement of men between levels.

The No 6 Sub-vertical shaft orebody has the capacity to produce approximately 110,000 reef tonnes per month applying industry norms. This will depend on the degree of faulting present as well as the ability to mine the narrow steep stopes at depth. The No 6 Shaft sub-vertical system was designed and costed to produce 102,500 reef tonnes per month. The detailed mine planning recently completed has confirmed this to be a realistic target production rate.

The Twistdraai ore body will be exploited via three decline systems providing a total of 80ktpm during the latter phase of the LoM.

A labour plan from first principles has been compiled for the expected peak production period when the No 6 Sub-vertical shafts are operating at full capacity. The maximum number of people employed by the mine is estimated to be 3,005. This includes a labour allocation for the processing plant.

The operating cost at full production will be approximately USD83.6/t milled. This includes the recent Eskom increases. The cash costs are approximately USD397/oz for the Evander project.

It is recommended by the Competent Persons that Taung progress the Evander Project to a full PFS, as the technical and economic risks, as well as the outlook for the gold price, support the potential development of the project, subject to additional drilling commencing as soon as possible.

The up-side potential associated with the Evander project can be summarised as:-

  • additional drilling to bring Inferred Resources into the Indicated category;

  • additional economic reef zones identified;

  • the project has used a MFC factor of 90%, whilst some underground operations in the gold industry report MCFs in excess of 90% (others report as low as 75%);

  • stoping width reduction to better than 35cm more than the channel width;

  • improved gold plant recovery as a result of the high head grades and process optimisation;

  • additional tonnage processed through the plant as a result of improved availability and control;

  • simpler geology/structure than the current interpretation;

  • increased mechanisation in the stoping environment to reduce costs; and

  • earlier project start date than January 2014.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-69 –

42

5 JEANETTE PROJECT

5.1 Property Description and Location

The Jeanette project area is situated northeast of Welkom in the Free State Province of South Africa. Jeanette consists of numerous farms and farm portions over which a single New Order Prospecting Right is in the process of being registered in the name of Taung Gold Free State (Pty) Limited. Harmony’s Tshepong Mine borders the project area to the south (originally the Freegold North operation) (Figure 13).

Jeanette lies approximately 2km east of Allanridge and the southern boundary of the project is approximately 2km north of Odendaalsrus.

Jeanette is centred on longitude 26°41’E and latitude 27°47’S and is 10km long in a north-south direction and 5km wide east-west. Jeanette is situated directly east of the previously mined Loraine Gold Mine property, with the western boundary forming a common boundary with the eastern margin of Loraine Gold Mine, now the property of Harmony (Figure 13).

5.2 Legal Aspects and Tenure

The Jeanette project comprises a portion of a single New Order Prospecting Right originally granted to Harmony Freegold Limited on 24[th] April 2008, and which consists of numerous farms and portions of farms as listed in Table 24 below and illustrated in Figure 13. Taung and African Precious Minerals Limited (‘APM’) entered into an agreement with a wholly-owned subsidiary of Harmony, ARMgold / Harmony Freegold Joint Venture Company (Proprietary) Limited on 1[st] February 2008, in terms of which Taung acquired a 100% of the Jeanette Project by way of the issue of shares in APM.

As a consequence of exchange control issues, this agreement was terminated and replaced on 30[th] June 2008 by an agreement in which the Prospecting Right was acquired by Taung for a purchase consideration of USD12.5m. A deposit of USD0.625m was paid upon signature of this agreement.

Regulatory issues in regard to the subdivision of the right became apparent and on the advice of the DMR, the parties entered into a new Sale Agreement on 17[th] December 2009 (later amended on 11[th] March 2010), in terms of which the purchase price was reduced to USD9.4m and the mode of transferring the right was amended.

On the 29[th] September 2010 a Section 11 consent to the transfer of the Prospecting Right from Harmony Freegold to Taung Gold Freestate (Pty) Ltd, was granted by the DMR under the reference number FS30/5/1/1/2/895PR. The Prospecting Right is valid for a period of five years from date of execution of the new Prospecting Right. The balance of the purchase price of USD 8.76m was paid on 2[nd] July 2010.

Table 24 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Jeanette

PROSPECTING
RIGHT NO.
FS30/5/1/1/2/895PR
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
29 June 2010
EXPIRY
DATE
Five Years
EFFECTIVE
INTEREST
On 29thSept 2010
Section 11 transfer
consent to the
prospecting right to
Taung Gold
Freestate (Pty) Ltd
from
ARMgold/Harmony
Freegold JV was
granted by the DMR
under
FS30/5/1/1/2/895PR.
Awaiting registration
of the cession.
FARM SIZE (ha) MINERALS
Philadelphia 273 3,886 Gold, silver,
uranium and
associated
minerals
MyBetty351
Wesselsrust 58
Vriendskap234
Roodepoort 235
Rustoord 33
Heldenmoet 117
Zoeten Inval 268
Paardevley251
Martina 226
Aanleg50
Goud Rand 272
Jeanette 371
De Erf 140
Allanridge 425
Uitkyk 258
TOTAL 3,886

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-70 –

==> picture [432 x 651] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-71 –

44

The surface area is sufficient for any future mining operations, storage areas, tailings facilities and plant sites. The right is are granted for exploration of the minerals shown in Table 24 and all requisite fees due to the DMR are paid.

5.3 Material Agreements

5.3.1 Survey of Property Boundaries

The farms, as shown in Table 24 and Figure 13 are registered with the South African Deeds Office and are located on the Government 1:50,000 Topo-Cadastral sheet 2726DC (1996). Property boundaries and corner beacons have been interrogated as part of the Mining and Prospecting Right applications of previous and current right holders.

5.3.2 Surface Rights

The surface rights at Jeanette and Hilton are held by numerous parties and Taung and associated companies do not hold any surface rights in this area. The surface rights holders and all relevant parties have been consulted by Taung. Taung will be the custodian responsible for all aspects of the EMP and for all specifics as set out in the EMP for the properties that form part of the Jeanette and Hilton prospects. All proposed exploration activities on the Jeanette property will be communicated to the surface right owners. The surface rights owners of the Jeanette and Hilton project areas are presented in Note 8.

5.3.3 Ore Concentrate and Treatment Agreement

Currently there are no agreements in place for the treating of ore on or off the Prospecting Right boundaries and such agreements will only be negotiated upon the favourable outcome of a PFS.

5.3.4 Permits to Conduct Work

All permits to conduct exploration have been obtained.

5.3.5 South African Mining Law , Royalties and Taxes

The South African Mining Law, royalties and taxes are discussed in Note 3. Taung will produce refined products and consequently will pay a 5% royalty.

5.4 Accessibility, Infrastructure, Climate and Physiography

5.4.1 Property Access

Access to Jeanette is excellent with the tarred national road R30 linking Welkom and Bothaville, which lie immediately south and north of the property, respectively.

The western portions of Jeanette are accessed via 2km of tarred road from the town of Allanridge (see Figure 13). Well-maintained secondary roads traverse the central and southern portions of the area of interest and in the future, access to drill sites is expected to be via farm tracks. The most proximal populated centre to the project area is the town of Odendaalsrus, located about 2km to the south of Jeanette. A local airport is maintained at Welkom with tarred runways and hangars.

5.4.2 Topography, Climate and Vegetation

The majority of the Jeanette project region is flat, even terrain, overlain by a thick layer of aeolian Kalahari-type sands and loam. The elevation difference between the low and high levels at Jeanette is nominal, ranging between 1,300m and 1,360m amsl. The underlying siltstones and shales of the Ecca Group (Karoo Supergroup) form an impermeable barrier below the sands and as a result, the area is suited to wheat and maize farming and most of the area is consequently cultivated.

Jeanette is located in drainage area nominated C340 by the Department of Water Affairs and Forestry’s surface water resources catchment area index system. The northern section of the area drains towards the Sandspruit, which is a small non-perennial north-south flowing stream with marshy ground developed on either side of the channel (Figure 13).

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-72 –

45

The regional climate is the typical Highveld climate with moderately wet, warm summers and cold dry winters with an average precipitation of 526mm per annum. The winds are seldom strong over the central interior but gusty winds of 100km/h are associated with thunderstorms and moderate to fresh winds occur with cold fronts.

The rainy season occurs in the summer months from October to April with the highest rainfall in December and January. The annual average temperature is 17°C with an average maximum of 24°C, and an average minimum of 10°C. In summer (October to April), the days are moderate to hot, with afternoon showers or thunderstorms. During winter months (May to September), days are dry and sunny with moderate to cool temperatures, while evening temperatures drop sharply.

The hottest months are generally December and January with June and July being the coldest. Natural vegetation in the Jeanette area consists of a variation of dry Cymbopogon themeda veld, which is typical for the inland central districts of South Africa. The dominant grass species is Themeda triandra (Red grass) and is typical grassland veld type Gm8 (Mucina and Rutherford 2006). The presence of Aristida congesta (Three-awn), Eragrostis lehmanniana (Lehmann’s Love Grass) and Tragus koelerioides indicates the arid nature of this veld type.

5.4.3 Infrastructure with Respect to Mining

A well developed infrastructure is available with the following key developments (see Figure 13):-

  • a rail link between Odendaalsrus and Allanridge to the south west of the prospect;

  • the R30 road linking Welkom and Bothaville;

  • Eskom power lines (part of a major grid), situated on the western side of the prospect; and

  • Odendaalsrus and Allanridge both situated nearby and both being centres of existing mining activities in the area and potential sources of unskilled and skilled labour.

5.5 Historical

5.5.1 Early Historical Exploration and Mine Development

The Jeanette Gold mine has been the subject of ongoing investigations since the early part of the last century. The historical operators in the Jeanette Gold Mine area since 1936 are summarised in Table 25 and the exploration programmes shown in Figure 14:-...

Table 25 : Historical Ownership and Exploration on Jeanette

DATE COMPANY COMMODITY ACTIVITY
1936 Wits Extension Limited('WEL') Gold Drilling
1937 Anglo American Corporation of South
Africa onbehalfof WEL
Gold Drilling
1951 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Shaft sinkingat Number 1 shaft initial construction
1951 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Suspension of shaft sinkingat No 1 shaft
1951 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Commencement of Shaft sinking at Number 2B
ventilationshaft to depthof 1546.86m
1954 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Underground work ex 2B ventilation shaft at 49 level
for 3,556m of development.
1955 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Resumption of shaft sinking operations at No 1 shaft
to depthof 1293.27m
1955 Jeanette Gold Mines Limited Gold Suspension of mining operations on the property
due to adverse market conditions.
1972 Anglo American Corporation Gold and Uranium Review of available data andproject
1974 Anglo American Corporation Gold and Uranium Drilling of additional diamond boreholes to test the
gold bearingreefsinthe Jeanette area.
1977 Anglo American Corporation Gold and Uranium Completion of this phase of drilling on the Jeanette
project
1992- Anglo American ProspectingServices Gold Diamond drilling programme comprising3 boreholes.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-73 –

46

DATE COMPANY COMMODITY ACTIVITY
1998 AngloGold Gold Jeanette Gold mine becomes a wholly owned
subsidiaryof AngloGold
2001 Harmony/ARM Gold Purchase of Jeanette Gold Mine byHarmony/ARM
2008 Taung Gold Limited Gold Agreement of sale of Jeanette Gold Mine to Taung
Gold Limited

5.6 Regional Geology and Mineralisation

5.6.1 Regional Geology and Mineralisation of the Witwatersrand Basin

Jeanette project is located in the Welkom Goldfield on the south-western margin of the Achaean Witwatersrand Gold Basin, located on the Kaapvaal Craton in South Africa (Figure 5).

The description of the stratigraphy, structure and mineralisation controls of the Witwatersrand Basin is the same as discussed in the Evander section of this report (see Section 4.6).

5.6.2 Regional Geological Setting of the Welkom Goldfield

The Welkom Goldfield is host to eleven mines in the region between Allanridge, Welkom, and Virginia, in the Free State, located 270km southwest of Johannesburg, at an elevation of 1,370m amsl. These mines have collectively produced 8.7Mkg Au.

The Welkom Goldfield is entirely overlain by Karoo Supergroup formations and comprises two main stratigraphic groups; the lower West Rand Group and the Central Rand Group as illustrated in the stratigraphic column in Figure 16, with over 20 stratigraphically separate reef horizons. These reefs were derived from an Archaean source (2,6Ga) and were deposited into the southwestern corner of the Central Rand Group Basin.

The Welkom Goldfield has a complicated deformational history. The regional geological structure is dominated by a northeast trending synform that is split along its axis by two major faults that diverge in the area to the south of Hilton into the De Bron Fault and the Homestead Fault (Figure 15). The area between these two faults forms a regionally extensive horst block named the De Bron Horst, and divides the northern part of the Free State Goldfield into two structural domains, named the Odendaalsrus Graben to the west, and the Virginia Section to the east of the Hilton project area.

The western margin of the goldfield is a locally overturned syncline with easterly verging faults and the dominant structural features of the region are northerly striking normal faults as illustrated in Figure 15 (Johnson et al 2006). The main mineralised reefs of the Welkom Goldfield include the following from stratigraphically highest to lowest positions as illustrated in Figure 15:-

  • Eldorado Formation reefs;

  • A-Reef;

  • Big Pebble Reef;

  • B-Reef – locally mineralised conglomerate on the discontinuity between the Kimberley and Krugersdorp/Booysens Formations;

  • Leader Reef – sporadic mineralisation; and

  • Basal Reef – in the middle of the Central Rand Group with locally developed bituminous zones with uranium and gold mineralisation.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-74 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-75 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-76 –

49

Historically the Basal Reef has been the prime economic target, with the Kimberley Formation’s (Turffontein Subgroup’s) reef horizons; A-Reef, Big Pebble Conglomerate and B-Reef, considered a secondary source of gold, due to their aerially discontinuous and more erratically developed nature, which have restricted large scale mining. The mineralisation of these reefs is described in detail in Section 5.8.

5.7 Local Geology of the Jeanette Project

5.7.1 Structure of the Jeanette Region

The Jeanette project area is located in the northern part of the Welkom Goldfield where the regional geological and structural setting is that of a graben, bounded towards the west by the Border Fault and to the east by the De Bron Fault, as illustrated in Figure 16.

The dominant structural feature within the prospecting area is the Dagbreek Fault in the east, which strikes approximately northsouth (Figure 16).

On the western, down-throw side of the Dagbreek Fault, a full succession of the Central Rand Group sediments is developed whilst on the eastern up-throw side of the fault, the Central Rand Group sediments subcrop against the Karoo sediments, with the subcrop of the Basal Reef occurring on the eastern edge of the Jeanette project area.

The second most prominent structural feature in the area is the Damspruit Fault which traverses the area from the southwestern corner of the property, towards the east, where it abuts against the Dagbreek Fault (Figure 16).

The structure of the Basal Reef in the Jeanette project area (Figure 16) is that of a westerly dipping body which has been faulted by north striking faults. The shallowest reef occurs on the eastern margin at 950m below surface while the deepest reef is developed along the western boundary at 2,200m below surface.

The depth contours to the Basal Reef below mean sea level (mbmsl) are shown in Figure 16. A rotation component to the faulting results in the fault-bounded blocks displaying dips ranging from 9° to 27° with local dips steepening towards 68° approaching fault contacts.

The Basal Reef (Black Chert facies) ranges in depth below surface from approximately 1,200m to 2,000m on the western side of the Dagbreek Fault and it is estimated that the downthrown displacement towards the west of this fault may be as much as 800m. Some of the subordinate (synthetic and antithetic) faults may have up to 300m down-throw towards the east.

5.7.2 Stratigraphy of the Jeanette Project

The stratigraphic nomenclature used for the Jeanette project is complicated by the change in historic terminology discussed in Section 4.6.1, as well as the variety of classifications used by the various mines in the region. The stratigraphic divisions and used in this report are illustrated in Figure 16.

5.7.3 Mineralised Reefs of the Jeanette Project

The Basal Reef has historically been the prime economic target, with the Kimberley Formation’s (Turffontein Subgroup’s) reef horizons; A-Reef, Big Pebble Conglomerate and B-Reef, only considered as a secondary source of gold, due to their aerial discontinuity and erratic development, which have restricted large scale mining.

Four of the Kimberley Formation’s reefs, have been mined to varying degrees on most of the Free State Goldfield’s mines but prior to production from Gold Fields’ Beatrix Mine, no operation was founded solely on the strength of the Kimberley Formation reefs.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-77 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-78 –

51

The need for replenishment of depleted Basal Reef Mineral Resources in recent years has led to exploration of the Kimberley Formation but in most cases the Kimberley Formation reefs do not represent stand alone Mineral Resources but rather are considered upside potential once underground development has reached the target horizon.

The Basal Reef

The Basal Reef in the Jeanette area is represented by the Black Chert facies which constitutes 40% of the Basal Reef, the Overlap or Transition facies (20%) and the Loraine facies as illustrated in Figure 16.

An additional block in the area dominated by the Loraine Facies may include the Melkkraal facies as an isolated occurrence. Exploration is required to more accurately delineate the boundaries between these four facies domains.

Economically the Black Chert facies is the most important facies and spatially the higher economic potential exists in the southwest (Black Chert facies and Transition facies) of the Jeanette project area. The values in the Loraine facies will be of lower grade (Figure 16).

Lithologically, the Basal Reef on Jeanette is composed of 5cm to 77cm of grey orthoquartzite overlying a poorly developed conglomerate bed. The quartzite is medium to coarse grained with small, white to greenish cream kaolinised feldspar grains scattered throughout. The quartzite is trough cross-bedded on a small scale and fine-grained pyrite nodules mark heavy mineral concentrations on the foresets and bottom-sets.

The base of the reef is marked by a single layer of scattered small oligiomictic pebbles that rest as a lag deposit on a possible scour surface. This lag is associated with a sparse concentration of fine-grained nodular pyrite, scattered granules of carbon, and in some instances with a thin carbon seam up to a few millimetres thick. Fine grains of visible gold occur in this lag and very fine-grained disseminations of gold occur in the thin carbon seam.

Within a sedimentary deposit, the indicators of the proximal or distal locations of deposition within the geometry of a sedimentological fan are pebble size, heavy mineral size and the mineralogical ratio between uranium and gold. In the case of the Basal Reef at Jeanette the pebble size is <6mm in diameter, the pyrite nodules are 0,135mm, the zircon grains are 0,149mm in diameter and the uranium/gold ratio is approximately 30. In comparison to other deposits, the values of these attributes indicate that the Basal Reef in this area is extremely distal (Knowles, 1978).

The structure of the Basal Reef in the Jeanette project area is that of a westerly dipping body, which on the eastern margin of the basin occurs at 950m below surface, whilst along the northern boundary at 2,200m below surface as illustrated in Figure 16. The reef is faulted by the north striking faults.

The A-Reef Zone

The A-Reef occurs in the Aandenk Formation and marks the base of the Earl’s Court member. The A-Reef consists of one or more tabular reef deposits, separated by argillaceous, coarse grained, immature quartzites. The A-Reef is a pebble supported, small to medium pebble conglomerate which can be significantly enriched in pyrite, with gold strongly associated with pyrite nodules occurring on the basal contact of the conglomerate unit. The individual reef bands are very similar in appearance and they are lenticular (discontinuous) in shape, typical of a braided stream deposit.

The individual reef horizons have an oligomictic, small to medium (25mm) pebble conglomerate band/lag on the scoured base which comprises quartz and chert clasts with sulphide mineralisation and occasional carbon associations. Light grey, siliceous, upward fining orthoquartzite with pyritic stringers occur above the basal lag. Shale fragments may be present in the conglomerate. Correlation of the individual reefs, from borehole to borehole, is difficult. Gold mineralisation is restricted to channels and where mature conglomerates are developed the gold grades seem to be higher.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-79 –

52

5.8 Deposit Type and Mineralisation

The deposition of gold deposits of the Witwatersrand Basin is considered to have taken place along the interface between a fluvial system and a major body of still water or an inland sea.

The source of the gold is postulated as being a northerly Archaean Greenstone where plate interactions caused the development of mineralising hydrothermal activity and generated sedimentary environments where deposition could occur.

The basin is filled with approximately 14,000m of sedimentary and subordinate volcanic rocks, which have folded along a northeast to southwest axis into an asymmetrical syncline (Pretorius, 1974).

The gold bearing fan deposits are considered to represent major, diachronous, entry points of coarse-grained sediment into the basin where fluvial braid-plains have developed and coalesced laterally and gold was concentrated within conglomerates developed primarily on unconformities.

Economic gold concentrations commonly extend for 10km to 30km down depositional dip, and for up to 10km to 12km along depositional strike and are postulated to represent mineralised channels within the postulated braid-plains.

The gold mineralisation typically occurs in lenticular conglomeratic channel-like deposits, usually associated with regional unconformities. Conglomerates are described in terms of clast size and type, and as either proximal or distal depending on the sedimentological characteristics of the unit. The conglomerate horizons can vary significantly along strike and may appear similar to other horizons either higher or lower in the stratigraphic succession and for this reason, selected marker horizons are used for correlation purposes.

Gold mineralisation in the ‘reef’ horizons (mineralised, potentially economic zone) is usually associated with pyrite and carbon and these reef horizons are principally conglomeratic with pebbles of quartz, quartzite and minor chert, shale and siltstone. The conglomerate matrix is hydrothermally altered and metamorphosed to greenschist facies, with quartz and phylosilicates being the most abundant constituents and pyrite and sericite present in appreciable quantities.

Gold occurs as very fine grains and occasionally as veinlets within quartz pebbles, suggestive of post deposition mobilisation. In addition to gold, silver and base metals are present in the economic horizons and the proportion of gold to silver varies between reef horizons.

Detailed descriptions for the nature of the economic reefs are presented in Sections 5.7.3

5.8.1 Widths of the Mineralised Zones and Basal Reef Hanging Wall

The mean reef width of the primary reef, the Basal Reef in the Jeanette area averages 21cm in width. The resource estimation in this area provided for a 100cm mining width. The mean width of the A Reef is 113cm.

The Basal Reef at the Jeanette Project is overlain by a succession of quartzite and shale. The layer of shale is prevalent in the Northern Free State goldfield and is known locally as the “Khaki Shale”. The shale is of variable thickness and is geotechnically weak. The Khaki Shale is separated from the Basal Reef by a layer of quartzite, which is also of varying thickness, but which is geotechnically competent.

5.8.2 Orientation of the Mineralised Zones

The structure of the Basal Reef in the Jeanette project area is that of a westerly dipping body which has been displaced by north striking faults.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-80 –

53

The shallowest reef occurs on the eastern margin at 950m below surface while the deepest reef is developed along the Loraine Gold Mines boundary at 2,200m below surface. There was rotation associated with faulting with the result that the fault-bounded blocks have dips ranging from 9° to 27°, with local dips steepening towards 68° approaching fault contacts. A structural plan of the Jeanette project area on the Basal Reef horizon is given in Figure 8 showing the orientation of Basal Reef, which is likely to be similar for the other potential economic horizons.

5.9 Recent Exploration

An extensive, independent Due Diligence review of data purchased from Harmony and AngloGold Ashanti was conducted on behalf of Taung by TMC in July 2008 and May 2009.

The historic borehole drilling records and core, reports, resource statements and sampling data were examined and the original assay results verified in a resampling exercise. The Due Diligence and resampling exercises have been conducted for both the Basal Reef and the three reefs occurring in the Kimberley Formation.

In addition, an independent, high level Scoping Study has been completed for the Jeanette project, which examined a conventional breast mining option, utilising the original ventilation shaft and sinking a new shaft to 1,925m below surface (SMS 2009). A further Scoping Study was conducted by Minxcon in 2010.

The results of these Scoping Studies demonstrated that at an in-situ grade of 9.58g/t Au over 100cm and utilising 64% of the resource area, the project proved economically viable. A PFS should now be commissioned to design a mine plan, convert the Mineral Resources to compliant Mineral Reserves and develop a financial model based on these reserves. Site investigations for a 2D and 3D seismic survey have been completed, and the 2D survey will be finalised prior to the commencement of any drilling.

5.10 Geological Data

5.10.1 Drilling – Due Diligence of Historic Drilling and Re-sampling

Exploration in the Jeanette area was carried out in several drilling campaigns since the 1930s. Ownership changes in the intervening period have resulted in some difficulty in sourcing the majority of reported intersections on the Basal Reef. Taung located five boreholes out of a total of sixteen that reportedly intersected the Basal Reef, which represents approximately 30% of the total data set reported on the property.

Four of these borehole intersections are located in the southern half of the area, hosted by the Black Chert facies, whilst the fifth intersection is located in the extreme north of the area, reportedly hosted by the Loraine facies. This has restricted the aerial extent for which the confirmatory sampling exercise can be applied. There is no available Basal Reef intersection data within 1,000m of the underground development around the shaft area (TMC 2008c).

The available boreholes used in the confirmatory sampling exercise were therefore WR1, HB1, MB1, HB2 and JER1 (Figure 14). Although higher stratigraphic portions of borehole LW1 were available, no intersections of Basal Reef could be located. In addition, while some drill core from borehole AL2 was available, it was clearly representative of a highly faulted stratigraphic interval in the region of the Kimberley (Aandenk) Formation, and therefore of no value for the Due Diligence Review.

Basal Reef intersections from the five boreholes reviewed displayed varying degrees of grinding and core loss, ranging from complete eradication of the hydrocarbon-rich bottom contact, to complete preservation. The nature of the review, which involved quartering of existing core, dictated that the deflections chosen for resampling were those that displayed minimal core loss.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-81 –

54

The Kimberley Formation Reefs

Taung identified seven boreholes of the original ACC drilling programme with Kimberley Formation intersections (JEZ1, JEZ2, JER1, HB1, WR1, LW1, JEJ1) for resampling, which represents 30% of a possible eighteen intersections reportedly drilled on the Jeanette property. A central eastwest portion of the lease area with historic high value intersections is poorly represented by available core.

5.10.1.1 Establishment of Structural Continuity

The Basal Reef

The extensive drilling campaign of the late 1970s carried out by AAC enabled the compilation of a Basal Reef structure plan. In addition, the geological structure of the Jeanette area was well established from surrounding mining operations at Freegold North, Loraine and Melkkraal exploration ventures to the south, west and east respectively. The resultant structure map shown in Figure 16 has been collated from a combination of boreholes drilled in the Jeanette Mine property and through interpretation from surrounding operations and projects, and is considered to be of sufficient accuracy for a project at this stage of development.

5.10.1.2 Facies Variations

The Basal Reef

The stratigraphic succession in the Jeanette area is extremely well documented and the stratigraphic markers above and below the reef horizon are recognised in boreholes, in regional mining activities on the same horizon and in the underground development on the Jeanette property. Facies distribution maps have been compiled for the Basal Reef from the historic borehole data (Figure 16).

The Black Chert facies is preferentially developed in the southern and western areas of the Jeanette area, including the 2B Shaft development area (Figure 16). The Black Chert facies is bordered to the east by a poorly constrained “overlap zone some 1,000m wide in which a reported mixed facies of Black Chert and Loraine facies is present. The Black Chert facies is significant in that high gold grades are associated with this facies.

The Loraine facies represents a distal deposition of Basal Reef dominated by an insignificant pebble layer lying at the base of a thin siliceous quartzite, and carries a lower gold and uranium grade (TMC, 2008c). Borehole intersections constraining this zone are however widely separated with a reported low core recovery on the critical bottom reef contact (Figure 16).

The Overlap facies zone is generally poorly understood and the absence of available borehole intersections gives only a low level of confidence in the continuity of the facies. The intersection of borehole HB2, reviewed during the Due Diligence Review, is reported to lie within the Overlap facies zone but displays similar characteristics to the Black Chert facies developed elsewhere on the property. The Overlap facies may not constitute a separate facies.

5.10.1.3 Confirmatory Sampling Programme

Two independent confirmatory sampling exercises were undertaken to confirm the presence of gold and uranium in the core and provide a value comparison with original data for the Basal Reef (TMC 2008c) and Kimberley Formation reefs (TMC 2009) at Jeanette. Essentially the methodology of both campaigns was similar and is summarised as follows.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-82 –

55

Only one or two selected deflections from each borehole were identified for resampling. The selection criteria were based on core integrity and completeness. Structurally disturbed intersections were not considered and a sufficiently large number of intact reef intersections were available for sampling. The sampling protocols used in the resampling programme are presented in Note 10.

The exercise included the insertion of appropriate Certified Reference Material (‘CRM’) and barren material (Blanks) into the sampling stream to check for laboratory accuracy and contamination respectively. CRM was obtained from African Mineral Standards. Of the CRM produced by the company, AMIS 0077 was considered to be the most representative of the rock type to be assayed from the Jeanette project, with reported concentrations of 12ppm (g/t) Au (±0.84ppm at 2 standard deviations) and 490ppm U3O8 (±50ppm at 2 standard deviations).

Details of the results of the re-sampling on the Basal Reef are presented in Note 11 .

Gold and uranium accumulations have been calculated on the basis of the reef assays and measured apparent dip angle and include values received from the immediate hangingwall sample, where this was identified as the siliceous Basal Reef quartzite. Footwall assays were excluded from reef calculations.

The Basal Reef

Comparisons between the two stages of sampling confirm the presence of gold and uranium accumulations in the borehole core.

The spread of gold assay data indicates that in general there is no particular bias towards either the original or the re-sampled gold assay data set.

5.10.1.4 Capture of Historic Data and Data Management

The results of the drilling and the geological interpretation were digitally captured in MICROMINE geological modelling software and stored in GIS software ARCVIEW. Borehole locations, together with the results of the economic evaluation, were plotted on plan.

The geometry of the deposit has been defined in historic sections drawn through the property. The width of the Basal Reef is well defined and has been estimated at an average width of 0.21m.

5.10.1.5 Borehole Surveys

Collar surveys were undertaken on all boreholes while down-hole survey information is available on the majority of the later boreholes drilled in the project area. The down-hole surveys were generally multishot surveys.

5.10.1.6 Borehole Core Logging

The historical borehole core at Jeanette was logged by professional geologists employed by Anglo American Corporation. The data has been captured digitally by Taung Gold and the original logging sheets/books are kept in Taung’s filing system. Standard logging conventions as applicable to Witwatersrand gold mining and exploration activities has been applied.

5.10.2 Sampling Methodology

The original core sampling was based on standard Anglo American Corporation sampling procedures as follows:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-83 –

56

  • core was logged and reef horizons identified;

  • sampling of the reefs entailed orientating the core so that the low point of the bedding was directed down the hole;

  • the core was halved with a diamond saw along the axis of this low point and further split into approximately 20cm sample lengths;

  • the samples extended to approximately 2cm above and below the top and bottom contacts respectively;

  • samples were labelled and the remaining half core is similarly labelled in the core box and retained for reference;

  • samples were submitted for analysis at appropriate laboratories where fire assay was the most common analytical method.

The borehole core is in good condition and is stored in robust core trays in a secure core shed at Welkom.

As part of the due diligence of the project area, Taung Gold further sampled some of the historic zones, by halving the remaining reference core (thus quartering the core) and submitting it for analysis. The results provided the necessary confidence in the data to permit incorporation in Mineral Resource estimates.

The detailed sampling protocols used in the re-sampling exercise for both the Basal Reef and the Kimberley Formation reefs are presented in Note 10.

Details of all borehole sampling carried out during the due diligence review are compiled in the spreadsheet shown in Note 11.

The samples taken for the resampling programme were taken under direct supervision of the TMC qualified person, stored in locked premises and transported to the laboratory. No other party had access to the samples during this process.

5.10.2.1 Sample Analysis

The samples were assayed by Set Point Laboratories (‘Set Point’), Isando, Johannesburg, South Africa, which issued a receipt on arrival of the samples. Set Point is an ISO accredited laboratory (ISO17025) specialising in gold and platinum group element analysis.

The gold determinations were made by fire assay and Inductively Coupled Plasma (‘ICP’) and the laboratory is accredited to 0.01ppm to 50ppm levels. The U3O8 analyses were done using pressed powder discs and X-ray Fluorescence (‘XRF’) analysis accredited from 7ppm to 2040ppm levels.

5.10.2.2 Quality Assurance and Quality Control (‘QA/QC’)

An assessment of the laboratory accuracy and contamination was undertaken by incorporation of Certified Reference Materials (‘CRM’) and barren material (blanks) respectively. The CRM was sourced from African Mineral Standards and AMIS 0077 was considered the most appropriate for the Jeanette lithologies with 12ppm gold (±0.84ppm at 2 standard deviations) and 409ppm U3O8 (±50ppm at 2 standard deviations).

The gold assays indicate a consistent under-evaluation of AMIS 00770 and a consistent over-evaluation of uranium relative to the certified value of AMIS 0077. With a single exception the Au and U3O8 assays of Blanks returned values of less than 0.06g/t and 7ppm respectively indicating reasonable laboratory control of contamination.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-84 –

57

TMC and Venmyn are satisfied that the sample preparation, security and analytical procedures are adequate and are confident in the accuracy of the results. TMC concluded from the resampling programme that the historical dataset for Jeanette has been validated.

5.10.2.3 Data Verification

The entire resampling programme at Jeanette was aimed at the verification of the historical exploration data which included drilling results, borehole logs and assay results. The available borehole logs and core were reviewed by TMC in July 2008 and May 2009, and re-sampled and assayed.

TMC has stated in writing that they are satisfied that the historical data for the Basal Reef and Kimberley Formation reefs have been verified and therefore may be used in Mineral Resource estimates.

The spread of gold assay results about the X-axis indicates there is no bias toward either the original or the re-sampled data set. The grouping of the data above the X-axis for the U3O8 data set indicates that the original assays may have overestimated the U3O8 grade.

An analysis of the deflection variance for the Basal Reef indicates an gold value of 1,224,942cmg/t which is higher than the total population variance of 1,046,997cmg/t (TMC, 2008). This would suggest a total nugget effect for the Basal Reef. The acceptable percentage mean deviation at the 90% confidence limits can be ascertained. None of the resampling data falls outside the acceptable limits (TMC 2008).

5.10.2.4 Rock Density

No relative density (‘RD’) measurements have been undertaken for the mineralised reefs at Jeanette. Standard South African gold mine density figures range from 2.74t/m[3] to 2.77t/m[3] based on weighted density calculations for rocks comprising 94% silica with accessory pyrite. In the resource calculations a theoretical density of 2.75t/m[3] was used (TMC, 2009).

5.11 Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves

5.11.1 Geological Modelling

A 3D geological modelling exercise was completed by Taung on the Jeanette ore body based on historic structural models. The model was refined to accommodate new interpretations as required by the 3D geometry and has been used to assist in developing the conceptual mine design for Jeanette. The model will require updating once additional data from the seismic surveys and drilling becomes available (Figure 17).

5.11.2 Mineral Resource and Reserve Estimates

The historical dataset, consisting mainly of exploration drilling data from AAC has been validated through the re-check sampling and reconciliation of the hardcopy log-sheet data and core (‘TMC’). In the classification process of the Mineral Resources the definitions and guidelines of the JORC and SAMREC Codes were considered, as well as direct geological experience of the ore body to the west and south of the project.

Support for classification in the Indicated Mineral Resource category was based upon lateral continuity of reef facies between surface borehole intersections. Positions and orientations of major fault zones have been obtained from surrounding mine properties and confirmed by direct observations from drill core. Structural continuity has been established with a reasonable degree of confidence. The exploration data is further confirmed by un-validated underground sampling that suggests on a local level, that the mineralisation is continuous and of relatively low variability.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-85 –

58

This conclusion would appear to be in conflict with the high nugget effect reported earlier which is interpreted as a sampling effect deriving from the loss of friable hydrocarbon mineralisation at the basal contact of the reef.

Resource Estimation and Methodology for the Basal Reef - Jeanette

The stratigraphic persistence and grade of the Basal Reef has been well documented over a fifty year history of mining in the Welkom Goldfield. Two main facies to the Basal Reef have been noted for fifty years and the Black Chert facies has been extensively studied by Muntingh (AAC).

Due to the clear geographical distribution of the two main facies of the Basal Reef (Figure 16) the evaluation of the zone dominated by the Black Chert facies in the south of Jeanette Mine and the lower grade Loraine facies in the north, were treated separately in the resource estimation process. The boundaries between the various facies are subjective, as they are based on widely spaced surface borehole intersections and are therefore open to reinterpretation.

The 3D geological modelling exercise shows the elevation model of the base of the Basal Reef based on borehole information, historical mapping plans and interpreted geological structure. The various facies domains are illustrated in Figure 17.

Reported gold values from the 15 historic boreholes together with deflection data (excluding the possible Melkkraal facies intersections), in addition to limited information from underground reef development, were used in the evaluation.

A tabulation of the verified gold values by borehole and facies type is presented in Table 26 (TMC, 2008).

Table 26: Borehole Values and Facies Type for the Basal Reef– Jeanette

**BOREHOLE ID.NO. ** BASAL REEF(cmg/t) FACIES
MB1 312 Black Chert facies
HB1 1517
LW1 126
J1 1054
HB2 107
J2 133
DEE1 220
WR1 559
AL3 502
AL2 Faulted out
DEE3 264
WE12 1537
U/G 897
HD1 22 Overlap facies
MT2 stopped
WE3 29
WE11 307
WE5 stopped
DEE2 faulted
RP1 beyond
JER1 291* Melkkraal facies

The evaluation was conducted on arithmetic averages of borehole clusters and a single value for combined underground development sampling.

TMC, an independent consultancy, prepared the Mineral Resource Statement presented in Table 28, which was reviewed by Venmyn. TMC is of the opinion that the current borehole spacing across the Jeanette Mine property is adequate to facilitate the division of the Basal Reef into separate facies, and to allow the definition of these facies into areas of reasonable geological confidence, but with a low degree of certainty in facies boundary definition. Similarly, the borehole intersection spacing is adequate to enable a broad structure plan to be developed with a reasonable degree of accuracy in relation to major faulting.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-86 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-87 –

60

TMC believes that the historical dataset, consisting mainly of exploration drilling data from AAC and reports provided by Taung, has been validated and may be employed in Mineral Resource estimation.

The data set was insufficient to allow for a full geostatistical analysis, consequently the classification of the Mineral Resources was based on the 90% confidence limits error expressed as a percentage (Mwasinga, 2001).

Those reefs with an error of less than 10% were considered a Measured Mineral Resource; those between 10% and 25% were considered an Indicated Mineral Resource and those between 25% and 50% as Inferred.

Resource Estimation and Methodology for the A Reef - Jeanette

The grade-tonnage relationship for the A Reef was determined, as well as the variance for 200m x 200m resource blocks. The parameters at a cut-off grade of 3g/t are indicated in Table 27 and according to the same geostatistical analysis that was applied to the Basal Reef, the Mineral Resources for the A Reef can be classified as Inferred Mineral Resources.

Table 27 : Grade Tonnage Data for the A Reef

CUT-OFF
GRADE
VALUE ABOVE
CUT-OFF
% ABOVE
CUT-OFF
EVALUATION
WIDTH
TONNAGE
ABOVE CUT-
OFF
CONTAINED
Au
(g/t) (g/t) (cm) (t) (oz)
0.00
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
2.55
2.60
2.89
3.34
3.85
4.39
100.00
97.75
84.24
66.26
50.17
37.53
113
113
113
113
113
113
100,948,000
98,677,000
85,039,000
66,888,000
50,646,000
37,886,000
8,265,000
8,249,000
7,901,000
7,183,000
6,269,000
5,347,000
3.00 4.95 28.07 113 28,336,000 4,510,000
3.50
4.00
4.50
5.00
5.51
6.08
6.66
7.23
21.09
15.96
12.18
9.37
113
113
113
113
21,290,000
16,111,000
12,295,000
9,459,000
3,772,000
3,149,000
2,633,000
2,199,000
Source: TMC 2009
Density value used
Geological Losses 2
Average Dip 25°
2.75tpm
Area 39,107,291m2
5%

An accepted industry norm is that, for a primary ore body with deep level mining, if the percentage above the cut-off is less than 25%, then the economics of the underground development required, renders the ore body unviable.

The A Reef has an estimated payability of 28.07% at the 3.0g/t cut-off. The A Reef occurs 225m above the primary target reef (Basal Reef) and can therefore be considered a mineable secondary reef. The A Reef could be defined by underground exploration at the time the Basal Reef is developed. The potential for the eventual economic extraction of the A Reef is apparent and therefore an Inferred Mineral Resource of 28.3Mt at a grade of 4.95g/t Au for 4.51Moz contained gold is defined at a cut-off grade of 3g/t Au over a width of 113cm.

No compliant Mineral Resources can be estimated for the Big Pebble Conglomerate and B Reefs at this stage.

Consolidated Mineral Resource Estimate - Jeanette

A consolidated Mineral Resource statement for the Basal and A Reefs at Jeanette is presented in Table 28 below.

Rock Density

Bulk density measurements are well established from adjacent mining operations on the same reef. The accepted density of Basal Reef as utilised by TMC is 2.75g/cm[3] .

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-88 –

61

5.11.3 Summary of Mineral Resource Classification Logic for Jeanette

The Jeanette project is situated between the mined out Loraine Gold Mines to the west and the currently operating Tshepong Gold Mine to the south, both of which mined the Basal Reef as the primary economic horizon. In addition, this horizon has been the primary economic reef mined throughout the Welkom goldfield for the past 60 years, so that the level of geological understanding of this reef is high, with the Basal Reef classified and subdivided according to various facies, sub facies and geo-zones.

As discussed in Sections 5.11.1 and 5.11.2, the Black Chert facies of the Basal Reef at Jeanette is classified as an Indicated Mineral Resource (Table 28).

An Inferred Mineral Resource classification has been applied to the Overlap facies, which is a demonstrable, interpreted change in facies between the low grade Basal Reef-‘Loraine’ facies to the north and the higher grade Basal Reef-‘Black Chert’ facies in the south.

However, apart from the grade distribution, the confidence levels for the resource classification parameters for the Overlap facies exceed those required for classification in the Inferred category. In the context of the high confidence levels applicable to grade distribution in the Basal Reef in the Welkom goldfields area, Taung is confident that the Overlap facies Inferred Mineral Resources will be rapidly upgraded to the Indicated category through the proposed exploration programme.

Table 28: Consolidated Mineral Resource Estimate – Jeanette (Venmyn, August 2009)

MINERAL RESOURCE
CATEGORY
Indicated (Black Chert
Facies)
Inferred (Overlap Facies)
Inferred (A-Reef)
Total Indicated
Total Inferred
TOTAL MINERAL
RESOURCE*
MINING
TONNES
(t) **
23,030,000
11,540,000
28,340,000
23,030,000
39,880,000

MINING
GRADE
(g/t)
9.58
9.58
4.95
9.58
6.29
MINING
GRADE
(cmg/t)
958
958
559
958
MINING
WIDTH
(cm)
100
100
113
100
CHANNEL
WIDTH
(cm)
24
24
113
24
CHANNEL
GRADE
(g/t)
39.92
39.92
4.95
39.92
GOLD
(kg)
220,580
110,530
140,260
220,580
250,790

GOLD
(oz)
7,092,000
3,553,000
4,510,000
7,092,000
8,063,000
62,910,000 7.49 471,370 15,155,000

*Tonnes at cut-off greater than 3.0g/t Au Computational inconsistencies due to rounding down Reported inclusive of Mineral Reserves Facies types are in accordance with AAC – Muntingh’s classification Density value used 2.75t/m[3 ] Mineralised width of 100cm used to convert area to volume Geological Losses 25% Average Dip 25° Area 39,107,291m[2]

5.11.4 Inclusion of Inferred Mineral Resources in the Scoping Study

As discussed in Section 5.11.3, apart from grade continuity, there is a high level of detailed geological understanding of the Overlap facies-Inferred Mineral Resources at Jeanette, which would require only minimal exploration to be upgraded into the Indicated Mineral Resources category. Furthermore, when the Inferred Mineral Resources are viewed within the Witwatersrand Gold deposit context, the confidence level is typically greater than that in greenstone and shear hosted gold deposits. Taung therefore considered the inclusion of the Inferred Mineral Resources in the economic evaluation of Scoping Study to be reasonable and based on the sound expectation of upgrading the Inferred Mineral Resources to the Indicated category.

The Scoping Study indicated that the mine is economic based on the Indicated Mineral Resources alone and the economic contribution of the ‘Inferred’ Mineral Resource is therefore an additional asset, providing that grade exceeds the current pay limit of 5.20g/t Au in situ. The average grade for the Overlap facies is likely to exceed that threshold, considering that it forms the transition zone from the Black Chert facies, which has grades of 9.58g/t Au.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-89 –

62

5.11.5 Modifying Factors

As part of the economic evaluation at Scoping Study level, Minxcon 2010, included both the Indicated and some of Inferred Mineral Resources in the mine plan and scheduling. In terms of international reporting codes no category exists for modified Inferred Mineral Resources and consequently the resultant tonnages are not compliant Mineral Reserves but are referred to as “Economic Inferred Mineral Resources” for the purposes of reporting the Scoping Study results . The applied modifying factors are discussed below.

Taung’s proposed exploration programme is specifically aimed at the upgrading of the Inferred Mineral Resources to the Indicated Mineral Resource category in order to permit the definition of compliant Probable Mineral Reserves. The following modifying factors were applied:-

  • the target ore body is the Basal Reef which has been mined for 60 years extensively on neighbouring properties and no other reefs were considered economic for the purposes of the study;

  • Inferred Mineral Resources were included in the estimation and the resultant tonnages are “Economic Inferred Mineral Resources”. The Indicated Mineral Resources were converted to Probable Reserves;

  • the selected mining width of the reef is approximately 88cm;

  • the specific gravity has not been determined but industry accepted Bulk Density of the Basal Reef is 2.75g/cm[3] ;

  • an average dip of 18° was used in the mine design criteria;

  • the average in-situ Mineral Resource grade of 9.58g/t Au over a mining cut of 100cm in the payable area translates to 11.89g/t Au over the selected mining cut of 88cm;

  • Mine2-4D™ and EPS Gant Chart software was used to define the optimum mine design using inputs including geotechnical parameters, mining parameters, metal prices, metallurgical recoveries, mining and processing costs and royalties;

  • a two year historic, average gold price of USD34,375/kg ;

  • the in-stope waste development will be minimised and dilution is expected to average between 10% and 15%, which assumes some waste storage underground;

  • a dilution of 11% was applied, with an average MCF of 79% over the LoM;

  • metallurgical recoveries were based on a conventional CIP/CIL plant with known recovery parameters and a gold recovery of 96%; and

  • mining and processing costs were estimated and appropriate allowances were made for royalties and other costs.

Additional modifying factors are presented in Table 29 and these factors are in line with the current design parameters used at Tshepong Gold mine for annual planning. The Scoping Study scheduled 30.13Mt at a shaft head grade of 7.25g/t Au.

Table 29: Design Criteria and Modifying Factors – Jeanette (Minxcon, 2010)

**REEF BLOCK INFORMATION ** AVERAGE STOPING PANEL
Block Width(m) 150.00 Panel Length(m) 25
Block Length(m) 180.00 Planned StopingHeight(m) 0.88
Block Height (m) 0.88 Overbreak(%) 11
Block RD 2.75 Max Possible ADV/Blast(m) 0.9
Block Grade(g/t Au) 10.89 Realistic ADV/Blast(m) 0.84
Geological Losses (%) 10.00 Max PossibleBlasts/Period 23
Other Losses(%) 10.00 Current ADV/Period 16
Mine Call Factor(%) 79.00 m2/crew in Period 399

Source: Minxcon 2010

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-90 –

63

The application of the modifying factors to the Inferred and Indicated Mineral Resources in the Scoping Study (Section 5.11.5) is discussed above and the final estimated Probable Mineral Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ is presented in Table 30. The logic for the inclusion of the Inferred Mineral Resources in the economic evaluation is summarised in Sections 5.11.3 and 5.11.4.

Table 30: Probable Reserves and ‘Economic Inferred Mineral Resources’ for Jeanette (Minxcon 2010

REEF CATEGORY VOLUME TONNES HEAD
GRADE (g/t)
7.26
7.26
GOLD GOLD
**( ‘000 m3) ** (t) (kg) (oz)
Basal Reef
Basal Reef
Probable
Reserves
+
Economic Inferred Mineral
Resources
Probable Reserves only
10,956
8,086
30,130,000
22,254,000
218,425
161,000
7,022,525
5,191,000

Source: Minxcon 2010

Includes Inferred Mineral Resources from Overlap facies Mining Width 88cm

International reporting standards requires that an economic evaluation of a project that includes Inferred Mineral Resources should be reported in two scenarios, the first being the evaluation based on Mineral Resources inclusive of Inferred Mineral Resources and the second based on evaluation of Indicated and Measured only. The purpose of this requirement is to highlight the extent to which the project viability hinges on the inclusion of Inferred Mineral Resources.

In compliance with this requirement, the conversion of the Jeanette Indicated Mineral Resources only to Probable Mineral Reserves, is presented for completeness in Table 30.

Future Reserve Potential

Potential exists for the definition of additional Mineral Reserves through the upgrading of adjacent Mineral Resources to the Indicated Mineral Resource category. In addition, Mineral Resources that are currently classed as Inferred may be upgraded to Indicated, thus presenting the opportunity to convert these to Mineral Reserves at a later stage. There is currently 4.514Moz Au Inferred Mineral Resource of A-Reef which could be upgraded to Mineral Reserves once mining has commenced.

5.11.6 Jeanette Planned Exploration Expenditure

Taung expects to outlay USD15.584m for the financial year ending February 2012 on the Jeanette project for exploration activities. The funding to undertake this exploration programme is available.

The exploration expenditure has been planned to upgrade some current Inferred Mineral Resources to the Indicated Mineral Resource category.

Table 31 : Exploration Expenditure for Jeanette for the Financial Year 2012

EXPLORATION 1 CONSULTANTS 2 OVERHEADS3 TOTAL
(USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000) (USD'000)
(13,084) (2,188) (312) (15,584)
  1. Drilling 2 boreholes, sampling and 3D reflective geophysical survey

  2. 2 .Consultants, environmental management

  3. On site and Head Office

5.12 Mining

5.12.1 Overview

Jeanette is an historic mine with two unequipped shafts that were sunk during the 1950s which are available for early mine access.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-91 –

64

The area has a well developed infrastructure with a rail link and a national road (R30) between Odendaalsrus and Bothaville and access to the national Eskom power lines which are situated on the western side of the prospect area (see Sections 5.1 and 5.4).

Various Scoping Studies for Jeanette developed a conceptual design for mining the ore body. The conceptual design required the sinking of a new vertical shaft adjacent to the existing ventilation shaft.

The ventilation shaft would then form part of a twin shaft system. The portions of the ore body which were originally planned to be accessed from the existing rectangular shaft, would in the current design, be accessed via twin declines and horizontal haulages from the new shaft. The new vertical shaft, with the entire necessary infrastructure and the existing ventilation shaft would have a handling capacity of 145ktpm. The aim would be to maximise the LoM in order to optimally service the infrastructural capital expenditure at a steady state of approximately 145ktpm.

5.12.2 Mine Design in the Scoping Study

The key properties of the ore body affecting the mine design and planning are as follows:-

  • the channel width which averages 24cm;

  • the proposed mining width of the reef will be approximately 88cm;

  • the orebody dip varies from 5° to 27°;

  • the two main facies types are the Black Chert facies and the Overlap facies; At Jeanette, the high grades are typically associated with Black Chert facies basal Reef; and

the thickness and competence of the hangingwall units.

For all areas, the conventional Witwatersrand Gold mine stoping techniques were applied as assumption criteria and for access development, footwall drives and crosscuts were used.

The new 9m diameter service shaft would be sunk conventionally by means of drilling and blasting to a depth of 1,925mbsl, in close proximity of the current 5.5m diameter ventilation shaft. The new shaft would operate over six stations to access all of the mining blocks. During steady state, ore will be transported from the stopes using track bound equipment to a conveyor system feeding the shaft conveyances.

5.12.3 Mine Planning and Scheduling

Mining Tonnage

The full LoM and ramp-up mining production summary schedules were developed during the Scoping Study (Minxcon 2010). The planned mining blocks are illustrated in Figure 18. The planned production statistics are summarised in Table 34.

The ramp-up production schedules for Jeanette based on Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources combined, as well as Indicated Mineral Resources only, are presented in Table 32 and Table 33 respectively.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-92 –

Table 32 : Ramp-up Mining Production for Jeanette Scoping Study including Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources (Minxcon, 2010) 2019 10 15,269
581,895.00
476,460
1,740,000
7.59
426,197.42
2019 10 14,200
541,157.53
443,104
1,618,186
14,200
541,157.53
443,104
1,618,186
14,200
541,157.53
443,104
1,618,186
14,200
541,157.53
443,104
1,618,186
7.62
396,360.06
7.62
396,360.06
Source: Minxcon 2010
*Total for LoM
2018 9 16,377
579,418.00
517,624
1,720,495
7.67
424,090.39
2018 9 15,230
579,418.00
481,350
1,599,926
7.67
394,371.05
2017 8 17,093
306,222.00
589,845
949,078
7.05
215,033.22
on 2010) 2017 8 17,093 306,222.00 589,845 920,599 7.05 208,580.69





c 15,822
30,803.00
575,208
132,435
5.97
25,425.55
2016 7 15,822
30,803.00
575,208
132,435
5.97
25,425.55
ly (Minx 2016 7
n





O

646,182

6,283

3.19

645.06
2015 6 14,380
0.00
646,182
6,283
3.19
645.06
g Study for Indicated Mineral Resources 2015 6
14,380

0.00
2014 5 10,039
0.00
506,096
0.00
0.00
0.00
2014 5 10,039 0.00 506,096 0.00 0.00 0.00
2013 4 5,255
0.00
288,330
0.00
0.00
0.00
2013 4
5,255

0.00

288,330

0.00

0.00

0.00
2012 3 1,307
0.00
149,625
0.00
0.00
0.00
2012 3 1,307
0.00
149,625
0.00
0.00
0.00
2011 2 1,058
0.00
133,129
0.00
0.00
0.00
ette Scopin 2011 2 1,058 0.00 133,129 0.00 0.00 0.00





n 584
0.00
102,143
0.00
0.00
0.00
2010 1
584
0.00
102,143
0.00
0.00
0.00
ction Schedule for Jea 2010 1
TOTALS/Year* 241,834
10,156,746
7,964,927
30,129,983.00
7.25
7,022,525
Totals/Year* 204,358 7,538,885 6,993,629 22,254,525 7.25 5,191,516
UNITS
m
m2
t to dump
t treated
g/t
Ounces
u
Source: Minxcon 2010
Total for LoM
Table 33 : Ramp-up Mining Prod*
PRODUCTION
SUMMARY
Total m advanced
Total m2broken
Waste tonnes
Reef Tonnes
Head Grade g/t
Gold recovered
PRODUCTION
SUMMARY
Total m advanced
Total m2broken
Waste tonnes
Reef Tonnes
Head Grade g/t
Gold recovered

– IV-93 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-94 –

67

The mining method selected for the Jeanette area is conventional and scattered breast mining, which is appropriate for the prevalent geological conditions and would result in undercutting the Khaki Shale horizon. Historically the Khaki Shale has proven a limiting factor in the mining of the reefs in the region, however the Tshepong Gold Mine, to the south of Jeanette has been able to successfully implement conventional mining which entails undercutting the shale.

The approach would be to ensure that the hangingwall quartzite remains in situ and intact as a suitable beam to provide stability to the incompetent shale above (Figure 17):-

Table 34 : Production Statistics for Jeanette

LoM SUMMARY
(USD)*
LoM SUMMARY
(USD)**
ITEM
CAPEX IncludingPlant and OngoingCAPEX(m) (1,057,000) (1,024,000)
OPEX LifeAverage cost/tonnemilled (USD/t) (72.06) (74.48)
Cash Cost Total Cash Cost/oz Auproduced (322.03) (330.94)
Production Annual Ore Production(tonnesper annum – tpa)) 1,720,000 1,63,0000
Monthly OreProduction(tonnes per month-tpm) 145,000 135,000
Annual Gold Production(kg goldper annum) 11,000 9,600
Annual Peak Gold Production (ounces per
annum)
411,000 380,000
Average Production Gold ouncespa 380,000 290,000
StopingWidth(cm) 88 88
Head Grade (g/t) 7.25 7.26
Mine Call Factor 79.90 79.90
Metallurgical Yield(g/t) 6.96 7.00
TotalGold (kg) 209,518 154,845
Total Gold(ounces) 6,736,149 4,978,381
Total Waste Tonnes(LoM) 7,965,000 6,994,000
Reef: Waste Ratio 3.86 3.18

Figures in (red) are negative Source: Minxcon June 2010 *Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only

Ventilation Requirements

A more detailed ventilation and cooling design is necessary to facilitate a total rock breaking production rate of 145ktpm (excluding 40ktpm for waste) and an average reject wet bulb temperature of 27.5°C. Refrigeration is required due to the high virgin rock temperatures in the Witwatersrand Basin. Air can be used in more than one area and the potential for re-circulation will be addressed in the subsequent studies. The conceptual planning and associated cost estimate are benchmarked from similar projects based on the typical suite of design criteria. Comparison of Jeanette to similar operations suggests that a rule of thumb estimate to clear the mine of all contaminants for every 100ktpm of rock broken production would be a minimum of 400kg/s of air.

Mine Scheduling

The designs utilised Mine2-4D software but the scheduling was undertaken in EPS, an underground mining scheduling package. Mining blocks were prioritised using a ranking exercise whereby each block was allocated with a delay to simulate the amount of development required to open up the first raise within that block. A steady state of 145ktpm for 15 years could be achieved at the new shaft.

A two year exploration program and full feasibility study must be completed before shaft sinking can begin. In terms of timing it is estimated that the project would require the following:-

  • eighteen months for finalisation of the power supply from Eskom;

  • twelve months for EIA and EMPR to be completed;

  • six months to mobilise a shaft sinking contractor; and

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-95 –

68

six months to secure winders, a headgear and ropes etc.

It is accepted, however, that most, if not all of these activities could run concurrently.

Geotechnical and Hydrological Aspects

Studies on geotechnical and hydrological aspects of the mine are at an early stage and will be incorporated into the mine design and layout at a later stage. Regional experience from other mines presents extensive input of the likely geotechnical and hydrological issues to be encountered at the mine.

Power Supply

The power for the initial mining period would be supplied by generators and the full production phase would source power from Eskom, distributed from the sub-station, to the underground sub-stations (SMS 2009).

Water Supply and Water Disposal

A conservative estimate of approximately 1t/t (tons of water per ton total rock broken) is assumed. Water will be supplied by the Rand Water Board. Potable water will be sent underground and used as drinking water, service water and makeup water for the refrigeration plants. All water will be supplied to the mining blocks in a common insulated pipe. Fissure and service water will be treated and recycled to minimise the water sent underground.

A staged dirty water pumping system will be utilised for shaft bottom dewatering with stages at 272m intervals. At full production the service water and air-cooler water required within the mining blocks will drain to a main pump station and water treatment facility. Secondary bulk air cooler water will flow independently to the clear water dams.

Gold Processing Plant

No dedicated processing plant exists to process ore from the Jeanette project.

A number of operating gold plants exist on the surrounding mines and an opportunity to purchase one of these plants may arise in the future as ore bodies in adjacent mines become depleted and the current operating mines wind down operations.

Existing Underground Infrastructure

The Jeanette vent shaft has been sunk to a depth of 1,546.86m, while the main shaft has been sunk to 1,293.27m. All shaft infrastructures have been removed. Access development out of the historic vent shaft totalled approximately 3,556m, of which 762m was on the Basal Reef. Re-equipping of this development will be required. Sampling results from these drives and raises have been used in the Mineral Resources estimates for the property.

5.12.4 Manpower

The workforce required on the mine is estimated at between 2,000 to 3,000 workers at peak production. The project area is located in an historic mining area and skilled labour is expected to be available locally, without the need to build accommodation for miners from outside of the region.

5.12.5 Capital Requirements

Capital estimates were broadly defined in the Scoping Study from industry benchmarks and known costs of operating mines will have to be defined more accurately during the PFS, when the optimised mine design will be applied. The LoM CAPEX for the Jeanette mine for various major capital expenditure categories is presented in Table 35, which were also based on 2008 benchmarke cost estimates and inflated by the annual CPI to give an estimate of 2010 costs.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-96 –

69

The capital expenditure schedule for the Jeanette mine for non-surface CAPEX over the ramp-up phase is presented in Table 35. Production is ramped down from year 24 to year 26 and there is consequently no major CAPEX after year 24.

Peak funding is expected to be required in year two after commencement of gold production.

Table 35 : Mining Capex Estimates for Jeanette Mine

ITEM VALUE(USD)
Old Vent Shaft (9,676,567)
NewShaft (342,402,712)
Ventilation & Refrigeration (109,500,000)
Underground Services (132,329,067)
MiningEquipment (15,409,198)
U/G EquippingCosts (15,220,958)
Owners Costs (24,316,320)
Other (2,869,497)
TOTAL (651,724,320)

Source:Minxcon 2010 Negative figures in (red)

Table 36 : Total LoM Capital for Jeanette

TOTAL CAPITAL OVER LoM USD* USD**
Feasibility Studies (10,244,625) (10,244,625)
Exploration Drillingand 3D Seismic Survey*** (19,033,638) (19,033,638)
MiningCapex (651,724,320) (651,724,320)
Plant and Other Infrastructure (181,381,025) (181,381,118)
Contingency (73,391,362) (73,391,362)
OngoingCapex (132,080,387) (98,303,408)
TOTAL (1,067,855,357) (1,034,078,471)
Source:Minxcon 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

  • **Indicated Mineral Resources only

  • ***Includes exploration expenditure up to and including Feb 2012, as quoted in Table I Negative figures in (red)

Contractors’ Indirect Costs

In the current financial model, the mine is considered to be owner mined and contractors will not be utilised for the mining operation. Contractors will however be used for shaft sinking, plant construction and possibly for operating the gold recovery plant.

EPCM Costs

EPCM costs are indicated in Table 37 and were estimated at 8% of plant, shaft, and TSF design, surface infrastructure design and ventilation service costs.

Table 37 : EPCM Activity Costs

ECPM ACTIVITY USD('000)
ECPM (46,564)
Source: Minxcon 2010
Negative figures in (red

Other Owner’s Costs

Other owners’ costs will be determined during the PFS and BFS stages.

Processing Plant

The costs for the construction of the new plant are summarised in Table 38 below and are included in the capital expenditure summarised in Table 36. The possibility exists to purchase an existing plant in the vicinity of Jeanette Mine and this option will be investigated during the PFS and BFS stages.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-97 –

70

Table 38 : Process Plant and Infrastructure Capital

PROCESS PLANT AND INFRASTRUCTURE CAPITAL
Item/Activity Cost(USD)
PlantInfrastructure and SitePreparation (8,356,250)
Civils (10,125,000)
Mechanical Equipment Costs (41,186,250)
ElectricalandInstrumentation (11,875,000)
Structural Steelwork (8,138,900)
Pipingfabrication and supplyof valves (5,500,000)
New Tailings storagefacility study (625,000)
New Tailings storage facility (6,250,000)
Subtotal (6,875,000)
TOTAL (92,056,400)

Source: Minxcon 2010 Negative figures in (red

Contingency and Deferred, Sustaining Capital

A contingency of 15% on plant Capex and 10% on mining Capex has been used. Ongoing Capex was allowed at approximately USD0.132b over the LoM (3% of Plant and 7.5% of mining operating costs).

5.12.6 Working Capital

Operating Costs

Operational cost estimates are based on figures from the Scoping Study and benchmarked against the operating costs of similar mines currently operating. It is estimated that a LoM mining operating cost of USD54.12/t could be achieved when producing at 145ktpm. The LoM operating cost is summarised in Table 39:-

The total operating cash costs for Jeanette are USD322/oz Au.

Table 39 : Operating Costs over LoM

Cost*(USD/t) Cost (USD/t)**
Mining Cost (54.12) (54.37)
ProcessingCosts (9.12) (11.31)
Analytical costs (0.08) (0.08)
Smelting/treatment charges (0.10 (0.10)
Administration/overheads and services (8.64) (8.62)
TOTAL (72.06) (74.48)

Source: Minxcon 2010

*Total Ore body including both Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources

**Indicated Mineral Resources only Negative figures in (red

Cost of Eskom Power

The March 2010 National Electricity Regulator of South Africa (‘NERSA’) review approved the national supplier’s (Eskom) proposed power cost increases from USD0.04per kWhr in 2010 to UDS0.08per kWhr in 2013, which amounts to a 25% increase in tariff. Increases beyond 2013 have not been announced and it is assumed that they will follow inflation.

As the increases are inflation linked, there is no impact on the financial model, which is a constant money model. The power requirement is based on 45kWh/t milled for the gold plant and 75kWh/t mined for the remainder for the other infrastructure.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-98 –

71

Cost of Water

The estimated cost of water supplied to a mine is currently USD0.56/m3. As water supply is directly related to the cost of energy, the cost of water has been increased with the Eskom increases from USD0.56/m3 in 2010 to USD0.75/m3 in 2013, a 9% increase.

5.12.7 Project Risk Profile

Risk Background

A detailed risk assessment will form part of the BFS. There are certain risks, which would need to be assessed, that are common to similar gold projects in South Africa and these, together with the risks that are specific to the Jeanette project, are presented in Note 12.

5.13 Processing

The Jeanette project is at a Scoping Study stage of evaluation and Taung has not conducted metallurgical or mineral processing studies. The Basal Reef and A-Reef horizons have been extensively mined in the region and the metallurgical characteristics are well understood. Historical and current plant recoveries on adjacent operating mines processing the same material are in the order of 95% to 96%. It is anticipated that data from these operations would suffice for profiling the metallurgical response of these reefs. In the event that metallurgical test work is considered warranted, it would probably be undertaken at the BFS stage of the evaluation.

Currently there are no agreements in place for the treating of ore, and such agreements will only be negotiated upon the favourable outcome of a completed PFS.

As adjacent mines are ramping down production operations, it is highly likely that an existing adjacent processing plant could be purchased for treating Jeanette ore.

5.14 Project Implementation

5.14.1 Contracting Strategy

Taung has a strategy of contracting out the PFS and BFS stages of the project to competent, independent consultants of good industry standing.

The orebody is expected to be owner mined. Contractors may be utilised to operate the plant. At the current stage of evaluation of the project, the optimal operating structure for the mine has not been established.

5.14.2 Status of Implementation

Implementation activities are at an early stage and a phase 2 Scoping Study has been completed, the results of which are expected to lead to a PFS in 2010. Physical implementation of the mine plan and commencement of construction will be contingent on the granting and execution of a mining right in respect of the project area.

5.14.3 Project Schedule

The major project milestones and the critical path of the design are summarised in the Project Schedule presented in Note 13. The realistic time that production will commence and the year during which full production is reached, are indicated.

Preparations for shaft sinking begin in March 2013 and the project focus moves from site establishment to production. Jeanette will start production in the fifth year of the project and full production of 145ktpm will be reached in year 8. The starting date is conceptual and the milestone dates will be shifted to accommodate prevailing conditions.

Fast-tracking Production Start-up

The production start up has not been optimized, and there may be some potential to fast track development up to steady state production through more rapid shaft sinking and development regimes. These options will be investigated during the PFS stage.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-99 –

72

5.15 Environmental Considerations

5.15.1 Environmental Standards

An EMP was conducted and approved by the DMR and was submitted as part of the supporting documents for the Prospecting Right application. Key environmental legislation applicable in South Africa has been described in Note 3, as well as the relevance of the legislation with regards to the Jeanette project. The mining infrastructure in the region around the Jeanette Shafts is well established. Mitigation measures with respect to additional impacts on the environment will be investigated during the PFS.

The Jeanette mining operations, sites and related infrastructure are the subject of an EMPR approved as part of the conversion to a ‘New Order’ Mining Right by all relevant interested and affected parties. The EMPR includes a detailed ‘Environmental Closure Assessment’ detailing all areas of environmental liability.

5.16 Social, Community and Land Use

Social Setting

According to an EIA conducted by Golder Associates on behalf of Harmony, dated April 2008, the land capability of the region can be summarised as follows:-approximately, 55% of the land in the region has had its capability permanently altered:-

  • 15% by mining;

  • 10% by infrastructure;

  • 20% by urbanisation; and

  • 10% by other activities.

Taung’s future exploration activities in the area will have a relatively minor impact on land use and will be addressed in the next phase of exploration.

Resettlement

There are no community developments on the property which will require resettlement initiatives.

Local Employment

Several townships are located adjacent to the project area and these will provide a source of skilled and semi-skilled labour. Many of the occupants of these townships have experience of working on the adjacent mines.

5.17 Conclusions

The techno-economic review of the Jeanette project has highlighted the following conclusions:-

  • the Jeanette Gold Mine has been investigated on an ongoing basis for the past 60 years;

  • a substantial database of information has been compiled which has been the platform from which the project has been evaluated;

  • the mine has been non-productive due to historic economic and geotechnical issues, which may now may no longer be valid due to improvements in gold price and mining technologies respectively;

  • a Due Diligence Review on selected Jeanette Mine Basal Reef and Kimberley Formation reef intersections has confirmed the presence of gold and uranium values comparable to those in the historical dataset. The conclusion is that the historical dataset has been validated and can be relied upon for Mineral Resource estimation;

  • the substantial database of historical information on the Basal Reef supports considerable lateral geological continuity, and on this basis an Indicated Mineral Resource for the Black Chert facies of the Basal Reef has been defined;

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-100 –

73

  • the total Indicated Mineral Resource for the Black Chert facies is estimated to be 23.03Mt (above a 3g/t Au cut-off) at 9.58g/t Au for 7.092Moz contained gold (over 100cm);

  • the consolidated JORC compliant Mineral Resource estimate for the Basal and A Reefs over the Jeanette project at a cut-off grade of 3g/t Au, is:-

  • Indicated Mineral Resources 23.03Mt for 7.09Moz contained gold; and

  • Inferred Mineral Resources 39.88Mt for 8.06Moz contained gold.

  • a scoping study with a conceptual mine design and schedule has demonstrated the potential economic viability of the Jeanette project at gold prices that are less than those prevalent at August 2010;

  • a steady state production rate of 145,000tpm or over 380,000oz/annum Au has been modelled;

  • the current structural model for the Jeanette project area may be acceptable for an inception model. A more sophisticated 3D structural model will be constructed with additional drilling and/or 3D seismic survey interpretation at the PFS and BFS stages;

  • the Scoping Study that has been completed and detailed in this CPR is designed to be accurate within 30%;

  • a PFS should now be commissioned to refine the mine design, convert the Inferred Mineral Resources to compliant Mineral Reserves and develop a financial model based on these reserves;

  • the PFS will be accurate to within 20% and there is a low technical risk of failing to achieve the projected capital and operating cost within the expected timeframes;

  • a technical assessment of the rock mechanic aspects of mining the Basal Reef below the Khaki shale has shown that mining is feasible (Keen 2009). . A Technical Committee including independent industry specialists has been established to further review the mining strategy for the Basal Reef at Jeanette and to mitigate the risk associated with the mining thereof. The PFS will include the application of recommendations from the Technical Committee.

  • further upside potential exists to define additional Basal Reef Mineral Resources both within the Jeanette project area and adjacent to Jeanette. An agreement to purchase the prospecting rights to the adjacent resources on Buitendachshoop, Weltevreden and Le Clusa is being concluded;

  • the Big Pebble Conglomerate has not been systematically sampled, despite highly attractive mineral and facies associations on this horizon. The implications of this are that the true extent of gold and uranium mineralisation in this horizon may not be fully realised;

  • additional upside potential therefore exists in definition of Mineral Resources for the Big Pebble Conglomerate and B reef at Jeanette;

  • a drilling programme should be undertaken to convert the Inferred Mineral Resource at Jeanette to the Indicated Mineral Resource category;

  • an additional drilling programme should be undertaken to test potential Mineral Resources in the northern portion of Jeanette;

  • the proposed mine schedule comprises a ramp up of 3 years, followed by 15 years at steady state production, with a 3 year ramp down over the LoM. Remnant and pillar mining is an option that could be carried out over a further period of 10 years but may not prove optimal for maximising project value. Should no additional Mineral Reserves be defined it is likely that the production profile would be cut shortly after ramp down; and

  • an environmental scoping study should be initiated.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-101 –

74

6 GREENFIELDS PROJECTS

Taung, by virtue of holdings in the subsidiary companies illustrated in Figure 1, is the holder or has an interest in numerous greenfields gold projects in the Free State, North West, Gauteng, Limpopo and Mpumalanga provinces of South Africa. The location, extent, nature and right status of the greenfields gold assets are summarised in Table 40 and illustrated in Figure 2.

The early exploration stage of many of the greenfields assets means that available information is, often, limited, and consequently full compliant disclosure is not possible.

The Greenfields projects, whilst providing an important pipeline of future exploration projects for Taung, are however, insignificant in terms of value, compared to the two flagship projects. Consequently, reporting for the portfolio is restricted to brief summaries of the legal tenure, potential mineralisation and available information for the four most prospective projects, namely Hilton, South Rand, Bothaville Gap and Yzerspruit projects and a summary of the legal aspects for the remaining projects (Note 14).

The Hilton project is the most advanced of the greenfields projects.

Table 40 : Summary of Taung's Greenfields Assets

TYPE OF
RIGHT
New Order
Prospecting
Rights
PROVINCE PROJECT PROPERTY SIZE (ha) HELD BY
Gauteng South Rand Sugar Bush 13,685
TaungGold Exploration Ltd
Mpumalanga South Rand Balfour Region 1,812 Taung GoldExploration Ltd
Witpoort Region 3,150 TaungGold Exploration Ltd
Roodepoort Region 2,589 Taung Gold Exploration Ltd
and privatemembers
Hexrivier Region 6,100 Taung Gold Exploration Ltd
andprivate members
Drukfontein Region 9,385 Taung GoldExploration Ltd
Hartebeesfontein Region 1,354 TaungGold Exploration Ltd
Evander
(Watervalshoek)
Various ,
1
969
Taung Gold Exploration
(West) (Pty)Ltd(100% )
North West Malmani Various ,
2
1
252
Taung Gold (North West)
(Pty)Limited
Palmietfontein Palmietfontein ,
5
352
Taung Gold (North West)
(Pty)Limited
Yzerspruit Various 15,231 Taung Gold (North West)
(Pty) Ltd + 20% Private
Ownership
Free State Harrisburg Various ,
2
280
Taung Gold (Free State)
(Pty) Ltd + 20% Private
Ownership
Bothaville Gap Various ,
5
360
In process of being rolled up
into Taung Gold Ltd (from
Sephaku Gold Exploration)
Hilton Various 15,230 Taung Gold (Free State)
(Pty)Ltd(100% )
Richelieu/Plecy Various 652 Taung Gold (Free State)
(Pty) Ltd (100% )
TOTAL 96,401

Source: Taung 2011

6.1 Hilton Project

6.1.1 Property Description and Location

The Hilton project area is situated northeast of Welkom in the Free State Province of South Africa, directly adjacent to the flagship Jeanette project. The Hilton project lies with the Witwatersrand basin, approximately 2km east of Allanridge and comprises numerous properties, over which seven New Order Prospecting Rights are held by Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Limited (‘Taung Free State’). Exploration for all minerals excepting coal and diamonds is permitted under five of the Prospecting Rights. Two rights were granted for exploration of gold, silver, and uranium (Table 41, Figure 19 ).

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-102 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-103 –

76

Table 41 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Hilton

FARM PORTION SIZE PROSPECTING COMMENCE- EXPIRY MINERALS HELD BY
(ha) RIGHT MENT DATE DATE
Bruintjieslaagte 243 2059 FS30/5/1/2/369PR 29-Nov-06 28-Nov-11
Stillewoning283
Schaapplaats100 ,
Langverwacht 281, Pts RE, 1
Hilton30 1801 FS30/5/1/2/399PR 6-Feb-07 5-Feb-12
Melkkraal 450 ,
Hilton 449 5806 FS30/5/1/1/2/419PR 4-Jun-07 3-Jun-12
Emmanuel 433
Langkuil66 All minerals,
excluding
diamonds
and coal
Kameeldoorns 402 ,
Dreyers 445
Leeuwbosch 285,PtsRE5, 8 Taung Gold (Free
State) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Waterpan 263, Ptn RE
Damspruit 184,Ptn RE
Zooikraal 101,Ptn RE,1,2 2891 FS30/5/1/1/2/442PR 6-Jul-07 5-Jul-10*
Eerste Geluk 61, Pts RE, RE1,
2,3 & 4
,
Vrede 201,Farm
Grootkop 277, Pts RE, 8, 10 926 FS30/5/1/1/2/450PR 6-Jul-07 5-Jul-10*
Bandon 345, RE
Weltevreden 59, 3 & 6
Leeuwbosch 285, 3
Gold, Silver
and Uranium
Ore
1,315 FS30/5/1/1/2/713PR 3 Dec 09 2 Dec 14
Damplaats 361, RE & 1
Katbosch 358,RE & 1
Gold and
Uranium Ore
431 FS30/5/1/1/2/818PR 1 Mar 10 28 Feb 15
TOTAL 15,230
  • Application for renewal has been submitted to the DMR

6.1.2 Property Accessibility, Climate and Physiography

The Hilton project is directly west and adjacent to Jeanette and the property access, local mining infrastructure, climate and physiography are identical to those described for Jeanette in Sections 5.4.1, 5.4.2 and 5.4.3.

Two areas of Hilton, in the extreme north and south, have sufficient data to estimate potential mineralisation, termed a ‘deposit’ in the SAMREC Code, but no Mineral Resource estimate compliant with international reporting standards could be compiled for Hilton.

6.1.3 Geology, Historical Exploration and Potential

Hilton straddles the northward extension of the De Bron Horst (Figure 15) and is structurally complex. This complexity is a reflection of the regional tectonic history of the Welkom Goldfield. In the Hilton area, the structures resulting from these tectonic events are juxtaposed within a relatively small area, resulting in a more complex local structure than on Jeanette and on adjacent properties. The structure has been interpreted through historic seismic survey and drilling data, which are described in Section 5.10 and summarised in Figure 19.

Six distinct structural domains are recognised in the Hilton project area, as shown in Figure 20, which is a structural plan based on the Basal Reef which is described in detail in Section 5.7.3 for Jeanette.

Resource Estimation and Methodology for Hilton

According to TMC (2008a), the quality and confidence in the historic source information does not permit classification in a Mineral Resource category acceptable to international reporting codes.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-104 –

77

The historic information can only be regarded as indicative of potential mineralisation and would require additional verification to improve confidence limits. The potential mineralisation is therefore described as a ‘deposit’ in terms of the SAMREC Code Mineral Resource classification scheme.

A statement describing potential mineralisation at Hilton has been compiled by TMC (2008) which included the following factors and parameters:-

  • three Basal Reef facies reported by AAC have been combined;

  • for the estimation of the potential mineralisation a composite width of 100cm was applied to all intersections where the channel width was less than 100cm, or the actual channel width is greater than 100cm;

  • pay limit calculation and cut off grade;

  • a density of 2.75t/m[3] has been used to convert volume to tonnage;

  • estimation of total gold resources, expressed at zero g/t cut-off;

  • at a 4.65g/t cut-off grade, derived using Harmony’s 2007 operating cost data, only 11% of the tonnage inventory lies above the cut-off grade, thus eliminating any resource potential for the project;

  • at a 3.0g/t cut-off grade, which could be considered a more realistic estimate, bearing in mind the shallower mining depths of the target horizon in the Waterpan Block, approximately 32% of the total tonnage inventory lies above the cut-off grade, with an average grade above cutoff of 4.55g/t Au; and

  • despite the higher borehole density in Waterpan Block, gold value continuity has not been firmly established.

Table 42 : Mineral Deposit Estimate of a Portion of the Hilton Area

SURFACE
AREA
(m2)
6,007,444
1,632,842
6,159,942
BLOCK
DIP
(Deg)
23
23
26
DIP AREA
(m2)
6,526,249
1,773,855
6,853,563

TRUE WIDTH
(m)
1.3
1.3
1

GEOL.
LOSS (%)
25%
25%
25%
TONNES
GRADE
(g/t)
2.7
2.7
1.69
GOLD
(Moz)
1,520,000
410,000
770,000
(t)
Waterpan No 1
Waterpan No 2
Langkuil
17,507,146
4,758,497
14,135,475
TOTAL* 36,401,000 2.31 2,710,000

Source: The Mineral Corporation (2008)

Note: Zero cut-off grade.

No ranges have been provided as the statistics required to do this would be speculative. This could lead to an unrealistic presentation of technical quantities. *Computational inconsistencies due to rounding down

TMC derived tonnage estimates for the Basal Reef for the remainder of the blocks at Hilton and these indicative estimates are presented in Table 43:-

Table 43 : Indicated Tonnage Estimates for Structural Blocks at Hilton

BLOCK SURFACE AREA
(m2)
614,084
3,520,278
1,271,750
5,846,288
8,910,323
5,359,227
8,465,888
DIP
(Deg)
23
23
23
23
23
23
23
DIP
AREA
(m2)
667,117
3,624,291
1,381,579
6,351,176
9,679,822
5,822,052
8,871,097
TRUE
WIDTH
(m)
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
GEOL.
LOSS (%)
25%
25%
25%
25%
25%
25%
25%
TONNES
(t)
1,375,929
7,887,600
2,849,507
13,099,301
19,964,633
12,007,982
18,296,638
Grootkop pt1
Grootkop pt2
Grootkop pt3
Grootkop pt4
Dreyers
Leeuwbosch 1
Leeuwbosch 2
TOTAL 75,481,590

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-105 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-106 –

79

The Hilton project represents considerable upside potential for Taung and Venmyn recommends additional exploration to define Mineral Resources compliant with international reporting standards. Taung plans to outlay USD0.400m for exploration for the financial year ending February 2012.

6.2 South Rand Project

6.2.1 Property Description and Location

The South Rand project is located in the South Rand Basin of the Witwatersrand Basin, approximately 80km southeast of Johannesburg (Figure 2). The project is situated east of Balfour, in the Mpumalanga Province, of South Africa and directly south of Great Basin Gold’s Burnstone project (Figure 21).

The South Rand project comprises 38 Prospecting Rights which have been grouped into seven gold prospecting regions known as: Balfour, Witpoort, Roodepoort, Hexrivier, Drukfontein, Hartebeesfontein and Sugar Bush (Figure 21).

Table 44 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Balfour Region

SIZE
(ha)
PROSPECTING
RIGHT
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
EXPIRY
DATE
PROJECT FARM PORTION MINERALS HELD BY
Vlakfontein 558IR , Ptn RE5,
RE6, RE8, RE9, RE13, 14,
1176 MP30/5/1/1/2/701PR 4-Oct-06 3-Oct-11 All minerals,
South 19, 27 and Tweefontein
560IR,Ptn RE2
, excluding
diamonds
and coal
Taung
Gold
Exploration
Limited
(100%)
Rand - Vlakfontein 558IR, Ptn 30 15 MP30/5/1/1/2/1125PR 4-Oct-06 3-Oct-11
Balfour Vlakfontein558IR,Ptn 29 6 MP30/5/1/1/2/1126PR 4-Oct-06 3-Oct-11
Coal and
gold
Tweefontein 560IR, Ptn 12 387 MP 30/5/1/1/2/1725PR 10-Apr-08 9-Apr-13
Vlakfontein569IR,Ptn RE 227 MP30/5/1/1/2/1828PR 17-Jul-08 16-Jul-13 Gold
TOTAL 1,812

Table 45 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Witpoort Region

SIZE
(ha)
PROSPECTING
RIGHT
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
EXPIRY
DATE
PROJECT FARM PORTION MINERALS HELD BY
Zyferfontein 576IR,Ptn RE3 154 MP30/5/1/1/2/710PR 19-Oct-06 18-Oct-11 All minerals,
excluding
Taung
Gold
South
Strydfontein 609IR,Ptn RE4
Witpoort 565IR, Ptn 13, 14,
86
586
MP30/5/1/1/2/1045PR
MP30/5/1/1/2/671PR
4-Oct-06
4-Oct-06
3-Oct-11
New subm.
Rand -
Witpoort
15,27,28,29,30,31
Daspoort 564IR, Ptn 1, 2, 3,
4
Daspoort 564IR, Ptn 5
1,866 MP30/5/1/1/2/192PR 10-Apr-08 16 Feb 2009
9-Apr-13

diamonds
and coal
Exploration
Ltd (100%)
458 MP30/5/1/1/2/1776PR 17-Jul-08 16-Jul-13
TOTAL 3,150

Table 46 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of Roodepoort Region

SIZE
(ha)
PROSPECTING
RIGHT
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
PROJECT FARM PORTION EXPIRY DATE HELD BY
Goedgedacht 595IR, Ptn
RE, 3, 4, 5
Goedgedacht 595IR, Ptn
RE, 1
Roodepoort 598IR, Ptn 2,
3, RE4, 6, 10, 11, 30, 31
607 MP30/5/1/2/250PR 19-Oct-06 18-Oct-11 S Campbell (100% )
297 MP30/5/1/1/2/391PR 19-Oct-06 18-Oct-11 N Melman (100% )
South Rand
Roodepoort
Taung Gold Exploration
Limited (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration
Limited (100%)
1,684 MP30/5/1/1/2/928PR 4-Oct-06 3-Oct-11
Doornhoek 577IR, Ptn 36 1 MP30/5/1/1/2/977PR 4-Oct-06 3-Oct-11
TOTAL 2,589

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-107 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-108 –

81

6.2.2 Property Accessibility, Climate and Physiography

The South Rand project terrain is a gently undulating surface with a <5% gradient, sloping towards the southwest. Inconspicuous hills are sporadically present in some of the regions. Drainage occurs towards the southwest on most parts of the project region and a non-perennial meandering stream network is typical. The vegetation is characterised by typical Mpumalanga Province grassland veld type Gm8. No endangered plant species are currently recorded in the area.

Elevations range between 1,840m amsl on the isolated hilltops and 1,520m amsl in the agriculturally exploited valleys.

The area is typical of the Highveld climatic zone with medium precipitation during summer season, and high summer temperatures. The rainy season occurs in the summer months from October to April with the highest rainfall in December and January. Total precipitation varies greatly from year to year, with an average of 600mm.

6.2.3 Historical Exploration and Potential

Several operators, including AAC, undertook exploration in the South Rand Basin (Table 47).

Table 47 : Historical Exploration in the South Rand Region

DATE COMPANY **EXPLORATION ** AREA
1892 to 1942 Heidelberg Roodepoort Mine Produced 209,475t ore from which 37,851oz Au
recovered
Burnstone
1908 to1942 Kildare Mine Produced 5,301t orerecovered 670oz Au Burnstone
1974 to 1993 Union Corporation Limited Shallow decline holes and ruins of oldgold mines South Rand
Gencor South Rand
Anglovaal Limited Boreholes in unknown positions on farm
Vlakfontein
South Rand
1980 Southgold Limited Drilled in Burnstone area Burnstone
2002 Great Basin Gold 260 boreholes Burnstone

Historical production from the South Rand Basin totalled 267,969t of ore at mean grade of 5.31g/t Au.

6.2.4 Geology of the South Rand Basin

The South Rand project is located within the South Rand Goldfield, which is one of the eastern most extensions of the gold-bearing Witwatersrand Basin (Figure 2 and Figure 5). The regional geological controls in the Balfour, Witpoort and Roodepoort regions of the South Rand project are common to all properties. The mineralised reef horizon exploited in the project region is the Kimberley Reef, which occurs at the base of the Turffontein Subgroup. Interpretation of regional aeromagnetic data made it possible to delineate structural features and lithologies and attempt to predict the occurrence of Kimberley Reef beneath much younger Karoo lithologies and Ventersdorp lava, particularly in the southeastern part of the Balfour region (Figure 22).

Balfour Region

The Kimberley Reef is the principal economic reef in the Balfour region and can be traced for 2.5km along the southern section of portion 2 of the farm Tweefontein 560IR where it outcrops sporadically (Figure 23).

Both the Intermediate Reef and Kimberley Reef occur on the farm Tweefontein. Assay results indicate weak gold mineralisation associated with the conglomeratic zones. Generally, anomalous gold values were reported on the Intermediate Reef with sporadic instances of low gold values occurring on the Kimberley Reef, of which borehole TW04 at 5.64g/t Au over a 24cm channel width is the best result. A well-developed Kimberley Reef with good sulphide mineralisation was intersected in borehole TW03 at a depth of 94m at the eastern end of the property.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-109 –

82

Witpoort Region

The Kimberley reef occurs as a small pebble conglomerate overlying a shale footwall. Conglomerate lags and lenses occur in an orthoquartzite hangingwall and as scree on surface. The Kimberley Reef strike direction trends northwest to southeast and the dip is a gentle 15° to 20° degrees east. Eleven boreholes were drilled on the farm Witpoort 565IR, totalling 2,338m of core, which includes a number of deflections drilled for additional reef cuts. A Phase 1 exploration drill grid of 400m was planned and two lines of boreholes were completed (Figure 24). A well-developed Kimberley Reef erosional channel was intersected in two boreholes (WI01 and W104) with 6.52g/t gold over 93cm and 9.80g/t gold over a corrected width of 26cm respectively.

Roodepoort Region

The consistent intersection of the Booysens Shale marker horizon in all 10 boreholes (Figure 25) permits the classification of the overlying quartzites as Kimberley Formation. The conclusion from the drilling programme is that the Roodepoort 589IR (portion 11) is not located in an area conducive to exploring for well-developed channelised and mineralised Kimberley Reef.

The exploration programme conducted to date on the South Rand project, has not produced sufficient information at acceptable confidence levels to permit the calculation of a compliant Mineral Resource or a Mineral Reserve statement. Taung is convinced that a potentially economic resource exists, based on the active exploration northeast of the South Rand project where GBG identified 10.9Moz, at a mean grade of 6.9g/t Au in Indicated and Inferred categories, during 2007.

6.3 Bothaville Gap Project

6.3.1 Property Description and Location

The Bothaville project is located between the Klerksdorp and Free State Goldfields, near the town of Bothaville, in the Free State province. The project comprises a Prospecting Right which covers an area immediately south of Bothaville for 17km southwards (Figure 26).

The Bothaville project is centred on Longitude 26°35'50.55"E and Latitude 27°29'06.30"S and comprises numerous farm portions as indicated in Table 48. The project comprises a single Prospecting Right granted on 7 May 2008 for all minerals except diamonds and coal, together with an approved EMP (Table 48).

Table 48 : Legal Aspects and Tenure of the Bothaville Project

PROSPECTING
RIGHT
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
EXPIRY
DATE
PROJECT FARM PORTION MINERALS SIZE (ha) HELD BY
Gladdedrift 487,Pts RE,1 424
Johannes Hoop 884, Pts
RE,1
649
Gelykvlakte 153 , Pts RE ,
3
342
Klipkraal 54,Ptn RE 342
Middelplaats 348, Pts RE
,1
342 Sephaku
Gold
Exploration
(Pty) Ltd
(100%).
Section 11
transfer is
pending.
Bothaville Holvley246,Pts RE,1
Doornkraal 229, Pts RE,
FS30/5/1/1/2/475PR 7M08 6M13 Gold & 369
Gap
1,2
Doornkraal Zuid 45, Pts
RE,1,2
-ay- -ay- Uranium 342
342
Hartebeestbult 237, Pts
RE,1,2, 3
616
Nooitverwacht 248, Pts
RE,1,2
685
Den Haag 3, Pts RE, 1, 2,
3,
616
Schaapplaats 67,Ptn RE 292
TOTAL 5,360

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-110 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-111 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-112 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-113 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-114 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-115 –

88

6.3.2 Historical Exploration and Potential

To-date only scoping studies have been conducted on the project. No drilling has been conducted and exploration in the future will likely be initiated by geophysical surveys.

Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves have been defined by Anglovaal and Harmony for the Target Mine (Figure 26), Target North (inclusive of Sun North and Sun South projects) and Oribi Projects, which are in the vicinity and to the south of the Bothaville project. The Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves for these projects are summarised below:-

Table 49 : Mineral Resource Statements for Adjacent Properties

MINER AL RESOU RCE MI NERAL RES ERVE
GOLD
PROJECT CATEGORY TONNES GRADE GOLD TONNES GRADE
CATEGORY
('000t) (g/t) (Moz) ('000t) (g/t) (Moz)
Target Mine Measured
Indicated
Subtotal
Inferred
9.9
123,714
133,624
127,203
9.0
7.2
7.4
7.0
2.9
28.7
31.6
28.8
Proven
Probable
Total
7,388
11,892
19,281
7.9
6.4
7.0
1.9
2.4
4.3
Target North
Project
Indicated 108,300 7.3 25.3
Inferred 120,800 7.8 27.5
Oribi Project Inferred 52,000 6.5 10.9

Source: Snowden 2008

Published information and historical drilling results from projects to the north and south of the Bothaville project suggest that there is good potential for the preservation of mineralised conglomerates in the licence area.

The depths to the target horizons vary between 3,000m and >4,300m. The shallower Ventersdorp Contact Reef (‘VCR’ see Section 6.3.3) in the north of the project area represents the initial exploration target. The historical drilling results published by Anglovaal for exploration on the Oribi project, north of the Bothaville project provide sufficient encouragement and evidence of economic mineralisation, to warrant further investigation.

6.3.3 Geology and Mineralisation

The main economic targets of the Bothaville project are the VCR (Ventersdorp Contact Reef), Eldorado Reefs and Basal Reefs hosted in the Central Rand Group and possibly the Big Pebble Reefs. The mineralised VCR and Eldorado conglomerates are developed in narrow northsouth trending zones, close to the sub-outcrop of the Central Rand Group. Little is known about the Basal Reef in the area. Depths to the target horizons within the Bothaville project vary between 3,000m and >4,300m and depth will be a limiting factor on the successful development of a mining operation and as a result the shallower reefs in the north of the project area represents the initial exploration target.

6.4 Yzerspruit Project

6.4.1 Property Description and Location

The Yzerspruit project is located 20km southwest of the town of Orkney, and 40km southwest of the town of Klerksdorp. The project comprises two areas adjacent to each other and separated by the Vaal River, with the Yzerspruit area situated in the North West Province and the Harrisburg in the Free State Province (Figure 27).

These projects comprise numerous farms and portions, which are centred at longitude 26° 25’ 58’’ E and latitude 27° 07’ 02’’ S.

The Harrisburg project comprises a single Prospecting Right which was granted on 11 March 2009 and Yzerspruit comprises four rights. Each licence comprises a cluster of multiple farms and farm portions as in the tables below:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-116 –

89

Table 50 : Legal Aspects and Tenure - Harrisburg Area of the project

FARM PORTION SIZE (ha) PROSPECTING RIGHT COMMENC
E-MENT
DATE
EXPIRY
DATE
MINERALS HELD BY
Taung
Gold
(Free
State) (Pty)Ltd
Zomersbult 692, Farm 169
Ebenhaezer 289, Ptn
RE,1
242
Veepost 694 , Ptn RE, 1
Zondertuin 708Farm
211
403
Chris Bargmann has
a 10 % free-carried
interest in the project
until completion of a
Definitive
Feasibility
Study.
,
Erfdeel 558, Ptn RE,
RE1
171 FS 30/5/1/1/5/1/626PR 11-Mar-09 10-Mar-14 Gold
Goedewil 23,Farm 171
Boomtuin553,Ptn RE 171
Hart van Boomtuin 552,
Ptn RE,RE1,2,3,4
742
TOTAL 2,280

Table 51 : Legal Aspects and Tenure - Yzerspruit Area of the project

SIZE
(ha)
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
EXPIRY
DATE
PROSPECT FARM PORTION PROSPECTING RIGHT MINERALS HELD BY
Yzerspruit
(Klerksdrift)
Yzerspruit
Doornplaat 9 HP,
Farm
Taung Gold
(North West)
(Pty)Ltd
NW 30/5/1/1/3/2/2088PR Gold and
Klerksdrift 23 HP,
Pts RE,1
Chris
Bargmann
has a 10 %
free-carried
interest in the
project until
completion of
a Definitive
Feasibility
Study.
Klerksdrift 16 HP,
Pts RE1, 3, RE5, 9
4,285 15-Jul-09 14-Jul-14 Uranium
Doornplaat 14 HP
Pt5
Goedgenoeg 433 IP,
Ptn 23
778 NW30/5/1/1/3/2/2376PR 18-Mar-10 17-Mar-15 Gold and
Uranium
Taung Gold
(North West)
(Pty) Ltd
Taung Gold
(North West)
(Pty)Ltd

7,695

NW30/5/1/1/3/2/1/2047PR 15-Jul-09 14-Jul-14 Gold and
Wolvehuis 114 HP,
Pts RE1, RE20, 26,
27
Doornplaat 14 HP,
Pts 8,9,12
Yzerspruit 15 HP,
Chris
Bargmann
has a 10 %
free-carried
interest in the
project until
completion of
a Definitive
Feasibility
Study
Pts RE, RE1, RE2,
RE3, 4, 5, 6, RE7,
RE8, RE9, 10, 13,
15, RE17, 18, RE19,
20, 21, 22, 23, 25,
26,27


Uranium
Yzerspruit 113 HP,
Pts RE2, RE7, 9, 23,
24
.
Buffelsdoorn 389 IP
RE6
2473 NW30/5/1/1/3/2/1/2470PR 19-Oct 10 18-Oct-15 Gold and
Uranium
Taung Gold
(North West)
(Pty) Ltd
Welgegund 390 IP
RE2,4
Stilfontein 408 IP 25,
28
TOTAL 15,231

The projects are located in two local municipal areas, namely the Klerksdorp local municipality on the northern side of the Vaal River (Yzerspruit) and in the Nala Local municipality in the Lejweleputswa district Municipality on the south side of the Vaal River in the Free State Province (Harrisburg).

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-117 –

==> picture [431 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-118 –

91

6.4.2 Historical Exploration and Potential

The Witwatersrand Supergroup sediments were historically mined on at least 18 mines in the Klerksdorp-Orkney-Stilfontein-Hartbeesfontein (KOSH) region and some mines are still in operation. In excess of 4,800t of gold has been mined historically from the Klerksdorp Goldfield region. Taung has identified 29 boreholes drilled by previous exploration companies, which are considered sufficiently close to, or on Taung’s project area to provide relevant geological information.

6.4.3 Geology and Mineralisation

The Klerksdorp Goldfield is the most intricate of the Witwatersrand goldfields, with complex stratigraphic relationships. The West Rand and Central Rand Group sediments host the target reefs and occur at depths of 2,500m to 3,500m over the Harrisburg project area. The most favourable targets for gold mineralisation in the Central Rand Group is considered to be the VCR and the Elsburg Conglomerate reefs.

6.5 Other Greenfield Projects

Taung holds Prospecting Rights in respect of other greenfields projects in Mpumalanga, the North West, Limpopo, and Free State provinces of South Africa and the project locations, status of legal tenure and size of the rights are summarised in Note 14.

In most cases the rights were recently granted or acquired by Taung and the projects are in the review and planning stages and limited exploration activities have been undertaken to date. Taung is in the process of acquiring and collating historical geological, exploration, logistical and infrastructure information pertinent to these rights, but is not presently in a position to report on these parameters in this CPR. Consequently it is not possible to complete a full JORC/SAMREC compliant report for these assets.

Yours faithfully

==> picture [76 x 41] intentionally omitted <==

F. HARPER

B.Sc.Hons (Geol.) Pr Sci Nat ; MGSSA MINERAL INDUSTRY ADVISOR

==> picture [55 x 52] intentionally omitted <==

A.N.CLAY

M.Sc. (Geol.), M.Sc. (Min. Eng.), Dip. Bus. M. Pr Sci Nat, MSAIMM, FAusIMM, FGSSA, MAIMA, M.Inst.D, AAPG MANAGING DIRECTOR

Effective Date : 11[th] February 2011

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-119 –

92

7 REFERENCES

AUTHOR DATE TITLE SOURCE
Antrobus, E.S., 1986 Witwatersrand Gold-100 Years Geological Society of South Africa
Anglo American
Corporation
Unknown Area North and East of Jeanette Gold Mine Limited-
An Investigation into the Uranium Values in the
IntermediateReefs
Report No 173/120
Anhaeusser, C.R.
Maske,S.,
1986 The Mineral Deposits of Southern Africa Geological Society of South Africa
Behre Dolbear and
CompanyLtd,
2006 Feasibility Study for the Burnstone Gold Project GBG Technical Report
Bush, D.A., 1996 Evaluation of the Global Ore Reserves of the
Jeanette Mine Lease Area,AAPS
Int. Co. Memo
Clay, A. 2008 SAMREC Compliant Technical Statement as at 23rd
May2008Evander6 Shaft
Venmyn
Conradie, C 2008 South African Minerals Industry Department of Minerals and Energy
De Jager, J.A., 1992 Annual Report for the year ended March 31st1992 Anglo American Prospecting Services
(Pty)Limited. RepNo. 11/173/114
Dell, R.W., Winkler
K.S., and Dukas,
B.A.
1997 Geological Assessment and Evaluation of the
Jeanette Contiguous Block
Anglo American Prospecting Services
(Pty) Limited. Internal Report No.
11/173/120/car95/0699
Harmony 2007 Annual Report www.harmony.co.za
Harmony Gold
Mining Company
Limited
2002 Pre-Feasibility Study Evander 6 Shaft Project Internal Company Report. Harmony
Gold Mining Company Limited
Irons, C., Kennedy
J.F., Steenkamp
W.H.B.,Strydom,D.
1991 The De Bron Horst Report Anglo American Prospecting Services
(Pty) Limited. Internal Report No.
11/173/1081/KDP.91/1822
Johnson, M.R.,
Anhaeusser,CR.,
2006 The Geology of South Africa Geological Society of South Africa
Jordaan, M.J., 1986 Depositional Framework of the Kimberley Reefs in
the Welkom Goldfield.
In: Geocongress 1986, extended
abstracts, Geological Society South
Africa
Kapwijk, P., 2007 Goldfields Mineral Services (GFMS) presentation,
London
Gold Survey 2007
The Mineral
Corporation
2008a Technical Review of the Hilton Project Rep No. C-TAU-FSG-588-440
The Mineral
Corporation
2008b Preliminary Overview of Reef Potential in the
Kimberley Formation at the Jeanette Gold Mine
Project
Rep No. 2008-283
The Mineral
Corporation
2008c Basal Reef Evaluation and Technical Due Diligence
of the Jeanette Mine Project
The Mineral Corporation Rep no. C-
TAU-FSG-588-483
Knowles, A.G. 1978 Jeanette Gold Mines- A Geological Assessment of
theLeaseArea
Anglo American Corporation of South
AfricaInternal ReportNo173/520/103
Leeb du Toit, A., 1986 The Evander Goldfield In:
Antrobus,
E.S.A.
(Ed.),
Witwatersrand
Gold-100
Years.
GeologicalSociety ofSouth Africa
Lemmer, C., 2008 APM
Evander
Project
Resource
Upgrade
Requirements-AdditionalQuestions
Internal Company Report. African
Precious Minerals(Pty)Ltd
Maree, D., 2006 Mineral Reserve Statement for Operation No.6 Shaft Internal Company Report. Harmony
GoldMining CompanyLimited
McCarthy, T.S., 2006 The Witwatersrand Supergroup In: The Geology of South Africa.
Geological Societyof South Africa
Miall, A.D., 1981 Alluvial sedimentary basins: Tectonic setting and
basin architecture
In: Miall A.D. (Ed) Sedimentation and
Tectonics
in
alluvial
basins.
Geological association of Canada
specialpaper 23
Minter, W.E.L., Hill,
W.C.N.,Kidger, R.J.,
Kingsley C.S.,
Snowden P.A.,
1986 The Welkom Goldfield Mineral Resources of Southern Africa
Mitchell, G et al 2008 Competent Persons Report of the Resource
Estimate for the Evander Six Shaft Property,
Mpumalanga Province,Republic of South Africa
ExplorMine
Mogilnicki, M.A. and
Assibey-Bonsu, W.,
1994 A case study of the impact of support and
information effects of Resource/Reserve estimates
to be used for medium term mine planning in the
Witwatersrand type deposits
Proceedings of the conference on
mining geostatistics, 1994
Muntingh 1991 A sedimentological assessment of the Basal Reef on
the Jeanette Mine
AAC Internal Report No 173/520/102
Mwasinga, P.P. 1996 Winkelhaak Six Shaft project Report No.153. Internal Company
Report. Gencor Limited

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-120 –

93

AUTHOR DATE TITLE SOURCE
Northrop, W.D. 2003 A logical approach to the evaluation of a stacked
multi-reef Witwatersrand gold deposit. Application of
Computers and Operations Research in the Minerals
Industries
South African Institute of Mining and
Metallurgy
Pretorius, D.A. 1974 The nature of the Witwatersrand gold-uranium
deposits
Inform. Circ. Econ. Geol. Res. Unit,
University
of
Witwatersrand,
Johannesburg
Pretorius, D.A. 1974 The Nature of the Witwatersrand Gold-Uranium
Deposits
Inform. Circular.Econ. Geol.Res.Unit
Universityof Witwatersrand
Snowden V. 1996 Practical Interpretation of Resource Classification
Guide Lines
AusIMMM
Annual
Conference,
electronic Mediapp16
Snowden, V. 1996 Practical Interpretation of Resource Classification
guide Lines AusIMM Annual Conference
Electronic media
Steffen, Robertson
andKirsten
2005 Independent Competent Persons Report on Mining
Assets of Harmony GoldMining CompanyLimited
SRK Report
Steffen Robertson
and Kirsten,
2005 An Independent Competent Persons report on the
Mining Assets of Harmony Gold Mining Company
Limited
www.harmony.co.za
The Mineral
Corporation,
Kershaw D.J., Young
D.R.
2009 Mineral Resource Evaluation and Due Diligence
Review of the Kimberley Formation at Jeanette
Report Number C-TAU-FSG-588-502
Thomas, M.A.S. 1977 Area North and East of Jeanette Gold Mine Limited-
An Investigation into the Uranium Values in the
Intermediate Reefs
Anglo American Corporation of South
Africa Internal Report No 173/120
Tweedie, E.B.,
Anhaeusser, C.R.
and Maske,S., (Eds)
1986 The
Evander
Goldfield.
Mineral
Deposits
of
Southern Africa, Vol.1.
Geological Society of South Africa
Winter, H.de la R. 1986 Cratonic Foreland model for Witwatersrand Basin
development in a continental back-arc plate tectonic
setting
In: Geo-congress 1986, extended
abstracts, Geological Society of South
Africa
The Mineral
Corporation
2007 Preliminary Assessment of tonnage and grade in the
Basal Reefat Jeanette GoldMine
Rep No. 2007/207
The Mineral
Corporation
2008 Update on the Mineral Resource Potential of Taung
Gold Holdings' Jeanette Mine in the Free State
Province
Rep No. 2008-220

Reliance on Other Experts - Evander Project

PROJECT EXPERT COMPANY TYPE OF STUDY DATE EXTENT OF RELIANCE
Six Shaft Mitchell
G.
ExplorMine Competent
Persons
Report
('CPR')
of
the
Resource Estimate for the
Six
Shaft
Shaft,
Mpumalnga Province,SA
2008 Reliance on data verification
and
mineral
resource
estimate
Mitchell,
G. et al
ExplorMine CPR of the Resource
Estimate for the Evander
Six
Shaft
Area,
Mpumalnga Province,SA
2009 Reliance on data verification
and
mineral
resource
estimate
Lemmer
C.
Geological and Geostatistical
Services
Evander
Upgrade
Requirements: Additional
Questions Addressed
2008 Reliance
on
statistical
evaluation
Spindler,
T et all
Ukwazi Group Reserve and Pre-liminary
Assessment -Mine Design
Criteria
2009 Conversion
of
Mineral
Resources
to
Mineral
Reserves,Mine design
Twisdraai PosleyA. Stefan,Roberts and Kirsten HarmonyCPR 2007 Reliance on data verification
Mitchell,
G. et all
ExplorMine CPR of the Resource
Estimate
for
the
Twistdraai Area, Evander
Gold Mines, Mpumalnga
Province, SA
2009 Reliance on data verification
and
Mineral
Resource
estimation
Evander Ukwazi/Turnberry Scoping Study 2010 Reliance on conversion of
mineral resources to
reserves, mine plan and
scheduling

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-121 –

94

Reliance on Other Experts – Jeanette Project

PROJECT EXPERT COMPANY TYPE OF STUDY DATE EXTENT OF RELIANCE
Jeanette - The Mineral
Corporation
Evaluation of the Basal Reef and
Kimberley Formation reefs in terms
of tonnage and grade, updated
Mineral Resource
2008 & 2009 Reliance on Due Diligence
of the re-sampling
programme and mineral
resource estimate
Jeanette Lemmer C. Geological and
Geostatistical
Services
Jeanette project Resource Upgrade
Requirements
2008 Reliance on statistical
evaluation
Jeanette Campbell D. Sound Mining
Solutions (‘SMS’)
Jeanette Gold Mine project Scoping
Study
2009 Reliance on conversion of
mineral resources to
reserves, mine plan and
scheduling
Jeanette Keen, J.E. Consulting Rock
Engineering
A Technical Assessment of the
Feasibility of proposed Mining of the
Basal reef overlain byKhaki Shales
2008 Technical assessment of
potential to safely mine
below the shale
Hilton - The Mineral
Corporation
Technical review of historical data 2008 Reliance on due diligence
of original borehole data
and potential mineralisation
estimate
Jeanette
Hilton
Minxcon Scoping Study 0
1
0
2
Reliance on conversion of
mineral resources to
reserves, mine plan and
scheduling

Reliance on Other Experts – Greenfields Projects

PROJECT EXPERT COMPANY TYPE OF STUDY DATE EXTENT OF RELIANCE
South Rand Mitchell G. ExplorMine Report on Stratigraphic
Correlation of Boreholes
2007 Reliance on stratigraphic
confirmation
Bothaville Gap Bargmann, C. Snowden Geological Report on Sephaku’s
Gold Explorations Bothaville
GapProject
2008 Due Diligence of
Historical Data

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-122 –

95

Note 1 : Glossary and Abbreviation, Units of Measurement and Acronyms

Assay A chemical test performed on a sample of ores or minerals to determine the amount of
valuable metals contained.
Assay map Plan view of an area indicating assay values and locations of all samples taken on the
property.
Agglomerate Coarse pyroclastic deposit, or its lithified equivalent, containing a large proportion of
rounded volcanic bombs. Agglomerate is apyroclastic fall deposit formed close to the vent.
Arsenopyrite It is the principal ore of arsenic and a common mineral with lead and tin ores in ore veins,
and in pegmatites, probably having been deposited by action of both hydrothermal solutions
and vapours
Block Model Technique for modellingwhich divides the resources into mineable blocks.
Breccias Coarse grained clastic rock composed of broken, angular rock fragments enclosed in a fine-
grained matrix or held together by a mineral content. Fault breccias are composed of
fragments produced by rock fragments produced by rock fracturing during faulting and other
crustaldeformation.
Borehole A hole drilled from surface or underground, in which core of the rock is cut by diamond drill
bit as the cuttingedge.
Bulk sample A large sample of mineralised rock, frequently hundreds of tonnes, selected in such a
manner as to be representative of the potential orebody being sampled. Used to determine
metallurgical characteristics, Large sample which is processed through a small-scale plant,
not a laboratory.
By-product A secondarymetal or mineralproduct recovered in the milling process.
Cash costs See Operatingcash costs
Carbonates A mineral type containingthe carbonate radical(CO3)2-
Carbon-in-leach The recovery process in which Au is leached from Au ore pulp by cyanide and
simultaneously adsorbed onto activated carbon granules in the same vessel. The loaded
carbon is then separated from the pulp for subsequent Au removal by elution. The process
is typicallyemployed where there is a naturallyoccurringAu adsorbent in the ore.
Carbon-in-pulp A method of recovering Au and silver from pregnant cyanide solutions by adsorbing the
precious metals to granules of activated carbon, which are typically ground up coconut
shells.
Conglomerate Sedimentaryrock comprises ofpebbles in a finergrained matrix
Cross section A diagram or drawing that shows features transected by a vertical plane drawn at right
angles to the longer axis of ageologic feature.
Chalcopyrite A brassyorgolden-yellow tetragonal mineral CuFeS2,that is an important ore of copper.
Channel sample A sample composed of pieces of vein or mineral deposit that have been cut out of a small
trench or channel,usuallyabout 10 cm wide and 2 cm deep.
Density Measure of the relative “heaviness” of objects with a constant volume, density =
mass/volume
Deposit Any sort of earth material that has accumulated through the action of wind, water, ice or
other agents.
Development property A mineral property that is being prepared for mineral production and for which economic
viabilityhas beendemonstrated.
Development Underground work carried out for the purpose of opening up a mineral deposit. Includes
shaft sinking,crosscutting,driftingand raising.
Diamond drilling A drillingmethod,where the rock is cut with a diamond bit,to extract cores.
Dip The angle that a structural surface, i.e. a bedding or fault plane, makes with the horizontal
measuredperpendicular to the strike of the structure.
Dolerite/doleritic A medium grained igneous rock which is emplaced within the earth's crust in the form of
dykes and sills, andhas the samemineralogy as basalt.
Dyke Intrusive igneous rock verticallyor subverticallyemplaced.
Estimation Thequantitativejudgement of a variable.
Epigenetic Ore bodies formed by hydrothermal fluids and gases that were introduced into the host
rocksfromelsewhere,filling cavitiesinthehostrock.
Epithermal deposit A mineral deposit formed from hydrothermal solutions at a range of temperatures and
pressure. Epithermal deposits are formed within about 1km of the earth’s surface in the
range of 50 to 200oC. These deposits are typically found in volcanic rocks; the chief metals
aregold,silver and mercury.
Exploration Prospecting, sampling, mapping, diamond drilling and other work involved in the search for
mineralisation.
Exploration Property A Mineral Asset which is being actively explored for Mineral deposits or petroleum fields,
but for which economic viabilityhas not been demonstrated.
Facies An assemblage or association of mineral, rock, or fossil features reflecting the environment
and conditions oforiginoftherock.
Fault A fracture in earth materials, along which the opposite sides have been displaced parallel to
thenplane of the movement
Feasibility study A definitive engineering estimate of all costs, revenues, equipment requirements and
production levels likely to be achieved if a mine is developed. The study is used to define
the economic viabilityof aproject and to support the search forproject financing.
Grade The relative quantity or percentage of gold within the rock mass. Measured as grams per
tonnes in this report.
Hanging wall The overlyingunit of a stratigraphic horizon,fault ore bodyor stope

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-123 –

96

In situ In its originalplace,most often used to refer to the location of the mineral resources.
Imbrication A sedimentary structure in which gravel, pebbles or grains are stacked with their flat
surfaces dippingupstream.
Indicated Mineral Resource That part of a mineral resource for which tonnage, densities, shape, physical
characteristics, grade and average mineral content can be estimated with a reasonable
level of confidence. It is based on exploration sampling and testing information gathered
through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings
and drill holes. The locations are too widely or inappropriately spaced to confirm geological
and/or grade continuity but are spaced closely enough for continuity to be assumed and
sufficient minerals have been recovered to allow a confident estimate of average mineral
value.
Inferred Mineral Resource That part of a mineral resource for which tonnage, grade and average mineral content can
be estimated with a low level of confidence. It is inferred from geological evidence and
assumed but not verified by geological and/or grade continuity. It is based on information
gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits,
workings and drill holes that maybe limited or of uncertainqualityand reliability.
Kaolinite Phyllosilicate clay minerals formed by the alteration of alkali feldspars and other aluminium-
bearingminerals. Its largest deposits are beds of clayformed in lakes.
Lava Molten silicate material extruded bya volcano.
License, Permit, Lease or other
similar entitlement
Any form of license, permit, lease or other entitlement granted by the relevant Government
department in accordance with its mining legislation that confers on the holder certain rights
to explore for and/or extract minerals that might be contained in the land, or ownership title
that may prove ownershipof the minerals.
Life-of-Mine/LoM Expected duration of time that it will take to extract accessible material.
Liberation Release of Au from the host rock throughprocessing.
Lithologies The description of the characteristics of rocks, as seen in hand-specimens and outcrops on
the basis ofcolour, grainsize and composition.
Lithosphere The solid outer shell of the earth’s crust, including the crust and uppermost rigid layer of the
mantle. It is described as a strongor rigid zone above the asthenosphere,or weak zone.
Mining property A mineral asset which is inproduction.
Matrix Finegrained rock which supports larger clasts orpebbles.
Mine call Factor/MCF The ratio, expressed as a percentage, of the total quantity of recovered and unrecovered
mineralproduct afterprocessingwith the amount estimated in the ore based on sampling.
Mineable Thatportion of a resource for which extraction is technicallyand economicallyfeasible.
Mineral Asset(s) Any right to explore and / or mine which has been granted (“property”), or entity holding
such property or the securities of such an entity, including but not limited to all corporeal
and incorporeal property, mineral rights, mining titles, mining leases, intellectual property,
personal property (including plant equipment and infrastructure), mining and exploration
tenures and titles or any other right held or acquired in connection with the finding and
removing of minerals and petroleum located in, on or near the earth’s crust. Mineral Assets
can be classified as Dormant Properties, Exploration Properties, Development Properties,
MiningProperties or Defunct Properties.
Mineral Reserve The economically mineable material derived from a Measured and/or Indicated Mineral
Resource. It is inclusive of diluting materials and allows for losses that may occur when the
material is mined. Appropriate assessments, which may include feasibility studies, have
been carried out, including consideration of and modification by, realistically assumed
mining, metallurgical, economic, marketing, legal, environmental, social and governmental
factors. These assessments demonstrate at the time of reporting that extraction is
reasonably justified. Mineral Reserves are sub-divided in order of increasing confidence into
ProbableMineral Reserves andProvedMineral Reserve.
Mineral Resource A concentration of material of economic interest in or on Earth’s crust in such form, quality
and quantity that there are reasonable and realistic prospects for eventual economic
extraction. The location, quantity, grade, continuity and other geological characteristics of a
Mineral Resource are known, estimated from specific geological evidence and knowledge,
or interpreted from a well constrained and portrayed geological model. Mineral Resources
are subdivided, in order of increasing confidence in respect of geoscientific evidence, into
Inferred, Indicated and Measured categories.
A deposit is a concentration of material of possible economic interest in, on or near the
Earth’s crust. Portions of a deposit that do not have reasonable and realistic prospects for
eventual economic extraction must not be included in a Mineral resource.
Measured Mineral Resource That part of a mineral resource for which tonnage, densities, shape, physical
characteristics, grade and mineral content can be estimated with a high level of confidence.
It is based on detailed and reliable exploration, sampling and testing information gathered
through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings
and drill-holes. The locations are spaced closely enough to confirm geological and grade
continuity.
Mineralisation Thepresence of a target mineral in a mass of host rock.
Mining Property a Mineral Asset which is inproduction.
National instrument 43-101 Canadian National Instrument on the reporting of exploration, mineral resources and
mineral reserves for the TSX.
Opencast / Open pit Surface mining in which the ore is extracted from a pit. The geometry of the pit may vary
with the characteristics of the ore body.
Operating Cash Costs A measure of the average cost of producing an ounce of gold calculated by the total cash
workingcosts for aperiod/total Auproduced in thatperiod

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-124 –

97

Optimisation Creating the best mining scenario while taking into account the economic parameters of the
deposit.
Orebody A continuous well defined mass of material of sufficient ore content to make extraction
economicallyfeasible.
Overburden The alluvium and rock that must be removed in order to expose an ore deposit.
Placer An alluvial deposit of ore,usuallya mineral bearing gravel or sand.
Probable reserves Is the economically mineable material derived from a Measured and/or Indicated Mineral
Resource. It is estimated with a lower level of confidence than a Proved Reserve. It is
inclusive of diluting materials and allows for losses that may occur when the material is
mined. Appropriate assessments, which may include feasibility studies, have been carried
out, including consideration of, and modification by, realistically assumed mining,
metallurgical, economic, marketing, legal, environmental, social and governmental factors.
These assessments demonstrate at the time of reporting that extraction is reasonably
justified.
Project capital Capital expenditure which is associated with specificprojects of a non-routine nature.
Prospect A deposit with thepotential for economic extraction.
Pyrite Fool’s gold a common yellow sulphide mineral, FeS. Pyrite forms under a wide range of
pressure-temperature conditions,and so is found in many geological environments.
Pyrophyllite Ayellowish white, grey,orpale-greenphyllosilicate.
Quartzite A metamorphic rock consisting primarily of quartz grains, formed by the recrystallisation of
sandstone by thermal or regional metamorphism or a sandstone composed of quartz grains
cemented bysilica.
Recoveredgrade/Yield The actualgrade of ore realised after the miningand treatmentprocess.
Reef Mineralised lode.
Rehabilitation The process of restoring mined land to a condition approximating to a greater or lesser
degree its original state. Reclamation standards are determined by the Russia Federation
Department of Mineral and Energy Affairs and address ground and surface water, topsoil,
final slopegradients,waste handlingand re-vegetation issues.
Sample The removal of a small amount of rock pertaining to the deposit which is used to estimate
thegrade of the deposit and othergeologicalparameters.
Sampling Taking small pieces of rock at intervals along exposed mineralisation for assay (to
determine the mineral content).
Sedimentary Formed by the deposition of solid fragmental or chemical material that originates from
weathering of rocks andis transportedfroma source to a site ofdeposition.
Slimes dam A storage facilityfor all fine wasteproducts from theprocessing plant.
Specificgravity/S.G. Measure ofquantityof massper unit of volume,density.
Stockpile A store of unprocessed ore or marginalgrade material.
Stripping Removal of waste overburden coveringthe mineral deposit.
Stripping ratio Ratio of ore rock to waste rock.
Subduction The movement of one crustal plate (lithospheric plate) under another so that the
descending plateis“consumed.
Tailings The waste products of the processing circuit. These may still contain very small quantities of
the economic mineral.
Tailings dam Dams or dumps created from waste material from processed ore after the economically
recoverablemetalor mineral has beenextracted.
Tonnage Quantities where the tonne is an appropriate unit of measure. Typically used to measure
reserves of metal-bearing material in-situ or quantities of ore and waste material mined,
transported or milled.
Trenching Makingelongated open-air excavations for thepurposed of mappingand sampling.
Trust Fund A fund required by law to be set up, to which annual contributions are paid so that the
remainingenvironmental liabilityof the operation is covered.
Veins A tabular or sheet like body of one or more minerals deposited in openings of fissures,
joints or faults,frequentlywith associated replacement of the host rock.
Yield/Recoveredgrade The actualgrade of ore realised after the miningand treatmentprocess.
% Percentage
+ Plus
± Approximately
º Degrees
μ Microns
< Less than
> Greaterthan
/ Per
AAC Anglo American Corporation
AAPS AngloAmerican Prospecting Services
amsl Above mean sea level
APM African Precious Minerals
APPA Pollution Prevention Act
AusIMM Australian Institute of Miningand Metallurgy
ASG Advance Strike Gullies
ASX Australian Stock Exchange

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-125 –

98

Au ChemicalSymbol forgold
AUD Australian Dollar
AUMGT Aumg/t
BEE Black EconomicEmpowerment
BFS Bankable FeasibilityStudy
bmsl Below meansealevel
bn billion
BRI Black Reef Incline
B.Sc.(Geol) BachelorofScienceDegreeinGeology
B.Sc. Hons Bachelor of Science degree with Honours
CBGA Central Bank Gold Agreement
CGS Council forGeosciences
CIL Carbon in leachplant
CMC Consolidated MiningCorporation
CIP Carbon inpulp plant
cmg/t centimetregramsper tonne
CMR Consolidated Main Reef
CPR CompetentPersonsReport
DFS Definitive FeasibilityStudy
EGM Evander Gold Mines
EIA Environmental ImpactAssessment
EMP Environmental Management Plan
EMPR Environmental Management Programme Report
DMR Department of MineralsResources
DWA Department Water Affairs
EMP Environmental Management Programme
EPCM Engineering procurement construction management
FWGM First Wes Gold MiningCorporation
g/t gramsper tonne
GBG GreatBasinGold
GBP Great Britain Pounds
GDP Gross domesticproduct
ha hectares
HKeX HongKongStock Exchange
HDSA Historical disadvantaged South African
HFO HeavyFuelOil
HW Hangingwall
ICMI International Cyanide Management Institute
IT Information Technology
JORC Joint Ore Reserves Committee
JSE JSE Limited
km Kilometres
kt Kilo tonnes
LoM Life of Mine
m metres
mamsl Metres above mean sea level
msl Mean sea level
mbs Metres belowsurface
mbsl Metres below sea level
MCF Mine call factor
MW Megawatt ofpower
my millionyears
MPRDA Mineral and Petroleum Resources Development Act
MPRRA MineralandPetroleum ResourcesRoyaltyAct
MWP Mine Works Plan
NERSA National ElectricityRegulator South Africa
NWA National Water Act
QA/QC Qualityassurance/Qualitycontrol
OPEX OperatingExpenditure
pa perannum
PGM Platinumgroupmetal
PFS Pre FeasibilityStudy
PR ProspectingRight
RD Reef drive
RoM Run of Mine
SASC South AfricanStratigraphy Committee
SAG Semi Autogenous Grinding
SAGS South African Geological Survey

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-126 –

99

SAIMM South African Institute of Mining andMetallurgy
SAMREC South African Code for the Reporting of Exploration Results, Mineral
Resources and Mineral Reserves
SAMVAL South AfricanCodefortheReporting of Mineral AssetValuation
SG Specific Gravity
SLP Social and Labour Plan
SMU SmallestMining Unit
SQL StandardqueryLanguage
SRK Steffen Kirsten and Roberts Consulting
t tonnage
tph Ton/sper hour
tpm Ton/sper month
TMC TheMinerals Corporation
TSF Tailings storage facility
RC Reverse circulation
USD United States of AmericaDollar
VCR VentersdorpContact Reef
WOC Waste on contact
WNA WorldNuclear Association
WRCM West Rand Consolidated Mines Limited
WWML West Wits MiningLimited
ZAR South African Rand
2D Two dimensional
3D Three dimensional

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-127 –

100

Note 2 : Legal Aspects and Tenure Evander

The Evander transaction is governed by two distinct sets of agreements. There is a pre-existing “earn-in agreement” in place. Over and above this, an agreement has been entered into in terms of which Taung will purchase 100% of the projects from EGM. If, for whatever reason, the parties are unable to give effect to the Sale Agreement, the terms of the existing earn-in agreement will continue to apply, as described below.

Taung entered into an ‘earn-in agreement’ with EGM, a wholly owned subsidiary of Harmony, in respect of the Evander project properties on 29[th] February 2008. Agreements with EGM include a separate right of Access and Use, Sale of Assets, Subscription and Shareholder agreements and provide for the Mining Right to be transferred into subsidiaries of Harmony, with Taung enjoying the right to earn a majority interest in same by completing a Bankable Feasibility Study (‘BFS’) over the Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects.

Taung completed a Scoping Study over the project on 9[th] April 2010, which was a requirement in order to “earn-in” on the project. Taung is required to complete PFS by 9th April 2012 and a BFS by 9th April 2013. The Scoping Study was approved by various Taung and EGM committees, which recommended that the project should proceed to the PFS stage. Upon completion of the PFS, Taung will earn a 25% shareholding in the subsidiaries (and therefore the project) and upon completion of the BFS, an aggregate of 52% in the subsidiaries.

Historical Subscription and Shareholder Agreements

All of the conditions precedent in the Subscription Agreement have been fulfilled and the effective date of the Subscription Agreement is 9th April 2008. In terms of the agreements, Taung agreed to complete the following for both Twistdraai and Six Shaft:-

  • commission a Scoping Study by 9th April 2010, which has been completed;

  • on completion of a Scoping Study in its sole discretion, commission a PFS, and complete it within 4 years of the effective date, 9th April 2012; and

  • on completion of a PFS in its sole discretion, commission a BFS and complete it within 5 years of the effective date,by 9th April 2013.

In consideration for the assignment of all rights to the PFS and BFS by Taung to EGM, EGM will allot and issue shares in two tranches to Taung in new entities, which will be Harmony subsidiaries. These new entities will hold the Mining Right and ultimately EGM will hold 48% and Taung 52% of the shareholding in the new companies.

On completion of the PFS and BFS, and after the issue of the first and second tranches of shares, the shareholding in the new entities will be as indicated in the table below:-.

STAGE SHAREHOLDER SHARES PERCENTAGE
Completion of PFS and issue of first tranche of
shares byEGM
EGM 75 75
Taung 25 25
TOTAL 100 100
Completion of BFS and issue of the second
tranche ofshares
EGM 75 48.08
Taung 81 51.92
TOTAL 156 100

The agreements provide for:-

  • the formation of a Technical Committee which will oversee the Scoping Study, PFS and BFS; and

  • the formation of a Gatekeeper Committee to ensure compliance of the Scoping Study, PFS and BFS to Harmony’s internal Gatekeeper Committee Policy.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-128 –

101

In addition, the Gatekeeper Committee is to ensure that, on the completion of the PFS, the following criteria have been fulfilled:-

  • 3/5 of an agreed minimum exploration work for the PFS has been completed; and

  • 70% of the Mineral Resources during the pay-back period are in the Indicated Mineral Resource category.

At the completion of the BFS, the Gatekeeper Committee must also ensure that the study has complied with the following:-

  • the agreed minimum exploration work for the BFS has been completed; and

  • 100% of the Mineral Resources during the payback period are in the Indicated Mineral Resource category.

The agreed minimum exploration work plan may only be changed by the Technical Committee. If any of the studies are not completed by Taung, all rights in any such incomplete study will be assigned to EGM.

Right of Access and Use Agreement

EGM granted Taung the right of access to the relevant areas for exploration.

Joint Venture Agreement

On the completion of the BFS by Taung and depending on a joint decision to develop and operate a mine, a joint venture will be entered into whereby all costs and revenue will be split according to the parties’ respective participation interests.

The Mining Charter requires a 15% BEE stake holding by 30th April 2009, and an additional 11% by 2014. Both Taung and Harmony meet the Mining Charter requirement by virtue of the following :-

  • the 26% shareholding in Taung held by Sephaku ( a BEE company); and

  • the 2002 Harmony agreement entered into with African Rainbow Minerals (Pty) Ltd, (a BEE company).

As described above Taung entered into an earn-in agreement with EGM on 29th February 2008 with respect to the Six Shaft and Twistdraai projects. Subsequent to that, 10th September 2010, a Sale Agreement was concluded in terms of which a Taung subsidiary will purchase 100 % of the projects from EGM for a purchase price of USD28.125m. Ministerial permission for transfer of the projects into Taung’s name is required, but should the transfer not be approved for any reason, the existing earn-in agreement as described above will continue to apply.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-129 –

102

Note 3 : South African Mining and Environmental Law

MINERAL AND PETROLEUM RESOURCES DEVELOPMENT ACT (MPRDA)

The South African Government enacted the MPRDA on the 1st May 2004. It defines the State’s legislation on mineral rights and mineral transactions in South Africa. The Act emphasises that the government did not accept the existence of the historical dual State and private ownership of mineral rights in South Africa and, as such, the Act legislated that all mineral and petroleum resources in South Africa now vest in the State. Additional objectives of the Act include the promotion of economic growth, the development of resources to expand opportunities for the historically disadvantaged, and the socio-economic development of the areas in which mining and prospecting companies are operating. It also provides for security of tenure relating to prospecting, exploration, mining and production.

A further objective of the Act was to further BEE within South Africa’s minerals industry, by encouraging mineral exploration and mining companies to enter into equity partnerships with BEE companies. The Act also makes provision for the implementation of social responsibility procedures and programmes by mineral resource companies.

The Act incorporated a "use-it or lose-it" principle, that has been applied to companies or individuals who owned mineral rights or the rights to prospect and mine prior to 2004 (Old Order Rights). These Old Order Rights were required to be transferred within specified timeframes, under the provisions of the Act, into New Order Rights to prospect and mine. Once the State has granted the conversion of the Old Order Rights to New Order Rights, or has granted a New Order Right to new applications submitted after the implementation of the MPRDA, a Notarial Agreement between the State and the holder of the New Order Right is entered into. This Agreement sets out all the conditions associated with the New Order Right. New Order Rights can be suspended or cancelled by the Minister if, upon notice of a breach from the Minister of its obligations to comply with the MPRDA, or the conditions prescribed as part of its New Order Right, a breaching entity fails to rectify such a breach.

In addition, in terms of the MPRDA, mining and exploration companies have to comply with additional responsibilities relating to environmental management and to environmental damage, degradation or pollution, resulting from their prospecting or exploration activities. Types of rights and permits applicable to the mining industry in South Africa, as provided for in the MPRDA, are detailed below.

LICENCE TYPE PURPOSE DURATION REQUIREMENTS CONDITIONS
Reconnaissance
Permission
Prospecting Right
Retention Permit
Mining Right
Mining Permit
Exploration at the
reconnaissance stage.
Exploration at target-
definition stage.
Hold on to legal rights
between prospecting
and mining stages.
Development and
production stage.
Small-scale mining.
2 years
(non renewable)
Up to 5 years initially.
Renewable once for 3
years.
3 years initially.
Renewable once for 2
years.
30 years initially.
Renewable for further
periods of 30 years.
Effective for LoM.
2 years initially.
Renewable for 3
further periods of 1
year at a time.
Financial ability;
technical ability; and
work programme.
Financial ability;
technical ability;
economic programme;
work programme; and
environmental plan.
Prospecting stage complete;
feasibility study complete;
project not currently feasible;
and completed
Environmental Management
Plan (EMP).
Financial ability;
technical ability;
prospecting complete;
economic programme;
work programme;
social plan;
labour plan; and
completed EMP.
Life of project must be <2
years;
areas must be <1.5Ha; and
completed EMP.
Holder does not have the
exclusive right to apply for a
Prospecting Right.
Payment of Prospecting fees.
Holder has the exclusive right
to apply for a Mining Right
May not result in exclusion of
competition, unfair
competition or hoarding of
rights.
May not be transferred,
ceded, leased, sold,
mortgaged or encumbered in
any way.
Payment of royalties (from
2010).
Compliance with Mining
Charter and Codes of Good
Practice on broad-based BEE
(BBBEE.)
Payment of royalties (from
2010).
May not be leased or sold,
but can be mortgaged.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-130 –

103

Broad-based Socio-Economic Charter

Promulgation of the Broad-based Socio-Economic Charter for the South African Mining Industry (also known as the Mining Charter) marked the end of protracted debates and varying interpretations of the legislation’s requirements, paving the way for the full implementation of the MPRDA.

All mining and prospecting companies are required to comply with the provisions of the Mining Charter. The objectives of the Mining Charter are to:-

  • promote equitable access to the State’s mineral resources by all the people of South Africa. It required that every mining company achieved a 15% level of ownership of its mining assets by historically disadvantaged South Africans (HDSAs) by the 1st May 2009, and a level of 26% ownership by the 1st May 2014;

  • substantially and meaningfully expand opportunities for HDSAs, including women, to enter the mining and minerals industry and to benefit from the exploitation of the nation’s mineral resources. In terms of this requirement, 40% of management roles are to be held by HDSAs by 2010;

  • expand the skills base of HDSAs to serve the community;

  • promote employment and advance the social and economic welfare of mining communities, and the major areas from which labour is drawn to carry out exploration or mining; and

  • promote the beneficiation of South Africa’s mineral commodities, whereby the companies which have facilitated downstream, value-adding activities, for products they mine, could achieve an “offset” against the HDSA equity participation requirement.

Most mining companies are already implementing their own empowerment strategies. These strategies demonstrate their best endeavours to consider the issues and a willingness to accommodate the requirements when they are finally defined.

Compliance with the Mining Charter will be measured using a designated scorecard, which provides a practical framework against which the Minister can assess whether a company actually measures up to what was intended in the MPRDA and the Mining Charter.

Promotion of Beneficiation Bill

This is still being prepared, and is expected to provide incentives for upstream companies that facilitate downstream investments, in order to reduce the exporting of unprocessed mineral products and to promote local value addition.

MINERAL AND PETROLEUM RESOURCES ROYALTY ACT (MPRRA)

This piece of legislation incorporates the government’s intention to impose royalties on revenues derived from mineral production in South Africa. Enacted in 2008, the Minerals and Petroleum Resources Royalty Act (MPRRA) was initially set to be implemented in May 2009. However, in an effort to mitigate job losses in the mining sector, the government decided to postpone the implementation of the new mineral and mining royalty regime until March 2010. The main purpose of the Act was to provide legislation for the collection of royalties from mines, developed and operated in terms of the New Order Mineral Rights, granted through the MPRDA process.

There are a number of problems with the administration of the Act, in that it needs to be linked to existing tax legislation, which clearly defines mining and industrial tax rates based on a profitability formula. The intention is not to facilitate double taxation on an already burdened industry.

The Act distinguishes between refined and unrefined mineral resources, where refined minerals have been refined beyond a condition specified by the Act, and unrefined minerals have undergone limited beneficiation as specified by the Act.

The royalty is determined by multiplying the gross sales value of the extractor, in respect of that mineral resource, in a specified year, by the percentage determined by the royalty formula.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-131 –

104

Both direct operating expenditure (Opex) and capital expenditure (Capex) incurred is deductable for the determination of earnings before interest and tax (EBIT). The quantum of the revenue royalty on all minerals is dependent on the profitability of the company based on the following formula. For Refined Mineral Resources the formula is:-

Royalty Rate = 0.5 + EBIT X 100 Gross Sales (refined) x 12.5 Royalty Rate = 0.5 + EBIT X 100 Gross Sales (unrefined) x 9

The maximum percentage for Refined Mineral Resources is 5%.

For Unrefined Mineral Resources the formula is:-

The maximum percentage for Unrefined Mineral Resources is 7%.

The EBIT in the above formula shall be zero before the cumulative cashflow of the projects becomes positive. Capex incurred is deductable for the determination of EBIT, as stated above.

TAXATION

In addition to the Royalty payment detailed above, the Evander and Jeanette projects will be subject to corporate taxation. The corporate tax rate applicable to the Evander and Jeanette projects is based on a formula as discussed below and will apply when the cumulative cash flow of the projects becomes positive.

Gold mining companies are taxed according to a formula, as shown in the table below, and such companies may elect whether to pay Secondary Tax on Companies (STC) separately. For companies that elect to pay STC separately, STC is only payable if dividends are declared. If no dividends are declared, no STC is payable.

COMPANIES ELECTING TO PAY STC
SEPARATELY
COMPANIES ELECTING TO NOT PAY
STC SEPARATELY
Y=34-(170/X) Y=43-(215/X)
Y=% tax rate
X=ratio expressed as a percentage which the taxable income from gold
miningbears to the total turnover fromgold mining

GENERAL ENVIRONMENTAL PERMITTING AND STANDARDS

Key environmental legislation, applicable in South Africa, is as follows:-

  • National Environmental Management Act (107 of 1998) (‘NEMA’) as regulated by the Department of Environmental Affairs and Tourism (‘DEAT’) and relevant Provincial Departments of Environment;

  • MPRDA as regulated by the DMR. The MPRDA replaces the Minerals Act, 1991 and makes provision for equitable access to, and sustainable development of, South Africa’s mineral and petroleum resources.

  • Regulations under the MPRDA set out the procedures for undertaking EIA’s;

  • The MPRDA also requires a Social and Labour Plan (‘SLP’), a mine works plan (‘MWP’), proof of technical and financial competence as well as an approved Environmental Management Plan (‘EMP’); and

  • Mine Health and Safety Act (Act 29 of 1996) as regulated by the DMR. This Act deals with the protection of the health and safety of persons in the mining industry but also has implications for environmental issues related to environmental health monitoring within mines.

Additional relevant legislation includes the following:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-132 –

105

  • National Water Act (36 of 1998) (‘NWA’) as regulated by the Department of Water Affairs (‘DWA’);

  • Atmospheric Pollution Prevention Act (45 of 1965) (‘APPA’) as regulated by DEAT;

  • Environment Conservation Act (73 of 1989) (‘ECA’) as regulated by the DEAT, DWAE and relevant Provincial Departments;

  • National Heritage Resources Act (25 of 1999) as regulated by South African Heritage Resource Agency (‘SAHRA‘) or relevant Provincial Departments where established;

  • Hazardous Substances Act (15 of 1973) as regulated by the Department of Health;

  • Forest Act (84 of 1998), Provincial Nature Conservation Acts and other Ordinances as regulated by Provincial conservation authorities; and

  • National Nuclear Regulatory Act of 1999 as regulated by the National Nuclear Regulator (‘NNR‘). This legislation has been replaced by the Certificate of Registration (‘COR’) system.

Environmental Legislation with Respect to Evander

Environmental liability provisioning in the South African mining industry is a requirement of the MPRDA and must be agreed with the relevant regulatory authorities (mainly the DMR and the DWAE). For existing mines such as the Evander operations, funds are accrued based on the estimated environmental rehabilitation costs, should the mine have to close and over the operating LoM. Contributions are made to an environmental trust fund, which are approved by the South African Revenue Service.

The EMPR includes a detailed ‘Environmental Closure Assessment’ detailing all areas of environmental liability. It is understood that Evander Gold Mines Limited and therefore any Joint Venture or company resulting from such agreement, will ensure that the Rehabilitation Trust Fund is funded to cover the total environmental liability on closure of operations.

The mining infrastructure in the immediate area surrounding the Evander Gold Mines Shafts, including Evander Six Shaft, is well established. Impacts due to new infrastructure planned will be assessed in detail at the PFS and BFS stage.

Safety, Health, Environment and Community Aspects

Safety, Health, Environment and Community (‘SHEC’) aspects of the Evander project have not been evaluated or reviewed at the level of study to date, apart from the conclusion in the Scoping Study which predicts that the project will have the same safety and health concerns as the remainder of the mining industry in South Africa.

The safety, community and health issues, yet to be formally identified for Evander, will be in accordance with the legal framework controlled by the DMR and the mine will adhere to all legal requirements stipulated in the appropriate Acts and Regulations as promulgated from time to time. The mine will be compelled to comply with the EMPR developed and approved for the project.

The Social and Labour Plan (‘SLP’) will be developed for approval by the DMR and the mine will be compelled to comply with the outcomes detailed in the SLP during the operation. There are no significant relocation issues associated with the Six Shaft Project area.

Taung is unaware of any negative environmental factors relating to the Evander properties Seismicity is not a threat to the project. The Evander project does not have a history of seismic events because it is located in the middle of the Kaapvaal Craton. Seismicity is limited to localised events associated with mining operations and has been evaluated as part of the geo-technical study.

Other Environmental Legal Requirements

The Evander Project is a brown field’s site located near a number of similar mining sites in a heavily industrialised region with a strong gold and coal mining culture. A detailed environmental update study

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-133 –

106

will be required prior to development of the project site. The objectives of the environmental study will be to:-

  • identify the issues associated with the Evander Project, which are most likely to affect the biophysical and socio-economic aspects of the surrounding environment;

  • conduct a review of the applicable environmental legislation; and

  • determine and document the aspects of the project, which will require further detailed investigation.

In order to meet the objectives the following activities will need to be undertaken:-

  • site visits;

  • review of existing information;

  • review of the applicable legislation;

  • compilation of a Scoping Report according to the requirements of the MPRDA;

  • brief description of the environmental setting;

  • envisaged impacts on the environmental aspects of concern;

  • nature and extent of proposed specialist investigations; and

  • outline of the environmental processes and authorisations applicable to the Evander Project.

The environmental impact of the Evander project, both positive and negative, are to be addressed in the EMPR and the specific requirements to prevent unnecessary environmental degradation are to be included in these documents. The process is to be conducted in an open and transparent manner to ensure that all aspects and issues of concern are taken into account.

No public participation meetings with the Interested and Affected Parties (‘IAP’) have been held at this stage of the project but will form an integral part of the PFS and BFS stages.

Ground Water Removal

The removal of ground water as the dewatering of the lower workings of the mine unlikely to result in the lowering of the water table in the immediate vicinity of the mine as the neighbouring EGM are currently dewatering.

The neighbouring operations of Evander No 2 shaft and Evander No 5 shaft are to be closed down within the near future. The impact of the cessation of pumping from these shafts is to be investigated during the next phase of the Six Shaft project. No impact has been factored into the current financial model.

Rehabilitation Fund

The potential funding of the requirements for the Mine’s Rehabilitation Fund has not been taken into account as a separate cost element within the current working cost model but is included in the administration and overheads provision of USD10.5/t milled. The rehabilitation fund may also be assisted with financing from the sale of assets at the end of the LoM and any gold recovered from plant clean up.

Current Environmental Concerns

There are no current environmental concerns on the property apart from water disposal to Leeupan. The impact of the additional water on the pan remains to be investigated.

No significant agricultural activities are practiced on the property.

Cyanide Management

The International Cyanide Management Institute (‘ICMI’) guidelines for cyanide management require that cyanide be destroyed prior to disposal to storage facilities. The Weak Acid Dissociable (‘WAD’) cyanide content of water to be discharged is to be less than 0.5ppm, which can be achieved by the

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-134 –

107

use of improved technology cyanide destruction techniques. This technology will be included in the processing plant and tailings storage facility (‘TSF’) design at Six Shaft.

Waste Rock Dump

A waste rock dump facility will be required with a capacity of 11.4Mt waste rock on a footprint of 30ha to 50ha, at a height of 30m. Such an area has previously been used at No 6 Shaft and this facility will be reinstated A smaller facility could be feasible if an agreement can be successfully arranged with a local producer of aggregate.

Infrastructure

The disturbed surface area available will be adequate for the infrastructure required for the mine operation, the gold plant and the tailings dam.

Environmental Legislation with Respect to Jeanette

Regulatory Framework, Safety. Health, Environment and Community Aspects

The information pertaining to SHEC aspects are the same for the Jeanette project as those discussed above for the Evander project.

Other Environmental Legal Requirements

A detailed environmental update study will be required prior to work commencing on the project site. The objectives of the environmental study will be to:-

  • identify the issues associated with the Jeanette Project, which are most likely to affect the biophysical and socio-economic aspects of the surrounding environment;

  • conduct a review of the applicable environmental legislation; and

  • determine and document the aspects of the project, which will require further detailed investigation.

In order to meet the objectives the following activities will need to be undertaken:-

  • site visits;

  • review of existing information;

  • review of the applicable legislation;

  • compilation of a Scoping Report according to the requirements of the Minerals and Petroleum Resources Development Act;

  • compile a brief description of the environmental setting;

  • document the envisaged impacts on the environmental aspects of concern;

  • document the nature and extent of proposed specialist investigations; and

  • create an outline of the environmental processes and authorisations applicable to the Jeanette Project.

The environmental consequences of the proposed project, both positive and negative, are to be addressed in the EIA/EMPR. The specific requirements, which must be implemented, to prevent unnecessary environmental degradation, whilst promoting economical and social upliftment are to be included in these documents. The process is to be conducted in an open and transparent manner to ensure that all aspects and issues of concern are taken into account.

No public participation meetings with the Interested and Affected Parties (IAP) have been held at this stage but will commence with the initiation of a Feasibility Study,whilst the engineering design is progressing and before activities have commenced on site.

In addition to compliance with host country laws the SEIA should, if international funding is contemplated, be in compliance with the:-

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-135 –

108

  • International Finance Corporations (IFC) Performance Standards on Environmental and Social Sustainability (30 April, 2006);

  • the IFCs Mining-Specific Environmental, Health and Safety (EHS) Guidelines which include the environmental guidelines contained in Part III of the World Bank’s Pollution Prevention and Abatement Handbook (PPAH, 1 July 1998); and

a series of environmental, health and safety guidelines published on the IFC website.

The construction permit is contained within the execution of a Mining Right for the project. Once the Right has been executed, construction may start. Application for a mining right is typically started once the PFS has been completed and the financial viability of the project has been established. A mining right is usually granted within a year of application, execution of the granting may require a few extra months.

Environmental and Community Issues

Applicants for a mining right in South Africa are required to conduct an EIA and submit an EMPR, whilst applicants for a PR, mining permit or reconnaissance permit have to submit an EMP. Prospecting and mining rights only become effective under the MPRDA on the date that the corresponding EMP has been approved. The Jeanette EMP was approved by the DMR on 24th April 2008 and a revised EMP was submitted to the DMR on 16th February 2010. There are no existing negative environmental issues relating to the Jeanette properties to the knowledge of Taung.

Mining Right applicants also have to submit a Social and Labour Plan (‘SLP’) for the LoM which includes details such as the expected labour utilisation, training protocols, and re-skilling programmes.

Requirements for financial provision for the remediation of environmental damage, as well as for the issuing of a closure certificate, are included in the MPRDA and include the requirement that financial provision must be in place before approval of the EMP. An application for a closure certificate now becomes compulsory upon lapsing of the right or cessation of activities.

The surface rights at Jeanette are held by numerous parties and Taung and associated companies do not hold any surface rights in this area. Taung will be the custodian responsible for all aspects of the EMP and for all specifics as set out in the EMP for the properties that form part of the Jeanette prospects.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-136 –

109

Note 4 : Global Gold Market

Gold is produced in numerous countries, and for most of the past century until 2006, South Africa was the world's largest gold producer. In March 2010 the South African Chamber of Mines released new statistics that indicate South Africa’s ranking as a global gold producer is now behind China, Australia Russia and the United States.

Major reasons cited for the decrease in South African production are declining grades, as well as several mines reaching the end of their lives, combined with high production costs. Both China and Australia operate shallower mines, resulting in significantly cheaper production costs.

The gold price has steadily increased over the past 10 years and when the world markets experienced a recession, with consequent decline in commodity prices, the price for gold remained relatively steady. The average price for gold in 2009 was USD972/oz and the average for the first quarter of 2010 was USD1109/oz (World Gold Council 2010). Investment demand for gold bars and coins almost doubled in 2011 to 366t and was driven by dips in prices in January 2011, high global inflation, concern over some European countries credit worthiness and political unrest in northern Africa and Middle East.

Global Reserves and Production

The United States Geological Survey (USGS) estimates global gold reserves and global gold production as summarised below:-

Estimated Global Gold Reserves - 2011

COUNTRY RESERVES(t)
Australia 7,300
South Africa 6,000
Russia 5,000
Chile 3,400
United States 3,000
Indonesia 3,000
Brazil 2,400
Peru 2,000
China 1,900
Uzbekistan 1,700
Ghana 1,400
Mexico 1,400
Papua New Guinea 1,200
Canada 990
Other countries 10,000
WORLD TOTAL 51,000

Source : USGS (2011)

Estimated Global Gold Production 2009 - 2010

COUNTRY 2009(t Au) 2010(t Au)
China 320 345
Australia 222 255
United States 223 230
Russia 191 190
South Africa 198 190
Peru 182 170
Indonesia 130 120
Ghana 86 100
Canada 97 90
Uzbekistan 90 90
Brazil 60 65
Mexico 51 60
PapuaNewGuinea 66 60
Chile 41 40
Other countries 490 500
WORLD TOTAL 2,450 2,500
Source: USGS (2011)

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-137 –

110

Global Supply and Demand

Supply and demand figures for gold in the period 2006 to 2010 are summarised below (World Gold Council and USGS).

Global Gold Supply and Demand

2006(t) 2007(t) 2008(t) 2009(t) 2010(t)
SUPPLY
Mine production 2,483 2,473 2,409 2,572 2,659
Official sector sales 365 484 232 41
Oldgold scrap 1,133 982 1,316 1,674 1,653
TOTAL SUPPLY 3,981 3,939 3,957 4,287 4,312
DEMAND
Jewellery 2,298 2,417 2,193 1,759 2,060
Technology (Industrial & dental) 650 672 696 658 420
Total Fabrication including Jewellery 2,948 3,089 2,889 2,417 2,479
Bar Hoarding 235 236 386 187 713
Producer de-hedging 434 444 352 254 116
ImpliednetInvestment 365 169 330 1,429 916
Officialsectorpurchases 87
TOTAL DEMAND* 3,981 3,939 3,957 4,287 4,312

Source: World Gold Council (WGC), United States Geological Survey (USGS), GFMS Ltd

*Computational discrepancies due to idendpendent rounding

Primary production from mines still dominates world supply, while other sources include sector sales and old scrap (recycling). Total supply for 2010 amounted to 4,3t and reflects large increases in scarp supply amounting to 40% of the total gold supply. The increase was due to investor fears during the economic crisis and the conversion of jewellery to cash.

Mine production fell between 2004 and 2008 but has returned to 2001 levels at 2,659t for 2010.

The 2010 demand increase is attributable to the investment demand for gold bars and coins and an improvement in the jewellery trade.

Gold Price

The gold spot price trend for gold in the period 1993-2010, is shown in Figure 28. The gold price has been experiencing a steady increase since 2001, with the average price increasing from USD271/oz in 2001 to USD1,200/oz at the end of 2010. The global financial crisis marked a strong upward trend starting in September 2008. In September 2009, gold reached the USD1,000/oz threshold, the primary driver of which was the devaluation of the USD, market concern over the effectiveness of the various financial stimulus packages and fears of inflation increases. The average annualised gold price volatility for the beginning of 2011 was lower than the historical average observed over the past twenty years (WGC 2011).

Market Outlook

The outlook for gold will be driven by the uncertainties with respect to the global economy. The concerns over the US and various European economies, political unrest in northern Africa and Asia, and rising interest rates in China and India are driving the current strong investment demand.

A growing demand for jewellery in China and India, an increase in European and US investment in gold due to continued economic instability and the threat of another recession, indicates that the demand for gold will continue to be strong. WGC is of the opinion that central banks, especially in emerging markets will continue with gold purchasing programmes. Mine supply will continue to increase in response to demand and the dramatic reduction in global producer hedging.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-138 –

==> picture [432 x 652] intentionally omitted <==

– IV-139 –

112

Note 5 : Sampling Protocols for Evander

Historical Sampling Methodology

Historical face sampling procedures utilised by Harmony and Gencor are summarised as follows:

  • all underground channel sampling was conducted with a hammer and chisel by trained sampling crew;

  • stope faces were sampled at measured intervals after 6m face advance and on a 5m interval along the face. Reef development was sampled at a 3m interval;

  • the minimum sample volume required for assay was 15cm wide, 4cm high and 2cm deep;

  • the sampling procedure records incomplete reef exposure due to mining as either reef in hang (‘RIH’) or reef in foot (‘RIF’). Geological structures (faults) were also recorded;

  • channels are marked at 5m intervals along the stope face. An additional 2cm of material was included in the sample length above and below reef contacts. Corrections for dip were made;

  • care was taken to avoid contamination of and between individual samples;

  • stoping width measurements were made 1m back from the face; and

  • all channels’ sampling positions were determined with the aid of co-ordinated underground survey stations.

Historical Laboratory Procedures

Prior to 1998 EGM utilised an in-house assay laboratory situated at Leslie Gold Mine (Evander No 9 Shaft). Harmony, on acquiring the Evander Mines, outsourced all mine assaying, including underground chip samples, plant samples and geological samples to Performance Laboratories, Randfontein South Africa.

Performance Laboratories is a South African National Accreditation Service (‘SANAS’) accredited laboratory (facility accreditation number T0265) and is accredited for gold by fire assay with gravimetric finish. Venmyn and ExplorMine have not conducted an audit on Performance Laboratories or any previous historical assay installations.

The QA/QC measures reflect common practice in the exploration industry from the mid-fifties to the early 1990s and Gencor placed considerable emphasis on quality control of assay data from its inhouse laboratory. Whilst the use of field standards and blanks was not normal practice during this period, 1 in every 10 samples submitted to the laboratories was a duplicate. Performance laboratories included internal standards and Certified Reference Materials (‘CRM’) in every batch of analyses, and conducted check analyses on a regular basis with four accredited laboratories. ExplorMine (2008) is assured that the laboratory produced good quality data.

Underground chip and borehole core samples were crushed to 40mm in a primary jaw crusher, and a subsequent secondary crusher that reduced the particle size to less than 3mm.The samples were pulverized, using a vertical spindle pulveriser, to the minimum specification that at least 70% must pass through a –75 micron sieve.

All the Samples were assayed for gold by fire assay technique with gravimetric finish. The sample aliquot for analysis is 25g. A premix flux of sodium carbonate was used, and the sample was reduced in a hearth reduction furnace at 1100°C. The detection limit is 0.04g/t Au (Performance Laboratories – Determination of Gold by Fire Assay and Gravimetric Finish: Method M001).

ExplorMine (2009) is confident the sample preparation and analytical procedures were reliable and conform to industry norms of the time.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-140 –

113

Note 6 : Production Schedule for Evander

Fast-tracking the Production start-up date

There exists an opportunity, within the first phase of the project implementation, to fast-track the production start-up date of January 2016 by a number of years if the dewatering and re-equipping of the existing No 6 Shaft infrastructure is started sooner.

Two possible scenarios exist in this regard;-

  • Scenario 1 – the dewatering commences immediately upon the successful completion of the PFS, this scenario will result in the production start-up date moving forward by two years to 2014; and

  • Scenario 2 – the dewatering commences immediately, that is before the successful completion of the PFS; this scenario will result in the production start-up date moving forward by four years to 2012.

The estimated capital expenditure to bring the mine into production, (excluding the consultants costs and surface drilling), was estimated by Turnberry to be in the order of USD137,000.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-141 –

>2018































































































2017 H2
















H1
















2016 H2
















H1
















2015 H2
















H1
















2014 H2
















H1
















2013 H2
















H1
















2012 H2
















H1
















2011 H2
















H1
















PROJECT ACTIVITY
Conduct Pre-Feasibility Study
Evaluate Pre-Feasibility Study
Conduct Definitive Feasibility Study
Review BFS
Project Financing
PROJECT ACTIVITIES ON SITE Appoint Sinking Contractor
Purchase Surface Winders
Install Temporary Winders
Prepare to dewater the mine
Dewater the mine
Introduce safety measures to initiate
sinking
MINE PRODUCTION No 6 Shaft Upper
Twistdraai Upper
Deepening existing Ventilation Shaft
Sinking No 6 Sub-Vertical Shafts
Sinking Twistdraai Decline Shafts*

– IV-142 –

==> picture [352 x 589] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

HIGH
RISK CATEGORY
Delayed project start date beyond January 2014 due to problems with electricity supply or possible delays with the DMR.
MEDIUM
RISK CATEGORY
Variability of gold mineralisation - geostatistically shown not high risk. Demonstrable scope for upgrading Inferred Mineral Resources. Inferred Resources good confidence just require additional data points. Planned for exploration 2011. Meeting the 90% MCF for the ramp-up. Turnberry tonnage profile estimated during mine scheduling indicates this attainable. Hang stability in stopes on the 'Flats' controlled with good mining practice; new technology and Rock Engineering .
LOW
RISK CATEGORY
February 2008.
th
Sufficient Indicated Mineral Resources. Confident classification as Indicated Mineral Resource and some Measured Mineral Resources Independent specialist reviews confirm data acceptable for Mineral Resource estimation. Independently prepared and validated by ExplorMine consultants. Detailed lithological and mineralisation domains have been defined. Independent Scoping Study - a detailed mine design, produced a production schedule and have delineated a Probable Reserve. A Probable Reserve has been estimated for the Shaft Block area by Ukwazi and Turnberry. Mining dilution and mining recovery factors used in the Mineral Reserve estimate are acceptable. Shrinkage and conventional Witwatersrand mining. Taung entered into an 'earn-in agreement' with EGM on 29 Taung subsidiary Pluriclox entered a sales agreement with to acquire 100% of Evander for USD225m. EGM granted Taung the right of access to the relevant areas for exploration. Turnberry/Ukwazi mine scheduling are realistic and achievable. Maintaining the Grade Profile by experienced management through effective maintenance of the Production Plan. Implementation of effective Short Interval Control
RISK
ELEMENT
Mineralisation Tonnages Classification Data Quality Modelling Scoping Study Probable Reserves Dilution and Recovery Mining Earn in Agreement Sales Agreement Access Agreement Mine Scheduling Project Start Ramp-up MCF Hangwall Stability Grade Profile Opitimal Tonnage
RISK
ELEMENT
Note 7: Risk Assessment Matrix - Evander
Tenure
Reserves
Mineral Resources Aspects and Underground Mining
Mineral
Legal
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-143 –

RISK CATEGORY HIGH
AIDS risk with the impact on the
workforce.
RISK CATEGORY MEDIUM
Managing the hanging-wall cut above the reef channel
by implementing the Recommended Geological Face
Width Control ('RGFC').
Interpretation of reef blocks must be based on sound
exploration programme from primary access
development to upgrade the structure model and
confidence.
Sound geostatistical evaluation of existing data .
Future data will have to be managed in the same
manner.
The Block Factor of 100% not being achieved due to
overvaluation of the drilling results may pose a risk.
Sound geostatistical applications need to be
implemented to eliminate this risk.
Mineralogical evaluation will be done during the PFS.
Risk associated with ground-water inflows from
fissures and other sources. Pumping accounted for in
mine design.
Metallurgical test work has not been conducted , a
good database of gold recoveries is available.














RISK CATEGORY LOW measures. Availability of skilled labour SLP approved by DMR
National, Provincial and local government authorities
supportive of the project.
The project is adjacent to a producing mine which has
treated similar ore for the last decades in a
conventional CIP/CIL plant with acceptable gold
recoveries.
The No 6 Shaft ore has previously been mined and
treated in the same plant with good success.
There is very little carbon present in the ore body
which could adversely affect gold recoveries.
Para-statal is presently increasing its generating
power capacity to match demand. Interrupted supply a
risk until 2015.Taung has planned accordingly.

Low risk factor. The bulk of the water will be provided
by the local authorities, with the remainder being
underground sources from adjacent mines.

Access to the site is via tarred roads linked to the
national grid. No constraints in terms of logistics are
anticipated.


RISK ELEMENT Extraction Ore Dilution Labour Supply SLP Government Structure Grade Evaluation Block Factor Mineralogy Geo-hydrological Historical Processing Eskom Supply Water Supply Access
RISK
ELEMENT
Geology and Geo-Hydrology Ore Processing
Resource Services
Human Infrastructure and

– IV-144 –

==> picture [180 x 588] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

HIGH
RISK CATEGORY
MEDIUM
RISK CATEGORY
Excess tailings decant or tailings seepage risk low and the potential impact is reduced due to the various design elements and proposed infrastructure layouts. Environmental risk are considered to be relatively low as there are sufficient safeguards in place in the design to prevent environmental threats. The capital costs estimates prepared in the Scoping Study by Turnberry are based on the information and prices in South Africa to be revised in the PFS. Based on the current working costs as at April 2010 for comparabel projects. There is an inflationary risk associated with this project. The following items should be noted:- Political Risk and Mining Charter, Royalty Bill, 'Use it or Lose it' philosophy/legislation of the DMR.
117
LOW
RISK CATEGORY
Local, regional and national regulatory agencies support for the project. Government approvals, access to land, have been successfully obtained.
RISK
ELEMENT
Surface Water Contamination CIP/CIL Plant Benchmarked CAPEX Benchmarked OPEX Government Regulations
RISK
ELEMENT Estimates
Risk
Costs
Environmental Political
Operating
Country
Capital and
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-145 –

118

Note 8 : Surface Rights Owners of Jeanette and Hilton

The surface rights owners on the Jeanette project area:

FARM NAME AND
NUMBER
PORTION OWNER ADDRESS
Philadelphia 273 RE GH Jansen van Vuuren Farm Hilton, Odendaalsrus, 9480 PO Box
10,Odendaalsrus,9480
My Betty 351 The farm Hester AG Jansen van Vuuren Farm Hilton, Odendaalsrus, 9480 PO Box
10, Odendaalsrus, 9480
Wesselsrust 58 RE LP Steyn & Seun (Pty) Ltd c/o GH Jansen van
Vuuren
Farm Hilton, Odendaalsrus, 9480 PO Box
10,Odendaalsrus,9480
Wesselsrust 58 Portion 1 Transnet Ltd c/o Willie de Beer 35 th Floor, Carlton Centre, 150
Commissioner Street, JHB. PO Box 99-
106 JOHANNESBURG,2001
Vriendskap234 The farm Uysmar Trust IT 1438/98 To be determined
Martina 226 The farm Uysmar Trust IT 1438/98 To be determined
Roodepoort 235 RE, 1 Bob Moolman Trust c/o Mrs. M van Heerden, PO Box 1080,
Odendaalsrus. Farm de Erf,
Odendaalsrus
De Erf 140 RE Bob Moolman Trust c/o Mrs. M van Heerden, PO Box 1080,
Odendaalsrus. Farm de Erf,
Odendaalsrus
De Erf 140 Portion 3 Goudveld Water 49 Malan Str,Hartswater.
Rustoord 33 RE Wilhelmus H van Zyl 10 Janeke Str,Wesselsbron 9680
Heldenmoet117 RE WilhelmusH van Zyl 10 Janeke Str,Wesselsbron9680
Heldenmoet117 Portion3 MatjhabengLocal Municipality Civic Centre,Welkom
Zoeten Inval 268 RE Roelof Adriaan Buitendag PO Box 250,Odendaalsrus,9480
Goudrand 272 The farm Jacobus M Joubert 58 Voortrekker Ave,Odendaalsrus.
Paardevley251 RE NyakallongFarmers Trust Unknown
Aanleg50 RE NyakallongFarmers Trust Unknown
Jeanette 371 RE NyakallongFarmersTrust Unknown
Allanridge425 RE MatjhabengLocal Municipality Civic CentreWelkom
Uitkyk Ptn MatjhabengLocal Municipality Civic Centre Welkom

The surface rights owners on the Hilton project area:

OWNER CONTACT DETAILS FARM / PORTION
Pieter Viljoen Trust Mr Pieter Viljoen Grootkop 277: Remaining Extent
1Odendaalsrus Street
Odendaalsrus,9480
Langkuil Trust Mr HJ van Niekerk Snr & Jnr Grootkop 277: Portion 8
P O Box 1398
Kroonstad,9499
Michiel Rossouw Familie Trust SDM Rossouw Grootkop 277: Portion 10
POBox35
Odendaalsrus,9480
Mr MJ Strydom
30 Badenhorst Street
Welkom, 9459
Mr MJRossouw
P O Box 35
Odendaalsrus,9480
Mr JCF Taljaard PO Box 372 Zooikraal 101: re, portion 1
Odendaalsrus,9480
Tweeling Trust POBox 1082 Zooikraal 101: portion 2
Kroonstad, 9500
Pieter Viljoen Trust 1 Odendaalsrus Street Eerste Geluk 61: re, portion 2
Odendaalsrus,9480
Chris Geel Familie Trust PO Box 108 Eerste Geluk 61: re 1
Odendaalsrus
Mr GJ Welman POBox 1 Eerste Geluk 61: portion 3
Odendaalsrus
Mrs ECE Fourie PO Box 25124 Eerste Geluk 61: portion 4
Gezina,0084
Langkuil Trust PO Box 1398 Vrede 201: farm
Kroonstad,9499
Leerike Trust 10Badenhorst Street Damspruit 184: farm
Welkom, 9459

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-146 –

119

OWNER CONTACT DETAILS FARM / PORTION
Welverdruk Trust PO Box 2308 Waterpan 263: farm
Kroonstad,9499
AMA Delport 76 Erasmus Street Bruintjieslaagte 243: farm
Odendaalsrus Schaapplaats100: farm
POBox 1080 Stillewoning283: farm
JCF Taljaard Odendaalsrus Langverwacht 281:portion 1
PO Box 372 Langverwacht 281: re
Odendaalsrus
Mrs AMA Delport 76 Erasmus Street Melkkraal 450: farm
Odendaalsrus
Mr GH Jansen van Vuuren POBox 10 Hilton 30: farm
Odendaalsrus
AMA Delport 76 Erasmus Street Hilton 449: farm
Odendaalsrus
Mr RPJ van Vuuren P O Box 1241 Emmanuel 433: farm
Odendaalsrus
c/oMr MM Vani Langkuil66: re
P O Box 1157K2 Dreyers 445: re
Kutlwanong,9480

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-147 –

120

Note 9 : Historical Sampling Results for Jeanette

Basal Reef Sampling Results

BOREHOLE
ID.NO.
MB1
HB1
LW1
J1
HB2
J2
DEE1
WR1
AL3
AL2
DEE3
WE12
U/G dev.
at Shaft 2B
HD1
MT2
WE3
WE11
WE5
DEE2
EG1
JER1
JEZ1
GRADE
(g/t)
11.64
77.6
45.04
6.55
15.07
47.78
29.36
15.06
103.85
Av. 40.02
1.24
2.25
22.01
5.46
33.89
DEPTH (m) WIDTH (m) REEF cmg/t cmkg/t
1,422
1,442
FO
1,510
Intrusive
1,502
1,523
1,856
1,768
FO
1,430
1,839
1,826
Abandoned
1,171
1,039
Stopped above Basal
FO
1,586
1,787
1,875
0.268
0.195
n/a
0.234
n/a
0.203
0.146
0.117
0.171
n/a
0.175
0.148
Av 0.224
0.178
n/a
0.129
0.139
n/a
n/a
0.14
0.45
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
Basal
312
1,517
126
1,054
107
133
220
559
502
264
1,537
897
22
stopped short of reef
29
307
stopped short of reef
faulted out
76
1,059
1,515
7.61
11.2
4.32
9.13
11.2
Not
sampled
12.04
12.77
1.13
12.01

A Reef Sampling Results

BOREHOLE
ID. NO.
MB1
HB1
LW1
J1
HB2
J2
DEE1
WR1
AL3
AL2
DEE3
WE12
HD1
MT2
WE3/MT1
WE11
WE5
DEE2
RP1
EG1
JER1
JEZ1
WIDTH
(m)
29.9
99.5
77.8
81.3
78.6
30.5
45.7
22.4
137.7
43.9
30.5
56.5
66
111.8
30.5
83.8
GRADE
(g/t)
1.64
1.48
7.47
1.05
0.18
3.44
5.14
12.77
1.64
26.97
2.4
0.86
1.12
2.3
28.26
1.77
DEPTH (m) cmg/t U3O8 (kg/t) cmkg/t
1,274
1,197
1,315
1,292
1,558
1,361
1,295
1,575
1,545
Reef not
developed/identified
1,159
1,583
Reef not
developed/identified
Borehole abandoned
above reef horizon
887
797
664
1,065
East of Subcrop
1,337
A Reef horizons to be
re-defined in later
investigations
A Reef horizons to be
re-defined in later
investigations
49
147
581
85
14
105
235
286
226
1184
73
49
74
257
682
148
0.15
0.23
0.49
Not assayed
0.16
Not assayed
Not assayed
0.52
0.11
Not assayed
Not sampled
Not sampled
Not sampled
Not sampled
Not sampled
Not sampled
4.38
22.9
38.16
N/A
12.6
N/A
N/A
11.65
15.16
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-148 –

121

Historical Sampling Results for Big Pebble Reef

BOREHOLE
ID.NO.
AL3
DEE2
DEE3
J2
JER1
JEZ1A
LW1
WE3
WE5
WE11
WE12
MT2
WE3
REEF cmg/t U3O8 (kg/t)
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'Big Pebble Conglomerate B'
'BigPebble Conglomerate B'
86
444
771
78
194
922
717
1,177
65
154
540
BH
ABANDONED
1,177
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed

Historical Sampling Results for B Reef

BOREHOLE
ID.NO.
AL2
DEE1
DEE2
DEE3
EG1
HB1
HB2
HD1
J1
J2
JER1
JEZ1A
JEZ2
LW1
MB1
WE3
WE5
WE11
WE12
WT4
HB4
WIDTH
(m)
NA
NA
0.99
0.12
0.28
1.68
0.51
0.63
NA
0.3
0.32
0.31
0.18
0.01
0.78
0.01
0.86
0.94
0.15
0.76
0.34
GRADE
(g/t)
FO
TR
2.95
178.44
24.19
1.46
1.07
4.8
TR
TR
12.73
0.77
18.45
TR
0.96
TR
2.81
0.51
1.2
10.2
40.14
DEPTH (m) REEF cmg/t U3O8 (kg/t) cmkg/t
1,564
1,353
1,130
1,227
1,381
1,266
1,555
1,703
1,363
1,433
1,577
1,330
1,659
1,352
1,333
985
723
837
1,631
1,500
1,401
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
'B'
FO
26
292
2,177
675
245
55
305
-
TR
405
24
334
TR
75
TR
243
48
18
775
1,389
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed

Not assayed
Not assayed
0.345
0.261
1.517
Not assayed
0.108
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
Not assayed
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
10.96
5.51
35.19
N/A
8.42
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-149 –

122

Note 10 : Sampling Protocols for Due Diligence of the Reefs at Jeanette

Due Diligence procedure for Boreholes at Jeanette

  • check that borehole intersection end depths concur with logging information, and any discrepancies noted;

  • check for core continuity, areas of loss recorded on the core, with appropriate written indication and depth check controls;

  • validation of start and end depths of each reported deflection against logs;

  • establish contact depths of the main lithological and stratigraphic zone boundaries within the Witwatersrand succession and compare with logged information (if available);

  • establish positions of main stratigraphic horizons from Leader Reef and Khaki Shale to the Basal Reef;

  • check of the original sampling of each reef intersection. For instance, the Anglo American sampling standard for the Basal Reef involves the inclusion of 2cm of hangingwall and footwall stratigraphy in the reef sample which should be adhered to; and

  • if reef horizons have not been sampled in previous campaigns, these are identified but no sampling is carried out unless approval is obtained from Taung staff.

Sampling protocols for the Re-sampling Exercise for the Basal Reef and Kimberley Formation Reefs at Jeanette

  • check end depths concur with geological log information, where available, but note if not available;

  • establish contacts of main lithological and stratigraphic zone boundaries and compare with logs (if available);

  • scan through core to check for core continuity and establish if areas of loss have been reported adequately, with appropriate marking on the resumed area of core and depth check controls;

  • establish position of main reef horizons from VS5 through to B Reef including Earls Court Marker, preliminary A Reef, B Reef and Spes Bona. Also the Leader Reef and Khaki Shale above the Basal Reef;

  • check briefly the appropriateness of original sampling of each of these reefs;

  • if notable reef horizons have not been sampled, mark them out for resampling using bedding low points and lithological boundaries as a guide to cutting, and make a note (for Taung) to follow up on this;

  • validate start and end depth of each reported deflection against logs, if available;

  • choose a representative deflection from each borehole where Basal Reef is fully developed with no notable losses near the contact;

  • decide on a start and depth for sampling (based on the ’2cm’ rule);

  • mark any full meter on the half core with a permanent marker. Mark the starting depth for sampling on the reverse side of the first piece of core (i.e. on the curved surface);

  • decide where each sample should start and stop, highlight the breaks in the core with a china marker;

  • mark the measured sample depth that corresponds to the end of each sample on the top side of the core;

  • write the sample ticket number roughly midway along the sample on the top side of the core;

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-150 –

123

  • place a black cutting mark on the cut surface down the centre of the entire length of core to be sampled, ensuring it aligns exactly parallel to the axis of the core and precisely bisects the core;

  • transfer the entire piece of half core to a clean separate box ensuring no mix-up occurs;

  • saw the core exactly down the black line marked on the flat surface of the half core as above;

  • replace both quarters of cut core back in their original positions in the core tray; ensuring that the piece to be sampled (i.e. the piece without marker labels) lies adjacent to the piece that will remain as a check;

  • take each piece of core to be sampled from its position in the core tray and place it in a new plastic bag;

  • take a pre-marked ticket from the ticket book and place 2 tickets in with the core sample;

  • record in the field book borehole number, deflection, depth from, depth to, stratigraphy, lithology, dip angle, sample ticket number, type of sample (H,R,F, Std, Blank);

  • remember to start each sequence with a ‘blank’ sample which should bear the first ticket number, followed by the hangingwall sample of core, followed by a standard (in the first batch). The standard should be placed adjacent to the reef sample;

  • between each reef cut place a blank. Standards should only be placed every 2nd or 3rd reef cut;

  • the order should be as follows: Blank, HW1,(HW2), Standard, reef-sample 1, Reef sample 2, FW1, FW2, Blank, HW1, HW2, Reef1, Reef2, Standard, FW1, FW2, Blank, Etc.;

  • the number of hangingwall, footwall and reef samples is variable, depending on reef thickness;

  • once all the sampling is complete, write the ticket number boldly on the outside of each bag in sequence and seal the bag;

  • the reef intersection will be photographed initially without marks, and then with all marks prior to cutting and after longitudinal cutting has taken place;

  • the remaining core is finally returned to its original place in the core tray;

  • choose a section for resampling;

  • validate start and end depths against available logs;

  • start sampling approximately 2cm into the hangingwall of the Basal Quartzite if possible, otherwise along already existing breaks, unless these clearly contravene the standards, i.e. within 2cm of major lithological contacts; and

  • end sampling approximately 2cm into the footwall of the Basal Reef if possible, otherwise along already existing breaks, unless these clearly contravene the standards, i.e. within 2cm of major lithological contacts.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-151 –

124

Note 11 : Re-sampled Intervals and Re-sampling for Basal Reef at Jeanette

Comparison of Re-Sampling Data with original for Basal Reef (TMC 2008c)

BORE
-HOLE
DEFLEC-
TION
AVER
Au
AVE.
ACC.Au

AVE.
ACC.U3O8
ORIGINAL
Au
ORIGINAL
U3O8
FROM TO Au U3O8 U3O8
ID NO NO (m) (m) (g/t) (cmg/t) (kg/t) (cmkg/t) (cm.g/t) (cmkg/t) (cmg/t) (cmkg/t)
WR1 0 1,821.0 1,821.2 9.22 140.0 256 3.9 140
686
33
549
135
679
136
211
874
286
387
9
315
4
33
4
12
4
11
4
4
91
32
43
10
11
No record No record
WR1
WR1
WR1
0
2?
0
1,821.2
-
1,654.1
1,821.3
0.2
1,654.4
0.81
39.00
0.27
14.0
686.0
0.3
22
1,895
13
0.4
33.3
0.3
No record
No record
No record
No record
No record
No record
WR1 0 1,654.4 1,654.6 1.06 3.4 133 3.4
WR1
WR1
0
8
1,654.6
1,854.3
1,654.8
1,854.5
0.63
27.84
12.0
549.0
<7
625
Nd
12.3
570
244
700
90
395
428
No record
No record
19
245
16
8
9
3
7
35
No record
No record
9
WR1
HB1
8
8
1,854.5
1,264.5
1,854.8
1,264.8
0.09
4.22
3.0
135.0
9
121
0.3
3.9
HB1
HB1
8
5
1,264.8
1,447.9
1,265.0
1,448.2
0.07
17.68
1.0
679.0
<7
296
Nd
11.4
HB1
HB1
5
6
1,448.2
1,447.5
1,448.6
1,447.8
0.16
4.86
5.0
136.0
<7
131
Nd
3.7
HB1
MB1
6
1
1,447.8
1,421.0
1,448.1
1,421.3
0.19
0.78
4.0
24.0
<7
<7
Nd
Nd
MB1 1 1,421.3 421.5 7.35 187.0 150 3.8
MB1
JER1
1
0
1,421.5
1,767.8
1,421.8
1,768.1
0.10
0.88
3.0
29.0
<7
254
Nd
8.2
JER1 0 1,768.1 1,768.5 23.92 846.0 2,354 83.2
JER1
JER1
0
6
1,768.5
1,785.8
1,768.7
1,786.1
0.13
0.28
3.0
8.0
10
105
0.2
3
JER1 6 1,786.1 1,786.4 8.06 278.0 835 28.8
JER1
JER1
6
23
1,786.4
1,788.9
1,786.8
1,789.2
0.15
0.19
6.0
6.0
16
14
0.6
0.4
JER1 23 1,789.2 1,789.4 13.67 381.0 1,515 42.3
JER1
HB2
23
12
1,789.4
1,594.1
1,789.8
1,594.4
0.07
0.16
2.0
5.0
<7
25
Nd
0.8
HB2 12 1,594.4 1,594.6 0.18 4.0 375 8.9
HB2
HB2
12
18
1,594.6
1,588.8
1,595.0
1,589.2
0.13
0.13
4.0
5.0
40
13
1.3
0.5
20
HB2 18 1,589.2 1,589.5 8.88 310.0 302 10.6
HB2 18 1,589.5 1,589.9 0.15 5.0 14 0.5

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-152 –

TRUE
WIDTH
(cm)
28.9
23.0 28.0 26.0 39.0 39.0 38.0 57.0 41.0 35.0 27.9 37.0 25.0 37.0 22.4 24.9 25.8 39.0
70.9
48.0
36.9
31.6
28.0
47.0 31.0
28.9
24.0 49.9 45.0 37.0 41.0
42.2
40.0
50.9
33.0
33.0 44.0 42.0
43.8
40.4
ORIGINAL
U3O8
(cmg/t)
nd
17
4.40
23.00
nd
nd
nd
na
nd
39
ORIGINAL
Au
(cmg/t)
174
64.00
54.00
797.00
133
1085.00
8.00
226
179.00
955.00
141
nd
nd
na
nd
707
AVER.ACCUM.
U3O8
(cmg/t)
3.14
10.15
1.89
5.41
17.41
39.00
12.51
26.97
7.15
9.36
5.00
20.74
25.96
6.41
8.37
27.00
AVER.ACCUM.
Au
(cmg/t)
24.00
73.00
29.98
32.00
158.00
666.00
12.35
253.00
187.00
273.33
87.00
468.00
489.00
60.00
123.00
561.00
U3O8
(cmg/t)
1.70 1.44 8.31 1.85
1.20
0.68
1.12
4.29
14.61
2.20
3.23
3.59 17.08 7.26 7.84
12.51
21.81
5.16
7.15
9.36
1.80
1.38 3.48
3.16
0.19 2.28 4.71 6.69 3.71
21.48
4.48
6.41
1.42
0.81 1.70 4.44
15.83
12.98
Au
(cmg/t)
0.91
14.99 8.42 0.84
39.92
34.26
11.88
18.10
1.02
32.07
124.50
31.61
40.78
27.36 295.27 137.26 170.63
12.35
195.99
73.35
188.76
273.33
18.98
10.56 84.18
37.75
69.11 182.81 67.96 69.14 57.38
458.68
39.46
61.97
14.10
33.10 63.30 17.18
185.96
404.34
AVER Au
(g/t)
0.03
0.65 0.30 0.03
1.02
0.88
0.31
0.32
0.02
0.92
4.46
0.85
1.63
0.74 13.19 5.52 6.61
0.32
2.76
1.53
5.12
8.64
0.68
0.22 2.72
1.30
2.88 3.66 1.51 1.87 1.40
10.86
0.99
1.22
0.43
1.00 1.44 0.41
4.24
10.01
TO
(m)
1617.54
1617.77 1618.05 1618.31
1595.01
1595.40
1617.34
1617.91
1659.03
1659.38
1284.99
1285.36
1315.61
1315.98 1316.21 1316.46 1316.72
1337.53
1511.41
1511.89
1536.49
1576.87
1337.11
1337.58 1337.89
1598.31
1598.80 1599.30 1599.75 1600.12 1600.53
1575.49
1575.89
0.51
0.33
0.66 1.10 1.52
1315.22
1315.63
FROM
(m)
1617.25
1617.54 1617.77 1618.05
1594.62
1595.01
1616.96
1617.34
1658.62
1659.03
1284.71
1284.99
1315.36
1315.61 1315.98 1316.21 1316.46
1337.14
1510.70
1511.41
1536.12
1576.55
1336.83
1337.11 1337.58
1598.02
1598.56 1598.80 1599.30 1599.75 1600.12
1575.06
1575.49
0.00
0.00
0.33 0.66 1.10
1314.78
1315.22
REEF
A
A A A
A
A
BP Bott
BP Bott
B
B
A
A
BP Bott
BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott
B
A
A
BP Bott
B
BP Bott
BP Bott BP Bott
BP Bott
BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott
A
A
A
BP Bott
BP Bott BP Bott BP Bott
BP Bott?
BP Bott?
DEFLEC-
TION
NO
0
0 0 0
10
10
10
10
10
10
8
8
8
8 8 8 8
8
0
0
0
15
1
1 1
0
0 0 0 0 0
2
2
0?
0?
0? 0? 0?
2?
2?
BORE-
HOLE
ID
JEZ2
JEZ2 JEZ2 JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ2
JEZ1
JEZ1
JEZ1
JEZ1 JEZ1 JEZ1 JEZ1
JEZ1
JER1
JER1
JER1
JER1
JEJ1
JEJ1 JEJ1
WR1
WR1 WR1 WR1 WR1 WR1
WR1
WR1
HB1
HB1
HB1 HB1 HB1
LW1
LW1

– IV-153 –

==> picture [7 x 183] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

Note 12 : Risk Assessment Matrix for Jeanette
----- End of picture text -----

==> picture [333 x 585] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

HIGH
RISK CATEGORY
Delayed project start date beyond January 2014 due to problems with electricity supply or possible delays with the DMR.
MEDIUM
RISK CATEGORY
Variability of gold mineralisation - geostatistically shown not high risk. Demonstrable scope for upgrading Inferred Mineral Resources. Inferred Resources good confidence just reuire additional data points. Planned for exploration 2011. Undercutting the Khaki Shale important risk. Engineering reports favourable and mining bleow the shale successfully undertaken in other operations Operating a conveyor system over a distance 26km requires good design and management to maintain production rates of 700tpd. Efficiency and productivity will be adversely affected unless suitable storage is always available. Meeting the 80% MCF for the ramp-up. Minxcon's tonnage profile estimated during mine scheduling indicates this attainable. Hang stability must controlled with good mining practice;
LOW
RISK CATEGORY
Sufficient Indicated Mineral Resources. Confident classification as Indicated Mineral Resources Independent specialist reviews confirm data acceptable for Mineral Resource estimation. Independently prepared and validated by ExplorMine consultants. Detailed lithological and mineralisation facies domains have been defined. Independent Scoping Studies by Minxcon and SMS y - a detailed mine design, produced a production schedule and have delineated a Probable Reserve and Economic Inferred Mineral resource. A Probable Reserve has been estimated. Mining dilution and mining recovery factors used in the Mineral Reserve estimate are acceptable. Shrinkage and conventional Witwatersrand mining. Taung purchased the Prospecting Right from Harmony Gold. Taung has no further obligations. Minxcon mine schedulings are realistic and achievable.
RISK
ELEMENT
Mineralisation Tonnages Classification Data Quality Modelling Scoping Study Probable Reserves Dilution and Recovery Mining Earn in Agreement Mine Scheduling Project Start Ore Storage and Conveyor system Ramp-up MCF Hangwall
RISK
ELEMENT
Reserves Tenure
Mineral Resources Underground Mining
Mineral Legal
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-154 –

==> picture [399 x 585] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

HIGH
RISK CATEGORY
AIDS risk with the impact on the workforce.
MEDIUM
RISK CATEGORY
127 new technology and Rock Engineering . Developing and operating decline system are often less efficient and more costly than horizontal systems. The decline system will rely on trackless vehicles operating at high angles over long distances. Managing the hanging-wall cut above the reef channel by implementing the Recommended Geological Face Width Control ('RGFC'). The Block Factor of 100% not being achieved due to overvaluation of the drilling results may pose a risk. Sound geostatistical applications need to be implemented to eliminate this risk. Mineralogical evaluation will be done during the PFS. Risk associated with ground-water inflows from fissures and other sources. Pumping accounted for in mine design. Metallurgical test work has not been conducted , a good database of gold recoveries is available.
LOW
RISK CATEGORY
Maintaining the Grade Profile by experienced management through effective maintenance of the Production Plan. Implementation of effective Short Interval Control measures. Also dependent on Main and New Shaft airway capacity and a new ventilation shaft may be required if production exceeds 145ktpm. Availability of skilled labour SLP approved by DMR National, Provincial and local government authorities supportive of the project. Interpretation of reef blocks must be based on sound exploration programme from primary access development to upgrade the structure model and confidence. Risk mitigated by 3D seismic survey. Sound geostatistical evaluation of existing data . Future data will have to be managed in the same manner. The project is adjacent to a producing mine which has treated similar ore for the last decades in a conventional CIP/CIL plant with acceptable gold recoveries. The Basal Reef has previously been mined and treated in the adjacent mine plant with good success. There is some carbon present in the ore body which could adversely affect gold recoveries. Appropriate technology successfully used on adjacent mine. Para-statal is presently increasing its generating power capacity to match demand. Interrupted supply a risk until 2015.Taung has planned accordingly. Low risk factor. The bulk of the water will be provided
RISK
ELEMENT Stability Grade Profile Opitimal Tonnage Extraction Ore Dilution Labour Supply SLP Government Structure Grade Evaluation Block Factor Mineralogy Geo- hydrological Historical Processing Eskom Supply Water Supply
RISK
ELEMENT
e
Resources
Geology and Geo-Hydrology Ore Processing structur
Human
Infra-
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-155 –

128 RISK CATEGORY HIGH
RISK CATEGORY MEDIUM
The following items should be noted:- Political Risk and
Mining Charter, Royalty Bill, 'Use it or Lose it'
philosophy/legislation of the DMR.
Excess tailings decant or tailings seepage risk low and the
potential impact is reduced due to the various design
elements and proposed infrastructure layouts.
The capital costs estimates prepared in the Scoping Study
by Minxcon are based on the information and prices in
South Africa to be revised in the PFS.
Based on the current working costs as at April 2010 for
comparabel projects. There is an inflationary risk
associated with this project.
RISK CATEGORY LOW by the local authorities, with the remainder being
underground sources from adjacent mines.

Access to the site is via tarred roads linked to the
national grid. No constraints in terms of logistics are
anticipated.
Local, regional and national regulatory agencies
support for the project. Government approvals,
access to land, have been successfully obtained.
Environmental risk are considered to be relatively low
as there are sufficient safeguards in place in the
design to prevent environmental threats.
RISK ELEMENT Access Surface Water
Contamination
CIP/CIL Plant Benchmarked
CAPEX
Benchmarked
OPEX
Government
Regulations
RISK
ELEMENT
Estimates Political Risk
tal Liability Costs
Environmen Operating
Capital and

– IV-156 –

==> picture [177 x 497] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

H2
2019
H1
H2
2018
H1
H2
2017
H1
H2
2016
H1
H2
2015
H1
H2
2014
H1
H2
2013
H1
H2
2012
H1
H2
2011
H1
PROJECT ACTIVITY
Jeanette Exploration 3D Reflective Seismic Survey Pre-Feasibility Study Full Feasibility Study Application for Eskom Power Mining Right Application - Jeanette Grant of Mining Right Sink Main Shaft Refurbish Old Vent Shaft Access development to first reef Production Ramp Up Steady State Production
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-157 –

HELD BY Silver Bank Family Trust (100% ) J & L Silverbank CK (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty)
Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) R. A. Beyers (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty)
Ltd (100% )
MINERALS
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal
Gold and
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal




3-Oct-11 18-Oct-11 18-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 18-Oct-11 New subm
10Feb2009
18-Feb-12 3-Oct-11 9-Apr-13 18-Oct-11 3-Oct-11
To be
EXPIRY
DATE
3-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 3-Oct-11 18-Feb-12 Revised
submission
16 Feb 09
4-Oct-06 19-Oct-06 19-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 19-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 19-Feb-07 4-Oct-06 10-Apr-08 19-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 5-May-09
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 4-Oct-06 19-Feb-07
MP30/5/1/1/2/202PR MP30/5/1/1/2/208PR MP30/5/1/1/2/606PR MP30/1/1/2/672PR MP305/5/1/1/965PR MP30/5/1/1/2/702PR MP30/5/1/1/2/733PR MP30/5/1/1/2/252PR MP30/5/1/1/2/692PR MP30/5/1/1/2/1726PR MP30/5/1/1/2/709PR MP30/5/1/1/2/821PR MP30/5/1/1/2/776PR GP 30/5/1/1/2/476PR
PROSPECTING
RIGHT
MP30/5/1/1/2/207PR MP30/5/1/1/2/203PR MP30/5/1/1/2/201PR MP30/5/1/1/2/964PR MP30/5/1/1/2/673PR MP30/5/1/1/2/1214PR
962 704 421 1,197 301 6,100
2,733

3,425
2,381 169 677 9,385
1,353
1,534
1,406
564 1,969 1,502
SIZE
(ha)
1,123
196 328 86 328 455
FARM PORTION Brandkraal 651IR Ptn 5
Rooiwal 607 IR, Ptn 13
Grouwater 353 IR, Pts 5 , 6
Subtotal De Hoek 411 IR, Pts RE1, RE4, RE6,
Hexrivier 634IR ,Ptn RE1 Driefontein 632IR, Pts RE 21, 23 Driefontein 632 IR, Ptn RE 25 Driefontein 632 IR, Pts 10,11,18,19,
24, 26
Driefontein 632 IR, Ptn 22 Driefontein 632 IR, Pts RE 3, 16 Driefontein 632 IR, Ptn RE 5 Silverbank 611 IR, Pts RE 6, RE 7, 11,
13
Silverbank 611 IR, Ptn 3 Silverbank 611 IR,Pts RE2,5,8,9 Subtotal De Pan 615IR, Ptn RE, RE1, RE2, 3,
RE4, RE5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13,
14, 15, 16

Grootspruit 617 IR, Pts RE 5, 20 and
Drukfontein 613 IR, Pts RE, 1, 2, 3, 4,
5 and
Vogelstruisfontein 593 IR, Pts RE 2, 3,
7, 10, 11
Grootvley 579 IR, Pts RE 1, RE 2, RE
4, 7, 10, RE 11, 15, 17, 18, 19, 21
Grootvley 579 IR, Ptn RE 5 Grootvley 579 IR, Pts RE and 22 Subtotal Hartebeesfontein 638 IR, Pts RE 7,
RE 9, 16
Subtotal Watervalshoek 350 IR, Pts 1, 3, 4, 19,
25, 26, 27, 28, 32, 35, 36, 46
PROJECT
South Rand -
Hexrivier
South Rand -
Drukfontein
South Rand -
Hartbeesfontein
Evander West South Rand -
PROVINCE Mpumalanga Gauteng

– IV-158 –

HELD BY HELD BY HELD BY Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold Exploration Ltd (100% ) Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (North West) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty)
Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty)
Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold Exploration (West) (Pty)
Ltd (100% )
Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
Taung Gold (Free State) (Pty) Ltd
(100% )
MINERALS
Coal
Gold Ore Gold Ore Gold Ore All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal
Gold, Silver
and base
metals
All minerals
excluding
diamonds
and coal




EXPIRY
DATE
executed
8-Mar-15 8-Mar-15 8-Mar-15 12-Jan-12 8-Jan-12 12-Jan-12 1-Mar-12 15-Feb-12 25-Mar-12 8-Nov-12 12-Jan-12 12-Jan-12 12-Jan-12 14-Apr-11
COMMENCE-
MENT DATE
5-May-09
9-Jun-09
8-Mar-15 8-Mar-15 8-Mar-15 13-Jan-07 9-Jan-07 13-Jan-07 2-Mar-07 16-Feb-07 26-Mar-07 9-Nov-07 13-Jan-07 13-Jan-07 13-Jan-07 15-Apr-08
PROSPECTING
RIGHT
GP 30/5/1/1/2/485PR GP 30/5/1/1/2/490PR GP 305/1/1/2/499 PR GP 305/1/1/2/500 PR GP 30/5/1/1/2/491 PR NW30/5/1/1/2/1014PR NW30/5/1/1/2/454PR NW30/5/1/1/2/666PR NW30/5/1/1/2/457PR NW30/5/1/1/2/667PR NW30/5/1/1/2/456PR NW30/5/1/1/2/1432PR NW30/5/1/1/2/981PR NW30/5/1/1/2/1135PR NW30/5/1/1/2/1156PR FS30/5/1/1/2/497 PR
SIZE
(ha)
3,035
4,357
2,702 1,899 189 13,685
2,156
1,628
824
1,176 3,145 1,156 2,168 12,252
3,231

1,778
343 5,352
652
652
FARM PORTION
RE7, RE8, 13
Kaalplaats 330 JP, Pts 1, 2 Plecy 82, Farm Subtotal
Lagerspoort 406IR, Farm
Orion 413 IR - Farm
Modderfontein 410 IR, Pts RE, 1, 2, 3,
4 & 5 De
Hoek 411 IR, Pts RE & 2
Steynskraal 399 IR - The Farm Blinkpoort 396 IR RE3, RE4, RE13,
RE16, RE25, 10, 11, 12, 14, 17,
18,19,20, 22, 26
Steynkraal 403 IR Subtotal
Stinkhoutboom 68 JO, Pts RE, 1, 3, 4,
5, 6, RE 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 16,
17, 19 and 21
Rietpoort 69 JO, Pts 1, 2, MA 3, on
Ptn 11
Stinkhoutboom 84 JO, Pts RE, 1, RE
2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 15, 18,
19,20,21,22
Doornplaat 85 JO, Pts RE 1, RE 4, RE
2
Wonderhoek 70 JO, Pts RE 1, 2, 3
and Windheuvel 86 JO, Pts, RE 1
Oog van Malmani 333 JP, Ptn RE Subtotal
Palmietfontein 403 IP, Pts
RE2,16,RE18,22,23,24,RE26,RE27,28
,29,30,33,34,35,40,41,42,RE43,44,45,
46,47,48,49,51,52,53,54,55,56

Palmietfontein 403 IP, Pts 11,12,
RE13,17,19,20,25,31,
RE32,36,38,RE39,58,59,RE60,63,64
Palmietfontein 403 IP, Ptn 21 Subtotal Richelieu 135, Farm





















PROJECT
Sugarbush
Malmani Palmietfontein Richelieu Plecy
**
PROVINCE North West North West
(Klerksdorp)
Free State

– IV-159 –

132

Note 15 : Competent Persons Certificates

Name of Firm: Venmyn Rand (Pty) Limited Name of Staff: Mr Andrew Clay Company Responsibility: Managing Director Profession: Geologist Date of Birth: 16[th] April 1955 Years with Firm/Entity: 21 years Nationality: British Membership in Professional Societies:

CLASS PROFESSIONAL SOCIETY YEAR OF REGISTRATION
Member Canadian Institute of Mining,Metallurgyand Petroleum 2006
Advisor JSE LimitedListingsAdvisory Committee 2005
Issuer JSE IssuerServices 2008
Member JSE Issuer MiningSub-committee 2009
Associate Member American Association of Petroleum Geologists 2005
Member South African Institute of Directors 2004
Fellow Geological Societyof South Africa 2003
Member American Institute of Mineral Appraisers 2002
Member South African Institute of Mining andMetallurgy 1998
Fellow Australasian Institute of Miningand Metallurgy 1994
Member Natural Scientist Institute of South Africa 1988
Member Investment Analysts Societyof South Africa 1990

Involvement in Code Writing:

POSITION PROFESSIONAL CODE DATE OF INVOLVEMENT
Chairman Venmyn AdvisoryChecklist 2000 -present
Member South African(SAICA)extractive industries deliberations 2003 -present
Initiator & Panel Member SAMREC / IAS Award 2002 -present
Advisor JSE ListingRequirements (Section3 On-going obligations) 2002 -present
Working GroupMember SAMREC Code (Oil& Gas) 2005-present
WorkingGroupMember SAMVAL Code 2001 –present
WorkingGroupMember SAMREC Code(Re-write Sections 1 – 5) 2005 -present
WorkingGroupMember SAMREC Code(Re-write) 2003 -present
WorkingGroupMember SAMREC Code(First Version) 1996 - 2001
Advisory CommitteeMember JSE Limited 2005-present
Advisor JSE ListingRequirements (Section 12) 1990–present

Mr Clay currently has a special interest in incorporating oil and gas reporting procedures into the general application of mineral asset valuation.

Involvement in Fund Management

POSITION FUND DATE OF INVOLVEMENT
Member of Investment & Audit
Committee
New Africa Mining Fund (NAMF)
Director Strategic African Mineral Investment
Fund(SAMI)
2008 - present

Detailed Tasks Assigned:

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY DOCUMENTATION
2009 Metorex Gold Independent Fairness Opinion
2009 Kivu Resources Pegmatites Independentprefeasibilitystudy
2009 Kalagadi Manganese Manganese Independent Tehno-Economic Review
2009 TaungGold Gold Independent Competent Person’s Report
2009 Sylvania Resources Platinum Independent Technical and Valuation Expert’s Report
2009 Ernst & Young Jordan Gold Independent Valuation Report on mineral assets of a Gold
MiningConcession in Ethiopia
2009 Dwyka Resources Gold Independent Technical Statement on Tulu Kapi Gold Project
2009 G & B African Resources Pot Ash Independent ProspectivityReview
2009 Central African Gold Gold Information Memorandum in the form of NI 43-101 Compliant
Technical Statement
2009 Braemore Resources Platinum Fairness Opinion

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-160 –

133

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY DOCUMENTATION
2009 New Dawn Gold Independent Technical Statement
2009 Investec Cement Independent Technical Review of CILU Cement assets
2009 IBI Iron ore Independent Technical Resource Statement
2009 Chrometco Chrome Fairness Opinion
2009 Rand Uranium Uranium Mineral Resource Review and Modelling
2008 Signet Mining Coal Independent valuation of coal assets
2008 Lesego Platinum PGMs Independent Competent Person’s Report for JSE Listing
2008 Norilsk Nickel Nickel Review of business strategy
2008 Minero Group Zinc/Lead Review of business strategyand Competent Person’s Report
2008 Paramount Mining Diamonds Independent Technical Statements
2008 Anglo Platinum PGMs Independent Technical Report and valuation
2008 Demindex Diamonds Review of business strategyand Technical Advice
2008 Investec Cement Due Diligence and valuation of Cilu Cement
2008 DGI Copper/Cobalt Independent Technical Statements
2008 Abalengani Platinum Review ofplant and valuation
2008 Absolute Holdings Quarryvaluation
2008 Metorex Copper/Cobalt Fairness Opinion
2008 Investec Cement Due diligence on Sephaku assets
2008 Kivu Resources Tantalite Tantalite strategicplanningand valuation
2008 Tantilite Resources Tantalite Independent Technical Report
2008 DGI Copper/Cobalt Independent Technical Statement and valuation
2008 Uramin Uranium, Resource Review and Technical Statements
2008 Harmony Gold Mining Au, Uranium Independent Technical Statements and Strategic business
plan
2008 HarmonyGold Uranium Cooke DumpResource and Financial Valuation
2008 HarmonyGold Au Uranium Reserve and Resource Audit for thegroup
2008 Nkwe Platinum PGMs Independent Technical Statement and Competent Person’s
Report
2008 Highveld
Steel
&
Vanadium
Corporation

Steel, Vanadium
Independent Resource and Reserve planning
2008 African Minerals Diamonds Independent Technical Statements
2008 Continental Coal Coal Independent Technical Report
2008 Industrial Base Metals Base Metals Base Metal RefineryAudit
2007 Crushco Industrial Minerals Independent valuation
2007 Kimberley Consolidated Mining Diamonds Independent valuation
2007 LionOre Mining Nickel. PGMs Technical and economic valuation
2007 PBS Group PGMs Project review
2007 Western Areas Au Independent valuation
2007 Harmony Gold Mining Au. Uranium Independent scoping and valuation
2007 Great Basin Gold Au Independent valuation for BEE transaction
2007 BRC/Diamondcore Resources Diamonds Valuation and Opinion provider
2007 Urals Investors Diamonds Au. PGMs
and Oiland Gas
Independent Transaction Report
2007 Energem Diamonds Independent Technical Statement for Koidu
2007 Xstrata Cr Independent CGT and Valuation advice
2007 PWC Magnetite Mine Review Magnetite Independent Mineral Resource Review and Valuation for
apportionment calculations
2007 Magnum Resources Ta Independent Mineral Resource Review
2007 Gaanahoek Coal Deposit Coal ProspectivityReview
2005 Letseng Diamonds Independent Competent Person’s Report for disposal
2005 Zimplats Tenements Platinum GroupMetals Independent Competent Person’s Report for disposal
2005 DRD Gold Fair & Reasonable
2005 ARM Modikwa Platinum GroupMetals Independent Valuation for Impairment Calculation
2005 HarmonyCompetitions Tribunal Gold Independent Expert Witness
2005 Ecca Holdings Bentonite Independent IndustryReview
2007 DRDGold Au Emperor Gold Mines independent forensic review
2007 KimberleyDiamonds Corporation Diamonds Independent Listings Documentation
2007 Rockwell Diamonds Transhex Transaction Documentation
2007 Rockwell Diamonds Independent Mineral Resource Review
2007 Caledonia Mining Au Independent Disposal Documentation Eersteling
2007 Caledonia Mining Au Independent Disposal Documentation Barbrook
2007 Adsani Tantalite Refinery Ta Independent Technical Report
2006 LionOre Ni Base Metals Independent Valuation of Falconbridge International and
Nikkelverk Refinery
2006 LionOre/BCL Ni Base Metals Independent Technical and Economic Valuation

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-161 –

134

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY DOCUMENTATION
2006 Vanamin V Independent Report for disposal
2006 Kurils Islands Au Independent Technical Report NI43-101
2006 Mgart Armenia Au Independent Assessment and Valuation for AIM
2006 Zimbabwe MiningBill All Preparation of industrysubmission togovernment
2006 Energem Oil & Gas Preparation of National Instrument Compliance
2006 Ncondedzi Coal Coal Technical & Corporate ListingDocumentation
2006 Metallon International - Armenia Gold & Base Metals Prospectivity& Exploration Programme Preparation
2006 Hood Tantalite Tantalite Independent Techno Economic Valuation Report
2005 HarmonyRandfontein 4 Shaft Gold Independent Valuation
2005 GalleryGold Gold Independent Competent Person’s Report for disposal
2005 Stuart Coal Coal Independent Competent Person’s Report for disposal
2005 Elementis Chrome Chrome Independent IndustryReview
2005 Diamond Core Diamonds Independent Competent Person’s Report
2005 Diamond Core Diamonds Fair & Reasonable Statement
2005 Kensington Resources Diamonds Independent Inspection & Certification of Laboratory
2005 Bayer Valuation Chrome Independent
Valuation
for
Economic
Empowerment
Transaction
2005 Pangea Diamonds Diamonds Independent Competent Person’s Report
2005 LionOre International Nickel Tati Nickel Review of Mineral Resources.
Aquarius PSA2 Independent Competent Person’s Report
2005 Aquarius Platinum Marikana Mineral Resources Review.
2005 LionOre International Nickel Nkomati Due Diligence and Transaction Value Calculations.
2005 LionOre International Nickel World Nickel market studyforgroupcorporate work.
2004 Avgold Limited Gold Fair & Reasonable Opinion on the Methodologies applied and
Values attributed to the Mineral Assets of ET Cons
2004 Aquarius Platinum Update of Independent Valuation of Mimosa
2004 Aquarius Platinum Independent
Techno-Economic
Report
and
Fair
and
Reasonable Opinion tot the PIC, DBSA and IDC on the 26%
BEE Transaction for AQPSA – Documentwaived by the JSE.
2004 Mimosa MiningCompany Platinum Mineral Resource and Ore Reserve Review
2004 Zimplats Platinum Zimplats Makwiro Valuation and Corporate Restructuring
2004 Assmang Manganese CGT Valuation
2004 Aquarius Platinum CGT Valuation
2004 Sishen South Iron CGT Valuation
2003 Unki Platinum Project Platinum CGT Valuation
2003 Hernic Ferrochrome (Pty) Ltd, Itochu
Corporation
Chromite Independent valuation of the Satellite Chromite Mine Joint
Venture.
2003 African Diamond Holdings (Pty) Ltd Diamonds Independent techno-economic due diligence and valuation of
African Diamond Holdings marine diamond concessions and
diamond cuttingoperation in Walvis Bay,Namibia.
2003 Unki Platinum Project, Zimbabwe Platinum Techno-Economic Valuation Report & Fair & Reasonable
Opinion
2003 Transvaal Ferrochrome Ltd Ferrochrome Independent Competent Person’s Report and Valuation as a
bankable Document for Australian Stock Exchange
2003 Aquarius Platinum (SA) (Pty) Ltd Platinum Independent Competent Person’s Report and Valuation for the
Everest South Project
2002 Zimbabwe Platinum Mines Ltd Platinum Independent valuation of Zimplats relative to the value of the
ImpalaPlatinum Ltd/AurionGoldLtd transaction.
2002 Mitsubishi Corporation Ferrochrome Expansion Report and Valuation on Hernic Ferrochrome (Pty)
Ltd.
2002 Aquarius Platinum Ltd Platinum Acquisition Report on ZCE Platinum Ltd including the due
diligence andvaluationof MimosaMinein Zimbabwe.
2002 Freddev Gold Valuation of Mineral Rights & Royalties
2002 Barnex Gold Valuation of Mineral Rights & Royalties
2002 Western Areas Gold WA4 Project : Valuation of Mineral Rights & Royalty
Agreement
2002 Mitsubishi Ferrochrome Expansion report and valuation
2002 Aquarius Platinum Acquisition Report
2001 Northam Platinum Valuation
2001 Mitsubishi Corporation Ferrochrome Due Diligence,Valuation and Acquisition Report
2001 Amcol Due Diligence Bentonite Independent due diligence and valuation on G&W
2001 Zimplats Impala Raising Platinum Circular to shareholders valuation report
2000 African Minerals Varied Independent competentperson’s report
2000 Barnato Exploration Limited Varied Competentperson’s report
2000 Durban Deep Gold Independent valuation report
2000 Iscor Limited Varied Independent valuation of exploration assets
1999 HarmonyGold MiningCo Ltd Gold Harmony/ Kalgold / West Rand Cons
1999 Leighton Contractors Tin Pre-feasibilitystudyPemali Tin(Indonesia)
1999 Mitsubishi Ferro-Chrome Techno-economic valuation of Hernic Chrome

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-162 –

135

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY DOCUMENTATION
1998 Barnex Ltd Wits Gold Due diligence
1998 Camco Diamonds Independent Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1998 Crown Mines and DRD Wits Gold Valuation
1998 Egyptian Government Phosphate Due diligence and valuation
1998 Great FitzroyMines Copper Competent Person’s Report and Valuation
1998 Iscor Mining Greenstone Gold Due diligence and valuation
1998 JCI Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1998 Randgold & Exploration Co Ltd Gold Competent Person’s Report
1998 Western Areas Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1997 CBR Mining Coal Due diligence
1997 Durban Roodepoort DeepLtd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1997 G&W Base Bentonite Due diligence
1997 JCI Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1997 Opaline Gold Greenstone Gold Competent Person’s Report
1997 Penumbra Coal Due diligence
1997 Randgold & Exploration Co Ltd Greenstone Gold Competent Person’s Report
1997 Rondebult Colliery Coal Due diligence
1996 African MiningCorporation* Alluvial Gold Project valuation
1996 Australian Platinum Mines NL Platinum Due diligence
1996 Benoni Gold Holdings Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1996 Consolidated Metallurgical Industries Ferrochrome Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1996 Durban Roodepoort DeepLtd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1996 HarmonyGold MiningCo Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1996 JCI Ltd Wits Gold Valuation
1996 Rand Leases Properties Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1996 Randgold & Exploration Co Ltd Wits Gold Due diligence
1995 African Mines Limited* Greenstone Gold Project valuation
1995 Barney-Seidle Arbitration Granite Project valuation arbitration
1995 Mopet Oil* Oil and Gas Market analysis facilitator
1995 Randgold & Exploration Co Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1995 Randgold Durban Deep Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1995 Randgold HarmonyUnisel Merger Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1994 Aurora Exploration Varied - Industrials Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1994 Consolidated MiningCorp Wits Gold Due diligence and valuation
1994 CRA(Australia) Iron Ore Due diligence
1994 Durban Roodepoort DeepLtd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1994 Ghana Gold Mines* Greenstone Gold Due diligence and valuation
1994 Gold Fields of SA Ltd Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1994 Hernic Chrome Ferro-Chrome Valuation and Strategic Analysis
1994 Inca Magnesium Due diligence and valuation
1994 Mitsubishi Ferrochrome Due diligence and valuation
1994 Namco* Diamonds Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1994 Randgold & Exploration Co Ltd Wits Gold Due diligence
1993 Namibia Oil & Gas licence
applications
Oil & Gas Working with Paul Blair licence applications
1993 Atomic EnergyCommission Uranium Strategic Analysis
1993 Eskom Base metals Strategic Analysis
1993 JCI Wits Gold Financial PlanningAnalysis(Rehabilitation)
1993 Lonrho Platinum Financial PlanningAnalysis(Rehabilitation)
1993 Rand Mines Properties Varied Mineral rights evaluation
1992 Barbrook Gold Mines Greenstone Gold Ore resource modellingand mine valuation
1992 Rand Merchant Bank Copper Ore resource modellingandproject valuation
1992 Rembrandt Platinum Mine valuation(Northam Platinum)
1992 West Rand Cons Wits Gold Ore resource modellingand mine valuation
1991 Rand Merchant Bank Wits Gold Ore reserve evaluation(Westonaria Gold Mine)
1991 Rembrandt(Gold Fields of SA) Varied Due diligence,valuation and strategic analysis
1991 Standard Merchant Bank Greenstone Gold Due diligence and valuation(EerstelingGold Mine)
1990 Sequence Oil and Gas Oil & Gas Due Diligence Report
1990 Atomic EnergyCorporation Nuclear Fuels Strategic analysis
1990 Consolidated MiningCorp Wits Gold Due diligence and valuation
1990 Eskom Copper/Zinc Strategic Market Analysis(Toll Smelterpotential)
1990 Freddies Minerals Feldspar - Industrials Due diligence
1990 Industrial MachinerySupplies Coal Strategic analysis and valuation(Bricketting plant)
1990 Knights Gold Mine Wits Gold Competent Person’s Report
1990 Rand Merchant Bank Diamonds Due diligence and valuation(Alluvial Mine)
1990 Corex Oil & Gas Evaluation ofprospectivity
1990 Rand Merchant Bank Lead/Zinc Due diligence and valuation(Miranda Mine)

==> picture [344 x 9] intentionally omitted <==

----- Start of picture text -----

Taung Gold CPR February 2011
----- End of picture text -----

– IV-163 –

136

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY DOCUMENTATION
1990 Rand Mines Varied Corporate Strategic Analysis
1990 Rhogold Wits Gold Ore resource modelling
1990 Rice Rinaldi Coal Due diligence and valuation
1990 Sub Nigel Gold Mine Wits Gold Due diligence and valuation
1990 Zaaiplaats Tin Mine Tin Due diligence and valuation
1989 Avontuur Diamond Mines Diamonds Due diligence and valuation
1989 Granite Consolidated Mining Granite Due diligence and valuation
1989 OspreyGold Mine Greenstone Gold Due diligence and valuation
1989 Rand Leases Gold Mine Wits Gold Ore resource modelling
1989 Rand Merchant Bank* Varied Mineralportfolio analysis(Swanson Rights)
1989 Rhovan Vanadium Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1989 Vanamin Severrin Mining Vanadium Due diligence and valuation
1989 Zimco Andalusite Competent Person’s Report and valuation
1988 Mullet Slate Slate Due diligence and valuation
1988 Rand Merchant Bank Wits Gold Risk assessment analysis(Peritus Exploration)
1988 Wit Nigel Gold Mine Wits Gold Ore resource modelling

Fair and Reasonable Opinions:

YEAR CLIENT SECURITIES
EXCHANGE
IMPLIED
VALUE
DESCRIPTION
TRANSACTION

JURISDICTION
TYPE
(US$m)
2009 Chrometco JSE Acquisition
of
interest

8.3
Independent Professional Expert Report
2009 Metorex JSE Disposal
of
6.3%
interest

5.7
Independent Professional Expert Report
2009 Braemore Resources JSE Acquisition
of
interest

36.3
Independent Professional Expert Report
2007 Diamondcore/BRC JSE Acquisition 50 Independent F&R for Diamondcore
2006 LionOre International TSX Acquisition
notification
documentation.
650 Independent Technical and Valuation Fatal
Flaws Report and F&R opinion for the Board of
LionOre. Notpublished as an F&R.
2005 Diamond Core JSE Category I Merger 10.0 Independent CPR on the mineral assets of
Samadi Resources SA (Pty) Ltd and Diamond
CoreResourcesLimited.
2005 LionOre International TSX Acquisition
notification
documentation.
110.0 Tati Nickel Review of Mineral Resources.
2005 Aquarius JSE 26% BEE 150.0 Independent Techno-Economic Valuation and
Fair and Reasonable Opinion on the PIC, IDC,
DBSA
26%
Empowerment
Transaction.
Documentswaivedforthe secondarylisting.
2004 Barplats JSE Offer
to
Barplats
Minorities

60.0
Offer by Platinum Consortium to take out
Implats. The SRP insisted our report be
prepared in full. In the end Investec wrote the
Fair and Reasonable but was fully reliant upon
the Venmyn work as demonstrated in the
circular.
2004 Zimplats ASX Collapse
of
the
Makwiro
Structure
for shares to Implats.



38.0
Fair
Value
calculation
in
a
corporate
restructure.
2003 Amplats JSE Acquisition
price
calculation for Unki
Platinum.


Confidential
Preparation
of
an
Independent
Techno-
Economic Valuation Report and Fair and
Reasonable Opinion. Document not used as
the transaction became immaterial for reporting
purposes.
2003 Aquarius Platinum
(South Africa) (Pty) Ltd
ASX Opinion on the value
of
a
Refinery
Agreement.


10.0
Fair & Reasonable Opinions for Aquarius
Platinum for the Impala Refinery Commitments.
2002 Consolidated African
Mines Limited.
JSE CAM acquired 40%
of
the
Letseng
diamond
mine
for
CAM shares.



10.0
Preparation
of
an
Independent
Techno-
Economic Valuation Report and Fair and
Reasonable Opinion. Document used in full.
2002 Zimplats ASX Implats
aquired
a
controlling interest in
Zimplats by acquiring
Aurion Gold shares.



50.0
Preparation
of
an
Independent
Techno-
Economic Valuation Report and Fair and
Reasonable Opinion. Document used in full.
2002 Aquarius ASX Aquarius
acquires
65%
in
ZCE
Platinum Limited.


50.0
Preparation
of
an
Independent
Techno-
Economic Valuation Report and Fair and
Reasonable Opinion. Document used in full.

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-164 –

137

2000 DiamondWorks TSX Lyndhurst a South
African
Company
takes
control
of
Canadian
junior
Diamond works.




20.0
Preparation
of
an
Independent
Techno-
Economic Valuation Report and Fair and
Reasonable Opinion. Document used in full and
special representation required in Toronto to
explain the transaction and the assets.
1999 New Mining
Corporation
JSE Listing
and
acquisition
documentation.

50.0
Complicated transaction and full Independent
Techno-Economic Valuation prepared with Fair
and Reasonable Opinion included in our report.
This satisfied the JSE and the SRP.
1996 West Witwatersrand
Gold Holdings Limited
JSE Section 440k Offer 20.0 Independent Competent Persons Report on the
Offer by Durban Deep to West Wits under
Section 440k. Document included in circulars to
both shareholders. Our Fair and Reasonable
Opinion was specificallyrequested by the SRP.

Key Qualifications and Description:

Mr Clay has been a serving professional in the minerals industry since 1977 when he undertook field mapping and a professional apprenticeship within the Rhodesian Geological Survey. This was at a time when fieldwork and practical application of geological principals was still fundamental to the development of geology as a science. Following this, Mr Clay has dedicated his career to the commercial incorporation of first principles scientific process to the description, reporting and valuation of mineral assets.

Having worked for a number of years with mining companies, both underground and in corporate, Mr Clay became a founding member of Venmyn in 1988. At this time the company was closely associated with Rand Merchant Bank. This relationship enabled him to pursue the process of linking technical and financial valuation. Since that time Mr Clay has been involved in growing Venmyn and is presently the Managing Director and major shareholder.

He has been involved in developing a style of reporting at Venmyn which has become internationally recognised as compliant shorter form reporting. The emphasis of the work is on concise and graphical reporting, bullet points and descriptive graphics for ease of presentation and shareholder appreciation.

He has been involved in the writing of numerous codes the South African Code for the Reporting of Mineral Resources and Reserves (SAMREC Code) and is currently on the committee writing the South African Code for the Valuation of mineral projects (SAMVAL Code). He is presently involved in the oil and gas industry where his expertise in valuation is being used to determine the relationship between the reporting methodologies in this industry relative to the rest of the mineral industry.

Mr Clay’s key areas of expertise lie in the detailed financial valuation of mineral and mining projects using discounted cash flow models. In this regard he has undertaken over 25 valuations for eight different commodities over the last four years. Details of the valuations and other assignments are tabled above. These valuations have been used in listing and merger documentation both in local and international stock exchanges and for the private use of the companies concerned.

Education:

DEGREE/DIPLOMA FIELD INSTITUTION YEAR
B. Sc Hons. Geology UniversityCollege Cardiff 1976
M. Sc. Econ. Geol. Economic Geology
(awarded Corstorphine Medal for Best M.Sc. Thesis)
University of the Witwatersrand 1981
GDE Graduate Diploma in MiningEngineering Universityof the Witwatersrand 1986
M. Sc. MiningEngineering Universityof the Witwatersrand 1988
Dip. Bus. M. Diploma in Business Management Damelin College 1983
Tax Mgmt Tax Management and Planning Universityof the Witwatersrand 1988

Employment Record:

Taung Gold CPR
February 2011
POSITION
COMPANY
Managing Director
and Founding
partner
Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd
POSITION COMPANY JOB DESCRIPTION DURATION
Managing Director
and Founding
partner
Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd Mr Clay serves as the Managing Director of Venmyn and is
responsible for the company’s strategic process as well as
finances, budgeting and operations;
Venmyn operates as a techno-economic consultancy for the
resources industry on a world wide basis;
Mr Clay has been a key member of the SAMREC Working
Group,responsibleforcompiling the SAMREC Code;
1997 –
present

– IV-165 –

138

**POSITION ** COMPANY **JOB DESCRIPTION ** **DURATION **
Served on the JSE/SAMREC working committee for the
development of the JSE Section 12 requirements;
Serves on the Readers Panel for the JSE;
Mr Clay is director of the advisory business and provides
hands-on services to all the company’s major clients;
His expertise in financial valuation is particularly appropriate
for ensuring market to market presentation of both the
technical and financial issues of resources projects;
Course leader for the Witwatersrand University and
Continuing Education programme on Compliance in the
Minerals Industry; and
Mr Clay has a special interest in the proposed International
Accounting Standards “IAS” Extractive Industries rules for
determining NAV and NPV calculations in the minerals
industry.
General Manager RMB Resources
Rand Merchant Bank
Continuing business functions detailed below;
Also valuing, managing and marketing investment projects
of the Resources division including deal structuring and
corporate finance.
1996 – 1997
Managing Director
and founding
partner
Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd Techno-economic evaluation of a wide range of mineral
resource projects using cashflow, market capitalisation,
optionpricingand other comparative methods.
1987 – 1996
Senior Geologist Rand Mines Ltd Resident senior gold mine geologist responsible for the
development and implementation of modern computerised
ore reserve evaluation techniques at Harmony Gold Mine
and Durban Roodepoort Deep Gold Mine.
Transferred to head office where he was responsible for all
gold mine ore reserve valuation functions. This computer
work involved the development and planning of very large
databases for orebodymodelling.
1981 – 1988
Senior Geologist Zimro (Pty) Ltd
(Industrial Minerals Division of
AAC)
Market development and application of a wide range of
industrial and base minerals.
1979 – 1981
Geologist Geological Survey of
Zimbabwe
Mapped a 100 km² area of granite-greenstone terrain and
assisted in the compilation of a Bulletin over the area.
Assisted the small mining sector with geological advice on
gold,copper, gemstones and industrial minerals.
1975 – 1979

Languages:

English: Excellent Afrikaans: Fair Certification:

I, the undersigned, certify that to the best of my knowledge and belief, these data correctly describe my qualifications, and experience.

==> picture [51 x 49] intentionally omitted <==

Date:11[th] February 2011

Full name of staff member: Andrew Neil Clay

February 2011

Taung Gold CPR

– IV-166 –

139

COMPETENT PERSONS CERTIFICATES

Proposed Position: Advisor Name of Firm: Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd Name of Staff: Fiona Harper Profession: Geologist Date of Birth: 31 January 1957 Years with Firm/Entity: Joined May 2007 Nationality: British

Membership in Professional Societies:

CLASS CLASS PROFESSIONALSOCIETY PROFESSIONALSOCIETY **YEAROF REGISTRATION **
Member Geological Societyof South Africa 2007
Member Professional Natu ral Scientist 2008
Detailed Tasks Assigned:
YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY TYPE OF STUDY PROJECT DESCRIPTION
2010 Colonial Resource Gold CPR and Valuation JORC, National Instrument 43-101 compliant CPR and
Valuation
2009 Lithic Metals and
Energy
Uranium, nickel,
zinc
CPR SAMREC compliant CPR on Togo, Zambia and
Mozambique assetsfor AIM listing
2009 TaungGold Gold CPR and Valuation TaungGreenfieldprojects CPR for JSE Listing
2009 TaungGold Gold CPR and Valuation Evander Gold Mine for JSE Listing
2009 TaungGold Gold CPR and Valuation Jeanette Gold Mine CPR for JSE listing
2009 Lithic Metals and
Energy
Uranium, nickel,
zinc
Technical and
ProspectivityReview
Independent review of assets in Togo, Zambia ,
Mozambique and South Africa
2009 G&B Resources Potash,
Phosphate,
Uranium, nickel,
zinc, coal
Technical and
Prospectivity Review
Independent review of assets in Togo, Zambia ,
Mozambique and South Africa
2009 Sephaku Holdings Fluorspar CPR and Valuation SAMREC compliant CPR on Dinokeng Fluorspar project
for JSE Listing
2009 Platmin Pty Ltd Platinum CPR and Valuation NI and SAMREC Compliant CPR on Mphahlele for JSE
andTSX Listing
2009 Platmin Pty Ltd Platinum CPR and Valuation NI and SAMREC Compliant CPR on PPM for JSE and
TSX Listing
2009 Platmin Pty Ltd Platinum CPR and Valuation NI and SAMREC Compliant CPR on Grootboom for JSE
andTSX Listing
2009 Platmin Pty Ltd Platinum CPR and Valuation NI and SAMREC Compliant CPR for Loskop for JSE and
TSX Listing
2009 Platmin Pty Ltd Platinum CPR and Valuation NI and SAMREC Compliant CPR on numerous platinum
projectsforJSEandTSX Listing
2009 African Precious
Minerals
Gold Technical Statement Summary Technical Statement for Monarch Gold Mine
Mozambique
2008 Abalengani Platinum CPR and Valuation CPR for listingof tailings re-treatmentproject
2008 TaungGold Limited Gold CPR and Valuation Consolidated CPR of six mineral assets for JSE Listing
2008 African Minerals Diamonds Prospectivity review
and valuation
Prospectivity Review and valuation of exploration
licences
2008 African Minerals Diamonds CPR and Valuation CPR and valuation of operatingalluvial mine
2008 Quinisele Resources Lead Zinc Due Diligence Due Diligence of a mine in Zambia
2008 African Mineral
Trading and
Exploration(Pty)Ltd
Tantalite Competent Persons
Report
Preparation of CPR on mineral resources and refinery
for proposed 2008 listing
2008 African Mineral
Trading and
Exploration(Pty)Ltd
Tantalite Sample Trail Audit Current- design of sample trail audit and exploration
protocols for Mozambique tantalite operation
2008 Kimberley
Consolidated Mining
Limited
Diamonds Sample Trail Audit Current- design of an internationally compliant sample
trail audit and exploration programme protocol for KCM's
mining operations andresource defining exploration
2008 Kimberley
Consolidated Mining
Limited
Diamonds Presentation for JSE
and Investor Panels
Preparation and presentation of technical and economic
parameters of the KCM operation
2008 Ukuvula Diamonds Prospectivity Review Prospectivity of alluvial and primary kimberlite deposits
in the Christiana and Warrenton area of South Africa
2008 Kimberley
Consolidated Mining
limited
Diamonds Prospectivity Review Alluvial diamond deposits on the Harts River South
Africa
2008 CVS Management Copper and
gold
Prospectivity Review Copper and gold prospects in the Middle Atlas, Morocco
2008 Signature Brands Gold,uranium ProspectivityReview ProspectivityReport on sixgold,uranium and base

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-167 –

140

YEAR CLIENT COMMODITY TYPE OF STUDY PROJECT DESCRIPTION
Limited and base
metals
metals prospects in greenstone belts, Uganda
2007 The Rohatyn Group Platinum Due Diligence High level Due Diligence of the Wesizwe Platinum
Project in the Bushveld Igneous Complex, South Africa.
Examination of legal, technical, processing and
economic studies to give comfort for proposed Rohatyn
investment
2007 Lindhurst Mining Iron ore Prospectivity Review Prospectivity review of iron ore deposits in near Honde
Mozambique
2007 Lindhurst Mining Iron ore ProspectivityReview Prospectivityreview of iron oreprospects in Brazil
2007 Matterhorn
Investments
Uranium and
base metals
Prospectivity Review Prospectivity Report on four uranium and base metals
prospects in Zambia
2007 Caledonia Mining
Corporation
Gold Information
Memorandum
Information Memorandum for the Proposed Disposal by
CaledoniaMining CorporationoftheBarbrookGoldMine
2007 Caledonia Mining
Corporation
Gold Information
Memorandum
Information Memorandum for the Proposed Disposal by
Caledonia Mining Corporation of the Eersteling Gold
Mine
2007 Uramin Gold and Base
Metals
Prospectivity Review Prospectivity Report on the Adjaria Gold and Base
Metals Prospect,Adjaria,Georgia
2007 Rockwell Diamonds
Inc
Alluvial
Diamonds
NI43-101 Compilation and Conversion to NI41-101 of the
Technical Advisors Report Trans Hex Group Limited’s
Middle Orange River Operations South Africa.
2007 Energem Diamonds Competent Persons
Report for AIM
Compilation of the Competent Persons Report on the
Diamond and Oil and Gas Assets of Energem in CAR
and Chadfor listing on AIM
2007 Kimberley
Consolidated Mining
Diamonds Sampling protocols and
Exploration Programme
Sampling Protocols and Proposed Drilling Programme
for The Shone Kimberlite in Cater Block for Kimberley
ConsolidatedMining
2007 Kimberley
Consolidated Mining
Diamonds Competent Persons
Report (SAMREC) for
JSE
Compilation of Independent Techno-Economic Valuation
Report in the Form of a Competent Person’s Report
Prepared for the Mineral Assets of Kimberley
Consolidated MiningLimited for listingon the JSE
1980
1984
De Beers Diamonds Research Report Four year comprehensive research project on De Beers
kimberlite pipes in Botswana including petrographic,
mineralogical, mineral chemistry and whole rock
geochemistry.
1982 De Beers Diamonds Research study Research project as part of a post graduate study on
carbonatites in Namibia and their genetic relationship to
kimberlites

Key Qualifications:

Fiona Harper studied at the University of the Witwatersrand and her major subjects were geology and geography. As part of her studies she undertook geochemical studies of chromitites in the Bushveld Igneous Complex. She worked for Anglo American Research Laboratories where she was responsible for all the geochemical and mineral chemistry analysis for the exploration teams and mine operations of De Beers in Botswana, as well as the forward looking research on the genesis and economic potential of all the kimberlites in Botswana. She undertook a three year research project on the geochemistry of carbonatites in Namibia. She joined Venmyn in 2007 as an Advisor and has specialised in creating compliant CPRs for listings on the JSE and international stock exchanges.

Education:

DEGREE/DIPLOMA FIELD INSTITUTION YEAR
B.Sc Geologyand Geography Universityof the Witwatersrand 1977
B.Sc(Hons) Geology Universityof the Witwatersrand 1977

Employment Record:

POSITION COMPANY JOB DESCRIPTION DURATION
Senior Research
Mineralogist
Anglo American Research
Laboratories
Petrographic, mineral chemistry, geochemical analysis of
samples for both base metal and diamonds exploration
teams.
Research project on 7kimberlites in Botswana
Researchproject on carbonatites in Namibia
1978--1983

Languages: English: Excellent Afrikaans: Fair

Taung Gold CPR February 2011

– IV-168 –

141

Certification:

I, the undersigned, certify that to the best of my knowledge and belief, the above summary correctly describes my qualifications, and experience.

==> picture [61 x 31] intentionally omitted <==

Date: 11[th] February 2011

Full name of staff member: Fiona Jane Harper

Taung Gold CPR

February 2011

– IV-169 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The following is the text of a report prepared for the purpose of incorporation in this circular received from BMI Appraisals Limited, an independent valuer, in connection with its valuation as at 30 April 2011 of the fair market value of the 100% interest in the gold mine projects named Evander Project and Jeanette Project, located in the Republic of South Africa.

33[rd] Floor, Shui On Centre, Nos. 6-8 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong 香港灣仔港灣道6-8號瑞安中心33樓

www.bmi-appraisals.com

28 July 2011

The Directors Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower 8 Yeung Uk Road Tsuen Wan New Territories Hong Kong

Dear Sirs,

INSTRUCTIONS

We refer to the instructions from Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (referred to as the ‘‘Company’’) for us to provide our opinion on the fair market value of the 100% interest in the gold mine projects named Evander Project and Jeanette Project (collectively referred to as the ‘‘Gold Mines’’), located in the Republic of South Africa (referred to as ‘‘South Africa’’) as at 30 April 2011.

This report presents on the basis of valuation, the background of the Gold Mines, an industry overview, the source of information, the scope of work and the valuation assumptions. It also explains the valuation methodology utilized and presents our conclusion of value.

BASIS OF VALUATION

Our valuation has been carried out in accordance with the ‘‘Code for the Technical Assessment and Valuation of Mineral and Petroleum Assets and Securities for Independent Expert Reports’’ (VALMIN Code).

– V-1 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The valuation has been carried out on the basis of fair market value. Fair market value is defined as ‘‘the amount of money (or the cash equivalent of some other consideration) determined for which an asset change hands on the valuation date in an open and unrestricted market between a willing buyer and a willing seller in an arm’s length transaction, with each party acting knowledgeably, prudently and without compulsion’’.

BACKGROUND OF THE GOLD MINES

The Evander Project and the Jeanette Project are the primary assets held by Taung Gold Limited (referred to as ‘‘Taung’’). Taung is principally engaged in exploration and development of gold and associated minerals in South Africa. Taung holds prospecting rights in respect of various gold exploration projects in Mpumalanga, Limpopo, Gauteng, North West and Free State Provinces of South Africa. The mineral assets have been consolidated into a focused entity whose intention is to develop its two highly prospective flagship projects, Evander Project and Jeanette Project. Evander Project and Jeanette Project are gold exploration projects for which scoping studies (referred to as the ‘‘Scoping Studies’’) have been completed and for which Pre-Feasibility Studies (referred to as the ‘‘PFS’’) and Bankable Feasibility Studies (referred to as the ‘‘BFS’’) have been commissioned. As advised by the Company, the PFS is in progress and is expected to meet the schedule to be finalized in the 1st quarter in year 2012.

Evander Project is located within the eastern Evander Goldfield on the northeastern limb of the Witwatersrand Basin. Evander comprises of two adjacent areas, namely Six Shaft Area and Twistdraai Area, which collectively occupies an area of 5,129 ha. According to a technical report (referred to as the ‘‘Competent Person’s Report’’) prepared by an independent technical advisor, Venmyn Rand (Pty) Ltd. (referred to as the ‘‘Competent Person’’) dated 11 February 2011, Evander holds a mining right (mining right no.: MP30/5/ 1/2/2/126MR Mining Right 107/2010). The total probable reserve of Evander was 8,640,000 tonnes.

Jeanette Project is situated northeast of Welkom on the southwest margin of the Witwatersrand Basin and in the Free State Province of South Africa. According to Competent Person’s Report, Jeanette holds a prospecting right (prospecting right no: FS30/ 5/1/1/2/895PR) with an area of 3,886 ha. The total probable reserve of Jeanette was 22,254,000 tonnes.

Mining Area
JORC Classification
Evander Project
Probable
Jeanette Project
Probable
Total:
Probable
Tonnes (t)
8,640,000
22,254,000
30,894,000

– V-2 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

Global Gold Industry

According to World Gold Council, the annual gold demand of 3,812 tonnes in year 2010 has reached a ten year high. Despite of the 26% increase in annual average gold price as compared to the previous year, the full year demand in year 2010 was up 9% within the same period.

The gold demand can be divided into three categories: jewellery, technology (including electronics, other industrial and dentistry) and investment. Jewellery consistently accounts for the largest share of final demand at around 54% of total gold demand in year 2010. Technology accounts for about 11% and the remaining portion in year 2010 was investment demand.

Based on the World Gold Council’s latest report for the year 2010, the average yearly gold price of US$1,224.5 per ounce was 26% above the average of year 2009 and 40% above that of year 2008. The growth in the previous year was due to a strong recovery growth in jewellery demand of 17%, a solid growth in technology of 12% and a slight decline in investment of 2%.

The annual supply of gold comes from mine production, recycled gold scraps and net sales of gold by central banks, which together amount to 4,108 tonnes, of which around 2,543 tonnes of the total supply came from mine production.

Details of gold demand and supply are shown as below:

Unit: Tonnes
Supply
Mine production
Net producer
hedging
Total Mine Supply
Official Sector Sales
Recycled Gold
Total Supply:
Demand
Jewellery
Technology
Investment
Total Demand:
2009
2,584
-252
2,332
30
1,672
2010
2,659
-116
2,543
-87
1,653
Q3’2009
682
-97
586
-11
297
Q4’2009
676
-125
552
-13
403
Q3’2010
702
-67
635
-20
384
Q4’2010
695
-37
658
13
470
% Change
Q4’2010 vs
Q4’2009
3

19

17
% Change
2010 vs
2009
3

9

1
4,034 4,108 872 942 999 1,141 21 2
1,760
373
1,360
2,060
420
1,333
490
97
241
511
103
244
541
108
294
575
104
276
13
1
13
17
12
-2
3,493 3,812 828 858 943 956 11 9

Source: GFMS

– V-3 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The closing gold price in United States dollars per ounce from year 2002 till present is shown in the graph below:

==> picture [415 x 219] intentionally omitted <==

Source: Bloomberg

The price of gold has been increasing consistently and is expected to remain strong for the incoming years.

Gold Mining Industry in South Africa

South Africa remains in a dominant position as one of the world’s largest gold producers, despite its continuous decline in production for the current decade. In year 2008, South Africa had a 14.5% decline in the gold output because of the electricity crisis. However, in year 2009, the drop was not so significant at 5.8%. Nonetheless, gold mining has played a significant role in establishing the economy of South Africa over a century. The gold industry brought in a huge earnings as the country’s income source. This made this segment of the industry the second largest exporter behind platinum metals.

– V-4 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

South Africa is also one of the countries with the top three amounts of reserves. The following chart illustrates the global distribution of gold reserves:

National Distribution in Gold Reserves

==> picture [391 x 244] intentionally omitted <==

Source: USGS, 2011

SOURCE OF INFORMATION

For the purpose of our valuation, we have been furnished with the information in respect of the Gold Mines provided by the senior management of the Company. The valuation required the consideration of all pertinent factors, including, but not limited to, the following:

  • . The nature of the Gold Mines including the industry sector and the geographical location in which the Gold Mines are currently exposed to or will be exposed to;

  • . The information in respect of the Gold Mines provided by the senior management of the Company;

  • . The information in respect of the Gold Mines as stated in the Competent Person’s Report;

  • . The specific economic environment and competition for the market in which the Gold Mines are currently exposed to or will be exposed to; and

  • . The financial and business risks that will materially affect the operation of the Gold Mines.

– V-5 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

SCOPE OF WORK

In the course of our valuation work, the following processes have been conducted to evaluate the reasonableness of the adopted basis and assumptions provided by the senior management of the Company:

  • . Conducted on-site inspections to investigate the Gold Mines;

  • . Interviews with the senior management of the Company and Taung to obtain all relevant information in respect of the Gold Mines;

  • . Examined the relevant bases and assumptions of the information in respect of the Gold Mines provided by the senior management of the Company;

  • . Examined the relevant bases and assumptions of the information in respect of the Gold Mines as stated in the Competent Person’s Report;

  • . Conducted appropriate research to obtain sufficient market data and statistical figures and prepared the valuation based on generally accepted valuation procedures and practices; and

  • . Presented the basis of valuation, the background of the Gold Mines, an industry overview, the source of information, the scope of work, the valuation assumptions, the valuation methodology and our conclusion of value in this report.

VALUATION ASSUMPTIONS

Due to the changing environment in which the Gold Mines are currently exposed to or will be exposed to, the following assumptions have been adopted in order to sufficiently support our conclusion of value:

  • . All requisite licenses and permits issued by any authorized entities that will materially affect the operation of the Gold Mines have been obtained or can be obtained upon request;

  • . There will be no material change in the political, legal, fiscal, technological, market and economic conditions in the jurisdiction where the Gold Mines are currently exposed to or will be exposed to;

  • . The core operation of the Gold Mines will not differ materially from those of present or expected;

  • . The information in respect of the Gold Mines has been prepared on a reasonable basis after due and careful consideration by the senior management of the Company;

– V-6 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

  • . The information in respect of the Gold Mines as stated in the Competent Person’s Report have been prepared on a reasonable basis after due and careful considerations by the Competent Person; and

  • . There will be no human disruptions or natural disasters that will materially affect the operation of the Gold Mine.

ON-SITE INSPECTION

On-site inspections were conducted from 28 April 2011 to 2 May 2011 in both project areas, the Evander Project (Fig. 1) and Jeanette Project (Fig. 2). At the time of the visit, both projects were undergoing pre-feasibility study and the exploration program with 2 drill rigs and 1 drill rig actively drilling at the Evander Project and Jeanette Project respectively (Fig. 3). Mr. Godfrey Griffin, the Exploration Manager of the Evander Project introduced the project status, current exploration and project development plan of Evander to us on 30 April 2011. Drill cores (Fig. 4) of the current exploration project and the previous mining infrastructure, e.g. the No. 6 Main shaft (Fig. 1) were shown to us. Mr. James Wilson, the Exploration Manager of the Jeanette Project showed us the previous drillholes, (Fig. 5) which were drilled by Anglogold America and purchased by Taung, and explained the current exploration and project development plan of the Jeanette Project in the field area on 1 May 2011.

– V-7 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

We believe that the database, geological works, and relevant technical reports and scoping study conducted in both projects are up to international standard and have a relative high-level of confidence. However, a pre-feasibility study is required to have a clearer picture of each aspect of the projects.

==> picture [174 x 235] intentionally omitted <==

  • Fig. 1: The No. 6 Shaft of the Evander Project. The shaft will be renovated when the project commences production.

==> picture [333 x 222] intentionally omitted <==

  • Fig. 2: The core farm and field office of the Jeanette Project. The core farm has stored over 20,000m of drill cores of the Jeanette Project.

– V-8 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

==> picture [333 x 222] intentionally omitted <==

  • Fig. 3: Drill site with very good safety and environment management at the Evander project.

==> picture [333 x 222] intentionally omitted <==

  • Fig. 4: Core trays of the 2011 drilling program of the Evander Project are stored properly at the core farm near the office next to the No.6 Shaft.

– V-9 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

==> picture [333 x 222] intentionally omitted <==

  • Fig. 5: Mineralized intercept which obtains 50.4 g/t over a length of *20cm (i.e. 1m at 10g/t roughly) from an old drillhole of the Jeanette Project.

VALUATION METHODOLOGY

The Valuation Approaches

The following generally accepted valuation approaches have been considered in the valuation:

  1. The cost approach provides an indication of value based on the principle that an informed buyer would pay no more than the cost of producing a substitute asset with equal utility as the subject asset;

  2. The market approach provides an indication of value by comparing the subject asset to similar assets that have been sold in the market, with appropriate adjustments for the differences between the assets; and

  3. The income approach provides an indication of value based on the principle that an informed buyer would pay no more than the present value of anticipated future economic benefits generated by the subject asset.

Among the three approaches, the cost approach was regarded not appropriate in the valuation, as it only considers the costs of recreating the Gold Mines and the costs may not represent the market value since it does not directly incorporate information about the economic benefits contributed by the underlying asset. While for market approach, the value mainly is determined by an approximate transaction price in the market as a reference. As it is concerned that available public information in the market generally involves specific buyers’ consideration involves a premium or discount under corresponding

– V-10 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

unique circumstances. This makes it difficult to know if the price paid truly represents the approximate value of the underlying asset. Thus, the income approach was considered to be the most appropriate valuation approach in this valuation, as it takes the future growth potential and asset-specific issues of the Gold Mines into consideration.

Under the income approach, the Discounted Cash Flow (DCF) method was adopted. In applying the DCF method, the free cash flows for each year in the future were determined. The results were then discounted using a discount rate, or the cost of capital, to determine the present value of the expected cash flows.

Reserves

As stated in the Competent Person’s Report, Evander Project consists of measured indicated and inferred resources while Jeanette Project consists of indicated and inferred resources. The mineral resources were being converted to probable mineral reserves by applying consideration factors such as pillar loss, mining loss, dilution and mine call factor etc. Only measured and indicated resources are taken into account of the conversion from mineral resources to probable reserves. And the amounts of estimated probable reserves as stated in the Competent Person’s Report were adopted in the valuation.

The consolidated mineral resource estimate and the probable reserves estimate of Evander and Jeanette are presented respectively in the table below:

Mining Area
Evander Project
Jeanette Project
Total:
Total Mineral
Resources
(Tonnes)
29,557,000
62,910,000
92,467,000
Probable Reserves
(Tonnes)
8,640,000
22,254,000
30,894,000

Production Schedule

According to the Competent Person’s Report, both Evander Project and Jeanette Project are expected to start its production in year 2015. Based on the total estimated reserve and the production capacity of the Gold Mines, the mine life would approximately end in year 2027 and year 2030 for Evander Project and Jeanette Project respectively. The following tables are the ore production schedule as extracted from the Competent Person’s Report for Evander Project and Jeanette Project respectively:

(i) Production Schedule of Evander Project:

Year 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022
Units
(Million Tonnes) 0.09 0.18 0.18 0.17 0.19 0.25 0.68 1.09

Source: Competent Person’s Report

– V-11 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

With reference to the Competent Person’s Report, the average annual ore production would be 1,150,000 tonnes per annum for years after 2022.

  • (ii) Production Schedule of Jeanette Project:
Year 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019
Units (Tonnes) 6,283 132,435 920,599 1,599,926 1,618,186

Source: Competent Person’s Report

With reference to the Competent Person’s Report, the average annual ore production would be 1,630,000 tonnes per annum for years after 2019.

Operating Cost

According to the Competent Person’s Report, the estimated operating costs of Evander Project is US$80.88 per tonne and that of Jeanette Project is US$74.48 per tonne. The detailed breakdown of the corresponding operating costs as extracted from the Competent Person’s Report please refers to the following tables:

  • (i) Operating Cost of Evander Project:
Description
Mining Costs
Processing Cost (Excluding Services)
Analytical Cost (Excluding Services)
Smelting and Treatment Charges
Services
Administration and Overhead Costs
Total Operating Cost:
Operating Cost
(US$/t)
52.71
4.88
0.19
0.58
11.28
11.24
80.88

Source: Competent Person’s Report

– V-12 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

  • (ii) Operating Cost of Jeanette Project:
Description
Mining Costs
Analytical Costs
Processing Costs
Smelting/Treatment Charges
Administration/Overheads and Services
Total Operating Cost:
Operating Cost
(US$/t)
54.37
11.31
0.08
0.10
8.62
74.48

Source: Competent Person’s Report

Investment in Capital Expenditure

According to the Competent Person’s Report, the estimated capital expenditure of Evander Project is US$629,922,000 and that of Jeanette Project is US$1,034,078,471. The detailed breakdown of the corresponding capital expenditure as extracted from the Competent Person’s Report please refers to the following tables:

  • (i) Capital Expenditure of Evander Project:
Description
Phase 0 — Studies
Phase 1 — Dewater Mine and Upper Level Steep Production
Phase 2 — Sub-vertical Shaft
Phase 3 — Twistdraai Incline Shaft
Possible savings on second hand equipment
Exploration drilling programme
Project Development Capital Estimate
Sustaining Capital — Engineering and Projects
Total Capital Expenditure:
Capital
Expenditure
(US$’000)
10,310
132,114
438,878
0
-20,000
6,190
40,867
21,563
629,922

Source: Competent Person’s Report

– V-13 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

  • (ii) Capital Expenditure of Jeanette Project:
Description
Feasibility Study
Exploration Drilling and 3D Seismic Survey
Mining Capex
Plant and Other Infrastructure
Contingency
Ongoing Capex
Total Capital Expenditure:
Capital
Expenditure
(US$)
10,244,625
19,033,638
651,724,320
181,381,118
73,391,362
98,303,408
1,034,078,471

Source: Competent Person’s Report

Gold Price

The forecasted gold price in 2015 is US$1,700 per troy ounce, with reference to the median forecast of 12 analysts (analysts of reputable financial institutions such as Credit Agricole, FastMarkets and Standard Chartered etc.) polled by Thomson Reuters. The forecast was based on the global political and economic environment as well as demand and supply of gold consumption. These 12 analysts are reputable and competent financial institutions that have in-depth knowledge in the metal and mining industry. Although the average gold price in 2010 was around US$1,225, recently in 2011 the gold price had already reached around US$1,500. Moreover, the historical compounded annual growth rate over the last 10 years (i.e. from 2000 to 2010) is approximately 16%, and a gold price of US$1,700 that has been forecasted for 4 years later (i.e. in 2015) only represents a compounded annual growth rate of approximately 3%, which is a much lower rate compared to the historical price growth rate. The trend of the historical and forecast price of gold is shown in the graph as below:

The Trend of the Historical and Forecast Price of Gold, 1985–2015

==> picture [365 x 196] intentionally omitted <==

Source: Bloomberg Terminal and Thomson Reuters

– V-14 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The Comparable Companies

The fair market value of the Gold Mines was determined with reference to the information of publicly listed companies that are considered to be comparable to the Gold Mines (referred to as the ‘‘Comparable Companies’’). Details of the Comparable Companies are as follows:

Name of the Comparable Companies

Bloomberg Ticker

  1. AngloGold Ashanti Limited ANG SJ EQUITY 2. Harmony Gold Mining Company HAR SJ EQUITY 3. Gold Fields Limited GFI SJ EQUITY 4. DRDGOLD Limited DRD SJ EQUITY

The above Comparable Companies are selected based on the following criteria:

  • (i) The companies’ principal businesses were located in the South Africa;

  • (ii) The companies were principally engaged in the gold mining business; and

  • (iii) The financial information of the companies are publicly available.

The above selected Comparable Companies were considered as the most fair and representative comparables.

The Discount Rate

The Weighted Average Cost of Capital (WACC) is the required return on the capital investment of a company. The cost of capital will be different for each source of capital and class of securities a company has, reflecting the different risks. The WACC is the weighted average of the costs of each of the different types of capital. The weights on each of these components reflect their fair market value proportions. The WACC was computed using the following formula:

WACC = Re (E/(D+E)) + Rd (1 – Tc )(D/(D+E))

Where:

WACC = Weighted average cost of capital Re = Cost of equity Rd = Cost of debt Tc = Corporate tax rate E = Market value of the firm’s equity D = Market value of the firm’s debt

– V-15 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The WACC comprises two components: the cost of equity and the cost of debt. The cost of equity was determined using the Capital Asset Pricing Model (CAPM). The CAPM describes the relationship between the risk of a particular asset, its market price and the expected return to the investor, that investors required additional return to compensate additional risk associated. The CAPM was computed using the following formula:

Re = Rf +b* MRP

Where:

Re = Cost of equity
Rf = Risk-free rate
b = Beta coefficient
MRP = Market risk premium

As the South Africa government bonds are not actually default-free, the yield rate of the 10-year United States Treasury Bonds of 3.29% as extracted from Bloomberg was adopted as the long term risk-free rate in the valuation of business or asset with long projected life.

The beta coefficient measures the systematic risk of an asset relative to the overall market. To determine the beta coefficient, the unlevered betas of the Comparable Companies were calculated by removing the effects of financial leverage from the betas as extracted from Bloomberg. The average of the unlevered betas of the Comparable Companies was then being relevered based on the expected weight of debt applied in the valuation. Thus, the beta coefficients were calculated as 0.458.

The market risk premium represents the additional return required by an investor as compensation for investing in equities rather than a risk-free instrument. In the valuation, the market risk premium of South Africa of 6.93%. The market risk premium of the United States was determined with reference to the Risk Premia over Time Report 2010 published by Ibbotson Associates and the country risk premium of South Africa was estimated with reference to relative volatility between S&P 500 Index and equity index of South Africa.

Having considered that the Gold Mines are located in the South Africa, the principle of purchasing power parity is applied to convert the cost of equity in terms of United States dollars into a cost of equity in terms of local currency. Furthermore, an additional premium of 3.50% was added to the cost of equity after careful consideration in respect of the specific status, conditions and risk factors of the Gold Mines.

The cost of debt of 9.00% as extracted from Bloomberg was determined based on the expected lending rate in South Africa. Since the interest paid on debts are tax-deductible expense, the cost of the company to obtain debt funds is less than the required rate of return of the suppliers of the debt capital. The after-tax cost of debt was calculated by multiplying one minus the corporate tax rate of the tax rate of the Gold Mines by the cost of debt. The after-tax cost of debt was 6.26%.

– V-16 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

The weight of debt of 7.61% was determined by the average of the weights of debt of the comparable companies, assuming the weight of debt of the Gold Mines moves toward that of the average of the comparable companies over time as the average weight provides an indication on capital structure of the industry.

As a result, the WACC of the Gold Mines was calculated as 13.04% and it was applied on the estimated future cash flows to arrive at the present value of cash flows.

The Discount for the Lack of Marketability

The concept of marketability deals with the liquidity of an ownership interest, that is, how quickly and easily it can be converted into cash if the owner chooses to sell. The discount for lack of marketability is a downward adjustment factor applied on the present value of cash flows to reflect the business’s or asset’s marketability in order to determine the fair market value.

15% has been adopted as the discount for the lack of marketability for controlling interest. The discount for lack of marketability is considered fair and reasonable after considering i) the average rate obtained from relevant studies on discount on lack of marketability for controlling interest; ii) the fact that gold mines in South Africa is relatively marketable.

RISK FACTORS

  • . Reliance on the Reserves Estimate

The valuation is dependent, to a large extent on the amount of estimated reserves as stated in the Competent Person’s Report as it is the only source of operating income of the Gold Mines. Any change of the reserves amount requires relevant adjustments and the valuation result would differ. As mentioned in the Competent Person’s Report, both PFS on Evander Project and Jeanette Project have not been completed yet, the reserves calculation is mainly relied on the Scoping Study. There is potential that the reserves maybe adjusted after the PFS when a more detailed mine plan, more detailed investigations and studies will be ready.

  • . Consideration on the Natural Barrier of Evander Project

There comes into concern that there is potential influx of underground water into the Evander Project. Although there is a natural barrier present to prevent such issue, the effectiveness of the natural barrier can only be more clearly addressed when the PFS or even BFS is ready.

  • . Granting of the Mining License of Jeanette Project

Jeanette Project currently holds a prospecting right (prospecting right no: FS30/5/1/1/ 2/895PR) with an area of 3,886 ha. The Company and legal opinion has advised that the mining license of Jeanette Project could be obtained without substantial time and cost. Such factor has been taken into account in the valuation.

– V-17 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

  • . Potential Geotechnical Challenge at Jeanette Project

The targeted Basal Reef at Jeanette Project is overlain by a succession of quartzite and Khaki Shale. The thickness of the Khaki Shale in the target area can be up to 2.8m. The proximity of the Shale to the Basal Reef varies across the property and may result in unfavourable geotechnical conditions. The Company is actively pursuing a risk mitigation approach to this matter and the results of this work will be applied during the PFS and BFS.

UPSIDE POTENTIAL OF THE GOLD MINES

  • . Additional drilling is expected to upgrade the inferred resources to indicated category upon full PFS and thus presenting potential for converting these to mineral reserves at later stage;

  • . Additional economic reef zones might be identified upon full PFS;

  • . Additional tonnage processed might be resulted through the plant of improved availability and control; and

  • . Costs might be able to be reduced due to increased mechanization in the stoping environment, as stated in the Competent Person’s Report for Evander Project

SENSITIVITY ANALYSIS

The sensitivity analysis has been applied to determine the impact of changes in the gold price on the fair market value of the Gold Mines. The assumed gold price used for the central case of the sensitivity analysis was the forecasted gold price of US$1,700 per troy ounce in 2015. 2015 is the estimated first production year as stated in the Competent Person’s Report. The results of the sensitivity analysis were as follows:

Change in Price Concluded Fair Market Value Change in Fair Market Value
(%) (US$) (%)
-15% 382,000,000 -37%
-10% 455,000,000 -25%
-5% 527,000,000 -13%
605,000,000 0%
+5% 693,000,000 15%
+10% 781,000,000 29%
+15% 870,000,000 44%

REMARKS

For the purpose of our valuation and in arriving at our opinion of value, we have referred to the information provided by the senior management of the Company to estimate the value of the Gold Mines. We have also sought and received confirmation from the Company that no material facts were omitted from the information supplied.

– V-18 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

To the best of our knowledge, all data set forth in this report are true and accurate. Although gathered from reliable sources, no guarantee is made nor liability assumed for the accuracy of any data, opinions, or estimates identified as being furnished by others, which have been used in formulating this analysis.

Unless otherwise stated, all money amounts stated herein are in United States Dollars (US$).

CONCLUSION OF VALUE

Our conclusion of value is based on accepted valuation procedures and practices that rely substantially on the use of numerous assumptions and the consideration of a lot of uncertainties, not all of which can be easily ascertained or quantified.

Further, whilst the assumptions and consideration of such matters are considered by us to be reasonable, they are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the control of the Company, Taung, the Competent Person or us.

Based on our investigation and analysis outlined in this report, it is our opinion that the fair market value of the 100% interest in the Gold Mines as at 30 April 2011 was US$605,000,000 (UNITED STATES DOLLARS SIX HUNDRED AND FIVE MILLION ONLY).

We hereby certify that we have neither present nor prospective interest in the Company, Taung, the Competent Person, the Competent Person’s Report, the PFS, the BFS, the Gold Mines or the result reported.

This report is subject to the limiting conditions attached.

Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of

BMI APPRAISALS LIMITED

Marco T. C. Sze

B.Eng(Hon), PGD(Eng), MBA(Acct), CFA, AICPA/ABV, RBV, CIM Director

Grant Thomas

B.Sc (Hon), MAusIMM, CP Geology Consultant

– V-19 –

APPENDIX V

THE VALUATION REPORT

Analyzed and reported by:

Derek Chan — Technical Advisor Paul Lau — Associate Director

Notes:

  1. Mr. Marco T. C. Sze is a Chartered Financial Analyst, a member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) and is accredited in Business Valuation by the AICPA. In addition, he is a Registered Business Valuer under the Hong Kong Business Valuation Forum and a member of the Canadian Institute of Mining, Metallurgy and Petroleum (CIM).

  2. Mr. Grant Thomas took the role of the competent evaluator under Chapter 18 of the Listing Rules for this valuation. He is a member of the Australasian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy (MAusIMM). He has over 28 years’ experience in the mineral exploration and mining industry working on gold, coal, copper, lead, zinc, nickel, uranium, phosphate and diamond commodities. He also has extensive experience in mineral asset evaluation and valuation. He has previously explored and evaluated mineral projects in Australia, Brazil, China, Laos and Cambodia. He has been associated with several major base and precious metal and iron ore discoveries. He has held senior and executive positions in several exploration and mining companies and has consulted on mineral asset evaluation and valuation and corporate management.

– V-20 –

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

APPENDIX VI

1. THE LOAN NOTE AND THE PUT OPTION AGREEMENTS

The South African Shareholders are holders of TG Shares and are residents of South Africa. Foreign investments by South African resident shareholders in overseas assets and companies are subject to foreign exchange control restrictions. In particular, the sale proceeds from South African assets received from non-residents are not eligible for retransfer abroad by South African residents. As such, if the South African Shareholders were issued Wing Hing Shares directly by Wing Hing in consideration for their TG Shares, they would be restricted from on-selling, transferring or otherwise dealing in such Wing Hing Shares.

In view of these restrictions, GoldCom, a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands, has been introduced to subscribe for Wing Shares and enter into the following transactions with Wing Hing and the South African Shareholders:

  • (a) Subscription of Wing Hing Shares by GoldCom under the Acquisition Agreement. Pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement, Wing Hing has conditionally agreed to issue the GoldCom Consideration Shares to GoldCom in consideration for the Loan Note on the First Completion Date.

  • (b) Grant of put options under the Put Option Agreements. GoldCom and Wing Hing will, on or prior to First Completion, enter into the Put Option Agreement with each South African Shareholder pursuant to which GoldCom will grant to each South African Shareholder the SA Put Option, being a right to sell the TG Shares owned by him to GoldCom.

  • (c) On-Market Sale. Under the Put Option Agreement, as and when a South African Shareholder exercises his SA Put Option, GoldCom will sell on-market a number of Wing Hing Shares representing the number of TG Shares being sold by such South African Shareholder, multiplied by the Share Exchange Ratio. GoldCom will deliver the cash proceeds from such on-market sale to the South African Shareholder and will transfer the TG Shares to Wing Hing. The principal amount outstanding under the Loan Note will reduce by the market value of the corresponding number of Wing Hing Shares upon the transfer of TG Shares to Wing Hing.

The South African Shareholders hold TG Shares which will represent approximately 8.99% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold as at First Completion.

GoldCom is a third party whose principal business is to engage in investment holding and related activities and whose sole shareholder and sole director is Mr. Michael Yates, who is an Other TG Shareholder.

– VI-1 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

The key terms of the Put Option Agreement and Loan Note are set out below.

  • 1.2 The Put Option Agreement

Consideration The consideration payable by each South African Shareholder for the grant of the SA Put Option is ZAR1.00.

Exercise Period

The SA Put Option may be exercised at any time within three years from (and including) the First Completion Date.

  • Exercise of the SA Put Option

The SA Put Option shall be exercisable by the relevant South African Shareholder delivering a put option notice to GoldCom and an escrow agent (to be appointed by GoldCom, Wing Hing and the South African Shareholder) (with a copy to Wing Hing and Taung Gold). Upon the exercise of the SA Put Option:

  • the South African Shareholder shall, amongst other things, irrevocably instruct GoldCom to sell or procure the sale of a number of Wing Hing Shares equal to the number of TG Shares being sold multiplied by the Share Exchange Ratio, being the Put Option Consideration Shares;

  • GoldCom shall, after the sale of the Put Option Consideration Shares, deposit the cash proceeds raised from such sale into an escrow account.

Upon the deposit of the cash proceeds into an escrow account, the escrow agent shall, amongst other things and in accordance with joint instructions of Wing Hing and GoldCom, deposit the cash proceeds into a bank account of the relevant South African Shareholder.

Following exercise of the SA Put Options by the South African Shareholders, the transfer of the TG Shares from GoldCom to Wing Hing shall constitute partial repayment of the Loan Note by an amount equal to the market value of the corresponding number of Wing Hing shares.

– VI-2 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

Other material terms of the Put Option Agreement

The SA Put Options may not be transferred or transmitted by the South African Shareholders without the prior written consent of the other parties to the Put Option Agreement. If any South African Shareholder has not exercised his SA Put Option in full within the three year exercise period, GoldCom shall sell or procure the sale of the remaining Wing Hing Shares it then holds and the cash proceeds from such sale shall be paid to Wing Hing in partial repayment of the Loan Note. If the trading price of the Wing Hing Shares at the time GoldCom sells such Wing Hing Shares is below the Issue Price, the cash proceeds from the sale of such Wing Hing Shares, combined with the previous repayments may not be sufficient to repay the Loan Note in full. As GoldCom will have no further assets, Wing Hing will incur a loss by writing down the unsettled Loan Amount.

Wing Hing believes that it is unlikely that SA Put Options will remain unexercised at the end of the exercise period. At the First Completion Date, the South African Shareholders are not holding options to acquire TG Shares; they are holding issued TG Shares which are fully paid-up. The exercise of the SA Put Option is the only opportunity for the South African Shareholders to monetize their shareholdings in Taung Gold. Accordingly, it is expected that before the three year exercise period expires, all South African Shareholders will elect to exercise the SA Put Option even if the trading price of the Wing Hing Shares is below the Issue Price. Whenever a South African Shareholder exercises his SA Put Option, the Loan Note will be repaid by an amount equal to the value of the TG Shares as at the date of the Acquisition Agreement. Therefore if the SA Put Option is exercised in full, Wing Hing will not have any exposure to a fall in the Wing Hing share price as a result of having entered into the Loan Note.

If any South African Shareholder wishes to sell all or part of the TG Shares held by it to a third party during the term of the Put Option Agreement, he shall first be required to offer such TG Shares to Wing Hing through GoldCom and Wing Hing shall, through GoldCom, indicate its acceptance of the offer of such TG Shares within ten (10) Business Days from the date of receipt of the offer.

– VI-3 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

1.3 The Loan Note

Principal amount

HK$464,480,706.98

Payment

On written demand, provided that Wing Hing may not demand repayment of any amount outstanding thereunder prior to the sale on the Exchange of Wing Hing Shares and the receipt by GoldCom of an amount equivalent to the cash proceeds from the sale of the relevant Put Option Consideration Shares.

Interest

Nil

  • Other material terms

  • Other than its undertaking to sell Wing Hing Shares in accordance with the terms of the Put Option Agreements, GoldCom shall not be required to provide any additional security for payment of the principal amount outstanding on the Loan Note, and the risk of any reduction in value of the Wing Hing Shares shall be borne by Wing Hing.

GoldCom may prepay the Loan Note in whole or in part, at any time, with no penalty.

2. ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT

In addition to the TG Shares held by it prior to First Completion, Electrum also holds certain warrants giving it the right to acquire further TG Shares — the Electrum TG Warrants. Pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement, Wing Hing has agreed to enter into the Electrum Option Agreement with Electrum to conditionally grant Electrum the right to sell to Wing Hing the TG Shares acquired by Electrum upon its exercise of the Electrum TG Warrants (being Electrum Option Shares) in consideration for the issue to Electrum of the Electrum Consideration Shares. Electrum Completion takes place upon completion of the acquisition of the Electrum Option Shares by Wing Hing.

– VI-4 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

The Electrum Option Agreement is subject to the Conditions being satisfied or waived in accordance with the terms of the Acquisition Agreement. The terms of the Electrum Option Agreement are subject to the requirements under Chapter 15 of the Listing Rules and will be subject to the approval of the Exchange and the WH Shareholders at the SGM. The Electrum Option Agreement does not constitute a share option scheme of Wing Hing and accordingly, it does not fall within the requirements under Chapter 17 of the Listing Rules. The key terms of the Electrum Option Agreement are set out below.

Consideration

The consideration payable by Electrum under the Electrum Option Agreement is HK$1.00.

  • Term of the Electrum Option Agreement and the exercise period

  • The Electrum Option Agreement automatically terminates on the day which is one (1) month from (and including) the First Completion Date in the event that Electrum has not exercised its right to sell the Electrum Option Shares, or on the date which is one (1) year from (and including) the date on which Electrum has exercised its right to sell the Electrum Option Shares, whichever is later.

Electrum may exercise its right to sell the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing within one (1) month from the First Completion Date.

  • Exercise of right to sell under the Electrum Option Agreement

  • Electrum may exercise its right to sell under the Electrum Option Agreement by delivering to Wing Hing an Electrum Option Notice. Upon the issue of the Electrum Option Notice and delivery of the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing, Wing Hing will issue the Electrum Consideration Shares to Electrum.

  • Other material terms under the Electrum Option Agreement

  • The right to sell the Electrum Option Shares to Wing Hing may not be transferred or transmitted by Electrum without the prior written consent of the other parties to the Electrum Option Agreement.

3. TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

As at the date of the Acquisition Agreement, the TG Optionholders are holders of options in Taung Gold which entitle them to acquire up to 23,645,210 new TG Shares.

Pursuant to the TG Optionholder Agreement, each TG Optionholder may sell to Wing Hing or GoldCom up to 80% of the TG shares that can be issued to him following First Completion. Accordingly, up to 18,916,168 TG Shares may be sold by TG Optionholders to Wing Hing or GoldCom following First Completion. The Optionholder Agreement is subject to the Conditions being satisfied or waived in accordance with the terms of the Acquisition Agreement.

– VI-5 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

The right of the TG Optionholders to sell their TG Shares to Wing Hing or GoldCom (the TG Optionholder Put Option) is granted in accordance with the requirements under Chapter 15 of the Listing Rules and will be subject to the approval of the Exchange and the WH Shareholders at the SGM. The Optionholder Agreements do not constitute share option schemes of Wing Hing and accordingly, do not fall within the requirements under Chapter 17 of the Listing Rules.

The key terms of the TG Optionholder Agreement are as follows:

  • Consideration

  • The consideration payable by each TG Optionholder to each of Wing Hing and GoldCom for the grant of the TG Optionholder Put Option is ZAR1.00.

  • Exercise period

  • The TG Optionholder Put Options may be exercised at any time within three (3) years from (and including) the First Completion Date.

  • Exercise of the TG Optionholder Put Options

  • Following the exercise of his options to acquire TG Shares, the TG Optionholder may exercise the TG Optionholder Put Option by means of a Share Exchange or an ‘‘On-Market Sale’’ as described in the TG Optionholder Agreement.

  • Share exchange and on-market sale

  • As some of the TG Optionholders are residents of South Africa, the restrictions regarding foreign investments as mentioned in the above section of this Appendix VI headed ‘‘1. The Loan Note and the Put Option Agreements’’ will also apply to them. Accordingly, only the on-market sale mechanism will be made available to these TG Optionholders. Under this mechanic, the TG Optionholder will transfer its TG Shares to GoldCom. GoldCom will transfer the TG Shares to Wing Hing in consideration for the issue of a corresponding number of Wing Hing Shares at the Share Exchange Ratio. Those Wing Hing Shares will be sold on-market by GoldCom and the proceeds will be remitted to the TG Option Holder via the Escrow Agent.

If a TG Optionholder is not a resident of South Africa, he may sell his TG Shares to Wing Hing and Wing Hing will issue a corresponding number of Wing Hing Shares to such TG Optionholder at the Share Exchange Ratio.

The aggregate number of Wing Hing Shares to be issued to TG Optionholders and GoldCom will not exceed 1,009,616,519 Wing Hing Shares.

– VI-6 –

APPENDIX VI

THE LOAN NOTE, PUT OPTION AGREEMENT, ELECTRUM OPTION AGREEMENT AND TG OPTIONHOLDER AGREEMENT

Other material terms of the TG Optionholder Agreement

The right of first refusal

The TG Optionholder Put Options may not be transferred or transmitted without the prior written consent of the other parties to the TG Optionholder Agreement.

If, during the term of the TG Optionholder Agreement, an Optionholder wishes to sell all or part of his TG Shares to a third party, he shall first be required to offer such shares to Wing Hing (if the Optionholder is not South African resident) or to GoldCom (if the Optionholder is a South African resident) by way of written notification.

In the event that Wing Hing declines or otherwise fails to accept the offer, the TG Optionholder shall be free to offer the TG Shares to the third party, provided that such offer to the third party must be on the same terms as the offer to Wing Hing (or to GoldCom).

The right of first refusal is applicable to any of the TG Shares held by the TG Optionholder. The TG Optionholder must set out the details of the offer in the notification to Wing Hong and the terms of such offer may or may not be the same as the terms of the TG Optionholder Put Option.

– VI-7 –

APPENDIX VII

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON THE TAUNG GROUP

1. CORPORATE INFORMATION ON TAUNG GOLD

Registered Office

Block C, Ground Floor, Little Fourways Office Park, 1 Leslie Avenue East, Fourways, South Africa 2055

Place of business in Hong Kong

Not applicable

Financial advisor

Renaissance Capital (Hong Kong) Limited, a corporation licensed to carry out Type 1 (dealing in securities), Type 4 (advising on securities) and Type 6 (advising on corporate finance) regulated activities under the SFO

Auditors

Deloitte & Touche, South Africa

Company secretary Mr. Chris Hendrik Mulder

2. CHANGES IN ISSUED SHARE CAPITAL OF TAUNG GOLD SINCE ITS ESTABLISHMENT

Taung Gold was founded in 2005 by Dr. David Twist and Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin. Dr. David Twist and his wife, Mrs. Helena Twist, are TG Sellers while Mr. Christiaan Rudolph de Wet de Bruin is a South African Shareholder in the Acquisition Agreement. Subsequent to its establishment in 2005, Taung Gold raised funds through several rounds of new issuances of TG Shares.

2.1 First round fund raising (2008–2009)

In August 2008, Taung Gold issued new shares to its employees and other investors. During the second half of 2008 and the first half of 2009, Taung Gold placed additional TG Shares to other individual and institutional/corporate investors. These investors are the Other TG Shareholders and the South African Shareholders.

2.2 Electrum round fund raising

Electrum entered into a subscription agreement in May 2009 pursuant to which it subscribed for 21,500,000 TG Shares and 43,000,000 Electrum TG Warrants. The initial subscription of 10,750,000 TG Shares and 21,500,000 Electrum TG Warrants closed in June 2009. In June 2010, Electrum subscribed for an additional 10,750,000 TG Shares and an additional 21,500,000 Electrum TG Warrants. Electrum also exercised its first tranche of 21,500,000 Electrum TG Warrants. Immediately prior to First Completion, Electrum will hold 43,000,000 TG Shares and the Electrum TG Warrants to purchase 21,500,000 additional TG Shares.

– VII-1 –

APPENDIX VII

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON THE TAUNG GROUP

2.3 Investment by Mandra

Mandra entered into share subscription agreements with Taung Gold in December 2010 and January 2011 to subscribe for 2,250,000 new TG Shares.

Mandra has also entered into a warrant purchase agreement with Taung Gold pursuant to which Mandra has purchased warrants and will exercise the warrants and subscribe for an additional 11,200,000 new TG Shares prior to First Completion. The warrants will be exercised in full prior to First Completion.

Mandra and Montane Development Limited has agreed to transfer TG Shares to some of the TG Sellers before First Completion (the Transfers). The following sets out further details on the Transfers.

The Transfers

  • (a) Woo Foong Hong Limited: During 2010, Woo Foong Hong Limited purchased TG Shares from existing offshore shareholders of Taung Gold. Mandra will also transfer 4,994,049 TG Shares to Woo Foong Hong Limited prior to the First Completion Date. Woo Foong Hong Limited is ultimately beneficially owned by Moonchu Foundation Limited, a tax exempt charity established by Mr. Zhang Songyi and his family.

  • (b) Mandra Esop Limited: Mandra will transfer 5,390,770 TG Shares to Mandra Esop Limited prior to the First Completion Date. Mandra Esop Limited is ultimately beneficially owned as to 50% by Mr. Zhang Songyi and as to 50% by Mui Bing How, the wife of Mr. Zhang Songyi.

  • (c) Mr. Lin Hsin Ho: Mr. Lin Hsin Ho agreed to purchase 3,700,000 TG Shares from Mandra in June 2010 and Mandra will transfer such shares to Mr. Lin Hsin Ho prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (d) Montane Development Limited: Montane Development Limited will purchase 4,863,326 TG Shares from Mandra and will transfer 1,340,959 TG Shares to Yi Star Investment Limited prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (e) Mr. Hu Xiang Cheng: Mr. Hu Xiang Cheng will purchase 1,830,050 TG Shares from Mandra prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (f) Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace: Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace will purchase 150,000 TG Shares from Mandra prior to the First Completion Date. Ms. Mui Bing Wah Grace is the sister of Ms. Mui Bing How.

  • (g) Yi Star Investment Limited: Yi Star Investment Limited will purchase 1,340,959 TG Shares from Montane Development Limited prior to the First Completion Date.

– VII-2 –

APPENDIX VII

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON THE TAUNG GROUP

Mandra will have transferred a total of 20,928,195 TG Shares to the above-mentioned TG Sellers immediately before First Completion.

2.4 Investment by various TG Sellers

The following TG Sellers entered into subscription agreements with Taung Gold during 2011 to subscribe for new TG Shares:

  • (a) Able Union Limited: Able Union Limited has subscribed for and holds 11,200,000 TG Shares.

  • (b) ZNE Capital Limited has subscribed for and holds 3,500,000 TG Shares.

  • (c) Fully Global Investments Limited has subscribed for and holds 3,150,000 TG Shares.

  • (d) Grit Capital Limited has subscribed for and holds 700,000 TG Shares.

  • (e) Angelfly Investments Limited has subscribed for and holds 700,000 TG Shares.

Before First Completion, the following TG Sellers will purchase warrants in Taung Gold by entering into warrant purchase agreements with Taung Gold. All of the warrants will be exercised in full prior to First Completion:

  • (a) ZNE Capital Limited will hold an additional 1,655,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 1,655,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (b) Able Union Limited will hold an additional 2,800,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 2,800,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (c) Fully Global Investments Limited will hold an additional 7,800,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 7,800,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (d) Manford Capital (HK) Limited will hold an additional 420,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 420,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (e) Amplewood Resources Limited will hold an additional 2,200,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 2,200,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (f) Hong Kong Sheen Smile International Investment Limited will hold an additional 2,600,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 2,600,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

– VII-3 –

APPENDIX VII

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON THE TAUNG GROUP

  • (g) Woo Foong Hong Limited will hold an additional 675,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 675,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (h) Easy Capital Holdings Limited will hold an additional 700,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 700,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

  • (i) Sino Reach Investments Limited will hold an additional 750,000 TG Shares following the exercise of 750,000 warrants immediately prior to the First Completion Date.

– VII-4 –

APPENDIX VIII

STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

1. RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT

This Circular, for which the Directors collectively and individually accept full responsibility, includes particulars given in compliance with the Listing Rules for the purpose of giving information with regard to the Wing Hing Group and the Taung Group. The Directors, having made all reasonable enquiries, confirm that to the best of their knowledge and belief, the information contained in this Circular is accurate and complete in all material respects and not misleading or deceptive, and there are no other matters the omission of which would make any statement herein or this Circular misleading.

2. INFORMATION ON SHARE CAPITAL OF WING HING

The authorised share capital of Wing Hing is HK$150,000,000 divided into 15,000,000,000 ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each. 2,197,909,600 ordinary shares have been issued and fully paid up as at the Latest Practicable Date.

Wing Hing has 236,348,000 warrants outstanding. Each of the warrants carries the right to subscribe for one warrant share at the initial exercise price of HK$0.16 per warrant share during the period from 10 March 2010 to 9 March 2015. The exercise in full of the outstanding warrants would result in the issue of additional 236,348,000 shares of HK$0.01 each in the share capital of Wing Hing.

Wing Hing has 31,984,800 options outstanding. Each of the options carries the right to subscribe for one option share at the initial exercise price of HK$0.1846 per option share during the period from 2 March 2010 to 2 March 2012. The exercise in full of the outstanding options would result in the issue of additional 31,984,800 shares of HK$0.01 each in the share capital of Wing Hing.

3. DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS

As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors nor any of their associates, nor the Chief Executive, had any interests or short positions in the shares, underlying shares and debentures of Wing Hing and the shares and debentures of its associated corporations (within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO) which were required to be notified to Wing Hing and the Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including interests or short positions which any such director or chief executive has taken or deemed to have under such provisions of the SFO) or which were required, pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be entered in the register referred to therein, or which were required, pursuant to the Model Code for Securities Transactions by Directors of Listed Issuers, to be notified to Wing Hing and the Exchange.

3.1 Directors’ Interests in Competing Businesses

As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors nor their respective associates had any interest in any business, which might compete with the business of the Wing Hing Group.

– VIII-1 –

APPENDIX VIII

STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

3.2 Directors’ Interests in assets of the Enlarged Group

As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors had any direct or indirect interests in any assets which have been acquired or disposed of by, or leased to, or which are proposed to be acquired or disposed of by, or leased to, any member of the Enlarged Group since 31 March 2011, this being the date on which the latest audited consolidated financial statements of the Wing Hing Group were published.

3.3 Directors’ Interests in contracts of the Enlarged Group

As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors were materially interested in any contract or arrangement, which was subsisting as at the Latest Practicable Date and was significant in relation to the business of the Enlarged Group.

4. SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS

As at the Latest Practicable Date, so far as was known to the Directors and the Chief Executive of Wing Hing, the following persons had an interest or a long position in the shares and underlying shares which would fall to be disclosed to Wing Hing under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or, who was, directly or indirectly, interested in 5% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital carrying rights to vote in all circumstances at general meetings of any other member of the Enlarged Group or had options in respect of such capital:

Percentage of
Underlying issued ordinary
shares of shares as at
Number of equity the Latest
ordinary derivatives Practicable
Name of Shareholder shares (i.e. warrant) Total Interest Date
Orient Best Holdings Limited 236,348,000 236,348,000 10.75

5. DIRECTORS’ SERVICE CONTRACTS

As at the Latest Practicable Date, there was no existing or proposed service contract between any of the Directors or proposed Directors and Wing Hing or any member of the Enlarged Group (excluding contracts expiring or determinable by the Enlarged Group within a year without payment of any compensation (other than statutory compensation)).

6. LITIGATION

On 4 July 2011, Lee Hing Mining Industry Limited, a subsidiary of Wing Hing, commenced a lawsuit at a district court in Indonesia against a supplier in Indonesia involving a claimed amount of approximately HK$27,800,000 in respect of the supplier’s failure to supply certain minerals, in terms of quality and quantity specified in the supply contract, and for recovery of down payment made to the supplier and potential loss arising from the breach of contract by the supplier.

– VIII-2 –

APPENDIX VIII STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

Save as disclosed above, as at the Latest Practicable Date, so far as the Directors were aware, no member of the Enlarged Group was engaged in any litigation or arbitration or claim of material importance and the Directors were not aware of any litigation or claims of material importance pending or threatened against any member of the Enlarged Group.

7. WORKING CAPITAL OF THE ENLARGED GROUP

In determining the sufficiency of the working capital of the Enlarged Group, the Directors have made the assumption that the Transactions will be completed.

The Directors are of the opinion that, after taking into account the financial resources available to and the internal resources of the Enlarged Group and on the assumption that the Transactions will be completed in due course as set out in the preceding paragraph, the Enlarged Group has available sufficient working capital for 125% of the Enlarged Group’s requirements for the next twelve months from the date of this Circular.

8. INDEBTEDNESS

As at the close of business on 31 May 2011, being the latest practicable date for the purpose of this indebtedness statement prior to the printing of this Circular, the Enlarged Group had no secured interest-bearing bank borrowings.

As at 31 May 2011, the Enlarged Group had pledged deposits of approximately US$0.8 million of the Enlarged Group for providing loan guarantee service to client in the PRC. As at 31 May 2011, the Enlarged Group did not have any outstanding loan capital, bank overdrafts, loans, mortgages, charges or other similar indebtedness, or hire purchase of finance lease commitments, liabilities under acceptances or acceptance credits, guarantees or other material contingent liabilities.

The Directors are not aware of any material adverse changes in the Enlarged Group’s indebtedness position or contingent liabilities since 31 May 2011.

9. MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE

As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Directors were not aware of any material adverse change in the financial or trading position of the Wing Hing Group since 31 March 2011, being the date on which the latest audited consolidated financial statements of Wing Hing were published.

– VIII-3 –

APPENDIX VIII STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

10. EXPERTS AND CONSENTS

The following sets out the qualifications of the experts who have given opinion or advice which are contained in this Circular:

Qualification Independent valuer

Name Qualification BMI Appraisals Limited Independent valuer Deloitte & Touche, South Africa Certified public accountants registered in South Africa Hannes Gouws and Partners Inc. Licensed legal advisor on South African law

HLB Hodgson Impey Cheng Certified public accountants Venmyn Rand (Proprietary) Limited Independent technical adviser

Each of the above experts has given and has not withdrawn its written consent to the issue of this Circular with the inclusion herein of its report and/or opinion and/or references to its names in the form and context in which they appear.

The letters and reports from HLB Hodgson Impey Cheng were given on 28 July 2011 for incorporation in this Circular.

The letter and report from Deloitte & Touche South Africa were given on 28 July 2011 for incorporation in this circular.

The report from Venmyn Rand (Proprietary) Limited was effective on 11 February 2011 for incorporation in this Circular.

The report from BMI Appraisals Limited was given on 28 July 2011 for incorporation in this Circular.

As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the above experts was beneficially interested in the share capital of any member of the Wing Hing Group, nor did any one of them have any right (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for or to nominate persons to subscribe for securities in any member of the Wing Hing Group (including any company which will become a subsidiary of Wing Hing by reason of an acquisition or which has been agreed or proposed since 31 March 2011, being the date to which the audited consolidated financial statements of Wing Hing have been made up).

– VIII-4 –

APPENDIX VIII

STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

11. MATERIAL CONTRACTS

Set out below are the material contracts (not being contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business) entered or to be entered into by any member of the Enlarged Group within the two years immediately preceding the Latest Practicable Date:

  • (a) the subscription agreement dated 7 August 2009 and entered into between Wing Hing and Galaxy Asset Management (HK) Limited in respect of the subscription of 10,350,000 new shares of HK$1 each in the capital of Wing Hing at the subscription price of HK$1.46 per share;

  • (b) the subscription agreement dated 7 August 2009 and entered into between Wing Hing and VMS Investment Group Limited in respect of the subscription of 3,450,000 new shares of HK$1 each in the capital of Wing Hing at the subscription price of HK$1.46 per share;

  • (c) the sale and purchase agreement dated 7 September 2009 entered into between Wing Hing and Mr. Ng Tat Leung, George in respect of Wing Hing disposing the entire issued share capital of Club Ace Holdings Limited and the shareholder’s loan to Mr. Ng Tat Leung, George for a consideration of HK$1,000,000;

  • (d) the subscription agreement dated 25 September 2009 in respect of the issuance and allotment of 12,000,000 new shares of HK$1.00 each in the capital of Wing Hing to Cheever Capital Management (Asia) Limited at the subscription price of HK$1.78 per share;

  • (e) the memorandum of understanding, a supplemental memorandum of understanding and a termination agreement dated 7 October 2009, 7 April 2010 and 27 May 2010 respectively entered into between Wing Hing and Ms. Ho Yuk Ling in respect of Wing Hing acquiring the entire issued share capital of Richome Enterprises Limited;

  • (f) the underwriting agreement dated 13 November 2009 entered into between Wing Hing and China Everbright Securities (HK) Limited relating to the issuance and allotment of 46,264,000 offer shares of HK$0.1 each in the capital of Wing Hing at a subscription price of HK$1.80 per offer share by way of an open offer with an underwriting commission of approximately HK$2.67 million;

  • (g) the acquisition agreement dated 8 February 2010, the first supplemental agreement dated 14 May 2010 and the second supplemental agreement dated 2 July 2010 entered into between Longold Win Limited (a wholly-owned subsidiary of Wing Hing) and Ms. Wong Kei Yan in respect of the acquisition of the entire equity interests in Bestkin International Limited for an aggregate consideration of HK$88,000,000. Bestkin International Limited through its subsidiaries holds certain exploitation and exploration licenses to certain gold mines in the PRC;

– VIII-5 –

APPENDIX VIII

STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

  • (h) the warrant subscription agreement dated 26 February 2010 entered into between Wing Hing and Orient Best Holdings Limited, under which Wing Hing agreed to issue and the Orient Best Holdings Limited agreed to subscribe for 323,848,000 warrants at the issue price of HK$0.001 per warrant. Each of the warrants carries the right to subscribe for one warrant share at the initial exercise price of HK$0.16 per warrant share during a period of five years commencing from (and inclusive of) the date of issue of the warrants;

  • (i) the placing agreement dated 26 April 2010 entered into between Wing Hing and VC Brokerage Limited as the placing agent in respect of the placing of an aggregate of 80,000,000 shares of HK$0.01 each in the capital of Wing Hing to not fewer than six placees, at the placing price of HK$0.50 per share;

  • (j) the sale and purchase agreement and a supplemental agreement dated on 31 December 2010 and on 30 June 2011 respectively, entered between Guizhou Jinyida Mining Company Limited (an indirectly-owned subsidiary of Wing Hing) and Mr. Cheng Wei in respect of the disposal of three coal mining licenses of the Wing Hing Group at a total consideration of RMB76,600,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$90,000,000);

  • (k) the placing agreement dated on 18 January 2011 entered between Wing Hing and the Daily Growth Securities Limited in respect of the placing of up to 346,000,000 shares of Wing Hing to not fewer than six placees at a price of HK$0.40 per share; and

  • (l) the Acquisition Agreement and Amendment Agreement and Second Amendment Agreement.

Save as the aforesaid material contracts, there is no material contract (not being entered into in the ordinary course of business) entered into by any member of the Enlarged Group within the two years immediately preceding the issue of this Circular.

12. MISCELLANEOUS

  • (a) The branch share registrar of Wing Hing in Hong Kong is Tricor Tengis Limited at 26/F, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong.

  • (b) The secretary of Wing Hing is Mr. Choi Wing Koon, a fellow member of the Association of Chartered Certified Accountants and a member of the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants.

  • (c) Save as otherwise disclosed in this Circular:

  • (i) None of the Directors or any of the parties listed in the section headed ‘‘Appendix VIII — 10. Experts and Consents’’ of this Circular is interested in Wing Hing’s promotion, or in any assets which have, within the two years

– VIII-6 –

APPENDIX VIII

STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

immediately preceding the issue of this Circular, been acquired or disposed of by or leased to Wing Hing, or are proposed to be acquired or disposed of by or leased to any member of the Enlarged Group.

  • (ii) None of the Directors or any of the parties listed in the section headed ‘‘Appendix VIII — 10. Experts and Consents’’ of this Circular is materially interested in any contract or arrangement subsisting at the date of this Circular which is significant in relation to Wing Hing’s business.

  • (iii) No share or loan capital of any members of the Wing Hing Group is under option or is agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option.

  • (iv) Wing Hing has not issued nor agreed to issue any founder shares, management shares or deferred shares.

  • (v) No commission has been paid or payable (except commissions to the underwriters) for subscription, agreeing to subscribe, procuring subscription or agreeing to procure subscription of any shares in Wing Hing within the two years preceding the date of this Circular.

  • (vi) No amount or securities or benefit has been paid or allotted or given within the two years preceding the date of this Circular to any of the promoters nor is any such securities or amount or benefit intended to be paid or allotted or given.

  • (vii) To the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief having made all reasonable enquiry, the TG Sellers and the ultimate beneficial owner of the TG Sellers are third parties independent of Wing Hing and connected persons of Wing Hing.

  • (viii)The Directors have confirmed, after performing all due diligence work which they consider appropriate, that there has been no material adverse change in Wing Hing’s financial or trading position since 31 March 2011.

  • (ix) None of the Directors or any of the persons whose names are listed in the section headed ‘‘Appendix VIII — 10. Experts and Consents’’ of this Circular had received any commissions, discounts, agency fee, brokerages or other special terms in connection with the issue or sale of any capital of Wing Hing from Wing Hing within the two years preceding the date of this Circular.

  • (x) There were no alterations in the capital of any member of the Wing Hing Group within the two years preceding the date of this Circular.

  • (xi) There is no arrangement under which future dividends are waived or agreed to be waived.

  • (xii) There are no restrictions affecting the remittance of profits or repatriation of capital into Hong Kong from outside Hong Kong.

– VIII-7 –

APPENDIX VIII STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION ON WING HING

  • (d) The English text of this Circular shall prevail over the Chinese text.

– VIII-8 –

APPENDIX IX

DOCUMENTS AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION

Copies of the following documents will be available for inspection at the principal place of business of Wing Hing, at Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower, 8 Yeung Uk Road, Tsuen Wan, New Territories, Hong Kong during normal business hours up to and including the date which is 21 days from the date of this Circular:

  • (a) the memorandum of association and the by-laws of Wing Hing;

  • (b) the annual reports of the Wing Hing Group for the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011;

  • (c) the audited financial information of the Wing Hing Group for the three years ended 31 March 2009, 2010 and 2011, the text of which is set out in Appendix I of this Circular;

  • (d) the written statement of adjustments;

  • (e) the Financial Information of the Taung Group, the text of which is set out in Appendix II of this Circular;

  • (f) the report in relation to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group, the text of which is set out in Appendix III of this Circular;

  • (g) the Competent Persons Report, the text of which is set out in Appendix IV of this Circular;

  • (h) the Valuation Report, the text of which is set out in Appendix V of this Circular;

  • (i) the written consents referred to in the section headed ‘‘Appendix VIII — Statutory and General Information on Wing Hing — 10. Experts and Consents’’ of this Circular; and

  • (j) the material contracts referred to in the section headed ‘‘Appendix VIII — Statutory and General Information on Wing Hing — 11. Material Contracts’’ of this Circular.

– IX-1 –

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited and The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited take no responsibility for the contents of this announcement, make no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaim any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon the whole or any part of the contents of this announcement.

(incorporated in Bermuda with limited liability)

(Stock Code: 621)

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

NOTICE IS HEREBY GIVEN that a special general meeting (the SGM) of Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited (the Company) will be held at Unit 1901, 19/F, Nina Tower, No. 8 Yeung Uk Road, Tsuen Wan, New Territories, Hong Kong on Friday, 19 August 2011 at 11: 00 a.m. for the purpose of considering and, if thought fit, passing with or without amendments the following resolutions:

ORDINARY RESOLUTIONS

  • ‘‘1. THAT:

  • (a) the authorised share capital of the Company be and is hereby increased from HK$150,000,000 divided into 15,000,000,000 ordinary shares (the Shares) of HK$0.01 to HK$300,000,000 divided into 30,000,000,000 Shares by the creation of 15,000,000,000 additional Shares (the Capital Increase);

  • (b) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and to do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her discretion consider necessary or desirable for the purpose of or in connection with the implementation of the Capital Increase and the transactions contemplated thereunder.’’

  • ‘‘2. THAT:

  • (a) the acquisition agreement dated 28 January 2011 (as amended by two amendment agreements dated 22 March 2011 and 22 July 2011 and any other subsequent amendment) (together, the Acquisition Agreement) entered into by the Company (the Purchaser), the TG Sellers and Gold Commercial Services Limited (a copy of which is tabled at this meeting and marked ‘‘[A]’’ and initialled by the chairman of this meeting for the purpose of identification) and more particularly described in the circular of the Company dated 28 July 2011, pursuant to which the parties agreed that, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions precedent therein, the Purchaser shall acquire and the TG Sellers shall sell or procure the sale of up to 86.966% of Taung Gold Limited (Taung Gold) in consideration for the

– N-1 –

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

issuance of up to a total of 11,987,246,522 new Shares (the Consideration Shares) and all transactions contemplated thereunder be and are hereby approved, ratified and confirmed;

for the purpose of this resolution:

TG Sellers refers to, Electrum Strategic Exploration Limited, Mr. David Twist, Mrs. Helena Twist, Woo Foong Hong Limited, Yi Star Investment Limited, Mr. Lin, Hsin-Ho, Able Union Limited, ZNE Capital Limited, Fully Global Investments Limited, Grit Capital Limited, Angelfly Investments Limited, Mandra Esop Limited, Montane Development Limited, Mr. Hu, Xiang-Cheng, Ms. Mui, Bing-Wah Grace, Mandra Materials Limited, Easy Capital Holdings Limited, Manford Capital (HK) Limited, Amplewood Resources Limited, Hong Kong Sheen Smile International Investment Limited and Sino Reach Investments Limited;

  • (b) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable for the purpose of and in connection with the implementation of the Acquisition Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder and to agree to such variations of the terms of the Acquisition Agreement and the transactions documents contemplated thereunder as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable; and

  • (c) subject to and conditional upon the passing of the resolutions numbered 2 (a) and (b) and conditional upon the Listing Committee of The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited granting the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Consideration Shares, the allotment and issue of the Consideration Shares pursuant to the Acquisition Agreement upon the terms and subject to the conditions therein contained be and is hereby approved; and that any one director of the Company be and are hereby authorised, for and on behalf of the Company, to do all such acts and things and to sign, seal and execute and deliver all such documents and take all such steps which he/she may in his/ her absolute discretion consider necessary, desirable or expedient for the implementation of and giving effect to the allotment and issue of the Consideration Shares.’’

  • ‘‘3. THAT:

  • (a) put option agreements annexed to the Acquisition Agreement (the Put Option Agreements) relating to the grant of put options to each South African resident shareholders of Taung Gold in relation to the sale to the Company through Gold Commercial Services Limited (GoldCom) of such number of shares of Taung Gold representing in aggregate approximately 8.99% of the issued share capital of Taung Gold upon First Completion (as defined in the

– N-2 –

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

  - circular of the Company dated 28 July 2011) for a consideration of 1,134,348,686 new Shares and involving the issue of a loan note by GoldCom to the Company (the Loan Note) be and is hereby approved;
  • (b) Loan Note be and is hereby approved; and

  • (c) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable for the purpose of and in connection with the implementation of the Put Option Agreements and the Loan Note and the transactions contemplated thereunder and to agree to such variations of the terms of the Put Option Agreements and the Loan Note and the transactions documents contemplated thereunder as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable.’’

  • ‘‘4. THAT

  • (a) the Electrum option agreement annexed to the Acquisition Agreement (the Electrum Option Agreement) relating to the grant of put options to Electrum Strategic Exploration Limited (Electrum) in relation to the sale of such number of shares of Taung Gold acquired by Electrum upon the exercise of warrants held by Electrum issued by Taung Gold to the Company for a consideration of 1,147,523,915 new Shares be and is hereby approved; and

  • (b) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable for the purpose of and in connection with the implementation of the Electrum Option Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder and to agree to such variations of the terms of the Electrum Option Agreement and the transactions documents contemplated thereunder as he/she may in his/ her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable.’’

  • ‘‘5. THAT

  • (a) the optionholder agreement annexed to the Acquisition Agreement (the TG Optionholder Agreement) relating to the grant of put options to holders of options in Taung Gold in relation to the sale to the Company directly or through GoldCom of up to 18,916,168 shares of Taung Gold Limited acquired pursuant to the exercise of options in Taung Gold for an aggregate consideration of up to 1,009,616,519 new Shares be and is hereby approved; and

– N-3 –

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

  • (b) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable for the purpose of and in connection with the implementation of the TG Optionholder Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder and to agree to such variations of the terms of the TG Optionholder Agreement and the transactions documents contemplated thereunder as he/ she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable.’’

SPECIAL RESOLUTION

  • ‘‘6. THAT

  • (a) subject to the completion of the Acquisition Agreement and the approval of the Registrar of the Companies in Bermuda, the name of the Company be changed from ‘‘Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited’’ to ‘‘Taung Gold International Limited’’ and the Chinese name ‘‘壇金礦業有限公司’’ be adopted by the Company for identification purposes only; and

  • (b) any one director of the Company be and is hereby authorised for and on behalf of the Company to execute all such documents, instruments, agreements and deeds and do all such acts, matters and things as he/she may in his/her absolute discretion consider necessary or desirable to effect such change of name and adoption of the Chinese name.

By order of the Board Wing Hing International (Holdings) Limited Li Hok Yin Chairman

Hong Kong, 28 July 2011

Registered office: Canon’s Court 22 Victoria Street Hamilton HM 12 Bermuda

Head office and principal place of business in Hong Kong: Unit 1901, 19th Floor Nina Tower 8 Yeung Uk Road Tsuen Wan, New Territories Hong Kong

Notes:

  1. A member entitled to attend and vote at the SGM is entitled to appoint one or more than one proxy to attend and, subject to the provisions of the bye-laws of the Company, to vote on his behalf. A proxy need not be a member of the Company but

– N-4 –

NOTICE OF SPECIAL GENERAL MEETING

must be present in person at the SGM to represent the member. If more than one proxy is so appointed, the appointment shall specify the number and class of shares in respect of which each such proxy is so appointed.

  1. A form of proxy for use at the SGM is enclosed. Whether or not you intend to attend the SGM in person, you are encouraged to complete and return the enclosed form of proxy in accordance with the instructions printed thereon. Completion and return of a form of proxy will not preclude a member from attending in person and voting at the SGM or any adjournment thereof, should he so wish.

  2. In order to be valid, the form of proxy, together with a power of attorney or other authority, if any, under which it is signed, or a certified copy of such power or authority must be deposited at the Company’s branch share registrar in Hong Kong, Tricor Tengis Limited, at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for holding the SGM or any adjournment thereof.

  3. In the case of joint holders of shares, any one of such holders may vote at the SGM, either personally or by proxy, in respect of such share as if he was solely entitled thereto, but if more than one of such joint holder are present at the SGM personally or by proxy, that one of the said persons so present whose name stands first on the register of members of the Company in respect of such shares shall alone be entitled to vote in respect thereof.

  4. As at the date hereof, the Board comprises six Directors. The Executive Directors are Mr. Li Hok Yin, Ms. Cheung Pak Sum and Mr. Shen Junchen. The Independent Nonexecutive Directors are Mr. Chui Man Lung, Everett, Mr. Hui Wah Tat, Anthony and Mr. Li Kam Chung.

– N-5 –